Documente Academic
Documente Profesional
Documente Cultură
9848-600-02111/2
MON: 4512-984-30121
0.1
The relationship between mR (milliroentgen), which is the unit of radiation, and C/kg (micro-coulomb/kilogram), which is the SI derived unit of radiation, is as follows. 1 mR = 0.258 C/kg
FCR is a registered trademark of Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. <No part of this manual may be reproduced or transmitted.> Copyright 1998-2005 by Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored
Document No. 009-051-11 1 st Edition - June 20, 1998 Revised Edition - Aug. 31, 2005
in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. Miyanodai Technology Development Center.
0.1
Getting Started
0.2
Getting Started
0.3
Getting Started
I Scope
This Service Manual is applicable to Fuji Computed Radiography CR-IR341 and CR-IR341P. The machine is categorized as Class 1 according to IEC classification. For the console (hereinafter abbreviated as CSL), reference should be made to the Service Manual for ID-T741 or CR-IR348CL.
N NOTES N
Differences between the CR-IR341 and CR-IR341P are as follows. The CR-IR341 may be connected to the ID-T741. The CR-IR341P may be connected to the CR-IR348CL and ID-T741. Units with serial number #5001 or later are called CR-IR341P.
I Notational Conventions
In this manual, some conventions for unit symbols, cautions, warnings, etc. are followed to provide a simple, easy-to-read layout. G Notation of unit symbols For notation of unit symbols, metric units set forth in the International Systems of Units (SI) are used, as a rule. However, some metric units that are not allowed in the SI but are permitted in the Measurement Law are used partially. G Notation of cautions, warnings, etc. The notation formats of warning, caution, note, supplementary note, and reference are shown below.
WARNING
Used when physical injury or death may occur if the instruction is not observed.
CAUTION
Used when a minor physical injury may be incurred or the machine may suffer serious damage if the instruction is not observed.
N NOTE N
Used when the machine may suffer damage, or any failure or malfunction may occur if the instruction is not observed. SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Used to supply information that is not related directly to the work flow but may be useful if known.
0.2
0.3
Safety Precaution
0.3_1
Safety Precaution
0.3_2
Safety Precaution
Observe the following safety precautions to avoid possible hazards and accidents during installation and servicing.
1.
General Precautions
Be sure to turn OFF the power before servicing. If servicing is performed while the power remains ON, you may experience electric shock, burn, or machine malfunction. Since some parts are not fully discharged (such as the photomultiplier) or remain at high temperature (such as the lamp) even after power OFF, exercise due care not to touch them. If servicing procedures (such as voltage measurement) that cannot be performed under power-OFF condition are to be performed, use due care to avoid electric shock and other hazards, as instructed in this manual. To restart the machine, power it OFF and wait more than five seconds before powering it ON again. If the machine is powered ON within five seconds, it may shut down due to overcurrent/overvoltage protection.
I Power Supply
I Grounding
Safety provided by grounding is assured by properly establishing power cable and additional protective ground wire connections and securing the parts with retaining screws. To maintain safety, ensure that the parts and retaining screws removed for servicing purposes are restored to states existing upon installation. After the parts and retaining screws are restored to the above-mentioned states, follow the procedures set forth in this service manual to verify that the retaining screws are securely tightened to properly secure the parts.
I Heavy Objects
Get an assistant to help you during installation and removal of heavy objects. Also use suitable gear or machinery when appropriate.
I Safety Devices
For safety devices, such as fuses, breakers, interlock switches, panels, and covers, their safety features should always be enabled. Do not make any alternation or modification that may impair their functionality.
0.3_1
0.3_2
Safety Precaution
0.3_3
Safety Precaution
0.3_4
2.
BLANK PAGE
0.3_3
0.3_4
0.4
0.5
Features of Machine ....................................................................................................... MD-4 2.1 2.2 Features of Mechanical Mechanism.................................................................... MD-4 Image Network I/F Option..................................................................................... MD-5
3.
New Parts with Better Serviceability ............................................................................. MD-6 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 E-ringless Housing Employed ............................................................................. MD-6 Snap-fit Pinion Gears Employed ......................................................................... MD-7 Simple Bearing Employed.................................................................................... MD-8 Tensioner Not Requiring Tension Adjustment .................................................. MD-9 Sensor Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position .......................... MD-11
4. 5.
System Block Diagram ................................................................................................. MD-12 I/O Locations and Functional Descriptions ................................................................ MD-14 5.1 5.2 I/O Location Diagram .......................................................................................... MD-14 I/O List (Sensor) .................................................................................................. MD-15 5.2.1 5.2.2 5.2.3 5.3 Models of Sensors and Parts Codes .................................................... MD-15 Description of Sensor ON/OFF ............................................................. MD-16 Sensor Monitoring Screen Under Idle Condition ................................ MD-16 8.4 8.3
8.2.10 IP Load .................................................................................................... MD-98 8.2.11 Cassette Ejection ................................................................................. MD-103 Machine Operation During Secondary Erasure ............................................. MD-104 8.3.1 8.3.2 8.3.3 8.3.4 8.4.1 8.4.2 8.4.3 8.5 8.5.1 8.5.2 8.5.3 8.5.4 8.5.5 8.5.6 8.5.7 8.5.8 8.5.9 Summary of Operation ........................................................................ MD-104 Side-Positioning (Secondary Erasure) .............................................. MD-105 Reading (Secondary Erasure) ............................................................. MD-105 Erasure Conveyance ........................................................................... MD-108 Summary of Operation ........................................................................ MD-109 Feed/Load Step Operation .................................................................. MD-109 Side-Positioning Step Operation ........................................................ MD-116 Summary of Operation ........................................................................ MD-117 Initialization Subscanning Grip Check .............................................. MD-119 IP Search............................................................................................... MD-120 Processing of Feed/Load Conveyance IP.......................................... MD-135 Cassette Hold Release Operation Check ........................................... MD-138 Processing of Before-Reading Standby IP ........................................ MD-140 Processing of Load Standby IP .......................................................... MD-143 Processing of After-Reading Standby IP ........................................... MD-144 Subscanning Grip HP Positioning ..................................................... MD-145
6.
7.
Descriptions of Operations .......................................................................................... MD-20 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 7.8 7.9 7.10 7.11 7.12 Elevation Unit ...................................................................................................... MD-20 IP Removal Unit................................................................................................... MD-21 Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor ................................................................... MD-24 Side-Positioning Conveyor ................................................................................ MD-26 Subscanning Unit ............................................................................................... MD-29 After-Reading Conveyor..................................................................................... MD-31 Erasure Conveyor ............................................................................................... MD-32 Electrical System Block Diagram ...................................................................... MD-34 Image Data Flow.................................................................................................. MD-35 Function of Each Board ..................................................................................... MD-37 Power Supply ...................................................................................................... MD-45 Scanning Optics/Scanner Unit .......................................................................... MD-46
CR-IR341 Service Manual 0.4
009-051-11 08.31.2005 FM4710
8.5.10 Empty Cassette Ejection ..................................................................... MD-151 8.5.11 Cassette Hold Release Operation ...................................................... MD-152
CR-IR341 Service Manual 0.5
0.6
0.7
BLANK PAGE
8.6
Error Handling ................................................................................................... MD-153 8.6.1 8.6.2 8.6.3 8.6.4 8.6.5 8.6.6 8.6.7 8.6.8 8.6.9 Error Handling: Cassette Ejection 1 ................................................... MD-153 Error Handling: Cassette Ejection 2 ................................................... MD-154 Error Handling: Recovered IP Load ................................................... MD-156 Error Handling: Overexposure ........................................................... MD-158 Error Handling: Lamp Failure ............................................................. MD-158 Error Handling: Detection of IP with Improper Generation or Unit Type............................................................................................... MD-159 Error Handling: IDT Line Error ............................................................ MD-160 Error Handling: ID Information Error ................................................. MD-161 Error Handling: After-Reading Conveyance Error ............................ MD-162
8.6.10 Error Handling: BCR Retry .................................................................. MD-163 8.7 8.8 Error Code Index ............................................................................................... MD-164 Parameters ........................................................................................................ MD-166 8.8.1 8.8.2 8.8.3 8.8.4 9. Timer Settings ...................................................................................... MD-166 Retry Count Settings ........................................................................... MD-171 Erasure Conveyance Table ................................................................. MD-172 Pulse Motor Parameters ...................................................................... MD-174
Unit Location Information .......................................................................................... MD-176 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 Unit Locations ................................................................................................... MD-176 Roller Locations ................................................................................................ MD-180 IP Conveyance Locations ................................................................................ MD-181 Home Position Values ...................................................................................... MD-182 Installation Locations for Members in Contact with IP Fluorescent Face... MD-185 Data on Grip Springs ........................................................................................ MD-186
Information on Board LEDs ....................................................................................... MD-188 Interlock ....................................................................................................................... MD-190 Initialization when Starting Up the Machine ............................................................. MD-192
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
Troubleshooting (MT)
1. 2. Document Map ................................................................................................................. MT-2 Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Error Codes ................................................... MT-3 2.1 2.2 2.3 How to Understand Error Code ........................................................................... MT-3 Error Codes List .................................................................................................... MT-4 Format of Detail Information ............................................................................ MT-106 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 2.4 2.4.1 03A2 03A8 03B1 03B2 03B3 03B4 03B5 03B6 03B7 03B9 03BC 03BF 03C0 03C1 03C2 03C6 03CA 03C7 03CB 03D1 03D2 03D3 03D4 03D5
009-051-08 05.30.2002 FM3405 (1)
03D6 03D7 03D8 03D9 03DC 03DD 03DE 03E8 13A1 13A2 13A3 13A9 13AB 13AC 13AD 13AE 13AF 13E1 13E2 13E3 13E4 2.4.2 2.4.3 2.4.4 2.4.5 2.4.6 2.5 2.6
After-Erasure Conveyance Error ........................................................ MT-178 Convergence Path Changeover Guide Operation Error................... MT-180 After-Reading Conveyance Remaining IP Ejection Error ................ MT-182 Erasure Conveyance Remaining IP Ejection Error ........................... MT-184 After-Reading Conveyance Grip Operation Error ............................. MT-186 Elevation HP Movement error ............................................................. MT-188 Elevation Movement Error .................................................................. MT-190 Suction Cup Movement Operation Error ........................................... MT-192 Cassette Setting Error ......................................................................... MT-194 Cassette Hold Release Error ............................................................... MT-196 Cassette Shelf Error ............................................................................ MT-198 Barcode Read Error ............................................................................. MT-200 Overexposed IP Unerased .................................................................. MT-204 ID Information Not Registered ............................................................ MT-206 IP with Improper Generation or Type Detected................................. MT-208 No MPM Code Available ...................................................................... MT-210 IDT Line Error ....................................................................................... MT-212 Feed IP Suction Error .......................................................................... MT-214 Feed IP Dropped/13E5 Load IP Dropped ........................................... MT-216 IP Grip Error ......................................................................................... MT-218 Load IP Suction Error .......................................................................... MT-220 Cable Check Flow ................................................................................ MT-222 PC Board Check Flow.......................................................................... MT-224 HDD Check Flow .................................................................................. MT-226 Power Supply Unit Check Flow .......................................................... MT-228 Monitor Check Flow ............................................................................. MT-232
Supplementary Explanation of Detail Information ............................ MT-122 Format of Abort Code .......................................................................... MT-123 Priority Checks to Be Conducted upon Trouble Occurrence .......... MT-124 Error Code Analysis Flows ................................................................. MT-128 Cassette hold release error / 03A3 Degeneration for all shelves .... MT-128 Out-Of-Spec Initialization IP Size/13A8 Out-Of-Spec IP Size ........... MT-130 Feed Conveyance Error ....................................................................... MT-132 Load Conveyance Error ...................................................................... MT-134 Side-Positioning Conveyor Inlet Conveyance Error......................... MT-136 Recovered IP Load Slow Conveyance Error ..................................... MT-138 Recovered IP Load Fast Conveyance Error ...................................... MT-140 Feed/Load Conveyance Remaining IP Ejection Error ...................... MT-142 Side-Positioning Conveyance Remaining IP Ejection Error ............ MT-144 Load Standby Remaining IP Ejection Error....................................... MT-148 Side-Positioning Operation Error ....................................................... MT-150 Side-Positioning Grip Operation Error .............................................. MT-152 Reading Preparation Conveyance Error ............................................ MT-156 Reading Conveyance Error ................................................................. MT-158 Reading IP Leading-Edge Detection Error ........................................ MT-160 Driving Shaft Grip Error/03C8 Driving Shaft Grip Release Error ..... MT-162 Driving Shaft Grip Self-Diagnostics Error ......................................... MT-162 Driven Shaft Grip Release Error/03C9 Driven Shaft Grip Error ....... MT-164 Driven Shaft Grip Self-Diagnostics Error .......................................... MT-164 After-Reading Conveyance Error ....................................................... MT-168 Switchback Conveyance Error ........................................................... MT-170 Before-Erasure Conveyance Error ..................................................... MT-172 Branch Path Changeover Guide Operation Error ............................. MT-174 Erasure Conveyance Error .................................................................. MT-176
CR-IR341 Service Manual 0.8
009-051-08 05.30.2002 FM3405
IP Jam Handling Procedures ........................................................................... MT-234 Checking for Improper IP Conveyance ........................................................... MT-245
0.9
0.10
0.11
BLANK PAGE
3.
Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Abnormal Images ...................................... MT-248 3.1 3.2 3.3 Troubleshooting for Scanner-Related Errors................................................. MT-248 Image Troubleshooting for Controller ............................................................ MT-255 Other Image Troubleshooting.......................................................................... MT-259
4.
Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Improper Operation ................................... MT-262 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 Remedy When Cassette Cannot be Removed ............................................... MT-262 Remedy When Machine Does Not Power Up ................................................. MT-263 Remedy When LED Is Not Lit........................................................................... MT-264 Remedy When System Goes Down Unexpectedly during Operation .......... MT-265 Main Numerical Values Used for Troubleshooting ........................................ MT-266
5. 6.
Machine Circuit Diagram ............................................................................................. MT-268 Power Supply Related Fuse Block Diagram .............................................................. MT-289
Appendix 1. Supplementary Information ............................................................................ MT_A1-1 Appendix 1.1 Setting of Error Code to be Captured for IO Trace ........................ MT_A1-1
0.10
0.11
0.12
0.13
Checking and Replacing Shock Absorbers of IP Removal Unit..................... MC-78 Checking and Replacing Elevation Changeover Guide .................................. MC-82 Replacing Vertical Conveyor Guide .................................................................. MC-84
Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor .............................................................................. MC-86 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 6.9 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor .................... MC-86 Checking and Replacing Before-BCR IP Sensor (SC1) ................................... MC-88 Checking and Replacing Convergence Standby IP Sensor (SC2) ................. MC-90 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Convergence Path Changeover Guide Drive Solenoid (SOLC1) .......................................................................... MC-92 Replacing Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor IP Transport Motor (MC1) ..... MC-94 Replacing and Adjusting Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor Drive Timing Belt ................................................................................................ MC-95 Replacing Cleaning Roller ................................................................................. MC-97 Replacing Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor Rubber Rollers ...................... MC-99 Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber-Attached Guide of Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor ................................................................. MC-100
Removing and Reinstalling Covers ............................................................................. MC-20 Cassette Set Unit ........................................................................................................... MC-26 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit .................................... MC-26 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit ................................................. MC-28 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly ................................................ MC-30 Checking and Replacing Cassette Ejection Sensors (SA1, 5, 9, 13).............. MC-32 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette IN Sensors (SA2, 6, 10, 14) .. MC-34 Checking and Replacing Cassette Hold Sensors (SA3, 7, 11, 15).................. MC-38 Checking and Replacing Mammo/ST Sensors (SA4, 8, 12, 16) ...................... MC-40 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette Hold Solenoids (SOLA1-4) ... MC-42 Checking and Replacing Elevation HP Sensor (SA17).................................... MC-47 Replacing Inch/Metric Guides............................................................................ MC-49 Adjusting Movable Roll ...................................................................................... MC-50 Replacing Rubber Rollers of Cassette Set Unit ............................................... MC-55 Replacing Guide Plate of Cassette Set Unit ..................................................... MC-56 Mounting the Antistatic Member of the Shutter Section ............................ MC-59.21 7. 8.
Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit ................................................................. MC-106 Side-Positioning Conveyor......................................................................................... MC-110 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 8.9 8.10 8.11 8.12 8.13 8.14 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor ............................... MC-110 Checking and Replacing Side-Positioning Mechanism HP Sensor (SD1)... MC-112 Checking and Replacing Grip Release HP Sensor (SD2).............................. MC-114 Checking and Replacing Side-Positioning IP Sensor (SD3) ......................... MC-116 Replacing Side-Positioning Motor (MD1) ....................................................... MC-118 Replacing Grip Release Motor (MD2) .............................................................. MC-119 Replacing IP Transport Motor (MD3)............................................................... MC-120 Replacing Barcode Reader (BCR) ................................................................... MC-121 Checking and Replacing Side-Positioning Conveyor Grip Mechanism ...... MC-122 Checking and Replacing Side-Positioning Top Stopper............................... MC-124 Replacing Side-Positioning Conveyor Grip Release Timing Belt ................ MC-126 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Side-Positioning Conveyor IP Conveyance Timing Belt .............................................................................. MC-127 Replacing Side-Positioning Conveyor Rubber Rollers ................................. MC-130 Checking and Replacing Shock Absorbers of Side-Positioning Conveyor MC-131
5.
Up-Down IP Removal Unit ............................................................................................ MC-60 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 Checking and Replacing Suction Cup HP Sensor (SB1) ................................ MC-60 Checking and Replacing Cassette Inlet IP Sensor (SB2) ................................ MC-62 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Each Shelf Position Sensor (SB3) ...... MC-64 Checking and Adjusting Inch/Metric Sensor (SB4) ......................................... MC-66 Checking and Replacing Suction Sensor (SB5) .............................................. MC-67 Replacing Suction Pump (PB1) ......................................................................... MC-68 Replacing IP Leak Valve (SVB1) ........................................................................ MC-70 Replacing Suction Cups..................................................................................... MC-71 Replacing Suction Cup Drive Motor (MB1) ....................................................... MC-73 Replacing IP Transport Motor (MB2)................................................................. MC-75 Replacing Up-Down Drive Motor (MB3) ............................................................ MC-76 Replacing Elevation Timing Belt ....................................................................... MC-77
CR-IR341 Service Manual 0.12
0.13
0.14
0.15
9.
Scanning Optics Unit .................................................................................................. MC-132 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 Adjusting Read Start Position and Read Width ............................................. MC-132 Shading/Sensitivity Correction........................................................................ MC-138 Removing and Reinstalling Scanning Optics Unit ..................................... MC-143.1 Checking and Replacing LD Assembly .......................................................... MC-145 Checking and Replacing Polygonal Mirror Assembly................................... MC-151 Checking and Replacing SYN08A Board ........................................................ MC-156
12.
Erasure Conveyor ....................................................................................................... MC-218 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4 12.5 12.6 12.7 12.8 12.9 12.10 12.11 12.12 12.13 12.14 12.15 Removing and Reinstalling Erasure Lamp Assembly ................................... MC-218 Removal and Reinstallation of Erasure Conveyor......................................... MC-220 Checking and Replacing After-Reading Conveyance Standby IP Sensor (SF1) ................................................................................................. MC-222 Checking and Replacing Changeover IP Sensor (SF2) ................................. MC-224 Checking and Replacing Load Standby IP Sensor (SF3) .............................. MC-226 Checking and Replacing Overrun IP Sensor (SF4)........................................ MC-228 Replacing IP Transport Motor (MF1) ............................................................... MC-230 Checking and Replacing Erasure Lamp ......................................................... MC-231 Replacing Thermal Switches (TSW1, TSW2) .................................................. MC-232 Replacing Erasure Cooling Fan (FANF1)........................................................ MC-234 Replacing Erasure Cooling Fan Air Filter ....................................................... MC-235 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Erasure Unit IP Conveyance Timing Belt ........................................................................................................ MC-236 Replacing Erasure Conveyor Rubber Rollers ................................................ MC-239 Checking and Replacing Branch Path Changeover Guide ........................... MC-240 Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber of Erasure Conveyor ................. MC-243
10.
Subscanning Unit ........................................................................................................ MC-162 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 10.11 10.12 10.13 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 Checking and Replacing SCN08A Board........................................................ MC-162 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide .................................................................... MC-165 Checking and Replacing PMT08A Board........................................................ MC-174 Servicing Light-Collecting Mirror .................................................................... MC-180 Checking and Replacing IP Leading-Edge Sensor (SZ1/SED08A) ............... MC-184 Checking and Replacing Driving-Side Grip Release HP Sensor (SZ2) ........ MC-186 Checking and Replacing Driven-Side Grip Release HP Sensor (SZ3) ......... MC-187 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) ..................................... MC-188 Replacing Driving Shaft Grip Motor (MZ2) ..................................................... MC-190 Replacing Driven Shaft Grip Motor (MZ3)....................................................... MC-191 Checking and Replacing SUS Belt/Rubber Belt/Tensioner .......................... MC-192 Checking and Replacing Kapton Belt/Tensioner/Flywheel ........................ MC-195 Replacing Rubber Roller Located Above Subscanning Unit........................ MC-199 Replacing Grip Arms ........................................................................................ MC-201 Replacing Guide Plate of Subscanning Unit .................................................. MC-202 Replacing Lower Rubber Rollers of Subscanning Unit ................................ MC-204 Replacing and Adjusting Shock-Absorbing Rubbers ................................... MC-205 15. 14. 13.
Power Supply Unit ....................................................................................................... MC-252 13.1 13.2 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit .............................. MC-252 Power Supply Unit Fuses ................................................................................. MC-254
HDD .............................................................................................................................. MC-258 14.1 14.2 14.3 Setting HDD ....................................................................................................... MC-258 Replacing HDD .................................................................................................. MC-260 Replacing the HDD (ST52160N/QM32100SE-S/WDE4550-003/ WDE9100-003/ST318416N) ............................................................................ MC-263.1
11.
After-Reading Conveyor ............................................................................................. MC-208 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor ................................... MC-208 Checking and Replacing Grip Release HP Sensor (SE1) .............................. MC-213 Replacing Grip Release Motor (ME1) .............................................................. MC-215 Replacing IP Transport Motor (ME2) ............................................................... MC-216 Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber of After-Reading Conveyor....... MC-217 16. 15.1 15.2
FDD ............................................................................................................................... MC-264 Setting FDD ....................................................................................................... MC-264 Replacing FDD .................................................................................................. MC-265
Monitor ......................................................................................................................... MC-268 16.1 16.2 16.3 Cleaning Monitor............................................................................................... MC-268 Replacing the Monitor ...................................................................................... MC-269 Monitor Fuse ..................................................................................................... MC-271
0.14
0.15
0.16
0.17
BLANK PAGE
17.
PC Boards .................................................................................................................... MC-274 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.5 17.6 17.7 17.8 17.9 17.10 17.11 17.12 17.13 17.14 17.15 17.16 17.17 17.18 17.19 17.20 17.21 Board Arrangement Diagram ........................................................................... MC-274 MTH08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-275 MTH08D Board .................................................................................................. MC-277 CPU90E Board................................................................................................... MC-279 IMG07B Board ................................................................................................... MC-282 IMG08A Board ................................................................................................... MC-283 IMG08B/H Board................................................................................................ MC-284 DMC08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-285 HCP08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-286 CPU90F Board ................................................................................................... MC-287 LAN90B/D Board ............................................................................................... MC-289 DRV08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-290 SNS08A Board................................................................................................... MC-292 LED08A Board ................................................................................................... MC-294 LED08B Board ................................................................................................... MC-295 VOL08A Board................................................................................................... MC-295 BCR08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-296 FFM Board ......................................................................................................... MC-296 SCN08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-296 PMT08A Board .................................................................................................. MC-296 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards .... MC-297
18. 19.
Cleaning IP ................................................................................................................... MC-298 Tools ............................................................................................................................. MC-300 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 19.5 Standard Tools .................................................................................................. MC-300 Special Tools and Measuring Instruments ..................................................... MC-304 Special Consumables ....................................................................................... MC-305 Semi-Standard Tools ........................................................................................ MC-306 Tools .................................................................................................................. MC-307
0.16
0.17
0.18
0.19
NETMASKS (NETMASKS) ................................................................................. MU-62 DICOM (Base on DICOM)................................................................................... MU-63 Backing Up Configuration File ......................................................................... MU-65 Network-Related Setup Example ...................................................................... MU-66
3. TEST MODE: Operation Setup ................................................................................. MU-72 8.1 8.2 1.ROUTINE: Setting Operation Mode of Routine Processing ........................ MU-72 2. AUTO MODE: Setting Operation Mode of Conveyance Test ..................... MU-72
How to Activate and Exit M-Utility ................................................................................ MU-6 3.1 3.2 Activating M-Utility .............................................................................................. MU-6 Exiting M-Utility .................................................................................................... MU-9
4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY: Electrical Diagnostics ....................................................... MU-74 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 1. ERASURE LAMP TEST: Erasure Lamp Turn-On Test ................................ MU-74 2. IMAGE MEMORY TEST: Image Memory Test .............................................. MU-74 3. DSP TEST: Self Diagnostics of Image Processing Board.......................... MU-74 4. LAN: LAN Test................................................................................................ MU-75 5. HDD: HDD Test ............................................................................................... MU-77 6. FDD: FDD Test................................................................................................ MU-77
4.
Common Operating Procedures for M-Utility ............................................................ MU-10 4.1 4.2 4.3 Selecting a Menu................................................................................................ MU-10 Quitting a Menu .................................................................................................. MU-11 Entering a Numerical Value .............................................................................. MU-12 10.
5.
Menu Hierarchy of M-Utility ......................................................................................... MU-14 5.1 5.2 Menu Hierarchy of M-Utility during Normal Operation ................................... MU-14 Menu Hierarchy of M-Utility in Initialization Sequence or in Serious Error.. MU-22
5. SCANNER UTILITY: Scanner Diagnostics and Setting ......................................... MU-78 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 1. INITIALIZE: Initial Setting of Main-Scan System ......................................... MU-78 2. POLYGON: Polygon Stop/Rotation .............................................................. MU-78 3. LASER: Laser ON/OFF .................................................................................. MU-78 4. HV: HV ON/OFF .............................................................................................. MU-79 5. HV DATA: High-Voltage Setting ................................................................... MU-79 6. FORMAT: Setting Read Start Position and Read Width ............................. MU-80 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY : Setting Shading and Sensitivity Correction Data ......................................... MU-82 8. DATA MANAGEMENT: Displaying Data Setup Values and Writing to HD ............................................................................................... MU-84 9. DIAGNOSTIC: Self Diagnostics of Scanner................................................. MU-87 10. VIRTUAL IMAGE: Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal ................................................................................................. MU-88
6.
1. ERROR LOG UTILITY: Error Log Utility .................................................................. MU-24 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 1. LIST: Displaying Error Log ........................................................................... MU-24 2. CLEAR: Clearing Error Log........................................................................... MU-26 3. SAVE TO FD: Saving Error Log to Floppy Disk .......................................... MU-27 4. SAVE TO HD: Saving Error Log to HD ......................................................... MU-28
7.
2. CONFIGURATION SETTING: Configuration Utility ................................................ MU-30 7.1 7.2 Editing Various Setup Files ............................................................................. MU- 31 SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)........................................................................................ MU-33 7.2.1 7.2.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 7.8 7.9 7.10 7.11 List of Setup Items for SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) .................................... MU-35 For Installation by Copying Configuration Files ........................... MU-41.10 11.
PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG) ...................................................................................... MU-42 Network-Related Setup Items ........................................................................... MU-51 REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) ................................................................... MU-52 EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) ......................................................................................... MU-53 LOCAL INTERFACE (INTERFACE) ................................................................... MU-55 NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) ......................................................... MU-56 HOSTS ADDRESS (HOSTS) .............................................................................. MU-58 DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ............................................................................ MU-60 ROUTING (ROUTE) ............................................................................................ MU-61
6. MECHANICAL UTILITY: Mechanical Diagnostics .................................................. MU-90 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5 11.6 1. INITIALIZE: Initialization of Motors, Actuators, and Sensors .................... MU-90 2. MOTOR: Operation Tests on Motor.............................................................. MU-91 3. ACTUATOR: Operation Tests on Solenoids, Pumps, etc. ......................... MU-95 4. SENSOR: Operation Tests on Sensors........................................................ MU-97 5. UNIT: 1. IP FEED/LOAD UNIT: Operation Tests on IP Removal Mechanism ......................................................................................................... MU-99 5. UNIT: 2. UP-DOWN UNIT: Operation Tests on Elevation Unit ................. MU-100
0.18
0.19
0.20
0.21
5. UNIT: 3. SIDE-POSITIONING GRIP: Operation Tests on Side-Positioning Mechanism Grip ............................................................ 5. UNIT: 4. SIDE-POSITIONING UNIT: Operation Tests on Side-Positioning Mechanism..................................................................... 5. UNIT: 5. AFTER-READING GRIP: Operation Tests on After-Reading Conveyor Grip .................................................................... 5. UNIT: 6. DRIVING GRIP: Operation Tests on Subscanning Driving Grip Mechanism..................................................... 5. UNIT: 7. DRIVEN GRIP: Operation Tests on Subscanning Driven Grip Mechanism ...................................................... 5. UNIT : 8. MIRROR UP/DOWN: Operation Tests on Light-Collecting Mirror ...............................................................................
Software Installation Procedures ............................................................................. MU-154 16.1 16.2 16.3 Installing the Software (Application).............................................................. MU-155 Formatting Hard Disk ....................................................................................... MU-159 Installing Menu Default FD for USA Setup File (Only for Use in USA/ CSL Type) ......................................................................................................... MU-160 List of Software Files ................................................................................................. MU-162 17.1 17.2 SYSTEM ............................................................................................................ MU-162 LOG ................................................................................................................... MU-169
7. FILE UTILITY: File Operation ................................................................................. MU-108 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4 12.5 12.6 12.7 1. FORMAT FD: Formatting FD ....................................................................... MU-108 2. FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION : Formatting HD Image Storage Partition ...................................................... MU-109 3. BACKUP: Backing Up Various Data........................................................... MU-110 4. RESTORE: Reading Various Data .............................................................. MU-116 5. EDR DATA: Saving EDR Calculation to FD ............................................... MU-121 6. PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE: Reverting Back to Previous Version of System Software.......................................................................................... MU-123 7. EXECUTION: Loading and Executing File ................................................. MU-124
8. BACKUP MEMORY: Backing Up Memory ............................................................. MU-126 9. HV ON/OFF: High-Voltage Switch (Software Switch) .......................................... MU-128 10. MENU SETTING: Menu Setting ........................................................................... MU-130 15.1 15.2 15.3 15.4 15.5 15.6 15.7 1. LIST: Displaying Menu ................................................................................ MU-133 2. MOVE: Changing Menu Display Location ................................................. MU-135 3. ROUTINE: Registering and Deleting (Disselecting) Routine Menu ......... MU-139 4. EDIT: Editing Menu Names and Various Parameters ............................... MU-143 5. COPY: Copying Menu .................................................................................. MU-146 6. DELETE: Deleting Menu .............................................................................. MU-148 7. FILMMARK: Editing Film Mark.................................................................... MU-150
0.20
0.21
0.22
0.23
INDEX 10A SUB SCANNING UNIT 1 ..................................................................................... SP-80 INDEX 10B SUB SCANNING UNIT 2 ..................................................................................... SP-82 INDEX 10C SUB SCANNING UNIT 3 ..................................................................................... SP-84 INDEX 11 SCANNING OPTICS UNIT .................................................................................. SP-86 INDEX 12A CONTROLLER 1 ................................................................................................. SP-88 INDEX 12B CONTROLLER 2 ................................................................................................. SP-90 INDEX 12C CONTROLLER 3 ................................................................................................. SP-94 INDEX 13 INDEX 14 INDEX 15 INDEX 16 INDEX 17 INDEX 18 OPTION ............................................................................................................... SP-96 CABLE ................................................................................................................. SP-98 CONNECTION DIAGRAM ................................................................................. SP-102 PARTS NOS. SEARCH TABLE ........................................................................ SP-112 TABLE OF SCREWS / WASHERS INDICATION SYMBOLS .......................... SP-122 LIST OF QUICK WEARING PARTS .................................................................. SP-123
0.22
0.23
0.24
0.25
(separate manual)
Setting Date and Time ....................................................................................... PM-82 Clearing Error Log ............................................................................................. PM-84 Turning ON High-Voltage Switch (Software Switch) ...................................... PM-85 Checking Image ................................................................................................. PM-86 Checking for Improper Protective Grounding ................................................. PM-87
Preventive Maintenance ................................................................................................ PM-2 Preventive Maintenance Programs by Intervals .......................................................... PM-4 Details of Procedures .................................................................................................... PM-6 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 3.12 3.13 3.14 3.15 3.16 3.17 3.18 3.19 3.20 3.21 3.22 3.23 3.24 3.25 3.26 3.27 3.28 3.29 3.30 3.31 Checking Error Log ............................................................................................. PM-6 Checking Image ................................................................................................... PM-7 Cleaning FD Drive and Magnetic Card Reader................................................ PM-12 Turning OFF High-Voltage Switch (Software Switch) .................................... PM-13 Removing Covers .............................................................................................. PM-14 Replacing Air Filters .......................................................................................... PM-16 Pulling Out Tray of Cassette Set Unit .............................................................. PM-17 Removing Cassette Set Unit ............................................................................. PM-18 Cleaning Suction Cups...................................................................................... PM-19 Replacing Suction Cups.................................................................................... PM-20 Replacing Suction Pump (PB1) ........................................................................ PM-22 Checking Shock Absorbers of IP Removal Unit ............................................. PM-24 Checking Shock Absorber Located Under Vertical Conveyor ...................... PM-28 Checking Shock Absorbers of Vertical Conveyor .......................................... PM-29 Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit .......................................................................... PM-31 Pushing in Tray of Cassette Set Unit ............................................................... PM-32 Checking Shock Absorbers of Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor .............. PM-33 Replacing Cleaning Roller ................................................................................ PM-39 Cleaning Erasure Lamp Assembly and Erasure Conveyor Filter................... PM-41 Replacing Erasure Lamps ................................................................................. PM-43 Checking Shock Absorbers of Erasure Conveyor.......................................... PM-44 Checking Shock Absorber Located Under Erasure Conveyor ...................... PM-51 Checking and Cleaning Subscanning Unit Belts ............................................ PM-54 Checking Vibration-Proof Rubbers .................................................................. PM-57 Pulling Out Scanner Unit................................................................................... PM-58 Cleaning Light-Collecting Guide and Light-Collecting Mirror ....................... PM-60 Checking Shock Absorber of After-reading Conveyor .................................. PM-66 Checking Shock Absorbers of Side-Positioning Conveyor........................... PM-72 Pushing in Scanner Unit ................................................................................... PM-75 Cleaning Rubber Rollers ................................................................................... PM-77 Reinstalling and Cleaning Covers .................................................................... PM-79
XXXX.............................................................................................................................. PM-88
0.24
0.25
Contents Installation
0.26
Contents Installation
0.27
Installation (IN)
1. 2. How Installation Volume Is Organized ............................................................................. IN-2 Determination of System Configuration ......................................................................... IN-8 2.1 2.2 2.3 Connectable Peripherals and Software Versions ................................................ IN-8 Information on Optional Boards for CR-IR341 ................................................... IN-10 Basic Pattern of System Configuration .............................................................. IN-11 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 2.4 3. Pattern Where IDT-IV Is Connected to CPU90E .................................... IN-13 Pattern Where IDT-IV Is Connected to CPU90F .................................... IN-14 Pattern Where CR-IR348CL is Connected to LAN90B .......................... IN-15
5.
Temporary Placement ..................................................................................................... IN-70 5.1 5.2 Unloading, Transfer, and Unpacking .................................................................. IN-70 Checking the Items Supplied ............................................................................... IN-75 5.2.1 5.2.2 5.2.3 5.3 Machine main body.................................................................................. IN-75 Separate packaged items ........................................................................ IN-76 Options ..................................................................................................... IN-77
6.
Installation ....................................................................................................................... IN-78 6.1 6.2 Work Flow .............................................................................................................. IN-78 Unclamping and Installing Separate Packaged Items (Except for Boards) .... IN-79 6.2.1 6.2.2 6.2.3 6.2.4 6.2.5 6.2.6 6.2.7 6.3 6.3.1 6.3.2 6.3.3 6.3.4 6.3.5 6.3.6 6.3.7 6.3.8 6.3.9 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 6.9 Removal of Covers .................................................................................. IN-80 Procedures at Cassette Set Unit and Up-Down IP Removal Unit ........ IN-82 Procedures at Erasure Conveyor and Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor .................................................................................................. IN-91 Procedures at Side-Positioning Conveyor, Subscanning Unit, and Power Supply Unit ............................................................................ IN-93 Procedures at Scanner Unit .................................................................... IN-98 Procedures at Controller ....................................................................... IN-108 Unclamping Check List ......................................................................... IN-110 MTH08A Board or MTH08D Board ........................................................ IN-111 MMC90A Board or DIM08A Board ........................................................ IN-114 CPU90E board ..................................................................................... IN-115.1 IMG07B board......................................................................................... IN-116 CPU90F board or LAN90B board .......................................................... IN-118 HCP08A board ........................................................................................ IN-121 DMC08A board ....................................................................................... IN-123 IMG08B/H board ..................................................................................... IN-126 IMG08A board......................................................................................... IN-128
Determination of Configuration Information ................................................................ IN-16 3.1 SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)........................................................................................... IN-22 3.1.1 3.1.2 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 3.12 List of Setup Items of SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) ........................................ IN-24 Setup Items of SYSTEM to be Changed for Second and Subsequent Machines .......................................................................... IN-35.3 PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG) ...................................................................................... IN-35.4 3.2.1 List of Setup Items of PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG) ....................................... IN-36 REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) ...................................................................... IN-42 EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) ............................................................................................ IN-43 LOCAL INTERFACE (INTERFACE) ...................................................................... IN-45 NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) ............................................................ IN-46 HOSTS ADDRESS (HOSTS) ................................................................................. IN-48 DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ............................................................................... IN-50 ROUTING (ROUTE) ............................................................................................... IN-51 NETMASKS (NETMASKS) .................................................................................... IN-52 DICOM (Base on DICOM)................................................................................... IN-53.1 List of Setup Items Related to Network and Setup Examples .......................... IN-54
4.
Preparation for Installation Environment ...................................................................... IN-62 4.1 Specifications of Machine .................................................................................... IN-62 4.1.1 4.1.2 4.1.3 4.2 4.3 Machine Moving and Fixing Means ........................................................ IN-64 Environmental Requirements ................................................................. IN-64 Electrical Specifications .......................................................................... IN-65
6.3.10 Installing Board Retaining Plate ........................................................ IN-129.1 Cable Wiring Diagram......................................................................................... IN-130 6.4.1 Interface Cables ..................................................................................... IN-130 Preparations for Power ON ................................................................................ IN-131 Turning ON the Power ........................................................................................ IN-134 Measuring and Adjusting Voltage ..................................................................... IN-137 Clearing Backup Memory ................................................................................... IN-138 Setting Date and Time ........................................................................................ IN-140
0.26
0.27
Contents Installation
0.28
Contents Installation
0.29
7.
Setting Configuration File ............................................................................................ IN-142 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 Installing Configuration File .............................................................................. IN-143 Editing Configuration Files ................................................................................ IN-147 Backing Up Configuration File .......................................................................... IN-150 Resetting Machine .............................................................................................. IN-153
Appendix 1. Worksheet for Determination of System Configuration ............................... IN_A1-1 Appendix 2. For Determination of Configuration Information .......................................... IN_A2-1 Appendix 2.1 SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) ............................................................. IN_A2-1 Appendix 2.2 PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG) .......................................................... IN_A2-15 Appendix 3. Common Information about M-Utility............................................................. IN_A3-1 Appendix 3.1 How to Activate M-Utility ......................................................... IN_A3-1 Appendix 3.2 How to Exit M-Utility ................................................................ IN_A3-3 Appendix 3.3 Common Operations in M-Utility ............................................ IN_A3-4 Appendix 3.3.1 How to Select Menu ..................................... IN_A3-4 Appendix 3.3.2 How to Quit Menu ....................................... IN_A3-5 Appendix 3.3.3 How to Enter Numeral Value ....................... IN_A3-6 Appendix 4. Requirements Regarding Locally Obtained Parts ....................................... IN_A4-1 Appendix 5. Settings on Units Interfaced .......................................................................... IN_A5-1 Appendix 5.1 Settings on IDT-IV .................................................................... IN_A5-1 Appendix 5.2 Settings on DMS Unit .............................................................. IN_A5-1 Appendix 6. Installing Optional Software ........................................................................... IN_A6-1 Appendix 7. *** ...................................................................................................................... IN_A7-1 Appendix 7.1 ***.............................................................................................. IN_A7-1 Appendix 7.2 ***............................................................................................ IN_A7-19 Appendix 8. Menu Editor Settings ....................................................................................... IN_A8-1 Appendix 9. Procedures for Connecting with CR Console (CR-IR348CL) ....................... IN_A9-1
8.
Final Installation and Checks ....................................................................................... IN-154 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 8.9 8.10 Checking IP Conveyance in M-Utility ................................................................ IN-154 Reinstalling Covers ............................................................................................ IN-157 Final Placement................................................................................................... IN-158 Checks after Machine Startup ........................................................................... IN-161 Checking Interface Operation ............................................................................ IN-162 Checking Image and Adjusting Image Requirements ..................................... IN-163 Checking and Deleting Error Logs That Occur during Setup......................... IN-168 Checking Machine Shutdown ............................................................................ IN-169 Cleaning Covers.................................................................................................. IN-170 Attachment of Labels ......................................................................................... IN-171
0.28
0.29
0.30
0.31
I Paper Manual
The Service Manual consists of the following four volumes. <Maintenance Volume> Machine Description Describes the summary of the machine (CR-IR341). Troubleshooting Describes the troubleshooting methods and servicing procedures. Checks, Replacement and Adjustment Describes the procedures for servicing in steps. Maintenance Utility Describes the functional organization of Service Utility. <Service Parts Volume> Describes the service part lists and exploded views, as well as how to read the service parts lists. <Preventive Maintenance Volume> Describes the procedures for preventive maintenance. <Installation Volume> Describes the specifications of the machine, installation requirements and procedures, and checkpoints after installation, which are required for installation preparation and installation.
I How To Search
G Refer to the table of contents and document map. In order to facilitate efficient search for a desired item in the paper version of the manual, a document map is provided in addition to the table of contents. The document map is illustratively organized so that you can visually find a location where your desired information is described. G Open a desired chapter by referring to the chapter icon on the header. The header contains chapter icons to indicate the chapter where the current page is located; the highlighted number corresponds to the chapter number for each volume. On the hardcopy version of the manual, you can browse pages with reference to the chapter icon to access your desired chapter quickly. On the electronic version of the manual, you can skip pages with reference to the chapter icon to access your desired chapter quickly. G Section number on the footer In the footer, a section number for that page is indicated. On the hardcopy version of the manual, you can browse pages with reference to the footer to access your desired section quickly. On the electronic version of the manual, you can skip pages with reference to the chapter icon to access your desired section quickly.
G Installing Acrobat Reader For installation of Acrobat Reader, see the Read Me file in the CD-ROM that contains electronic manuals. If the version of Acrobat Reader is older than 3.0, the electronic manual cannot be viewed or, if it can be viewed, its specific features may not be guaranteed. Referring to the Read Me file, install a proper version of Acrobat Reader.
0.30
0.31
0.32
0.33
Compiled as one Description of Machine article in the Maintenance Volume. Compiled as one Troubleshooting article in the Maintenance Volume. Compiled as one Description of Machine article. Electrical system and scanner operations are also covered.
TR1B1014.EPS
Compiled in a single volume entitled Installation . Instructions are given on the presumption that they are sequentially followed.
Compiled as an independent chapter in the Maintenance Volume. Instructions are given on the presumption that they are sequentially followed. Compiled under the error category in the Maintenance Volume. Software files are listed under Maintenance Data .
Chapter F1 Error Code Chapter F2 Image Troubleshooting Chapter F3 Abnormal Events Chapter F4 Mechanical Parts (Checks/ Replacement/ Adjustment) Chapter F5 Electrical Parts (Checks/ Replacement/ Adjustment) Chapter F6 Scaning Optics Parts (Checks/ Replacement/ Adjustment) Chapter F7 Service Modes Chapter F8 IP Jams Chapter P Parts List
Maintenance Volume: Troubleshooting 2. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Error Codes 3. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Abnormal Images 4. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Improper Operation Checks, Replacement and Adjustment of Parts Maintenance Utility
The checks, adjustment, and replacement procedures to be performed for maintenance are described in the form of reference information.
The details of functions are given. Compiled as one Troubleshooting article in the Maintenance Volume. Service Parts Volume: Maintenance Volume: Checks, Adjustment, and Replacement of Parts 15. Tools Installation Volume: 6. Installation 6.4 Cable Wiring Diagram Maintenance Volume: Machine Description 11. Interlock Checks, Adjustment, and Replacement of Parts Compiled as one Description of Machine article in the Maintenance Volume. Consumables and search table are added. Compiled as one Checks, Adjustment, and Replacement article in the Maintenance Volume.
Chapter Z3 I/O Layout Drawings Chapter Z4 Covers and Units Removal and Reinstallation Chapter Z5 Interlock
Installation Volume: 6. Installation Maintenance Volume: Checks, Adjustment, and Replacement of Parts 16 Setting Boards and HDD
TR1B1000.EPS
0.32
0.33
0.34
0.35
G Remedies based on mechanical control flows 8. Mechanical Control Flows in Machine Description Volume The Mechanical Control Flows section furnishes flowcharts to detail the machine operations and describe the error occurrence timing. Note the mechanical control flowcharts to determine the machine operations performed at the time of error occurrence and investigate the error cause.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
When initiating a troubleshooting operation in accordance with the generated error code, refer to the 8.7 Index of Error Codes at the end of 8. Mechanical Control Flows in Machine Description Volume.
G Remedies based on descriptions of operations 7. Descriptions of Operations in Machine Description Volume The Descriptions of Operations section furnishes diagrams to explain about the normal operations and functions of various machine components. Read the relevant descriptions of operations to check whether the machine normally operates.
I Maintenance Space
(1) Confirm the generated error code. Note the error code displayed on the operation panel. (2) Note the Index at the beginning of Troubleshooting Flows section and search for the recovery procedure for the error code. The recovery procedures are set forth in numerical order. (3) Estimate the cause of the error, with reference to the Cause in the Troubleshooting Flows. The Troubleshooting Flows describe the following information. Cause Error-related I/O locations Error-related system block diagram (4) Restore the machine to normal by following the flow chart that is indicated in the Troubleshooting. When replacing or adjusting parts, refer to the following sections. Replacement parts confirmation Service Parts List Volume Parts replacement and adjustment Checks, Replacement and Adjustment of Parts
Front 700 or more Unit: mm
FR1H4029.EPS
When performing maintenance procedures, secure sufficient space for that purpose.
Height: 1900 or more 700 or more
Rear
600 or more
Machine
700 or more
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
If the machine cannot be restored to normal by performing the specified procedures, report the employed procedures and results to the Service Headquarters to make a request for analysis. Even if the machine has been restored to normal by performing procedures other than those which are set forth in the Troubleshooting Flows, report the employed procedures, progress, and results to the Service Headquarters. Such reports will be utilized for future service manual improvement and machine serviceability enhancement.
0.34
0.35
Safety Labels
0.36
Safety Labels
0.37
Safety Labels
1. Laser Precaution Labels
Below are illustrated the protective housings and laser precaution labels specified in Part 1J, Federal Regulations Code Title 21 issued by the FDA of the U.S.
CR-IR 341P
FIT
This product complies with 21 CFR Chapter 1. Subchapter J.
FR1B1261.EPS
CR-IR341
FUJI PHOTO FILM CO., LTD.
26-30, NISHIAZABU 2-CHOME, MINATO-KU, TOKYO 106-8620, JAPAN
CR-IR 341
FPE
This product complies with 21 CFR Chapter 1. Subchapter J.
HHS Label #1
FR1B1043.EPS
G HHS Label #1
HHS Label #2 EN 60825-1:1996 Class 3B Panel Label
FR1B1067.EPS
G HHS Label #2
Laser radiation when open external cover AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO BEAM
FR1B1046.EPS
DANGER
Laser radiation when open AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO BEAM
FR1B1045.EPS
DANGER
HHS Certification and Identification Label EN 60825-1: 1996 Class 3B Panel Label HHS Label #1 EN 60825-1: 1996 Class 1 Product Label
FR1B1044.EPS
FR1B1068.EPS
0.36
0.37
Safety Labels
0.38
Safety Labels
0.39
MODEL
CRIR 341P
SN
405N2895
FR1B1262E.EPS
CR-IR341
Manufacturer
FR1B1047.EPS
2.
Labels
Left-hand side
MODEL
CRIR341 50-60Hz
120-240V~ 6.7-3.3A
SN
405N 2313A
FR1B1142.EPS
G Manufacturer Label
FR1B1039.EPS
G Acceptance Label
EXAMINED
GOOD
Acceptance Label Electric Shock Warning Label
FUJI KIKI
FR1B1038.EPS
FR1B1035.EPS
0.38
0.39
0.40
0.41
Top cover
Lower rear cover Lower left-hand side cover Upper front cover Upper right-hand side cover
FR1B1049.EPS
0.40
0.41
MD - 1
05
Reason Pages affected Corrections due to change in configuration All pages (FM2460) Corrections (FM3006) MD-12, 14, 34, 36, 53, 61, 102,
08/30/2001 05/30/2002
07 08
03/20/2004
10
08/31/2005
11
Additional information for LAN board (FM3115) Additions of software terms and definitions and other information (FM3405) LAN board/MTH board information additions and typographical error corrections (FM4275) Revision (FM4710)
124, 128, 129, 136, 140, 164, 165, 172175, 175.1, 175.2 MD-12, 34, 36 MD-17, 55.155.8, 132, 133, 148, 149, 157, 179, 186189, 189.1189.4, 192 MD-12, 15, 3436, 45, 136, 186, 189.1, 189.4 MD-56, 57, 59, 62, 67, 71, 74, 77, 82, 89, 9294, 96, 98, 103105, 107109, 116, 117, 119, 120, 135, 138, 140, 143145, 151154, 156, 158166, 171, 172, 174, 192199
MD - 1
CONTENTS
10
MD - 2
CONTENTS
10
MD - 3
1.
1.1
1.2
Configuration of Machine
Controller
FRONT
UP-down IP removal unit (B) Cassette set unit (A) IP removal unit (B)
T ON FR
FR1H1221.EPS
Housing (G)
FR1H1222.EPS
MD - 2
MD - 3
CONTENTS
10
MD - 4
CONTENTS
10
MD - 5
2.
2.1
Features of Machine
Features of Mechanical Mechanism
2.2
I Hardware Specs
IEEE802.3 (10Base-TX) IEEE802.3u (10Base-TX) auto-sensing & switching
G Hardware
Compression/decompression board (HCP08A) Network I/F board (CPU90F)
I Software Specs
FINP (Fuji Integrated Network Protocol) Base on DICOM (OEM Network Protocol)
MD - 4
MD - 5
CONTENTS
10
MD - 6
CONTENTS
10
MD - 7
3.
3.2
3.1
N NOTE N
When putting the pinion gear onto the shaft, use care not to confuse the orientation of the pinion gear. If it is put onto the shaft in a wrong way, the latch for preventing the removal of the pinion gear will be damaged.
Shaft Pinion gear Pinion gear
IP removal unit
E-ringless housing
Vertical conveyor
Latch Latch
Shaft
: Location employed
OK
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FRONT
NG
FR1H1494.EPS
IP removal unit
: Location employed
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1223.EPS
MD - 6
MD - 7
CONTENTS
10
MD - 8
CONTENTS
10
MD - 9
3.3
3.4
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
(1) Loosen the tensioner retaining screw. The tensioner becomes movable. (2) With the tensioner pushed to the loosened screw, secure it in place by tightening the screw. (3) Remove the timing belt.
FRONT
Vertical conveyor
Loosen screw
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
FR1H1226.EPS
MD - 8
MD - 9
CONTENTS
10
MD - 10
CONTENTS
10
MD - 11
3.5
CAUTION
Mount the sensor exercising care not to bend its claws.
FRONT
Vertical conveyor
Tighten screw
Latch
MD - 10
MD - 11
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
MD - 12
4.
LP ODF/HIC
Ethernet
E i/f
E i/f
alternative option
Serial/Ether
MODEM FDD
External VGA monitor option
Compress/ Network I/F board (DMS i/f) decompress board option option option CPU90F/ DMC08A HCP08A LAN90B
HDD
Motherboard MTH08A/D 5V 12V 12V EDR reduction/ CRT reduction IMG07B Immunity shield area Scanner unit Scanner-related boards
FAN LED08A
SHD correction LD driver
M
Driver board DRV08A Drive unit
from CPU90E remote 15V JPS1 P SV IDT type FAN Bar Code Reader AC100/200V remote
Serial line & power supply
5V
FAN
Instant-OFF thermo switch
FR1H1134.EPS
MD - 12
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
MD - 13
BLANK PAGE
MD - 13
CONTENTS
10
MD - 14
CONTENTS
10
MD - 15
5.
5.1
5.2
Type
Function/Remarks
Recognizes the status in pair with SA3, 7, 11, and 15
SA4, 8, 12, 16
Mammo/ST sensor Cassette hold sensor Cassette ejection sensor Elevation HP sensor Suction cup HP sensor Cassette inlet IP sensor
MS PS PS PS
Detects mammo and ST cassette types. Detects the completion of cassette hold. Detects that the cassette has been ejected. Elevation HP for suction conveyor.
SA4 SA2
SB3 SB4 SB5 Before-side- SC1 SC2 positioning conveyor (C) SideSD1 positioning conveyor (D) SD2 SD3 BCR
MF1
During HP: ON (1) PS IP found: ON (1) IP conveyance sensor PS When located in the shelf position: ON (1) Each shelf position sensor IP found: ON (1) PS Inch/metric sensor PS (reflective IP width determination type) During IP suction: Suction sensor Suction sensor ON (1) Before-BCR IP sensor Convergence standby IP sensor IP found: ON (1) IP found: ON (1) PS PS IP conveyance sensor IP conveyance sensor
SOLF1 MD1 MD3 MD2 MZ3 SD3 SZ3 FANG3 SVB1 SB3 SB1 SB2 LAMP15 PB1 SB4 SB5 MB2 TSW1 TSW2
FR ON T
During HP: ON (1) PS Side-positioning mechanism HP sensor During HP: ON (1) PS Grip release HP sensor Side-positioning HP sensor IP found: ON (1) PS Barcode reader
MB3 MB1
After-reading SE1 conveyor (E) Erasure SF1 conveyor (F) SF2 SF3 SF4 TSW1 Grip release HP sensor During HP: (1) PS
SE1
T ON FR
MZ2 SZ2
SZ1
After-reading conveyance standby IP sensor Changeover IP sensor Load standby IP sensor Overrun IP sensor Safety thermostat
PS PS PS PS (separation type)
Safety thermostat TSW2 LDSN1-1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Unlit lamp sensor Subscanning SZ1 (SED08A) unit (Z) SZ2 SZ3 IP leading-edge sensor Driving-side grip release HP sensor Driven-side grip release HP sensor IP found: ON (no display)
MC1
SD2
Serial number
FANF1 SC2
Unit symbol (AG, T, Z) Example) D: Side-positioning conveyor The unit symbol may sometimes be omitted. I/O type S: Sensor M: Motor TSW: Thermal switch FAN: Fan SV: Solenoid valve and more
SD1 SD2
FR1H1135.EPS
MD - 14
MD - 15
CONTENTS
10
MD - 16
CONTENTS
10
MD - 17
5.3
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1490.EPS
I Reflective sensor
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1493.EPS
Side-positioning MD 1 conveyor (D) MD 2 MD 3 After-reading conveyor (E) Erasure conveyor (F) ME 1 ME 2 MF 1 SOLF1
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1491.EPS
IP transport motor Branch path changeover guide drive LAMP1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Erasure lamp FANF1 Erasure cooling Subscanning motor Driving shaft grip Driven shaft grip
ON(1) : CLOSE
OFF(0) : OPEN
FR1H1492.EPS
Housing (G)
Board cooling Board cooling CRT cooling Board cooling Board cooling
Cools down the DRV08A board. Cools down the DRV08A board. Cools down the CRT. Cools down the MTH. Cools down the MTH.
TR1H1004.EPS
MD - 16
MD - 17
6.1
6.
0ms
SA1 SA2 SA3 SA4 SA5 SA6 SA7 SA8 SA9 SA10 SA11 SA12 SA13 SA14 SA15 SA16 SA17 SB1 SB2 SB3 SB4 SB5 SC1 SC2 SD1 SD2 SD3 SE1 SF1 SF2 SF3 SF4 SZ2 SZ3 SOLA1 SOLA2 SOLA3 SOLA4 MB1 MB2 MB3 PB1 SVB1 MC1 SOLC1 MD1 MD2 MD3 ME1 ME2 MF1 SOLF1 FFM(MZ1) MZ2 MZ3 BCR_S BCR_R
2500ms
5000ms
7500ms
10000ms
12500ms
CONTENTS
Timing Chart
IP Flow
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
MD - 18
0ms
2500ms
5000ms
7500ms
10000ms
12500ms
CONTENTS
10
MD - 19
BLANK PAGE
MD - 19
CONTENTS
10
MD - 20
CONTENTS
10
MD - 21
7.
7.1
Descriptions of Operations
Elevation Unit
The elevation unit performs its up-down operation by transferring the driving from the MB3 to the worm gear via the timing belt. Operational requirements are imposed on the movement (up or down) of the elevation unit: it can be operated when the suction cups are in their home position (HP) (in order to prevent interference between the suction cup arm and the cassette set unit). Home positioning of the elevation unit is detected by SA17 (elevation HP sensor) and SB3 (each shelf position sensor), and implemented during initialization. When the elevation operation is permitted, MB3 is driven and SA17 sensor detection is implemented (OPEN CLOSE); then SB sensor detection is implemented (OPEN CLOSE OPEN) to ensure that the elevation unit is located at the topmost shelf position. Subsequently, 1-pulse driving is performed by MB3, and the home position is detected by the SB sensor (OPEN CLOSE).
FR ON
7.2
IP Removal Unit
The IP in the cassette inserted is sucked and conveyed to the feed roller.
Sensor arm
Timing belt
T
I IP Feed Suction
In order to suck the IP, MB1 that drives the suction cup moves from the home position toward the cassette cover by 83 mm (250 pulses). When the suction cup arrives at the IP suction position, it also activates the suction pump (PB1) at the same time, so that the IP is sucked by air. After the activation of the suction pump (PB1), if the SB5 sensor does not become CLOSE after an elapse of 1 sec, it is judged as IP suction failure.
The suction cup moves from HP to feed suction.
Atmospheric pressure Suction pump
PB 1 ON SVB 1 OFF
MB3
Actuator Hole
IP
SB3
FR1H0201.EPS
SB5 CLOSE
Suction sensor
Suction sensor
FR1H0204.EPS
FR1H0205.EPS
Actuator Hole
SB3
FR1H0202.EPS
MD - 20
MD - 21
CONTENTS
10
MD - 22
CONTENTS
10
MD - 23
I IP Feed Leak
After the suction cup is moved to the feed roller by 88 mm (-262 pulses), the IP sucked is detached from the suction cup as SVB1 is activated for air leak. Because the movement speed of the suction cup is the same as the rotation speed of the feed roller, the leading edge of the IP is fed to the feed roller. The IP being conveyed is prevented from coming into contact with the suction cup by moving the suction cup, which has moved to the feed roller, from the home position toward the cassette cover by 30 mm (86 pulses). For the IP conveyed, its IP leading edge is detected by the SB2 sensor (OPEN CLOSE), thereby monitoring that it has been conveyed normally.
G Suction cup movement operation (feed suction feed leak)
I IP Load Leak
After the suction cup is moved toward the cassette cover by 88 mm (262 pulses), the IP sucked is detached from the suction cup as SVB1 is activated for air leak. Because the movement speed of the suction cup is the same as the rotation speed of the feed roller, the trailing edge of the IP is inserted into the cassette.
The IP sucked is moved to the cassette cover and detached.
Atmospheric pressure
PB 1 OFF
SVB 1 ON
SB5 OPEN
PB 1 OFF
SVB 1 ON
23.83
SB5 OPEN
IP
Unit: mm 5.5 IP accommodation position (trailing edge when IP is placed at the bottom of the cassette)
FR1H0210.EPS
During IP leak
IP
FR1H0211.EPS
FR1H0206.EPS
During IP leak
IP
FR1H0207.EPS
I IP Load Suction
In order to insert into the cassette the IP conveyed from the erasure conveyor to the elevation unit, the suction cup is moved from the suction cup home position toward the cassette cover by 30 mm (86 pulses) and placed in the standby mode. When the IP conveyed from the feed roller is inserted into the cassette, the suction cup that is placed in the standby mode is moved by 30 mm (86 pulses) and the suction pump is activated, thereby sucking the trailing edge of the IP.
The IP loaded is sucked by the suction cup.
Suction pump
PB 1 ON SVB 1 OFF
Atmospheric pressure
18.97
SB5 CLOSE
Suction sensor
Unit: mm
IP
Suction sensor
FR1H0209.EPS
MD - 22
MD - 23
CONTENTS
10
MD - 24
CONTENTS
10
MD - 25
7.3
Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
The IP conveyed from the up-down IP removal unit is subjected to IP length measurement by SC1 (IP passage time through SC1) and routed to the side-positioning conveyor. For IP length measurement, the IP size is classified into eight types according to the length of the IP, SB4 status during IP feed, and mammo/ST cassette sensor status. If the passage time through SC1 is 2.9 sec or longer, it is judged as an IP jam.
I IP Length Measurement
IP type setting 14" x 17" 14" x 14" 10" x 12" 8" x 10" 18cm x 24cm ST 24cm x 30cmST 18cm x 24cm HR 24cm x 30cm HR
Length x width mm 430 x 354 354 x 354 303 x 252 201 x 252 178 x 238 298 x 238 178 x 238 238 x 298
SC1 passage time Sec 0.832.9 0.70.83 0.570.7 0.57 0.57 0.570.7 0.57 0.57
SB4 result CLOSE CLOSE CLOSE CLOSE OPEN OPEN OPEN CLOSE
Guide SOLC1 ON
After detection by the cassette inlet IP sensor SB2 (CLOSE OPEN), the SOLC1 energized is deenergized, so that the conveyance path is changed over. A spring is attached to SOLC1, so that upon deenergization, the spring force (tension) causes the guide to be forcefully returned to its original position.
Guide SOLC1 OFF
SOLC1
SC2
SOLC1
SC2
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
SC1 IP path
FR1H0214.EPS
MD - 24
MD - 25
CONTENTS
10
MD - 26
CONTENTS
10
MD - 27
7.4
Side-Positioning Conveyor
After the width/length of the IP is determined, the IP is conveyed to the side-positioning conveyor. The IP No. is read by the barcode reader (BCR) from the IP being conveyed. For an IP size of 14"x 17" or 14" x 14", the leading edge of the IP has moved beyond the sidepositioning top stopper and reached before the subscanning unit; as such, after reading by the barcode reader, reverse conveyance of the IP is performed to move the latch assembly by 9.6 mm (64 pulses) from the home position and move up the side-positioning top stopper. For IP sizes other than 14"x 17" or 14" x 14", reverse conveyance of the IP is not performed; instead, after reading by the barcode reader, the side-positioning top stopper is moved up.
Barcode reader (BCR) mounting position BCR
IP
FRONT IP stopper
FR1H0217.EPS
REAR
MD1
Up/down operation of side-positioning top stopper Latch assembly Guide of side-positioning top stopper Guide plate Shaft
IP
Latch assembly
FRONT
Side-positioning top stopper Side-positioning top stopper DOWN condition (as seen from right)
FR1H0216.EPS
Side guide
FR1H0218.EPS
MD - 26
MD - 27
CONTENTS
10
MD - 28
CONTENTS
10
MD - 29
I Side-Positioning Operation
The latch assembly moves by a distance corresponding to the width of the IP already detected, thereby performing side-positioning operation. During the side-positioning operation, as the IP is aligned against the side guide, the IP is pushed into by two latches. Because a tension is applied by a spring to the two latches, they are brought down when loaded, so that the IP is pressed with a fixed pressure. This operation is executed twice, thereby determining an accurate horizontal position of the IP. This not only prevents contact of the IP with the side plate, but also determines the reading position in the main-scan direction for the scanner unit.
7.5
Subscanning Unit
The IP conveyed to the driven shaft of the scanner unit is conveyed by the driving of FFM (MZ1) and operation of the driven shaft roller and driving shaft roller to initiate reading. To drive the upper driven shaft roller and upper driving shaft roller, their respective motors are used; as the cam attached thereto is rotated, the upper driven shaft roller or upper driving shaft roller is operated (up and down). The rotation of the cam facilitates smooth up/ down operation of the upper rollers, thereby preventing uneven IP fluctuations.
Light-collecting mirror
Laser beam line
FF shaft
IP
SZ1
Subscanning unit
MZ2 SZ2
MZ3
FRONT Latch
Cam
Cam
MZ2 MZ3 Grip (solid line) : Z2 (OPEN) Grip (solid line) : SZ3 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line) : SZ2 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line) : SZ3 (OPEN)
FR1H0220.EPS
IP
FR1H0219.EPS
Subsequently, the latch assembly moves to its home position and the IP stopper moves down. MD2 is also activated to rotate the cam, so that the roller grips the IP and the side guide is accommodated, thereby conveying the IP to the scanner unit.
After-reading conveyor side SZ2
Conveyance direction
IP
MZ3
MD - 28
MD - 29
CONTENTS
10
MD - 30
CONTENTS
10
MD - 31
7.6
After-Reading Conveyor
The grip operation is terminated as the sensor SE1 becomes CLOSE from the OPEN status, so that the IP is conveyed by ME2 to the erasure conveyor.
I After-Reading Grip
ME1
FFM (MZ1)
ME2
REAR
SZ2
Side-positioning conveyor side MZ2 Sensor arm for SZ2 MZ3 SZ3
FR1H0222.EPS
Steel belt
FR1H0223.EPS
MD - 30
MD - 31
CONTENTS
10
MD - 32
CONTENTS
10
MD - 33
7.7
Erasure Conveyor
The IP conveyed from the after-reading conveyor is temporarily conveyed to the inverting stocker in order to change the conveyance path. The conveyance stops after the IP passes SF2 (CLOSE OPEN), and IP overrun (conveyance beyond specified value) is monitored by SF4 (overrun IP sensor).
IP inverting stocker
I IP Reverse Conveyance
After the path changeover guide is activated, the IP is conveyed to the inlet of the erasure conveyor by the driving of MF1.
I Inverting Stocker
IP path
SOLF1 Guide
FR1H0227.EPS
I IP Erasure
For the IP conveyed to the erasure conveyor, the image data of that IP is erased by the erasure lamps.
FRONT IP path Path changeover mechanism
FR1H0225.EPS
Five erasure lamps are used to erase the image data of the IP. In order to maintain a required level of light intensity for the erasure lamps, the turn-on of the erasure lamps is initiated immediately after the completion of the IP length measurement performed by the before-side-positioning conveyor, thereby making erasure preparation.
I IP Path Changeover
For IP path changeover, after the IP passes SF2 (CLOSE OPEN), SOLF1 is energized to activate the path changeover guide, thereby changing the IP conveyance direction toward the erasure conveyor.
Lamp
IP
FR1H0228EPS
For the IP conveyed to the erasure unit, its image data is erased by the erasure lamps.
MD - 32
MD - 33
CONTENTS
10
MD - 34
CONTENTS
10
MD - 35
7.8
7.9
Network(DMS/IDT)
Ethernet
E i/f
alternative option
Serial/Ether
IDT
MODEM FDD
External VGA monitor option
Compress/ Network I/F board (DMS i/f) decompress board option option option CPU90F/ DMC08A HCP08A LAN90B Shared memory MMC90A/DIM08A
HDD
HDD
CPU90E
Motherboard MTH08A/D 5V 12V 12V
y z |
EDR reduction/ CRT reduction IMG07B Immunity shield area Scanner unit Scanner-related boards
FAN LED08A
PMT
SHD correction LD driver Start-point detection POL driver Leading-edge detection
BUSCON
{ Shared memory
FFM driver
M
Driver board DRV08A
5V 15V 24V
DMC08A }
M SOL SOL
FR1H0230.EPS
SV IDT type
2. After the completion of the reading, the data is temporarily saved to the HDD, and one frame is freed for the next image acquisition. 3. After the write to the HDD is completed, the shared memory is used for a pin-pong buffer, so that a portion of the image is loaded in the shared memory. 4. While handshaking with the shared memory, image processing is performed for output to the LP. 5. As with step 3 above, the data for DMS output is loaded in the shared memory. 6. As with step 4 above, the output is provided to the DMS.
LED08B*4 S 24V
Erasure unit Unlit lamp sensor signal Erasure driver
FAN
Instant-OFF thermo switch
FR1H6519.EPS
MD - 34
MD - 35
CONTENTS
10
MD - 36
CONTENTS
10
MD - 37
HDD
I CPU90E Board
The 68EN360 (25 MHz), available from Motorola, is used as a CPU, with 16 MB of DRAM as main memory, 1 MB of EPPROM and FEPROM, and 128 KB of SRAM.
yz|
CPU90E
The SRAM contents, as well as the date and time, are backed up by a battery (lithium ion cell). A PD72070 floppy disk controller (FDC) is used to control the floppy disk drive (FDD).
IMG08B
With VRAM (4M bits, x3), an image plane is displayed with 640 x 480 pixels (12 bits), while a text plane is displayed with 640 x 480 pixels (4 bits). When an image is displayed on the CR-IR341s monitor, gamma correction is performed. Thus, in order to achieve gamma correction quickly, the monitor screen goes blank, and an image is then displayed after gamma correction.
CPU90F/ LAN90B
FR1H0231.EPS
MD - 36
MD - 37
CONTENTS
10
MD - 38
CONTENTS
10
MD - 39
FR1H0232.EPS
FR1H0233.EPS
MD - 38
MD - 39
CONTENTS
10
MD - 40
CONTENTS
10
MD - 41
External
External
External
LP i/f circuit
High resolution or standard resolution is judged in an image transfer reservation response from the output destination. This information is stored for each DMS after boot-up. It should be noted that when a break status is detected on the line, the E I/F clear its memory.
Input
Output
External
BUSCON (input)
FR1H0234.EPS
BUSCON (input)
FR1H0235.EPS
MD - 40
MD - 41
CONTENTS
10
MD - 42
CONTENTS
10
MD - 43
I SNS08A Board
The SNS08A board provides direct control of a sensor input system, as well as control of drive I/O. A drive I/O control signal is transferred to the DRV08A board for driving. Measures to cope with chattering and noise during sensor control are provided by software. The sensor input system controls the buzzer, touch panel, magnetic card reader, and keyboard, in addition to various sensors.
HOST I/F circuit Address/data bus AS signal ALE signal Address MPX signal OS signal R/W signal DTACK signal INT signal
CPU bus
Sensor input circuit From various sensors
Interlock control
Arithmetic FIFO
From keyboard Keyboard control circuit Pump control circuit x1
FR1H0236.EPS
To DRV08A board
To FFM board
To erasure inverter
FR1H0237.EPS
MD - 42
MD - 43
CONTENTS
10
MD - 44
CONTENTS
10
MD - 45
I DRV08A Board
The DRV08A board receives control signals sent from the sensor board (SNS08A) to directly drive the actuators within the machine. Control signals from the SNS08A board are transferred through a photocoupler interface. Main functions are as follows.
I/O name Pulse motor drive Power-down solenoid Solenoid valve DC pump DC motor 24 VDC 24 VDC 24 VDC 24 VDC 24 VDC 15 VDC I/O drive 10 circuits 6 circuits 1 circuit 1 circuit 2 circuits 1 circuit
TR1H0002.PCT
Full-power excitation signal Power-down solenoid Power-down excitation signal drive circuit x3 (power transistor: MP4504)
To each solenoid
+5V +5V +12V +5V +15V +24V +24V +24V +24V +24V +24V +5V +24V +15V -15V +5V +15V
5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5% 5%
10% 10%
Fixed
0.1A 37A 9.5A 3.0A 0.6A 2.77A 2.77A 2.77A 2.77A 8.0A 0.26A 3.2A 0.3A 2.15A 0.95A 0.1A 0.4A
0.1A 37A 9.5A 3.0A 2.4A 3.1A 3.1A 3.1A 3.1A 12A 0.26A 3.2A 0.6A 3.0A 3.0A 0.1A 2.0A
Drive signal
To solenoid valve
DCOUT7
Drive signal Pump drive circuit x1 (power transistor: MP4504) To pump
FFM
TR1H0004.EPS
10%
Drive signal
To each DC motor
MD - 44
MD - 45
CONTENTS
10
MD - 46
CONTENTS
10
MD - 47
HD
(a): Shading data (b): Polygon data (c): Sensitivity data (d): Format data (e): Other scanner data
Machines RAM (primary memory) : Used for actual operation. Data will disappear when power is turned OFF or reset. (a): Shading data (b): Polygon data (c): Sensitivity data (d): Format data (e): Other scanner data The data in the machines RAM is rewritten after calculation in step 5-7-2.
5-8-1 : (a), (b) 5-8-2 : (c) 5-8-3 : (d) 7-4-1 : (a), (b), (c), (d), (e)
NOTE 1
5-8-5-1 : (a), (b) 5-8-5-2 : (c) 7-3-1 : (a), (b), (c), (d), (e)
Image data
Image signal
A/D conversion
Image data
Image block
FD
Control signal
Polygon control
Polygon
Shading correction
Scanner
(a): Shading data (b): Polygon data (c): Sensitivity data (d): Format data (e): Other scanner data
Control signal
LD control signal
HV control signal
LD status
NOTE 1: Data will not be changed unless the machine is restarted after RESTORE.
FR1H1754.EPS
Quasi-read control
5-7-2: 5-8-1:
Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY, and 2. CALCULATION in sequence. Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT, and 1. SAVE SHADING AND POLYGON DATA in sequence. Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT, and 2. SAVE SENSITIVITY in sequence. Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT, and 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA in sequence.
5-8-2: 5-8-3:
5-8-5-1: Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY, 5. LOAD FROM FD, and 1. SHADING AND POLYGON in sequence.
To each I/O
5-8-5-2: Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY, 5. LOAD FROM FD, and 2. SENSITIVITY in sequence. 5-8-6: Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY, and 2. CALCULATION in sequence. Select 7. FILE UTILITY, 3. BACKUP, and 1. SCANNER DATA in sequence. Select 7. FILE UTILITY, 4. RESTORE, and 1. SCANNER DATA in sequence.
7-3-1: 7-4-1:
For more detail, see 4. Maintenance Utility, 4.10 Scanner Diagnostics and Setting: 5. SCANNER UTILITY, and 4.12 File Operation: 7. FILE UTILITY.
MD - 46
MD - 47
CONTENTS
10
MD - 48
CONTENTS
10
MD - 49
I SCN08A Board
The SCN08A board, which is located between the MTH board and scanning optics/scanner unit, controls each I/O of the scanning optics/scanner unit in accordance with an instruction from the MTH board. Polygon driver/laser/HV control is performed so that a start-point detection signal detected by the SYN08A board and a leading-edge detection signal detected by the SED08A board are acquired as sync signals to control the image acquisition timing. Furthermore, as its selfdiagnostic function, image quasi-read control is implemented to generate a quasi-read LED output voltage. For image acquisition, an analog image signal is inputted from the PMT08A board (log amp board), and after shading correction and filtering, it is analog-to-digital (A/D) converted for output to the IMG08A board (image processing board) as digital image data.
G Shading correction
Shading correction is implemented in hardware to achieve high-speed processing. Analog image data sent from the PMT08A board (log amp board) is corrected for shading. Shading correction compensates for differences in beam-collecting efficiency of the lightcollecting/scanning optics system in the main-scan direction.
G Filtering
The image signal response is adjusted to achieve sharpness balance between main scanning and subscanning.
A/D conversion
Light-collecting guide
Scan over IP
Output level
FR1H0240.EPS
OPCLK
Image data [10 : 0]
D1 D2 D3 D4
FR1H0241.EPS
MD - 48
MD - 49
CONTENTS
10
MD - 50
CONTENTS
10
MD - 51
G A/D converter
An analog image signal filtered is converted to a digital image by an A/D converter.
ADC buffer
G HV control
HV can artificially control the turn-ON/OFF of the output by use of a software switch of the Maintenance Utility and a slide switch (S1) located on the SCN08A board. This information is reported to the CPU, so that when HV is OFF, a dialog indicative of the HV OFF status is displayed on the monitor. The HV control signal is routed from the SCN08A to the PMT08 board.
CLK VINA VINB SENSE 11 11
74ALS574
This signal is outputted at an analog level of 0 (= OFF) 10 V. The resulting output, multiplied by 100 (i.e., 0 V to -1000 V), is outputted as HV.
ADC
+ 1V 3.3 F 0.1 F
VREF
Reference voltages for other ADC and DAC X (- 10) X (2.5) X (- 2.5) - 10V + 2.5V - 2.5V
- 2.5V Soft ON/OFF HV decoder HVON : 2.5 10V HVOFF : 0V Multiplied by -1 LPF PMT08
FR1H0243.EPS
Hard ON/OFF
FR1H0245.EPS
CLK
8 P
MD - 50
MD - 51
CONTENTS
10
MD - 52
CONTENTS
10
MD - 53
G Quasi-read control
A troubleshooting signal is generated when an image anomaly occurs. It is used to distinguish probable causes of the failure into either of scanning optics section, light-collecting section (PMT/log amp), or scanner control board. By selecting this mode and scanning an unexposed IP, a quasi-image signal can is generated from each selected point to check if a normal image is obtained and to isolate the probable cause of the failure. 1. With LIGHT, a fixed amount of light can be inputted to the photomultiplier from the LED on the light-collecting sections PMT board to check if a normal solid image is obtained. If the resulting image is normal, the probable cause of the image anomaly is the scanning optics unit, subscanning unit, IP, or extraneous noise. 2. With LOGAMP, a fixed amount of current can be inputted to the log amp on the PMT board to check if a normal solid image is obtained. If the resulting image is normal, the probable cause of the image anomaly is the photomultiplier, high-voltage power supply, leaked light during erasure or due to extraneous light, IP optical noise, or so forth. 3. With SCN08INPUT, a fixed amount of voltage can be inputted to the scanner control board to check if a normal solid image is obtained. If the resulting image is normal, the probable cause of the image anomaly is the PMT board, extraneous noise to the PMT board, or cable connection between the PMT board and SCN board. 4. If all of the results obtained at steps 1 through 3 above are abnormal, the probable cause is the SCN board, extraneous noise of SCN, or image board(s) that are subsequent to the SCN board.
G LED functions
The SCN08A board has eight LEDs mounted on its surface to permit visual inspection of signals. Their locations on the board and signals detected are shown below.
SCN08A board
HVON (HV ON LED)
This LED is OFF when reading operation is performed under the HV ON condition. To check the LED, HV should be turned OFF.
D16
Normal if this LED is ON, or if the leading edge of the IP is located at SZ1 (IP leading-edge sensor) with this LED OFF. If this LED is OFF or blinking (slow blinking), with the IP not located at SZ1, and the laser is normal, then it is necessary to check SZ1.
S1
Normal if this LED is ON. If this LED is blinking (slow blinking) or OFF and the laser is normal, then it is necessary to check the start-point sensor board.
D15
When this LED is ON, the polygonal mirror is rotating at a constant speed. If it is OFF or blinking, it is necessary to check the polygonal mirror.
G Polygon control
After power-ON, the polygonal mirror is rotated.
When this LED is ON, a pixel clock is generated during reading. If this LED is OFF and the laser is normal, it is necessary to check the SCN08A board.
D11 D10
G Error detection
The SCN08A board detects errors related to the polygon, LD, image signal, etc.
Error detection item Polygon Laser beam intensity Start-point detection Leading-edge detection (during self-diagnostics) Leading-edge detection (during reading timeout) End-of-screen timeout HV power supply PMT analog power supply Monitoring A lock signal of the polygon motor (indicating that it rotates at a constant rate) is monitored. The beam intensity of two LDs is monitored. It is checked to see that a signal is generated at nominal timings. It is checked to see that a signal is detected upon incident laser beam. During a series of reading sequences, the time from the activation of the subscanning motor to the generation of a leading-edge detection signal (until the IP reaches its laser scanning position) is monitored. During a series of reading sequence, the time from the leading-edge detection to the generation of an end signal is monitored. The output voltage and noise of the high-voltage power supply provided to the PMT is monitored. It is checked if the power supply to the PMT08A board is normal.
TR1H0003.EPS
D9 D8
When this LED is ON, the laser is normal. If it is OFF, it is necessary to check the first or second laser.
MD - 52
MD - 53
CONTENTS
10
MD - 54
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55
Accelerated phosphorescence light emitted from a latent image due to laser beam irradiated onto the latent image on the IP surface is collected by the light-collecting mirror, and the excited light (660 nm laser light) is cut off by the filter mounted on the photomultiplier section, and the resulting light is guided to the photomultiplier (PMT). The dust-shield guide prevents dust deposits onto an area between the light-collecting guide/mirror section and scanning optics unit.
Laser light Light-collecting guide
Laser irradiation
The laser beam reflected by the polygonal mirror passes through f lenses, and the laser beam is irradiated by the reflective mirror onto the IP surface under the scanning optics unit.
f lenses Main-scan direction
Light-collecting guide
Sub-scan direction
FR1H0248.EPS
MD - 54
MD - 55
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.1
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.2
I Subsystems
Divisions of the entire software system that are defined according to functionality and processing type MFC PNL IMG CSL LIF FOT JNL IPH IIF DST DIF FIN DOT : Exercises primary control over the systems startup, initialization, and shutdown processes and mode management. : Exercises panel control over M-Utility, U-Utility, and window display/reception. : Exercises image input control of the IMG07B board/scanner board. : Exercises ID input control over ID information processing (CSL type). : Exercises interface control over the IMG08A/B/C/H board. : Controls FINP output image data. : Controls an error logging process. : Provides IP conveyance control and IP mechanism control (subscanning included). : Exercises interface control over IDT communications. : Provides image data flow control. : Exercises interface control of the DMC08A board. : Exercises FINP input image data control of the network boards (CPU90F, LAN, and HCP). : Exercises DICOM output control of the network.
Device drivers
G OS
VxWorks
G Basic software
Software offering the functions that are commonly used by the application software.
Basic software ISC SED Management system Inter-subsystem communication management Subsystem status/external event processing mechanism IMM QUM CDM IDM Image data/ID information management control Processing request (queue) management control for image input/output subsystems Shared data (information about machine setup and external device connection setup) management control Image information (parameter) management control
TR1H1321.EPS
G Subsystem connections
The subsystems are interconnected by a software bus, which consists of the subsystems, SEDs, and ISCs. SED ISC : Processes the messages (events) from the remote subsystems and the state of the local subsystem. : Manages message exchanges between the subsystems.
MFC IMM QUM CDM IDM
G Application software
Control application software.
G Device drivers
Software offered for device access common procedures SIO SCSI FDC Ethernet DMA DSP SCN Video Sensor FPMC Timer SMCU Polling Keyboard IOT LAN Touch panel Card : Driver for serial transmission/reception : Driver for SCSI interface control : Driver for floppy disk control : Driver for network interface control : Driver for overall DMA control : Driver for image processing board (DSP) control : Driver for processing an interrupt notification from the scanner board : Monitor system control driver : Driver for sensor status change (ON/OFF detection) notification : Pulse motor system control driver : System clock system control driver (CPU clock incorporation into the OS) : IDT/DMS/LP (E interface) communication protocol : Driver for transmission/processing request confirmation during each communication : Driver for keyboard control : Driver for performing a sensor status trace : Driver for network board DMA control : Driver for touch panel control : Driver for magnetic card reader control
JNL
PNL
IPH
DST
LIF
DIF
FOT
FIN
DOT
IMG
G Hardware
PC boards
009-051-08 05.30.2002 FM3405
FR1H6527.EPS
MD - 55.1
MD - 55.2
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.3
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.4
Normalization process
Monitor reduced image processing EDR reduced image processing
IMG08A
MMC90A/DIM08A
HDD
CPU90E
LP
HDD
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
IMG08B/H
Image data
MTH08A/D
IMG07B
MTH08A/D
CPU90E
CRT
MTH08A/D
IMG08A
LP
FR1H6529.EPS
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HDD
FR1H6528.EPS
MD - 55.3
MD - 55.4
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.5
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.6
MMC90A/DIM08A
DMS
DICOM process
Network
HDD MTH08A/D MMC90A /DIM08A MTH08A/D DMC08A DMS
FR1H6530.EPS
CPU90F /LAN90B
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HDD HDD
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HCP08A
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HDD HDD
FR1H6531.EPS
MD - 55.5
MD - 55.6
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.7
CONTENTS
10
MD - 55.8
MMC90A/DIM08A
MMC90A/DIM08A
DICOM process
DICOM process
HDD
HDD
Network
HDD HDD
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D MTH08A/D
HCP08A
MTH08A/D
HDD
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HCP08A
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
CPU90F /LAN90B
MTH08A/D
Network
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
HDD
MTH08A/D
FR1H6532.EPS
MMC90A /DIM08A
MTH08A/D
CPU90F /LAN90B
Network
FR1H6533.EPS
MD - 55.7
MD - 55.8
CONTENTS
10
MD - 56
CONTENTS
10
MD - 57
8.
8.1
8.2
: User operation
N Y
: Decision block
: Subroutine name
G Up-down IP removal unit In this sequence, the elevation unit is moved to the shelf where the cassette that loads the IP has been set.
03XX
: Occurrence of error
G Up-down IP removal unit In this sequence, the IP is removed from the cassette and conveyed to the before-side-positioning conveyor. G Before-side-positioning conveyor In this sequence, the IP from the up-down IP removal unit is conveyed to the side-positioning conveyor. During the conveyance, IP length measurement is performed. After the IP length measurement, the erasure lamp turn-on process is performed. G Side-positioning conveyor In this sequence, the barcode on the back of the IP is read during the conveyance; subsequently, positioning of the start point for IP reading (i.e., side-positioning) is performed. G Subscanning unit After-reading conveyor In this sequence, after the IP data is read, the IP is conveyed to the conveyance-inverting stocker. G Up-down IP removal unit In this sequence, the elevation unit is moved to the shelf where the cassette that loads the IP has been set.
END
: End of sequence
PB11
: Control parameter for pulse motor Number (serial number) Unit number (B through F) : Timer value or timeout value Number (serial number) Unit number (A through D, F, Z) : Retry value Number (serial number) Unit number (A, B, D)
FR1H0300.EPS
TA11
NA11
G Erasure conveyor The IP in the inverting stocker is passed under the erasure lamp (data is erased) by switching the conveyance path of the erasure conveyor, and conveyed to the before-side-positioning conveyor. The erasure lamp turn-off process is also performed. G Before-side-positioning conveyor Up-down IP removal unit The IP sent from the erasure conveyor is conveyed to the up-down IP removal unit by switching the conveyance path, and loaded into the cassette. G Cassette set unit In this sequence, the hold on the cassette into which the IP has been loaded is released, so that the cassette
END
FR1H0301.EPS
MD - 56
MD - 57
CONTENTS
10
MD - 58
CONTENTS
10
MD - 59
8.2.2 Cassette IN
(1) Overall/General Sequence This is for the operation of the cassette set unit. In this sequence of cassette IN operation, after the cassette inserted is detected, it is held, and then whether it has been held properly is detected.
Elevation unit
Housing
START
In response to the sequence, such as initialization, during startup, this step indicates that the cassette feeder is ready to accept a cassette.
Check for READY condition LEDT1 of all the shelves are turned on.
B
User operation SA of all the shelves are checked in sequence. The leading edge of the cassette causes the sensor SA2 to turn ON, so that cassette IN is detected. Cassette setting
Subscanning unit
N Y
Is SA2 closed?
After-reading conveyor
C
Cassette hold mechanism activated Cassette hold DRIVE (SOLA1/OFF)
Is SA3 closed within TA14? Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA12)?
Cassetteset unit
SB2
N Y
23A1
SF4 SF2
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
Level 2 error log Cassette hold failure retry Retry upon cassette hold failure
Erasure conveyor
SF1 SC1 SF3 BCR
Cassette ejection
Fig. 2.11.1
FR1H0304.EPS
Sidepositioning conveyor
FR1H0303.EPS
MD - 58
MD - 59
CONTENTS
10
MD - 60
CONTENTS
10
MD - 61
(2) Detailed Sequence of Hold Release The operation is to release the cassette hold.
A
If an attempt to release the hold fails five times in succession, the relevant shelf is marked by level 1 error, cassette hold release failure.
N
END
Table 2.2.1 Operation Parameters Symbol TA14 TA15 NA12 Description Hold timeout Wait for hold retry Hold retry Value 0.5 sec 2 sec 5 times
TR1H0010.EPS
Table 2.2.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name in flow I/O name SA1 SA2 SA3 SOLA1 LEDT1 Topmost shelf position SA1 SA2 SA4 SOLA1 LDET1 2nd shelf 3rd shelf position position SA5 SA6 SA7 SOLA2 LDET3 SA9 SA10 SA11 SOLA3 LDET5 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 SA15 SOLA4 LDET7
TR1H0011.EPS
*: Push the cassette once to draw it out. The cassette cannot be drawn out by merely pulling it.
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA11)?
N Y
13A2
23A2
Topmost stage 2nd stage 3rd stage Cassette that has been set in the 3rd stage 4th stage SOLA1 SOLA2 SOLA3 SOLA4
Message display "CASS. HOLD RELEASE FAILURE CS# * Check cassette position and press HOLD RELEASE key". Cassette hold release Operation stopped Level 2 error Degeneration for shelf where relevant cassette is set Degeneration or all shelves? Cassette hold release DRIVE (SOLA1/OFF) DELAY TA12
23A3
N Y
03A3
Hold pin
END
FR1H0307.EPS
Table 2.2.2 Operation Parameters Symbol TA11 TA12 NA11 Description Hold release timeout Wait for hold release retry Hold release retry Value 0.5 sec 2 sec 5 times
TR1H0012.EPS
Table 2.2.2a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow I/O name in flow I/O name SA3 SOLA1 Topmost shelf position SA3 SOLA1 2nd shelf position SA7 SOLA2 3rd shelf position SA11 SOLA3 4th shelf position SA15 SOLA4
TR1H0013.EPS
MD - 60
MD - 61
CONTENTS
10
MD - 62
CONTENTS
10
MD - 63
(2) Detailed Sequence of Suction Cup HP Positioning This sequence is performed when home positioning (HP) is performed for the suction cups.
Fig. 2.3.2 Suction Cup HP Positioning (1/2)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.3.1, Fig. 2.3.3, Fig. 2.4.2, Fig. 2.4.3, Fig. 2.4.4, Fig. 2.6.4, Fig. 2.8.1, Fig. 2.10.3, Fig. 2.10.4, Fig. 4.2.2, Fig. 4.2.3, Fig. 4.3.1, Fig. 5.1.1, and Fig. 5.3.2
START
Table 2.3.2 Operation Parameters Symbol PB50 PB51 PB52 PB53 PB54 TB51 TB52 TB53 Description Suction cup movement (initial driving) Suction cup movement (HP positioning) Suction cup movement (HP positioning) Suction cup movement (HP movement 2) Wait for suction cup HP settlement Suction cup HP detection timeout Suction cup HP 1-pulse driving timeout Value 1p + infinite P - infinite P -6p 0.5sec 5.3sec 20sec 2 times
TR1H0016.EPS
MB1 phase start-point forced return (2-phase) Suction cup driving (initial driving) DRIVE (MB1/PB50)
C
N Y
It is initiated when the following condition is met. Movement of the elevation unit permitted: Fig. 2.7.1 The sequence is not initiated until the movement (load) of the elevation unit is performed to load the previous IP and the loading of that IP is completed.
TB54
N Y
Is SB1 closed?
DELAY TB51
Level 2 error Suction cup HP return 23E8 failure DELAY TB17 Retry at the time of HP detection failure
Is SB1 closed?
Y N
MB3 moves the elevation unit to a designated shelf. For its parameters, see Table 2.3.1a. It is confirmed that the elevation unit is in a proper shelf position.
With deceleration time setting and LIMIT stop, it is fed by a specified amount after sensor edge detection.
Is SB3 closed? Elevation unit HP positioning Fig.2.3.3 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB101)?
Y N 23DE
END
N Y
Suction cup driving stop DRIVE (MB1/OFF) (Soft) DELAY TB51 Suction cup driving (return) DRIVE (MB1/PB51)
Table 2.3.1 Operation Parameters Symbol PB19 TB17 Description Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) Wait for next operation Value -12 p 0.1 sec 2 times
TR1H0014.EPS
Level 0 error 03DE Elevation movement Leve 2 error error Elevation shelf movement failure retray
FR1H0308.EPS
Is SB1 opened within TB52? 2) Return for preparation of suction cup HP detection
N Y
Table 2.3.1a Elevation Unit Movement Parameters (PB_) Pulse Movement of Symbol count (P) elevation unit Topmost stage 2nd stage PB112 -3,470 Topmost stage 3rd stage Topmost stage 4th stage 2nd stage topmost stage 2nd stage 3rd stage 2nd stage 4th stage 3rd stage topmost stage 3rd stage 2nd stage 3rd stage 4th stage 4th stage topmost stage 4th stage 2nd stage 4th stage 3rd stage PB113 PB114 PB121 PB123 PB124 PB131 PB132 PB134 PB141 PB142 PB143 -6,930 -10,392 3,470 -3,460 -6,922 6,930 3,460 -3,462 10,392 6,922 3,462
TR1H0015.EPS
SA17
Ascend
Sensor arm for SA17 (attached at the elevation unit) Elevation unit SB3
Rack
4 pulses = 0.1mm travel (360 (= 400 pulses) Reduction ratio: 1/20 Sensor arm for SB3
B A
FR1H0310.EPS
Elevation unit
Cassette feeder Condition as seen from the cassette loading side (front) Condition as seen from the right-hand side
FR1H0309.EPS
MD - 62
MD - 63
CONTENTS
10
MD - 64
CONTENTS
10
MD - 65
(3) Detailed Sequence of Elevation Unit HP Positioning This operation is performed during IP feed conveyance or load conveyance, or when the elevation unit is not in a proper shelf position. It is also performed during initialization.
1-pulse driving process Parameter Suction cup 1-pulse driving (HP movement 1) DRIVE (MB1/BB52) Is SB1 closed within TB54?
START
MB1 phase start-point forced return (2-phase) Suction cup driving (HP movement 2) DRIVE (MB1/PB54) 4) HP positioning DELAY TB51
Is SB1 closed?
N Y
Side-positioning for suction cup HP detection preparation For up/down movement of the up-down IP removal unit, it is prerequisite that the suction arm is in its home position in order to avoid interference.
23E7
23E8
DELAY TB17
N Y
Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 MB3 phase start-point forced return (2-phase) Elevation unit movement (initial driving) DRIVE (MB3/PB101) Is SA17 closed?
Y N
END
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB51)?
N Y
03E8
I Explanation of HP Detection Operation G The home position (HP) is detected when the sensor arm attached to the suction arm shields SB1. G The suction cups are moved by MB1 driving and stops at their home position according to the following steps. 1) Positioning for suction cup HP detection preparation When SB1 is OPEN: Positioning operation (backward movement) is performed to seek the home position, and after SB1 is CLOSE, the suction cups are fed by a specified amount and then stop. When SB1 is CLOSE: Proceed to the next step. 2) Return for suction cup HP detection The return operation (forward movement) is performed, and after SB is OPEN, the suction cups are fed by a specified amount and stop. 3) Suction cup HP detection: Sensor edge detection The positioning operation is performed by 1-pulse driving, and the sensor edge is detected when SB1 is CLOSE. 4) Suction cup HP detection: HP positioning The suction cups are fed from the edge by a specified amount, and the positioning operation is stopped. If normal, this stop point represents the home position.
N Y
It is confirmed that the up-down IP removal unit is near the topmost shelf by checking that sensor SA17 is CLOSE.
Elevation unit movement stop DRIVE (MB3/OFF) (Soft) Elevation unit movement DOWN DRIVE (MB3/PB102)
Suction arm
Y
03DD
MD - 64
MD - 65
CONTENTS
10
Table 2.3.3 Operation Parameters Symbol Description
MD - 66
Value 1p + infinite P - infinite P 1p 60 p 0.1 sec 14.5 sec 2.4 sec 2.4 sec 2.4 sec 20 sec 2 times
TR1H0017.EPS
CONTENTS
10
MD - 67
8.2.4 IP Feed
(1) Overall/General Sequence In this sequence, an IP is removed from the cassette and fed to the before-side-positioning conveyor. The IP conveyance path is from the up-down IP removal unit to the before-side-positioning conveyor to the before-side-positioning conveyor. In order to prevent conflict with the returning (loading) IP, this sequence is performed after conveyance path clearing is confirmed.
Fig. 2.4.1 IP Feed (Overall Sequence)
PB100 Elevation (initial driving) PB101 Elevation (UP) PB102 Elevation (DOWN)
Elevation unit movement UP DRIVE (MB3/PB101) HP positioning preparation operation Sensor SB3 is engaged with the actuator for topmost shelf detection. Is SB3 closed within TB103?
N Y
PB103 Elevation 1-pulse driving (edge movement) PB104 Elevation (HP movement) TB17 Wait for next operation TB101 Elevation reference seek timeout 1 TB102 Elevation reference seek timeout 2 TB103 Elevation topmost shelf seek timeout 1 TB104 Elevation topmost shelf seek timeout 2 TB105 Elevation HP 1-pulse driving timeout NB100 Elevation HP retry
Elevation unit movement DOWN DRIVE (MB3/PB102) Operation for elevation edge detection preparation Sensor SB3 detects the edge (lower end) of the actuator for HP positioning.
Elevation unit movement stop DRIVE (MB3/OFF) (Soft) 1-pulse driving process Parameter Elevation unit movement UP (to edge) DRIVE (MB3/PB103) Is SB3 closed within TB105?
N Y 03DE
<Sequence start requirements> When all the following requirements are met, the sequence starts. IP feed permission enabled: Fig. 2.7.3
Elevation unit movement stop DRIVE (MB3/OFF) (Soft)
N Y
Is IP feed permitted?
The IP in the cassette is sucked by the suction cups. The IP sucked by the suction cups is gripped by the grip rollers of the up-down IP removal unit.
Feed suction Fig. 2.4.3 Feed suction gripping Fig. 2.4.3 Feed gripping and conveying Fig. 2.4.4
END
FR1H0315.EPS
MB3 phase start-point forced return (2-phase) Moved by 60p to the center of the actuator, which corresponds to the home position of the up-down IP removal unit (travel: 1.5 mm).
Y
SB2
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB100)?
IP
END
N Y
03DE
SZ1SD3
FR1H0316.EPS
MD - 66
MD - 67
CONTENTS
10
MD - 68
CONTENTS
10
MD - 69
(2) Feed Suction Sequence This is for the operation of the up-down IP removal unit. In this sequence, the IP in the cassette is sucked by the suction cups. This sequence is also performed during a search for any remaining IP.
I Pump/Suction Cup Operation Atmospheric pressure
START
PB 1 ON
SVB 1 OFF
Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Suction cup movement (HP feed suction) DRIVE (MB1/PB11) Suction pump ON DRIVE (PB1/ON) Is SB5 closed within TB11? The suction cups are moved from their home position to suck an IP in the cassette.
SB5 CLOSE
The grip rollers rotate at the rate of suction cup movement. While the suction cups feed the IP to the grip rollers, the IP is monitored so that it is not dropped. OPEN: IP dropped CLOSE: IP sucked When the leading edge of the IP is fed to the grip rollers, air leak occurs so that the IP is released from the suction cups.
The suction condition and suction cup position is reset.
Y
During IP suction
IP
N Y 23E1
FR1H0319.EPS
Level 2 error Feed IP suction failure retry IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) DELAY TB17
IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) SB4 monitoring completed DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 2 Fig. 6.2.1
Table 2.4.3 Operation Parameters Description Symbol PB12 Suction cup movement (feed suction feed leak) PB19 Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) PB21 Conveyance (feed suction standby) Value -262 p -12 p 675 p 0.1 sec 0.1 sec
TR1H0019.EPS
DELAY TB12
END
Atmospheric pressure
PB 1 OFF
SVB 1 ON
It is confirmed that the suction cups suck the IP securely. OPEN: IP suction not completed CLOSE: IP suction completed
23E8
SB5 OPEN
Y
Suction HP detection Fig. 2.3.2 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB11)?
N
Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB19)
FR1H0321.EPS
13E1
During IP leak
Level 1 error Feed IP suction failure Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 1 Fig. 6.1.1
IP
FR1H0319.EPS
END
TB13 TB17
Atmospheric pressure
Value 1 sec 0 sec 0.1 sec 3 times
TR1H0018.EPS
Description Feed suction timeout Wait for feed suction Wait for next operation Feed suction retry
.7 7
TB17 NB11
PB 1 OFF
SVB 1 ON
75
.1
SB5 OPEN
During IP leak
IP
FR1H0322.EPS
MD - 68
MD - 69
CONTENTS
10
MD - 70
CONTENTS
10
MD - 71
(4) Feed Conveyance Sequence This is for the operation of the up-down IP removal unit. In this sequence, the IP fed by the grip roller is routed to the before-side-positioning conveyor.
Fig. 2.4.4 Feed Conveyance
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.4.1
START
Leak valve closed DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) After feed leak, the suction cups advance by 98p and stop. The stop point corresponds to a position where the suction cups are retreated to feed the IP removed. Suction cup movement (feed leak load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB18)
(Sequence initiation requirement) When the following requirement is met, the sequence starts. IP feed conveyance permission OK: Fig. 2.9.1 To the conveyance path of the up-down IP removal unit, the IP is not fed with the driving motor, but with the belt drive, from the before-side-positioning conveyor. Data for determination of IP type is obtained.
N Y
DELAY TB18
Conveyance driving DRICE (MD3/PD31) DRIVE (MC1/PB22) DRIVE (MB2/PB22) IP length measurement Fig.2.5.2 IP determination
N Y
The leading edge of the IP fed by the grip rollers is detected. (The leading edge of the IP shields SB2.)
Table 2.4.4 Operation Parameters Symbol PB18 PB26 TB14 TB17 TB18 Description Conveyance (grip retry) Grip timeout Wait for next operation Wait for feed Value Suction cup movement (feed leak load standby) 98 p + infinite P 1 sec 0.1 sec 0.05 sec
TR1H0020.EPS
N Y
Is SB2 closed? Conveyance driving DRIVE (MB2/PB26) Is SB2 closed within TB14?
N
Fig.2.5.3
Table 2.5.1 Operation Parameters Symbol PB22 PC11 PD31 Description Conveyance (feed) Conveyance (feed) Conveyance (feed) Value + infinite P - infinite P - infinite P
TR1H0021.EPS
FR1H0326.EPS
DELAY TB17
END
I Structure and Operation of Path Changeover Mechanism The conveyance path of the before-side-positioning conveyor is normally in the feed state. Upon load request, the convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid SOLC1 is turned ON to implement path changeover. After the IP has been passed (sensor SB2 is CLOSE OPEN), the solenoid is turned OFF to reset it to its original state.
Level 1 error IP grip failure Error handling Cassette ejection 2 Fig. 6.2.1
SB2
IP
SOLC1
FR1H0324.EPS
SC2
2 4.9 2
MD - 70
MD - 71
CONTENTS
10
MD - 72
CONTENTS
10
MD - 73
(2) Sequence of IP Length Measurement This sequence is performed while the IP is fed by the before-side-positioning conveyor. In response to the result of this IP length measurement, the type of the IP being fed is determined.
Fig. 2.5.2 IP Length Measurement Preprocessing: Fig. 2.5.1, and Fig. 5.6.1
START
(3) Sequence of IP Determination The sequence for IP type determination and upon detection of out-of-spec IP is as follows.
Fig. 2.5.3 IP Determination
N Y
Combination is applicable?
13A8
The time required for IP feed is detected. The resulting value is used for IP determination. IP trailing-edge detection timeout
Y
Level 1 error IP size is out of specification Error handling Recovered IP load Fig. 6.3.1 FR1H0330.EPS
END
Table 2.5.3 IP Determination Criteria IP type setting Length x width, in mm 430x354 354x354 303x252 201x252 178x238 298x238 178x238 238x298 SB4 result CLOSE CLOSE CLOSE CLOSE OPEN OPEN OPEN CLOSE State of SA4, 8, 12, 16 OPEN OPEN OPEN OPEN OPEN OPEN CLOSE CLOSE
TR1H0023.EPS
TC21 (0.57)
TC23TC12 (0.832.9)
Conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (Hard) DRIVE (MD1/OFF) (Soft) DRIVE (MD2/OFF) (Soft)
Conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (Hard) DRIVE (MD1/OFF) (Soft) DRIVE (MD2/OFF) (Soft) MD3, MC1, MB2 excitation OFF
03B1
END
FR1H0329.EPS
Table 2.5.2 Operation Parameters Symbol TC11 TC12 Description Feed conveyance timeout IP length measurement timeout Value 3.5 sec 2.9 sec
TR1H0022.EPS
MD - 72
MD - 73
CONTENTS
10
MD - 74
CONTENTS
10
MD - 75
(2) Sequence of Barcode Reading This sequence is performed during IP feeding at the side-positioning conveyor. The barcode reader (BCR) is located near the inlet of the side-positioning conveyor.
Fig. 2.6.2 BCR Preprocessing: Fig. 2.6.1
START
BCR reading start DRIVE (BCR/ON) Reading is implemented according to IP size and ST/HR information. In this case, no error notification is issued, but a notification is made upon loading of this IP.
N
N Y
Is the BCR reading completed within PD32? Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (ND31)?
N Y
N Y
13AD
23A9
13A9
In this sequence, the barcode located on the back of the IP is read during the IP conveyance. For 14"x17" and 14"x14", reverse conveyance is performed before side-positioning to position the leading edge of the IP. IP side-positioning is performed.
BCR reading complete DRIVE (BCR/OFF) IDT request TD33 start Wait for PD32 completion BCR reading completed DRIVE (BCR/OFF) Side-positioning conveyance Fig.2.6.3 Side-positioning Fig.2.6.4 Error handling BCR retry Fig.6.10.1 Retry sequence of barcode reading
A
BCR reading complete DRIVE (BCR/OFF) Side-positioning conveyance Fig.2.6.3 Side-positioning Fig.2.6.4 Error handling Recovered IP load Fig.6.3.1
FR1H0333.EPS
Barcode reading Fig.2.6.2 Side-positioning conveyance Fig.2.6.3 Side-positioning Fig.2.6.4 CSL/IDT information check Fig.2.6.6
END
FR1H0331.EPS
When BCR data is obtained during conveyance, a request is immediately issued to the IDT.
END
SB2
SB2
REAR
MD1
Side-positioning mechanism
FR1H0334.EPS
Side-positioning conveyor
IP SZ1SD3 During barcode reading SZ1SD3 Upon completion of side-positioning conveyance
FR1H0332.EPS
IP
MD - 74
MD - 75
CONTENTS
10
MD - 76
CONTENTS
10
MD - 77
(3) Sequence of Side-Positioning Conveyance The IP fed from the side-positioning conveyor is positioned for its start point for side-positioning top stopper after conveyed to the side-positioning top stopper. For 14"x17" and 14"x14" sizes, the leading edge of the IP moves beyond the side-positioning IP sensor (SD3), which is located at the inlet of the subscanning unit, and into the subscanning unit, upon completion of BCR reading, because of their IP length. Thus, reverse conveyance is performed to position the leading edge of the IP. For other sizes, such reverse conveyance is not necessary.
Table 2.6.3a Operation Parameters Symbol PB13 Description Value 64 p - infinite P 0.2 sec
TR1H0025.EPS
(4) Sequence of Side-Positioning The IP conveyed to the side-positioning stopper is side-positioned. The operation of the side-positioning stopper is performed during the sequence of sidepositioning conveyance described in the preceding subsection 8.2.6 (3).
Right-hand side plate of sidepositioning conveyor Side guide (out)
Fig. 2.6.4 Side-Positioning
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.6.1, Fig. 2.6.2, Fig. 3.2.1, and Fig. 5.6.1
START
PD11 Side-positioning (HP stopper) PD35 Conveyance (side-positioning) TD32 Wait for side-positioning return
Table 2.6.3b Operation Parameters Symbol PD34 TD34 Description Conveyance (side-positioning conveyance return) Side-positioning timeout Mode 14x17 I 14x14 I 10x12 I 8x10 I 18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR IDT CSL 242 p 116 p 242 p 2.37 sec 2.47 sec
TR1H0026.EPS
The IP conveyed from the beforeside-positioning conveyor to the side-positioning FR1H0338.EPS I Side-Positioning Mechanism and Driving Section conveyor is side-positioned.
Side-positioning (stopper side-positioning 1) DRIVE (MD1/PD12) DELAY TD12 Side-positioning (side-positioning 1 back) DRIVE (MD1/PD13) DELAY TD13
IDT 2.17 sec 2.33 sec 2.24 sec 2.45 sec 2.50 sec 2.25 sec 2.50 sec CSL 2.16 sec 2.32 sec 2.34 sec 2.55 sec 2.60 sec 2.35 sec 2.60 sec
The side-positioning operation is performed twice in order to increase positional accuracy. The second side-positioning movement is so small that it is difficult to visually check that movement.
Latch assembly
DELAY TD14 Side-positioning conveyance grip (slow) DRIVE (MD2/PD24) Side-positioning (side-positioning 2 HP) DRIVE (MD1/PD15)
FRONT
N Y
Side-positioning conveyor
N Y
Is SD1 closed?
23BC
FRONT Column of latch assembly Guide of side-positioning stopper Guide plate Shaft
Belt
OK
END
The IP stopper located at IP stopper the edge of the Side-positioning stopper unit is turned UP condition (as seen from right) ON (UP condition).
Latch assembly Column of latch assembly Guide of side-positioning stopper Guide plate Shaft
Side-positioning movement (HP stopper) DRIVE (MD1/PD11) Side-positioning driving DRIVE (MD3/PD35) Is SD3 closed within TD34?
N Y
Side-positioning stopper Side-positioning stopper DOWN condition (as seen from right)
FR1H0336.EPS
END
TR1H0027.EPS
Table 2.6.4b Operation Parameters Symbol PD12 PD13 PD14 PD15 Description Side-positioning (stopper side-positioning 1) Side-positioning (side-positioning 1 back) Side-positioning (back side-positioning 2) Side-positioning (side-positioning 2 HP) 14x17 I 14x14 I 10x12 I 8x10 I 18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR 98 p 68 p -68 p 162 p 98 p 68 p -68 p 162 p 778 p 778 p 68 p -68 p 68 p -68 p 872 p 68 p -68 p 936 p 872 p 68 p -68 p 936 p 840 p 34 p -34 p 904 p 440 p 34 p -34 p 504 p
TR1H0028.EPS
842 p 842 p
MD - 76
MD - 77
CONTENTS
10
MD - 78
CONTENTS
10
MD - 79
(5) Detailed Sequence of Side-Positioning HP Positioning In this sequence, the home position of the IP side-positioning mechanism of the side-positioning conveyor is located. It is performed during initial operation and side-positioning operation.
Fig. 2.6.5 Side-Positioning HP Positioning (1/2)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.6.4, and Fig. 5.1.1
START
2w-1-2 phase
1-pulse driving process parameter Side-positioning 1-pulse driving (HP movement 1) DRIVE (MD1/PD52)
N Y
MB1 excitation stability point reset (2-phase) Side-positioning driving (initial driving) DRIVE (MD1/PD50) When OPEN, MD1 is driven to fit the actuator into SD1.
Y N
Side-positioning HP detection
Is SD1 closed?
23BA
Side-positioning driving (positioning) DRIVE (MD1/PD53) It is confirmed Sidethat SD1 positioning is CLOSE. HP detection preparation Is SD1 closed within TD53?
N Y
With deceleration time setting and LIMIT stop, it is fed by a specified amount after sensor edge detection.
END
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (ND51)?
N Y
Side-positioning driving stop DRIVE (MD1/OFF) (Soft) DELAY TD51 Side-positioning driving (return) DRIVE (MD1/PD51)
03BC
Side-positioning driving stop DRIVE (MD1/OFF) (Soft) Level 2 error Side-positioning 23BB HP detection preparation retry
B
FR1H0340.EPS
Table 2.6.5 Operation Parameters Symbol PD50 PD51 PD52 PD53 PD54 TD51 TD52 TD53 TD54 Description Side-positioning (initial driving) Side-positioning (HP return) Side-positioning (HP positioning) Side-positioning (HP movement 2) Wait for side-positioning HP settlement Side-positioning HP detection preparation retry Side-positioning HP detection timeout Side-positioning HP 1-pulse driving timeout Value 1p + infinite P - infinite P -18 p 0.5 sec 1 sec 8 sec 10 sec 3 times
TR1H0029.EPS
SD1
Latch assembly
MD1
Belt
MD1
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
Belt
SD1
FR1H0341.EPS
MD - 78
MD - 79
CONTENTS
10
MD - 80
CONTENTS
10
MD - 81
(6) Sequence of CSL/IDT Information Check This is the process performed by the controller. The IDT information read, machine type, and CSL information are identified, and whether the ID and other information has been entered/registered is checked accordingly.
Fig. 2.6.6 CSL/IDT Information Check
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.6.1, and Fig. 3.2.1
START
(7) Sequence of IP Determination Check HR/ST information is updated according to the barcode information.
Fig. 2.6.7 IP Determination Check
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.6.6
START
CSL: Logical reading and highsensitivity reading are disabled in Config Setting.
END
BC information
IDT Does the IDT respond within TD33? Wait for CSL input
BC information HR HR
BC information
BC information ST
ST HR ST
ST
END END
HR
END
N Y
END
ID not registered
13A8
ID information OK
13AE
13AC
13AF
END
END
END
FR1H0344.EPS
Table 2.6.6 Operation Parameters Symbol TD33 Description IDT response timeout Value 120 sec
TR1H0030.EPS
MD - 80
MD - 81
CONTENTS
10
MD - 82
CONTENTS
10
MD - 83
8.2.7 Reading
(1) Overall/General Sequence In this sequence, the IP data is read and then the IP is conveyed to the conveyance inverting stocker. Reading preparation and reading are performed by the subscanning unit.
Fig. 2.7.1 Reading (Overall Sequence)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.1.1
START
(2) Sequence of Reading Preparation This is for the operation of the subscanning unit. In this sequence, prior to IP data reading, preparation for IP conveyance is performed.
Fig. 2.7.2 Reading Preparation
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.7.1
START
Conveyance driving DRIVE (MD3/PD36) Driven shaft grip driving (fast) DRIVE (MZ3/ON)
Description Conveyance grip release Conveyance (preparation for reading) Driven shaft grip timeout
Is SZ3 closed within TZ34? Driven shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (Soft)
03C9
Reading Fig.2.7.3
SB2
SB2
END
FR1H0348.EPS
G Location of driving shaft/driven shaft and nearby mechanism (initial condition) Light-collecting mirror Driving shaft Laser beam line
SC1 BCR
SC1 BCR
Driven shaft
MD3
IP SZ1 SD3
IP SZ1 SD3
Conveyance direction MZ2 Sensor arm MZ3 for SZ2 SZ3 IP Side-positioning conveyor side Sensor arm for SZ3
FRH0349.EPS
SZ1
Side-positioning SD3 reference/location of side-positioning latch Side-positioning conveyor Sensor arm for SZ3 SZ3
Subscanning unit MZ2 SZ2 Sensor arm for SZ2 Cam Cam MZ3
During reading
FR1H0347.EPS
MZ2 MZ3 Grip (solid line): SZ2 (OPEN) Grip (solid line): SZ3 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line):SZ2 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line):SZ3 (OPEN)
FR1H0350.EPS
MD - 82
MD - 83
CONTENTS
10
MD - 84
CONTENTS
10
MD - 85
Description Value 144 p -256 p (ST/HR) (ST/HR) 2.10/ 4.20 sec 0.3 sec 5 / 10 sec 1.6 / 3.3 sec 2.8 / 6.0 sec 2 sec 5 / 10s ec 1.2 / 3.0 sec 2.4 / 4.9 sec
TR1H0032.EPS
(3) Sequence of Reading This is for the operation of the subscanning unit. In this sequence, the IP data is scanned.
Fig. 2.7.3 Reading (1/3)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.7.1
N Y
Conveyance grip Conveyance grip Driving shaft grip start Wait for subscanning stop Driving shaft grip timeout Lower limit for driving shaft grip spec ( ST/HR) Upper limit for driving shaft grip spec ( ST/HR) Driving shaft grip release timeout Driven shaft grip timeout (fast/HR) (ST/HR)
START
DELAY TZ14
FFM reading speed setting FFM reading driving DRIVE (MZ1/ON) Level 0 error Conveyance error (reading conveyance) To <Sequence IP feed permission start condition> Does the IP leading-edge detection described in Fig. 2.4.1 interrupt occur within TZ11?
Y 03C1 N Y 03C2 N
FFM stop DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (Soft) DELAY TZ15 After-reading conveyance grip DRIVE (1/PE12)
Upper limit for driven shaft grip spec ( ST/HR) Upper limit for driven shaft grip spec ( ST/HR)
Is SE1 closed?
Y N
From the scanner board The scanner issues an interrupt upon detection of the leading edge or at the end of the screen, and the conveyance software receives this interrupt.
23DC
23BF
Level 2 error Side-positioning grip operation error Side-positioning conveyance grip HP positioning Fig. 2.7.5
To isolate causes of TZ11 OUT, the timer is set to TZ11 > TD35. Variations in FFM speed are monitored and the time upon occurrence of such variations is measured.
Driven shaft grip release (fast)
After-reading conveyance grip HP positioning Fig. 2.7.4 Driving shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) Is SZ2 closed within TA24?
N Y
DELAY TZ12 Driving shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) TZ21 START Timer START
N Y N Y
DELAY TZ13 Driven shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ3/ON) TZ31 START Timer START
N
Driving shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (Soft) Level 0 error Driving shaft grip release error
Is SZ3 opened within TZ31? Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (Soft)
03C7
Table 2.7.3b Operation Parameters Symbol TD35 TZ11 TZ13 TZ14 Description Normal reading IP trailing-edge detection timeout Subscanning IP leading-edge detection timeout Driven shaft grip release start Wait for subscanning stop (conveyance compensation for logical reading) Mode Standard reading 18x38 portrait center 10x8 landscape upper right 10x12 portrait upper right 14x14 top 10x8 upper right Pantomo portrait right center
FR1H0352.EPS
Level 0 error Driving shaft grip error Timer > TZ23 or Timer <TZ22 ?
Y N Y
Driving shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (Hard) Timer STOP
Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (Hard) Timer STOP
8x10 I
18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR 6.8 sec 7.8 sec 5.2 sec 0 sec 13.1 sec 14.1 sec 11.6 sec 0 sec 11.5 sec 12.5 sec 10.4 sec 0 sec 17.8 sec 18.8 sec 16.8 sec 0 sec
TR1H0033.EPS
20.1 sec 16.0 sec 13.4 sec 8.0 sec 21.1 sec 17.0 sec 14.4 sec 9.0 sec 18.5 sec 14.5 sec 11.8 sec 6.4 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0 sec 0.5 sec 0 sec
N N Y
Y N
Timer > TZ33 or Timer <TZ32 Error log (detailed information) Timer data recording Level 2 error Driven shaft grip release operation error
FR1H0351.EPS
23C7 A
MD - 84
MD - 85
CONTENTS
10
MD - 86
CONTENTS
10
MD - 87
(4) Detailed Sequence of After-Reading Conveyance Grip HP Positioning This is for the after-reading conveyance grip HP positioning operation performed in the IP reading sequence.
W.F monitorin latch reset (to SNS board)
Fig. 2.7.4 After-Reading Conveyance Grip HP Positioning (1/2)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.7.3, and Fig. 5.1.1
Timer STRT
START
N Y
W.F. error?
ME1 excitation stability point reset (2-phase) Grip driving (initial driving) DRIVE (ME1/PD60)
C
DELAY TD61
Is SE1 closed?
N Y
End-of-screen interrupt?
G Location of driving shaft/driven shaft and nearby mechanism (initial condition) Light-collecting mirror Driving shaft Laser beam line
N Y
After-reading conveyor side FFM (MZ1) Conveyance direction CCW: reading IP conveyance
DELAY TD61
Driven shaft MD3
SZ2
SZ1
N Y
SE1
Subscanning unit MZ2 SZ2 Sensor arm for SZ2 Cam Cam MZ3
SZ3
Grip driving stop DRIVE (ME1/OFF) (soft) Level 2 error After-reading conveyance grip HP detection preparation retry
23DB
DELAY TD61
MZ2 MZ3 Grip (solid line): SZ2 (OPEN) Grip (solid line): SZ3 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line):SZ2 (CLOSE) Grip release (dotted line):SZ3 (OPEN)
FR1H0355.EPS
B
FR1H0356.EPS
MD - 86
MD - 87
CONTENTS
10
MD - 88
CONTENTS
10
MD - 89
(5) Detailed Sequence of Side-Positioning Conveyance Grip HP Positioning This side-positioning conveyance grip home positioning operation is performed, concurrently with the after-reading conveyance grip home positioning operation, at the end of the reading sequence described in section 8.2.7 (3).
2w-1-2-phase
1-pulse driving process Parameter Grip pulse driving (HP movement 1) DRIVE (ME1/PD63) Is SE1 closed within TD64?
N Y
MD2 excitation stability point reset (2-phase) Grip driving (HP movement 2) DRIVE (ME1/PD64) DELAY TD61
Y N
MD2 excitation stability point reset (2-phase) Grip driving (initial driving) DRIVE (MD1/PD60)
Grip HP detection
N Y
Is SE1 closed?
23DA
END Y
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (ND61)?
N
Grip driving stop DRIVE (MD2/OFF) (soft) DELAY TD61 Grip driving (return) DRIVE (MD2/PD61)
G Driving system of side-positioning grip For side guide out/return For side-positioning grip open/close
03DC
MD2
Sensor arm
SD2
Grip driving stop DRIVE (MD2/OFF) (soft) Level 2 error Side-positioning 23BE conveyance grip HP detection preparation retry
B
FR1H0360.EPS
SD2 CLOSE
FR1H0361.EPS
Cam
MD - 88
MD - 89
CONTENTS
10
MD - 90
CONTENTS
10
MD - 91
(6) Sequence of After-Reading Conveyance This is for the operation of the after-reading conveyor and erasure conveyor. In this sequence, the IP that has been read is fed into the conveyance inverting stocker via the after-reading conveyor and erasure conveyor.
2w-1-2phase
1-pulse driving process parameter Grip pulse driving (HP movement 1) DRIVE (MD1/PD63) Is SD2 closed within TD64?
N Y
START
After-reading conveyance driving DRIVE (ME2/PE21) DRIVE (MF1/PF11) Is SF1 closed within TF11?
N Y
Grip HP detection
DELAY TD61
03D1
After-reading conveyance stop DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) MF1, ME2 excitation OFF Level 0 error Conveyance error Does SF4 remain closed (after-reading conveyance) during TF12? After-reading conveyance stop DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) MF1, ME2 excitation OFF Level 0 error Conveyance error (Switchback)
N Y
Is SD2 closed?
23BD END
The actuations of the sensors during normal operation are as follows: SF2: OPEN CLOSE SF4: OPEN CLOSE Monitoring of SF4 is implemented in case SF2 becomes faulty.
N Y
N Y
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (ND61)?
N Y
Is SF2 opened?
03D2
FR1H0362.EPS
N Y
SF4 normal?
Table 2.7.5 Operation Parameters Symbol PD60 PD61 PD63 PD64 TD61 TD62 TD63 TD64 ND61 Description Conveyance grip (initial driving) Conveyance grip (HP return) Conveyance grip (HP positioning) Conveyance grip (HP positioning 2) Wait for side-positioning grip HP settlement Side-positioning grip HP detection preparation timeout Side-positioning grip HP detection timeout Side-positioning HP 1-pulse driving timeout Conveyance grip HP retry Value 1p - infinite p + infinite p 6p 0.5 sec 1.2 sec 13.3 sec 10 sec 3 times
TR1H0035.EPS
23D2 END
Table 2.7.6a Operation Parameters Symbol PE21 PF11 TF11 Description Conveyance (after-reading conveyance) Conveyance (after-reading conveyance) After-reading conveyance IP leading-edge detection timeout Value - infinite P - infinite P 2.67 sec
TR1H0036.EPS
SD3
Table 2.7.6b Operation Parameters Symbol TF12 Description After-reading conveyance IP trailing-edge detection timeout 14x17 I 14x14 I 10x12 I 8x10 I 18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR 2.89 sec 2.63 sec 2.76 sec
TR1H0037.EPS
3.17 sec 3.01 sec 2.9 sec 2.68 sec 2.63 sec
Cam
FR1H0363.EPS
MD - 90
MD - 91
CONTENTS
10
MD - 92
CONTENTS
10
MD - 93
(7) Sequence of CSL/IDT Information Check 2 This is the process performed by the controller. It is performed in response to the result of the sequence described in 8.2.6 (6) Sequence of CSL/IDT Information Check performed at the end of BCR reading and side-positioning. If the ID information is obtained normally, the process continues.
Fig. 2.7.7 CSL/IDT Information Check 2
CSL: Logical reading and high-sensitivity reading are disabled in Config Setting. IDT or CSL: Logical reading or high-sensitivity reading is enabled in Config Setting.
Same as in Fig. 2.3.1
N Y
(Sequence initiation requirement) Initiation is awaited under the following Is the movement of the elevation unit permitted? condition.
N
N Y
Is SB1 closed?
23E8
The process waits until the next cassette is set and reading preparation for the IP in that cassette is completed. Level 2 error Suction cup HP return error DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning
MB3 moves the elevation unit to a designed shelf. For its parameters, see Table 2.8.1a.
Fig. 2.3.2 Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB19)
A
N Y
Is SB3 closed? Elevation unit HP positioning Retry at the time of shelf position detection failure Fig. 2.3.3 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB101)?
03DE Level 2 error Elevation shelf movement error retry
N 23DE
END
FR1H0365.EPS
Suction cup movement (HP load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB14) IP load permission OK
A
FR1H0366.EPS
END
Table 2.8.1a Elevation Unit Movement Parameters (PB_) Movement of elevation unit Topmost stage 2nd stage Topmost stage 3rd stage Topmost stage 4th stage 2nd stage topmost stage 2nd stage 3rd stage 2nd stage 4th stage Symbol PB112 PB113 PB114 PB121 PB123 PB124 PB131 PB132 PB134 PB141 PB142 PB143 Pulse count (P) -3,462 -6930 -10,392 3,470 -3,460 -6,922 6,930 3,460 -3,462 10,392 6,922 3,462
TR1H0039.EPS
Table 2.8.1 Operation Parameters Description Symbol PB14 Suction cup movement (HP load standby) PB19 TB17 Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) Wait for next operation Value 86 p -12 p 0.1 sec 2 times
TR1H0038.EPS
3rd stage topmost stage 3rd stage 2nd stage 3rd stage 4th stage 4th stage topmost stage 4th stage 2nd stage 4th stage 3rd stage
MD - 92
MD - 93
CONTENTS
10
MD - 94
CONTENTS
10
MD - 95
8.2.9 Erasure
(1) Overall/General Sequence This is for the operation of the erasure conveyor. In this sequence, the path of the erasure conveyor is changed over to feed the IP in the inverting stocker to the erasure conveyor where the IP data is erased. The erasure lamp is lit (turned on), if unlit, once the IP length measurement is completed normally. Meanwhile, the erasure lamp is unlit (turned off) if the second IP is not in the feed condition at the end of erasure conveyance.
Fig. 2.9.1 Erasure (Overall Sequence)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.1.1
START
(2) Sequence of Before-Erasure Conveyance In this sequence, after path changeover in the erasure conveyor, the IP is fed from the conveyance inverting stocker to the erasure section.
Fig. 2.9.2 Before-Erasure Conveyance
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.9.1
START
Table 2.9.2 Operation Parameters Symbol PF12 TF13 TF14 Description Conveyance (before-erasure conveyance) Wait for switchback Value 1,044 p 0.2 sec
N Y
After-reading conveyance After path changeover, the IP is loaded from the inverting stocker to the erasure conveyor. The data of the IP conveyed is erased.
(Sequence initiation requirement) Before-erasure conveyance If the following requirement is met as logic, the sequence is initiated. Fig.2.9.2 After-reading conveyance permission OK: Fig. 2.10.1 Erasure conveyance Fig.2.9.3
N
END
03D3
N Y
END
Two IPs One IP Erasure lamp turn-off and preheating DRIVE (LAMP1-5/preheating)
END
FR1H0367.EPS
SB2
SF3 SC2
IP
FRONT
FR1H0371.EPS
IP path
MD - 94
MD - 95
CONTENTS
10
MD - 96
CONTENTS
10
MD - 97
(3) Sequence of Erasure Conveyance In this sequence, the IP is erased and fed to the IP removal conveyor. After this sequence, the erasure lamp turn-off process is performed. For more detail, see Section 8.2.9 (1).
Fig. 2.9.3 Erasure Conveyance
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.9.1
START
(4) Sequence of After-Erasure Conveyance In this sequence, after the IP is erased, it is fed to the up-down IP removal unit via the before-side-positioning conveyor. This operation is collaboratively performed by the erasure conveyor, before-side-positioning conveyor, and up-down IP removal unit.
Fig. 2.9.4 After-Erasure Conveyance
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.9.1
Is SF3 closed, as the conveyance of PF14 is performed with erasure conveyance?
N Y
START
Is SF2 opened?
N
Order of activation
2w-1-2 phase Erasure conveyance DRIVE (MF1/PF13)
After-erasure conveyance DRIVE (SOLC1/ON) DRIVE (MF1/PF15) DRIVE (MC1/PC12) DRIVE (MB2/PB23) TF18 START TF17 START TF21 START Is SF3 opened within TF17? If the IP is small, the initial value of SF4 may be OPEN.
N Y
Erasure conveyance stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) MF1 excitation OFF Level 0 error Conveyance error (erasure)
Y
2w-1-2 phase
Specified erasure conveyance DRIVE (MF1/PF14) MF1 excitation stability point reset (2-phase)
END
FR1H0372.EPS
N Y
Is SB2 closed?
N Y
Is SB2 closed within TB21? After-erasure conveyance stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) DRIVE (SOLF/OFF) MF1, MC1, MB2 excitation OFF
03D6
IP inverting stocker
END
After-erasure conveyance stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) DRIVE (SOLF/OFF) MF1, MC1, MB2 excitation OFF
03D7
IP path
Table 2.9.3 Operation Parameters Symbol PF13 PF14 TF15 Description Conveyance (erasure 1) Conveyance (erasure 2) Erasure conveyance IPtrailing-edge detection timeout Value + infinite p 15,992 p Variable depending on exposure
TR1H0041.EPS
Erasure lamp
Table 2.9.4 Operation Parameters Symbol PB23 Description Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance) Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance) Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance) After-erasure conveyance timeout After-erasure conveyance IP trailing-edge detection timeout 1 After-erasure conveyance IP trailing-edge detection timeout 2 Value - infinite p + infinite p + infinite p 3.6 sec 2.2 sec 2.8 sec
TR1H0042.EPS
FRONT
IP path
TF17 TF18
MD - 96
MD - 97
CONTENTS
10
MD - 98
CONTENTS
10
MD - 99
8.2.10 IP Load
(1) Overall/General Sequence This is for the operation of the IP removal unit. In this sequence, the IP fed via the side-positioning conveyor and erasure conveyor is loaded into the cassette.
Fig. 2.10.1 IP Load (Overall Sequence)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.1.1, Fig. 3.1.1, and Fig. 5.4.3
START
(2) Sequence of Load Conveyance This is for the operation of the IP removal unit. In order to load the IP into the cassette, the IP is conveyed to the grip rollers of the IP removal unit. Driving is performed collectively for the side-positioning conveyor and erasure conveyor during erasure conveyance.
Fig. 2.10.2 Load Conveyance
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.10.1
START
The IP that has been erased is conveyed via the before-side-positioning conveyor to the up-down IP removal unit. The IP is conveyed to the cassette inlet. The IP conveyed is sucked by the suction cups.
(Sequence initiation requirement) When the following requirement is After-erasure et, the sequence starts. conveyance IP load permission OK: Fig. 2.8.1 Fig. 2.9.4
N Y
Load conveyance Fig. 2.10.2 Load suction Fig. 2.10.3 Load suction conveyance Fig. 2.10.4 Erasure check Fig. 2.10.5
END
Load conveyance stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (hard) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft)
03B2
Load conveyance stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (hard) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) MF1, MC1, MB2 excitation OFF Level 0 error Conveyance error (during load conveyance)
FR1H0377.EPS
After-reading conveyance permission OK To the sequence initiation requirement in Fig. 2.9.1 FR1H0375.EPS
END
Table 2.10.2 Operation Parameters Symbol TB22 Description Load timeout Value 2.9sec
TR1H0043.EPS
SB2
SB2
IP
I Structure and Operation of Path Changeover Mechanism The conveyance path of the before-side-positioning conveyor is normally in the feed state. Upon load request, the convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid SOLC1 is turned ON to implement path changeover. After the IP has been passed (sensor SB2 is CLOSE OPEN), the solenoid is turned OFF to reset it to its original state.
SF3 SC2
IP
SC1 BCR
SC2
SC1
MD - 98
MD - 99
CONTENTS
10
MD - 100
CONTENTS
10
MD - 101
(3) Load Suction Sequence This is for the operation of the elevation unit. The IP fed from the grip rollers of the up-down IP removal unit is sucked by the suction cups.
Fig. 2.10.3 Load Suction Preprocessing: Fig. 2.10.1, Fig. 5.4.1, Fig. 5.6.1, Fig. 5.7.1, and Fig. 6.3.2
START
(4) Sequence of Load Suction Conveyance This is for the operation of the elevation unit. In this sequence, the IP sucked by the suction cups is loaded into the cassette. It is in the reverse order of IP feed.
Fig. 2.10.4 Load Suction Conveyance Preprocessing: Fig. 2.10.1, Fig. 5.4.1, Fig. 5.6.1, Fig. 5.7.1, and Fig. 6.3.2 The grip rollers convey the IP in the return direction at the same speed of the suction cups. The suction cups suck the trailing edge of the IP and load it into the cassette (see illustration below). While the suction cups load the IP into the cassette, it is checked if the IP is not dropped.
Load IP suction failure retry
START
Table 2.10.4 Operation Parameters
Leak valve close DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) The suction cups move from the load standby position to the maximum retreat position (see illustration below). Suction movement (load standby load suction) DRIVE (MB1/PB15) The suction cups move from the HP to the load standby position. Suction cup movement (HP load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB14) Suction cup load preparation
Roller rotation (at the equal speed of the arm) DRIVE (MB2/PB25) Suction cup movement (load suction load leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB16) Roller rotation stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft)
N Y
Description Suction cup movement (load suction load leak) Suction cup movement (load leak HP) Conveyance (load suction synchronization) Wait for load leak Wait for next operation
Suction pump ON DRIVE (PB1/ON) It is detected that the suction cups suck the trailing edge of the IP. OPEN: IP suction not completed CLOSE: IP suction completed Is SB5 closed within TB11?
N Y 23E4
Is SB5 closed?
13E5
DELAY TB15
Suction leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) After the suction cups load the IP into the cassette and air leak occurs, the IP is released from the suction cups. After load leak, the suction cups return to their home position.
Y
Level 1 error Load IP dropped IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Remedial sequence at the time when the IP is dropped
END
Suction pump OFF DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DELAY TB16 Suction movement (load leak HP) DRIVE (MB1/PB17) Is SB1 closed?
N 23E8
Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB11)?
N Y
13E4
Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 2 Fig. 6.2.1
Value 86 p 1 sec 0 sec 0.1sec 3 times
TR1H0044.EPS
Suction HP check
Level 2 error Suction cup HP return failure Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2
Table 2.10.3 Operation Parameters Symbol PB14 PB15 TB11 TB15 TB17 NB11 Description Suction cup movement (HP load standby) Feed suction timeout Wait for load suction Wait for next operation Feed suction retry
FR1H0379.EPS
END
Atmospheric pressure
18.97
2 7.6
PB 1 ON
SVB 1 OFF
PB 1 OFF
78
.9 2
SB5 CLOSE
23.83
0.55 5.26 IP trailing-edge stop position Unit: mm Suction cup movement (load standby load suction)
FR1H0380.EPS
During IP leak
During IP suction IP
IP
FR1H0383.EPS
Unit: mm 5.5 IP accommodation position (trailing edge at the time when IP is placed at the bottom of the cassette)
FR1H0381.EPS
MD - 100
MD - 101
CONTENTS
10
MD - 102
CONTENTS
10
MD - 103
(5) Erasure Check In this sequence, it is checked if the IP data has been erased, and if erasure failed, its remedial action is taken.
Fig. 2.10.5 Erasure Check
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.10.1
START
N Y
Is the erasure lamp lit? Level 1 error Erasure lamp failure Error handling Erasure lamp Fig.6.5.1
START
Cassette hold release Fig. 2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on The cassette removable condition is indicated. Operation performed by the operator
Is an overexposed IP indicated?
13AB
Cassette removal
N Y
Is SA1 opened?
END
END
FR1H0386.EPS
Table 2.11.1 Operation Parameters Description Symbol TA13 Wait for cassette OUT Value 0.5 sec
TR1H0046.EPS
Table 2.11.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name in flow I/O name SA1 SA2 SA3 SOLA1 LEDT1 LEDT2 Topmost shelf position SA1 SA2 SA3 SOLA1 LEDT1 LEDT2 2nd shelf position SA5 SA6 SA7 SOLA2 LEDT3 LEDT4 3rd shelf position SA9 SA10 SA11 SOLA3 LEDT5 LEDT6 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 SA15 SOLA4 LEDT7 LEDT8
TR1H0047.EPS
MD - 102
MD - 103
CONTENTS
10
MD - 104
CONTENTS
10
MD - 105
8.3
G This step is skipped in the secondary erasure. The barcode located on the back of the IP is read during the IP conveyance. Same as in the routine For 14"x17" and 14"x14", reverse conveyance is performed before side-positioning to position the leading edge of the IP. Same as in the routine The start point for reading, which is the next sequence, is located. Same as in the routine
Barcode reading
Same as in the routine Cassette set unit Same as in the routine UP-down IP removal unit Same as in the routine Up-down IP removal unit Same as in the routine Before-side-positioning conveyor G Barcode reading is not performed. The reset are the same as in the routine. Side-positioning conveyor G The reading preparation and reading conveyance are different than in the routine. Reading conveyor after-reading conveyor erasure conveyor Same as in the routine Up-down IP removal unit G The erasure conveyance speed is different than in the routine. The rest are the same as in the routine. Erasure conveyor Same as in the routine Before-side-positioning conveyor up-down IP removal unit Same as in the routine Cassette set unit
Cassette IN See 8.2.2 Movement of elevation unit (feed) See 8.2.3 IP feed See 8.2.4 Passage through before-sidepositioning conveyor and IP length measurement See 8.2.5 Side-positioning (secondary erasure) See 8.3.2 Reading (secondary erasure) See 8.3.3 Movement of elevation unit (load) See 8.2.8 Erasure See 8.3.4 IP load See 8.2.10 Cassette ejection See 8.2.11
END
FR1H0388.EPS
G Different than in the routine Preparation prior to IP reading G Different than in the routine The IP conveyed is scanned.
MD - 104
MD - 105
CONTENTS
10
MD - 106
CONTENTS
10
MD - 107
(2) Reading Preparation Sequence This is for the operation of the subscanning unit. It is the sequence of reading preparation during secondary erasure.
Fig. 3.3.2 Reading Preparation (Secondary Erasure) Preprocessing: Fig. 3.3.1
START
(3) Reading Sequence This is for the operation of the subscanning unit. It is the reading sequence during secondary erasure.
Fig. 3.3.3 Reading (Secondary Erasure)
Preprocessing: Fig. 3.3.1
START
Conveyance driving DRIVE (MD3/PD36) Driven shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ3/ON) Driving shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) TZ21 START Timer START
Y
Reading secondary erasure conveyance DRIVE (MZ1/ON) DRIVE (MD3/PD37) DRIVE (ME2/PE22) Is SD3 opened within TD36? Reading secondary erasure conveyance stop DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error 03C1 Conveyance error (reading conveyance) No wait for completion of driven shaft slow grip Driven shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MD3/ON) TZ31 START Timer START Is SZ3 opened within TZ31?
N Y
N Y
Is SZ3 closed within TZ34? Driven shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (soft) Driven shaft grip driving (fast)
IP feed permission
DELAY
TZ17
03C9
Reading secondary erasure conveyance stop DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DELAY TZ18
Driving shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) Is SZ2 closed within TZ24? Driving shaft grip release (fast) Driving shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Driving shaft grip release error
N Y
Timer STOP
Y N
Timer > TZ23 or Timer <TZ22 Error log (detailed information) Timer data recording Level 2 error Driving shaft grip operation error
03C8
Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Driven shaft grip release error Driven shaft grip release (ST)
Timer STOP
END
23C6
FR1H0391.EPS
Timer > TZ33 or Timer <TZ32 Error log (detailed information) Timer data recording Level 2 error Driven shaft grip release operation error
Table 3.3.2 Operation Parameters Symbol PD36 TZ21 TZ22 TZ23 TZ34 Description Conveyance (reading preparation) Driving shaft grip timeout Lower limit for driving shaft grip spec Upper limit for driving shaft grip spec Driven shaft grip timeout (ST/HR) (ST/HR) (ST/HR) (fast/slow) Value -180 p 5 / 10 sec 1.6 / 3.3 sec 2.8 / 6 sec 2 / 10 sec
TR1H0048.EPS
23C7 END
FR1H0392.EPS
MD - 106
MD - 107
CONTENTS
10
MD - 108
CONTENTS
10
MD - 109
8.4
Step Operation
START
IP positioning
END
FR1H0393.EPS
MD - 108
MD - 109
CONTENTS
10
MD - 110
CONTENTS
10
MD - 111
(2) Detailed Sequence of Feed Step Operation It is the sequence of feed step operation in the Maintenance Utility. From its menu, select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 4. UNIT 1. IP FEED/LOAD 2. FEED to execute this sequence of operation.
Fig. 4.2.2 Feed Step Operation (1/3)
Preprocessing: Fig. 4.2.1
START
Wait for step input Suction movement (feed suction feed leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB12)
Wait for cassette IN Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Suction cup movement (HP feed suction) DRIVE (MB1/PB11) Suction pump ON DRIVE (PB1/ON) Is SB5 closed within TB11?
N Y
Is SB5 closed?
13E2
While the suction cups feed the IP to the grip rollers, the IP is monitored so that it is not dropped. OPEN: IP dropped CLOSE: IP sucked When the leading edge of the IP is fed to the grip rollers, air leak occurs so that the IP is released from the suction cups.
Y N
Level 1 error Feed IP dropped IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) SB4 monitoring completed DELAY TB17 Remedial sequence at the time when the IP is dropped
N Y
It is confirmed that the suction cups suck the IP securely. OPEN: IP suction not completed CLOSE: IP suction completed
A
23E1
Level 2 error Feed IP suction failure retry The suction condition and suction cup position is reset.
DELAY TB12
IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig.2.3.2 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB11)?
N Y
Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF)
23E8
Level 2 error Suction cup HP return failure DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Suction cup movement (HP feed leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB19)
After the suction cup HP positioning is performed, it is retreated by 12p, and feed leak occurs.
13E1
Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 1 Fig.6.1.1
The suction cups fail to suck the IP, so it is judged that there is no IP left in the cassette.
FR1H0394.EPS
DELAY TB13
B
FR1H0395.EPS
MD - 110
MD - 111
CONTENTS
10
MD - 112
CONTENTS
10
MD - 113
(3) Detailed Sequence of Load Step Operation It is the sequence of load step operation in the Maintenance Utility. From its menu, select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 4. UNIT 1. IP FEED/LOAD 2. FEED/LOAD to execute this sequence of operation.
Leak valve close DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Suction cup movement (feed leak load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB18)
DELAY TB18
N Y
Suction cup movement (load standby load suction) DRIVE (MB1/PB15) Suction pump ON DRIVE (PB1/ON) Is SB5 closed within TB11?
23E4
The suction cups move from the home position to the load standby position.
The leading edge of the IP fed by the grip rollers is detected. (The leading edge of the IP shields These steps correspond to SB2.) "Feed Conveyance" described in Fig. 2.4.4.
Y N
Conveyance stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) (MB2 excitation OFF) SB4 monitoring completed
It is confirmed that the suction cups suck the IP securely. OPEN: IP suction not completed CLOSE: IP suction completed
A
IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) DELAY TB15 DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NB11)?
N Y
DELAY TB17
END
13E4
13E3
Level 1 error Load IP suction failure retry Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 2 Fig. 6.2.1 Load suction failure
FR1H0396.EPS
FR1H0397.EPS
Description Suction cup movement (feed suction feed leak) Suction cup movement (HP load standby ) Suction cup movement (load standby load suction) Suction cup movement (load leak HP) Conveyance (load suction synchronization) Feed suction retry Wait for cassette OUT Feed suction timeout Wait for load suction Wait for load leak Wait for next operation
Value -262 p 86 p -100 p -250 p + infinite p 3 times 0.5 sec 1 sec 0 sec 0.1 sec 0.1 sec
TR1H0053.EPS
PB14 PB15 PB17 PB25 NB11 TA13 TB11 TB15 TB16 TB17
MD - 112
MD - 113
CONTENTS
10
MD - 114
CONTENTS
10
MD - 115
Wait for step input Roller rotation (at the equal speed of the arm) DRIVE (MB2/PB25) Suction movement (load suction load leak) DRIVE (MB1/PB12)
N
Cassette hold release Fig. 2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on The cassette removable condition is indicated.
Is SA1 opened?
Roller rotation stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) Is SB5 closed? These steps are the same as in Fig. 2.11.1.
13E5
N Y
While the suction cups load the IP into the cassette, it is checked if the IP is not dropped. After the suction cups load the IP into the cassette and air leak occurs, the IP is released from the suction cups. After load leak, the suction cups return to their home position.
Suction leak DRIVE (SVB1/ON) Suction pump OFF DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DELAY TB16 Suction movement (load leak HP) DRIVE (MB1/PB17) Wait for step input Suction leak DRIVE (SVB1/ON) Suction pump OFF DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DELAY TB16
Level 1 error Load IP dropped IP leak DRIVE (PB1/OFF) DRIVE (SVB1/ON) DELAY TB17 Suction cup HP positioning Fig.2.3.2 Leak valve suction condition DRIVE (SVB1/OFF) Error handling Cassette ejection 2 Fig.6.2.1 Remedial sequence at the time when the IP is dropped
Cassette removal
LEDT1 is turned on
END
FR1H0399.EPS
Table 4.2.3 Operation Parameters Symbol PB12 PB14 PB15 PB17 PB25 NB11 TA13 TB11 TB15 Description Suction cup movement (feed suction feed leak) Suction cup movement (HP load standby ) Suction cup movement (load standby load suction) Suction cup movement (load leak HP) Conveyance (load suction synchronization) Feed suction retry Wait for cassette OUT Feed suction timeout Wait for load suction Wait for load leak Wait for next operation Value -262 p 86 p -100 p -250 p + infinite p 3 times 0.5 sec 1 sec 0 sec 0.1 sec 0.1 sec
TR1H0053.EPS
List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name Topmost shelf position SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 2nd shelf position SA5 SA6 LEDT3 LEDT4 3rd shelf position SA9 SA10 LEDT5 LEDT6 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 LEDT7 LEDT8
TR1H0055.EPS
Y N
Is SB1 closed?
TB16 TB17
Suction HP check 2
23E8
MD - 114
MD - 115
CONTENTS
10
MD - 116
CONTENTS
10
MD - 117
8.5
Table 4.3.1a Operation Parameters Symbol PD11 PD16 PD21 PD23 PD24 TD11 TD12 TD13 TD14 Description Side-positioning (HP stopper) Side-positioning (stopper HP) Conveyance grip release Conveyance grip (HP return) Conveyance grip (slow) Wait for settlement of IP that is not side-positioned Wait for side-positioning return Wait for re-side-positioning Wait for settlement of IP that has been side-positioned Value 64p -64p 256p 400p 144p 0.2sec 0.1sec 0.1sec 0.2sec
TR1H0056.EPS
Wait for IP size input Side-positioning (HP stopper) DRIVE (MD1/PD11) Side-positioning conveyance grip release DRIVE (MD2/PD21) DELAY TD11 Wait for step input Side-positioning (stopper side-positioning) DRIVE (MD1/PD12) DELAY TD12
DELAY TD14 Side-positioning (side-positioning 1 back) DRIVE (MD1/PD13) DELAY TD13 Side-positioning (back side-positioning 2) DRIVE (MD1/PD14) DELAY TD14 Wait for step input
Side-positioning conveyance grip (slow) DRIVE (MD2/PD24) Side-positioning (side-positioning 2 HP) DRIVE (MD1/PD15) Wait for step input Side-positioning (HP stopper) DRIVE (MD1/PD11) Conveyance grip (HP return) DRIVE (MD2/PD23) Side-positioning (stopper HP) DRIVE (MD1/PD16)
N Y 23BC
Wait for step input Side-positioning (side-positioning 1 back) DRIVE (MD1/PD13) DELAY TD13 Side-positioning (back side-positioning 2) DRIVE (MD1/PD14)
A
Is SD1 closed? Level 2 error Side-positioning operation error Side-positioning HP positioning Fig.2.6.5
FR1H0400.EPS
END
Table 4.3.1b Operation Parameters Symbol PD12 PD13 PD14 PD15 Description Side-positioning (stopper side-positioning 1) Side-positioning (side-positioning 1 back) Side-positioning (back side-positioning 2) Side-positioning (side-positioning 2 HP) 14x17 I 14x14 I 10x12 I 98 p 68 p -68 p 162 p 98 p 68 p -68 p 162 p 778 p 68 p -68 p 842 p 8x10 I 778 p 68 p -68 p 842 p 18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR 872 p 68 p -68 p 936 p 872 p 68 p -68 p 936 p 840 p 34 p -34 p 904 p 440 p 34 p -34 p 504 p
TR1H0057.EPS
MD - 116
MD - 117
CONTENTS
10
MD - 118
CONTENTS
10
MD - 119
START
Side-positioning grip HP positioning See "Routine" (during single IP conveyance) in Fig. 2.7.5. Side-positioning HP positioning See "Routine" (during single IP conveyance) in Fig. 2.6.5. After-reading conveyance grip HP positioning See "Routine" (during single IP conveyance) in Fig. 2.7.4. Initialization subscanning grip check Fig. 5.2.1 If suction cup HP positioning is executed during DPR IP search, this operation is not performed. Processing of remaining IP (first stage) IP search Fig. 5.3.1 Suction cup HP positioning See "Routine" (during single IP conveyance) in Fig. 2.3.2. Processing of feed/load conveyance IP Fig. 5.4.1 Up-down HP positioning See "Routine" (during single IP conveyance) in Fig. 2.3.3. Cassette hold release operation check Fig. 5.5.1 Processing of before-reading standby IP Fig. 5.6.1 Processing of remaining IP (second stage) Processing of load standby IP Fig. 5.7.1 Processing of load standby IP Fig. 5.8.1 Subscanning grip HP positioning Fig. 5.9.1 Mechanical initialization (third stage) Empty cassette ejection Fig. 5.10.1 Cassette hold release operation Fig. 5.11.1
END
FR1H0401.EPS
START
Is SZ2 opened?
Driving shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) TZ21 START Is SZ2 closed within TZ21? Driving shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (soft) Driving shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (hard)
03C6
N Y
Is SZ3 closed?
N Y
Driven shaft griprerelease (ST) Fig. 5.9.4 DELAY TZ51 Driven shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (soft)
Driven shaft driving (fast) Driven shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (hard)
03C9
MD - 118
MD - 119
CONTENTS
10
MD - 120
CONTENTS
10
MD - 121
8.5.3 IP Search
(1) Overall/General Sequence
SF2 CLOSE
N Y
Is SB2 closed?
Search for cassette inlet IP Fig. 5.3.2 IP found (after search) SB2 CLOSE & SC1 OPEN & (SF1 | SF2 | SF3 CLOSE) No IP
(NOTE) Three steps marked by * in the figure, "search for feed conveyance remaining IP," "processing of before-reading conveyance remaining IP," and "search for load conveyance remaining IP," are activated concurrently. SB2 is OPEN
Movement of load conveyance remaining IP Fig. 5.3.10 After-reading standby IP found Positioning of load standby IP Processing of after-reading conveyance remaining IP
SB2 is CLOSE
SB2 CLOSE & SC1 & SF1 & SF2 & SF3 OPEN
SF3 CLOSE
SB2 & SC1 & SF1 & SF2 & SF3 OPEN (NOTE) SB2 OPEN & SC1 CLOSE
SB2 CLOSE & SC1 OPEN & (SF1 | SF2 | SF3 CLOSE) Movement Movement of feed/load of feed conveyance conveyance remaining IP remaining IP Fig. 5.3.3 Fig. 5.3.4
Fig. 5.3.1 (2/3) * Search for feed conveyance remaining IP Fig. 5.3.5
C
FR1H0404.EPS
SB2 CLOSE
SB2 OPEN
No IP
FR1H0403.EPS
MD - 120
MD - 121
CONTENTS
10
MD - 122
CONTENTS
10
MD - 123
SD3 CLOSE
SC1 CLOSE Movement of beforeside positioning conveyance remaining IP Fig. 5.3.14 Processing of before-reading conveyance remaining IP
Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Leak valve closed DRIVE(SVB1/OFF) Suction cup movement (HP load suction) DRIVE(MB1/PB81) Suction pump ON DRIVE(PB1/ON)
SD3 CLOSE
No IP
N Y
DELAY TB15
No IP
SF1 OPEN No IP
Table 5.3.2 Operation Parameters Symbol PB81 PB82 TB11 TB15 TB16 Description Suction cup movement (HP load suction) Suction cup movement (load suction HP) Feed suction timeout Wait for load suction Wait for load leak Value -14 p 14 p 1 sec 0 sec 0.1 sec
TR1H0059.EPS
END
Is SB1 closed?
N
23E8
Level 2 error Suction cup HP return error Suction cup HP positioning Fig. 2.3.2 Leak released DRIVE(SB1/OFF)
END
FR1H0406.EPS
MD - 122
MD - 123
CONTENTS
10
MD - 124
CONTENTS
10
MD - 125
Description Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout
Feed conveyance DOWN direction DRIVE (MB2/PB71) DRIVE (MC1/PC71) DRIVE (MF1/PF71) When SB2 is not opened within TB72, or when SF1/SF2/SF3 is not closed within TB72 Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft)
03B6
Feed conveyance DOWN direction DRIVE (MB2/PB71) DRIVE (MC1/PC71) Is SB2 opened within TB72?
Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DELAY TF13 Branch 1 Movement of feed conveyance remaining IP Fig. 5.3.4
Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) Positioning of feed/load conveyance remaining IP Fig.5.3.6
Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
03B6
END
FR1H0408.EPS
Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Feed conveyance DOWN direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft)
Table 5.3.5 Operation Parameters Symbol PC72 PD72 TB71 Description Initialization conveyance (UP direction) Initialization conveyance (UP direction) Feed/load conveyance remaining IP search timeout Value - infinite p - infinite p 11.2 sec
TR1H0062.EPS
03B6
DELAY TF13
DELAY TF13
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (MD2/PD72) DRIVE (MC1/PC72) Is SB2 closed within TB71?
N Y
Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) Feed/load conveyance IP found
Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) No IP
END
FR1H0409.EPS
MD - 124
MD - 125
CONTENTS
10
MD - 126
CONTENTS
10
MD - 127
N Y
Is SC2 closed?
N Y
Is SB2 closed within TB78? Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Convergence path changeover guide driving DRIVE(SOLC1/ON)
Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft)
03B6
When SC2 is closed When SF3/SC2 is closed Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft)
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft)
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft)
Table 5.3.7 Operation Parameters Symbol PB72 PC72 PF72 TB79 Description Initialization conveyance (UP direction) Initialization conveyance (UP direction) Initialization conveyance (erasure conveyance direction) Feed/load conveyance remaining IP movement timeout 2 Value - infinite p - infinite p + infinite p 10.7 sec
TR1H0064.EPS
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (SOLC1/ON) DRIVE (MB2/PB72) DRIVE (MC1/PC72) DRIVE (MF1/PF72)
N Y
FR1H0412.EPS
Table 5.3.8 Operation Parameters Symbol PF72 TF13 TF73 Description Value Initialization conveyance (erasure conveyance direction) + infinite p Wait for switchback Erasure conveyance remaining IP search timeout 0.2sec 4.9sec
TR1H0065.EPS
Is SB2 closed within TB79? Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE(SOLC1/OFF (soft) DRIVE(MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE(MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE(MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Feed/load conveyance IP found
03B6
END
FR1H0411.EPS
MD - 126
MD - 127
CONTENTS
10
MD - 128
CONTENTS
10
MD - 129
After-reading conveyance direction DRIVE (ME2/PE71) DRIVE (MF1/PF71) Is SF2 opened closed closed within TF71? The actuation of the sensors during normal operation are as follows: SF2: OPEN CLOSE OPEN SF4: OPEN CLOSE CLOSE Monitoring of SF4 is implemented in case SF2 becomes faulty.
N Y
After-reading conveyance direction DRIVE (MF1/PF71) Is SF4 is opened closed closed within TF71?
N Y
N Y
After-reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DELAY TF13 Erasure conveyance direction DRIVE (SOLF1/ON) DRIVE (MF1/PF72) When SF1/SF3 is not closed within TF72 When SF1 is closed When SF3 is closed SF1: After-reading conveyance standby IP detection SF3: Load standby IP detection
After-reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error 03D8 After-reading conveyance remaining IP ejection error
The actuation of the sensors during normal operation are as follows: SF2: OPEN CLOSE OPEN SF4: OPEN CLOSE CLOSE Monitoring of SF4 is implemented in case SF2 becomes faulty.
DELAY TF13 Erasure conveyance direction DRIVE (SOLF1/ON) DRIVE (MF1/PF72) When SF1/SF3 is not closed within TF72 When SF1 is closed When SF3 is closed Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft)
03D8
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DELAY TF13 After-reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft)
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DELAY TF13
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (SOLF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Positioning of load standby IP Fig. 5.3.11
END
03D9
03D4
03D9
03D4
END
FR1H0414.EPS
Table 5.3.9 Operation Parameters Symbol PE71 PF71 PF72 TF13 TF71 TF72 Description Value Initialization conveyance (after-reading conveyance direction) - infinite p Initialization conveyance (after-reading conveyance direction) - infinite p Initialization conveyance (erasure conveyance direction) Wait for switchback After-reading conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout Erasure conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout + infinite p 0.2 sec 7.6 sec 6.8 sec
TR1H0066.EPS
MD - 128
MD - 129
CONTENTS
10
MD - 130
CONTENTS
10
MD - 131
Side-positioning conveyance reverse direction DRIVE (MD3/PD73) DRIVE (MZ1/ON) Fast reverse conveyance
Is SC1 closed within TD72? Side-positioning conveyance reverse direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (soft) reverse
03B7
N Y
Side-positioning conveyance reverse direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (soft) reverse DELAY TD74
Erasure conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Erasure conveyance remaining IP ejection error
After-reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) After-reading conveyance direction DRIVE (MF1/PF73)
03D9
After-reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Erasure conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Symbol PD71 PD73
END
FR1H0416.EPS
Table 5.3.12 Operation Parameters Description Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Side-positioning conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout 2 Wait for side-positioning switchback Initialization side-positioning timeout Value + infinite p 5.9 sec 0.5 sec 5.8 sec
TR1H0069.EPS
END
FR1H0415.EPS
MD - 130
MD - 131
CONTENTS
10
MD - 132
CONTENTS
10
MD - 133
START
Side-positioning conveyance direction DRIVE (MD3/PD71) DRIVE (MC1/PC71) DRIVE (MB2/PB71) Is SC1 opened within TD71? Side-positioning conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Side-positioning conveyor remaining IP discharge error
N
N Y
Side-positioning conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) Side-positioning conveyance direction DRIVE (MD3/PD71)
03B7
DELAY TD74
Side-positioning conveyance direction DRIVE (MD3/PD71) Initialization side-positioning conveyance Is SD3 closed within TD75? Side-positioning conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Side-positioning conveyor remaining IP discharge error
Y
N Y
Side-positioning conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) Before-reading standby IP found
03B7
Side-positioning conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Side-positioning conveyor remaining IP discharge error
END
Is SD3 closed?
N
Table 5.3.14 Operation Parameters Symbol Description Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Initialization side-positioning timeout Value + infinite p + infinite p + infinite p 5.8sec
TR1H0071.EPS
FR1H0418.EPS
No IP
END
Table 5.3.13 Operation Parameters Symbol PD71 PD72 TD73 TD74 TD75 Description Initialization conveyance (DOWN direction) Initialization conveyance (UP direction) Side-positioning conveyance remaining IP search timeout Wait for side-positioning switchback Initialization side-positioning Value + infinite p - infinite p 5.8 sec 0.5 sec 5.8 sec
TR1H0070.EPS
MD - 132
MD - 133
CONTENTS
10
MD - 134
CONTENTS
10
MD - 135
Reading conveyance direction DRIVE (MZ1/ON) Fast conveyance DRIVE (ME2/PE73) Is SF1 closed within TF76?
N Y
Reading conveyance direction stop DRIVE (MZ1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft)
No IP
Y N
Suction cup movement (HP load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB14) Any IP before search?
END
FR1H0419.EPS
Table 5.3.15 Operation Parameters Symbol PE73 TF76 Description Reading conveyance remaining IP search timeout Value 5.8 sec
TR1H0072.EPS
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (MB2/PB74) DRIVE (MC2/PC74) DRIVE (MF1/PF74) Is SB2 opened within TB72?
N Y
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (hard) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft)
03B6
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Load suction Fig.2.10.3 Load suction conveyance Fig.2.10.4 Cassette ejection Fig.2.11.1
END
FR1H0420.EPS
MD - 134
MD - 135
CONTENTS
10
MD - 136
CONTENTS
10
MD - 137
N Y
N 13B8
Level 1 error IP position information error Message output *** User selected process continued?
Y Y
Y A
No IP
B
DELAY TA16
IP found
Is SA3 closed?
N
Cassette hold check Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA12)?
N Y
Message output "Load largest empty cassette". Remaining ejected cassette IN Fig. 5.4.3
13A1
23A1
END
FR1H0421.EPS
N Y
Is SA2 closed?
Fig.2.2.2
FR1H0422.EPS
MD - 136
MD - 137
CONTENTS
10
MD - 138
CONTENTS
10
MD - 139
C
N Y
Is SA3 closed?
Y Y N B
Is SA1 closed?
N Y
Is SA3 closed within TA11? Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA12)?
N Y
DELAY TA51
13A3 Y
23A1
Level 2 error Cassette hold release failure retry Retry at the time of cassette hold failure
Is SA3 closed?
N
Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA11)?
Message display "CASS. SET INCORRECT CS#" Degeneration for relevant shelf
A 13A3
23A2
Level 2 error Cassette hold release failure retry Cassette hold DRIVER (SOLA1/OFF) DELAY TA12 Retry at the time of cassette hold release failure
B
Y E 03A3
Message display "CASS. SET INCORRECT CS#." Degeneration for relevant shelf
D
END
FR1H0424.EPS
N Y
Table 5.5.1 Operation Parameters Symbol TA11 TA12 Description Hold release timeout Wait for hold release retry Wait for hold retry Wait for initialization hold Hold release retry Hold retry Value 0.5 sec 2 sec 2 sec 0.5 sec 5 times 5 times
TR1H0076.EPS
Table 5.5.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name I/O name in flow SA1 SA3 SOLA1 Topmost 2nd shelf 3rd shelf shelf position position position SA1 SA3 SOLA1 SA5 SA7 SOLA2 SA9 SA11 SOLA3 4th shelf position SA13 SA15 SOLA4
TR1H0077.EPS
03A3
TA15
FR1H0423.EPS
MD - 138
MD - 139
CONTENTS
10
MD - 140
CONTENTS
10
MD - 141
N
B
Is SB2 opened within TB74? Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection error
Up-down load movement Fig. 2.8.1 Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (MB2/PB72) DRIVE (MC1/PC72) DRIVE (MD3/PD72)
SB2: Cassette inlet IP sensor SC1: Before-BCR IP sensor SB2:OPEN CLOSE SC1:CLOSE OPEN
Feed conveyance UP direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (hard) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft)
03B6
Fig.2.10.4 Conveyance grip (HP return) DRIVE (MD2/PD23) Cassette can be inserted. LED remains OFF.
Is SB4 closed?
N Y
DELAY TB76 Load conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DELAY TB76
Feed conveyance UP direction stop DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft)
03B6
END
FR1H0426.EPS
It is checked that it is for lateral (width) It is checked that it is metric size. for lateral (width) inch size.
If the size of the IP being initialized is out of spec, level 0 error occurs.
Table 5.6.1 Operation Parameters Symbol PB72 PC72 PD23 PD72 TB74 TB75 TB76 TB77 Description Initialization conveyance (up direction) Initialization conveyance (up direction) Conveyance grip (HP return) Initialization conveyance (up direction) Load remaining IP ejection timeout Wait for side-positioning detection Wait for feed switchback Value - infinite p - infinite p 400 p - infinite p 7.6 sec 0.5 sec 0.5 sec
TR1H0078.EPS
Side-positioning Fig.2.6.4
A
FR1H0425.EPS
MD - 140
MD - 141
CONTENTS
10
MD - 142
CONTENTS
10
MD - 143
N Y
Message output "IP may be jammed if CONTINUE key is pressed." User selected process continued?
Y N A Y N
Up-down load movement Fig.2.8.1 Load conveyance derection DRIVE (SOLC1/ON) DRIVE (MB2/PB74) DRIVE (MC1/PC74) DRIVE (MF1/PF74) Is SB2 closed within TB73?
N Y
System down
N
No IP
Message output "Load largest empty cassette" Remaining ejected cassette IN Fig. 5.4.3
Load conveyance direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft) Load suction Fig.2.10.3 Load suction conveyance Fig.2.10.4
03B9
Load conveyance direction DRIVE (ME2/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MF1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (SOLC1/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Load standby remaining IP ejection error
Message output "Load empty cassette in following size [10x12] " Remaining ejected cassette IN Fig. 5.4.3 IP found
FR1H0428.EPS
Table 5.7.1 Operation Parameters Symbol PB74 PC74 Description Value Initialization conveyance (load conveyance) - infinite p Initialization conveyance (load conveyance) - infinite p Initialization conveyance (load conveyance) + infinite p Load standby remaining IP ejection timeout 11.6 sec Load remaining IP ejection timeout 7.6 sec
TR1H0079.EPS
END
FR1H0427.EPS
MD - 142
MD - 143
CONTENTS
10
MD - 144
CONTENTS
10
MD - 145
Driving shaft grip release (fast) Fig. 5.9.2 DELAY TZ51 Driving shaft grip (ST) Fig. 5.9.3 DELAY TDZ51 Driving shaft grip release (fast) Fig. 5.9.2 DELAY TZ51 HP positioning Driving shaft grip (HR) Fig. 5.9.3 DELAY TZ51 Driving shaft grip release (HR) Fig. 5.9.2 DELAY TZ51 Selfdiagnostics
END
Driven shaft grip release (ST) Fig. 5.9.4 DELAY TZ51 Driven shaft grip (fast) Fig. 5.9.5 DELAY TZ51 Driven shaft grip release (ST) Fig. 5.9.4 DELAY TZ51 Driven shaft grip (HR) Fig. 5.9.5 DELAY TZ51 Driven shaft self-diagnostics Fig. 5.9.6 HP positioning Misalignment compensation warm-up operation
N Y
Up-down load movement Fig.2.8.1 Steps "after-reading conveyance " to "IP load" in reading sequence of routine are executed (including erasure lamp turn-off and movement of elevation unit) Fig.2.1.1 Cassette can be inserted. LED remains OFF.
END
FR1H0429.EPS
Driving shaft self-diagnostics Fig. 5.9.7 DELAY TZ51 Driving shaft grip release (fast) Fig. 5.9.2 DELAY TZ51
Idle positioning
A
FR1H0430.EPS
Table 5.9.1 Operation Parameters Symbol TZ51 Description Wait for initialization grip operation Value 0.5 sec
TR1H0080.EPS
MD - 144
MD - 145
CONTENTS
10
MD - 146
CONTENTS
10
MD - 147
Symbol TZ24
Value 2 / 10 sec
TR1H0081.EPS
START
Description Driven shaft grip timeout (ST/HR) Lower limit for driven shaft grip release spec (ST/HR) Upper limit for driven shaft grip release spec (ST/HR)
Driving shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) Is SZ2 closed within TZ24? Driving shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Driving shaft grip release error
FR1H0431.EPS
Driven shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ3/ON) TZ3 START Timer START Is SZ3 opened within TZ31?
N Y
N Y
Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ3/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Driven shaft grip release error
Timer STOP
Error log (detailed information) Timer data recording Level 2 error Driven shaft grip release operation error
FR1H0433.EPS
Table 5.9.3 Operation Parameters Symbol Description Driving shaft grip timeout (ST/HR) Lower limit for driving shaft grip spec (ST/HR) Upper limit for driving shaft grip spec (ST/HR) Value 5 / 10 sec 1.6 / 3.3 sec 2.8 / 6.0 sec
TR1H0082.EPS
END
23C7
Driving shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ2/ON) TZ21 START Timer START
N Y
Is SZ2 opened within TZ21? Driving shaft grip stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (soft)
03C6
START
Table 5.9.5 Operation Parameters Symbol Description Driven shaft grip timeout (fast/HR) Value 2 / 10 sec
TR1H0084.EPS
Driven shaft grip driving DRIVE (MZ3/ON) Is SZ3 closed within TZ34?
N Y
TZ34
Level 2 error Driving shaft grip operation error NOTE: It is subject to selection of reading mode (HR/ST).
END
FR1H0432.EPS
FR1H0434.EPS
MD - 146
MD - 147
CONTENTS
10
MD - 148
CONTENTS
10
MD - 149
Speed data setting Driven shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ3/ST speed ON) TZ35 STRAT Timer START Is SZ3 opened within TZ35?
N Y
Speed data setting Driven shaft grip release driving DRIVE (MZ2/ST speed ON) TZ25 STRAT Timer START Is SZ2 opened within TZ25?
N Y
Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE(MZ3/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Driven shaft grip release self-diagnosis error
Driven shaft grip release stop DRIVE (MZ2/OFF) (soft) Level 0 error Drive shaft grip self-diagnosis error
Timer STOP
03CB
Timer STOP
03CA
N Y
Rotation-speed correction Sequence flow chart See 5.9 (8). Speed data update
Rotation-speed correction Sequence flow chart See 5.9 (8). Speed data update
DELAY TZ51
DELAY TZ51
END
FR1H0435.EPS
END
FR1H0436.EPS
Table 5.9.6 Operation Parameters Symbol TZ35 TZ36 TZ37 TZ51 Description Driven shaft grip release timeout (self-diagnostics) Lower limit for driven shaft grip release spec (self-diagnostics) Upper limit for driven shaft grip release spec (self-diagnostics) Wait for initialization grip operation Value 5 sec 1.7 sec 2.0 sec 0.5 sec
TR1H0085.EPS
Table 5.9.7 Operation Parameters Symbol TZ25 TZ26 TZ27 TZ51 Description Driven shaft grip timeout (self-diagnostics) Lower limit for driven shaft grip spec (self-diagnostics) Upper limit for driven shaft grip spec (self-diagnostics) Wait for initialization grip operation Value 5 sec 2.2 sec 2.4 sec 0.5 sec
TR1H0086.EPS
MD - 148
MD - 149
CONTENTS
10
MD - 150
CONTENTS
10
MD - 151
(8) Detailed Sequence of Rotation-Speed Correction Sequence Flow Chart The rotation-speed correction sequence for driven-shaft and driving-shaft self-diagnostics, and their respective parameters are as follows.
Fig. 5.9.8 Rotation-Speed Correction Sequence Flow Chart
Preprocessing: Fig. 5.9.6, Fig. 5.9.7
START
Y N
Is SA1 opened?
T1: Processing time acquired by measurement It represents the value of the timer indicated in Fig. 5.9.7.
Calculate correction D/A data in each mode (decimals omitted). DHR = DoHR x T1/T0 DST = DoST x T1/T0 D (fast) = Do (fast) x T1/T0 Compare the upper-limit and lower-limit values of the correction D/A data in each mode, and confirm the value. Correction D/A data < lower-limit value Substitute the lower-limit value for the correction D/A data. Correction D/A data > upper-limit value Substitute the upper-limit value for the correction D/A data. In other cases Use the correction D/A data as is. Update the default for the subsequent calculation. DoHR = DHR DoST = DST Do (fast) = D (fast)
Message output "Unload cassette." Cassette hold release Fig.2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on The cassette removable condition is indicated. Operation performed by the operator
Cassette removal Same as in the cassette ejection routine descried in Fig. 2.11.1.
N Y
Is SA1 opened?
END
FR1H0437.EPS
N Y
Table 5.9.8 Rotation-Speed Correction Parameters MZ2 Motor Mode HR ST Fast MZ3 Motor Mode HR ST Fast voltage (V) 4.30 8.60 10.00 voltage (V) 3.50 6.90 10.00 Initial value D/A output voltage (V) 1.20 2.30 3.30 D/A data Do 61 H 118 H 170 H Driving-shaft grip spec Process time To(sec) 1.86 value Tmin TZ36 value Tmax TZ37 2.30 TZ26 TZ27 Process time To(sec) Driving-shaft grip spec value Tmin value Tmax Correction D/A data value Dmin 36 H 36 H 36 H value Dmax 255 H 255 H 255 H
N Y
LEDT1 is turned on
Initial value D/A output voltage (V) 1.43 2.87 3.30 D/A data Do 73 H 147 H 170 H
Correction D/A data value Dmin 36 H 36 H 36 H value Dmax 255 H 255 H 255 H
TR1H0087.EPS
Table 5.10.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name I/O name in flow SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 Topmost 2nd shelf 3rd shelf shelf position position position SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 SA5 SA6 LEDT3 LEDT4 SA9 SA10 LEDT5 LEDT6 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 LEDT7 LEDT8
TR1H0088.EPS
Table 5.10.1 Operation Parameters Symbol TA13 Description Wait for cassette OUT Value 0.5 sec
TR1H0089.EPS
MD - 150
MD - 151
CONTENTS
10
MD - 152
CONTENTS
10
MD - 153
8.6
Error Handling
TA51 NA11
Table 5.11.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name I/O name in flow SA3 SOLA1 Topmost shelf position SA3 SOLA1 2nd shelf 3rd shelf position position SA7 SOLA2 SA11 SOLA3 4th shelf position SA15 SOLA4
TR1H0091.EPS
G Corresponding sequences Fig. 2.4.2 Feed Suction Fig. 4.2.2 Feed Step Operation (1/3)
Symbol TA13
Table 6.1.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name I/O name in flow SA1 Topmost 2nd shelf shelf position position SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 SA5 SA6 LEDT3 LEDT4 3rd shelf position SA9 SA10 LEDT5 LEDT6 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 LEDT7 LEDT8
TR1H0093.EPS
N Y
Is SA3 opened within TA11? Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA11)? Level 2 error Cassette hold release failure retry Cassette hold DRIVE (SOLA1/OFF) DELAY TA12
N Y
13A3
Level 1 error Cassette shelf error Message display "CASS. SET INCORRECT CS#." Degeneration for relevant shelf
23A2
At the time when the error IP is returned to the cassette, an elevation permission is issued to start the processing for the next IP in the queue. At the same time, removal of the cassette for the error IP is notified to the user.
START
This elevation permission allows the process to start. G If there is another IP in the machine, up-download load. G If there is any unprocessed cassette, up-down feed feed.
A N
03A3
N Y
END
If the shelf intended for ejection is degenerated due to initialization, another empty cassette is put into another shelf so that the process resumes.
FR1H0439.EPS
Cassette ejection Same as in the routine described in Fig. 2.11.1. If hold release error occurs during cassette ejection, degeneration takes place for the relevant shelf.
N
Cassette removal
N Y
Is SA1 opened?
LEDT2 is turned off LEDT1 is turned on The ready condition is indicated. Return to normal routine
FR1H0440.EPS
END
MD - 152
MD - 153
CONTENTS
10
MD - 154
CONTENTS
10
MD - 155
(2) Detailed Sequence of Cassette Hold Release It is the cassette release operation corresponding to Error Handling: Cassette Ejection 2.
Fig. 6.2.2 Cassette Hold Release 2
Preprocessing: Fig. 6.2.1
START
Table 6.2.1 Operation Parameters Symbol TA13 Description Wait for cassette OUT Value 0.5 sec
TR1H0094.EPS
Table 6.2.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing
Y
*: Push the cassette once to draw it out. The cassette cannot be drawn out by merely pulling it.
LEDT2
N Y
Is SA3 opened within TA11? Is the number of retries made greater than the retry count (NA11)? Level 2 error Cassette hold failure failure retry Cassette hold DRIVE (SOLA1/ON)
Preprocessing: Fig. 2.4.3, Fig. 2.4.4, Fig. 2.10.3, Fig. 2.10.4, Fig. 4.2.2, and Fig. 4.2.3 No matter whether there is any IP in the machine or START Removal of the cassette there is any unprocessed for the error IP is notified cassette, it is placed in a to the user, and after the Error message output queue until an elevation cassette removal, an "STOP ALARM permission. elevation permission is / UNLOAD CASS." G Another IP in the machine issued to start the proceeds to the load processing for the next standby condition. IP in the queue. Alarm disabled G The unprocessed cassette enters the feed standby Cassette removed condition. Cassette hold release 2 Fig.6.2.2 The cassette removable LEDT2 is turned on condition is indicated. Cassette removal Cassette ejection 2 If hold release failure occurs during cassette ejection 2, the system goes down.
N Y N Y
Y 23A2
03A2 END
END
DELAY TA12
System down
A
FR1H0442.EPS
Table 6.2.2 Operation Parameters Symbol TA11 TA12 NA11 Description Hold release timeout Wait for hold release retry Hold release retry Value 0.5 sec 2 sec 5 times
TR1H0096.EPS
Table 6.2.2a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow I/O name I/O name in flow SA3 SOLA1 Topmost shelf position SA3 SOLA1 2nd shelf 3rd shelf position position SA7 SOLA2 SA11 SOLA3 4th shelf position SA15 SOLA4
TR1H0097.EPS
Is SA1 opened?
LEDT2 is turned off LEDT1 is turned on Elevation permission is issued The ready condition is indicated. This elevation permission allows the process to start. G If there is another IP in the machine,up-down load load. G If there is any unprocessed cassette, up-down feed feed.
FR1H0441.EPS
END
MD - 154
MD - 155
CONTENTS
10
MD - 156
CONTENTS
10
MD - 157
(2) Detailed Sequence of Reverse Conveyance Load It is the detailed sequence of reverse conveyance load for Error Handling: Recovered IP Load.
Fig. 6.3.2 Reverse Conveyance Load
Preprocessing: Fig. 6.3.1, Fig. 6.7.1, Fig. 6.8.1, and Fig. 6.9.1
START
Recovered IP load fast conveyance DRIVE (MD3/PD81) DRIVE (MC1/PC12) DRIVE (MB2/PB23)
No matter whether there is any IP in the machine or there is any unprocessed cassette, it is placed in a queue until an elevation permission. G Another IP in the machine proceeds to the load standby condition. G The unprocessed cassette enters the feed standby condition.
N Y
Is SB2 closed within TB81? Recovered IP load fast conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) MD3, MC2, MB2, excitation OFF
03B5
Recovered IP load slow conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/PD81) DRIVE (MC1/PC12) DRIVE (MB2/PB23)
Elevation permission is issued Error message "STOP ALARM / UNLOAD CASS." Alarm disabled
This elevation permission allows the process to start. G If there is another IP in the machine, up-down load load. G If there is any unprocessed cassette, up-down feed feed.
Level 0 error Conveyance error (Restored IP load high-speed) Recovered IP load slow conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (soft) MD3, MC2, MB2, excitation OFF Level 0 error Conveyance error (Restored IP load low-speed)
N Y
Table 6.3.1a List of I/O Names Used in the Flow and Drawing I/O name I/O name in flow SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 Topmost shelf position SA1 SA2 LEDT1 LEDT2 2nd shelf 3rd shelf position position SA5 SA6 LEDT3 LEDT4 SA9 SA10 LEDT5 LEDT6 4th shelf position SA13 SA14 LEDT7 LEDT8
TR1H0099.EPS
Cassette removed Cassette hold release Fig.2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on Cassette removal The cassette removable condition is indicated. Operation performed by the operator
Recovered IP load slow conveyance stop DRIVE (MD3/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MC1/OFF) (soft) DRIVE (MB2/OFF) (hard)
03B4
Load suction Fig.2.10.3 Load suction conveyance Fig.2.10.4 Conveyance grip (HP return) DRIVE (MD2/PD23)
Instant return of cassette is supported.
END
Cassette ejection Same as in the routine described in Fig.2.11.1. If hold release error occurs during cassette ejection, degeneration takes place for the relevant shelf.
N Y
N Y
Is SA1 opened?
If reverse conveyance load is performed for any out-of-spec IP, conveyance grip (HP return) is not executed.
FR1H0444.EPS
LEDT1 is turned on
END
Description Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance) Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance) Conveyance grip (HP return) Recovery conveyance (fast load conveyance) Load timeout Recovery load timeout
MD - 156
MD - 157
CONTENTS
10
MD - 158
CONTENTS
10
MD - 159
At the time when the error IP is returned to the cassette, an elevation permission is issued (via normal routine) to start the processing for the next IP in the queue. At the same time, removal of the cassette for the error IP is notified to the user.
Process continued
FR1H0445.EPS
At the time when the error IP is returned to the cassette, an elevation permission is issued (via normal routine) to start the processing for the next IP in the queue. At the same time, removal of the cassette for the error IP is notified to the user.
END
Process continued
FR1H0447.EPS
At the time when the error IP is returned to the cassette, an elevation permission is issued (via normal routine) to start the processing for the next IP in the queue. At the same time, removal of the cassette for the error IP is notified to the user.
Alarm disabled Cassette removed Subsequently, degeneration is performed for the lamp and the IP is left unerased ***.
END
Process continued
FR1H0446.EPS
MD - 158
MD - 159
CONTENTS
10
MD - 160
CONTENTS
10
MD - 161
At the time when the error IP is returned to the cassette, an elevation permission IDT line established is issued to start the processing for the next IP in the queue. At the same time, removal of the cassette for the error IP is notified to the user.
Error message output Stop ARARM /UNLOAD CASS. Alarm disabled Process stopped
Error message output Stop ARARM /UNLOAD CASS. Alarm disabled Cassette removed
No matter whether there is any IP in the machine or there is any unprocessed cassette, it is placed in a queue until an elevation permission. G Another IP in the machine proceeds to the load standby condition. G The unprocessed cassette enters the feed standby condition.
Suction cup movement (HP load standby) Suction cup load preparation DRIVE (MB1/PB14) This elevation permission allows the Reverse conveyance process to start. load G If there is another IP in the machine, Fig.6.3.2 up-down load load. G If there is any unprocessed cassette, Elevation permission up-down feed feed. is issued Error message output Stop ARARM/UNLOAD CASS. IDT line error Alarm disabled Cassette removed Cassette hold release Fig.2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on The cassette removable condition is indicated. Operation performed by the operator
Suction cup movement (HP load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB14) Reverse conveyance load Fig.6.3.2 Elevation permission is issued Error message output Stop ARARM /UNLOAD CASS. Alarm disabled Cassette removed Cassette hold release Fig.2.2.2 LEDT2 is turned on
This elevation permission allows the process to start. G If there is another IP in the machine, up-down load load. G If there is any unprocessed cassette, up-down feed feed. The IP without ID information registration is ejected.
Cassette removal Cassette ejection Same as in the routine described in Fig. 2.11.1. If hold release error occurs during cassette ejection, degeneration takes place for the relevant shelf.
N Y
Cassette ejection
N Y
Is SA1 opened?
Same as in the routine described in Fig. 2.11.1. If hold release error occurs during cassette ejection, degeneration takes place for the relevant shelf.
N
N Y
END
FR1H0448.EPS
END
MD - 160
MD - 161
CONTENTS
10
MD - 162
CONTENTS
10
MD - 163
START
START
Process up to side-positioning is performed for second IP Suction cup movement (HP load standby) DRIVE (MB1/PB14) Suction cup load preparation
DELAY TC31 Side-positioning (HP stopper) DRIVE (MD1/PD11) Conveyance grip (HP return) DRIVE (MD2/PD23) Side-positioning (stopper HP) DRIVE (MD1/PD16) BCR return conveyance driving DRIVE (MD3/PD33)
Table 6.9.1 Operation Parameters Symbol PB14 Description Suction cup movement (HP load standby) Value 86p
DELAY TC31
TR1H0105.EPS
END
FR1H0451.EPS
Table 6.10.1a Operation Parameters Symbol PD11 PD16 PD23 TC31 Description Side-positioning (HP stopper) Side-positioning (stopper HP) Conveyance grip (HP return) Wait for BCR retry Value 64 p -64 p 400 p 0.1 sec
TR1H0106.EPS
Table 6.10.1b Operation Parameters Symbol PD33 Description Conveyance (BCR return) 14x17 I 14x14 I 10x12 I 204 p 1752 p 2792 p 8x10 I 4870 p 18x24 ST 24x30 ST 18x24 HR 24x30 HR 5338 p 2894 p 5338 p 4116 p
TR1H0107.EPS
MD - 162
MD - 163
CONTENTS
10
MD - 164
CONTENTS
10
MD - 165
8.7
Code 03A2 03A3 03B1 03B2 03B3 03B4 03B5 03B6 03B7 03B9 03BC 03BF 03C1 03C2 03C6 03C7 03C8 03C9 03CA 03CB 03D1 03D2 03D3 03D4 03D5 03D6 03D7 03D8
Fig. 2.6.4 (MD-77), Fig. 4.3.1 (MD-116) Fig. 2.7.5 (MD-90) Side-positioning grip HP detection preparation retry Fig. 2.7.5 (MD-89) Fig. 2.7.3 (MD-85) Side-positioning grip operation error FFM drive W.F. disorder Drive shaft grip operation error Driven grip release operation error Conveyance sensor error After-reading grip HP detection retry After-reading grip HP detection preparation retry After-reading grip operation error Elevation shelf movement error retry Feed-IP suction failure retry Load IP suction failure retry Suction cup HP detection preparation retry Suction cup HP detection retry Suction cup HP return error Fig. 2.7.3 (MD-86) Fig. 2.7.3 (MD-84), Fig. 3.3.2 (MD-106), Fig. 5.9.3 (MD-146) Fig. 2.7.3 (MD-84), Fig. 3.3.3 (MD-107), Fig. 5.9.4 (MD-147) Fig. 2.7.6 (MD-91) Fig. 2.7.4 (MD-88) Fig. 2.7.4 (MD-87) Fig. 2.7.3 (MD-85) Fig. 2.3.1 (MD-62), Fig. 2.3.3 (MD-66), Fig. 2.8.1 (MD-93) Fig. 2.4.2 (MD-68), Fig. 4.2.2 (MD-110) Fig. 2.10.3 (MD-100), Fig. 4.2.3 (MD-113) Fig. 2.3.2 (MD-63) Fig. 2.3.2 (MD-64) Fig. 2.3.1 (MD-62), Fig. 2.3.3 (MD-65), Fig. 2.4.3 (MD-69), Fig. 2.8.1 (MD-93), Fig. 2.10.4 (MD-101), Fig. 4.2.2 (MD-111), Fig. 4.2.3 (MD-114), Fig. 5.3.2 (MD-123)
TR1H0109.EPS
Post-conveyor remaining IP discharge error 03D9 Erasure conveyor remaining IP discharge error 03DC Post-conveyor grip operation error 03DD HP up-and-down movement error 03DE Up-and-down movement error 03E8 Suction cup moving error 0549 Image quit error 13A1 Cassette setting error 13A2 Cassette hold release error 13A3 Cassette shelf error 13A8 Non standard IP size 13A9 Barcode read error 13AA Erasure lamp failure 13AB Overexposed IP unerased 13AC ID information not registered 13AD IP with improper generation/type detected 13AE No relevant MPM code 13AF IDT line error 13B8 IP position information error 13E1 Feed-IP suction error 13E2 Feed-IP dropped 13E3 Feed-IP grip error 13E4 Load IP suction error 13E5 Load IP dropped
MD - 164
MD - 165
CONTENTS
10
MD - 166
CONTENTS
10
Ref. value (sec.)
MD - 167
Remarks
8.8
Parameters
Symbol
Description Feed conveyance timeout IP length measurement timeout 298mm (24x30 metric) /238mm (24x30 inch) determination
TC11
Ref. value (sec.)
0.5 2 0.5 0.5 2 0.2 0.5 1 0 0.1 1 0 0.1 0.1 0.05 2.6 3.7 0.5 1.3 5.3 20 10.2 5.6 9.6 5.6 12.5 0.5 0.5 6.7
TC12
Remarks
Description Hold release timeout Wait for hold release retry Wait for cassette OUT Hold timeout Wait for hold retry Wait for cassette IN Wait for initialization hold Feed suction timeout Wait for feed suction Wait for feed leak Grip timeout Wait for load suction Wait for load leak Wait for next operation Wait for feed After-reading conveyance timeout Load timeout Wait for suction cup HP settlement Suction cup HP detection preparation timeout Suction cup HP detection timeout Suction cup HP 1-pulse driving timeout Feed/load conveyance remaining IP search timeout Feed/load conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout Load standby remaining IP ejection timeout Load remaining IP ejection timeout Before-reading standby remaining IP ejection timeout Wait for side-positioning detection Wait for feed switchback Feed/load conveyance remaining IP movement timeout
TC21 TC22 TC23 TC31 TD11 TD12 TD13 TD14 TD31 TD32 TD33 TD34
354mm (14x14 inch)/303mm (10x21 inch) determination 0.7 430mm (14x17 inch)/354mm (14x14 inch) determination 0.83 Wait for BCR retry Wait for settlement of IP that is not side-positioned Wait for side-positioning return Wait for re-side-positioning Wait for settlement of IP that has been side-positioned Wait for BCR return Wait for side-positioning conveyance return IDT response timeout Side-positioning timeout IDT
0.1 0.2 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.5 0.2 120 0.37 0.53 0.44 0.65 0.70 0.45 0.70 0.57
14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR 14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR 14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR
TR1H1154.EPS
TD35
Feed/load conveyance remaining IP movement timeout 2 8.7 Recovery load timeout Elevation reference seek timeout 1 Elevation reference seek timeout 2 Elevation topmost shelf seek timeout 1 Elevation topmost shelf seek timeout 2 Elevation HP 1-pulse driving timeout
3.1 13.5 1.4 1.4 1.4 20
TR1H1153.EPS
MD - 166
MD - 167
CONTENTS
10
MD - 168
Remarks 14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR
CONTENTS
10
MD - 169
Remarks 14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR
Symbol
TD36
Symbol
TF12
Description
After-reading conveyance IP trailing-edge detection 1.38 timeout 1.22 1.11 0.89 0.84 1.10 0.84 0.97
TD51 TD52 TD53 TD54 TD61 TD62 TD63 TD64 TD71 TD72 TD73 TD74 TD75 TD91 TD92
Wait for side-positioning HP settlement Side-positioning HP detection preparation timeout Side-positioning HP detection timeout Side-positioning HP 1-pulse driving timeout Wait for conveyance grip HP settlement Conveyance grip HP detection preparation timeout Conveyance grip HP detection timeout Conveyance grip HP 1-pulse driving timeout Side-positioning conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout 1 Side-positioning conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout 2 Side-positioning conveyance remaining IP search timeout Wait for side-positioning switchback Initialization side-positioning timeout SPR after-reading conveyance timeout Wait for SPR after-reading trailing-edge detection
0.5 1 8 10 0.5 1.2 13.3 10 5.6 3.9 4.8 0.5 3.8 1.7 2.57 2.07 1.74 1.06 0.91 1.7 0.91 1.31
TF13 TF14 TF15 TF17 TF18 TF51 TF52 TF71 TF72 TF73 TF74 TF76 TF77 TQ21 TQ22 TR11
Wait for switchback Before-erasure conveyance IP leading-edge detection timeout Erasure conveyance IP trailing-edge detection timeout
After-erasure conveyance IP trailing-edge detection 1.2 timeout 1 After-erasure conveyance IP trailing-edge detection 1.3 timeout 2 Wait for initialization erasure lamp turn-on Wait for initialization erasure lamp turn-off After-reading conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout Erasure conveyance remaining IP ejection timeout Erasure conveyance remaining IP search timeout Load standby positioning timeout 1 Reading conveyance remaining IP search timeout Load standby positioning timeout 2 SPR after-erasure conveyance timeout SPR load timeout SPR before-erasure conveyance timeout 5 75 5.6 4.8 3.9 1.2 4.8 5.6 2.6 3.7 0.42 0.59 0.69 0.91 0.96 0.7
TF11
MD - 168
MD - 169
CONTENTS
10
MD - 170
Remarks 14x17 inch 14x14 inch 10x12 inch 8x10 inch 1824 ST 2430 ST 1824 HR 2430 HR
ST HR
CONTENTS
10
MD - 171
Remarks
ST HR ST HR ST HR
Symbol
TZ11
Description
Subscanning IP leading-edge detection timeout
Symbol
TZ31
Description
Driven shaft grip lease timeout
TZ32
1.5 3.0
TZ33
2.0 4.0
TZ34
2 10
Fast
HR
TZ12
2.10 4.20
Driven shaft grip release timeout (self-diagnostics) Lower limit for driven shaft grip release spec (self-diagnostics) Upper limit for driven shaft grip release spec (self-diagnostics) Mirror-up timeout Mirror-down timeout Wait for initialization grip operation
TZ13 TZ14
Driven shaft grip release start Wait for subscanning stop (conveyance compensation for logical reading) 0 Standard reading 18x43 portrait, center 10x8 landscape, upper right 10x12 portrait, upper right 14x14, top 18x8, top Pantomo, portrait, right center
TR1H1161.EPS
Wait for subscanning settlement Wait for secondary erasure grip release Wait for end of secondary erasure reading conveyance Wait for secondary erasure subscanning settlement Driving shaft grip timeout
Description
Hold release retry Hold retry Feed suction retry Load suction retry Suction HP retry Elevation HP retry Elevation movement retry BCR retry Side-positioning HP retry Conveyance grip HP retry
5 5 3 3 2 2 2 3 3 3
TZ22
1.8 3.6
TZ23
2.4 4.8
TZ24
2 10
TR1H1158.EPS
Driving shaft grip timeout (self-diagnostics) Lower limit for driving shaft grip spec (self-diagnostics) Upper limit for driving shaft grip spec (self-diagnostics)
5 2.2 2.4
MD - 170
MD - 171
CONTENTS
10
MD - 172
CONTENTS
10
MD - 173
Other than V-type (different generation) X-ray dosage (mR) Greater than B Less than
Remarks
Remarks
No limitation
471.20
1.8
TR1H1166.EPS
Remarks
No limitation
471.20
1.8
TR1H1167.EPS
V-type ST
(sub-standard sensitivity)
Remarks
4 5 6
0 85 120
Remarks
4 6
0 40
40
42.00 25.13
2139 1280
14.2 23.7
TR1H1164.EPS
Remarks
4 5 6 7 8 9 A B
MD - 172
MD - 173
CONTENTS
10
MD - 174
Next operation
FR1H6520.EPS
G UP (rise-time), DN (fall-time)
Acceleration and deceleration time during trapezoidal driving. It is set in msec.
G Delay (powerdown-delay)
A setup value, from stop to issuance of a next operating instruction. Its unit is 2 msec. 5 in the Delay column means 10 msec.
G H/L (halt-limit)
It corresponds to three digits of bits. 1st digit (bit 2): 0 = drive with high power; 1 = drive with low power 2nd digit (bit 1): 0 = stop in energized condition; 1 = stop with unenergized condition 3rd digit (bit 0): 0 = with power down delay; 1 = without power down delay The meanings of the H/L values are summarized in the table below.
HL value
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 000
3-bit value
Drive 1st digit of 3 bits High power High power High power High power Low power Low power Low power Low power
Stop condition 2nd digit of 3 bits Energized condition Energized condition Unenergized condition Unenergized condition Energized condition Energized condition Unenergized condition Unenergized condition
CR-IR341 Service Manual
Power down delay 3rd digit of 3 bits Provided Not provided Provided Not provided Provided Not provided Provided Not provided
TR1H1320**.EPS
MD - 174
CONTENTS
10
MD - 175
MB1
PB11
CW CCW CCW CW CCW CW CCW CW CCW CW CW CCW CCW CCW CCW CW CW CW CCW CCW CW CW CW CCW CCW CCW CCW CCW CW CCW CCW CW CW CCW CW CW CW CW CW CCW CW CW CCW CW CCW CW CW
1 60 0xFFFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0x7FFFFF 1 300 1000 1000 300 300 3000.070677 3000.070677 600.0141355 600.0141355 3000.070677 3462 4000 6922 4000 10392 4000 300 300 300 300 300 300 300 300 600.0141355 600.0141355 600.0141355 600.0141355 600.0141355 3462 4000 300 3460 4000 300 6930 4000 300 150 150 150 150 150 150 63 100 100 63 63 220 220 63 63 220 6922 4000 300 150 3460 4000 300 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 63 100 100 63 63 70 70 63 63 70 3470 4000 300 150 150 10392 4000 300 150 150 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 50 10 0 0 0 0 0 6930 4000 300 150 150 10 3470 4000 300 150 150 10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
TR1H1159.EPS
250 262 86 86 100 264 250 98 12 1 0x7FFFFF 1 0xFFFFFF 6 14 14 675 0x7FFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0x7FFFFF 715 0x7FFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 1500.035339 300.0070677 220 70 0 0 300.0070677 300.0070677 63 63 0 0 300.0070677 300.0070677 63 63 0 0 1000 600.0141355 70 70 0 0 1000 600.0141355 70 70 0 0 1185.386016 711 65 109 0 0 1500.035339 300.0070677 220 70 0 0 1500.035339 300.0070677 220 70 0 0 1185.386016 711 65 109 0 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 300 300 63 63 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 300 300 63 63 400 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 300 300 63 63 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 65 109 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 100 100 10 0 500 300 65 109 10 0
500
300
65
109
10
PB51 PB52 PB53 PB54 PB81 PB82 MB2 PB22 PB23 PB25 PB26 PB27 PB71 PB72 PB74 MB3 PB113 PB114 PB121 PB123 PB124 PB131 PB132 PB134 PB141 PB142 PB143 PB100 PB101 PB102 PB103 PB104 MC1 PC12 PC71 PC72 PC74 PC11 PB112 PB21
MD - 175
CONTENTS
10
MD - 175.1
Delay H/L Remarks
I/O name Symbol HSPD (pps) LSPD (pps) UP (ms) DN (ms) Description Side-positioning (HP stopper) Motor rotating direction
MD1 CW
98p (14x17) 98p (14x14) 778p (10x12) 778p (8x10) 872p (1824 ST) 872p (2430 ST) 840p (1824 HR) 440p (2430 HR) 68p (14x17) 68p (14x14) 68p (10x12) 68p (8x10) 68p (1824 ST) 68p (2430 ST) 34p (1824 HR) 34p (2430 HR) 68p (14x17) 68p (14x14) 68p (10x12) 68p (8x10) 68p (1824 ST) 68p (2430 ST) 34p (1824 HR) 34p (2430 HR)
PD11
64
1000.002338
600
70
70
10
PD12
CW 1000.002338 600 70 70 10 0
PD13 CW
1000.002338
600
70
70
10
PD14
PD15 PD16 CCW CW CW CCW CCW CCW CW CW CW CW CW CCW CW CW CW CCW CCW CW CW PD35
Conveyance (side-positioning) Conveyance (reading preparation) Conveyance (secondary erasure reading) Side-positioning (stopper HP)
64 1 0x7FFFFF 1 0xFFFFFF 18 256 144 400 144 1 0xFFFFFF 1 0x7FFFFF 6 0xFFFFFF 972 1200.028271 1200.028271 1200.028271 900 1200.028271 772 480.0113084 480.0113084 772 1200.028271 1200.028271 1500.003508 1200.028271 772 480.0113084 772 3000.070677 3000.070677 DPR4-4 0x7FFFFF 15992 1715 CW CW 0x7FFFFF DPR4-4 DPR4-4 DPR4-4 3000.070677 600.0141355 600.0141355 600.0141355 300 240.0056542 480.0113084 480.0113084 480.0113084 600.0141355 600.0141355 240.0056542 240.0056542 480.0113084 480.0113084 63 70 220 220 100 220 70 63 70 220 220 63 220 63 220 220 480.0113084 63 480.0113084 70 70 63 63 70 70 70 70 70 70 63 70 70 70 63 70 63 70 70 240.0056542 220 70 240.0056542 220 70 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 54 0 240.0056542 220 70 0 240.0056542 220 70 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Dosage/reading mode Secondary erasure mode Dosage/reading mode Secondary erasure mode
1000.002338 1000.002338 300 500 300.0070677 500 300.0070677 1500.003508 1500.003508 400 400 300 500 300.0070677 500 300.0070677 1200.028271 1019 240.0056542 220 70 0 0 1019 63 63 0 0
204p (14x17), 1752p (14x14), 2792p (10x12), 4870p (8x10), 5338p (1824 ST), 2894p (2430 ST), 5338p (1824 HR), 4116p (2430 HR) IDT : 242p (14x17), 242p (14x14) CSL : 116p (14x17)
600 600 300 300.0070677 300.0070677 300.0070677 300.0070677 300 300 300 300 300 300.0070677 300.0070677 300.0070677 300.0070677 240.0056542 220 70 0 0 63 63 10 0 100 100 10 0 63 63 200 0 100 100 10 0 63 63 10 0 300 63 10 0 300 300 10 0 100 100 10 0 100 100 10 0 63 63 10 0 100 100 10 0 63 63 400 0 100 100 10 0 63 63 10 0 70 70 10 0
70
70
10
PD50
Side-positioning (initial driving) Side-positioning (HP return) Side-positioning 1-pulse driving (HP movement 1) Side-positioning (HP positioning) Side-positioning (HP movement 2) Conveyance grip release Conveyance grip Conveyance grip (HP return) Conveyance grip (slow) Conveyance grip (initial driving) Conveyance grip (HP return) Conveyance grip 1-pulse driving (HP movement 1) Conveyance grip (HP positioning) Conveyance grip (HP movement 2) Conveyance (feed) Conveyance (BCR)
PD51 PD52 PD53 PD54 MD2 (ME1) PD23 PD24 PD60 PD61 PD62 PD63 PD64 MD3 PD32 PD33
Conveyance (BCR return)
PD21 PD22
PD31
PD34
Conveyance (side-positioning conveyance return)
CCW 0xFFFFFF 180 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0x7FFFFF 0x7FFFFF 256 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 0xFFFFFF 1044 0x7FFFFF CCW CCW CCW CW CW CW CW CCW CCW CCW CCW CCW CCW CW CW CW CW
PD72 PD73 PD74 PD81 ME1 ME2 PE22 PE71 PE73 MF1 PF12 PF13 PF11 PE21 PE12
PF14
Conveyance (erasure 2) Conveyance (erasure 2)
PF15
Conveyance (after-erasure conveyance)
CCW CW CCW CW
63 63 63 63
63 63 63 63
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
TR1H1160.EPS
MD - 175.1
CONTENTS
10
MD - 175.2
BLANK PAGE
MD - 175.2
CONTENTS
10
MD - 176
CONTENTS
10
MD - 177
9.
9.1
Cassette set unit 163.50.3 Side plate of up-down IP removal conveyor Frame 1880.3
FRONT
Front view Right-hand side plate of cassette set unit (machine-specific label side)
Cassette set unit tray Scale 105.5 0.5mm Cassette set unit tray
Local
One-plane alignment
Two-plane alignment
F R O N T
1 mm or less
O FR NT
FR1H1611.EPS
FR1H1701.EPS
MD - 176
MD - 177
CONTENTS
10
MD - 178
CONTENTS
10
MD - 179
I Vertical Conveyor
Vertical conveyor
I Subscanning Unit
Top view
FRONT
Tray
A
T ON FR
FR
ON
Subscanning unit
B
Top view External plate
Frame
F R O N T
Internal plate
0.5 mm or less
0.5 mm or less
I After-Reading Conveyor
FR1H1612.EPS
I Erasure Conveyor
Before-side-positioning conveyor Erasure conveyor
Side plate of Side plate of erasure conveyor before-side-positioning conveyor
F R O N T
1880.3
1880.3 Frame
FRONT
FR1H1613.EPS
I Side-Positioning Conveyor
ET RES ON SW
Remote Local
OFF
Side plate of Side plate of Side plate of subscanning unit subscanning unit side-positioning conveyor
F R O N T
MD - 178
MD - 179
CONTENTS
10
MD - 180
CONTENTS
10
MD - 181
9.2
Roller Locations
Controller
FRONT
9.3
IP Conveyance Locations
T ON FR
10 Rubber roller x4
Vertical conveyor
OFF
FR1H1606.EPS
FR1H1046.EPS
MD - 180
MD - 181
CONTENTS
10
MD - 182
CONTENTS
10
MD - 183
9.4
I IP removal unit
Check at the topmost stage Bracket Arm Bracket
Hole
IP removal unit
101mm IP removal unit Shock absorber
Actuator Hole
SB3
FR1H1607.EPS
I Side-positioning conveyor
Actuator
T ON FR
SB1
FR
NT
Actuator
Bearing flange
86.51mm
Actuator
FR1H4028.EPS
FR1H1609.EPS
MD - 182
MD - 183
CONTENTS
10
MD - 184
CONTENTS
10
MD - 185
I Subscanning unit
9.5
Guide plate
NT RO
Cassette
54.7 9.8
24.2
Guide plate 87
87 Guide plate 87
Cam
Cam
67
FR1H1608.EPS
Guide plate
52
I After-Reading Conveyor
80
Actuator
SF2 31
Erasure conveyor 28
104
SC2
40.6 92
128.2
BCR 155.4
Subscanning unit After-reading conveyor 136.7 79.6 SD3 Side-positioning conveyor 153
37.4 40 30 39.6
Guide plate
MD - 184
MD - 185
CONTENTS
10
MD - 186
CONTENTS
10
Free length (mm) 104.8
MD - 187
SERIAL NO.
9.6
Mounting location
Part No.
Right side (reference plane) 388N2407 A Left side B Left side 388N2391 0.5 0.5 Left side D 388N2385 0.5 Left side 388N2385 0.5 Left side 388N2387 0.5 Left side
CR-IR341: #3360 388N2395
388N2306 0.55 4
117.5 89.7 84.4 78.4 4 91.9 78.4 4 91.9 115.9 4 137.9 5 121.0 116.0 0.5 5 121.0 0.5 0.4 0.5 5 4 5 121.8 0.5 5 121.0 78.4 0.5 4 91.9
TR1H1050.EPS
Power supply
C
Erasure conveyor Before-side-positioning conveyor
Right side (reference plane) 388N2395 x2 388N2395 CR-IR341: #3360 F Right side (reference plane) 388N2501 x2 Left side 388N2395 x2 CR-IR341: #3361 121.0 CR-IR341: #3360 Left side G Right side (reference plane) 388N2501 x2 116.0 388N2396 118.8 CR-IR341: #3361
I
After-reading conveyor
CR-IR341: #3361
Left side
388N2501
388N2395 x2
H
388N2395
Sidepositioning conveyor
388N2395
Right side (reference plane) 388N2395 x2 H Left side I Left side 388N2385 388N2395 Right side (reference plane) 388N2384
G
CR-IR341: #3360 388N2396 388N2395
FR1H4035.EPS
MD - 186
MD - 187
CONTENTS
10
MD - 188
CONTENTS
10
MD - 189
LED1
CN2
CN1
LED2 LED3 LED4 LED5 LED6
LED7
LED5
LED3
LED1 LED0
FR1B1605.EPS
LED6
LED4
LED2
D6 D8 D9 (Reserved)
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
When network data is transmitted When network data is received When a collision is detected During system initialization During OS kernel initialization During system clock initialization During monitor initialization During system task initialization During boot ROM task initialization During DMA initialization During boot device (SCSI/FD) initialization During a system code read Upon system code startup During an idle state When an error occurs
: LED D6 glows. : LED D8 glows. : LED D9 glows. : LED D0 glows. : LEDs D0 and D1 glow. : LED D2 glows. : LEDs D0 and D2 glow. : LEDs D1 and D2 glow. : LEDs D0, D1, and D2 glow : LED D3 glows. : LEDs D0 and D3 glow. : LEDs D1 and D3 glow. : LEDs D0, D1, and D3 glow. : LEDs D0 to D7 sequentially come on. : LEDs D0 to D7 simultaneously blink.
MD - 188
MD - 189
CONTENTS
10
MD - 189.1
CONTENTS
10
MD - 189.2
CN3 D3 D4 D2 D1
FR1B1606.EPS
FR1B1608.EPS
: LEDs D1, D2, D3, and D4 sequentially come on. : LEDs D1, D2, D3, and D4 simultaneously blink.
D2 D1
FR1B1609.EPS
LED3
LED2
LED1
FR1B1607.EPS
: LED1, LED2, and LED3 sequentially come on. : LED1, LED2, and LED3 simultaneously blink.
MD - 189.1
MD - 189.2
CONTENTS
10
MD - 189.3
CONTENTS
10
MD - 189.4
D1
CN3
D2 D1
FR1B1610.EPS
CN20
CN21
When fuse F1 is normal: D1 illuminated When fuse F2 is normal: D2 illuminated When fuse F3 is normal: D3 illuminated When fuse F5 is normal: D5 illuminated When fuse F6 is normal: D6 illuminated When fuse F1 is abnormal: D1 extinguished When fuse F2 is abnormal: D2 extinguished When fuse F3 is abnormal: D3 extinguished When fuse F5 is abnormal: D5 extinguished When fuse F6 is abnormal: D6 extinguished
MD - 189.3
MD - 189.4
CONTENTS 11
MD - 190
CONTENTS 11
MD - 191
11. Interlock
The interlock requirements for machine protection provide that the up-down drive motor (MB3) must not operate while the suction cup home position sensor (SB1) is OPEN.
MB3 Up-down IP removal assembly
BLANK PAGE
SB1 SB1
IP removal arm
T ON
FR
Actuator
FR1B1087.EPS
MD - 190
MD - 191
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 192
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 193
12
I Initialization
The initialization (self diagnosis) of the machine extends from the bootup of the subsystem (MFC) until the completion of the initialization of the mechanical mechanism and the internal software data. The following steps are taken by the program software written in the ROM of the CPU90E board. Write/read of data recorded in the board Download of the application software (subsystem) from the HDD Startup of the application software (subsystem) downloaded from the HDD Display of the progress of the initialization (self diagnosis) on the display of the operation panel REFERENCE
The machine might hang up due to some trouble during the initialization (self diagnosis). In this case, you can locate a troubled subsystem by the displayed step number. Refer to the Machine Description 7.14 Software terms and definitions for detailed information on the subsystems.
[Step 99]: Panel control subsystem (PNL) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the panel control subsystem (PNL) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Accepts key inputs such as the MUTL transition request. Accepts the window display request from each subsystem, and notifies the key input. Accepts the requests for displaying the software version and the progress of the initialization. Controls the LED indications (CALL, ERROR, etc.).
Although the specifications of the operation panel differ between the FCR5000 and FCR5500 systems, the CPU90E boards of the common type are employed. The operation panels are identified by the DIP switch settings of the CPU90 board.
<Components related to the self diagnosis of the panel control subsystem (PNL)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, operation panel [Step 95]: Log information control subsystem (JNL) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the log information control subsystem (JNL) Registers error log acquisition functions. Verifies whether the previous termination was normal (storage of the core dump in the HDD).
The self-diagnostic steps are carried out by the program software written in the ROM of the CPU90E board.
Operation of the CPU90E board is checked, and the message is displayed on the panel.
The downloaded application software is divided into a plurality of subsystems depending on the functions and units to be processed. [What is the main control subsystem (MFC)?] The main control subsystem (MFC) is, as the higher-level application software of each subsystem, responsible for the main control of startup/initialization/termination of the entire software and the management of the respective modes including: Display of the progress of the initialization Initialization of the management system and processing when the initialization fails Request and response for the initialization diagnosis of each subsystem The step numbers start to decrement. Refer to "Step number display during initialization (self diagnosis)".
FR1B1618.EPS
<Components related to the self diagnosis (self diagnosis) of the log information control subsystem (JNL)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board
A
FR1B1619.EPS
MD - 192
MD - 193
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 194
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 195
[Step 90]:
Conveyance control subsystem (IPH) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the conveyance control subsystem (IPH) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Loads the conveyance parameter file. Loads the scanner control parameters. Initializes the IP conveyance mechanism (including the subscanning system). Checks the erasure lamps. <Components related to the initialization (self diagnosis) of the conveyance control (IPH)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, SNS08A board, DRV08A board, respective motors/sensors/solenoids/pumps, etc.
[Step 70]:
DMS/FINP output image data control subsystem (FOT) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the DMS/FINP output image data control subsystem (FOT) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Checks whether the board necessary for network control is present, and takes countermeasures when an error is detected on the board. Initializes the LAN board. Initializes the HCP subsystem. (Initialization of the compression/decompression board is executed by the HCP subsystem.) <Components related to the self diagnosis of the DMS/FINP output image data control (FOT)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, MMC90A/DIM08A boards, HCP08A board, CPU90F/LAN90B/LAN90D boards
[Step 80]:
Image input control subsystem (IMG) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the image input control subsystem (IMG) Self-diagnoses the IMG07B board (image processing board). Loads the DSP micro program. Initializes and diagnoses the subscanning system (laser light, polygon, leading edge sensor, start-point sensor, etc.). N NOTE N
[Step 65]:
ID information input control subsystem (IIF) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the ID information input control subsystem (IIF) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations (setting the ID information source, etc.). Checks whether the board necessary for IDT control is present. Monitors the connection/disconnection of the control line with/from the IDT and the timeout, and controls the display of the line conditions. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the ID information input control (IIF)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board
The function of automatically resetting and re-initializing the machine when any errors of 04xx, 05xx, 0Bxx, 15xx, 25xx and 28xx are detected during the self diagnosis (Step 80) is added to the software of the version A12 and those later than A12. If the initialization will not proceed farther than the step 80 if retried, check around the scanner or the IMG07B board.
<Components related to the self diagnosis of the image input control (IMG)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, IMG07B board, SCN08A board, MMC90A/DIM08A boards, PMT08A board, scanning optics unit
[Step 60]:
CSL control subsystem (CSL) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the CSL control subsystem (CSL) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations (setting the ID information source, etc.). <Components related to the self diagnosis of the CSL control (CSL)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board
B
FR1B1620.EPS
C
FR1B1621.EPS
MD - 194
MD - 195
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 196
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 197
[Step 55]:
Image data control subsystem (DST) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the image data control subsystem (DST) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the image data control (DST)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, MMC90A/DIM08A boards
[Step 30]: DMS FINP input control subsystem (FIN) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the DMS FINP input control subsystem (FIN) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Checks whether the board necessary for network control is present, and takes countermeasures when an error is detected on the board. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the DMS FINP input control (FIN)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, MMC90A/DIM08A boards, HCP08A board, CPU90F/LAN90B/LAN90D boards
[Step 40]:
LP output control subsystem (LIF) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the LP output control subsystem (LIF) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Loads the format information and the exposure menu table from the HDD, and transfers the format information to the LP. Checks whether the board necessary for LP control is present, and takes countermeasures when an error is detected on the board. Self-diagnoses the IMG08A/B/H boards (image processing boards). Loads the DSP micro program. Monitors the connection/disconnection of the control line with/from the IDT and the timeout, and controls the display of the line conditions. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the LP output control (LIF)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, IMG08A/B/H boards, MMC90A/DIM08A boards
[Step 15]: DICOM output control subsystem (DOT) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the DICOM output control subsystem (DOT) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Checks whether the board necessary for network control is present, and takes countermeasures when an error is detected on the board. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the DICOM output control (DOT)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, MMC90A/DIM08A boards, HCP08A board, CPU90F/LAN90B/LAN90D boards
[Step 35]:
DMS E-IF control subsystem (DIF) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the DMS E-IF control subsystem (DIF) Acquires system information for controls at the startup and for the lines. Checks whether the board necessary for DMS control (DMC08A board) is present, and takes countermeasures when an error is detected during the initialization or on the board. Monitors the connection/disconnection of the control line with/from the IDT and the timeout, and controls the display of the line conditions. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the DMS E-IF control (DIF)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board, DMC08A board
[Step 5]: Image management system control subsystem (IMM) Initialization (self diagnosis) by the image management system control subsystem (IMM) Acquires system information necessary for subsystem operations. Checks control of the image data/ID information management. <Components related to the self diagnosis of the image management system control (IMM)> Application software, HDD, MTH08A/D boards, CPU90E board Termination of the initialization is executed
FR1B1623.EPS
D
FR1B1622.EPS
MD - 196
MD - 197
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 198
CONTENTS 11
12
MD - 199
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MD - 198
MD - 199
MT - 1
Control Sheet
Issue date
05/31/99 11/20/99 04/20/2001
Revision number 04 Reason Pages affected Corrections due to change in configuration All pages (FM2460) Corrections (FM2638) MT-3234, 49, 5153, 56, 64, 7072 Software update (FM3006) MT-3, 4, 69, 11, 12, 2226, 28, 29, 29.1, 29.2, 30, 31, 33, 33.1, 33.2, 34, 35, 44, 45, 51, 51.1, 51.2, 5760, 60.1, 60.2, 67.1, 67.2, 146, 195, 198216 Support for plus MT-26, 28, 44, 46, 52, 60, 60.1, (support for software version A14) 60.2, 6163, 70, 72, 179, 198216 (FM3115) Additions of error code listings, analysis All pages flows, and other information (FM3405) Detailed error code additions and MT-3121, 124, 126, 127, 129, corrections in compliance with a software 130, 159, 161, 195, 197, 199, 224, update, error code list corrections, circuit 228, 230, 245, 265, 269, 282, 287, diagram corrections, and typographical 288 error corrections (FM4275) Revision (FM4710) MT-4104, 104.1104.6, 268271, 274, 279, 280, 284, 285
05 06
08/30/2001
07
05/30/2002 03/20/2004
08 10
Troubleshooting (MT)
08/31/2005 11
MT - 1
CONTENTS
MT - 2
1.
Document Map
When the machine experiences any trouble, troubleshoot it based on error codes, abnormal images, abnormal phenomena, and so forth to take remedial measures as appropriate.
Trouble occurred
Check components
Image is abnormal
Operation is improper
2. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Error Codes "2.1 How to Understand Error Code" "2.2 Error Code List" "2.3 Format of Detail Information" "2.4 Troubleshooting Flows" "2.5 IP Jam Handling Procedures" "2.6 Check for IP Conveyance"
Component check flows "2.4.2 Cable Check Flow" "2.4.3 PC Board Check Flow" "2.4.4 HDD Check Flow" "2.4.5 Power Supply Unit Check Flow" "2.4.6 Monitor Check Flow"
3. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Abnormal Images "3.1 Troubleshooting for ScannerRelated Errors" "3.2 Image Troubleshooting for Controller" "3.3 Other Image Troubleshooting"
4. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Improper Operation "4.1 Remedy When Cassette Cannot be Removed" "4.2 Remedy When Machine Does Not Power Up" "4.3 Remedy When LED Is Not Lit" "4.4 Remedy When System Goes Down Unexpectedly during Operation" "4.5 Main Numerical Values Used for Troubleshooting"
MT - 2
CONTENTS
MT - 3
2.
2.1
03BC
[During initialization/normal processing] Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Although the MD1 turned ON, the SD1 failed to close, Error 03BC (MT-2.4.1). allowing the maximum retry count (ND51) to be exceeded. Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). <I/O name> Check the side-positioning conveyor MD1; Side-positioning motor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-8). SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-16.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-16.13). <Reference> MD-8.2.5
Indicates the reference volume abbreviation and section number.
D-5
XYZZ
Hexadecimal notation
The checks to be performed are listed in random order. Judge the target machine condition and change the order of checks as needed to begin by checking on the most probable error cause.
00-FF: Reference number according to error classification 0-9, A-F: Error classification 0-3: Error level
Y: Error classification X: Error level 0: OS (operating system software), CPU, library FATAL error: 0 1: Overall control, information gathering function, Error where the normal processing cannot be resumed. output destination control function It is necessary to troubleshoot and take remedial action immediately. 2: Panel control WARNING: 1, 2, 3 3: Conveyor-related control Errors where the processing may be resumed by performing retry 4: Image processing related (reading) operation, etc. 5: Scanner control This category includes an error that is merely logged as history information and an error where the processing is resumed but its error code is displayed 6: Image processing related (printer) 7: IDT interface control on screen. ZZ: Reference number Managed according to the error classification 8: Printer interface control 9: DMS interface control A: ID information setup function B: Network output image processing C: FINP control D: DICOM control E: Undefined F: Other (software install, version update, etc.)
FR1H1316.EPS
MT - 3
MT-4
Check the board insertion location (MC-17). [During initialization] Check for improper board setup (MC-17). The board insertion slot position was found to be abnormal when it was checked. Check the board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17).
[During initialization/normal processing] The ID information control system (IMM) was found to be abnormal. An error was detected because the software was directly updated from version A08 or earlier to version A13 or later.
Check for an improper software update (MU-16). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During initialization] An error was detected in the common data control system (CDM).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected in the image control system (IDM).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected in the HD image display area.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the CPU90F board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10). [During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when shared memory allocation was attempted for option Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). configuration. Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-4
MT-5
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a configuration file (NETMASKS).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Detail
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a configuration file (NETMASKS).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a configuration file (NETMASKS).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a configuration file (NETMASKS).
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-5
MT-6
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
A-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the settings contained in a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS).
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the settings contained in a configuration file (ROUTING/HOSTS ADDRESS).
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to update ID information.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-6
MT-7
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the format contained in a configuration file (EQUIPMENT). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During U-Utility mode] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to delete an image queued for Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). processing. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a subsystem (IPH) file on the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
D-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the data format of a subsystem (IPH) file on the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
D-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was found in the setting data contained in a subsystem (IPH) file on the Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). HDD. Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
D-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a subsystem (IPH) file Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). on the HDD. Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
D-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to initialize the FPMC device for the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
D-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-7
MT-8
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although a pulse motor drive request or stop request was issued, a timeout occurred because the target pulse motor could not be driven or stopped.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Detail
D-3
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to initialize the SNS device.
D-3
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to open, allowing the maximum retry count (NA11) to be exceeded.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.6.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03A2 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 did not open.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.2/8.5.5/8.5.11
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03A3 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the fuse (F10) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization] Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03A8/13A8 When the IP size was checked, the CLOSE time combination of the SA4/8/12/16, (MT-2.4.1). SB4, and SC1 did not agree with the IP size data stored in the machine. Check the IP and cassette. Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). <I/O name> Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). SA4/8/12/16; Mammo/ST sensor Check the SA4/8/12/16 (MC-4.7). SB4; Inch/metric sensor Check the SB4 (MC-5.4). SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). <Reference> Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). MD-8.2.5 (IP identification condition table)
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-8
MT-9
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization] When the machine was searched for IPs, the remaining IP process could not be Check the SA1/5/9/13 (MC-4.4). Check the SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.5). performed for one of the following reasons: Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). Check the cassette. Cassette detection was not achievable. The CMOS information was abnormal.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MC1/MD3 turned ON, the feed conveyance operation could not be performed for one of the following reasons: A timeout occurred because the SC1 failed to close. A timeout occurred because the SC1 failed to open. <I/O name> MC1/MD3; IP transport motor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.5
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B1 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the fuse (F11) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB2/MC1/MF1 turned ON, the SB2 failed to open. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. A retry operation was performed because the SB2 failed to close when the IP passed it.
<I/O name> MB2/MC1/MF1; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.10
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B2 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-9
MT-10
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD3 turned ON, the SD3 did not close after the SC1 closing. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> MD3; IP transport motor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor SD3; Side-positioning IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B3 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the SD3 (MC-8.4). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MD3/MC1/MB2 turned ON, the SB2 did not open.
<I/O name> MD3/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.6.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B4 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MD3/MC1/MB2 turned ON, the SB2 did not close.
<I/O name> MD3/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.6.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B5 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-10
MT-11
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization] G Although the MB2/MC1/MF1 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SB2 did not open or the SF1/SF2/SF3 did not close. The SC1/SF2/SF3 did not close. [During initialization] G Although the MB2/MC1 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SB2 did not open. The SB2 did not close. [During initialization] Although the SOLC1 and MB2/MC1/MF1 turned ON, the SB2 did not close.
[During initialization] Although the MB2/MC1/MD3 turned ON, the SB2 did not close and the SC1 did not open. [During initialization] G Although the ME2/MC1/MD3 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SB2 did not close. The SB2 did not open after closing. G An error was found in the CMOS information. <I/O name> MB2/MC1/MD3/ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor SF1/SF2/SF3; IP sensor SOLC1; Convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.3/8.5.4/8.5.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B6 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the SF1/2/3 (MC-11.3/11.4/11.5). Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-11
MT-12
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization] Although the MD3 and MZ1 turned ON to reverse for the purpose of moving the remaining IP in the before-reading conveyor, the SC1 did not close. When the MD3 turned ON for feed conveyance after the SC1 close, the SD3 did not close. Although the MD3 turned ON for feed conveyance to search for a remaining IP in the before-reading conveyor, the SD3 did not close. [During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB2/MC1/MD3 turned ON for feed conveyance to move the remaining IP in the before-reading conveyor, the SC1 did not open. When the MD3 turned ON for feed conveyance after the SC1 close, the SD3 did not close. <I/O name> MB2/MC1/MD3; IP transport motor MZ1; Subscanning motor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor SD3; Side-positioning IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B7 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the MZ1 (MC-10.8). Check the SD3 (MC-8.4). Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the SZ1 (MC-10.5). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B8/13B8 (MT-2.4.1). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset [During initialization] (MC-2.3). The machine's CMOS information (IP found) did not agree with the remaining IP Turn the power OFF and then back ON to achieve search result (no IP). automatic discharge, clear the backup memory, and then perform a reset (MC-2.3).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-12
MT-13
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization] Although the SOLC1 and MB2/MC1/MF1 turned ON, the SB2 did not close upon IP leading edge detection. The SB2 did not open upon IP trailing edge detection.
<I/O name> SOLC1; Convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid MB2/MC1/MF1; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B9 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SOLC1 (MC-6.4). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD1 turned ON, the SD1 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (ND51) to be exceeded.
03BC Side-positioning HP
operation error
<I/O name> MD1; Side-positioning motor SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03BC (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-13
MT-14
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD2 turned ON, the SD2 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (ND61) to be exceeded.
<I/O name> MD2; Grip release motor SD2; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03BF (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the MD2 (MU-11.2/MC-8.6). Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). Check the SD2 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the fuse (F9/F12). for the power supply (JPS-1). (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD3 turned ON, the SZ1 closed before the SD1 closing.
<I/O name> MD3; IP transport motor SZ1; IP leading edge sensor SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C0 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the SD3 (MC-8.4). Check the SZ1 (MC-10.5). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the IP. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-14
MT-15
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the MZ1 turned ON, the SD3 did not open. [During secondary erasure] Although the MZ1 and MD3/ME2 turned ON, the SD3 did not open.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> MZ1; Subscanning motor SD3; Side-positioning IP sensor MD3/ME2; IP transport motor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C1 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ1 (FFM) (MC-10.8). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the SD3 (MC-8.4). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the fuse (F3/F4) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MZ1 turned ON, the SZ1 did not close.
<I/O name> MZ1; Subscanning motor SZ1; IP leading edge sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C2 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the MZ1 (FFM) (MC-10.8). Check the SZ1 (MC-10.5). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MZ2 turned ON, the SZ2 did not open.
<I/O name> MZ2; Driving-shaft grip motor SZ2; Driving-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.2/8.5.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C6/ 03C8/03CA (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ2 (MU-11.2/MC-10.9). Check the SZ2 (MC-10.6). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the fuse (F2) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-15
MT-16
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MZ3 turned ON, the SZ3 did not open.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C7/ 03C9/03CB (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ3 (MU-11.2/MC-10.10). Check the SZ3 (MC-10.7). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Detail
<I/O name> MZ3; Driven-shaft grip motor SZ3; Driven-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.9
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MZ2 turned ON, the SZ2 did not close.
<I/O name> MZ2; Driving shaft grip motor SZ2; Driving-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C6/ 03C8/03CA (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ2 (MU-11.2/MC-10.9). Check the SZ2 (MC-10.6). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the fuse (F2) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MZ3 turned ON, the SZ3 failed to close.
<I/O name> MZ3; Driven-shaft grip motor SZ3; Driven-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.2/8.5.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C7/ 03C9/03CB (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ3 (MU-11.2/MC-10.10). Check the SZ3 (MC-10.7). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3).
D-5
[During initialization] Although the MZ2 turned ON, the SZ2 did not open. MZ2; Driving-shaft grip motor 03CA Drive shaft grip self-diagnosis SZ2; Driving-side grip release home position sensor <I/O name>
error
<Reference> MD-8.5.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C6/ 03C8/03CA (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ2 (MU-11.2/MC-10.9). Check the SZ2 (MC-10.6). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the fuse (F2) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-16
MT-17
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] Although the MZ3 turned ON, the SZ3 did not open.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> MZ3; Driven-shaft grip motor SZ3; Driven-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03C7/ 03C9/03CB (MT-2.4.1). Check the MZ3 (MU-11.2/MC-10.10). Check the SZ3 (MC-10.7). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the ME2/MF1 turned ON, the SF1 did not close.
<I/O name> ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SF1; After-reading conveyance standby IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D1 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the SF1 (MC-12.3). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/ MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the ME2/MF1 turned ON, the SF4 opened. The SF2 failed to open.
<I/O name> ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SF4; Overrun IP sensor SF2; Changeover IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D2 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the SF4 (MC-12.6). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-17
MT-18
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the MF1 turned ON, the SF2 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D3 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/ MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Detail
<I/O name> MF1; IP transport motor SF2; Changeover IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.9
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the SOLF1 and MF1 turned ON, the SF1 did not open. [During initialization] Although the SOLF1 and MF1 turned ON, the SF1 closed.
<I/O name> SOLF1; Branch path changeover guide driving solenoid MF1; IP transport motor SF1; After-reading conveyance standby IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.9/8.5.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D4 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SOLF1 (MU-11.3/MC-12.14). Check the SF1 (MC-12.3). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/ MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MF1 turned ON, the SF3 failed to close or the SF2 failed to open.
<I/O name> MF1; IP transport motor SF3; Load standby IP sensor SF2; Changeover IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D5 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the SF3 (MC-12.5). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-18
MT-19
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During normal processing] Although the SOLC1 and MF1/MC1/MB2 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SF3 failed to open and the SB2 closed after the SC2 opened. The SB2 failed to close after the SF3 opened.
<I/O name> SOLC1; Convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid MF1/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SF3; Load standby IP sensor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor SC2; Convergence standby IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D6 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLC1 (MC-6.4). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SF3 (MC-12.5). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLC1 and MF1/MC1/MB2 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SF3 failed to open and the SC2 failed to open. The SF3 failed to open and the SB2 failed to close after the SC2 opened.
<I/O name> SOLC1; Convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid MF1/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SF3; Load standby IP sensor SC2; Convergence standby IP sensor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.9
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D7 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLC1 (MC-6.4). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SF3 (MC-12.5). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the SC2 (MC-6.3). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-19
MT-20
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] Although the ME2/MF1 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SF4 failed to close. The SF2 failed to open after the overrun IP sensor (SF4) closed. <I/O name> ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SF4; Overrun IP sensor SF2; Changeover IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.3
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D8 (MT-2.4.1). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the SF4 (MC-12.6). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization] Although the SOLF1 and MF1 turned ON, the SF1 and SF3 failed to close. Although the MF1 turned ON, the SF3 failed to open. Although the MF1 turned ON, the SF3 failed to close after it opened.
<I/O name> SOLF1; Branch path changeover guide driving solenoid MF1; IP transport motor SF1; After-reading conveyance standby IP sensor SF3; Load standby IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03D9 (MT-2.4.1). Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SOLF1 (MU-11.3/MC-12.14). Check the SF1 (MC-12.3). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the SF3 (MC-12.5). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the ME1 turned ON, the SE1 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (ND61) to be exceeded.
<I/O name> ME1; Grip release motor SE1; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03DC (MT-2.4.1). Check the ME1 (MU-11.2/MC-11.3). Check the SE1 (MC-11.2). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-20
MT-21
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB3 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons:
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
The SA17 did not close. Although the SA17 closed, it did not open later in the descent sequence. <I/O name> MB3; Up-down drive motor SA17; Elevation home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.3
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03DD (MT-2.4.1). Check the MB3 (MU-11.2/MC-5.11). Check the SA17 (MC-4.9). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB3 turned ON, an abnormal termination occurred for one of the following reasons: The SB3 failed to close. Although the MB3 turned ON, the SB3 failed to open after closing. Although the MB3 turned ON, the SB3 failed to close after it opened. The SB3 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (NB100/101) to be exceeded. <I/O name> MB3; Up-down drive motor SB3; Each shelf position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.3/8.2.8 Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03DE (MT-2.4.1). Check the MB3 (MU-11.2/MC-5.11). Check the SB3 (MC-5.3). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 turned ON for suction cup home positioning, the SB1 failed to Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03E8 (MT-2.4.1). close, allowing the maximum retry count (NB51) to be exceeded. Check the MB1 (MU-11.2/MC-5.9). Check the SB1 (MC-5.1). <I/O name> Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism MB1; Suction cup drive motor (MD-7.2/MC-5). SB1; Suction cup home position sensor Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). <Reference> MD-8.2.3
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-21
MT-22
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a subsystem file (IMG).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Detail
E-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a subsystem file (IMG).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
E-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the settings contained in a subsystem file (IMG).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
E-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a subsystem file (IMG).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
E-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to initialize the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5).
E-2
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5).
E-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-22
MT-23
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to boot a micro program for the DSP4 device (IMG07B board) from the HDD.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
E-2
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
E-2
[During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5).
E-2
[During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5).
E-2
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write into the DSP4 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5). (IMG07B board).
E-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read the DSP4 device (IMG07B board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5).
E-2
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5). Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). [During normal processing] Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). An image processing error was found in the DSP4 device (IMG07B board) when Check the cable (MT-2.4.2). image data was being read from the scanner. Check the fuse (F3/F4) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the MZ1/MZ2/MZ3 (MC-10.8/MC-10.9/MC-10.10). Check the MD1/MD2/MD3 (MC-8.5/MC-8.6/MC-8.7).
E-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-23
MT-24
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG07B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.5). Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the cable (MT-2.4.2). Check the fuse (F3/F4) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the MZ1/MZ2/MZ3 (MC-10.8/MC-10.9/MC-10.10). Check the MD1/MD2/MD3 (MC-8.5/MC-8.6/MC-8.7).
Detail
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP4 device (IMG07B board) after an image data read from the scanner.
E-2
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DMA device (CPU90E board).
E-5
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data from the scanner to the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
E-5
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to DMA-transfer 24 x 30 mammographic image data for rotation.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
E-5
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). [During normal processing] Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). An error was detected when an attempt was made to write read image data from Check the MTH08A/D board version the MMC90A/DIM08A board onto the HDD. (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-24
MT-25
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). [During normal processing] Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). An error was detected when an attempt was made to write monitored image data Check the MTH08A/D board version from the MMC90A/DIM08A board onto the HDD. (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write EDR-reduced image data from the MMC90A/DIM08A board onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write ID information from the MMC90A/DIM08A board onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a file that was opened in the read image write mode.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-25
MT-26
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
Detail
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a file that was opened in the read mode.
E-6
[During U-Utility mode] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During U-Utility mode] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write ID information.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During U-Utility mode] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a monitored image.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-26
MT-27
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Output the stored image data. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). [During normal processing] Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). An error was detected when an attempt was made to open an image data file for Check the MTH08A/D board version the purpose of retrying an image data write onto the HDD. (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-4
[During reoutput] When an attempt was made to reoutput an image, an error was detected because U-Utility's image lock or unlock setup was abnormal.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the MTH08A/D board version (MTH08A: Version E or later; MTH08D: Version B or later) Check the version of the application software (version A21 or later).
E-6
[During initialization] A polygon motor lock signal error was detected when the polygon status was checked upon laser power ON.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[During initialization] An error was detected when the laser status was checked.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
E-3
[During initialization] An analog power supply voltage error was found on the PMT08A board.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20).
E-3
[During initialization] An error was detected when the start point detection status was checked.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SYN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-9.6). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-27
MT-28
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). [During initialization] Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply The IP leading edge detection signal was found to be abnormal when the leading (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). edge detection status was checked. Check the SZ1 (SED08A board) (MC-10.5). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[During normal processing] An image quit interrupt was not executed within the specified time.
<Reference> MD-8.2.7
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the SYN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-9.6). Check the CPU90F board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
E-3
[During initialization] An error was found in the configuration settings (EQUIPMENT/HOSTS ADDRESS).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a subsystem file (LIF).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a subsystem file (LIF).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-1
[During initialization] An error was found in the settings contained in a subsystem file (LIF).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-28
MT-29
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). MMC90A/DIM08A board. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read an image file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-2
[During normal processing (film reoutput)] An error was found in the HDD format information. The format information about the battery backup memory was found to be abnormal.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
I-3
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the combination of IP read size and format information was checked.
I-4
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a device driver (DMA).
I-5
[During normal processing] A DMA image transfer to the IMG board failed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-5
[During initialization] An error was detected when memory area allocation was attempted.
I-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-29
MT-30
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP10 device (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP10 (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP10 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP10 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP10 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). (IMG08A board).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP10 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP10 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-30
MT-31
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP11 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). (IMG08A board).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP11 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-31
MT-32
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP20 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP20 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-32
MT-33
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP21 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-33
MT-34
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP21 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-34
MT-35
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP22 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP22 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-35
MT-36
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
I-7 Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP30 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP30 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-36
MT-37
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
Detail
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP31 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP31 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-37
MT-38
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
Detail
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP32 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP32 device Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-38
MT-39
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a micro program into the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data into the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data from the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP23 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During initialization] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP23 device Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). (IMG08B/H board). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-39
MT-40
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to load ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). CPU memory (CPU90E board). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to perform a memory write into the DSP0 device (DMC08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
[During normal processing] 0934 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP application startup) was 1 performed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] 0935 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP application execution) was
performed.
[During normal processing] 0936 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP command cancel) was
performed.
[During normal processing] A DMC08A board error was detected when a DMA transfer was performed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-40
MT-41
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write ID information onto the HDD.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the CPU90E board issued an instruction for writing image data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
[During normal processing] 0954 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP application startup) was 1 performed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] 0955 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP application execution) was
performed.
[During normal processing] 0956 DSP0 image processing error An error was detected when an image process (DSP command cancel) was
performed.
[During normal processing] A DMC08A board error was detected when a DMA transfer was performed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-41
MT-42
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to initialize the DSP device (CPU90E board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4).
Detail
C
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a dspLoad micro program into the DMC08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the output DMA device (CPU90E board).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the input DMA device Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). (CPU90E board).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSP device (CPU90E board).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a dspLoad micro program file into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a dspWrite micro program file into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to load a dspWrite micro program into the DMC08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-42
MT-43
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a file.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Detail
K-1
[During initialization] A format error was found in a file that was read into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
K-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
K-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
K-1
[During initialization] It was found that the type A and type B online connection options are both enabled (option setting inconsistency).
Uninstall the soft key file (FD) for the connection type irrelevant to the installation site (IN-A6).
K-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open an image data file.
L-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). MMC90A/DIM08A board. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write ID information onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-43
MT-44
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
L-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DSPH device (HCP08A board).
L-2
0B11 DSPH micro program file open error 0B12 DSPH micro program read
error
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a DSPH micro program file on the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
L-3
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a DSPH micro program into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-3
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to boot a micro program for the DSPH device (HCP08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-44
MT-45
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to perform a DSPH memory write into the DSPH device (HCP08A board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9).
Detail
L-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to perform a DSPH memory load into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9).
L-2
[During initialization] An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSPH device (HCP08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9).
L-2
[During initialization] An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSPH device (HCP08A board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9).
L-2
[During normal processing] An error was found in a compression/decompression process. A timeout occurred because image data could not be read from the HDD. An image data communication was aborted.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-2
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DMA device (CPU90E board).
L-4
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the HCP08A board. An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
L-4
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DMA device (CPU90E board).
M-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-45
MT-46
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90F board/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/ MC-17.10/MC-17.11). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the CPU90F/LAN90B board.
M-1
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). CPU memory (CPU90E board). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DMA device (CPU90E board).
M-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90F board/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/ MC-17.10/MC-17.11). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-1
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write ID information onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-46
MT-47
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open an image data file.
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write image data onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a received input image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). CPU memory (CPU90E board). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to update the ID information delivered to the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
M-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read image data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). [During normal processing] Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read ID information into the Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). CPU memory (CPU90E board). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-47
MT-48
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
Detail
D
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read EDR data into the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an EDR data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open the DMA device driver.
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the CPU90F board/LAN90B board. An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer image data to the MMC90A/DIM08A board.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] The DICOM transmission process for the LAN board could not be continued.
G-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a subsystem file (DOT).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-48
MT-49
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a file into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Detail
[During initialization] A format error was found in a file that was loaded into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During initialization] An error was found in the settings contained in a configuration file (SYSTEM).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
J+
[During normal processing] A timeout was found in an image file access. A timeout was detected in the HDD's read/write response.
e-6
[During normal processing] A timeout was found in an image file access. A timeout was detected in the HDD's read/write response.
e-6
[During normal processing] A timeout was found in an image file access. A timeout was detected in the HDD's read/write response.
e-6
[During initialization] An error was found in the format data about the HDD image area.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During normal processing] The image data area on the HDD at the output destination device became full.
D-4
[ 2.2 ]
MT-49
MT-50
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close an image data file.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
Detail
D-4
[During initialization/normal processing] Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13A1 Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to close, allowing (MT-2.4.1). the maximum retry count (NA12) to be exceeded. Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.5). <I/O name> Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). <Reference> Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). MD-8.2.2/8.5.4
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to open, allowing the maximum retry count (NA11) to be exceeded.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13A2 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the fuse (F10) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to open, allowing the maximum retry count (NA11) to be exceeded. Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (NA12) to be exceeded. <I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.5.5/8.5.11
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13A3 (MT-2.4.1). Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-50
MT-51
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the cassette was set in position, the SA2/6/10/14 did not close. <I/O name> SA2/6/10/14; Cassette IN sensor
Probable Cause/Remedy
Check the SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.5). Check the SA3/7/11/15 (MC-4.6). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Detail
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA2/6/10/14 opened.
Check the SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.5). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF upon cassette loading, the SA1/5/9/13 failed to close and the SA2/6/10/14 failed to close.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA1/5/9/13; Cassette ejection sensor SA2/6/10/14; Cassette IN sensor
Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA1/5/9/13 and SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.4/MC-4.5). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA1/5/9/13 failed to close and the SA2/6/10/14 failed to close.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA1/5/9/13; Cassette ejection sensor SA2/6/10/14; Cassette IN sensor
Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA1/5/9/13 and SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.4/MC-4.5). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-51
MT-52
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] When the IP size was checked, the CLOSE time combination of the SA4/8/12/16, SB4, and SC1 did not agree with the IP size data stored in the machine. Although the IP size was recognized as "8" x 10" ST", the barcode information indicated "HR". <I/O name> SA4/8/12/16; Mammo/ST sensor SB4; Inch/metric sensor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.5/8.2.6
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03A8/13A8 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP and cassette. Check the MC1 (MU-11.2/MC-6.5). Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the SA4/8/12/16 (MC-4.7). Check the SB4 (MC-5.4). Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the barcode reader (BCR) turned ON to read the IP's barcode information, it failed to read the barcode information, allowing the maximum retry count (ND31) to be exceeded. The barcode reader (BCR) installed in the machine was influenced by external irradiation noise. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13A9 (MT-2.4.1). Check the BCR (MU-11.4/MC-8.8). Check the IP. Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the cable connection between the SNS08A board (CN22) and the BCR, and attachment of the ferrite core. Check the cable routing between the SNS08A board (CN23) and the CPU90E board (CN11).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] It was found that the LAMP1/2/3/4/5 were not properly illuminated. The power of the machine is turned ON within less than 30 seconds after the power was turned OFF. If the power of the machine is turned OFF, voltage of 24 V starts to drop. Since the power is turned ON while the voltage is dropping, the current underconsumption detection circuit activates, preventing the voltage of 24V from being supplied. <I/O name> LAMP1/2/3/4/5; Erasure lamps <Reference> MD-8.210
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AA/23AA (MT-2.4.1). Check the LAMP1/2/3/4/5 (MU-9.1/MC-12.8). Check the fuse (F5) for the power supply (JPS-1). (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.2). Check the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MC-13.1). Check the FANF1 (MC-12.10). Check the TSW1 (MC-12.9). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Turn ON the power more than 30 seconds later after the machine power is turned OFF.
D-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-52
MT-53
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] It was found that the IP dosage was higher than 400 mR. <Reference> MD-8.2.10
Probable Cause/Remedy
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AB (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the exposure conditions. Check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20). Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19).
Detail
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the IDT was asked about the ID formation of the IP, it was not registered. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AC (MT-2.4.1). Check the ID information. Check the external device (IDT).
D-5
[During normal processing] It was found that the barcode information about the IP did not agree with the IP type data stored in the machine. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AD (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the IP's barcode label. Check the BCR (MU-11.4/MC-8.8).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although an attempt was made to perform an image recording process in accordance with ID information, no relevant image recording process condition (MPM code) was found in the machine. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AE (MT-2.4.1). Check the image recording process condition setup.
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the IDT was called, the IDT did not respond. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13AF (MT-2.4.1). Check the external device (IDT). Check the CPU90F board/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/ MC-17.10/MC-17.11).
D-5
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 03B8/13B8 [During initialization] (MT-2.4.1). The machine's CMOS information (IP found) did not agree with the remaining IP Clear the backup memory and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). search result (no IP). Turn the power OFF and then back ON to achieve Automatic discharge, clear the backup memory, <Reference> and then perform a reset (MC-2.3). MD-8.5.4/8.5.6
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-53
MT-54
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB1 and PB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (NB11) to be exceeded.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13E1 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the PB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.6). Check the SB5 (MC-5.5). Check the suction cups and hose (MC-5.8/PM-3.9/PM-3.10). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Detail
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor PB1; IP suction pump SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.4/8.4.2
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB2 turned ON after feed-IP suction, the SB5 failed to close.
<I/O name> MB2; IP transport motor SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.4/8.4.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13E2/13E5 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the SVB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.7). Check the PB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.6). Check the SB5 (MC-5.5). Check the suction cups and hose (MC-5.8/PM-3.9/PM-3.10). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB2 turned ON after feed-IP suction, the SB2 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB2; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.4/8.4.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13E3 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the MB1 (MU-11.2/MC-5.9). Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-54
MT-55
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 and PB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close, allowing the maximum retry count (NB11) to be exceeded.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor PB1; IP suction pump SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.10/8.4.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13E4 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the PB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.6). Check the SB5 (MC-5.5). Check the suction cups and hose (MC-5.8/PM-3.9/PM-3.10). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close.
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.10/8.4.2
Perform the troubleshooting procedure for Error 13E2/ 13E5 (MT-2.4.1). Check the IP. Check the SB5 (MC-5.5). Check the PB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.6). Check the SVB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.7). Check the suction cups and hose (MC-5.8/PM-3.9/3.10). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the PB1 turned OFF and the SVB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to open. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> PB1; IP suction DC pump SVB1; IP suction relief solenoid valve SB5; Suction sensor
Check the SVB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.7). Check the PB1 (MU-11.3/MC-5.6). Check the SB5 (MC-5.5). Check the suction cups and hose (MC-5.8/PM-3.9/3.10). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] It was found that the image reading parameter menu was not registered for the IDT.
[During initialization] An abnormality was detected when the laser status was checked.
E-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-55
MT-56
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An image output request was rejected because the HDD in the external device was full.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Output the image data that is stored on the HDD in the external device (DMS).
Detail
F
[During normal processing] An image output request was rejected because the OD in the external device was full.
[During normal processing] The DMS's image output request was rejected because the ODF did not have an Insert an OD into the ODF. OD for filing.
[During normal processing] Although a DMS output request was received while the DMC08A board was not mounted, no DMS output could be generated.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
Check the CPU90F board/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/ MC-17.10/MC-17.11). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2).
F+
C+
B+
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-56
MT-57
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write into a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write into a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-57
MT-58
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] It was found that the management information in the HDD image area was damaged.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
e-1 Format the image area of the HDD (MU-12.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization] Abnormal image management information was detected when an attempt was made to load the backup of HDD image management information.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: e-2 Format the image area of the HDD (MU-12.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During initialization/M-Utility mode] A HDD access error was detected when an attempt was made to reformat the HDD image area.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
e-1
[During initialization] The shared memory was found to be insufficient when the optional functionality was checked.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: e-3 Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the configuration of installed boards.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] A HDD access error was detected when an attempt was made to read the format Format the image area of the HDD (MU-12.2). information or image management information in the HDD image region. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
e-4
[ 2.2 ]
MT-58
MT-59
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the IMG08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.6). Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2).
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when the incorporated optional functions were checked.
e-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an image file was accessed. A HDD reset was performed.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
e-5
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A SCSI reset error or HDD reset error was detected.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
e-6
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] The maximum retry count for image file access was exceeded. An error was found in a request for HDD access.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
e-5
[During normal processing] The image data file backed up in the HDD was to be accessed, but timeout was detected. The reset signal was reset in the IO port and the CBC was reset. * CBC refers to the data controller LSI mounted on the MTH08 board.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4) Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). e-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-59
MT-60
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a configuration file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/ MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was found in the setting data in a configuration file.
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write into a configuration file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-60
MT-61
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a configuration file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open an image processing Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). parameter file. Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of an image processing parameter file. An error was detected because the software was directly updated from version A08 or earlier to version A13 or later.
Check for an improper software update (MU-16). Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was found in the setting data in an image processing parameter file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected and therefore replaced by the default value.
A-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-61
MT-62
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected but could not be replaced by the default value.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
A-2
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected and therefore replaced by the default value.
A-2
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (DMS).
A-3
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected but could not be replaced by the default value.
A-4
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected and therefore replaced by the default value.
A-5
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected and therefore replaced by the default value.
A-6
[During normal processing] When image ID information was set up, an illegal value was detected but could not be replaced by the default value.
A-6
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During a software update process] Files could not be written onto the HDD.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-62
MT-63
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a configuration file (REMOTE SWITCH).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a configuration file (REMOTE SWITCH).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a configuration file (REMOTE SWITCH).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a configuration file (REMOTE SWITCH).
Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] Check the configuration settings (MU-7). An error was found in the setting data in a configuration file (REMOTE SWITCH). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-63
MT-64
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] When the PC boards were checked, the MTH08A/D board was found to be abnormal.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
F Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4).
[During initialization] When the PC boards were checked, the SCN08A board was found to be abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). F
[During initialization] When the PC boards were checked, the SNS08A board was found to be abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). F
[During initialization] When the PC boards were checked, the HCP08A board was found to be abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the HCP08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.9). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). F
[During initialization] When the PC boards were checked, the SCN08A board was found to be abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). F
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: [During normal processing] An error was found in the setting data in a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS). Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
DST-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-64
MT-65
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An error was found in the setting data in a configuration file (NETWORK HOST INTERFACE).
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
Detail
DST-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: [During normal processing] An error was found in the setting data in a configuration file (HOSTS ADDRESS). Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
DST-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a core dump file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1+
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write abnormality information into a core dump file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). A-1+
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a core dump file after Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). abnormality information was written into it. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1+
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During the power OFF sequence] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a trace data file.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1+
[ 2.2 ]
MT-65
MT-66
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During the power OFF sequence] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write trace data into a trace Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). data file. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1+
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During the power OFF sequence] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a trace data file after Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). trace data was written into it. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1+
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.2/8.5.4/8.5.5
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13A1.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to open. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.2/8.5.5/8.5.11/8.6.2
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03A2/13A2.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-66
MT-67
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned ON, the SA3/7/11/15 failed to open, allowing the maximum retry count (NA11) to be exceeded. Therefore, the use of the affected cassette shelf was suspended by the user.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA3/7/11/15; Cassette hold sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.2
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03A3/13A3.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] When the IP size was checked, the CLOSE time combination of the SA4/8/12/16, SB4, and SC1 did not agree with the IP size data stored in the machine.
<I/O name> SA4/8/12/16; Mammo/ST sensor SB4; Inch/metric sensor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03A8/13A8.
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the barcode reader (BCR) turned ON to read the IP's barcode information, it failed to read the barcode information. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. The barcode reader (BCR) installed in the machine was influenced by external irradiation noise. <Reference> MD-8.2.6
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13A9.
D-5
[During initialization] It was found that the LAMP1/2/3/4/5 were not properly illuminated. The power of the machine is turned ON within less than 30 seconds after the power was turned OFF. If the power of the machine is turned OFF, voltage of 24 V starts to drop. Since the power is turned ON while the voltage is dropping, the current underconsumption detection circuit activates, preventing the voltage of 24V from being supplied. <I/O name> LAMP1/2/3/4/5; Erasure lamps
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13AA.
D-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-67
MT-68
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MC1/MD3 turned ON, the SC1 failed to close after the SB2 closed. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> MC1/MD3; IP transport motor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03B1.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB2/MC1/MF1 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons: The SB2 failed to close.
The SB2 failed to open. Although the SB2 opened, the MB2 did not stop normally. <I/O name> MB2/MC1/MF1; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03B2.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD3 turned ON, the SD3 failed to close after the SC1 closed. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. <I/O name> MD3; IP transport motor SD3; Side-positioning IP sensor SC1; Before-BCR IP sensor If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03B3. D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-68
MT-69
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD1 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons: The SD1 failed to close. Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
The SD1 closed. The MD1 was then returned to the phase origin and turned ON by a predetermined number of pulses (PD54). However, the SD1 failed to close after side-positioning motor ON. <I/O name> MD1; Side-positioning motor SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.6
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD1 turned ON to prepare for side-positioning mechanism home Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). positioning, the SD1 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism <I/O name> (MD-7.4/MC-8). MD1; Side-positioning motor Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). <Reference> MD-8.2.6
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MD1 turned ON, the SD1 failed to close.
<I/O name> MD1; Side-positioning motor SD1; Side-positioning mechanism home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.6/8.4.3
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03BC.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-69
MT-70
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD1 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons: The SD2 failed to close. Check the MD1 (MU-11.2/MC-8.5). Check the MD2 (MU-11.2/MC-8.6). Check the SD1 (MC-8.2). Check the SD2 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
Although the MD2 turned ON after the SD2 closed, the SD2 failed to close. <I/O name> MD1; Side-positioning motor SD2; Grip release home position sensor MD2; Grip release motor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MD2 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons: The SD2 failed to close. Check the MD2 (MU-11.2/MC-8.6). Check the SD2 (MC-8.2). Check the side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.4/MC-8). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
The SD2 failed to open. <I/O name> MD2; Grip release motor SD2; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MD2 turned ON, the SD2 failed to close.
<I/O name> MD2; Grip release motor SD2; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03BF.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-70
MT-71
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During normal processing] When the SNS08A board checked the drive status of the MZ1, the motor rotating speed signal was found to be abnormal. Check the MZ1 (MC-10.8). Check the subscanning unit mechanism (MD-7.5/MC-10). <I/O name> Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). MZ1; Subscanning motor Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). <Reference> MD-8.2.7
D-5
[During normal processing] The elapsed time between the instant at which the MZ2 turned ON and the instant at which the SZ2 opened was not as specified.
<I/O name> MZ2; Drive shaft grip motor SZ2; Drive-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.9
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03C6.
D-5
[During normal processing] The elapsed time between the instant at which the MZ3 turned ON and the instant at which the SZ3 opened was not as specified.
<I/O name> MZ3; Driven shaft grip motor SZ3; Driven-side grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7/8.3.3/8.5.9
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03C7.
D-5
[During initialization] When the driving shaft grip operation was subjected to self-diagnosis, a grip drive speed correction error was found.
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03C8.
D-5
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error When the driven shaft grip operation was subjected to self-diagnosis, a grip drive 03C9. speed correction error was found.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-71
MT-72
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the ME2/MF1 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons:
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
The SF4 failed to close and the SF2 failed to open. The SF4 opened. <I/O name> ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SF4; Overrun IP sensor SF2; Changeover IP sensor
Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the ME2 (MU-11.2/MC-11.4). Check the SF4 (MC-12.6). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] When the ME2/MF1 turned ON, the SF1 closed and then the SF2 opened. However, when the ME2/MF1 turned OFF later, the SF4 failed to close.
<I/O name> ME2/MF1; IP transport motor SF1; After-reading conveyor standby IP sensor SF2; Changeover IP sensor SF4; Overrun IP sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03D2.
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MF1 turned ON, the SF2 failed to close. <I/O name> MF1; IP transport motor SF2; Changeover IP sensor If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03D3. D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-72
MT-73
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the SOLC1 and MF1/MC1/MB2 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons:
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
The SF3 failed to open. Further, the SB2 closed after the SC2 opened. Although the SF3 opened, the SB2 failed to close. <I/O name> SOLC1; Convergence path changeover guide driving solenoid MF1/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SF3; Load standby IP sensor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor SC2; Grip release home position sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03D6.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the ME1 turned ON, the SE1 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> ME1; Grip release motor SE1; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
Check the ME1 (MU-11.2/MC-11.3). Check the SE1 (MC-11.2). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the ME1 turned ON, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons: The SE1 failed to close. Check the ME1 (MU-11.2/MC-11.3). Check the SE1 (MC-11.2). Check the SD2 (MC-8.2). Check the after-reading conveyor mechanism (MD-7.6/MC-11). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
The SD2 failed to open. <I/O name> ME1; Grip release motor SD2/SE1; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-73
MT-74
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the ME1 turned ON, the SE1 failed to close.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
<I/O name> ME1; Grip release motor SE1; Grip release home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.7
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03DC.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the MB3 turned ON, the SB3 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB3; Up-down drive motor SB3; Each shelf position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.3/8.2.8
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03DE.
D-5
[During normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB1 and PB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor PB1; IP suction pump SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.4/8.4.2
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E1.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-74
MT-75
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB2 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. <I/O name> MB2; IP transport motor SB5; Suction sensor
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E2.
D-5
[During normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the MB2 turned ON, after feed-IP suction, the SB2 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. <I/O name> MB2; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E3.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 and PB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor PB1; IP suction pump SB5; Suction sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.10/8.4.2
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E4.
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 and PB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor PB1; IP suction pump SB5; Suction sensor
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E5.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-75
MT-76
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 turned ON, to achieve suction cup home positioning, a retry operation was performed for one of the following reasons:
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
The SB1 failed to close. The SB1 failed to open. <I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor SB1; Suction cup home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.3
Check the MB1 (MU-11.2/MC-5.9). Check the SB1 (MC-5.1). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 turned ON, the SB1 failed to close. Therefore, a retry operation was performed.
<I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor SB1; Suction cup home position sensor <Reference> MD-8.2.3
Check the MB1 (MU-11.2/MC-5.9). Check the SB1 (MC-5.1). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During initialization/normal processing/abnormality processing] Although the MB1 turned ON, the SB1 failed to close. [During initialization/normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the PB1 and SVB1 turned ON, the SB1 failed to close. [During initialization/normal processing] After the elevation unit was allowed to move for IP loading, the SB1 failed to close. <I/O name> MB1; Suction cup drive motor SB1; Suction cup home position sensor PB1; IP suction pump SVB1; IP suction relief solenoid valve <Reference> MD-8.2.3/8.2.4/8.2.8/8.2.10/8.4.2/8.5.3
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 03E8.
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-76
MT-77
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing/M-Utility mode] Although the SVB1 turned ON, the SB5 failed to open. Therefore, a retry operation was performed. <I/O name> SVB1; IP suction relief solenoid valve SB5; Suction sensor
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 13E9.
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA1/5/9/13 opened. <I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA1/5/9/13; Cassette ejection sensor
Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA1/5/9/13 and SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.4/MC-4.5). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the SOLA1/2/3/4 turned OFF, the SA1/5/9/13 opened. <I/O name> SOLA1/2/3/4; Cassette hold solenoid SA1/5/9/13; Cassette ejection sensor
Check the SOLA1/2/3/4 (MC-4.8). Check the SA1/5/9/13 and SA2/6/10/14 (MC-4.4/MC-4.5). Check the cassette set unit mechanism (MC-4). Check the cassette. Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MD3 turned ON, the SC1 failed to close.
Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the SC1 (MC-6.2). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[During normal processing] Although the MD3 turned ON, the SD3 failed to close. <I/O name> MD3; IP transport motor SD3; Side-positioning IP sensor
Check the MD3 (MU-11.2/MC-8.7). Check the SD3 (MC-6.2). Check the before-side-positioning conveyor mechanism (MD-7.3/MC-6). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
D-5
[ 2.2 ]
MT-77
MT-78
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] Although the MF1/ME2 turned ON, one of the following situations was detected: The SF2 failed to open. Check the MF1 (MU-11.2/MC-12.7). Check the SF2 (MC-12.4). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Detail
D-5
<I/O name> MF1/ME2; IP transport motor SF2; Changeover IP sensor SF4; Overrun IP sensor
[During normal processing] Although the MF1/MC1/MB2 turned ON, one of the following situations was detected: The SB2 failed to close. Check the MB2 (MU-11.2/MC-5.10). Check the SB2 (MC-5.2). Check the up-down IP removal unit mechanism (MD-7.2/MC-5). Check the erasure conveyor mechanism (MD-7.7/MC-12). Check the DRV08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.12). Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
The SB2 failed to open. [During normal processing] When the MF1/MC1 turned OFF, the MB2 did not turn OFF. <I/O name> MF1/MC1/MB2; IP transport motor SB2; Cassette inlet IP sensor
D-5
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: D-2 Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13.1).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-78
MT-79
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During U-Utility mode] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a file (CRT test pattern display or like file).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
E-1
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a subsystem file (IMG).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0403.
E-1
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP4 device (IMG07B board) after image data was read from the scanner.
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0423.
E-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer the EDR backup data about a read image.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the IP address (MU-7.2).
E-4
[During normal processing] A connection establishment error was detected when an attempt was made to transfer the EDR backup data about a read image.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the IP address (MU-7.2). E-7
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] A connection error was detected while the EDR backup data about a read image Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ was being transferred. MC-17.11). Check the connected device.
E-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-79
MT-80
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
[During normal processing] If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, Although the barcode information and menu were entered via the IDT in use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: accordance with the message after the image was read without being registered via the IDT, no associated menu was found in the image reader. Therefore, the Upload (IDT Utility) the menu into the image reader. menu code was replaced with the default one.
E-8
[During error handling] Image data was to be written into the HDD, but a data write error occurs, resulting in shutdown of the system. ID information and EDR data were to be backed up in the HDD DOS region, but a file open error occurs.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4) Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). E-1
[During error handling] Image data was to be written into the HDD, but a data write error occurs, resulting in shutdown of the system. ID information and EDR data were to be backed up in the HDD DOS region, but a data write error occurs.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4) Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). E-1
[During error handling] Image data was to be written into the HDD, but a data write error occurs, resulting in shutdown of the system. The machine was restarted after the system shutdown, and ID information, EDR data or the like backed up in the HDD DOS region were to be read, but a file open error occurs.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4) Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). E-1
[During error handling] Image data was to be written into the HDD, but a data write error occurs, resulting in shutdown of the system. The machine was restarted after the system shutdown, and ID information, EDR data or the like backed up in the HDD DOS region were to be read, but a data read error occurs.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4) Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the MMC90A/DIM08A board (MT-2.4.3/IN-6.3.2). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). E-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-80
MT-81
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During scanner self-diagnosis] It was found that a leading-edge detection interrupt could not be initiated.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the fuse (F1) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SZ1 (SED08A board) (MC-10.5).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During scanner self-diagnosis] It was found that an end-of-screen interrupt could not be initiated. Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the CPU90F board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] When the HV voltage status was checked, the output voltage of the high-voltage Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the fuse (F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) power supply was found to be abnormal. (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). When the polygon status was checked, the lock signal for the polygon motor was Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). found to be abnormal. Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-81
MT-82
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: E-3 Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
Detail
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the laser power status was checked.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the laser status was checked.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] When the HV voltage status was checked, the output voltage of the high-voltage Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the fuse (F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) power supply was found to be abnormal. (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An analog power supply voltage error was found on the PMT08A board.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20).
E-3
[ 2.2 ]
MT-82
MT-83
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the start-point detection status was checked.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SYN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-9.6). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout was detected when the leading-edge detection status was checked.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SZ1 (SED08 board) (MC-10.5). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[During normal processing] Although an image quit interrupt was executed, a timeout occurred.
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0549.
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Do not use the IP that was found to be overexposed. Use a new IP to make an exposure at an appropriate dosage setting. The overexposed IP must be allowed to stand for about 16 hours and then subjected to a primary erasure process. If the same error (overexposure detection) occurs during the use of an IP exposed to an appropriate radiation dose, check the PMT08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.20).
[During normal processing] An overexposure (dosage of higher than 400 mR) was detected.
E-9
[ 2.2 ]
MT-83
MT-84
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During image read error occurrence] When the polygon status was checked in the event of an image read error, the lock signal for the polygon motor was found to be abnormal.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
[During initialization] An abnormality was detected when the laser status was checked.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: E-3 Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During image read error occurrence] An abnormality was detected when the laser status was checked in the event of an image read error.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
E-3
[During normal processing] The laser status was found to be abnormal when it was checked before image reading.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: E-3 Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-84
MT-85
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During normal processing] The laser status was found to be abnormal when it was checked before image reading.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F6) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the LD assembly (MC-9.4).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During image read error occurrence] An abnormality was detected when the start-point detection status was checked in the event of an image read error.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SYN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-9.6). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During image read error occurrence] The IP leading-edge detection signal was found to be abnormal when the leading-edge detection status was checked in the event of an image read error.
Check the SCN08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.19). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the fuse (F1/F6/F7/F8) for the power supply (JPS-1) (MT-2.4.5/MT-6/MC-13). Check the SZ1 (SED08 board) (MC-10.5). Check the polygon assembly (MC-9.5).
E-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: F Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the external device (IDT).
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when a line test was conducted.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-85
MT-86
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to access (open/write/close) a Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). device driver (SMCU) file. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the external device (IDT). Check the network-connected equipment.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing (ID deletion mode)] An error was detected when an attempt was made to establish the connection with the IDT.
Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the external device (IDT). Check the network-connected equipment.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing (IDT-Utility mode)] An error was detected when an attempt was made to establish the connection with the IDT.
Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the external device (IDT).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-86
MT-87
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ An error was detected when an attempt was made to establish the connection for MC-17.11). command reception. Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the external device (IDT). Check the network-connected equipment.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a subsystem file (IIF). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] An error was found in the format of a subsystem file (IIF).
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). An error was detected when an attempt was made to write a subsystem file (IIF). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). An error was detected when an attempt was made to read a subsystem file (IIF). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-87
MT-88
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a subsystem file (IIF). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HDD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] An error was found in the checksum on an image processing parameter file. Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16). A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] An error was found in the format of an image processing parameter file. Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16). A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] An error was found in the setting data in an image processing parameter file. Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16). A-1
[During initialization] When a line test was conducted, it was found that the character string transmitted was inconsistent with the character string received.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: I-8 Check the external device (LP). Check the external device (LP) cable.
[ 2.2 ]
MT-88
MT-89
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] An undefined or unexpected command was received from the external device (LP).
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
I-8 Check the external device (LP). Check the external device (LP) cable.
[During initialization/normal processing] The external device (LP) did not respond to a transmission.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: I-8 Check the external device (LP). Check the external device (LP) cable.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During initialization/normal processing] Although external device (LP) command parameter information was received, an Check the external device (LP). error was found in the received text. Check the external device (LP) cable.
I-8
[During initialization/normal processing] The film used in the external device (LP) could not be identified.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: I-8 Check the external device (LP). Check the external device (LP) cable.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] Although image parameter data (MFP) was entered, an image process could not Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). be performed because the IMG08B/H board was not detected. Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-9
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] Although image parameter data (MFP) was entered, an image process could not Check the IMG08B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7). be performed because the IMG08B/H board was not detected. Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-9
[ 2.2 ]
MT-89
MT-90
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, [During normal processing] use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Although image parameter data (PEM) was entered, an image process could not be performed because the IMG08H board was not detected. Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-9
[During normal processing] A request for 4-image output was issued in relation to B4 film. However, the Design analysis error code requested image will be converted to a single image and then generated after the output of all the other currently requested films.
I-6
In response to a request for 4-image output, the requested image is converted to Design analysis error code a single image and is now being generated.
I-6
I-10
[During initialization immediately after software update] If this error frequently occurs, check the CPU90E board (it is The backup memory was cleared because the backup memory data was conceivable that the backup memory battery may be changed by the software update. Or, the backup memory was cleared when initialization was effected immediately after the CPU90E board was replaced due exhausted). to backup memory destruction.
The connected printer is applicable to 14" x 14" film only (including the cases where this action was taken because of degeneration). Film output cannot be achieved unless the connected printer is set for B4 film or 14" x 17" film.
I-6
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP10 device 0814. (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP10 device 0815. (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP10 device (IMG08A board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0816.
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-90
MT-91
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
I-7 [During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP11 device 081B. (IMG08A board).
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP11 device 081C. (IMG08A board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP11 device (IMG08A board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 081D.
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP20 device 0822. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP20 device 0823. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP20 device (IMG08B/H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0824.
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP21 device 0829. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP21 device 082A. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP21 device (IMG08B/H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 082B.
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-91
MT-92
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
I-7 [During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP22 device 0830. (IMG08B/H board).
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP22 device 0831. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP22 device (IMG08B/H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0832.
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP30 device 0837. (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP30 device 0838. (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP30 device (IMG08H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0839.
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP31 device 083E. (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP31 device 083F. (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP31 device (IMG08H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0840.
I-7
[ 2.2 ]
MT-92
MT-93
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
I-7 [During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP32 device 0845. (IMG08H board).
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP32 device 0846. (IMG08H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP32 device (IMG08H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0847.
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was found in the checksum on the micro program for the DSP23 device 084C. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During initialization] If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error An error was detected in the micro program self-diagnosis on the DSP23 device 084D. (IMG08B/H board).
I-7
[During normal processing] An image processing error was found in the DSP23 device (IMG08B/H board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 084E.
I-7
Reoutput takes place after the generation of all the previously requested film outputs. Check the IMG08H board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.7).
I-11
[During initialization/normal processing] An undefined command was received when the DMS line connection was established.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the external device (DMS).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-93
MT-94
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the external device (DMS).
Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] An undefined command was received while an operation was stopped.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, [During normal processing] use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: A command was not successfully transmitted to the DMS while image output was in progress. Check the external device (DMS).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: [During normal processing] A receive line break-ON signal was received while image output was in progress. Check the external device (DMS).
[During normal processing] An undefined command was received while image output was in progress.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the external device (DMS).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, [During normal processing] use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: A command was not successfully received from the DMS while image output was in progress. Check the external device (DMS).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, [During normal processing] use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Because an image input termination notification was received from the DMS, the image output operation was aborted. Check the external device (DMS).
[During initialization/normal processing] An image output operation was interrupted by an abort instruction.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Turn ON the power.
[ 2.2 ]
MT-94
MT-95
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] A timeout occurred when a DSP application was started.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when an image transfer reservation response was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when an image information transfer request was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). A timeout occurred when an image data transfer standby response was awaited. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). A timeout occurred when an image data transfer completion report was awaited. Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-95
MT-96
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when an image output completion response was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error was found in the image transfer completion status.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (DMS).
[During normal processing] A high-resolution image could not be output because the DMS was in the standard resolution mode. Therefore, the DMS stored image data at the standard resolution.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (DMS).
due to use by another system The DMS refused to output an image because it was used by another system.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-96
MT-97
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] A command was not successfully transmitted to the DMS.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (DMS).
Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (DMS).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the external device (DMS).
[During normal processing] A command was not successfully received from the DMS.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: E Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the external device (DMS).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An image output termination notification was received from the DMS. Or, the DMS issued an image output termination notification.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An input operation was interrupted by an abort instruction from the MFC.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Turn ON the power.
[ 2.2 ]
MT-97
MT-98
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when a DSP application was started.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when an image data transfer preparation request was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when image data output completion was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when image information transmission was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error was found in an image data output completion notification.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-98
MT-99
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During normal processing] A timeout occurred when an image input termination response was awaited.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error occurred in an input image size check that was conducted.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Although an illegal value was found in input data, an error was detected when an Check the MTH08A/D board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.2/MC-17.3). attempt was made to replace the illegal value with a default one. Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During normal processing] It was found that FINP information setting data was outside the acceptable range.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open an image data file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-99
MT-100
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization/normal processing] A warning was detected by a DSP application.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
Detail
[During initialization] An error occurred in a file setting check (siosetup.idt) that was conducted.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a log file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write a log file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a log file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
A-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the DMC08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.8).
[During initialization] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a file.
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0A00.
K-1
[During initialization] A format error was found in a file that was read into the CPU memory (CPU90E board).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0A01.
K-1
[ 2.2 ]
MT-100
MT-101
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During initialization] An error was found in the setting data in a file.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0A02.
Detail
K-1
[During initialization/normal processing] The magnetic card reader was found to be inoperative although the employed equipment configuration permits the use of the magnetic card reader.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: K-2 Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the magnetic card reader.
[During initialization/normal processing] Although the routine menu display setup file was absent, the menu selection method stored in the backup memory was inconsistently for routine menu selection.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
K-2
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] Improper data was set in the patient information sent from an online-connected unit.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-3
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An undefined or unimplemented command was received from the onlineconnected unit.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-4
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] An unexpected command was received from an online-connected unit.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-4
[ 2.2 ]
MT-101
MT-102
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
Detail
[During initialization/normal processing] An error was detected when a serial line test was conducted in relation to an online-connected unit.
Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ MC-17.11). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-2
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During initialization/normal processing] A requested response to a command did not arrive within a predetermined period Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4). Check the CPU90F/LAN90B board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10/ of time when communication was conducted with an online-connected unit. MC-17.11). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-4
[During initialization/normal processing] A response indicating that the patient information was not found was received from a type B online-connected unit.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-2
[During initialization/normal processing] A response indicating that a timeout occurred in the search for the patient information was received from a type B online-connected unit.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
K-2
[During normal processing] It was found that the patient information read by the magnetic card reader was abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the magnetic card. Check the magnetic card reader. K-5
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide:
[During normal processing] An error was detected when the magnetic card was read.
Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13). Check the magnetic card. Check the magnetic card reader.
K-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-102
MT-103
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition Probable Cause/Remedy Detail
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, [During normal processing] use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: It was found that the card read by the magnetic card reader did not contain userspecified search key data. Check the magnetic card and selected search key type.
K-7
[During normal processing] It was found that the data read by the barcode reader was abnormal.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: K-2 Check the barcode reader (MC-8.8) Check the SNS08A board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.13).
If this error frequently occurs, refer to the instructions for Error 0B18.
L-2
2B30 Compressed/decompressed
image left
[During normal processing] A compression/decompression process came to an end although image data was left to be compressed or decompressed.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
L-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
M-3
[During normal processing] An error was detected while image data was being transferred.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
M-5
[During initialization] Since an error was found in the CPU90F board, the initialization process was continuously performed with the board changed to the CPU90E board. Although the CPU90E board was installed, the CPU90F board was selected in accordance with the configuration setup. Therefore, the initialization process was continuously performed with the board changed to the CPU90E board.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: Check the CPU90F board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.10). Check the configuration settings (MU-7). M-6
[ 2.2 ]
MT-103
MT-104
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] An unexpected command was received.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
Detail
M-3
[During normal processing] A 20 line/mm image input from an external device was rejected (FIN).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
[During initialization] It was found that there was no DICOM information for the local host (DICOM Storage Service SCU).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G-1 Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: [During normal processing] It was found that there was no DICOM information for the output destination host Check the configuration settings (MU-7). (DICOM Storage Service SCP). Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
G-1
[During normal processing] It was found that the output destination attribute in the device information was PRINT only.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
G-1
[During normal processing] It was found that the output destination host defined in the DICOM information file did not agree with the DICOM soft key in SOP class designation.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the configuration settings (MU-7).
G-1
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: [During initialization] It was found that the installed HCP08A board was an old version, which does not Replace the HCP08A board with version G or later support 11-bit output. (MC-17.9).
F+
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104
MT-104.1
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During normal processing] The external device refused to receive the transmission of a compressed image.
Probable Cause/Remedy
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
Detail
G-2
2D43 HD full
[During normal processing] It was found that the HDD of the external device was full.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the external device (online-connected unit).
G-2
[During normal processing] The negotiation for association with the output destination failed.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: G-2 Check the configuration settings (MU-7). Check the external device (online-connected unit).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the CPU90E board (MT-2.4.3/MC-17.4).
G-2
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to open a file.
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial actions as a guide: A Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14). Format the HD and reinstall the software (MU-16).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to write a subsystem file (DOT).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[During normal processing] An error was detected when an attempt was made to close a subsystem file (DOT).
If this error frequently occurs or is followed by a fatal error, use the following suggested remedial action as a guide: Check the HDD (MT-2.4.4/MC-14).
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.1
MT-104.2
Code Name User setup standard gamma parameter resetting Significance/Occurrence Condition
[During software update] The MPM code for user setup standard gamma parameter data coincidence did not exist. Therefore, the user setup standard gamma parameter data was replaced with the standard parameter data having a different MPM code.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
A-7
3080
30A0 LAN analysis information 30C0 Setup function error 30C1 Break reset error 30C2 Break setup error 30C3 Send error 30C4 Receive error 3717 SMCU transmission error 3718 Receive line break detection 3719 Serial line test error 371A Serial line test error 371B SMCU transmission error 3728 Network reception error
E-1++
A+
A+
A+
A+
A+
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.2
MT-104.3
Code Name Error detection during ID delete response wait Significance/Occurrence Condition
A timeout occurred when an ID deletion response to the network IDT was awaited. An error was detected in the content of the data received from the network IDT.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
H
3729
372B Network transmission error 372C Network transmission error 372D Network transmission error 3751 File setting value error
Although an ID acquisition request was issued to the network IDT, a transmission Design analysis error code completion notification error was detected.
Although an ID deletion request was issued to the network IDT, a transmission completion notification error was detected.
Although IDT utility information was transmitted to the network IDT, a transmission completion notification error was detected.
A-1
3800 Receive line break detection 3801 LP status error 3802 LP level 0 error 3803 LP error recovery failure
string transmission 3804 Character error
I-6
I-6
I-6
I-6
Although a character string was transmitted to an external device (LP), a transmission completion error was detected.
I-8
3805 No FINP ID 3806 Board insertion error 3910 SMCU transmission error
009-051-11 08.31.2005 FM4710
I-12
[While the line was established] An error was found in a command transmission to the DMS.
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.3
MT-104.4
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
[While the line was established] A receive line break-ON signal was received.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
F
3911 Receive line break detection 3913 SMCU receive error 3920 SMCU transmission error 3921 Receive line break detection 3923 SMCU receive error
line data-link 3A50 Transmission layer error line break-ON 3A51 Receive detection acquisition function 3C60 Socket error
[While the line was established] A command was not successfully received from the DMS.
[During an idle state] A command was not successfully received from the DMS.
[During initialization/normal processing] An abnormal termination occurred while a message was being transmitted.
K-6
K-2
M-4
3C61 Connect function error 3C62 BIND function error 3C63 LISTEN function error 3C64 ACCEPT function error
M-4
M-4
M-4
M-4
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.4
MT-104.5
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
An error was found in a request for control line connection.
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
M-3
M-3
M-3
The socket number acquired with the socket acquisition function (js_socket) was zero.
A message could not be transferred to a transmission task due to an illegal socket Design analysis error code number.
3C6A Error on the receiving end 3C70 LAN initialization timeout 3C71 LAN board initialization error
acquisition function 3CE0 Socket error
M-3
A PC board program could not be loaded from the CPU90E board because the CPU90F/LAN90B board did not start up.
M-4
M-4
3CE1 Connect function error 3CE2 BIND function error 3CE3 LISTEN function error
M-4
M-4
M-4
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.5
MT-104.6
Code Name Significance/Occurrence Condition
An error was found in the ACCEPT function (js_accept).
Probable Cause/Remedy
Design analysis error code
Detail
M-4
M-3
M-3
M-3
The socket number acquired with the socket acquisition function (js_socket) was zero.
A message could not be transferred to a reception task due to an illegal socket number.
In a multi-frame image reception sequence, more than 90 seconds elapsed between the reception of the data of a frame and the reception of the data of the next frame.
M-3
The reception process came to an end although the image data to be received was not completely received for all sizes.
M-3
G-2
[ 2.2 ]
MT-104.6
CONTENTS
MT - 105
BLANK PAGE
MT - 105
MT-106
Significance/DescriptionType
Blank if there is no extension. "_ _ _ _" is used if line number cannot be obtained as with a binary file. Requesting subsystem Return value from a driver (for analysis)
A+
AAAA.BBB.CCCC
A-1
Blank if there is no extension. "_ _ _ _" is used if line number cannot be obtained as with a binary file.
A-2
(For analysis) "_ _ _ _" is used if there is no FCR image ID. "_ _" is used if the data length is 0. Blank if there is no extension (for analysis)
[ 2.3 ]
MT-106
MT-107
Type A-3 Format
AAAA.BBBB.CCCC.DD AAAA DD.EEEE.FFFF.GGGG. BBBB HHHH.IIII.JJJJJJJJJJ.K CCCC KKKKKKKKK DDDD EEEE FFFF GGGG HHHH IIII JJJJJJJJJJ KKKKKKKKKK
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (4 characters) Character string of fixed length (10 characters) Character string of fixed length (10 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (4 characters) Character string of fixed length (16 characters) NOTE) 10 characters for A07 or earlier Character string of fixed length (10 characters) Hexadecimal dump of variable length Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Hexadecimal dump of variable length
Significance/DescriptionType
(For analysis) "_ _ _ _" when no coordinate point exists or no abnormality exists (for analysis). "_ _ _ _" when no coordinate point exists or no abnormality exists (for analysis). "_ _ _ _" when the unsharp mask value (left) does not exist or no Unsharp mask value (left) abnormality exists. Unsharp mask value "_ _ _ _" when the unsharp mask value (right) does not exist or no (right) abnormality exists. FCR image ID Patient ID Exposure date Error code FINP group number FINP element number FINP data length FCR image ID (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) "_ _ _ _" when the FCR image ID does not exist or cannot be acquired. "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _"when the patient ID does not exist or cannot be acquired. "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _" when YYYY.MM.DD does not exist or cannot be acquired. Original data "_ _" is used if the data length is 0. (for analysis) "_ _ _ _" when the FCR image ID does not exists. "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _" when the patient ID does not exist. "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _" when YYYY.MM.DD does not exist or cannot be acquired.
A-4
FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF
Patient ID
GGGGGGGGGG HH___HH
Exposure date Original data Error code Data start position Original data
A-5
[ 2.3 ]
MT-107
MT-108
Type A-6 Format
AAAA.BBBB.CCCCCCC AAAA CCC.DDDDDDDDDD.E BBBB EEE.FF___FF CCCCCCCCCC DDDDDDDDDD EEEE FF___FF
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (4 characters) Character string of fixed length (10 characters) Character string of fixed length (10 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Hexadecimal dump of variable length Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
"_ _ _ _" if an unsharp mask value does not exist or is normal. "_ _ _ _" if an unsharp mask value does not exist or is normal. YYYY.MM.DD "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _" if an exposure date does not exist. (For analysis) "_ _" is used if the data length is 0. (for analysis)
A-7 A-8 B
AAAA.BBBB AAAA.B
DDDDDD___KKKKKK Hexadecimal
B+ C
AAAA BBBBBBBB
AAAA.B.CCCC
AAAA B CCCC
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length Four hexadecimal digits Hexadecimal
C+
DMA channel number Function or end-ofFour hexadecimal digits message status Four hexadecimal digits Error code Information on error Character string of variable length detection task, etc. Character string of variable length Error ISC message Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Error code Image UID File descriptor
AAAA.BBBB.CC
AAAA BBBB CC
[ 2.3 ]
MT-108
MT-109
Type D-1 Format Form Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length (up to 8 characters) Character string of fixed length (3 characters) Four decimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
Unique number for image control purposes. Assigned in alphabetical order, starting with SA1. For the number of each sensor, see "2.3.1 Supplementary Explanation of Detail Information." 0: OPEN 1: CLOSE 1: Top stage, 2: Second stage, 3: Third stage, 4: Bottom stage 1: H (35*43) 2: DK (35*35) 3: 4 (10*12) 4: 6 (8*10) 5: 18*24ST 6: 24*30ST 7: 18*24 HR 8: 24*30 HR 0: No limitation 13: Used with CR-IR342 4: X-ray dosage (ST 0-85 mR) (HR 0-1700 mR) 5: X-ray dosage (ST 85-120 mR) (HR 1700-2400 mR) 6: X-ray dosage (ST 120-200 mR) (HR 2400-4000 mR) 7: X-ray dosage (ST 200-250 mR) (HR 4000-5000 mR) 8: X-ray dosage (ST 250-300 mR) (HR 5000-6000 mR) 9: X-ray dosage (ST 300-350 mR) (HR 6000-7000 mR) A: X-ray dosage (ST 350-400 mR) (HR 7000-8000 mR) B: X-ray dosage (ST 400 mR -) (HR 8000 mR -)
IP size
[ 2.3 ]
MT-109
MT-110
Type D-5 Format
AAAA.BB___BB.CCCC CCCC.D.E.F.G.H.I.J.KK G KK.LLLL.MMMM H I
Form
Notation
One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit
Significance/DescriptionType
Number is assigned in alphabetical order, starting with MA1. For the number of each motor, see "2.3.1 Supplementary Explanation of Detail Information."
0: Secondary erasure conveyance speed 1: Ce-based ST conveyance speed 2: Ce-based HR conveyance speed 3: Eu-based ST conveyance speed 4: Eu-based HR conveyance speed
Four decimal digits Four decimal digits Four decimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits
AAAA.BCD
AAAA B C D
Subscanning motor failure Timing from the start of reading to the occurrence of failure (in 10 msec). timing Error code Film output unit status Temporary storage device status Permanent storage device status Error code Image UID Number of image UIDs Image UID(for the number of image UIDs) Error code End status for function or (For analysis) message Error code
E E-1
AAAA.BBBB
AAAA BBBB
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length File name (up to 8 characters) Character string of fixed length (3 Extension characters) Four decimal digits Line number
Blank if there is no extension. "_ _ _ _" is used if line number cannot be obtained as with a binary file.
[ 2.3 ]
MT-110
MT-111
Type Format
FFFF.GGGG B C DDDD___GGGG One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (3 characters) Character string of fixed length (8 characters) Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four decimal digits One hexadecimal digit Character of fixed length (one character) One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
Command-requesting subsystem Requested command (for analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) Task ID for a DICOM process. OS error code or DICOM common software error code (for analysis)
E-2
FFFFFFFF AAAA.BB.CCCC.DDDD AAAA DD.EEEEEE.FFFFFF.G BB GGGGG.HHHHHH.IIIIII. CCCC JJJJJJ.KKKKKK DDDDDD___KKKKKK AAAA.BB.CC.DDDD.E.F AAAA .G BB CC DDDD E F G
E-3
(For analysis) The time from the start of reading (leading-edge detection) to the detection of error, measured in 10 msec. If it cannot be obtained, "_ _ _ _" is used. _ is used when it cannot be obtained. G: ST R: HR _: Used when it cannot be obtained. _ is used when it cannot be obtained.
E-4 E-5
AAAA AAAA.B.CCCC
[ 2.3 ]
MT-111
MT-112
Type E-6 Format
AAAA.BBBB.CC AAAA BBBB
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit
Significance/DescriptionType
E-7
CC AAAA.BBBBBBBB.CCC AAAA C BBBBBBBB CCCC AAAA.BBBB AAAA.BB __BB_A08____ AAAA.BB AAAA.BB.CCCC AAAA BBBB AAAA BB AAAA BB AAAA BB CCCC
e-3
AAAA.BB.CC.DDDD
AAAA BB CC DDDD
Amount of shared memory Amount of shared memory installed (MWord) Option Error code Service number Internal error code (For analysis) (For analysis) Request option value (for analysis)
e-4
AAAA.BB.C
AAAA BB C
[ 2.3 ]
MT-112
MT-113
Type e-5 Format
AAAA.BBB.CCCC.DDD AAAA D.EEEE.FF___FF.GG__ BBB _GG.HHHH CCCC DDDD EEEE FF___FF GG___GG HHHH
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (3 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of fixed length (16 characters) Character string of fixed length (16 characters) Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
e-6
AAAA.BB___BB
AAAA BB___BB
Number of requests to IMM I/O task Four hexadecimal digits Error code Error event function Character string of variable length name/trace information, etc. Error code Error code Receive command Error code Receive command Error code Image UID Error code LAN end status
(For analysis)
F F+ G
AAAA AAAA.BBB
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length (up to 3 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits or Character string of variable length (up to 3 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits
AAAA.BBB
AAAA BBB
(For analysis)
G-1 G-2
AAAA.BBBB
AAAA BBBB
Image UID DICOM common software (For analysis) execution result Execution result for Base on DICOM common (For analysis) software
[ 2.3 ]
MT-113
MT-114
Type H Format Form Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
"_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _" is used when the destination IP address cannot be obtained. (For analysis)
AAAA.BBBBBBBBBBBB AAAA .CCCC BBBBBBBBBBBB CCCC AAAA.BBBBBBBB.CCC. AAAA DDDD BBBBBBBB CCC DDDD
Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length File name (up to 12 characters) Four decimal digits Digit number Four hexadecimal digits Error code Character string of variable length File name (up to 8 characters) Character string of fixed Extension length (3 characters) Four decimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Line number Error code Image UID
I-1
Blank if there is no extension. "_ _ _ _" is used if line number cannot be obtained as with a binary file.
I-2
AAAA.BBBB.CC
AAAA BBBB CC
I-3
AAAA.BBBB
AAAA BBBB
[ 2.3 ]
MT-114
MT-115
Type I-4 Format
AAAA.BBBBBB.CC.DD. AAAA EE.FF.GG.HH.II.JJ.KK.L LLL.MMMMM.NN.OO B B B B B B CC
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits One or zero hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
1: Search format error 2: B4 format search failure 3: 14"x17" format search failure 4: Image number search failure 5: 14"x14" format search failure 6: 8"x10" format search failure 00: B4 film 01: 14" x 17" film 02: 14"x14" film 05: 8"x10" film 01: Standard density 10" x 8 02: Standard density 10" x 12 03: Standard density 14" x 14" 04: Standard density 14" x 17" 05: Standard density 502 8" x 10" 06: Standard density 9.5" x 9.5" 07: Standard density 8" x 10" 08: Standard density 17" x 17" 09: Standard density 18cm x 43cm 0A: Standard density 24cm x 18cm 0B: Standard density 24cm x 30cm 0C: Standard density 35cm x 35cm 0D: Standard density 35cm x 43cm 0E: Standard density 30cm x 15cm 0F: Standard density 24cm x 24cm 11: High density 10" x 8 12: High density 10" x 12" 13: High density 14" x 14" 14: High density 14" x 17" 15: High density 502 8" x 10" 16: High density 9.5" x 9.5" 17: High density 8" x 10" 18: High density 17" x 17" 19: High density 18cm x 43cm 1A: High density 24cm x 18cm 1B: High density 24cm x 30cm 1C: High density 35cm x 35cm 1D: High density 35cm x 43cm 1E: High density 30cm x 15cm 1F: High density 24cm x 24cm
DD
[ 2.3 ]
MT-115
MT-116
Type I-4 Format
AAAA.BBBBBB.CC.DD. EE.FF.GG.HH.II.JJ.KK.L EE LLL.MMMMM.NN.OO
Form
Notation
Two hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
00: 90-degree rotation OFF 01: 90-degree rotation ON 00: S (one-image output) 01: LR (simultaneous output of left and right of one image) 02: L-R (individual output of left or right of one image) 03: AB (two-image output, with different size or different image number) 04: SS (two-image output, with same size and same image number) 05: ABCD (four-image) 00: No location change 01: Changed (correspond to FC1 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 02: Changed (correspond to FC2 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 03: Changed (correspond to FC3 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 04: Changed (correspond to FC4 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 05: Changed (correspond to FC5 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 06: Changed (correspond to FC6 of FilmFmt.Cfg) 00: Image area 01: Film character area 00: Image area 0 (first frame) 01: Image area 1 (second frame) 02: Image area 2 (third frame) 03: Image area 3 (fourth frame) 10: Character area 0-0 (top of first frame) 11: Character area 0-1 (bottom of first frame) 12: Character area 1-0 (top of second frame) 13: Character area 1-1 (bottom of second frame) 14: Character area 2-0 (top of third frame) 15: Character area 2-1 (bottom of third frame) 16: Character area 3-0 (top of fourth frame) 17: Character area 3-1 (bottom of fourth frame) 00: 180-degree rotation OFF 01: 180-degree rotation ON 00: S (one-image output) 01: LR (simultaneous output of left and right of one image) 02: L-R (individual output of left or right of one image) 03: AB (two-image output, with different size or different image number) 04: SS (two-image output, with same size and same image number) 05: ABCD (four-image) For LR, a detail determination is made to discriminate between LR and L-R.
FF
Film format
GG
HH
Area type
II
Area number
JJ
KK
LR flag
[ 2.3 ]
MT-116
MT-117
Type I-4 Format
AAAA.BBBBBB.CC.DD. EE.FF.GG.HH.II.JJ.KK.L LLLL LLL.MMMMM.NN.OO
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
Below 0FFF: B4 format 1000_1FFF: 14"x17" format 2000_2FFF: 14"x14" format 5000_5FFF: 8"x10" format First digit: Film used 0: B4/1: 14"x17"/2: 14"x14"/5: 8"x10" Second digit: Reading image size code Same as the reading size code for DD Third digit: 90-degree rotation designation 0: 90-degree rotation OFF/ 90-degree rotation ON Fourth digit: Search format 0: S image character, AB character 1: LR/L_R/SS image character, AB image 2: Different-size 1843 AB image character 4: 14"x17" or 8"x10", with ABCD image character 5: Other than 14"x17" or 8"x10", with ABCD image character 6: 100% magnification 18cm-x-24cm AB image character Fifth digit: Film background 0: Transparent/1: Black
MMMMM
NN
00: One-image normal for B4/8"x10" film 01: Two-image normal for B4 02: One-image 8"x10" landscape for B4/8"x10" film 03: Two-image pantomo for B4 05: Character position change for B4 film 06: Different-size 1843 AB for B4 07: Two-image special for B4 film Format classification code 10: One-image normal for 14"x17"/14"x14" film 11: Two-image normal for 14"x17" 12: One-image 8"x10" landscape for 14"x17" 13: Two-image pantomo for 14"x17" 14: Four-image for 14"x17" 15: Film character position change for 14"x17"/14"x14"/8"x10" 16: Different-size 1843 AB for 14"x17" 17: Two-image special for 14"x17" For B4/14"x14"/8"x10" film 01_08 Image number For 14"x17" film (Detail number within format classification code) 01_08: 14"x17" area is used. 08_10: B4 area is used.
OO
[ 2.3 ]
MT-117
MT-118
Type I-5 Format
AAAA.B.CCCC AAAA B CCCC
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Six hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of four digits Character string of 10 digits 64-digit character string NOTE) 10 digits for A07 or earlier
Significance/DescriptionType
I-6 I-7
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA.BB.CCCC.DDDD AAAA DD.EEEEEE.FFFFFF.G GGGGG.HHHHHH.IIIIII. BB JJJJJJ.KKKKKK CCCC DDDDDD EEEEEE FFFFFF GGGGGG HHHHHH IIIIII JJJJJJ KKKKKK
10: DSP10/11: DSP11/20: DSP20 21: DSP21/22: DSP22/23: DSP23 30: DSP30/31: DSP31/32: DSP32 33: DSP33 (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis) (For analysis)
I-8 I-9
AAAA.BB AAAA.BBBB.C.D
0: One face, 1: Two faces (for analysis) 0: First frame 1: Second frame 2: Third frame 4: Fourth frame
I-10 I-11
AAAA.BBBB
AAAA
[ 2.3 ]
MT-118
MT-119
Type I-12 Format
AAAA.BBBB.CCCC.DD AAAA DD.E.F BBBB CCCC DDDD E F AAAA.B.CCCCCCCCCC AAAA CCCCCC B
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits One decimal digit
Significance/DescriptionType
0: One face, 1: Two faces (for analysis) 0: First frame 1: Second frame 2: Third frame 4: Fourth frame 0: B4; 1: 14" x 17"; 2: 14" x 14"; 3: 8" x 10" Available recording area: 2 digits x 8 (for analysis)
I-13
Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length (up to 8 characters) Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length (up to 8 characters) Character string of fixed length (3 characters) Four decimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit
J+
K-1
Blank if there is no extension. "_ _ _ _" is used if line number cannot be obtained as with a binary file.
K-2 K-3
AAAA AAAA.B.C
AAAA AAAA B C
K-4 K-5
AAAA.B AAAA.B
AAAA B AAAA B
[ 2.3 ]
MT-119
MT-120
Type K-6 K-7 K-8 K-9 Format
AAAA.BBBB AAAA.BBBB AAAA BBBB AAAA BBBB AAAA.BBBBBBBB AAAA BBBBBBBB AAAA.BBBBBBBB.CCC AAAA CCCCC BBBBBBBB CCCCCCCC AAAA.BBBB.CC AAAA BBBB
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
0001: Patient ID number 0002: Receipt number 0003: Examination number LAN task detail code (for analysis) LAN task detail code (for analysis) (For analysis) UID of image data to be opened, written, or read File descriptor when the image data is opened DSP number (0H) for HCP End status for function or message (for analysis) "_ _ _ _ _ _" is used if detail information internal to DSP cannot be obtained or if there is no meaning (for analysis).
L-1
L-2
L-3
Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Three hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits One hexadecimal digit Four hexadecimal digits
L-4
AAAA.B.CCCC
AAAA B CCCC
Channel number used for DMA transfer (for analysis) End status for function or message (for analysis) Channel number used for DMA transfer (for analysis) End status for function or message (for analysis)
M-1
AAAA.B.CCCC
AAAA B CCCC
[ 2.3 ]
MT-120
MT-121
Type M-2 Format
AAAA.BBBB.CC AAAA BBBB
Form
Notation
Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Two hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of 4 digits Character string of 10 digits 64-digit character string NOTE) 10 digits for A07 or earlier Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Eight hexadecimal digits Four hexadecimal digits Character string of variable length Four decimal digits
Significance/DescriptionType
UID for image data to be opened, written, or read File descriptor when the image data is opened (for analysis). IP address of the device connected to the machine over the network Socket number or command number obtained when a connection request is made. "_ _ _ _" is used when there is no meaning (for analysis).
M-3
M-4 M-5
AAAA.BBBBBBBB
AAAA BBBBBBBB
AAAA AAAA.BBBBBBBB
AAAA AAAA
BBBBBBBB AAAA.BBBBBBBB.CCC AAAA CCCCC BBBBBBBB CCCCCCCC AAAA.BBBBBBBB AAAA.BBBBBBBB AAAA BBBBBBBB AAAA BBBBBBBB
N-3 N-4 O
[ 2.3 ]
MT-121
CONTENTS
MT - 122
NOTE: 35* SZ4 is not used with the CR-IR341. The sensor information always reads 0 (OPEN).
TR1H1300.EPS
I Motor Number Correspondence Table (Applicable to Type: D-5, Format Symbols G, H, and I)
No. 0 1 2 3 4 Motor name MB1 MB2 MB3 MC1 MD1 No. 5 6 7 8 9 Motor name MD2 MD3 ME1 ME2 MF1
TR1H1301.EPS
MT - 122
CONTENTS
MT - 123
I Remedy
(1) Write down the top three liens of the message displayed, and notify them to the Service Headquarters. (2) Reset the machine.
MT - 123
CONTENTS
MT - 124
Stopped with "Attaching to <SCSI> device. . ." Can't mount the volume"0x1ff8ec4(tBoot): mempartFree" displayed
CPU90E: CN1, CN2 Stopped with "Attaching to DMA device. . . done" MTH08A: TB1 "Attaching to FloppyDisc device. . . done" MTH08D: TB1 "Attaching to SCSI device. . . done" displayed Power supply (located on the right-hand side): TB2 SNS08A: CN4 CPU90E: CN1, CN2 MTH08A: TB1 MTH08D: TB1 HDD: CNJ1, CNJ2 Power supply (located on the righthand side): TB2, DCOUT2 SNS08A: NFB1/F1 Power supply fuse: F13 MTH08A: CN19, CN20 SNS08A: CN7, CN9 SNS08A: CN1 Power supply (located on the righthand side): DCOUT6 CPU90E (VGA90E): CN7, CN19 Monitor: CN1, CN2, CN3, CN4 VOL08A: CN2 Power supply (located on the righthand side): DCOUT1 CPU90E (VGA90E): CN7, CN19 Monitor: CN1, CN2, CN3, CN4 LED08A: CN3 Power supply (located on the righthand side): DCOUT1 CPU90E: CN6 Power supply (located on the lefthand side): CN3 SCN08A: CN1CN9
CPU90E board MTH08A board MTH08D board Power supply unit (JPS-1)
SNS08A board CPU90E board MTH08A board MTH08D board HDD Power supply unit (JPS-1) MTH08A board MTH08D board SCN08A board SNS08A board Power supply unit (JPS-1)
Bus error
Monitor fuse: F1
CPU90E board Monitor VOL08A board Power supply unit (JPS-1) CPU90E board Monitor LED08A board VOL08A board Power supply unit (JPS-1) Monitor fuse: F1 CPU90E board Power supply unit (JPS-1) (Clear the backup memory.) SCN08A board CPU90F board LAN90B board (Clear the backup memory.) SNS08A board SCN08A board MTH08A board MTH08D board (Clear the backup memory.)
SNS08A: NFB2/F2
TR1H1304.EPS
MT - 124
CONTENTS
MT - 125
Stopped with "STEP5" displayed **ERROR CODE:ffffff02** **BUS ERROR** task name = tJNL d0=010825ff d1=00082714 d2=01082548 d3=ffffff02 d4=00000009 d5=01f258cc d6=01b17a22 d7=00000000 a0=ec000301 a1=0000000a a2=00000002 a3=00002400 a4=01a7c254 a5=01a87078 a6=01a86fb4 a7=01a86f6c sr= 27000 pc=01014cd4 stack +00:A75 01a87030 01028b16 00000002 +10:01a86fc0 010282ae 0103a1c8 01a872d8 +20:01a852db 00000000 00000000 00000000 ++30:01a872d8 01a86fb8 01035772 01a87404 Program Counter:01014a3c(_sysAbort + 2a4) Access address:ec000301 _exceptionHdr(1a872d8,2,1a87078,78,1e,20,3c) _excExcHandle(2,1a87078,1a87030,3c,10010f0,78,1e) _excStub(1a7c254,400,1e1b250,1e,1a9ec58,1ee7d10,1c4898c) Stored as trace data. (core.dmp) SCN08A board **ERROR CODE:ffffff04** **ILLEGAL INSTRUCTION** task name = tRestart d0=00000000 d1=00000000 d2=01fd3188 d3=00000000 d4=00000000 d5=00000000 d6=00000000 d7=00000000 a0=00000000 a1=00000000 a2=015aa014 a3=010979e0 a4=00000000 a5=0109d944 a6=01fd3170 a7=01fd3160 sr= 2000 pc=01c974bc stack +00:0104778 00000000 00000000 015aa014 +10:01fd3188 01c974bc 03010001 01c9741c +20:00000000 00000000 01fd31c4 01c9741c +30:01fd31f4 015aa014 01038e20 0102ad96 Stored as trace data. (core.dmp) **ERROR CODE:02110009** **IMM:ImmInit fails in check of the shared memory.** task name = tMFC d0=00000000 d1=00000000 d2=00000000 d3=01eda234 d4=01c339d4 a5=01c3377c a6=01a44800 a7=01a44800 sr= 3000 pc=01a81446 stack +00:01a44860 01a81446 02110009 01a862d5 +10:01c14c34 01eda234 01c339d4 01f1de7c +30:07000000 01a4484c 01a4994c 0130cb88 MTH08A (MMC90A): CN17, CN18 MTH08D (DIM08A): CN17 _ImmInit(70000000,14,1b95c4d,5,1a448e2,1a448f4,1b96466) _PowerOff(1c14c34,3c,1a4497c,1c339d4,1a448d2,1a449aa,20) _sed_debug(1eda234,1a449aa,1f1de7c,1c339d4,0,0,0) _sedISC(1c339d4,0,0,105c7c6,0,0,0) **ERROR CODE:05020003** **PNL:VCWindow ERROR** task name = tPNL **ERROR CODE:ffffff02** **BUS ERROR** task name = tHCP 0100d974(dspDevCreate+a2a) e5000000 **ERROR CODE:ffffff02** **BUS ERROR** task name = tilmain 01c07402(cmd enter+306) bf4cf55c
CPU90E board
HCP08A board
MT - 125
CONTENTS
MT - 126
Associated parts Others Cassette set unit: SA3, 7, 11, 15, SOLA14 DRV08A: CN4 Cassette set unit:CNA3
03BF
03DD
03DE
03E8
0532/0537/0538 No click tone/alarm sound generated, and cassette IN/OUT LED not illuminated Cassette IN/OUT LED not illuminated Cassette cannot be locked (the lock pin remains withdrawn) Touch panel inoperative Operation lamps unlit (Ready, Error lamps, etc.) Failed erasure lamp (13AA) Erasure lamp fan (FANF1) not rotated IP jam/freeze (offensive noise from the IP removal unit) Cassette Setting Error (13A1)
SCN08A: NFB5/F5
SNS08A: NFB3/F3
MT - 126
CONTENTS
MT - 127
03B1
03B3
03C1
03D1 03D2 0534/0537/0538 0534/0537/0538/0536 0536 0537 0537/0538 0538 03D4 03D5 03D6 0422 SCN08A: NFB1/F1, NFB3/F3
SCN08A: NFB8/F8
MT - 127
CONTENTS
MT - 128
CONTENTS
MT - 129
2.4
Troubleshooting flow
03A2/03A3
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF N Replace the cassette.
2.4.1 Error Code Analysis Flows 03A2 Cassette hold release error/03A3 Degeneration for all shelves
Cause 03A2: 03A3: SOLA1-4 is turned ON during cassette hold release after occurrence of 13E1-13E5, but SA3, 7, 11, and 15 do not turn OFF so that the cassette cannot be released. Cassette hold release is performed during initialization or during machine operation, but hold release for all the shelves (SA3, 7, 11, and 15 do not turn OFF) cannot be detected.
Are the hold pin holes for all the cassettes normal? Check to ensure that there is no flash, deformation, or foreign matter. Y Power OFF Is the operation of the solenoid arm and hold pin normal? Lower the solenoid arm by hand to check that it strokes properly. Y Power ON Are SOL1 4 turned ON and the hold pin released during initialization self-diagnostics? Y N N
Supplementary explanation G Upon initialization or cassette ejection, SOLA1-4 turn ON for releasing the cassette hold. G When the SOLA1-4 turn ON, the hold pin is withdrawn, so that SA3, 7, 11, and 15 turn OFF, thereby detecting the release of the hold pin. G An error message is displayed for a shelf where cassette hold release fails. G This error occurs when the entire cassette hold release is not detected during the above operation. Sensor related ON: Close, OFF: Open
Power OFF Is the fuse NFB1 on the SNS08A board normal? Y Power OFF Are the connector connections between SOLA1 4 and DRV08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Reset the NFB1.
Is the fuse (F10) in the power supply unit (JPS-1) normal? Y Replace the DRV08A board.
Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensors. Power ON again to check the sensors again. Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 normal? Y N
FR1H0001.EPS
SNS08A
CN6
CNA2
SA3/7/11/15
DC OUT2 CN4 DRV03D CN3 CN2 CNSOLA1 SOLA1
Are the connector connections from SA3, 7, 11 and 15 to SNS08A board normal? Y Restart the machine and check its status.
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN4
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
MT - 128
MT - 129
CONTENTS
MT - 130
CONTENTS
MT - 131
03A8/13A8
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, remove the cause of the IP jam, and then troubleshoot the 13A8 error. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all.
Supplementary Explanation 03A8: G Each motor is activated during initialization, and each sensor is used to detect any remaining IP left in the machine. G The remaining IP in the machine is conveyed, and IP length measurement is performed by SC1. G The size of the IP is determined according to the ON/OFF status of SA4, 8, 12, and 16 (mammo/ST sensor), and SB4 (inch/metric sensor), as well as the time taken for the IP to pass over SC1. G This error occurs when the size of the remaining IP is out of spec as a result of the above operation. 13A8: G IP length measurement is performed by SC1 during IP conveyance. G The size of the IP is determined according to the ON/OFF status of SA4, 8, 12, and 16 (mammo/ST sensor), and SB4 (inch/metric sensor), as well as the time taken for the IP to pass over SC1. G This error occurs when the size of the IP conveyed is out of spec as a result of the above operation. Sensor related ON: Close, OFF: Open
Power OFF Is the drive mechanism normal? Rotate the MC1/MD3 driving belts by hand to check that the conveyor rollers rotate smoothly. Y Power ON Are SA4, 8, 12, and 16 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the sensor status. By turning ON/OFF the SW, make sure that they are normal. Y Power ON Is SC1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the sensor status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the sensor light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N Power OFF N N Is the connector connection from SC1 to SNS08A board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Power OFF Are the connector connections from SA4, 8, 12, 16 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Replace the following parts in order named. G SA4, 8, 12, 16 (faulty SW only) G SNS08A board
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SC1 normal? Y
FR1H0006.EPS
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
SA8
SA8
SC1
CNC1 SA12 SA12
DC OUT2
SA16
SA16
JPS-1
MD3
CNMD3 CNC2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8
MC1
CNMC1
FR1H0005.EPS
MT - 130
MT - 131
CONTENTS
MT - 132
CONTENTS
MT - 133
03B1
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Are the connection belts for the elevation unit and before-side-positioning conveyor installed properly? Y Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of MC1 normal? Rotate the MC1 driving belt by hand to check that the conveyor roller rotates smoothly. Power OFF Y N N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Connection belt Vertical conveyance of elevation unit
Is the drive mechanism of MD3 normal? Rotate the MD3 driving belt by hand to check that the conveyor roller rotates smoothly. Power OFF Y
Before-side-positioning conveyor
Does the convergence path changeover function normally? Y Power ON Does SOLC1 operate during initialization self-diagnostics? Power ON Y
N Adjust/replace the following parts. G SOLC1/spring G Shaft/bearing N Replace the following parts. G SOLC1 G DRV08A board Power OFF N Are the following connector N connections normal? G MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 G MD3 DRV08A JPS-1 Y Power OFF Is the fuse (F11) in the power supply unit (JPS-1) N normal? If the fuse (F11) is faulty, MC1 does not rotate. Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SOLC1
SOLA4
FR1H0009.EPS
Do MC1/MD3 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Y
Replace the following parts. G Fuse (F11) G DRV08A board G Power supply unit
Power ON Is SC1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SC1 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SC1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y
Replace the following parts. G MC1/MD3 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board Power OFF N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SC1 normal? Y N Power OFF
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SC1
CNC1
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MD3
CNMD3 CNC2
Is the connector connection from SC1 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system diagram and connect the connector as appropriate.
FR1H0010.EPS
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8
MC1
CNMC1
FR1H0008.EPS
MT - 132
MT - 133
CONTENTS
MT - 134
CONTENTS
MT - 135
03B2
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Check to see that it is not curled, bent, or warped. Y Power OFF Are the conveyance systems of the erasure conveyor, before-sidepositioning conveyor, and up-down IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MC1/MB2 driving belts by hand to check that the conveyor rollers rotate smoothly. Y Power ON Do MC1/MB2 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON N Power OFF N Are the following connector connections normal? G MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 G MB2 DRV08A JPS-1 Y Replace the following parts in order named. G MC1/MB2 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Grip spring G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Path changeover guide (Section 6.7.4 of Chapter 6) N Replace the IP.
Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? Y
Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor MC1 IP transport motor
FR1H0011.EPS
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MB2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8
CNC2 CNMC1
MC1
FR1H0012.EPS
MT - 134
MT - 135
CONTENTS
MT - 136
CONTENTS
MT - 137
03B3
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Check to see that it is not curled or bent. The IP runs over the shaft due to its curling. Y Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of the side-positioning conveyor normal? G Rotate the MD3 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. G Make sure that the grip release wire functions properly. Y Power ON Does MD3 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SD3 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SD3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SD3 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N Power OFF N N Is SD3 installed normally? Y Power OFF Y Is the connector connection from SD3 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. Install the sensor properly. Replace the following parts in order named. G MD3 G DRV08A board N Power OFF Are the connector connections from MD3 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Grip release mechanism N Replace the IP.
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SD3 normal?
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SD3
JPS-1
MD3
CNMD3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0015.EPS
MT - 136
MT - 137
CONTENTS
MT - 138
CONTENTS
MT - 139
03B4
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, remove the cause of the before-reading error, and then troubleshoot this 03B4 error. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Check to see that it is not curled, bent, or warped. Power OFF Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Movable roll G Hold pin G Cassette N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing N Replace the IP.
With all the cassettes set into all the shelves, does the cassette cover open properly? Power OFF Y
Is the drive system of the up-down IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MB2 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Power ON Y
Does MB2 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N
Power OFF Are the following connector connections normal? G MB2, MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 board Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor MC1 IP transport motor
FR1H0017.EPS
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? Y
Power OFF Is SB2 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y Replace the following parts in order named. G SB2 G SNS08A board
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MB2
FR1H0019.EPS
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0018.EPS
MT - 138
MT - 139
CONTENTS
MT - 140
CONTENTS
MT - 141
03B5
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, remove the cause of the before-reading error, and then troubleshoot this 03B5 error. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Are the drive systems of the up-down IP removal unit/sidepositioning conveyor normal? Rotate the MB2/MC1 driving belts by hand to check that they rotate smoothly. Power ON Y N Power OFF Are the following connector connections normal? G MB2, MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 board Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Grip spring
Do MB2/MC1 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Power ON Y
Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? Y N
Replace the following parts in order named. G MB2/MC1 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board
Power OFF Is SB2 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor MC1 IP transport motor
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0020.EPS
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SB2
JPS-1
MB2
DRV08A
CN8 DC OUT3 CN1
CNC2 CNMC1
MC1
FR1H0021.EPS
MT - 140
MT - 141
CONTENTS
MT - 142
CONTENTS
MT - 143
03B6
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, check the cause of IP jam and remedy it. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Take out the IP and check to see that it is not curled, bent, or warped. Y Power OFF N Are the conveyance systems of the erasure conveyor, before-sidepositioning conveyor, and up-down IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MF1/MC1/MB2 driving belts by hand to check that the conveyor rollers rotate smoothly. Y With all the cassettes set into all the shelves, does the cassette cover open properly? Y Power ON Do MF1/MC1/MB2 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open"
MD3
FR1H0023.EPS
Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Grip spring G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Path changeover guide
Adjust/replace the following parts. G Movable roll G Hold pin G Cassette Power OFF
Are the following N connector connections normal? G MF1 DRV08A JPS-1 G MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 G MB2 DRV08A - JPS-1 Y Replace the following parts in order named. G MF1/MC1/MB2 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor MC1 IP transport motor MF1 IP transport motor
Y Power OFF
N Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? Y
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
CNB2
Restart the machine and check its status.
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MB2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8
CNC2 CNMC1
MC1
FR1H0024.EPS
MT - 142
MT - 143
CONTENTS
MT - 144
CONTENTS
MT - 145
03B7
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, check the cause of IP jam and remedy it. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all.
Is the IP normal? Check to see that it is not curled, bent, or warped. Y Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of the side-positioning conveyor normal? Rotate the MD3 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Also make sure that the grip release mechanism functions properly. Power ON Y
N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Grip release mechanism
Power OFF N Are the connector connections from MD3 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Does MD3 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Power ON Y
Are SD3/SC1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SD3/SC1 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SD3/SC1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Are SD3/SC1 normal? Y
Power OFF Are SD3/SC1 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SD3/SC1 to SNS08A board normal? Y
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
AC IN
CN5
SC1
CNC1
DC OUT2
SD3
CNZ2 CND1 CNZ7
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN13
Replace the following parts in order named. G SD3/SC1 (faulty sensor only) G SNS08A board
FR1H0028.EPS
MD3
CNMD3 CN2 CNZ4 CN3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN14
MZ1
DC OUT7 CN1
FR1H0027.EPS
MT - 144
MT - 145
CONTENTS
MT - 146
CONTENTS
MT - 147
03B8/13B8
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is there any remaining IP left in the machine? Y N Power ON and clear "8. BACK UP MEMORY" of M-Utility. Restart the machine again and check its status.
Power ON Is the remaining IP ejected during initialization self-diagnostics? Y N Manually eject the IP left in the machine. Power ON and clear "8. BACK UP MEMORY" of M-Utility. Restart the machine again and check its status.
FR1H0029.EPS
MT - 146
MT - 147
CONTENTS
MT - 148
CONTENTS
MT - 149
03B9
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, check the cause of IP jam and remedy it. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Are the drive systems of the up-down IP removal unit/erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MB2/MC1/MF1 driving belts by hand to check that they rotate smoothly. Power ON Y Power OFF N Are the following connectors normal? G MB2, MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 board G MF1 DRV08A JPS-1 board Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Grip release mechanism
Do MB2/MC1/MF1 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Power ON Y
Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? N
Replace the following parts in order named. G MB2/MC1/MF1 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Power OFF Is SB2 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor MC1 IP transport motor
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0030.EPS
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
CNB2
DC OUT2
SF3
CNF1 CNB3 CNMB2
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN5
MB2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8 CN10
CNC2 CNMC1
MC1
CNF2 CNMF1
MF1
FR1H0031.EPS
MT - 148
MT - 149
CONTENTS
MT - 150
CONTENTS
MT - 151
03BC
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the sidepositioning conveyor normal? Move the side-positioning conveyor by hand to check that it moves smoothly. Y Power ON Does MD1 rotate and the sidepositioning conveyor move during initialization self-diagnostics? Y
Latch assembly SD1 side-positioning mechanism HP sensor
Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Rail G Latch assembly Belt retaining section Positions of actuator and SD1 Power OFF N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0036.EPS
Power ON Is SD1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SD1 status. Move the side-positioning conveyor to its home position by hand and block the SD1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" (The sensor status is "close" at the home position.) Y
FR1H0034.EPS
Power OFF N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SD1 normal? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SD1 to SNS08A board normal? Y N
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN9
CNZ2
AC IN
CN5
SD1
CND1
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MD1
CNMD1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0035.EPS
MT - 150
MT - 151
CONTENTS
MT - 152
CONTENTS
MT - 153
03BF
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. START
Is the drive gear of MD2 installed properly? Y Is the grip drive system of the side-positioning conveyor normal? Rotate the cam by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y
Install it properly.
N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt G Grip release mechanism G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Drive gear The screw is tightened in place.
FR1H0040.EPS
Sensor related
Is the SD2 light-shielding plate normal? Check that it is not in contact with the SD2. Y Is +24 V present between the following DCOUT3 terminals of the power supply unit (JPS-1)? G DCOUT3-2 and DCOUT3-7 G DCOUT3-3 and DCOUT3-8 G DCOUT3-4 and DCOUT3-9 G DCOUT3-5 and DCOUT3-10 Y
Mount it properly.
Are the following power supply unit (JPS-1) fuses normal? G F9 (DCOUT3-2 and DCOUT3-7) G F10 (DCOUT3-3 and DCOUT3-8) G F11 (DCOUT3-4 and DCOUT3-9) G F12 (DCOUT3-5 and DCOUT3-10) Y Replace the power supply unit (JPS-1).
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT3 and DRV08A board CN1 normal? Y N Replace the cable.
FR1H0038.EPS
DRV08A
Is +5 V is present between power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT terminals 2-1 and 2-2?
AC IN
+15V +24V
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT2 and SNS08A board CN4 normal? Y N Replace the cable.
CN12
CNZ6
CNMD2 MD2
+5V
F13
DC OUT2 CN4
F1
F2
CN9
CNZ2
CND1 SD2
FR1H0039.EPS
MT - 152
MT - 153
CONTENTS
3
A
MT - 154
CONTENTS
MT - 155
BLANK PAGE
Is +5 V present between the TP2 and TP3 (GND) on the DRV08A board? Y
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT3 and DRV08A board CN1 normal? Y Replace the DRV08A board.
N Are the connector/cable connections among the SNS08A board CN9, CNZ2, and CND1 normal? Y Replace the SNS08A board. Replace the cable.
Is the MD2 normal? Perform operational checkout of the MD2 with 6. MECH of M-Utility. Y
N Are the connector/cable connections among the DRV08A board CN12, CNZ6, and CNMD2 normal? Y Replace the MD2.
Is the SD2 normal? Check the SD2 status by monitoring it with 6. MECH of M-Utility. Y
N Are the connector/cable connections among the SNS08A board CN9, CNZ2, and CND1 normal? Y Replace the SD2.
To START
FR1H1916.EPS
MT - 154
MT - 155
CONTENTS
MT - 156
CONTENTS
MT - 157
03C0
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the sidepositioning conveyor normal? Move the side-positioning conveyor by hand to check that the latch assembly pushes up the stopper. Y Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that the IP is not curled, bent, or warped. If it is curled, it moves beyond the stopper and is conveyed into the subscanning unit. Check all the IPs as needed. Y Power OFF N Replace the IP(s). N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Roller G Spring
SNS08A
CN9
CNZ2
AC IN
CN5
SD3
CND1
DC OUT2
SZ1
CNZ11 CNZ7
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN5
MD3
CNMD3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0043.EPS
MT - 156
MT - 157
CONTENTS
MT - 158
CONTENTS
MT - 159
03C1
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Remove the scanning optics unit. 4. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the subscanning unit normal? Rotate the driving shaft by hand to check that the driving shaft rotates smoothly. Move the cam to check that the upper rubber roller moves down. Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Kapton belt G SUS belt/rubber belt G Tensioner G Upper rubber roller/shaft /grip spring G Grip arm/cam
Tensioner
FR ON T
Subscanning unit
Right-hand side transparent cover Tensioner Kapton belt Subscanning unit Pulley
Flywheel
FR ON
FR1H0047.EPS
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
N Replace the following parts in order named. G Fuse (F3/F4) G DRV08A board G Power supply unit
Replace the following parts in order named. G MZ1 G SNS08A board Power OFF
CNZ2
SNS08A
CN9
SD3
CND1
DC OUT2
JPS-1
Is SD3 normal? N With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SD3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SD3 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SD3 normal? Y Power OFF Is SD3 installed normally? Power OFF Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N N Install the sensor properly.
MD3
CNMD3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN14 CNZ4
CN2 CN3
MZ1
DC OUT7 CN1
FR1H0046.EPS
Replace the following parts in order named. G SD3 G SNS08A board G DRV08A board
FR1H0048.EPS
MT - 158
MT - 159
CONTENTS
MT - 160
CONTENTS
MT - 161
03C2
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that the IP is not curled, bent, or warped. The IP runs over the shaft due to its curling. Y Power OFF N Is the drive system of the sidepositioning conveyor normal? Rotate the MD3 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Also make sure that the IP conveyance path is free of any foreign matter. Y Power OFF Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Removal of foreign matter
Right-hand side transparent cover Tensioner Kapton belt
Subscanning unit
Is the drive system of the subscanning unit normal? Rotate the driving shaft by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y
Adjust/replace the following parts. G Kapton belt G SUS belt/rubber belt G Tensioner G Upper rubber roller/upper shaft/grip spring G Grip arm
Flywheel
FR O
Power ON Is the operation of MZ1 (FFM) normal? See the MZ1 check/replacement procedure in section 10.8 of the MC volume and check the MZ1. Y Power ON N Power OFF Is the connector connection from MZ1 to JPS-1 board normal? Y Power OFF Are the connector connections from MZ1 to SNS08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y Replace the following parts in order named. G MZ1 G SNS08A board Power OFF Is the connection from SED08A to SCN08A board normal? Y N N
NT
FR1H0051.EPS
SZ1
Is SZ1 (SED08A board) normal? See the SED08A board check/ replacement procedure in section 10.5 of the MC volume and check the SED08A board. Y Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. N Power ON again to perform the SED08A board checks as described in section 10.5 of the MC volume. Is SZ1 normal? Y N
DRV08A
DC OUT3 DC OUT7 CN1
MZ1
CN1
FR1H0050.EPS
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Replace the following parts in order named. G SED08A board G SCN08A board G Laser assembly
FR1H0052.EPS
MT - 160
MT - 161
CONTENTS
MT - 162
CONTENTS
MT - 163
03C6 Driving Shaft Grip Error/03C8 Driving Shaft Grip Release Error 03CA Driving Shaft Grip Self-Diagnostics Error
Cause 03C6: 03C8: 03CA: MZ2 is driven before IP reading conveyance, but SZ2 does not turn OFF (IP not ungripped). MZ2 is driven before IP reading conveyance, but SZ2 does not turn ON (IP not gripped). MZ2 is driven during initialization, but SZ2 does not turn OFF.
03C6/03C8/03CA
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the grip mechanism of the subscanning unit normal? Rotate MZ2 by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Cam G MZ2 NOTE: When checking the operation, put an Allen wrench into the cam to check the operation of the grip arm.
MD3
Driving shaft
SZ1
Driven shaft
Supplementary explanation G During IP reading conveyance or during initialization, MZ2 is driven to perform the grip/ grip release operation. G Either grip or grip release is detected as SZ2 turns ON/OFF. G When SZ2 is OFF, it is detected as grip; when SZ2 is ON, it is detected as grip release. G This error occurs when SZ2 does not transition from ON to OFF, or from OFF to ON, during the above operation. Sensor related ON: Close, OFF: Open
Power ON Does MZ2 rotate during initialization self-diagnostics? Y N
MZ2
MZ3
SZ3
FR1H0055.EPS
Power OFF Is the connector connection from MZ1 to SNS08A board normal? Y Power OFF N N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Is the fuse (F2) of the power supply unit (JPS-1) normal? Y Power ON Is SZ2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SZ2 status. Put an Allen wrench into the cam of MZ2 and rotate it to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Replace the following parts in order named. G MZ2 G DRV08A board N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SZ2 normal? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SZ2 to SNS08A board normal? Y Replace the following parts in order named. G SZ2 G SNS08A board N N
Replace the following parts in order named. G Fuse (F2) G SNS08A board G Power supply unit
SNS08A
CN9
CNZ2
AC IN
CN5
SZ2
CNZ3
DC OUT2
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0056.EPS
JPS-1
MZ2
CNZ9
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0054.EPS
MT - 162
MT - 163
CONTENTS
MT - 164
CONTENTS
MT - 165
03C7 Driven Shaft Grip Release Error/03C9 Driven Shaft Grip Error 03CB Driven Shaft Grip Self-Diagnostics Error
Cause 03C7: 03C9: 03CB: MZ3 is driven during IP reading conveyance, but SZ3 does not turn OFF (IP not ungripped). MZ3 is driven during IP reading conveyance, but SZ3 does not turn ON (IP not gripped). MZ3 is driven during initialization, but SZ3 does not turn OFF.
03C7/03C9/03CB
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all.
START
MD3
Y Is the grip mechanism of the subscanning unit normal? Rotate MZ3 by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y N
Driving shaft
Adjust/replace the following parts. G Cam G MZ3 NOTE: When checking the operation, put an Allen wrench into the cam and rotate it clockwise to check the operation of the grip arm.
SZ1
Driven shaft
Supplementary explanation G During IP reading conveyance or during initialization, MZ3 is driven to perform the grip/ grip release operation. G Either grip or grip release is detected as SZ3 turns ON/OFF. G When SZ3 is OFF, it is detected as grip; when SZ3 is ON, it is detected as grip release. G This error occurs when SZ3 does not transition from ON to OFF, or from OFF to ON, during the above operation. Sensor related ON: Close, OFF: Open
MZ2
MZ3
SZ3
FR1H0059.EPS
Is +24 V present between the following DCOUT3 terminals of the power supply unit (JPS-1)? G DCOUT3-2 and DCOUT3-7 G DCOUT3-3 and DCOUT3-8 G DCOUT3-4 and DCOUT3-9 G DCOUT3-5 and DCOUT3-10 Y
Are the following power supply unit (JPS-1) fuses normal? G F9 (DCOUT3-2 and DCOUT3-7) G F10 (DCOUT3-3 and DCOUT3-8) G F11 (DCOUT3-4 and DCOUT3-9) G F12 (DCOUT3-5 and DCOUT3-10) Y Replace the power supply unit (JPS-1).
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT3 and DRV08A board CN1 normal? Y N Replace the cable.
Is +15 V is present between power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT terminals 3-1 and 3-6? Y
Is the power supply unit (JPS-1) fuse (F2) normal? Y Replace the power supply unit (JPS-1).
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT3 and DRV08A board CN1 normal? Y N Replace the cable.
AC IN
Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT2 and SNS08A board CN4 normal? Y N Replace the cable.
+5V
F13
DC OUT2 CN4
F1
F2
CN9
CNZ2
CNZ3 SZ3
FR1H0058.EPS
MT - 164
MT - 165
CONTENTS
3
A
MT - 166
CONTENTS
MT - 167
BLANK PAGE
Is +5 V present between the TP2 and TP3 (GND) on the DRV08A board? Y
N Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT3 and DRV08A board CN1 normal? Y Replace the DRV08A board. N Are the connector/cable connections among the SNS08A board CN9, CNZ2, and CNZ3 normal? Y Replace the SNS08A board. N Are the connector/cable connections among the DRV08A board CN14, CNZ8, and CNZ9 normal? Y Replace the MZ3.
Is the MZ3 normal? Perform operational checkout of the drive grip mechanism with 6. MECH of M-Utility. Y
Is the SZ3 normal? Check the SZ3 status by monitoring it with 6. MECH of M-Utility. Y
N Are the connector/cable connections among the SNS08A board CN9, CNZ2, and CNZ3 normal? Y Replace the SZ3.
To START
FR1H1917.EPS
MT - 166
MT - 167
CONTENTS
MT - 168
CONTENTS
MT - 169
03D1
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the grip release mechanism of the after-reading conveyor normal? Move each portion of the grip release mechanism by hand for checking. Y Power OFF Is the drive system of the afterreading conveyor normal? Rotate the ME2 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y Power ON Does ME2 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Grip release mechanism G Cam G ME1 drive gear
Power OFF Are the connector connections from ME2 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Power ON Is SF1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF1 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y
FR1H0061.EPS
N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF1 normal? N Power OFF Is SF1 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from N SF1 to SNS08A board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Install the sensor properly.
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF1
DC OUT2
JPS-1
ME2
CNME2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0062.EPS
MT - 168
MT - 169
CONTENTS
MT - 170
CONTENTS
MT - 171
03D2
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the afterreading conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y Power OFF Is the drive system of the erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft /bearing N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Grip release mechanism (should be gripped) G Conveyor roller/shaft /bearing
Power OFF
Y Reference: When operating the erasure conveyor by hand, the procedures are facilitated by removing the belt that connects the erasure conveyor and before-side-positioning conveyor. N Install it properly.
Is the drive gear of MF1 installed properly? Y Power ON Do ME2/MF1 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SF2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y N Power OFF
Power OFF N Are the connector connections from MF1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0064.EPS
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF1
DC OUT2
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF2 normal? Y
Power OFF Is SF2 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SF2 to SNS08A board normal? Y
SF2
JPS-1
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MF1
CNMF1
Restart the machine and check its status.
FR1H0065.EPS
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
MT - 170
MT - 171
CONTENTS
MT - 172
CONTENTS
MT - 173
03D3
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all.
Power OFF Is the drive system of the erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 driving belt to check that it rotates smoothly. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Two upper rollers G Grip spring
Y Power ON
Reference: When operating the erasure conveyor by hand, the procedures are facilitated by removing the belt that connects the erasure conveyor and before-side-positioning conveyor.
Does MF1 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y N Power OFF Are the connector connections from MF1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Power ON Is SF2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF2 normal?
FR1H0068.EPS
Power OFF Is SF2 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SF2 to SNS08A board normal? Y
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF4
CF4
DC OUT2
SF2
JPS-1
MF1
CNMF1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0069.EPS
MT - 172
MT - 173
CONTENTS
MT - 174
CONTENTS
MT - 175
03D4
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Check for any remaining IP left in the erasure conveyor. Does the IP block the SF1 light path? Y Power OFF Is the path changeover of the erasure conveyor normal? Actuates the SOLF1 solenoid by hand to check that it actuates smoothly. Also make sure that tension is applied by the spring. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G SOLF1/path changeover guide G SOLF1 spring N Power ON Is SF1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF1 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF1 normal? Y N Power OFF Are the following connector connections normal? G SOLF1 DRV08A JPS-1 Y N Power OFF Replace the following parts in order named. G SOLF1 G DRV08A board
FR1H0071.EPS
Y Is the connector connection from SF1 N to SNS08A board normal? Y Replace the following parts in order named. G SF1 G SNS08A board
FR1H0073.EPS
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF1
DC OUT2
SOLF1 spring
JPS-1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0072.EPS
FR1H0074.EPS
MT - 174
MT - 175
CONTENTS
MT - 176
CONTENTS
MT - 177
03D5
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 driving belt to check that it rotates smoothly. Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Roller/grip spring G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Reference: When operating the erasure conveyor by hand, the procedures are facilitated by removing the belt that connects the erasure conveyor and before-side-positioning conveyor. N Remove any foreign matter.
Power OFF Is there any foreign matter under the erasure lamp? Remove the erasure lamp and check the conveyance path. Y Power ON Does MF1 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON N Power OFF Are the connector connections from MF1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Is SF2/SF3 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF2/SF3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF2/SF3 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF2/SF3 normal? N
Power OFF Is SF2/SF3 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SF2/SF3 to SNS08A board normal? Y
FR1H0075.EPS
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF2
Restart the machine and check its status. Replace the following parts in order named. G SF3/SF2 G SNS08A board
FR1H0077.EPS
DC OUT2
SF3
JPS-1
MF1
CNMF1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0076.EPS
MT - 176
MT - 177
CONTENTS
MT - 178
CONTENTS
MT - 179
03D6
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Are the drive systems of the up-down IP removal unit/erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MB2/MC1/MF1 driving belts to check that they rotate smoothly. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Power OFF
Y Reference: When operating the erasure conveyor by hand, the procedures are facilitated by removing the belt that connects the erasure conveyor and before-side-positioning conveyor. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Path changeover guide/SOLC1
Is the path changeover of the before-side-positioning conveyor normal? Actuate SOLC1 by hand to check that it actuates smoothly. Y Power ON
Power OFF N N Are the following connector connections normal? G MB2, MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 board G MF1 DRV08A JPS-1 board Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Do MB2 and MC1/MF1 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during initialization self-diagnostics? Y
Replace the following parts in order named. G MB2/MC1/MF1 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board Power ON Power OFF N Is the connector connection from SOLC1 to DRV08A board normal? N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MB2 IP transport motor SB2 Cassette inlet IP sensor SOLC1 Convergence path changeover guide drive MC1 IP transport motor
Is SOLC1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, actuate SOLC1 for checking. Y Power ON Are SB2/SF3 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2/SF3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the sensor light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N
FR1H0078.EPS
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
CNB2
DC OUT2
SF3
CNF1 CNB3 CNMB2
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN9 CN5
SOLC1 MB2
CNSOLC1
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2/SF3 normal? Y
Power OFF Is SB2/SF3 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2/SF3 to SNS08A board normal? Y
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN8 CN10
CNC2 CNMC1
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MC1
CNF2 CNMF1
MF1
FR1H0079.EPS
MT - 178
MT - 179
CONTENTS
MT - 180
CONTENTS
MT - 181
03D7
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the before-side-positioning conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 and MC1 driving belts by hand to check that the conveyor rollers rotate smoothly. Y Power OFF Is the path changeover of the before-side-positioning conveyor normal? Actuate the SOLC1 by hand to check that it actuates smoothly. Y Power ON Do MF1/MC1 rotate along with the conveyor rollers during i nitialization self-diagnostics? Y N Power OFF Are the following connector connections normal? G MF1 DRV08A JPS-1 board G MC1 DRV08A JPS-1 board Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0083.EPS
N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Connection belt G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing G Grip spring
Connection belt
Replace the following parts in order named. G MF1/MC1 (faulty motor only) G DRV08A board
SOLC1 Convergence path changeover guide drive SC2 Convergence standby IP sensor
Power OFF N Is the following connector connection normal? G SOLC1 DRV08A JPS-1 Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Power ON Is SC2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SC2/SC3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SC2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SC2
CNC1
DC OUT2
Replace the following parts in order named. G SOLC1 G DRV08A board Power OFF Power OFF N Is SC2 installed Remove dust or normally? soil from the sensor. Power ON again to Y execute sensor Power OFF monitoring. Is SC2 normal? Is the connector Y connection from SC2 to SNS08A board normal? Y
JPS-1
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0082.EPS
MT - 180
MT - 181
CONTENTS
MT - 182
CONTENTS
MT - 183
03D8
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Are the conveyance systems of the erasure conveyor/after-reading conveyor normal? Rotate the ME2 driving belt by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y Power ON Does ME2 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SF2/SF4 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF2/SF4 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF2/SF4 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SF2/SF4 normal? Y N Power OFF Is SF2/SF4 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SF2/SF4 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Install the sensor properly. N Power OFF Are the connector connections from ME2 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Shaft/bearing G Grip release mechanism
FR1H0085.EPS
Replace the following parts in order named. G SF4/SF2 (faulty sensor) G SNS08A board
FR1H0087.EPS
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF1
DC OUT2
SF2
JPS-1
MF1
CNMF1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0086.EPS
MT - 182
MT - 183
CONTENTS
MT - 184
CONTENTS
MT - 185
03D9
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the erasure conveyor normal? Rotate the MF1 driving belts to check that it rotates smoothly. Y Reference: When operating the erasure conveyor by hand, the procedures are facilitated by removing the belt that connects the erasure conveyor and before-side-positioning conveyor. Power OFF Is there any foreign matter under the erasure lamp? Remove the erasure lamp and check the conveyance path. N Remove any foreign matter. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt/belt tension G Roller/grip spring G Conveyor roller/shaft/bearing
Power ON Does MF1 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON N
Power OFF Are the connector connections from MF1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Is SF2/SF3 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SF2 /SF3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SF2/SF3 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y Power OFF N Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2/SF3 normal? N
Power OFF Is SF2/SF3 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SF2/SF3 to DRV08A board normal? Y
FR1H0088.EPS
N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN8
CNF1
AC IN
CN5
SF2
Restart the machine and check its status.
DC OUT2
SF3
JPS-1
MF1
CNMF1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0089.EPS
MT - 184
MT - 185
CONTENTS
MT - 186
CONTENTS
MT - 187
03DC
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive gear of MF1 installed properly? Y Power OFF Is the grip release mechanism of the after-reading conveyor normal? Rotate the cam by hand to check that it rotates smoothly. Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Belt G Grip release mechanism G Shaft/bearing N Install it properly.
Drive gear
Power ON Does ME1 rotate along with the cam during initialization self-diagnostics? Y
FR1H0091.EPS
Power OFF N Are the connector connections from ME1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SNS08A
CN9
CNZ2
SE1
DC OUT2
JPS-1
Is SE1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SE1 status. Block the SE1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" (The sensor status is "close" at the home position.) Y
Replace the following parts in order named. G ME1 G DRV08A board N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SE1 normal? N Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SE1 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
ME1
CNME1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0092.EPS
Restart the machine and check its status. Replace the following parts in order named. G SE1 G SNS08A board
FR1H0094.EPS
MT - 186
MT - 187
CONTENTS
MT - 188
CONTENTS
MT - 189
03DD
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the up-down IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MB3 driving belt of the elevation unit by hand to check that the elevation unit moves up and down smoothly. Y Power OFF Is the actuator that blocks the SA17 light path normal? Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Actuator G Cassette set unit position adjustment G Elevation unit position adjustment Power ON N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Installed condition of drive gear, damage, or wear on it G Shaft/bearing G Slide rails at both ends of elevation unit
Power ON Is MB3 driven with the elevation unit activated during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SA17 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SA17 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SA17 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" N Are the connector connections from MB3 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0095.EPS
Power OFF
N N
Power OFF Is the connector connection from SA17 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
AC IN
CN5
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SA17 normal? Y
DC OUT2
SA17
CNA2 CNB4
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN6
MB3
CNMD3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0096.EPS
MT - 188
MT - 189
CONTENTS
MT - 190
CONTENTS
MT - 191
03DE
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the up-down IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MB3 driving belt of the elevation unit by hand to check that the elevation unit moves up and down smoothly. Y Power OFF Is the actuator that blocks the SB3 light path normal? Y N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Actuator G Cassette set unit position adjustment G Elevation unit position adjustment Power ON N Are the connector connections from MB3 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Installed condition of drive gear, damage, or wear on it G Shaft/bearing G Slide rails at both ends of elevation unit
Power ON Is MB3 driven with the elevation unit activated during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SB3 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB3 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB3 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open"
Power OFF
FR1H0098.EPS
N N
Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB3 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB3 normal? Y
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB3
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
FR1H0100.EPS
MB3
CNMD3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0099.EPS
MT - 190
MT - 191
CONTENTS
MT - 192
CONTENTS
MT - 193
03E8
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the drive system of the IP removal unit normal? Move the suction cups by hand to check that there is nothing abnormal with them. Also rotate the MB1 driving belt by hand to check that the suction cups move smoothly. Y Power ON Does MB1 rotate during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON N N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Installed condition of MB1 G Suction arm (deformation, misaligned parallelism, misaligned phase, loosened screw, etc.) G Shaft/bearing at both ends of IP removal arm G Link arm at both ends of IP removal arm (deformation, foreign matter trapped, etc.) G Side plate (deformation, foreign matter trapped, etc.) Power OFF Are the connector connections from MB1 to DRV08A to DCOUT3 of JPS-1 board normal? Y Replace the following parts in order named. G MB1 G DRV08A board N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Is SB1 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB1 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB1 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y N
Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB1 normal? Y G SB1 sensor position adjustment G Actuator adjustment Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB1 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N
FR1H0101.EPS
Power OFF Is the actuator that blocks the SB1 light path normal? N Make sure that it is free from distortion or twisting.
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB1
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MB1
CNMB1
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0102.EPS
MT - 192
MT - 193
CONTENTS
MT - 194
CONTENTS
MT - 195
13A1
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all.
Power OFF Are the hold pin holes the cassettes normal? Y Power OFF Is the operation of the solenoid arm and hold pin normal? Lower the solenoid arm by hand to check that it strokes properly. Y Power OFF N N Replace the cassette
Power OFF N Is the connector connection between SOLA1-4 (relevant shelf) and DRV08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SA3, 7, 11, 15 Cassette hold sensor SOLA14 Cassette hold solenoid SOLA14 ON :SA3, 7, 11, 15 OPEN SOLA14 OFF:SA3, 7, 11, 15 CLOSE Cassette hold solenoid
Are SOLA1-4 (relevant shelf) turned ON and the hold pin released during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 (relevant shelf) normal? Refer to section 4.6 of the MC volume to perform sensor checks. Y N
Replace the following parts in order named. G SOLA14 (relevant shelf) G DRV08A board Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensors. Power ON again to check the sensors again. Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 normal? Y N
SF3
FR1H0104.EPS
SNS08A
CN6
CNA2
AC IN
CN5
SA3/7/11/15
DC OUT2 CN4 DRV03D CN3 CN2 CNSOLA1 SOLA1
Power OFF Are the connector connections from SA3, 7, 11, and 15 to SNS08A board normal? Y Restart the machine and check its status. Replace the following parts in order named. G SA3, 7, 11, 15 (relevant shelf) G SNS08A board N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN4
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0106.EPS
MT - 194
MT - 195
CONTENTS
MT - 196
CONTENTS
MT - 197
13A2
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all.
Power OFF Are the hold pin holes for all the N cassettes normal? Check to ensure that there is no flash, deformation, or foreign matter. Y Power OFF Is the operation of the solenoid arm and hold pin normal? Lower the solenoid arm by hand to check that it strokes properly. Y Power ON Power OFF Is the fuse NFB1 of the SNS08A N board normal? Y Power OFF Are the connector connections between SOLA1-4 and DRV08A board normal? Y Power OFF Is the fuse (F10) in the power supply unit (JPS-1) nomral? N Replace the following parts. G Fuse (F10) G Power supply unit N Reset the NFB1. N Adjust/replace the solenoid portion.
Are SOLA1-4 turned ON and the hold N pin released during initialization selfdiagnostics? Y
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SF3
FR1H0107.EPS
Power ON Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 normal? Refer to section 4.6 of the MC volume to perform sensor checks.
N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensors. Power ON again to check the sensors again. Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 normal? Y N
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SA3/7/11/15
DC OUT2 CN4 DRV03D CN3 CN2 CNSOLA1 SOLA1
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN4
Power OFF Are the connector connections from SA3, 7, 11, and 15 to SNS08A board normal? Y Restart the machine and check its status. N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
MT - 196
MT - 197
CONTENTS
MT - 198
CONTENTS
MT - 199
13A3
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all.
Power OFF Are the hold pin holes the cassettes normal? Y Power OFF Is the operation of the relevant shelf solenoid arm and hold pin normal? Lower the solenoid arm by hand to check that it strokes properly. Y Power ON Are SOLA1-4 (relevant shelf) turned ON and the hold pin released during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 (relevant shelf) normal? Refer to section 4.6 of the MC volume to perform sensor checks. Y N Replace the following parts in order named. G SOLA14 (relevant shelf) G DRV08A board Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensors. Power ON again to check the sensors again. Are SA3, 7, 11, and 15 normal? Y
SA3, 7, 11, 15 Cassette hold sensor SOLA14 Cassette hold solenoid SOLA14 ON :SA3, 7, 11, 15 OPEN SOLA14 OFF :SA3, 7, 11, 15 CLOSE Cassette hold solenoid
Power OFF N Is the connector connection between SOLA1-4 (relevant shelf) and DRV08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
Power OFF Are the connector connections from SA3, 7, 11, and 15 to SNS08A board normal? Y
FR1H0110.EPS
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SF3
Replace the following parts in order named. G SA3, 7, 11, 15 (relevant shelf) G SNS08A board
FR1H0112.EPS
SNS08A
CN6
CNA2
AC IN
CN5
SA3/7/11/15
DC OUT2 CN4 DRV03D CN3 CN2 CNSOLA1 SOLA1
JPS-1
CN2 CN3 CN4
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
MT - 198
MT - 199
CONTENTS
MT - 200
CONTENTS
MT - 201
13A9
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? G Make sure that it is not curled or bent. G Make sure that the barcode display portion is free of soil. Y
Power OFF Is the BCR reading face normal? Make sure that the BCR reading face is free of soil. Y N Clean the BCR reading face.
Power ON Is the BCR reading face is lit? Make sure that the BCR reading face is lit in red.
FR1H0113.EPS
Power OFF N Are the connector connections from BCR to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
AC IN
CN5
BCR
JPS-1
FR1H0114.EPS
MT - 200
MT - 201
CONTENTS
MT - 202
CONTENTS
MT - 203
13AA/23AA
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all.
START
Y Are the erasure lamps normal? With 4. ELECTRICAL of M-Utility, check for improper erasure lamp illumination. Y N N Is the resistance between the electrode ends of each erasure lamp 20.5 ? Y Are the erasure lamps blackened? Y Replace any bad erasure lamp. N Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) ACOUT2/ACOUT3 and erasure lamp assembly normal? Y N Replace the cable. Replace any bad erasure lamp.
Is +24 V present between power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT terminals 4-1 and 4-3? Y
N Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT4 and thermal switch (TSW1) normal? Y
FR1H0116.EPS
Is +24 V present between power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT terminals 5-1 and 5-2? Y
AC IN
+24V
F5
Are the connector/cable connections among the power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT5, thermal switch (TSW2), and erasure fan (FANF1) normal? Y N Replace the cable. Replace the fuse (F5).
DC OUT4 +24V
TSW1
Is +24 V present between power supply unit (JPS-1) DCOUT terminals 4-2 and 4-3? Y N Is the fan (FANF1) normal? It is normal as far as it operates for temperature control. Y Replace the thermal switch (TSW1). N Is the connector/cable connection between the power supply unit (JPS-1) CN5 and SNS08A board CN13 normal? Y N Replace the following parts: G Fan (FANF1) G Thermal switch (TSW2)
AC OUT1 +24V
DCOUT2
LAMP 15
Inverter AC OUT2
+5V
F13
F1
F3
Replace the SNS08A board. Does the machine operate normally after its restart? Y N To START
FR1H0117.EPS
OK
FR1H0118.EPS
MT - 202
MT - 203
CONTENTS
MT - 204
CONTENTS
MT - 205
13AB
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power ON N Does an error occurs when another IP (IP with different dosage) is used? Y Power ON Is the sensitivity setting proper? Y N From M-Utility, select "2. CONFIGURATION SETTING" and "1. SYSTEM" in sequence to change the sensitivity setting (SFC/SFD). Leave the error-causing IP alone for about 16 hours, and then perform primary erasure before using it.
Replace the following parts in order named. G PMT board G SCN board
FR1H0119.EPS
MT - 204
MT - 205
CONTENTS
MT - 206
CONTENTS
MT - 207
13AC
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power ON Is the relevant ID card is read by the ID terminal? Y N Enter the ID information
Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that the barcode indication is free of soil. Y N Clean the IP barcode indication.
Power OFF Is the BCR reading face normal? Make sure that the BCR reading face is free of soil. Y N Clean the BCR reading face.
FR1H0120.EPS
MT - 206
MT - 207
CONTENTS
MT - 208
CONTENTS
MT - 209
13AD
CAUTION: Before remedying this error, remove the cause of the before-reading error and then troubleshoot the 03B5 error. Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP generation within spec? Make sure that the IP type complies with type V. Y N Replace the IP.
Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that the barcode indication is free of soil. Y N Clean or replace the IP.
Power OFF Is the BCR reading face normal? Make sure that the BCR reading face is free of soil. Y N Clean the BCR reading face.
FR1H0121.EPS
FR1H0122.EPS
MT - 208
MT - 209
CONTENTS
MT - 210
CONTENTS
MT - 211
13AE
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power ON Does the exposure information of the patient correspond to the image processing conditions of the machine? Y N Check the exposure information of the patient and the image processing of the machine, and execute it again.
Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that the barcode indication is free of soil. Y N Clean the IP barcode indication.
Power OFF Is the BCR reading face normal? Make sure that the BCR reading face is free of soil. Y N Clean the BCR reading face.
FR1H0123.EPS
MT - 210
MT - 211
CONTENTS
MT - 212
CONTENTS
MT - 213
13AF
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF N Is the IDT connected properly to the machine? Make sure that the modular jack is Y connected on the machine and IDT sides as appropriate. Y Connect the IDT to the machine and execute it again.
Power OFF N Is the cable connecting between the machine and IDT normal? Make sure that the cable is free of defect. Y Replace the connection cable.
FR1H0124.EPS
MT - 212
MT - 213
CONTENTS
MT - 214
CONTENTS
MT - 215
13E1
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that its sucked surface is not soiled, curled, or bent. Y Power OFF With the cassette set in the relevant shelf, does the cassette cover open properly? Y Power OFF Are the suction cups of the IP removal unit normal? G Check if the suction cups are installed properly. G Check the suction cups for any soil or deformation. Y N Clean/adjust/replace the following parts. G Suction cup rubber G Suction cup hose N Adjust/replace the following parts. G Movable roll G Hold pin G Cassette N Clean or replace the IP.
Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of the IP removal unit normal? G Move the suction cup arm by hand to check that it moves smoothly. Y Power ON Does PB1 rotate during initialization self-diagnostics? N Power OFF Are the connector connections N from PB1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. N
PB1 IP suction
FR1H0125.EPS
Y Power ON Is SB5 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB5 status. Y Power OFF Is SB5 installed normally? Y Power OFF N N
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB5
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
CN2 CN3
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN6
CNB4 CNPB1
PB1
Restart the machine and check its status.
FR1H0126.EPS
Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
FR1H0127.EPS
MT - 214
MT - 215
CONTENTS
MT - 216
CONTENTS
MT - 217
13E2/13E5
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that its sucked surface is not soiled, curled, or bent. Y Power OFF Are the suction cups of the IP removal unit normal? G Check if the suction cups are installed properly. G Check the suction cups for any soil or deformation. Y Power OFF Is the air hose of the IP removal unit normal? G Check if the air hose/hose joint are installed properly. Y N N N Clean or replace the IP.
Clean/adjust/replace the following parts. G Suction cup rubber G Suction cup retaining screw
Power OFF N Is SB5 installed normally? Y Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB5 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate. Install the sensor properly.
FR1H0130.EPS
FR1H0128.EPS
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB5
CNB2
DC OUT2
CN4 DRV03D
JPS-1
FR1H0129.EPS
MT - 216
MT - 217
CONTENTS
MT - 218
CONTENTS
MT - 219
13E3
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that it is not soiled, curled, or bent. Y Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of the IP removal unit normal? Rotate the MB2 driving belt by hand to check that the conveyor roller rotates smoothly. Y Power OFF N Does MB2 rotate along with the conveyor roller during initialization self-diagnostics? Y Power ON Is SB2 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB2 status. With a slip of paper or the like, block the SB2 light path to check that the sensor status is as follows. G Light blocked: "close" G Light transmitted: "open" Y
FR1H0131.EPS
Power OFF Are the connector connections N from MB2 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
MB2
IP transport motor
N Power OFF Remove dust or soil from the sensor. Power ON again to execute sensor monitoring. Is SB2 normal? N Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB2 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
SNS08A
CN7
CNB1
AC IN
CN5
SB2
Y
CNB2
DC OUT2
JPS-1
MB2
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1
FR1H0132.EPS
MT - 218
MT - 219
CONTENTS
MT - 220
CONTENTS
MT - 221
13E4
Preliminary steps: 1. Power OFF the machine and remove the covers. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and if any, remove it all. Power OFF Is the IP normal? Make sure that its sucked surface is not soiled, curled, or bent. Y Power OFF Are the suction cups of the IP removal unit normal? G Check if the suction cups are installed properly. G Check the suction cups for any soil or deformation. Y Power OFF Is the drive mechanism of the IP removal unit normal? G Move the suction cup arm by hand to check that it moves smoothly. Y N N N Clean/replace the IP.
Clean/adjust/replace the following parts. G Suction cup rubber G Suction cup hose
Power OFF Are the connector N connections from PB1 to DRV08A to JPS-1 board normal? Y Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
PB1 IP suction
Y Power ON Is SB5 normal? With "6. MECH" of M-Utility, execute sensor monitoring to check the SB5 status.
FR1H0134.EPS
Y Power OFF
AC IN
CN5
CN CN13
SB5
Power OFF Is the connector connection from SB5 to SNS08A board normal? Y N Check the error-related system block diagram and connect the connectors as appropriate.
JPS-1
CN2 CN3
Restart the machine and check its status. Replace the following parts in order named. G SB5 G SNS08A board
DRV08A
DC OUT3 CN1 CN6
CNB4 CNPB1
FR1H0136.EPS
PB1
FR1H0135.EPS
MT - 220
MT - 221
CONTENTS
MT - 222
CONTENTS
MT - 223
Replace the cable. Service Parts List volume, 15. Connection Diagrams
Frame
Replace the cable. Service Parts List volume, 15. Connection Diagrams
OK
FR1H4050.EPS
Digital tester
FR1H7007.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The cable is said to be in a ground fault condition when its conductor is in contact with the frame due to cable covering breakage. In this situation, there is electrical continuity between the frame and cable connector pins.
Cable
Digital tester
FR1H7006.EPS
Digital tester
FR1H7008.EPS
MT - 222
MT - 223
CONTENTS
MT - 224
CONTENTS
MT - 225
LED08A VOL08A
LED08B
Adjust the PC board switch settings.
Are the results of PC board selfdiagnostic checks normal? With 4. ELECTRICAL of M-Utility, perform self-diagnostic checks of the following boards: G IMG08A G IMG08B/H G DMC08A G IMG07B G HCP08A G MMC09A G DIM08A Y
FR
ON
17. PC Boards in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N Are PC board fuses normal? Y 17. PC Boards in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N
SCN08A
Replace fuses as needed. 17. PC Boards in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
DRV08A
PMT08A
SNS08A
Check the power supply unit. 2.4.5 Power Supply Unit Check Flow
Are normal output voltages delivered to the PC boards? Y 6. Power Supply Fuse System Diagram
Are the cables connected to the PC boards normal? Y Disconnect and reconnect the PC boards and connectors. Y Does the machine operate normally after its restart? Y OK
BCR08A
N Replace PC boards as needed. 17. PC Boards in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
FR1H4051.EPS
FFM
F N RO T
FR1H4058.EPS
MT - 224
MT - 225
CONTENTS
MT - 226
CONTENTS
MT - 227
BLANK PAGE
Set the HDD short pins properly. 11.1 Setting HDD in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +5 V present between the HDD CNJ2-3 and CNJ 2-4? Y N 1.6 Power Supply Fuse System Diagram in Machine Description
Are the HDD test results normal? With 4. ELECTRICAL of M-Utility, perform a HDD test. Y
Is the cable between the HDD CNJ2 and MTH08A board CN25 normal? Y
Check the MTH08C board. 7.41 PC Board Check Flow Is the cable between the HDD CNJ1 and MTH08A board CN22 normal? Y N Replace the cable. 13. Connection Diagram in Service Parts List
Format the HDD and install the software. Y Appendix 1. Installing Software in Maintenance Utility
Replace the HDD. 11.2 Replacing HDD in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
To START
OK
OK
FR1H4052.EPS
MT - 226
MT - 227
CONTENTS
MT - 228
CONTENTS
A
MT - 229
13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F11 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F11 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is fuse F13 in the power supply unit normal? Y N
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is +24 V1.2 V present between DC OUT3 terminals 5 and 10? Y N
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace fuse F13 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace fuse F12 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +15 V0.75 V present between DC OUT3 terminals 1 and 6? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N Replace fuse F2 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is +24 V1.2 V present between DC OUT5 terminals 1 and 2? Y
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F2 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Is fuse F5 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F5 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +24 V1.2 V present between DC OUT3 terminals 2 and 7? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts N
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +5 V0.75 V present between DC OUT6 terminals 1 and 5? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F9 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F9 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F1 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +24 V1.2 V present between DC OUT3 terminals 3 and 8? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y 5. Machine Circuit Diagram N N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace fuse F1 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
FR1H4054.EPS
Is fuse F10 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F10 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
FR1H4053.EPS
MT - 228
MT - 229
CONTENTS
B
MT - 230
CONTENTS
MT - 231
DCOUT6 DCOUT7
DCOUT2 DCOUT1
DCOUT3
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
2 1
4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TB2
Is fuse F7 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F7 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
DCOUT4 DCOUT5
3 2 1
2 1
+
1 3
ACOUT4 ACOUT2
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +15 V0.75 V present between DC OUT6 terminals 7 and 3? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 11 5 12 6
G
4
FR1H7005.EPS
Is fuse F8 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F8 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +24 V1.2 V present between DC OUT6 terminals 4 and 8? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y 5. Machine Circuit Diagram N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F6 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F6 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
CN4
1 2 3 4
FR1H7004.EPS
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +15 V0.75 V present between DC OUT7 terminals 1 and 3? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y 5. Machine Circuit Diagram N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is fuse F3 in the power supply unit normal? 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Y
Replace fuse F3 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +5 V0.25 V present between DC OUT7 terminals 2 and 4? Y N Is the voltage adjustment made? Y N 13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses Y in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts To START Replace the power supply unit.
Replace fuse F4 in the power supply unit. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
OK
13.1 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
FR1H4055.EPS
MT - 230
MT - 231
CONTENTS
MT - 232
CONTENTS
MT - 233
VGA90E
Is +12 V present between monitor CN1 terminals 1 and 2? Y Is the cable between fuse F1 and monitor CN1 normal? Y N Replace the cable. 13 CONNECTION DIAGRAM in Service Parts List N Is the fuse normal? Y N 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
VOL08A CN2
CN7
CN19
CN4 CN1
Replace fuse F1. 13.2 Power Supply Unit Fuses in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is +12 V present between power supply unit DCOUT terminals 2 and 4? Y N Replace the power supply unit. 13.1 Power Supply Unit (JPS-6) in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Is the cable between fuse F1 and power supply unit DCOUT1 normal? Y
FR1H4057.EPS
Replace the monitor. 14.1 CRT (Monitor) in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Is the cable between the monitor CN2 and CPU90E board CN7 normal? Y N Replace the cable. 13 CONNECTION DIAGRAM in Service Parts List
Is the cable between the monitor CN4 and CPU90E board CN19 normal? Y
Replace the CPU90E board. 15.3 CPU90E board in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Replace the cable. 13 CONNECTION DIAGRAM in Service Parts List
Is the cable between the monitor CN3 and VOL08A board CN2 normal? Y
Replace the VOL08A board. 15.12 VOL08A board in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
Replace the monitor. 14.1 CRT (Monitor) in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts
FR1H4056.EPS
MT - 232
MT - 233
CONTENTS
MT - 234
CONTENTS
6
Reference to IP removal procedure I IP Jam Locations and Detailed Procedures for IP Jam Removal" I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 4/5/6 ? ? I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 4/5/6 ? I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 7/8/9/10 I Remedy 7/8/9/10 I Remedy 7/8/9/10 I Remedy 7/8/9/10 I Remedy 3/4/5/10 I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 7/8/9/10 I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4
TR1H1019.EPS
MT - 235
2.5
CAUTIONS
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged. Before returning a jammed IP to the machine, thoroughly make sure that the IP is not scratched, scaled off, or seriously warped due to rubbing. Do not leave a jammed IP bent in the conveyance path for prolonged periods of time because machine malfunction or IP breakage may occur. IP conveyance checkout must be performed after the machine is restored to normal with a jammed IP removed.
03B0 03B1 03B2 03B3 03B4 03B5 03B6 IP feed/load conveyor remaining IP discharge impossible IP feed conveyance error IP load conveyance error Side-positioning conveyor entrance conveyance error Restored IP load low-speed conveyance error Restored IP load high-speed conveyance error IP feed/load conveyor remaining IP discharge error Side-positioning conveyor remaining IP discharge error IP position information error IP load standby unit remaining IP discharge error Side-positioning HP operation error Side-positioning grip operation error IP reading conveyance error Reading IP leading-edge detection error Drive shaft grip error Driven shaft grip release error Drive shaft grip release error Driven shaft grip error Drive shaft grip self-diagnosis error Driven shaft grip release self-diagnosis error Post-conveyor error Pre-erasure conveyance error Branch path selector guide operation error Erasure conveyance error Post-erasure conveyance error Junction path selector guide operation error Post-conveyor remaining IP discharge error Erasure conveyor remaining IP discharge error Post-conveyor grip operation error HP up-and-down movement error Up-and-down movement error Suction cup moving error IP leading-edge detection error 1 Cassette hold release error Cassette shelf error
I Removing a Jammed IP
When an IP jam error occurs, you should basically complete the following procedure. (1) Turn OFF the machine. (2) Turn the machine back ON. The initialization sequence is performed. (3) Check whether the jammed IP is discharged in the initialization sequence. G When the IP is not discharged Perform steps (4) and beyond. G When the IP is discharged Check for improper IP conveyance. 2.6 Checking for Improper IP Conveyance (4) Note the error code and remove the IP in a manner appropriate for the error encountered. The tables on the subsequent pages indicate the relationship between the displayed error codes and IP removal procedures. Note the tables to determine the IP removal procedures to be performed. Remove the IP as directed under I IP Jam Locations and Detailed Procedures for IP Jam Removal. (5) Restore the machine to normal. (6) Check for improper IP conveyance. 2.6 Checking for Improper IP Conveyance
03B7 03B8 03B9 03BC 03BF 03C1 03C2 03C6 03C7 03C8 03C9 03CA 03CB 03D1 03D3 03D4 03D5 03D6 03D7 03D8 03D9 03DC 03DD 03DE 03E8 0538 13A2 13A3
MT - 234
MT - 235
CONTENTS
MT - 236
Reference to IP removal procedure I IP Jam Locations and Detailed Procedures for IP Jam Removal" I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 ? ? I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 4/5/6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 I Remedy 6 ? I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 6/7 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4 I Remedy 1/2/3/4
TR1H1020.EPS
CONTENTS
MT - 237
Error code
Error name
13A8 13AD 13AE 13B8 13E1 13E2 13E3 13E4 13E5 23A1 23A2 23A3 23A9 23BA 23BB 23BC 23BD 23BE 23BF 23C5 23C6 23C7 23C8 23C9 23D2 23DA 23DB 23DC 23DE 23E1 23E4 23E6 23E7 23E8
Out-of-spec IP size IP with improper generation/type detected No relevant MPM code IP position information error Feed IP suction error Feed IP dropped Feed IP grip error Load IP suction error Load IP dropped Cassette hold failure retry Cassette hold release failure retry Degeneration for relevant cassette shelf Barcode read retry Side-positioning HP detection retry Side-positioning HP detection preparation retry Side-positioning operation error Side-positioning grip HP detection retry Side-positioning grip HP detection preparation retry Side-positioning grip operation error FFM drive W.F. disorder Driving shaft grip operation error Driven shaft grip release operation error Driving shaft grip drive speed correction error Driven shaft grip release drive speed correction error Conveyance sensor error After-reading grip HP detection retry After-reading grip HP detection preparation retry After-reading grip operation error Elevation shelf movement error Feed IP suction failure retry Load IP suction failure retry Suction cup HP detection preparation retry Suction cup HP detection retry Suction cup HP return error
FRONT
I Remedy 1
I Remedy 2
I Remedy 8 Cassette set unit I Remedy 7 I Remedy 4 I Remedy 9 I Remedy 10 Erasure conveyor
Before-side-positioning conveyor
I Remedy 6
FR1H1391.EPS
MT - 236
MT - 237
CONTENTS
MT - 238
CONTENTS
MT - 239
I Remedy 1
Jam location: Cause: IP status: a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. Ga (1) Remove the upper front cover. (2) Remove the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (3) Rotate the up-down IP removal unit rollers by hand to remove the IP Gb (1) Remove the upper front cover and cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (2) Pull out the tray of cassette set unit and remove the IP. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts Cassette set unit or up-down IP removal unit Removal failure or loading failure
I Remedy 2
Jam location: Cause: IP status: The IP leading edge or trailing edge has not reached the before-sidepositioning conveyor. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Ga Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the upper front cover. (2) Remove the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (3) Rotate the up-down IP removal unit rollers by hand to remove the IP. Gb Gain access from the front, right-hand, or left-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the upper front cover. (2) Pull out the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (3) Remove the up-down conveyance guide of the up-down IP removal unit to take out the IP. Up-down IP removal unit Conveyance failure
MT - 238
MT - 239
CONTENTS
MT - 240
CONTENTS
MT - 241
I Remedy 3
Jam location: Cause: IP status: A certain portion of the jammed IP is located in the up-down IP removal unit with the remaining portion placed in the before-side-positioning conveyor. Therefore, these two units cannot be pulled out. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Ga Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the right-hand side cover. (2) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor drive shaft by hand to convey the IP to the up-down IP removal unit. (3) Remove the upper front cover. (4) Pull out the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (5) Rotate the up-down IP removal unit rollers by hand to remove the IP. Gb Gain access from the rear or right-hand side of the machine (1) Remove the rear cover from the machine. (2) Remove the rear guide from the before-side-positioning conveyor. (3) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand to remove the IP. Up-down IP removal unit or before-side-positioning conveyor Conveyance failure
I Remedy 4
Jam location: Cause: IP status: A certain portion of the jammed IP is located in the up-down IP removal unit with the remaining portions placed in the before-side-positioning conveyor and in the side-positioning conveyor. Therefore, these three units cannot be pulled out. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Ga Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the right-hand side cover. (2) Release the side-positioning conveyor grip. (3) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand to convey the IP to the updown IP removal unit. (4) Remove the upper front cover. (5) Pull out the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (6) Rotate the up-down IP removal unit rollers by hand to remove the IP. Gb Gain access from the rear or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the rear cover. (2) Remove the rear guide from the before-side-positioning conveyor. (3) Release the side-positioning conveyor grip. (4) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand to remove the IP. Up-down IP removal unit, before-side-positioning conveyor, or sidepositioning conveyor Conveyance failure
MT - 240
MT - 241
CONTENTS
MT - 242
CONTENTS
MT - 243
I Remedy 5
Jam location: Cause: IP status: A certain portion of the jammed IP is located in the before-sidepositioning conveyor with the remaining portion placed in the sidepositioning conveyor. Therefore, these two units cannot be pulled out. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Ga Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the upper front cover. (2) Pull out the tray of cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (3) Release the side-positioning conveyor grip. (4) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand to remove the IP from the top (frame slit) of the before-side-positioning conveyor. Gb Gain access from the rear or right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the rear cover. (2) Remove the rear guide from the before-side-positioning conveyor. (3) Release the side-positioning conveyor grip. (4) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand to remove the IP. Before-side-positioning conveyor or side-positioning conveyor Conveyance failure
I Remedy 7
Jam location: Cause: IP status: A certain portion of the jammed IP is located in the after-reading conveyor with the remaining portion placed in the erasure conveyor. Therefore, these two units cannot be pulled out. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. Ga (1) Rotate the rollers in the after-reading conveyor and erasure conveyor by hand to position the entire IP in the after-reading conveyor. The alternative is to manually release the after-reading conveyor roller grip and then rotate the erasure conveyor rollers by hand to position the entire IP in the after-reading conveyor. (2) Remove the right-hand side cover. (3) Pull out the scanner unit and take out the IP. If you cannot directly access the IP in the subscanning unit, first remove the lightcollecting guide and then the IP. Gb (1) Manually release the after-reading conveyor roller grip. (2) Remove the erasure conveyor front guide and then manually convey the IP until it is entirely positioned in the after-reading conveyor. After-reading conveyor or erasure conveyor Conveyance failure
I Remedy 8
Jam location: Cause: Erasure conveyor Conveyance failure The IP is stopped at a position immediately before the erasure conveyor switchback point. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. The same recovery procedure is to be performed no matter whether the IP status is a or b. (1) Remove the front guide from the erasure conveyor. (2) Remove the IP by pulling it forward until it comes of the machine.
I Remedy 6
Jam location: Cause: IP status: a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: The same recovery procedure is to be performed no matter whether the IP is stopped in the side-positioning conveyor, subscanning unit, or after-reading conveyor. Gain access from the right-hand side of the machine. (1) Remove the right-hand side cover from the machine. (2) Pull out the scanner unit and then remove the IP. If the IP in the subscanning unit cannot directly be accessed, first remove the lightcollecting guide and then the IP. Side-positioning conveyor, subscanning unit, or after-reading conveyor Conveyance failure
IP status:
MT - 242
MT - 243
CONTENTS
MT - 244
CONTENTS
MT - 245
I Remedy 9
Jam location: Cause: IP status: The IP is stopped at a position immediately after the erasure conveyor switchback point. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Gain access from the front of the machine. Ga (1) Rotate the erasure conveyor rollers by hand to convey the IP to a position immediately before the temporary standby position. (2) Remove the front guide from the erasure conveyor. (3) Remove the IP by pulling it forward until it comes of the machine. Gb (1) Remove the guide from the top of the erasure conveyor temporary standby section. (2) Remove the IP by pulling it forward until it comes of the machine. Erasure conveyor Conveyance failure
2.6
I Items to Be Prepared
Provide on hand the IP cassettes of the following sizes and their corresponding IPs. 14" x 14" (35cm x 35cm) 14" x 17" (35cm x 43cm) 10" x 12" (24cm x 30cm) 8" x 10" (18cm x 24cm) (18 cm x 24 cm mammo) Required only when the mammo type is in use.
I Checkout Procedure
(1) Turn ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The display switches to the U-Utility screen. (3) Sequentially touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel. M-Utility starts.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
I Remedy 10
Jam location: Cause: IP status: Before-side-positioning conveyor or erasure conveyor Conveyance failure
Read
Date/time setup
A certain portion of the jammed IP is located in the before-sidepositioning conveyor with the remaining portion placed in the erasure conveyor. Therefore, these two units cannot be pulled out. a) The IP cannot be conveyed forward but can be conveyed backward. b) The IP cannot be conveyed forward or backward. Recovery procedure: Gain access from the front or right-hand side of the machine. The same recovery procedure is to be performed no matter whether the IP status is a or b. (1) Reach into the side plate hole in the before-side-positioning conveyor and properly position the IP (so that it can be conveyed forward). (2) Pull out the up-down IP removal unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit in Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment of Parts (3) Rotate the before-side-positioning conveyor rollers by hand and remove the IP from the top of the before-side-positioning conveyor.
Click sound
2 3
CRT test pattern display 8" x 10" film reduced output setup
FD operation
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1086.EPS
MT - 244
MT - 245
CONTENTS
MT - 246
CONTENTS
MT - 247
(4) Sequentially select 3. TEST MODE, 2. AUTO MODE, and 2. PRIMARY ERASURE. A message appears to prompt for IP conveyance count input. (5) Set the IP conveyance count to 10. (6) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility.
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >3 0.QUIT 1.ROUTINE 2.AUTO MODE TM > 2 0.QUIT 1.READING & ERASURE 2.PRIMARY ERASURE 3.SECONDARY ERASURE TM:AM > 2 0 - 99999 : 10
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
(7) Position the following four types (five types if a mammo type is included) of cassettes on arbitrary shelves. IP conveyance starts. 14" x 14" (35 cm x 35 cm) 14" x 17" (35 cm x 43 cm) 10" x 12" (24 cm x 30 cm) 8" x 10" (18 cm x 24 cm) (18 cm x 24 cm mammo) (8) Conduct the following checks during IP conveyance. Check that the machine does not emit any abnormal sound or odor. Check that the IPs are conveyed in the order of cassette positioning. Check that the erasure lamp cooling fan (FANF1) operates. (9) After completion of IP conveyance, remove all the cassettes to verify that the IPs are not scratched. (10) Change the positional relationships between the cassettes and shelves, and then repeat steps (7) through (9). The machine comes to an automatic stop when it repeats the IP conveyance sequence 10 times. (11) Remove the cassettes. (12) Press the reset button. The machine restarts and becomes ready for normal use.
Caps
FR1H1822.EPS
MT - 246
MT - 247
CONTENTS
MT - 248
CONTENTS
MT - 249
3.
(2) With reference to the examples of abnormal images described in this section, take remedial action as appropriate in accordance with <Probable Causes> and <Check and Reference>. (3) Use the virtual image generation mode (quasi-reading) to analyze the cause of the abnormal image. Perform image reading by generating quasi-image signals from various portions of the scanner. Based on the results of the virtual image generation mode, isolate the cause of the abnormal image. 10.10 Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal in Maintenance Utility
Result of virtual image generation mode Isolation of problem Probable cause
Optics (including the laser) Light-collecting guide/light-collecting mirror The cause of the problem is present Subscanning before the IP-generated light enters X-ray source the photomultiplier. (The IP-generated IP light is already abnormal.) Conveyors Erasure failure Extraneous noise to the laser, etc. The cause of the problem is present between light admittance to the photomultiplier and photomultiplier current output (to the PMT board). Alternatively, it is present in the highvoltage applied to the photomultiplier. Photomultiplier High-voltage power supply (located on the PMT board) Erasure or extraneous leak light Optical noise due to electrostatic buildup on the IP Magnetic noise SCN08A board PMT board Extraneous electric noise to the PMT board (static noise on the IP, power supply noise, motor noise, etc.) Cables between PMT board and SCN board SCN08A board Extraneous electric noise to the SCN08A board (electric noise, motor noise, etc.) Image-related boards after SCN08 (IMG board, etc.) Cables to such boards
TR1H1303.EPS
Troubleshoot the scanner unit. "3.1 Image Troubleshooting for Scanner Unit"
An abnormal image occurs with LIGHT, but not with LOG AMP.
An abnormal image occurs with LIGHT and LOG AMP, but not with SCN08 INPUT.
The cause of the problem is present between PMT board input and SCN board input.
END
FR1H1519.EPS
3.1
An abnormal image occurs with LIGHT, LOG AMP, and SCN08 INPUT.
The cause of the problem is present in the image signal lines after image signal input for the SCN board.
I Procedures
(1) Check the error log for the time when the abnormal image occurred. View the error log to check for any error whose occurrence time indicated in its detail information corresponds to the time when the abnormal image occurred. 23BA-23BE: Error codes for the subscanning mechanism 2500s: Error codes for the scanner mechanism If an error is found, take remedial action as appropriate with reference to the probable cause and troubleshooting procedures described in the error code list. 6.1 Displaying Error Log: 1. LIST in Maintenance Utility
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The detail information format of the error code contains chronological information, from the time when image reading started to the time when an error occurred. Reference should be made as needed to this detail information format.
N NOTE N
An error for the scanner subscanning mechanism that does not accompany any abnormal image need not be analyzed or troubleshot, and thus be ignored.
MT - 248
MT - 249
CONTENTS
MT - 250
CONTENTS
MT - 251
<Probable Cause> Operation of the driving-side grip motor (MZ2) or driven-side grip motor (MZ3) is improper.
Horizontal streaks are developed about 40 mm from the top edge and about 30 mm from the bottom edge.
40
<Check and Reference> <Check and Reference> Check if an error (2545: HV voltage error 2) occurs concurrently with the abnormal image. Note, however, that it will not be detected if the noise is minuscule.
30
Unit: mm
FR1H1852.EPS
FR1H1850.EPS
<Probable Cause>
No. 102
Banding-like streaks are developed such that intermittent thin horizontal streaks appear with a gradual inclination to the main-scan direction (from upper left to lower right).
<Probable Cause> Leaked rays of light externally coming into the machine may fall on the scanner unit. (Improper installation of covers to the machine, especially the lower front cover, improper installation of the light-tight members around the light-collecting guide assembly, etc.)
No. 104
60
<Check and Reference> Check for interference between the subscanning turn guide plate and the center guide plate.
Unit: mm
FR1H1853.EPS
FR1H1851.EPS
MT - 250
MT - 251
CONTENTS
MT - 252
<Probable Causes> The PMT08A board is faulty. The subscanning motor and subscanning mechanism are faulty. The subscanning motor is faulty. The polygonal mirror assembly is faulty.
CONTENTS
MT - 253
<Probable Causes> The high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board and the software switch are in the OFF position. The PMT08A board is faulty.
No. 105
No. 107
Blank image
70
<Check and Reference> Check if a scanner error (2500's) or wow-flutter error (23C5) occurred when the abnormal image occurred. Use the virtual image generation mode to isolate the cause. "10.10 Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal" in Maintenance Utility
Unit: mm
FR1H1854.EPS
<Check and Reference> Set the SCN08A boards high-voltage switch (S1) and the software switch in the ON position. Checking SCN08A Board Checking PMT08A Board
FR1H1856.EPS
No. 106
Horizontal streaks are developed over the entire surface at a pitch of 0.6 mm.
<Probable Causes> Proper shading correction has not been performed. 3. SHADING/POLYGON CORRECTION is turned OFF. The polygonal mirror is soiled.
No. 108
<Probable Causes> The connector (CN2) is not connected to the PMT08A board. The connector (CN5) is not connected to the SCN08A board. Quasi-reading mode is set.
<Check and Reference> Perform shading correction properly. Set 3. SHADING/POLYGON CORRECTION to ON. Replace the polygonal mirror. 9.5 Checking and Replacing Polygon Assembly
<Check and Reference> Connect the unplugged connector to the PMT08A board or SCN08A board. Cancel the quasi-reading mode.
FR1H1855.EPS
FR1H1857.EPS
MT - 252
MT - 253
CONTENTS
MT - 254
<Probable Causes> Relatively thin streak Dust deposited on the light-collecting guide or light-collecting mirror may block the laser beam. Relatively thick streak The light-collecting guide is faulty; shading correction is improper; the lens mirror (especially, the dust window) of the scanning optics unit is soiled.
CONTENTS
MT - 255
3.2
No. 109
No. 201
Although the film characters and border are outputted normally, an image itself is not generated.
<Check and Reference> Remove the dust deposits using a blower. Clean the light-collecting guide or light-collecting mirror. "Cleaning Light-Collecting Guide and LightCollecting Mirror" Perform shading correction properly. Thin streak Thick streak
FR1H1858.EPS
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board. SCN08A Board Check connection between each of the SCN08A, IMG07B, IMG08A, IMG08B, IMG08C, and MTH08A boards and their corresponding connectors. Use the virtual image generation mode to isolate the cause. "10.10 Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal" in Maintenance Utility
FR1H1860.EPS
No. 303
Jitters
<Probable Causes> The rotation of the polygon is improper. The incident beam of the SYN08A board is misaligned. Decrease in the laser power.
No. 202
<Probable Cause> The IMG08A board is faulty (the unsharp mask memory is faulty).
Sync is misaligned by one or several pixels in the main-scan direction. Such jitters may sometimes occur in the middle of the scan line.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate that any board is faulty, then replace that board. "Replacing SYN08A Assembly" If the error (polygon error 2: 2542) occurred simultaneously, check and replace the polygonal mirror assembly.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board.
FR1H1859.EPS
FR1H1861.EPS
MT - 254
MT - 255
CONTENTS
MT - 256
<Probable Cause> The IMG08A board is faulty.
CONTENTS
MT - 257
<Probable Cause> Any of the SCN08A, IMG07B, IMG08A, IMG08B, IMG08C, and MTH08A boards is faulty.
No. 203
No. 205
Although IP conveyance is normal and the film characters are outputted normally, the image and border are not generated.
Although the film characters and border are outputted normally, the image itself is not generated properly, with the same data appearing continuously in the vertical direction.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board. SCN08A Board
FR1H1862.EPS
FR1H1864.EPS
No. 204
<Probable Cause> The contents of the memory containing enlargement/reduction ratios in the IMG08A board is corrupted.
No. 206
<Probable Causes> The Kanji ROM on the CPU90E board and/or the font file is corrupted. The memory on the IMG08A board is faulty.
A full image in each size of 14" x 17" (35cm x 43cm), 14" x 14" (35cm x 35cm), and 10" x 12" (18cm x 24cm), as well as a two-in-one image of 8" x 10" (18cm x 24cm) size, is disturbed.
Although the image and border are outputted normally, the film characters are not generated properly.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board. Replacing and Adjusting CPU90E Board
FR1H1863.EPS
FR1H1865.EPS
MT - 256
MT - 257
CONTENTS
MT - 258
<Probable Cause> The CPU90E board and/or MTH08A board is faulty.
CONTENTS
MT - 259
3.3
No. 207
No. 301
Although the film characters, border, and image are outputted normally, only a portion of film characters consisting of Japanese text is disturbed.
One pixel or several pixels in one line have a markedly lower density, so white spots or speckles are developed. Regular patterns of such white spots or speckles frequently appear. <Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board. Replacing and Adjusting CPU90E Board
<Check and Reference> Use the virtual image generation mode to isolate the cause. "10.10 Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal" in Maintenance Utility
FR1H1866.EPS
No. 208
Halos
<Probable Cause> Any of the SCN08A, IMG07B, IMG08A, IMG08B, IMG08C, and MTH08A board is faulty or image signal cable on the board is faulty.
FR1H1868.EPS
No. 302
Multiple halos are developed outside the proper contour of the image. Black spots or speckles are developed randomly over the entire image. The black spots come in various sizes, such as those extending over several vertical lines, or as small as one line.
<Probable Cause> An IP that has been stored unused outside the machine for a long period of time (one week or longer) might have been used without secondary erasure.
<Check and Reference> Reset the machine, or power OFF the machine and then back ON again, to perform selfdiagnostics during machine initialization. If the results of the self-diagnostics indicate an error, replace the relevant board and cable. SCN08A Board
FR1H1867.EPS
FR1H1869.EPS
MT - 258
MT - 259
CONTENTS
MT - 260
<Probable Causes> The position of the scanning optics unit is improper (in the main-scan direction). The side-positioning operation is improper. The irradiation field is improper. The parameter for adjusting the main-scan format is improper.
CONTENTS
MT - 261
<Probable Causes> The side-positioning operation is improper. The side-positioning location is improper. The subscanning unit and side-positioning unit are misaligned. The subscanning grip is unbalanced. The side-positioning conveyance grip is unbalanced.
No. 304
No. 306
Format slanting
FR1H1870.EPS
FR1H1872.EPS
No. 305
<Probable Causes> The IP feed by FFM (MZ1) is improper when the IP is fed into the subscanning unit. The IP leading-edge sensor (SZ1) is faulty. The rpm of the FFM (MZ1) is improper. The irradiation field is improper.
FR1H1871.EPS
MT - 260
MT - 261
CONTENTS
MT - 262
CONTENTS
MT - 263
4.
4.1
4.2
Replace the following parts in order named. G DRV08A board G SOLA1 4 I Cassette Removal (Standard Procedures) Step 1: Remove the upper right-hand side cover of the machine. Step 2: Push up the cassette hold bracket for the shelf to be released. Its lock pin is released. Step 3: With the cassette hold bracket pushed up, pull out the cassette. Step 4: Reinstall the upper right-hand side cover of the machine. I Cassette Removal (Simple Procedures) If the IP has been put back completely into the cassette and if it can be verified that the solenoid operation is faulty, then insert the cassette hold release tools into the four small holes located on the upper right-hand side cover of the machine to release it without removing any cover of the machine.
Step 3 Are systems other than 100V and 24V normal? + 5V, + 12V, + 15V, and 15V systems
FR1H0137.EPS
MT - 262
MT - 263
CONTENTS
MT - 264
CONTENTS
MT - 265
4.3
4.4
Preliminary step 2: 1. Remove the covers of the machine. 2. Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board. 3. Check for any foreign matter (lead character marking chips, etc.) inside the machine, and, if any, remove it all.
FR1H0139.EPS
Step 1 Are the boards set in the board rack correctly? Y Step 2 Are the DIP switches and jumpers set correctly? Y Step 3 Is the memory set in the CPU90E board correctly? Y N Set it correctly. Then, restart the machine and check its status. N Set them correctly. Then, restart the machine and check its status. N Set them correctly. Then, restart the machine and check its status.
Replace the following boards. G MTH08A G CPU90E G CPU90F + ETH90F G DMC80A/HCP08A G IMG08A + IMG08B/H + IMG07B G SNS08A G DRV08A G SCN08A G JPS-1
FR1H0140.EPS
MT - 264
MT - 265
CONTENTS
MT - 266
4.5
Reading resolution
Main scan Subscan Standard Main scan High-res Standard Subscan High-res Standard
10 10 5 10 5 10 1760x2140 3520x4280
Output resolution
No. of pixels High-res Subscan speed Reading time Main scan frequency Sampling time For scanner reading Gray level Output after image processing
MT - 266
CONTENTS
MT - 267
BLANK PAGE
MT - 267
5.
CONTENTS
RED BLK WHT GRN Green/yellow spiral (Housing near the JPS-1 housing) RED BLK BLK
/D / 113Y1555
BLK
BLK (Housing near the JPS-1 housing) RED BLK RED BLK (Housing near the rack) RED BLK
2 3 4
/137S1319
BRN RED ORG YEL GRN RED BLK
RED BLK
RED BLK
RED BLK RED BLK RED BLK RED BLK RED BLK
BRN RED ORG YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORG YEL GRN BLUE RED BLK RED BLK BLUE BLK RED BLK RED BLK RED BLK BLUE BLK RED BLK
MT - 268
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS
/D
/
113Y1555
Signal name
Signal name
3 4
MT - 269
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS
/D
/
113Y1555
Signal name
BRN RED ORG YEL BRN RED ORG YEL
Signal name
2 3
4 5
BLK RED
BLK YEL
MT - 270
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS
/D
/
113Y1555
BRN RED ORG YEL BRN RED ORG YEL Signal name Signal name
3 4
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
MT - 271
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS
Signal name
Signal name
2 3 4 5
Signal name
Signal name
RED BLK
RED BLK
Signal name
BRN RED ORG YEL BRN RED ORG YEL
Signal name
(add-on option)
Signal name
Signal name
MT - 272
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5
RED BLK
RED BLK
MT - 273
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Panel
Signal name RED BLK YEL RED RED BLK YEL RED Signal name
CONTENTS
Touch panel
2 3
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
Signal name
YEL GRN
(Japanese) (English)
(Indent)
(Reserved)
MT - 274
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS 1 2
WHT
MT - 275
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
CONTENTS
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED
ORN YEL
2 3
PUR
MT - 276
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
BRN RED
BRN RED
BRN RED
BRN RED
RED BLK
RED BLK
Cassette IN sensor
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
RED BLK
RED BLK
Mammo/ST sensor
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
RED BLK
RED BLK
Cassette IN sensor
PUR GRAY
PUR GRAY
PUR GRAY
PUR GRAY
RED BLK
RED BLK
Mammo/ST sensor
WHT BLK
WHT BLK
WHT BLK
WHT BLK
RED BLK
RED BLK
Cassette IN sensor
BRN RED
BRN RED
BRN RED
BRN RED
RED BLK
RED BLK
Mammo/ST sensor
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
ORN YEL
RED BLK
RED BLK
Cassette IN sensor
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
GRN BLUE
RED BLK
RED BLK
Mammo/ST sensor
Cassette hold
Cassette hold
Cassette hold
Cassette hold
MT - 277
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5
MT - 278
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
# 5001 or later
RED BLK
RED BLK
IP conveyance motor
RED BLK
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK BLK
BLK BLK
RED BLK
RED BLK
IP suction
BLK RED
BLK RED
RED BLK
RED BLK
IP leak
(Elevation unit)
MT - 279
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
# 5000 or earlier
RED BLK
RED BLK
IP conveyance motor
RED BLK
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK BLK
BLK BLK
BLK RED
BLK RED
IP suction
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
IP leak
(Elevation unit)
MT - 280
MT - 280
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Drafted by Inoue
Checked by Morikawa
Approved by Yamada
Page
CONTENTS 1
WHT
ORN YEL
GRN BLUE
MT - 281
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS 1 2
IP conveyance motor
4 5
RED BLK
IP conveyance motor
MT - 282
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
WHT WHT
1 2
BLK RED
RED RED
WHT WHT
WHT WHT
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT
Socket assembly
WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT
WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT WHT
Socket assembly
MT - 283
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
# 5001 or later
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY RED BRN PUR ORN GRN BLUE
CONTENTS
GRAY GRAY
GRAY GRAY
RED GRN
RED GRN
GRAY GRAY
GRAY GRAY
GRAY WHT
GRAY WHT
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
3 4
Side-positioning motor
IP conveyance motor
MT - 284
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
# 5000 or earlier
BCR08A
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY
CONTENTS
G SEI:341A062
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY
1 2
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED
3 4
Sidepositioning IP sensor
Side-positioning motor
IP conveyance motor
MT - 285
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Drafted by Inoue
Checked by Morikawa
Approved by Yamada
Page
CONTENTS
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL BRN GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL BRN GRAY WHT BLK ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY GRN BLUE PUR GRAY Driven grip release, HP sensor BRN RED ORN YEL Driving grip release, HP sensor
1 2 3 4 5
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL
MT - 286
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK
BRN RED ORN YEL GRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK GRN BLUE PUR GRAY GRN BLUE PUR GRAY
1 2 3 4
BRN ORN
IP conveyance motor
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
BLK RED
MT - 287
Model
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
Code
Page
CONTENTS
Signal name
BRN RED ORN YEL BRN RED ORN YEL
Signal name
3 4
(LDD base)
BRN RED ORN YEL BRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK BRN RED ORN YEL BRN BLUE PUR GRAY WHT BLK
(Subscanning side cover) (Optics stool cover) (Subscanning side cover) (Scanner unit platform)
(After-reading conveyor)
RED BLK YEL RED BLK YEL Signal name Signal name
(Shield case)
BLK
Leading-edge sensor
Signal name
BRN RED ORN YEL
Model
Signal name
MT - 288
MT - 288
YEL
Unit
Name
Circuit Diagram
Sup. name
FR1H1378.EPS
Code
Page
6.
CONTENTS
SCN08A
F1
LD assembly
CN1 CN1
CN2
DCOUT6
CN9
TP1 F3
TP4
F9
LDD 08B
LDA08B
CN1
LD
LAN90B board
LAN90B(#5001)
CN4
PDA08B
CN15 CN16
CN1 CN2
I/F
TP8
CN2
CN1
MTH08A
TP27 F6
SYN08A
F10 F7
+12V
DCOUT1 TP3
Polygon assembly
F1 F5 F8 CN3 CN4 CN1
POL-DRV
POL
SZ1 (SED08A)
CN1
F2
CPU90E
CN5
MTH08D board
CN7
CRT
CN8 CN7
F4
PMT08A
SCN08A
CN8
VOL08A
CN21 CN20
MTH08D
CN15
CPU90F/LAN90B
CN1 CN2
I/F
MTH08A
CN21
CN20 CN15
CPU90F (#3421)
CN1 F2 F1
F3
F2
EHT90F FAN
I/F
+5V
TB2
TB1
F3 TB1
F2 CN16 CN2
CN27
DMC08A or HCP08A
TB2 +5V
DMC08A or HCP08A
F1
IMG08B/H
CPU90E
CN4 CN17
CRT
IMG08A
VOL08A
IMG07B
CN1
CPU90E
CN1 F1 F2 F3 CN2 F4 CN2 F1 CN18 CN11 CN3 CN18 CN11
FDD SNS08A
VGA 90E
CNJ1
CN22
F1 CN1 CN1
F2 F3
SNS08A
HDD
: Regulator
HDD
CNJ2
CN25
F5
FANG4 FANG5
FANG4 FANG5
CN28 CN29
CN29
MT - 289
VGA 90E
FR1H1140.EPS
CONTENTS
MZ1 (FFM)
SNS08A
F1 TP1 CN14
F2
SA1,SA3,SA5,SA7,SA9,SA11,SA15,SA17
SB1~5
F3
CN10 CN11
+5V CN4
CN15 CN16
CN17
CN12 CN22 CN23 CN2 CN3 CN14 TP7 TP5 TP6 TP4 TP1 CN12 CN13 CN15 CN11 CN4 CN10 CN8 TP2 CN9 CN5 CN6 F1 CN16
DRV08A
F2 +15V +24V F9 F10 F11 F12 DCOUT3 CN1
MZ2,MZ3 MD1,MD2 MD3 ME1,ME2 SOLF1 SOLA1~SOLA4 MF1 MC1 SOLC1 MB1,MB2 MB3,PB1,SVB1 FANG1~ FANG3
Erasure conveyor
TSW2
F5 +24V +24V
DCOUT5
DCOUT4 TSW1
FANF1
MT - 290
Inverter
SNS08A
ACOUT1
LAMP1~5
ACOUT2
: Regulator
FR1H1141.EPS
MT_A1 - 1
MT_A1 - 2
BLANK PAGE
How to set an error code to be captured for IO trace is described below. (1) Start the M-Utility. (2) Insert a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive (FDD) of the machine. (3) Select 7. FILE UTILITY, 3. BACKUP, and 2. CONFIGURATION DATA in sequence. The following files are copied to the floppy disk. IRSET.ORG FILMFMT.ORG IRSTATUS.ORG IRSET.OFG FILMFMT.OFG IRSTATUS.CFG
(4) Remove the floppy disk from the FDD of the machine and insert it into the FDD of the personal computer (PC). When installing the configuration data that is edited on the PC to the machine, make sure that software versions of the source and destination are the same. If the software versions are different, an error may occur during installation. (5) Using the editor on the PC, edit the IRSTATUS.CFG file. Example) To set the error code 1234 as the error code to be captured for IO trace, type in as follows: IOT_ERROR_CODE=1234 (6) Remove the floppy disk containing the edited file from the PC, and insert it into the FDD of the machine. (7) Select 7. FILE UTILITY, 4. RESTORE, and 2. CONFIGURATION DATA in sequence. The following files are copied to the HDD of the machine. IRSET.CFG IRSTATUS.CFG (8) Remove the floppy disk from the machine. (9) Press the RESET button to reboot the machine. FILMFMT.CFG
MT_A1 - 1
MT_A1 - 2
MT_A1 - 3
BLANK PAGE BLANK PAGE
MT_A1 - 4
MT_A1 - 3
MT_A1 - 4
Maintenance Volume Checks, Replacement and Adjustment of Parts (MC) Control Sheet
MC - 1
Control Sheet
Issue date
05/31/99 11/20/99
Revision number 04 Reason Pages affected Corrections due to change in configuration All pages (FM2460) Corrections (FM2638) MC-2, 6, 65, 132~138, 140, 142, 143, 144, 155, 161, 205, 255.1, 255.2 Corrections (FM3006) MC-7, 24, 25, 37, 140, 141, 143, 146, 152, 154, 157, 162, 164, 174, 179, 184, 185, 202, 205, 255, 262, 263, 273, 275, 282287 Design changes (FM3115) MC-5059, 59.159.20, 255, 255.1255.4, 256, 264, 266268, 272, 283 Addition of the information about the MC-3, 17, 72, 142, 143, 162, 163, power supply unit, PC boards, etc. 177, 189, 231, 252307 (FM3405) Hard disk drive procedure addition, MC-2, 3, 8, 16, 18, 25.1-25.4, 30, scanning optics unit spacer procedure 31, 142, 143, 143.1-143.4, 144, addition, MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and 145, 152, 162-164, 174, 252-254, DRV08A board replacement procedure 258-263, 263.1-263.12, 264, 266, additions, front shelf cover adjustment 275, 277, 278, 289, 290, 292, 293, procedure addition, shutter section 296, 297, 297.1-297.8 antistatic member mounting location MC_A1-2 addition, and other information additions, and typographical error corrections (FM4275) Revision (FM4710) MC-4, 5, 31, 59.21-59.24, 163, 292, 293, 304, 305, 307
05
04/20/2001
06
08/30/2001
07
05/30/2002
08
03/20/2004
10
MC - 1
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
MC - 2
1.
2.
2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 5.14 5.15 Turning ON/OFF High-Voltage Switch Checking Various Sensors Clearing Backup Memory Setting Date and Time 5.1 5.2 5.3 Checking and Replacing Suction Cup HP Sensor (SB1) Checking and Replacing Cassette Inlet IP Sensor (SB2) Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Each Shelf Position Sensor (SB3) Checking and Adjusting Inch/Metric Sensor (SB4) Checking and Replacing Suction Sensor (SB5) Replacing Suction Pump (PB1) Replacing IP Leak Valve (SVB1) Replacing Suction Cups Replacing Suction Cup Drive Motor (MB1) Replacing IP Transport Motor (MB2) Replacing Up-Down Drive Motor (MB3) Replacing Elevation Timing Belt Checking and Replacing Shock Absorbers of IP Removal Unit Checking and Replacing Elevation Changeover Guide Replacing Vertical Conveyor Guide
Document Map
Common Procedures for Checks, Replacement, and Adjustment MC - 4 5. Up-Down IP Removal Unit MC - 60
3.
4.
4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly Checking and Replacing Cassette Ejection Sensors (SA1, 5, 9, 13) Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette IN Sensors (SA2, 6, 10, 14) Checking and Replacing Cassette Hold Sensors (SA3, 7, 11, 15) Checking and Replacing Mammo/ST Sensors (SA4, 8, 12, 16) Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette Hold Solenoids (SOLA1-4) Checking and Replacing Elevation HP Sensor (SA17) Replacing Inch/Metric Guides Adjusting Movable Roll Replacing Rubber Rollers of Cassette Set Unit Replacing Guide Plate of Cassette Set Unit
6.
6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6
FRONT
Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor MC - 86
Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor Checking and Replacing Before-BCR IP Sensor (SC1) Checking and Replacing Convergence Standby IP Sensor (SC2) Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Convergence Path Changeover Guide Drive Solenoid (SOLC1) Replacing Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor IP Transport Motor (MC1) Replacing and Adjusting Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor Drive Timing Belt Replacing Cleaning Roller Replacing Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor Rubber Rollers Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber-Attached Guide of Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
12.
12.1 12.2 12.3 6.9 12.4 12.5 12.6 12.7 12.8 12.9 12.10 12.11 12.12 Removing and Reinstalling Erasure Lamp Assembly Removal and Reinstallation of Erasure Conveyor Checking and Replacing After-Reading Conveyance Standby IP Sensor (SF1) Checking and Replacing Changeover IP Sensor (SF2) Checking and Replacing Load Standby IP Sensor (SF3) Checking and Replacing Overrun IP Sensor (SF4) Replacing IP Transport Motor (MF1) Replacing Erasure Lamp Replacing Thermal Switches (TWS1, TWS2) Replacing Erasure Cooling Fan (FANF1) Replacing Erasure Cooling Fan Air Filter Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Erasure Unit IP Conveyance Timing Belt Replacing Erasure Conveyor Rubber Rollers Checking and Replacing Branch Path Changeover Guide Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber of Erasure Conveyor
6.7 6.8
7.
8.
8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 8.9 8.10 8.11 8.12 8.13 8.14
11.
11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor Checking and Replacing Grip Release HP Sensor (SE1) Replacing Grip Release Motor (ME1) Replacing IP Transport Motor (ME2) Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber of After-Reading Conveyor
10.
10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 10.11 10.12 10.13 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 Checking and Replacing SCN08A Board Servicing Light-Collecting Guide Checking and Replacing PMT08A Board Servicing Light-Collecting Mirror Checking and Replacing IP Leading-Edge Sensor (SZ1/SED08A) Checking and Replacing Driving-Side Grip Release HP Sensor (SZ2) Checking and Replacing Driven-Side Grip Release HP Sensor (SZ3) Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) Replacing Driving Shaft Grip Motor (MZ2) Replacing Driven Shaft Grip Motor (MZ3) Checking and Replacing SUS Belt/Rubber Belt/Tensioner Checking and Replacing Kapton Belt/Tensioner/Flywheel Replacing Rubber Roller Located Above Subscanning Unit Replacing Grip Arms Replacing Guide Plate of Subscanning Unit Replacing Lower Rubber Rollers of Subscanning Unit Replacing and Adjusting Shock-Absorbing Rubbers
13.
13.1 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.5 13.6
Housings MC - 252
Replacing Power Supply Unit Replacing Fuses Replacing HDD Replacing FDD and Checking Boards Setting Replacing the Monitor Cleaning Monitor Screen
FR1H1319.EPS
MC - 2
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
MC - 3
PC Boards
Board Arrangement Diagram MTH08A board MTH08D board CPU90E board IMG07B board IMG08A board IMG08B/H board DMC08A board HCP08A board CPU90F board LAN90B/D board DRV08A board SNS08A board LED08A board LED08B board VOL08A board BCR08A board FFM board SCN08A board PMT08A board Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
14.
14.1 14.2 14.3 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.5 17.6 17.7 17.8 17.9 17.10 17.11 17.12 17.13 17.14 17.15 17.16 17.17 17.18 17.19 17.20 17.21 Setting HDD Replacing HDD Replacing HDD (ST52160N/QM32100SE-S/ WDE4550-003/WDE9100-003/ST318416N)
HDD 17.
15.
15.1 15.2
FRONT
FDD
Setting FDD Replacing FDD
16.
16.1 16.2 16.3 Cleaning Monitor Replacing the Monitor Monitor Fuse
Monitor
13.
13.1 13.2 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Power Supply Unit Power Supply Unit Fuses
19.
19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 Standard Tools Special Tools and Measuring Instruments Special Consumables Semi-Standard Tools
Tools
FR1H1330.EPS
MC - 3
CONTENTS
10
MC - 4
CONTENTS
10
MC - 5
2.
2.1
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV ON 10. MENU SETTING >
Display in ON status
FR1H1417.EPS
(1) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (2) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (3) Select 9. HV OFF. The high-voltage switch is turned OFF, and 9. HV OFF displayed on the screen switches to 9. HV ON.
M-Utility screen
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >
FR ON T
M-Utility screen
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV ON 10. MENU SETTING >
Display in ON status
FR1H1416.EPS
MC - 4
MC - 5
CONTENTS
10
MC - 6
CONTENTS
10
MC - 7
2.2
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Place the high-voltage switch (software switch) in the OFF position. 2.1 Turning ON/OFF High-Voltage Switch (2) Remove the covers of the machine. (3) Place the high-voltage switch (hardware switch) in the OFF position. 2.1 Turning ON/OFF High-Voltage Switch (4) Power ON the machine. (5) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (6) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (7) Drive the actuator, as needed for sensor checks. I To Drive (DRIVE) or Stop (STOP) Actuator by Performing MECHANICAL UTILITY Operation (8) Perform MECHANICAL UTILITY operation so that the sensor can be checked. I To Enable Sensor Checks by Performing MECHANICAL UTILITY Operation (9) Block the light path of the sensor to be checked with a cassette, cardboard or the like to check the status of the sensor (Open/Close). (10) Deactivate the actuator that was driven at step (7). I To Drive (DRIVE) or Stop (STOP) Actuator by Performing MECHANICAL UTILITY Operation (11) Select 0. QUIT. The screen switches back to 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY menus. (12) Select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to the main menu. (13) Select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
MF1
SOLF1 MD1 MD3 MD2 MZ3 SD3 SZ3 FANG3 SVB1 SB3 SB1 SB2 LAMP15 PB1 SB4 SB5 MB2 TSW1 TSW2
FR ON T
MB3 MB1
SE1
FR ON T
MZ2 SZ2
SZ1
MC1
SD2
Serial number
FANF1 SC2
Unit symbol (AG, T, Z) Example) D: Side-positioning conveyor The unit symbol may sometimes be omitted. I/O type S: Sensor M: Motor TSW: Thermal switch FAN: Fan SV: Solenoid valve and more
SD1 SD2
FR1H1912.EPS
MC - 6
MC - 7
CONTENTS
10
MC - 8
CONTENTS
10
MC - 9
G Transmissive sensor
SA4, 8, 12, 16 SA3, 7, 11, 15 SA1, 5, 9, 13 SA17 IP removal unit (B) SB1 SB2
Mammo/ST sensor Cassette hold sensor Cassette ejection sensor Elevation HP sensor Suction cup HP sensor Cassette inlet IP sensor
MS PS PS PS
Detects mammo and ST cassette types. Detects the completion of cassette hold. Detects that the cassette has been ejected. Elevation HP for suction conveyor.
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1490.EPS
SB3 SB4 SB5 Before-side- SC1 SC2 positioning conveyor (C) SideSD1 positioning conveyor (D) SD2 SD3 BCR After-reading SE1 conveyor (E) Erasure SF1 conveyor (F) SF2 SF3 SF4 TSW1
During HP: ON (1) PS IP found: ON (1) IP conveyance sensor PS When located in the shelf position: ON (1) Each shelf position sensor IP found: ON (1) PS Inch/metric sensor PS (reflective IP width determination type) During IP suction: Suction sensor Suction sensor ON (1) Before-BCR IP sensor Convergence standby IP sensor IP found: ON (1) IP found: ON (1) PS PS IP conveyance sensor IP conveyance sensor
G Reflective sensor
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1493.EPS
During HP: ON (1) PS Side-positioning mechanism HP sensor During HP: ON (1) PS Grip release HP sensor Side-positioning HP sensor IP found: ON (1) PS Barcode reader
OFF(0) : OPEN
ON(1) : CLOSE
FR1H1491.EPS
PS
ON(1) : CLOSE
Lamp house Fan control
OFF(0) : OPEN
FR1H1492.EPS
Safety thermostat TSW2 LDSN1-1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Unlit lamp sensor Subscanning SZ1 (SED08A) unit (Z) SZ2 SZ3 IP leading-edge sensor Driving-side grip release HP sensor Driven-side grip release HP sensor IP found: ON (no display)
MC - 8
MC - 9
CONTENTS
10
MC - 10
CONTENTS
10
MC - 11
9
1 2 3
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
SP
Caps
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
MU:SEN > 3 SA1-17 : 0 0 SB1-5 : 1 0 SC1-2 : 0 0 SD1-3 : 1 1 SE1 : 1 SF1-4 : 0 0 SZ2-3 : 1 0 0:QUIT SA1 ----> Close SA2 ----> Open SA2 ----> Close SA1 ----> Open 0
0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 0
D 0 0 7
MU:SEN > 2 1:SA1 2:SA2 3:SA3 4:SA4 6:SA6 7:SA7 8:SA8 9:SA9 11:SA11 12:SA12 13:SA13 14:SA14 16:SA16 17:SA17 18:SB1 19:SB2 21:SB4 22:SB5 23:SC1 24:SC2 26:SD2 27:SD3 28:SE1 29:SF1 31:SF3 32:SF4 33:SZ2 34:SZ3 INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 34 : 4 SA4 ----> Close SA4 ----> Open SA4 ----> Close 0 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.MONITOR 3.MONITOR ALL MU:SEN >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
SP
Caps
DEL
BS
ENT
FR1H1235.EPS
Caps
FR1H1514.EPS
MC - 10
MC - 11
CONTENTS
10
MC - 12
CONTENTS
10
MC - 13
I To Drive (DRIVE) or Stop (STOP) Actuator by Performing MECHANICAL UTILITY Operation G To drive (DRIVE) or stop (STOP) an actuator other than FFM (MZ1)
(1) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 2. ACTUATOR in sequence. (2) Select 2. DRIVE or 3. STOP. A list of sensor numbers is displayed. (3) Enter the number of the actuator to be driven or stopped. The actuator selected is driven or stopped.
Example: 2. DRIVE is selected
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >6 0.QUIT 1.MOTOR 2.ACTUATOR 3.SENSOR 4.UNIT MU > 2 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT > 2
Side-positioning MD 1 conveyor (D) MD 2 MD 3 After-reading conveyor (E) Erasure conveyor (F) ME 1 ME 2 MF 1 SOLF1
IP transport motor Branch path changeover guide drive LAMP1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Erasure lamp FANF1 Erasure cooling Subscanning motor Driving shaft grip Driven shaft grip
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
Housing (G)
Board cooling Board cooling Board cooling Board cooling Board cooling
Cools down the DRV08A board. Cools down the DRV08A board. Cools down the DRV08A board. Cools down the MTH. Cools down the MTH.
TR1H1004.EPS
MU:AUT > 2 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 1 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1758.EPS
MC - 12
MC - 13
CONTENTS
10
MC - 14
CONTENTS
10
MC - 15
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
MU:AUT > 3 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 11 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1759.EPS
MC - 14
MC - 15
CONTENTS
10
MC - 16
CONTENTS
10
MC - 17
2.3
The following files are cleared from the HD. IMG Set processing information, information for image number generation, HV ON/OFF information IPH IP position information, subscanning grip correction data PNL Audible click tone enabled/disabled, parallax correction data DST
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Date/time setup
Read
Output LP information (NET/LOCAL) JNL Error log information LIF Format frequency information MFC Setup options information CSL (for CSL specification only) Multiframe-related information, set processing-related information, menu selection information
1 2 3
Click sound
CRT test pattern display 8" x 10" film reduced output setup
FD operation
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1086.EPS
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >8 0.QUIT 1.CLEAR BKM > 1 ARE YOU SURE TO CLEAR THE ALL BACKUP MEMORIES? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : 1 BACKUP MEMORIES ARE CLEARED.
(3) Select 8.BACK MEMORY. (4) Select 1.CLEAR. The following message appears. ARE YOU SURE TO CLEAR ALL THE BACKUP MEMORIES? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : Meaning: Are you sure to initialize (clear) the backup memory? (5) Select 1. The backup memory is initialized, with the following message displayed. BACKUP MEMORIES ARE CLEARED. Meaning: The backup memory has been initialized. (6) Select 0. QUIT repeatedly. M-Utility is exited. (7) Press the RESET switch of the machine.
FR1H1237.EPS
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
MC - 16
MC - 17
CONTENTS
10
MC - 18
CONTENTS
10
MC - 19
2.4
(2) Touch the date/time setting. The date/time setting screen appears. (3) Type in the current date and time form the keypad, as instructed in the on-screen example. (4) After entering the date and time, touch the [ ENT ] key for confirmation. When the setting is confirmed, OK appears below the entry line. If the date or time is entered incorrectly, press the BS (backspace) key to return to the character to be corrected.
Read
1 2 3 4
Set the new date and time in the order of Year, Month, Date and Time (military time) Ex)February 25, 1998.10:15 AM Input 98022511015
Virtual keyboard
4 5 6
9802251015
0
BS
ENT
U-Utility button NOTE: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear.
SET DATE/TIME
QUIT
FR1H1489.EPS
U-Utility screen
Date/time setup
Click sound
CRT test pattern display 8" x 10" film reduced output setup
FD operation
Utility
NOTE: For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear.
Return
FR1H1487.EPS
MC - 18
MC - 19
CONTENTS
10
MC - 20
CONTENTS
10
MC - 21
3.
I Procedures
(10) Upper front cover (BR M4x8, x2; truss M4x8, x2) Loosen the right and left truss screws, and slightly pull the top of the cover toward yourself to pull it up and out. Because the two screws on the upper portion of the cover are BR M4x8, while the two screws on the lower portion are truss M4x6, use care not to confuse these screws during installation. (11) Stack table (truss M4x6, x2) Using a 2-mm Allen wrench or so forth, first remove the screw covers and then the screws. (12) Lower front inner cover (BR M4x8, x8) Because the topmost screw in the center is used to hook the lower front inner cover, it should not be removed.
Screw used to hook the lower front inner cover
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Lower front cover (truss M4x12, x2) Loosen the truss screws, both right and left, and while slightly pulling the top of the cover toward yourself, pull it up and out. (3) Upper right-hand side cover (truss M4x6, x4) Pull up the entire cover toward yourself and out. (4) Lower right hand side cover (truss M4x6, x9) While slightly pulling the top of the cover toward yourself, pull it up and out. (5) Make sure that the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board is in the OFF position.
FR1B1172.EPS
(13) Multi-stage cassette loading cover (BR M4x8, x7) Disconnect the connector (CNT1), and then pull the cover toward yourself and out.
FR ON T
S1 HVON
OFF position
Scanner unit SCN08A board
FR1H1418.EPS
CNT1
ON T
FR
(6) Upper rear cover (truss M4x12, x4) (7) Lower rear cover (truss M4x12, x5; truss M4x20, x3) While slightly pulling the top of the cover toward yourself, pull it up and out. The top three screws on the left-hand side are tightened together with the cable retaining NK clamps. (8) Upper left-hand side cover (truss M4x12, x4) (9) Lower left-hand side cover (truss M4x6, x3; truss M4x12, x6) While slightly pulling the top of the cover toward yourself, pull it up and out, exercising care to prevent the cover of the switch portion from hitting the power supply unit. Because the three screws on the front of the machine are truss M4x6, while the six screws on the rear of the machine are truss M4x12, use care not to confuse these screws during installation.
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 20
MC - 21
CONTENTS
10
MC - 22
CONTENTS
10
MC - 23
I Reinstallation
Upper rear cover Upper left-hand side cover (6) (8) Lower left-hand side cover (7) (9) Lower rear cover
CAUTION
Before installing the cover, make sure that the high-voltage switch on the SCN08A board is ON.
N NOTE N
Accomplish positioning at the time of multi-stage cassette loading cover installation. If you do not complete positioning, a cassette holding failure may occur.
Upper right-hand side cover
(1)
(13) Screw cover Stack table (11) (2) (12) SCN08A board (10) (5)
(3)
(1) Mount the multi-stage cassette loading cover on the machine main body, and loosely retain the four lower screws.
(4)
O FR
NT
MC - 22
MC - 23
CONTENTS
10
MC - 24
CONTENTS
10
MC - 25
(2) Insert a 300 mm scale along the right-hand side of the lowermost shelf (fourth shelf). Press the manual release lever to lower the hold pin. (3) Slide the multi-stage cassette loading cover until the scale comes into contact with the cassette set unit entry reference guide protrusion (level difference: 0.5 1 mm), and then tighten the four screws that were loosely retained.
(2)
(4) Insert a 300-mm rule along the right edge of the shelf. Press the manual release lever to lower the hold pin. (5) Secure the multi-stage cassette loading cover. Loosely retain the two upper screws. After completing positioning steps (3) for the uppermost shelf (first shelf), tighten the screws. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
Because of parts machining precision, the multi-stage cassette loading cover may be slightly warped when secured, though this will not pose any problem. Alignment with the cassette set unit should take first priority.
Manual release lever (2) Top view (3) 0.5 - 1mm Scale Lower most shelf 0.5 - 1mm Cassette set unit entry reference guide (white plastic)
Scale
Scale
FR ON T
(4)
Manual release lever (5) Multi-stage cassette loading Top view (5) cover BR M4x8, x2 0.5 - 1mm (6) CNT1
0.5 - 1mm
Scale
(7) Reinstall the rest of the covers. Reinstall the covers in the reverse order of removal. I Removal (8) Make sure that the covers have been installed securely and there is no missing cover screw.
MC - 24
MC - 25
CONTENTS
10
MC - 25.1
CONTENTS
10
MC - 25.2
CAUTION
If the lower portion of the cassette edge is blocked by the guide located in the cassette insertion slot to prevent the cassette from being pulled out, perform the following procedures to make adjustments as appropriate.
(4) Press a rule against the center guide, and while pushing it down until the height of the top end of the center guide is equal to or lower than that of the right and left guides, tighten the five stopper retaining screws in place.
Right and left guides
G Adjustment
(1) Remove the front shelf cover. I Removal (2) Remove the stopper. (3) Loosen the five screws that retain the center guide.
Push down Rule
Center guide
GOOD
There shall be not gap.
FR1H7011.EPS
(5) Attach the stopper removed at step (2). (6) Reinstall the front shelf cover.
FR1H7010.EPS
MC - 25.1
MC - 25.2
CONTENTS
10
MC - 25.3
CONTENTS
10
MC - 25.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MC - 25.3
MC - 25.4
CONTENTS
10
MC - 26
CONTENTS
10
MC - 27
4.
I Pushing In
(1) While using care to prevent the connector cables, etc. from getting caught, push the tray of the cassette set unit all the way into the machine. (2) Secure the tray of the cassette set unit with two screws. (3) Connect the connectors (CNA1-3 to the cassette set unit; CNB1, 3, 4 to the up-down IP removal unit). (4) Attach the timing belt to the timing belt wheel. (5) Put the tensioner back where it was. Loosen the screw (BR M4x8) that retains the tensioner. Flick the timing belt several times to ensure that it snugly fits onto the timing belt wheel, and then secure the tensioner in place. 3.4 Tensioner Not Requiring Tension Adjustment in Machine Description
Up-down IP removal unit (3) CNB4 CNB3
4.1
I Pulling Out
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, upper right-hand side cover, lower right-hand side cover, upper lefthand side cover, upper front cover, stack table, multi-stage cassette loading cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Disconnect the connectors (CNA1-3 from the cassette set unit; CNB1, 3, 4 from the up-down IP removal unit). (3) Slide the tensioner until the timing belt is removed, and then secure the tensioner in place. Loosen the screw (BR M4x8) that retains the tensioner to slide the tensioner as appropriate, and then secure the tensioner in place. 3.4 Tensioner Not Requiring Tension Adjustment in Machine Description (4) Remove the timing belt. (5) Remove the two screws that retain the tray of the cassette set unit. (6) Pull out the tray, exercising care so that it is not caught by the connector cables and so forth.
Up-down IP removal unit (2) CNB4 CNB3
CNB1
(1) (2) Tray of the cassette set unit BR M4x8, x2 Cassette set unit (3) CNA3 BR M4x8
CNA1
CNB1
Tensioner
CNA2
(6) (5) Tray of the cassette set unit BR M4x8, x2 Cassette set unit (2) CNA3 BR M4x8
FR1H1621.EPS
CNA1 CNA2
Tensioner
FR1H1760.EPS
MC - 26
MC - 27
CONTENTS
10
MC - 28
CONTENTS
10
MC - 29
4.2
I Reinstallation
For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
CAUTIONS
Before inserting the cassette set unit into its position, place the IP removal arm in the home position. Also, adjust the IP removal height for the home position or the first to fourth shelf position. If an attempt is made to insert the cassette set unit with the up-down IP removal assembly positioned elsewhere, the machine may be damaged. When placing the cassette set unit in its position, insert it along the positioning brackets because the sensor may be damaged. When installing the cassette set unit, properly position it by pressing it against the positioning brackets. Screw down the cassette set unit while pushing its upper end toward the up-down IP removal unit.
Top view Positioning bracket
I Removal
(1) Pull out the tray of the cassette set unit. 4.1 Removing and Reinstalling Tray of Cassette Set Unit (2) Remove the six screws that retain the cassette set unit. (3) Pull out the cassette set unit horizontally.
N NOTES N
When pulling out the cassette set unit, place the IP removal in its home position or each of the four shelf positions. If the cassette set unit is pulled out from any other position, it may be damaged. When pulling out the cassette set unit, place the IP removal arm in the home position.
F R O N T
FR
ON
(3)
MC - 28
MC - 29
CONTENTS
10
MC - 30
CONTENTS
10
MC - 31
4.3
Cover
FR1H1208.EPS
I Replacement of Shutter
(1) Remove the shutter assembly. I Removal of Shutter Assembly (2) Remove the bracket. (3) Remove the torsion coil spring and slide bearings from the shutter. (4) Attach to a new shutter the torsion coil spring and slide bearings that were removed at step (2).
(2) Bracket Sems M3x6 (3), (4) Slide bearing (3), (4) Shutter
MC - 30
MC - 31
CONTENTS
10
MC - 32
CONTENTS
10
MC - 33
4.4
I Replacement
(1) Remove the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (2) Disconnect the connectors (SA1, 5, 9, 13). (3) Remove SA1, 5, 9, and 13. The sensor is secured to the bracket by four latches. To remove the sensor, pinch the latches by fingers.
Bracket (2) Connector (3) SA1,5,9,13
I Checks
(1) Place the machine in a sensor monitoring state so that SA1, 5, 9, and 13 can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (2) Set a cassette into the shelf in place. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel.
SA1
ON FR
(4) Install a new sensor. 3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description
FR
ON
(5) Connect the connectors (SA1, 5, 9, 13). (6) Reinstall the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly
FR1H4045.EPS
(7) Reinstall the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (8) Check the sensor replaced. I Checks
(3) Pull out the cassette. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel. (4) Repeat steps (2) and (3) several times to ensure that the messages appear as appropriate. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor checked, and then check it again. (5) Select 0. QUIT. The monitoring is exited to return to 3. SENSOR menu.
MC - 32
MC - 33
CONTENTS
10
MC - 34
CONTENTS
10
MC - 35
4.5
I Replacement
(1) Remove the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing an Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (2) Cut the cable tie. (3) Disconnect the connectors (SA2, 6, 10, 14). (4) Remove SA2, 6, 10, and 14.
(2) Cut cable tie
I Checks
(1) Place the machine in a sensor monitoring state so that SA2, 6, 10, and 14 can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (2) Set a cassette into the shelf in place. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel.
SA2
FR
ON
SA6 (3) Connector Bracket (4) SA2, 6, 10, 14 Double sems M2x10, x2 SA10 SA14
FR1H1057.EPS
(5) Install new SA2, 6, 10, and 14. (6) Connect the connectors. (7) Restore the cable tie that was cut at step (2). (8) Adjust the sensors replaced. I Adjustment
FR1H4046.EPS
(3) Pull out the cassette. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel. (4) Repeat steps (2) and (3) several times to ensure that the messages appear as appropriate. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor checked, and then check it again. (5) Select 0. QUIT. The monitoring is exited to return to 3. SENSOR menu.
MC - 34
MC - 35
CONTENTS
10
MC - 36
CONTENTS
10
MC - 37
I Adjustment
(7) Type in the number of the sensor to be checked (SA2, 6, 10, 14). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (8) Loosen the screw on the mounting bracket of the sensor to be checked (SA2, 6, 10, 14). (9) Secure the manual release lever of the cassette set unit in place with a cable tie, so that the hold pin is withdrawn. (10) While pushing down the latch by hand, set a scale in such a position that the distance from the end face of the plate to the tip of the scale is 1.5 mm. (11) With the tip of the scale in contact with the actuator of the sensor (SA2, 6, 10, 14) to be checked, slowly move the mounting bracket bit by bit toward the scale and tighten the screw in place where the sensor changes status from OPEN to CLOSE. (12) Slide the scale until the distance between the end of the plate and the tip of the rule is 1.0 mm, and make sure that the sensor (SA2, 6, 10, 14) transitions to OPEN.
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, upper right-hand side cover, lower right-hand side cover, upper lefthand side cover, upper front cover, stack table, multi-stage cassette loading cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) With the cassette set unit pulled out, connect the connectors (CNA1, 2) of the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit
(10) Latch Plate SA2 (10) Scale (8), (11) Mounting bracket BR M4x8 Actuator SA2, 6, 10, 14
CNA1 CNA2
T ON FR
(10) Scale
FR1H1412.EPS
(13) Repeat steps (6) through (12) to adjust the sensor mounting position. (14) Cut the cable tie that was attached at step (9).
FR1H1058.EPS
(15) Select 0. QUIT. The screen switches back to 5. MECHANICAL UTILITY menu. (16) Select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to the main menu. (17) Power OFF the machine. (18) Check the sensor adjusted. I Checks
(3) Power ON the machine. The initialization sequence is started, and, after 30 to 60 seconds have passed, a software version number (Axx) appears on the operation panel. (4) Immediately after the software version number (Axx) appears, touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. If STEP 95 is indicated, any touch on the operation panel is rejected. In that case, reset the machine and wait until the software version number (Axx) appears on the operation panel. (5) Select 5. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 1. INITIALIZE in sequence. (6) Select 4. SENSOR and 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed.
MC - 36
MC - 37
CONTENTS
10
MC - 38
CONTENTS
10
MC - 39
4.6
I Replacement
(1) Remove the mounting bracket together with SA3, 7, 11, 15. (2) Disconnect the connectors (SA3, 7, 11, 15). (3) Remove SA3, 7, 11, 15 from the mouting bracket. The sensor is secured to the bracket by four latches. To remove the sensor, pinch the latches by fingers.
I Checks
With no cassette inserted, the cassette hold pin is withdrawn. As such, when checking this sensor, turn OFF the solenoid so that the cassette hold pin is protruded before executing sensor monitoring. (1) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY, 2. ACTUATOR, and 3. STOP in sequence. (2) Enter the number of the solenoid (SOLA1-4) corresponding to SA3, 7, 11, 15. The solenoid is activated so that it is in the cassette hold mode (the sensor is CLOSE). (3) Place the machine in a sensor monitoring state so that SA3, 7, 11, 15 can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (4) Insert a 1.5-mm Allen wrench straight into the hold manual release hole to push the lever. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears.
FRONT
FR
ON
FR1H1056.EPS
3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description (5) Connect the connectors (SA3, 7, 11, 15). (6) Attach the mounting bracket. Screw down the mounting bracket while pushing it upward. (7) Check the sensor replaced. I Checks
T ON FR
FR1H1104.EPS
(5) Pull out the Allen wrench. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears. (6) Repeat steps (4) and (5) several times to ensure that the messages appear as appropriate. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor checked, and then check it again. (7) Select 0. QUIT, 0. QUIT, 2. ACTUATOR, and 2. DRIVE in sequence. (8) Enter the number of the solenoid activated at step (2). The solenoid is activated so that it is in the cassette hold release mode (the sensor is OPEN). (9) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 38
MC - 39
CONTENTS
10
MC - 40
CONTENTS
10
MC - 41
4.7
I Replacement
(1) Remove the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing an Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (2) Cut the cable tie. (3) Disconnect the connectors (CNA4, 8, 12, 16). (4) Remove the sensor bracket as a whole. (5) Replace the sensor assembly.
Cassette set unit (3) CNA4, 8, 12, 16
I Checks
(1) Place the machine in a sensor monitoring state so that SA4, 8, 12, and 16 can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (2) Set a non-mammo-type cassette into the shelf in place. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel.
(4) Loosen screw BR M4x8 (5) Sensor assembly (4) Sensor bracket BR M4x8
(6) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. When attaching the mounting bracket for SA4, 8, 12, 16, tighten the screw while holding it down.
O FR
NT
CAUTION
When retaining the cables with ties, observe the following precautions. Ensure that the cables do not protrude beyond the side plates. Retain the cables at proper positions so that they will not be caught by rotating rollers.
(7) Check the sensor replaced. I Checks
FR1H4047.EPS
(3) Pull out the cassette. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel. (4) Set a mammo-type cassette in place. When the cassette is inserted, a message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears. Immediately after that, a message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears. (5) Pull out the cassette. When the cassette is removed, a message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears. Immediately after that, a message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears. (6) Repeat steps (4) and (5) several times to ensure that the messages appear as appropriate. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace SA4, 8, 12, 16, and then check it again. (7) Enter 0 (zero). The monitoring is exited to return to 3. SENSOR menu.
MC - 40
MC - 41
CONTENTS
10
MC - 42
CONTENTS
10
MC - 43
4.8
(3) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 2. ACTUATOR in sequence. (4) Select 3. STOP. A list of sensor numbers is displayed. (5) Enter the number of the cassette hold solenoid to be stopped. The actuator selected is stopped.
Example: 3. STOP is selected
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >6 0.QUIT 1.MOTOR 2.ACTUATOR 3.SENSOR 4.UNIT MU > 2 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT > 3
I Checks
(1) Place the machine in a cassette hold solenoid (SOLA1-4) operation enabled state. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (2) Set a cassette in the shelf.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Cassette
Caps
SOLA4
FR1H4048.EPS
MU:AUT > 3 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 1 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1762.EPS
MC - 42
MC - 43
CONTENTS
10
MC - 44
CONTENTS
10
MC - 45
(6) Slightly pull the cassette to ensure that the cassette cannot be removed. (7) Select 2. DRIVE. (8) Enter the number of the solenoid selected at step (5). The actuator selected is driven.
Example: 2. DRIVE is selected
6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 1 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT > 2 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 1 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
I Replacement
(1) Remove the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (2) Disconnect the connector for the solenoid to be replaced from the side plate. (3) Remove the three solenoid retaining screws to take out the solenoid.
Cassette set unit (3) SOLA1, 2, 3, 4 Sems M3x6, x3
SOLA1 SOLA2
SOLA3
0 . SP
SOLA4
DEL BS ENT
(2) Connector
Caps
FR
ON
FR1H1761.EPS
FR1H1210.EPS
(9) Pull out the cassette. (10) Repeat steps (2) through (9) several times to ensure that there is nothing abnormal. If anything abnormal is found with a solenoid, replace it and then check it again. (11) Select 0. QUIT. The operation is exited to return to 2. ACTUATOR menu.
(4) Install new solenoid. (5) Connect the connector to the side plate. (6) Adjust the solenoid replaced. I Adjustment
MC - 44
MC - 45
CONTENTS
10
MC - 46
CONTENTS
10
MC - 47
I Adjustment
4.9
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (2) Remove the retaining bracket used for transit, which is located on the rear of the updown IP removal unit. (3) Loosen the three mounting screws so as to allow the solenoid mounting location to be shifted. (4) Remove the spring. (5) Put the protruding portion of the retaining bracket used for transit into the cassette hold pin sliding hole, and then grip the retaining bracket used for transit with the coverclosing roller. (6) Raise the solenoid until the cassette hold pin contacts the protruding portion of the retaining bracket used for transit, and then secure the solenoid in place. The solenoid should be raised so that the retaining bracket used for transit is not lifted up.
(5), (6) Guide plate of cassette set unit Cover-closing roller
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (5) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (6) Type in the number of the elevation HP sensor (SA17). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (7) Rotate the MB3 timing belt clockwise, as seen from the rear, until the actuator does not block the SA17 light path. From the hole in the side plate of the IP removal unit, visually check the actuator and SA17. When the light path is no longer blocked, a message indicative of the sensor OPEN status appears on the operation panel.
Protruding portion of retaining bracket used for transit Retaining bracket used for transit Hold pin (4) Spring
(7)
Timing belt
MB3
SOLA3
T ON FR
FR
ON
(7) Remove the retaining bracket used for transit. (8) Push down the iron core of the solenoid by hand. Make sure that the cassette hold pin is located below the guide plate of the cassette set unit. (9) Reinstall the spring. (10) Check the solenoid adjusted. I Checks
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 46
MC - 47
CONTENTS
10
MC - 48
CONTENTS
10
MC - 49
(8) Rotate the MB3 timing belt counterclockwise, as seen from the rear, until the actuator blocks the SA17 light path. When the light path is blocked, a message indicative of the sensor CLOSE status appears on the operation panel. (9) Rotate the MB3 timing belt clockwise, as seen from the rear, until the actuator does not block the SA17 light path. When the light path is no longer blocked, a message indicative of the sensor OPEN status appears on the operation panel.
CAUTION
Be sure to position the actuator below SA17. If the machine is booted up with the actuator positioned above SA17, the home position (HP) cannot be detected during initialization, so that the IP removal unit hits the top plate of the elevation unit, probably damaging the machine.
(10) Repeat steps (7) through (9) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor. (11) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (S17). (2) Remove the elevation HP sensor (SA17). 3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description
Cassette set unit
FR1H1320.EPS
(5) For installation of a new inch/metric guide, reverse the removal steps.
(1) Connector
FR1H1061.EPS
(3) Install a new sensor. (4) Connect the connector (SA17). (5) Check SA17. I Checks
MC - 48
MC - 49
CONTENTS
10
MC - 50
CONTENTS
10
MC - 51
MC - 50
MC - 51
CONTENTS
10
MC - 52
CONTENTS
10
MC - 53
(1) Loosen the two screws that retain the metric rearward toppling prevention bracket (screwed down on its upper and lower portions). (2) Make necessary adjustments to ensure that the distance moved downward for the trailing edge of the movable roll is not greater than 1 mm.
(3)
As the rearward toppling prevention bracket is offset in the direction of the arrow (toward the shutter assembly) as shown below, the distance moved downward for the movable roll trailing edge is decreased.
Top view
Cassette Top view Movable roll for inch use 24x30 mammo movable roll Movable roll for metric use (2), (6) BR M4x8 (yellow screw) Spring
(2) Metric rearward toppling prevention bracket (1) Hex socket head bolt with spring and plain washer M4x10 (lower portion)
F R O N T
(1) Hex socket head bolt with spring and plain washer The distance moved downward M4x10 (upper portion) is decreased.
FR1H1763.EPS
Side view FRONT Front end check The movement must be smooth.
1 mm max.
FR1H1766.EPS
(3) Reinstall the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (4) Reinstall the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing the Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (5) Push in the tray of the cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit
009-051-07 08.30.2001 FM3115 (1)
MC - 52
MC - 53
CONTENTS
10
MC - 54
CONTENTS
10
MC - 55
The distance moved downward is decreased. (2) Inch rearward toppling prevention bracket
(2) 24x30 mammo rearward toppling prevention bracket
(1) Hex socket head bolt with spring and plain washer M4x10
F R O N T
FR1H1764.EPS
F R O N T
Side view FRONT Front end check The movement must be smooth.
FR1H1765.EPS
Side view FRONT Front end check The movement must be smooth.
1 mm max.
FR1H1766.EPS
4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (4) Reinstall the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing the Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (5) Push in the tray of the cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit
(3) Reinstall the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (4) Reinstall the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing the Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (5) Push in the tray of the cassette set unit. 4.1 Pulling Out and Pushing In Tray of Cassette Set Unit
MC - 54
MC - 55
CONTENTS
10
MC - 56
CONTENTS
10
MC - 57
I Removal
(1) Remove the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing an Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (2) Remove the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly (3) Remove the sensor assembly of the mammo/ST sensors (SA4, 8, 12, and 16), together with the sensor bracket, as a whole.
N NOTE N
(4) Rubber roller (3) Bearing (3) Housing (2) Grip spring
SA4 SA8 SA12 SA16 (3) Sensor Bracket BR M4x8
ON FR T
FR1H3000.EPS
After the sensor assembly is removed, use care not to damage the sensor and not to cut the cable.
Cassette set unit
FR1H1755.EPS
MC - 56
MC - 57
CONTENTS
10
MC - 58
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59
(4) Remove the cassette IN sensors (SA2, 6, 10, and 14), together with the sensor assembly, as a whole.
N NOTE N
After the sensor assembly is removed, use care not to damage the sensor and not to cut the cable.
FR ON
Half-punch
T
Spring
FR ON T
Half-punch
(6) Free length: 43 mm spring x3 (located below the movable guide) (6) Free length: 31 mm spring (located below the latch)
FR1H3003.EPS
(5) Remove the rubber roller. Detach the grip springs, housings, and bearings located on both right and left sides of the robber roller, before removing the rubber roller.
(5) Free length: 120 mm grip spring
FR ON T
Solenoid arm
FR
ON
(5) Housing (5) Bearing (5) Bearing (5) Housing (5) Free length: 106 mm grip spring (5) Rubber roller
(7) Spring
FR1H3002.EPS
MC - 58
MC - 59
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.1
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.2
(8) Loosen the three solenoid (SOLA1-4) mounting screws. (9) Remove the screw that retains the shaft of the solenoid arm.
Guide plate
Cassette set unit
T ON FR
Solenoid arm
Solenoid
Shaft
SOLA2
SOLA1
SOLA3
Solenoid SOLA2
(9) B M3x10
SOLA4
Hole SOLA3
FR1H3005.EPS
SOLA4
(10) Remove the cassette hold sensors (SA3, 7, 11, and 15), together with the sensor assembly, as a whole. (11) Disconnect the connectors for the cassette IN sensors and mammo/ST sensors. For the first shelf: SA2 and SA4 For the second shelf: SA6 and SA8 For the third shelf: SA10 and SA12 For the fourth shelf: Connectors need not be disconnected.
FR1H3028.EPS
T ON FR
MC - 59.1
MC - 59.2
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.3
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.4
(13) Remove the guide A. (14) Remove the screws on the side plate that retain the stopper A, stopper B, and guide B. (15) Remove the single guide plate retaining screw.
(14) BR M4x8
(16) Disconnect the connectors (CNA1 and CNA2) and remove the connector bracket.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
This procedure need not be performed when replacing the guide plates for the first and second shelves.
(14) Bracket
FR
ON T
(14) BR M4x8
FR ON T
Stopper A
FR1H3006.EPS
MC - 59.3
MC - 59.4
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.5
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.6
(18) Remove the guide plate, with the guide B, stopper A, and stopper B attached thereto.
N NOTE N
Use care not to deform the guide plate and side plate.
While paying attention to the following points, remove the guide plate.
(17) BR M4x8 (17) BR M4x8
Detach the stoppers A and B from the half-punch on the side plate. Move upward the bends of the guide plate. Remove the guide plate rearward of the cassette set unit.
FR ON T
Guide plate
Guide plate
FR O NT
Stopper B Bend
Guide plate
Stopper A
(17) BR M4x8
FR
ON
FR1H3009.EPS
MC - 59.5
MC - 59.6
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.7
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.8
(19) Remove the guide B, stopper A, and stopper B from the guide plate.
(19) Guide B BR M4x8 (19) Stopper B Hex socket head bolt M4x10 (19) Stopper A Hex socket head bolt M4x10
FR ON T
I Reinstallation
(1) Loosely attach the guide B, stopper A, and stopper B to the guide plate.
(1) Guide B
(1) Stopper B
FR ON T
Guide plate
Guide plate
Loosely attached Hex socket head bolt M4x10 Loosely attached BR M4x8
(1) Stopper A
FR1H3010.EPS
FR1H3011.EPS
MC - 59.7
MC - 59.8
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.9
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.10
While paying attention to the following points, install the guide plate. Install the guide plate rearward of the cassette set unit. Make sure that the bends of the guide plate are positioned so that they can be screwed properly. Snap the side plate half-punch to the stoppers A and B.
N NOTES N
Use care not to deform the guide plate and side plate. Before installing the guide plate for the fourth shelf, make sure that the sensor assembly is located outside the side plate.
OK
FR O
NT
FR
ON
NG
Bend Bend
Bend
Bend
FR
ON
Guide plate
Bend
Stopper B
Stopper A Half-punch
Half-punch
FR1H3012.EPS
MC - 59.9
MC - 59.10
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.11
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.12
(3) Attach the guide A. Attach the guide A so that the side plate half-punch is snapped into the slit of the guide A. Loosely tighten the screw on the lower side of the guide A. (4) Tighten the screws for the guide B, stopper A, and stopper B on the side plate. (5) Tighten the guide plate retaining screw.
(6) Make sure that the guide plate is aligned properly to the guide A.
Side plate Top view Guide plate Guide plate Guide A
Guide A
OK
(4) BR M4x8 Slit (3) BR M4x8 (3) Loosely tighten BR M4x8 Guide B Stopper B (4) BR M4x8
NG
FR1H3015.EPS
(7) Tighten the screws for the guide A, guide B, stopper A, and stopper B on the guide plate. Securely tighten the screw that was loosely tighten on the lower side of the guide plate.
(7) BR M4x8
FR ON T
FR
ON
Stopper A
FR1H3014.EPS
MC - 59.11
MC - 59.12
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.13
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.14
(9) While measuring the levelness of the guide plate, securely tighten the five mounting screws.
FR
ON
FR ON T
Guide plate
300 mm scale
FR1H3018.EPS
N NOTE N
Guide plate
Adjust the gap developed when a 300 mm scale is applied to the guide plate, and tighten the five mounting screws in place. Gap adjustments should be made on the front, center, and rear of the guide plate. The gap is 0.5 mm or greater = NG The gap is less than 0.5 mm = OK
(8) Loosely tighten BR M4x8
FR1H3017.EPS
300 mm scale
FR
ON
MC - 59.13
MC - 59.14
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.15
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.16
(10) Attach the connectors (CNA1 and CNA2) to the connector bracket.
(13) Attach the sensor assembly of the mammo/ST sensors (SA4, 8, 12, and 16). When attaching the sensor assembly, tighten the screw with the sensor bracket pushed downward.
Cassette set unit
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
This procedure need not be performed when replacing the guide plates for the first and second shelves.
(11) Reinstall the connector bracket.
SA4 SA8 SA12 SA16 (13) Sensor assembly (13) Sensor bracket BR M4x8
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
This procedure need not be performed when replacing the guide plates for the first and second shelves.
FR ON T
T ON FR
FR1H3021.EPS
N NOTE N
Use care not to confuse the springs, which have different lengths.
FR
ON
Half-punch
T
Spring Half-punch
(14) Free length: 43 mm spring x3 (located below the movable guide) (14) Free length: 31 mm spring (located below the latch)
FR1H3022.EPS
(12) Attach the cassette IN sensors (SA2, 6, 10, and 14), together with the sensor assembly, as a whole. 4.5 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette IN Sensors (SA2, 6, 10, and 14), I Adjustment
MC - 59.15
MC - 59.16
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.17
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.18
(16) Attach the cassette hold pin. Fit the cassette hold pin into the cassette hold pin sliding hole.
Hole Guide plate
N NOTES N
Use care not to attach the rubber roller in a wrong direction. Use care not to confuse the right and left grip springs, which have different lengths.
FR
ON
(15) Bearing (15) Bearing (15) Housing (15) Free length: 106mm grip spring
FR1H3023.EPS
FR1H3024.EPS
(17) Screw down the shaft of the solenoid arm. (18) Adjust the position of the solenoid and tighten the three mounting screws. 4.8 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Cassette Hold Solenoids (SOLA1-4), I Adjustment (19) Attach the spring of the solenoid arm.
MC - 59.17
MC - 59.18
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.19
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.20
(20) Attach the cassette hold sensors (SA3, 7, 11, and 15), together with the sensor assembly, as a whole. When installing the sensor assembly, tighten the screw with the sensor assembly pushed against the guide plate.
(23) While pushing the manual release lever by hand to lower the cassette hold pin, insert cassettes of respective sizes into the cassette set unit. 24 x 30 10" x 12" 24 x 30 mammo Make sure that the stopper pin opens the cassette cover.
If the cassette cover does not open, adjust the levelness of the guide plate again.
FR
ON
FR1H3027.EPS
(21) Connect the connectors for the cassette IN sensors and mammo/ST sensors. For the first shelf: SA2 and SA4 For the second shelf: SA6 and SA8 For the third shelf: SA10 and SA12 For the fourth shelf: Connectors need not be connected. (22) Reinstall the shutter assembly. 4.3 Removing and Reinstalling Shutter Assembly
Cassette Pin Stopper Cassette
FRONT
Cover
FR1H3025.EPS
(24) Reinstall the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing and Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit
MC - 59.19
MC - 59.20
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.21
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.22
(1) Remove the front shelf cover. 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Align the half punches of the antistatic member positioning jig with the shutter assembly opening. (3) Mark the positions for mounting the antistatic member and applying the tape by means of the upper four slits of the antistatic member positioning jig. (4) Put the antistatic member within the marking lines A. (5) Apply the tape within the marking lines B to fix the antistatic member.
CAUTION
Pay due attention to the edges of the shutter assembly opening when replacing the antistatic member.
N NOTES N
Wipe clean the mounting location of a new antistatic member with a cloth dampened with dehydrated ethanol or the like. Use the antistatic member positioning jig to apply the tape or the antistatic member.
Shutter assembly
Shutter assembly cover (2) Half punches (3) Upper four slits
Shutter assembly
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The antistatic member positioning jig is supplied together with the kit for overseas use.
Antistatic member positioning jig
Marking lines A
Antistatic member
FR1H4050.EPS
(6) Reinstall the front shelf cover. 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers
MC - 59.21
MC - 59.22
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.23
CONTENTS
10
MC - 59.24
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MC - 59.23
MC - 59.24
CONTENTS
10
MC - 60
CONTENTS
10
MC - 61
5.
(9) Rotate the timing belt wheel by hand until the actuator blocks the SB1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message indicative of the sensor OPEN or CLOSE status displayed, then replace the sensor. (10) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the cassette set unit. 4.2 Removing the Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit (2) Disconnect the connector (SB1).
5.1
I Checks
N NOTE N
If it is difficult to disconnect the connector, rotate the MB3 timing belt to move the IP removal unit to such a position as to facilitate its disconnection. When moving the IP removal unit, locate the IP removal arm in its home position to prevent damage to it.
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
If anything abnormal is found during checks, replace SB1 and then check it again. (1) Power ON the machine. (2) Make sure that the distance between the bearing flange on the left side of the IP removal arm and the left side plate is 86.5 1 mm.
IP removal unit SB1 Timing belt wheel
IP removal unit
T ON FR
Actuator
FR1H1240.EPS
T ON FR
SB1
FR1H1312.EPS
(3) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (4) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (5) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (6) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor numbers is displayed. (7) Type in the number of the suction cup HP sensor (SB1). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (8) Rotate the timing belt wheel by hand until the actuator does not block the SB1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel.
(3) Pull the IP removal arm toward yourself. (4) Remove the suction cup HP sensor (SB1). 3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description (5) Install a new sensor. (6) Connect the connector (SB1). (7) Check SB1. I Checks
MC - 60
MC - 61
CONTENTS
10
MC - 62
CONTENTS
10
MC - 63
5.2
(9) Select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY. (10) Select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to the main menu. (11) Select 0. QUIT. Exit M-Utility.
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. The initialization starts, and after an elapse of about 30 to 60 seconds, the software version number (Axx) appear on the operation panel. (2) Immediately after the software version number (Axx) appears, sequentially touch the operation panel upper left corner and upper right corner. M-Utility is activated. When the screen reads STEP95, the operation panel is inoperative and does not respond at all even if you touch it. In such an instance, perform a reset and wait until the software version number (Axx) appears. (3) Select 5. MECHANICAL UTILITY, 1. INITIALIZE and 4. SENSOR in sequence. (4) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (5) Type in the number of the cassette inlet IP sensor (SB2). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (6) Using a slip of paper or the like, block the sensor light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (7) Remove the slip of paper or the like that has blocked the sensor light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (8) Repeat steps (6) and (7) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
(6), (7) SB2 IP removal unit Slip of paper
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector bracket. (2) Rotate the MB3 timing belt to lower the up-down IP removal unit until the connector (CNSB2) is visible through the window. (3) Remove the protective bracket. (4) Remove the cassette inlet IP sensor (SB2). (5) Disconnect the connector (SB2).
(2) Timing belt MB3 IP removal unit Spacer (4) SB2 Pan-head M3x8, x2 (5) Connector
98.02.25
FR
T ON
BR M4x8
Sems M3x6
Window
FR1H1064.EPS
(6) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. (7) Check SB2. I Checks
F NT RO
FR1H1293.EPS
MC - 62
MC - 63
CONTENTS
10
MC - 64
CONTENTS
10
MC - 65
5.3
(9) Rotate the MB3 timing belt wheel clockwise, as seen from the rear, until the actuator blocks the SB3 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel. (10) Repeat steps (8) and (9) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor. (11) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
I Replacement (replacement should be performed without removing the bracket where possible)
If the SB3-attached bracket is removed during replacement, be sure to adjust SB3. (1) While holding it up, remove the each shelf position sensor (SB3). 3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description (2) Disconnect the connector (SB3).
FR
ON
(1) SB3
FR1H1065.EPS
(3) Connect the connector (SB3). (4) Install a new sensor. (5) Check SB3. I Checks
I Adjustment
(1) Loosen the screw on the SB3 mounting bracket.
MB3
(2) Tighten the screw on the SB3 mounting bracket in place so that the distance between the lower portion of the side plate of the IP removal unit and the bottom of SB3 is 99.5 to 100.0 mm.
FR
ON
SB3
SB3
FR1H1241.EPS
FR1H1768.EPS
MC - 64
MC - 65
CONTENTS
10
MC - 66
CONTENTS
10
MC - 67
5.4
5.5
I Checks
If anything abnormal is found during checks, replace SB4. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors
I Checks
If anything abnormal is found during checks, replace SB5. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors
I Replacement
(1) Remove the bracket that retains SB4 in place.
N NOTE N
When monitoring SB5, make sure, with PB1 driven, that the sensor is CLOSE when the suction hose is pinched and OPEN when it is released.
N NOTE N
Remove the bracket before disconnecting the connector (SB4). If you attempt to disconnect the connector with the bracket fixed, moment is applied to the connector, thus damaging the connector.
(2) Disconnect the connector (SB4). (3) Remove the bracket from SB4.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the SB5 retaining bracket. (2) Remove the hose and FAST-ON terminal from SB5. (3) Remove SB5 from the bracket.
IP removal unit Timing belt Up-down IP removal unit
(2) Connector
Pump assembly
FR
ON
N NOTES N
When mounting connector SB4 on the bracket, ensure that the SB4 lower surface is flush with the bracket cut surface.
SB4 Bracket
When mounting the bracket in the up-down IP removal unit, screw it down while pressing it downward.
(5) Check SB4. I Checks
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460 (1)
MC - 66
MC - 67
CONTENTS
10
MC - 68
CONTENTS
10
MC - 69
5.6
(4) Cut the cable tie. (5) Disconnect the connectors (CNPB1). (6) Remove the hose from the PB1. (7) Remove the two screws (one of them should be merely loosened) that retain PB1, and take out the PB1 from the pump assembly.
IP removal unit
Timing belt
MB1
IP removal unit
FR
T ON
T ON
FR1H1767.EPS
FR
(8) Install a new PB1 to the pump assembly. (9) Restore the cable tie cut at step (4). (10) Attach the hose removed at step (6).
N NOTE N
When attaching the hose, connect it to the suction nozzle (upper one of the two nozzles arranged) of the PB1.
Suction nozzle Hose PB1
FR1H1496.EPS
(11) Connect the connector (CNPB1). (12) Attach the bracket that was removed at step (3). (13) Restore the cable clamp that was cut at step (2).
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 68
MC - 69
CONTENTS
10
MC - 70
CONTENTS
10
MC - 71
5.7
5.8
N NOTE N
When pulling out the IP removal arm, do not grasp its center. If its center is grasped, the IP removal arm may be bent.
(1)
IP removal arm
(4) Hose
FR
ON
T
FR1H1032.EPS
MC - 70
MC - 71
CONTENTS
10
MC - 72
CONTENTS
10
MC - 73
(2) Remove the guide. Remove either of the right and left brackets that retain the guide, and then remove the guide. (3) Replace the two suction cups and the two packings.
5.9
N NOTES N
Do not rotate the suction cup retaining screws while holding the suction cup rubber portions. Rotate the suction cup retaining screws with a thin-blade screwdriver while holding the pipe joint with a wrench or like tool. Exercise care to avoid hose disconnection.
Guide
IP removal arm
(2) Bracket Sems M3x6 Suction face view (3) Retaining screw
MB1
IP removal unit
T ON FR
FR1H1767.EPS
Suction cup
(5) Disconnect the connector (CNMB1). (4) Put the IP removal arm back to the rear side. (6) Remove the suction cup drive motor (MB1). (7) Remove the timing belt from the MB1 so removed, and attach it to a new MB1.
(6) MB1 Hex socket head bolts M4x12, x3 (7) Timing belt wheel E-ring
(5) CNMB1
Timing belt
FR
T ON
FR1H1067.EPS
MC - 72
MC - 73
CONTENTS
10
MC - 74
CONTENTS
10
MC - 75
(8) Secure MB1 in place with three hex socket head bolts. At this time, put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel. (9) Connect the connector (CNMB1). (10) Install the bracket. (11) Put the cable clamp back where it was.
N NOTE N
After putting the cable clamp back where it was, make sure that the motor cable does not interfere with the vertical conveyor and so forth by allowing the IP removal unit to move up and down.
Bracket (4) MB2 Pan-head M4x10, x2 (2), (3) CNMB2 (5) Wheel Hex socket head setscrew M4x6
FR1H1209.EPS
FR
ON
(6) Secure MB2 in place with two screws. At this time, put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel, and fit the protruding portion of the motor into the hole of the bracket. (7) Connect the connector (CNMB2). (8) Put the cable clamp back where it was.
MC - 74
MC - 75
CONTENTS
10
MC - 76
CONTENTS
10
MC - 77
CAUTION
Be sure to secure the IP removal unit in place. If not, theIP removal unit may fall down, because the worm gear becomes free when MB3 is removed.
(1) Timing belt
FR ON T
CAUTION
Be sure to secure the IP removal unit in place. If not, the up-down IP removal unit may fall down, because the worm gear becomes free when MB3 is removed.
(1) Timing belt
FR ON T
IP removal unit
IP removal unit
FR1H1072.EPS
FR1H1072.EPS
(3) Remove the cable clamp. (4) Disconnect the connector (CNMB3). (5) From the rear of the machine, remove the two MB3 retaining screws, and take out MB3. (6) Remove the timing belt wheel from the MB3 taken out, and attach it to a new MB3.
FR O
(3) Remove the cable clamp. (4) Disconnect the connector (CNMB3). (5) From the rear of the machine, remove the two MB3 retaining screws, and take out MB3. (6) Remove the timing belt. (7) Put a new timing belt onto the timing belt wheel.
FR
Timing belt
NT
E-ring
ON
(7) From the rear of the machine, secure MB3 in place with two screws. At this time, put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel. (8) Put the cable clamp back where it was. (9) Connect the connector (CNMB3). (10) Cut the cable tie that retains the IP removal unit in place.
(8) From the rear of the machine, secure MB3 in place with two screws. (9) Put the cable clamp back where it was. (10) Connect the connector (CNMB3). (11) Cut the cable tie that retains the IP removal unit in place.
MC - 76
MC - 77
CONTENTS
10
MC - 78
CONTENTS
10
MC - 79
(8) Remove the two screws (one of them should be merely loosened) that retain the shock absorber-attached guide plate (A), and take out the shock absorber-attached guide plate (A) from the stay. (9) Loosen the two screws that retain the shock absorber-attached guide plate (B), and take out the shock absorber-attached guide plate (B) from the stay. (10) Remove the two screws (one of them should be merely loosened) that retain the shock absorber-attached guide plate (C), and take out the shock absorber-attached guide plate (C) from the stay.
(8) Remove screw BR M4x8 (8) Shock absorber-attached guide plate (A) (9) Shock absorber-attached guide plate (B) (10) Remove screw BR M4x8 Stay (10) Shock absorber-attached guide plate (C)
(8) Loosen screw Sems M3x6 (9) Loosen screw Sems M3x6, x2 (10) Loosen screw Sems M3x6
FR1H1429.EPS
(11) Attach new shock absorber-attached guide plates A, B, and C to the stay. When installing the guide, tighten the screws while pushing the guide against the stay. (12) Reinstall the roller assembly removed at steps (5) and (6). (13) Hook the wire removed at step (4) into the groove of the roller. (14) Attach the spring removed at step (3) to the wire.
Bracket
FR1H1427.EPS
N NOTE N
When pulling out the IP removal arm, do not grasp its center. If the center is grasped, the IP removal arm may be bent.
MC - 78
MC - 79
CONTENTS
10
MC - 80
CONTENTS
10
MC - 81
(2) Remove from the rear of the machine the three screws that retain the shock absorberattached guide plate.
Rear of machine Rear of IP removal unit
FR
T ON
FR1H1483.EPS
(3) Take out the shock absorber-attached guide plate from the front of the machine. (4) Check if the shock absorber is not peeled or frayed. If it is peeled or frayed, replace the whole guide to which the shock absorber is attached. (5) Reinstall the shock absorber-attached guide plate. For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
Shock absorber-attached guide
FR1H1428.EPS
MC - 80
MC - 81
CONTENTS
10
MC - 82
CONTENTS
10
MC - 83
(7) Remove the elevation changeover guide, using care to avoid interference with the side plate of the vertical conveyor and so forth.
Shock absorber-attached elevation changeover guide
Vertical conveyor
T ON FR
Vertical conveyor
Shock absorber-attached elevation changeover guide
FR ON T
FR1H1425.EPS
(8) Install a new elevation changeover guide. (9) Reinstall both the right and left slide bearings removed at step (6). (10) From the front side of the machine, reinstall both the right and left E-rings removed at step (5). First install the E-ring on the right-hand side of the machine.
(1) Shock absorber-attached up-down changeover guide Right side view of machine (6) Slide bearing (5) E-ring Left side view of machine (6) Slide bearing (5) E-ring (3) Sems M3x10 for retaining up-down changeover guide (4) Arm (2) Spring
(11) Reinstall the arm removed at step (4). (12) Secure the elevation changeover guide to the arm in place with the single screw removed at step (3). (13) Reinstall the spring removed at step (2).
FR1H1424.EPS
MC - 82
MC - 83
CONTENTS
10
MC - 84
CONTENTS
10
MC - 85
(5) Remove the rubber rollers. Dislodge the shaft on one side of the four rubber rollers (right as seen from the rear) so that the vertical conveyor guide can be removed. (6) Remove the elevation changeover guide. 5.14 Replacing and Adjusting Elevation Changeover Guide (7) Remove the vertical conveyor guide.
A A
FR1H1076.EPS
(8) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. To install the vertical conveyor guide, tighten screws while pushing down the guide.
MC - 84
MC - 85
CONTENTS
10
MC - 86
CONTENTS
10
MC - 87
6.
Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
This section describes procedures for removing and reinstalling the before-side-positioning conveyor, and procedures for checking and replacing parts of the before-side-positioning conveyor to be replaced. Unless otherwise specified, it is assumed that covers that should be removed prior to checks and replacement have been removed. 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers
I Installation
(1) Insert the before-side-positioning conveyor along the rail into the machine. Align the before-side-positioning conveyor against the positioning pin located on the left side of the machine (into the machine as seen from the direction of insertion) and against the positioning bracket located on the rear side of the machine. (2) Secure the before-side-positioning conveyor in place with two mounting screws (BR M4x8). (3) Connect the connectors (CNC1, CNC2, CNSOLC1).
6.1
I Removal
(3) CNC1
FR1H1110.EPS
(4) Attach the two timing belt to the timing belt wheel. (5) Put the tensioner back where it was. Loosen the two screws (BR M4x8) that retain the tensioner. Flick the timing belt two or three times with your fingers to ensure that the belt snugly engages with the timing belt pulley. Screw down the tensioner in place where a proper tension is attained. 3.4 Tensioner Not Requiring Tension Adjustment in Machine Description
Erasure conveyor
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
FR ON T
(5)
(3) CNC1
FR1H1109.EPS
MC - 86
MC - 87
CONTENTS
10
MC - 88
CONTENTS
10
MC - 89
6.2
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SC1). (2) Remove SC1.
FR O
I Checks
(1) Remove the SC1 and spacer with the connector attached.
NT
FR O
NT
Before-side-positioning conveyor
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
(2) Place the machine in an SC1 monitoring enabled state. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (3) Using a cardboard or the like, block the SC1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel. (4) Remove the cardboard or the like that has blocked the SC1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel. (5) Repeat steps (3) and (4) several times. (6) Power OFF the machine. (7) Reinstall the SC1.
MC - 88
MC - 89
CONTENTS
10
MC - 90
CONTENTS
10
MC - 91
6.3
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SC2). (2) Remove SC2.
I Checks
(1) Remove the SC2 and spacer with the connector attached.
FR ON T
FR
ON
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
Spacer
FR1H1113.EPS
(1) Spacer
FR1H1770.EPS
(3) Install a new SC2. (4) Connect the connector (SC2). (5) Attach a cable clamp. (6) Check SC2. I Checks
(2) Place the machine in an SC2 monitoring enabled state. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (3) Using a cardboard or the like, block the SC2 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE appears on the operation panel. (4) Remove the cardboard or the like that has blocked the SC2 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN appears on the operation panel. (5) Repeat steps (3) and (4) several times. (6) Power OFF the machine. (7) Reinstall the SC2.
MC - 90
MC - 91
CONTENTS
10
MC - 92
CONTENTS
10
MC - 93
6.4
Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Convergence Path Changeover Guide Drive Solenoid (SOLC1)
If anything abnormal is found during checks, adjust or replace SOLC1. When replaced, adjust and check it again.
I Replacement
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Remove the SOLC1 and bracket as a whole. The SOLC1 shaft should also be removed along with them. (3) Remove SOLC1 from the bracket. (4) Attach a new SOLC1 to the bracket. (5) Install the SOLC1 and bracket as a whole with two screws. While fitting the SOLC1 shaft pin into the actuator of the guide driving shaft, install the SOLC1 and bracket as a whole. (6) Adjust SOLC1. I Adjustment
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 2. ACTUATOR in sequence. (5) Select 2. DRIVE. A list of actuator Nos. is displayed. (6) Enter the number for SOLC1. SOLC1 is driven. If SOLC1 is not driven, it is likely that cable connection is faulty. Check the cable connection, and select 2. DRIVE again. If it is not driven even after that, replace SOLC1.
FR
FR
ON T
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1115.EPS
I Adjustment
ON T
Adjust the mounting position of the convergence path changeover guide drive solenoid (SOLC1) so that the distance between the side face of the before-side-positioning changeover guide and the back of the guide plate is 1 mm or less.
Guide plate (363N1758B)
SOLC1
1 mm or less
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
FR1H1114.EPS
(7) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility. A message prompting you to reset the machine is displayed. (8) Press the RESET button.
FR1H1547.EPS
MC - 92
MC - 93
CONTENTS
10
MC - 94
CONTENTS
10
MC - 95
6.5
6.6
O FR
NT
FR
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1253.EPS
(3) Attach a new timing belt. (4) Adjust the MC1-related timing belt.
(2) Bracket (2) CNMC1 Before-sidepositioning conveyor
FR1H1111.EPS
(5) Install a new MC1. While putting the timing belt onto the pulley, install MC1 with three screws. (6) Attach the connector (CNMC1) to the bracket. (7) Connect the connector (CNMC1). (8) Install the before-side-positioning conveyor. 6.1 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
FR1H1251.EPS
MC - 94
MC - 95
CONTENTS
10
MC - 96
CONTENTS
10
MC - 97
6.7
T ON FR
FR
(2)
ON T
FR1H1254.EPS
(3) Attach a new timing belt. (4) Adjust the MF1-related timing belt. I Adjustment of MF1-related Timing Belt
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
(3) Remove the bracket. Loosen the four screws located on right and left sides of the cleaning roller assembly and remove the bracket. (4) Remove the cleaning roller.
FR
ON
MC1
(3) Bracket
500g 61mm
Timing belt
FR1H1252.EPS
FR1H1441.EPS
MC - 96
MC - 97
CONTENTS
10
MC - 98
CONTENTS
10
MC - 99
(6) Remove the spur gear, two spacers, two slide bearings, and E-ring from the cleaning roller.
6.8
(6) Cleaning roller Slide bearing Spacer Spur gear Sems M3x10
FR1H1442.EPS
3.1E-ringless Housing Employed in Machine Description (4) Remove the guide plate. 6.9 Checking and Replacing Shock Absorber-Attached Guide of Before-SidePositioning Conveyor (5) Remove the bearing and take out the rubber roller.
Side view : Rubber roller
FR ON T
(7) Install the spur gear, two spacers, two slide bearings, and E-ring removed at step (6) to a new cleaning roller. (8) Reinstall the cleaning roller to the cleaning roller assembly. (9) Reinstall the cleaning roller assembly in reverse order of removal.
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1116.EPS
N NOTES N
When installing the rubber rollers, observe the following precautions. Ensure that the flat machined surfaces of a pair of rubber rollers face each other. Be sure that the Bearing rotation prevention bracket is positioned toward the 20 mm diameter roller.
65 mm diameter roller Flat machined surface Bearing rotation prevention bracket Flat machined surface Bearing 20 mm diameter roller
Bearing
FR1H4013.EPS
When installing the grip spring, exercise care not to erroneously orient it because its left-hand portion is longer than the right-hand portion.
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 98
MC - 99
CONTENTS
10
MC - 100
CONTENTS
10
MC - 101
6.9
(8) Install the guide plate. (9) Tighten the screw loosened at step (3). (10) Reinstall the cover removed at step (2). (11) Reinstall the before-side-positioning conveyor. 6.1 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
I Check and Replacement G Checking and replacing shock absorbers located above before-sidepositioning conveyor and under cleaning roller
(1) Remove the before-side-positioning conveyor. 6.1 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the cover of the before-side-positioning conveyor. (3) Loosen the single screw that retains the bracket. (4) Remove the shock absorber-attached guide plate (A). (5) Remove the cleaning roller assembly. (6) Remove the shock absorber-attached guide plate (B). (7) Check if the shock absorber is not peeled or frayed. If it is peeled or frayed, replace the whole guide to which the shock absorber is attached.
(2) Cover BR M4x8, x4 (4), (7) Shock absorber-attached guide plate (A) Sems M3x6, x4
(3) Bracket
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR ON T
FR1H1549.EPS
MC - 100
MC - 101
CONTENTS
10
MC - 102
CONTENTS
10
MC - 103
G Checking and replacing shock absorbers of before-side-positioning changeover guide and before-side-positioning retention guide
(1) Remove the before-side-positioning conveyor. 6.1 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the guide plate. (3) Check if the shock absorbers on the before-side-positioning changeover guide and before-side-positioning retention guide. If it is peeled or frayed, proceed to step (4) to replace the whole guide plate to which the shock absorber is attached. If it is not peeled or frayed, proceed to step (14).
(3) Shock absorber-attached before-side-positioning changeover guide (3) Shock absorber-attached before-side-positioning changeover guide
(8) Install a new before-side-positioning changeover guide in reverse order of removal steps (4) through (7). When installing the arm, tighten the screw with the arm pushed against the flat machined surface.
(8) Arm Sems M3x10 Flat machined surface
FR1H1552.EPS
FR
ON T
(9) Adjust the mounting position of the convergence path changeover guide drive solenoid (SOLC1) so that the distance between the side face of the before-side-positioning changeover guide and the back of the guide plate is 1 mm or less.
Guide plate (363N1758B)
1 mm or less
(2) Guide plate BR M3x6, x4 Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1550.EPS
(4) Remove the spring. (5) Remove the arm. (6) Remove the bearing. (7) Remove the shock absorber-attached before-side-positioning changeover guide.
(5) Arm Sems M3x10 (6) Bearing BR M4x12, x2 (4) Spring
FR O NT
FR1H1547.EPS
MC - 102
MC - 103
CONTENTS
10
MC - 104
CONTENTS
10
MC - 105
(10) Remove the two screws and two spacers that retain the shaft of the before-sidepositioning retention guide, and take out the before-side-positioning retention guide assembly. (11) Remove the four screws and four spacers that retain the before-side-positioning retention guide, and take out the before-side-positioning retention guide from the shaft.
BLANK PAGE
FR
ON T
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1553.EPS
(12) Install new before-side-positioning retention guides to the shafts. (13) Install the before-side-positioning retention guide assembly to the side-positioning conveyor.
N NOTES N
When installing the shafts, position their grooves on the right-hand side of the machine. When installing the before-side-positioning retention guide assembly, screw it down while retaining the shafts with an Allen wrench lodged in the shaft hole.
Allen wrench insertion hole (13) Flat machined surface
FR ON T
Shaft x2
(14) Reinstall the guide plate removed at step (2). (15) Reinstall the before-side-positioning conveyor. 6.1 Removing and Reinstalling Before-Side-Positioning Conveyor
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 104
MC - 105
CONTENTS
10
MC - 106
CONTENTS
10
MC - 107
7.
The cables connected to the SCN08A board should be pushed aside to the right and top sides of the scanner unit, while the cables connected to the subscanning unit, both front and back of them, should be pushed beneath the cable cover.
I Pulling Out
Cable
CAUTIONS
Before pulling out the scanner unit, be sure to remove the two bracket retaining screws located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board and disconnect the connectors. If pulled out without removing them, the SCN08A board may be damaged. When pulling out the scanner unit, be sure to lower the adjustable feet down to the floor. If not, the bolts of the adjustable feet would interfere with the cable cover. When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
(1) Remove the following covers in order named. Lower front cover, lower right-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Disconnect the connectors (CN7-9, CNZ6-8, 10 on the SCN08A board, and CN1, 2, 4, 5 on the subscanning unit).
Subscanning unit (2) CNZ4 CNZ5 CNZ2 CNZ1 CN9 CN7 SCN08A board (2) Remove screw (BR M4x8, x2)
FR
ON T
Cable cover
ON
FR ON
Cable
T
FR1H1556.EPS
(3) Remove the two screws that retain the bracket located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board. (4) Remove the two screws that retain the scanner unit. (5) Pull out the scanner unit.
N NOTE N
When pulling out the scanner unit, use care so that it is not caught by the disconnected connectors and cables.
FR ON
CNZ8 CNZ10
FR
ON
Scanner unit
FR1H1555.EPS
FR1H1557.EPS
MC - 106
MC - 107
CONTENTS
10
MC - 108
CONTENTS
10
MC - 109
I Push-In
(3) Using two screws, secure the bracket located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board. (4) Secure the scanner unit in place with two screws. (5) Connect the connectors (CN7-9, CNZ6-8, 10 on the SCN08A board; CNZ1, 2, 4, 5 on the subscanning unit).
Subscanning unit (5)
CAUTIONS
When removing and installing the units, exercise care not to damage the cables. When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
(1) While pushing the stopper located on the front of the machine, put the scanner unit back into the machine until the stopper located on the rear side of the machine is activated. (2) While pushing the stopper located on the rear side of the machine, put the scanner unit all the way into the machine.
CNZ4 CNZ5 CNZ2 CNZ1 CN9 (3) Bracket BR M4x8, x2 SCN08A board (5) CN7 CN8 CNZ6 CNZ7
N NOTE N
When putting the scanner unit back where it was, use care so that it is not caught by the connectors and cables disconnected.
FR O
NT
CNZ8 CNZ10
FR
ON T
Scanner unit
(1)
Stopper
(2)
Stopper
FR1H1558.EPS
MC - 108
MC - 109
CONTENTS
10
MC - 110
CONTENTS
10
MC - 111
8.
8.1
Side-Positioning Conveyor
Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
I Reinstallation
CAUTION
When removing and installing the units, exercise care not to damage the cables.
I Removal
N NOTE N
Make sure that the scanner unit has been pulled all the way out. If not, MD3 will interfere with the machine frame when the side-positioning conveyor is removed.
(1) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor.
CAUTION
When removing and installing the units, exercise care not to damage the cables.
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing in Scanner Unit (2) Disconnect the connectors (CND1, BCRCN1, CNMD1-3). (3) Remove the five screws that retain the side-positioning conveyor. (4) Remove the side-positioning conveyor by taking it out in a horizontal direction.
While pressing the bracket of the side-positioning conveyor against the block section of the subscanning unit and the reference side, secure the side-positioning conveyor in place with five screws. (2) Connect the connectors (CND1, BCRCN1, CNMD1-3).
Top view (1) Block section of subscanning unit
N NOTE N
Make sure that the scanner unit has been pulled all the way out. If not, MD3 will interfere with the machine frame when the side-positioning conveyor is removed.
Positioning screw (should not be removed) (2) CNMD3
Reference side
Bracket
(2) CNMD3
(4)
FR
MD3
ON
MD3 (1) Block section (2) (1) CNMD1, CNMD2 Side-positioning conveyor BR M4x8, x5
FR1H1773.EPS
FR
ON
(3) Push in the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing in Scanner Unit
MC - 110
MC - 111
CONTENTS
10
MC - 112
CONTENTS
10
MC - 113
8.2
I Replacement
(1) Remove the following covers in order named. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the SD1 together with the bracket, with CNSD1 attached. (3) Disconnect the CNSD1. (4) Remove the SD1 from the bracket.
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the following covers in order named. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Place the machine in a state where the side-positioning mechanism HP sensor (SD1) can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (4) Shift the actuator of the side-positioning mechanism by hand to dislocate it from the sensor. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (5) Shift the actuator of the side-positioning mechanism by hand until the sensor is CLOSE. A message indicative of the sensor CLOSE status is displayed on the operation panel. (6) Repeat steps (4) and (5) several times. If no message is displayed, it is likely that the sensor is faulty. So, replace the sensor.
Actuator SD1
(3) SD1 (2) Bracket Sems M3x6, x2 (1) Connector Side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1301.EPS
(5) Attach a new SD1 to the bracket. (6) Connect the CNSD1. (7) Install the SD1 together with the bracket to the side-positioning conveyor.
FR1H1165.EPS
(7) Enter 0 (zero). The monitoring is quitted, and the screen returns to the 3. SENSOR menu. (8) Press the RESET button.
MC - 112
MC - 113
CONTENTS
10
MC - 114
CONTENTS
10
MC - 115
8.3
I Replacement
(1) Remove the following covers in order named. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Rotate the cam of the grip mechanism to dislocate the actuator from SD2. (3) Remove the SD2 together with the bracket, with CNSD2 attached. (4) Disconnect the CNSD2. (5) Remove the SD2 from the bracket.
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the following covers in order named. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Place the machine in a state where the side-positioning mechanism HP sensor (SD1) can be monitored. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (4) Rotate the cam of the grip mechanism to dislocate the actuator from the sensor. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel.
Side-positioning conveyor
(3) SD2
FR
ET RES ON SW
Remote Local
ON
FR1H1300.EPS
OFF
(7) Connect the CNSD12 (8) Install the SD2 together with the bracket to the side-positioning conveyor.
Side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1299.EPS
(5) Rotate the cam of the grip mechanism until the actuator causes the sensor to be CLOSE. A message indicative of the sensor CLOSE status is displayed on the operation panel. (6) Repeat steps (4) and (5) several times. If no message is displayed, it is likely that the sensor is faulty. So, replace the sensor. (7) Enter 0 (zero). The monitoring is quitted, and the screen returns to the 3. SENSOR menu. (8) Press the RESET button.
MC - 114
MC - 115
CONTENTS
10
MC - 116
CONTENTS
10
MC - 117
8.4
(10) Enter 0 (zero). The monitoring is quitted, and the screen returns to the 3. SENSOR menu. (11) Power OFF the machine. (12) Attach SD3 and spacer. (13) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the SD3 and spacer with the connector (CNSD3) attached. (3) Connect CND1. (4) Power ON the machine. The initialization sequence starts, and after an elapse of about 30 to 60 seconds, the software version number (Axx) appears on the operation panel. (5) Immediately after the software version number (Axx) appears, touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. When STEP 95 appears on screen, any subsequent touch on the operation panel is rejected. In that case, reset the machine and wait until the software version number (Axx) appears. (6) Make the side-positioning IP sensor (SD3) to be in the sensor monitoring enabled state. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (7) Using a piece of cardboard, block the SD3 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (8) Remove the piece of cardboard that blocks the SD3 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Repeat steps (7) and (8) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the SD3 and the spacer together with CNSD3. (3) Disconnect the CNSD3.
(4) Attach a new SD3 and the spacer removed at step (2). (5) Connect CNSD3. (6) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
(3) CND1
MC - 116
MC - 117
CONTENTS
10
MC - 118
CONTENTS
10
MC - 119
8.5
8.6
I Replacement
(1) Remove the following cover. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Cut the cable tie. (3) Disconnect CNMD1. (4) Remove MD1 together with the bracket. (5) Remove MD1 from the bracket. (6) Remove the timing belt wheel from MD1.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Cut the cable tie. (3) Disconnect CNMD2. (4) Remove MD2 together with the bracket. (5) Remove MD2 from the bracket. (6) Remove the timing belt wheel and stay from MD2.
(5) BR M4x8
Side-positioning conveyor
(3) CNMD1
FR1H1780.EPS
FR
ON
(7) Install to a new MD1 the timing belt wheel that was removed at step (6). (8) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. Put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel of MD1 and then secure MD1 in place.
(3) CNMD2
FR1H1781.EPS
(7) Install to a new MD2 the timing belt wheel that was removed at step (6). (8) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. Put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel of MD2 and then secure MD2 in place.
MC - 118
MC - 119
CONTENTS
10
MC - 120
CONTENTS
10
MC - 121
8.7
8.8
I Replacement
(1) Remove the following cover. Lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Cut the cable tie. (3) Disconnect CNMD3. (4) Remove MD3 together with the bracket. (5) Remove MD3 from the bracket. (6) Remove the timing belt wheel from MD3.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Cut the four cable ties. (3) Disconnect BCRCN2. (4) Remove the barcode reader. (5) Remove the four screws and take out the bracket.
(6) Timing belt wheel (4) Bracket BR M4x8, x3 (5) MD3 Pan head screw M3x10, x3
Side-positioning conveyor
(3) BCRCN2
(3) CNMD3
FR1H1782.EPS
(7) Install to a new MD3 the timing belt wheel that was removed at step (6). (8) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. Put the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel of MD3 and then secure MD3 in place.
MC - 120
MC - 121
CONTENTS
10
MC - 122
CONTENTS
10
MC - 123
8.9
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the E-ring. (3) Take out the triangular-shaped cam from the shaft. (4) Remove the wire and shaft from the triangular-shaped cam.
(3) Shaft Triangular-shaped cam
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower right-hand cover, lower rear cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Make the side-positioning IP sensor (SD2) to be in the sensor monitoring enabled state. 2.2 Checking Various Sensors (4) Make sure that 1 is indicated for SD2 (CLOSE status). (5) Make sure that the rubber roller is gripped. (6) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited.
(2) E-ring
(4) Nut
(4) Shaft
Truss M3x6
(4) Wire
FR1H1784.EPS
(5) Install the wire and shaft removed at step (4) to a new triangular-shaped cam.
N NOTE N
When installing the triangular-shaped cam to the shaft, use care not to confuse the orientation of the triangular-shaped cam.
FRONT FRONT
FR1H1785.EPS
(6) Reinstall the triangular-shaped cam to the shaft. (7) Reinstall the E-ring. (8) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (9) Check the grip mechanism of the side-positioning conveyor. I Checks
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 122
MC - 123
CONTENTS
10
MC - 124
CONTENTS
10
MC - 125
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove the spring from the stopper. (3) Remove the four screws that retain the stopper. (4) Remove the two slide bearings and two E-rings. (5) Remove the shaft. (6) Remove the stopper.
(4) E-ring (4) Slide bearing Guide plate (5) Shaft
Side view
Flat machined surface (5) Shaft (4) Slide bearing (4) E-ring
Stopper
FR1H1786.EPS
(6) Stopper
(4) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
(3) Sems M3x6, x4
FR1H1787.EPS
(7) Install a new stopper in reverse order of removal. (8) Check the stopper. I Checks
MC - 124
MC - 125
CONTENTS
10
MC - 126
CONTENTS
10
MC - 127
8.12 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Side-Positioning Conveyor IP Conveyance Timing Belt
I Checks
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Put a sheet or the like on the floor and place the side-positioning conveyor down on the sheet, with its side down. (3) Measure the distance A of the timing belt. (4) With a load of 500 50 g applied to the timing belt, measure the distance B.
Tension roller MD1
(5) Hex socket head bolt M4x12 Spring washer Bushing Bearing Cam
Timing belt
T O P
T O P
50050g
(6) Shaft
FR1H1789.EPS
Timing belt
T O P
A - B = 91(mm)
FR1H1790.EPS
(5) Make sure that the deflection (A - B) is 9 1 mm. (6) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
MC - 126
MC - 127
CONTENTS
10
MC - 128
CONTENTS
10
MC - 129
I Replacement
(1) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (2) Remove MD1 together with the bracket. 8.5 Replacing Side-Positioning Motor (MD1) (3) Remove the retainer that retains the timing belt. (4) Remove the timing belt.
I Adjustment
(1) Loosen the screw that retains the tension roller. (2) While checking the tension of the belt by use of a push-pull gauge, adjust the position of the tension roller. Screw down the tension roller in place where an appropriate tension is attained. The tension value is as follow. 500 50g, 9 1 mm
Tension roller MD1
T O P
(2) MD1
Timing belt
T O P
FR1H1791.EPS
(5) Install a new timing belt. (6) Reinstall the retainer to the timing belt. (7) Reinstall MD1. 8.5 Replacing Side-Positioning Motor (MD1) (8) Adjust the timing belt. I Adjustment
50050g Tension roller Push-pull gauge MD1
Timing belt
T O P
A - B = 91(mm)
FR1H1790.EPS
MC - 128
MC - 129
CONTENTS
10
MC - 130
CONTENTS
10
MC - 131
Rubber roller
FR O
NT
Side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1794.EPS
(5) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
FR1H1793.EPS
(4) Reinstall the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor
MC - 130
MC - 131
CONTENTS
10
MC - 132
CONTENTS
10
MC - 133
9.
CAUTION
Before adjusting the read start position and read width, set the image trimming to 0. If it is not set to 0, the IP edge may be invisible; if so, the distance between the image frame and IP edge cannot be measured.
(1) Activate M-Utility. I Activating and Exiting M-Utility (2) Select 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING and 2. PRINT in sequence. The FILMFMT.CFG file is opened to reveal its contents. (3) Make sure that the image trimming (TE) is 0. If it is 0, touch the CANCEL button to take the steps described in [2] Initialization of Format Set Data. If it is not 0, write down the displayed value on your notepad, and touch the setup value area. (4) Set the image trimming (TE) to 0.
9.1
CAUTION
If the image trimming is changed by entering value 0, be sure to revert the trimming back to its original value noted on your notepad after completing the adjustment of read start position and read width.
(5) Touch the SAVE button. The FILMFMT.CFG file is saved, and the screen returns to M-Utility. (6) Take the steps described in [2] Initialization of Format Set Data.
CAUTIONS
After completing the adjustment of read start position and read width, back up the scanner set data. Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
MC - 132
MC - 133
CONTENTS
10
MC - 134
CONTENTS
10
MC - 135
(4) Determine the actual dimension of the white blank on the IP. The distance measured on film may not correspond to the actual size on the IP depending on the reading size. For example, since a two-in-one image of 14" x 14" (35cm x 35cm) size has a reduction ration of 50%, the distance measured on film, multiplied by 2, represents the actual size on the IP. The correspondence between reading sizes and reduction factors is presented below.
Reading size 14" x 17" ( 35 cm x 43cm) 14" x 14" ( 35 cm x 35cm) 10" x 12" ( 24 cm x 30cm) 8" x 10" ( 18 cm x 24cm) Two-in-one image 1/2 1/2 2/3 6/7 Full image 2/3 2/3 1/1 1/1
TR1H1002.EPS
(5) Calculate the correction value for the read start position using the following formula.
FR1H1101.EPS
Note that A represents the actual size (in millimeters) determined in step (4) above. Correction value = A x 10 + 10 (6) Activate M-Utility. I Activating and Exiting M-Utility (7) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 6. FORMAT and 2. PIXEL ADJUST in sequence. (8) Enter the correction value determined in step (5). The read width is adjusted. If the correction value entered is positive, the resulting image is shifted to right, while it is to left if the value is negative. (9) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT and 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA in sequence. The read width adjustment value so adjusted is saved in the hard disk. (10) Exit M-Utility. (11) Power OFF the machine. (12) Turn OFF the circuit breaker. (13) Make sure that the high-voltage switch of the SCN08A board is in the ON position. (14) Reinstall all the covers of the machine. (15) Turn ON the circuit breaker.
(4) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT and 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA in sequence. The read width adjustment value so adjusted is saved in the hard disk.
White blank
FR1H1102.EPS
MC - 134
MC - 135
CONTENTS
10
MC - 136
CONTENTS
10
MC - 137
G Adjustment of invalid pixels (1) Activate M-Utility. I Activating and Exiting M-Utility (2) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 6. FORMAT, and 3. PIXEL ADJUST in sequence. (3) Enter the correction value. Use the following input data. Note that 10 pixels correspond to 1mm in actual size on the IP. To increment the current read start position by N pixels (0 < N 999) Value of N: The image is shifted rightward relative to the image frame. To decrement the current read start position by N pixels (0 < N 999) Value of -N: The image is shifted leftward relative to the image frame. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
The MP (invalid pixel) value, N, must be set so that the value after correction ranges from 60 to 180. Thus, if the MP value is 150, up to 30 may be set for positive quantity of N, and up to 90 may be set for negative quantity of N. To check the MP value, use 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT and 4. DISPLAY DATA menus.
N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
The white blank portions can be adjusted by setting the image trimming.
If an out-of-range value is set, an error results. If an error occurs, check to see that the procedures have been performed as instructed, and check if each of the parts is connected properly.
(5) Quit the adjustment of the read width and read start position. Only if anything abnormal is found with the output film, or the adjustment result is out of specification, perform the steps described in [6] Fine Adjustment of Read Width and Read Start Position below.
N NOTE N
After the adjustment, be sure to save the data to the hard disk by selecting MAINTENANCE UTILITY, 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT, and 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA in sequence.
G Adjustment of read width (1) Activate M-Utility. I Activating and Exiting M-Utility (2) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 6. FORMAT and 2. FREQ ADJUST in sequence. (3) Enter the correction value and press the [ ENT ] key. Use the following input data. To increment the current read width by N% (0 < N 5) (to enlarge the image) To decrement the current read width by N% (-5 < N 0) (to reduce the image)
MC - 136
MC - 137
CONTENTS
10
MC - 138
CONTENTS
10
MC - 139
9.2
Shading/Sensitivity Correction
Shading/sensitivity correction should be performed in the following sequence. [1] Initial setting for shading correction data recording [2] Uniform exposure of IP [3] Conveyance of IP [4] Correction for shading and sensitivity [5] Check on correction results [6] Set Sensitivity Correction If the correction results are abnormal or an increased degree of sensitivity correction accuracy is called for, make a machine shipment control sensitivity correction. After machine shipment control sensitivity correction, verify the correction results.
[3] Conveyance of IP
Convey the IP in primary erasure mode 10 minutes after its uniform exposure. (1) Change the processing mode to Primary Erasure. While in Routine Mode, touch the CHANGE key to select Primary Erasure. (2) Set in the machine the cassette containing the uniformly exposed IP. Primary erasure (reading and erasing without image output) is performed.
CAUTION
After completing the shading/sensitivity correction, back up the scanner set data.
For shading/sensitivity correction, use the following jigs and external devices. V-type and ST IP: Use an IP of 14" x 14" (35cm x 35cm) or 14" x 17" (35cm x 43cm) size, free from soil or scratch. X-ray source Dosimeter: Used to measure the dosage during uniform exposure. Stopwatch: Used to check the elapsed time after uniform exposure. ULP or LPII.
(2) Determine the correction dosage value. Round off the measured dosage value in mR to the second decimal place, and write down the resulting value on your notepad.
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
MC - 138
MC - 139
CONTENTS
10
MC - 140
CONTENTS
10
MC - 141
(5) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT, and 1. SAVE SHADING AND POLYGON DATA in sequence. The shading data and polygon data so corrected is saved in the HD. (6) If sensitivity correction has been made, select 2. SAVE SENSITIVITY DATA. The sensitivity data so corrected is saved in the HD. (7) Exit M-Utility.
Check for anything abnormal with the X-ray exposure. Check to see if the mounting location of the light-collecting guide is improper or it is soiled. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide
(1) Activate M-Utility. 9.1 Adjusting Read Start Position and Read Width, I Activating and Exiting MUtility (2) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY and 2. CALCULATION in sequence. (3) Select any of menu items 1 through 6. Normally, select 1. SHD., POLY. AND SENSITIVITY. Select either of the items 2 through 6 according to the purpose. If uniform exposure cannot be done so that normal shading data cannot be obtained 2. SHD., POLY. AND SENSITIVITY FOR BAD CONDITION If sensitivity correction is not performed 3. SHD. AND POLY. If uniform exposure cannot be done and if sensitivity correction is not performed 4. SHD. AND POLY. FOR BAD CONDITION If only polygon is to be calculated 5. POLYGON ONLY If only sensitivity is to be calculated 6. SENSITIVITY ONLY (4) For either 1, 2, or 6, enter the corrected dosage value. Otherwise, proceed to the next step.
(2) Determine the correction dosage value. Write down the resulting value on your notepad. (3) Perform recording under SENSITIVITY of the IDTs Test Menu, and generate image output.
N NOTE N
Image output should be generated 10 minutes after the uniform exposure of IP.
(4) After checking the film output, take out the IP used for shading correction. (5) Check the following points on the output film. Shading in the main scan direction has been corrected appropriately. There are no variations or nonuniformity between polygonal facets in the subscanning direction. The S value on film is within the following range: 182 S value x correction dosage value 220 (6) Quit the shading and sensitivity corrections. If anything abnormal is found on the output film, or it is desired to correct sensitivity with greater accuracy, take the steps described in [6] Set Sensitivity Correction below.
MC - 140
MC - 141
CONTENTS
10
MC - 142
CONTENTS
10
MC - 143
BLANK PAGE
N NOTE N
Image output should be generated 10 minutes after the uniform exposure of the IP.
(3) After checking the film output, take out the IP used for shading correction. (4) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY and 4. SENSITIVITY DATA in sequence. (5) Enter the current value and a desired correction value in sequence. The correction value is set. (6) Generate film output and confirm the correction result. (7) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 8. DATA MANAGEMENT and 2. SAVE SENSITIVITY DATA in sequence. The sensitivity data after correction is saved to the hard disk. (8) Exit M-Utility.
MC - 142
MC - 143
CONTENTS
10
MC - 143.1
CONTENTS
10
MC - 143.2
9.3
I Removal
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Write down on your notepad the read width adjustment value indicated on the label located on one side of a new scanning optics unit. This read width adjustment value will be used to adjust the read start position and read width. (3) Disconnect the connectors (CN1-3). (4) Remove the ground wire. (5) Carefully take out the scanning optics unit, while using care to avoid shock to it.
Software version
Version A10 or later
TR1H1322.EPS
Do not remove the top cover of the scanning optics unit. Carefully handle the scanning optics unit to avoid any shock to it. Do not tilt the scanning optics unit. Never put your fingers into the projection outlet located on the bottom of the scanning optics unit. During removal and installation, exercise care not to let any screw drop into the subscanning unit.
N NOTE N
If a scanning optics unit of the old type is to be replaced with 839Y0044, the spacers (347N1797A) should be installed. I Installation of Spacers during Replacement of Scanning Optics Unit
FR ON T
Scanner unit
N NOTE N
The scanning optics unit of the service parts does not contain the LD assembly. When replacing the scanning optics unit, reattach the existing LD assembly to a new scanning optics unit. 9.4 Checking and Replacing LD Assembly
MC - 143.1
MC - 143.2
CONTENTS
10
MC - 143.3
CONTENTS
10
MC - 143.4
I Reinstallation N NOTE N
To install the scanning optics unit, loosely tighten the four screws, and position the scanning optics unit by aligning it against the three reference pins located on the top of the subscanning unit.
(1) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall the scanning optics unit.
FR
T ON
FR ON T
Subscanning unit
Reference pins
FR1H1124.EPS
(2) Take the steps described in Check after Scanning Optics Unit Replacement.
FR1H7013.EPS
MC - 143.3
MC - 143.4
CONTENTS
10
MC - 144
CONTENTS
10
MC - 145
9.4
I Checks
Guide
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
Align the bottom of the spacer to the corner of the guide.
Align the sides of the spacer and guide together. [Attach] Spacer [Attach] Spacer
First check the SCN08A board before performing the procedures described in this section. 10.1 Checking and Replacing SCN08A Board
CAUTIONS
Do not disconnect the connectors CN2 and 3 from the LDD08A board. If they are disconnected, the LD protection is disabled, so that the LD may fail. Do not touch the patterns and ICs of the LDD08A board. Carefully handle the scanning optics unit, exercising care to avoid shock to it. When servicing the board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Make sure that the high-voltage switch (S1) is in the OFF position.
FR2H7015.EPS
CN7
CN8
(2)
(8) Reinstall the light-collecting guide assembly. (9) Reinstall the scanning optics unit. I Reinstallation
CN1
NFB3/F3
OFF state
NFB1/F1
FR1H1275.EPS
MC - 144
S1 HVON
MC - 145
CONTENTS
10
MC - 146
CONTENTS
10
MC - 147
(3) Pull out the scanner unit. 7 Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (4) Make sure that the connectors (CN1-4) of the LDD08A board are locked. If not, securely connect the connectors to lock them in place.
(8) Power ON the machine. [HV-OFF] appears on the operation panel. (9) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (10) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (11) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 3. LASER, and 2. ON in sequence. When ended normally: If the machine starts up normally, the LDD08A board is normal. When ended in error (LD down error or LD warning error occurs): Replace the LDD08A board.
CAUTION
When servicing the LD board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
(4)
CN3 CN2
CN1
Optics base
(5) Push in the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (6) Make sure that connector (CN1) of the SCN08A board is locked. If not, securely connect the connector to lock it in place.
CAUTION
When connecting CN1, use care not to touch the C33 and C94 capacitors.
(7) Make sure that the no-fuse breakers (NFB1, 3) of the SCN08A board are in their shorted condition (button depressed). Push the no-fuse breaker button several times to place the breaker in its shorted condition.
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
009-051-06 009-051-04 04.20.2001 FM3006 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 146
MC - 147
CONTENTS
10
MC - 148
CONTENTS
10
MC - 149
I Replacement
CAUTIONS
Do not disconnect the connectors CN2 and 3 from the LDD08A board. If they are disconnected, the LD protection is disabled, so that the LD may fail. Do not touch the patterns and ICs of the LDD08A board. When the top cover of the scanning optics unit is removed, use care to prevent admittance of dust. When performing the procedures with the top cover removed, wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around. Use care to avoid shock to the scanning optics unit. Do not remove the LD assembly cover, because the LD may be damaged by static electricity. Never touch the optical lens and mirror.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (3) Disconnect the connector (CN1) of the LDD08A board. (4) Remove the top cover from the scanning optics unit. (5) Remove the ground wire. (6) Replace the LD assembly.
(4) Top cover Screw x7
N NOTE N
When installing the LD assembly, align the LD assembly against the three positioning brackets for proper positioning.
Top view (7)
Positioning bracket
LD assembly
FR1H1169.EPS
(8) Take the steps described in Check after LD Assembly Replacement below.
FR1H1168.EPS
MC - 148
MC - 149
CONTENTS
10
MC - 150
CONTENTS
10
MC - 151
9.5
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. Make sure that the machine starts up normally. If the machine does not start up normally, take the following steps to perform selfdiagnostics of Scanner Utility. 1. Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. 2. Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. 3. Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 3. LASER, and 2. ON in sequence. Verify that no error occurs. (2) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
CAUTIONS
Do not touch the patterns and ICs of various boards. When the top cover of the scanning optics unit is removed, use care to prevent admittance of dust. When performing the procedures with the top cover removed, wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around. Use care to avoid shock to the scanning optics unit. Do not remove the LD assembly cover, because the LD may be damaged by static electricity. Never touch the optical lens and mirror. When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
I Checks To Determine If There Is Anything Abnormal with Polygonal Mirror Assembly G Check to see that no error occurs during polygon self-diagnostics.
Self-diagnostics is automatically performed during initialization after the machine starts up.
MC - 150
MC - 151
CONTENTS
10
MC - 152
CONTENTS
10
MC - 153
(10) Make sure that D13 located on the SCN08A board is lit. When D13 is lit: Turn OFF the polygon and back ON again. If D13 is lit again, the polygonal mirror assembly is normal. If it is not lit second time, it is conceivable that the polygonal mirror assembly may be faulty. So, replace the polygonal mirror assembly. When D13 is not lit: It is conceivable that the polygonal mirror assembly may be faulty. So, replace the polygonal mirror assembly.
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Turn OFF the high-voltage switch (S1) located on the SCN08A board. (3) Check the SCN08A board. 10.1 Checking and Replacing SCN08A Board (4) Make sure that the connector (CN1) on the polygon driver board and the connector (CN3) on the SCN08A board are locked securely. (5) Verify that the no-fuse breaker (NFB5) of the SCN08A board is in its shorted condition (button depressed). Push the NFB5 button several times to place the breaker in its shorted condition.
FR1H1277.EPS
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
Polygon driver board (4) CN1 CN2 SCN08A board (4), (5) CN3 NFB5/F5 S1
FR ON T
(6) Power ON the machine. (7) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (8) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (9) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 2. POLYGON and 2. ON in sequence.
MC - 152
MC - 153
CONTENTS
10
MC - 154
CONTENTS
10
MC - 155
(11) Remove the cover from a new polygonal mirror assembly. Release the latches of the cover, and lift up the cover so as to avoid contact with the mirror face of the polygonal mirror.
Cover Latch
CAUTIONS
Use care not to let the polygonal mirror assembly fall or bump. If the polygonal mirror assembly is shocked, its axis of rotation may be misaligned and thus it may become useless. Never touch the mirror face of the polygonal mirror (even when you are wearing gloves). If the mirror face of the polygonal mirror is touched, the polygonal mirror will become unusable.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (3) Remove the scanning optics unit. 9.3 Removing and Reinstalling Scanning Optics Unit, I Removal (4) Remove the clamp. (5) Cut the cable tie that retains the filter, and then remove the filter. (6) Replace the polygon driver. Remove the polygon driver with the shield case attached. (7) Disconnect the connector (CN1) on the LDD08A board. (8) Remove the top cover from the scanning optics unit. (9) Remove the polygon cover. (10) Remove the polygonal mirror assembly.
(8) Top cover Screw x7 Polygon mounting direction Cable
FR1H1405.EPS
(12) Install the new polygonal mirror assembly in reverse order of removal.
N NOTE N
When installing the polygon, pay attention to its direction. Orient the polygon so that its narrower edge width faces front, as seen from above.
(13) Take the steps described in Checks after Polygonal Mirror Assembly Replacement below.
(9) Polygon cover Screw x4 (10) Polygonal mirror assembly (Pay attention to its mounting direction.) Screw x4 Polygon mirror face (4) Clamp BR M4x8
Uniformly expose IPs of each size at about 1 mR. Then, check the film image recorded under SENSITIVITY from the Test Menu for scanner control failures, such as format misalignment and shading, which may cause diagnostic problems. If anything abnormal is found, make the following adjustment. (6) Adjust the read start position and read width. 9.1 Adjusting Read Start Position and Read Width, [6] Fine Adjustment of Read Width and Read Start Position
Filter
FR
ON
T
FR1H1170.EPS
MC - 154
MC - 155
CONTENTS
10
MC - 156
CONTENTS
10
MC - 157
9.6
(8) Disconnect the connector (CN1) of the LDD08A board. (9) Remove the top cover from the scanning optics unit. (10) Make sure that the connector (CN1) of the SYN08A board is locked. If not, securely connect the connector to lock it in place.
CAUTIONS
Do not disconnect the connectors CN2 and 3 from the LDD08A board. If they are disconnected, the LD protection is disabled, so that the LD may fail. Do not touch the patterns and ICs of the LDD08A board. Carefully handle the scanning optics unit, exercising care to avoid shock to it. When the top cover of the scanning optics unit is removed, use care to prevent admittance of dust. When performing the procedures with the top cover removed, wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around. When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
I Checks
(5)
SYN08A board
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
If anything abnormal is found during checks, replace the SYN08A board, and then check it again. (1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 9. HV OFF. The software switch is turned OFF, and 9. HV ON is displayed on the screen. (5) Power OFF the machine. (6) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (7) Place the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board in the OFF position. (11) Attach the top cover to the scanning optics unit. (12) Connect the connector (CN1) of the LDD08A board. (13) Push in the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (14) Make sure that the connector (CN2) of the SCN08A board is locked. If not, securely connect the connector to lock it in place. (15) Make sure that the no-fuse breakers (NFB6, NFB7, NFB9, NFB10) of the SCN08A board are in their shorted conditions (button depressed). Push the no-fuse breaker button several times to place the breaker in its shorted condition.
CN1
FR1H1175.EPS
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
(16) Power ON the machine. Make sure that HV-OFF is displayed on the operation panel.
MC - 156
MC - 157
CONTENTS
10
MC - 158
CONTENTS
10
MC - 159
(17) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (18) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (19) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 3. LASER, and 2. ON in sequence. (20) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 2. POLYGON, and 2. ON in sequence. (21) Check if D14 of the SCN08A board is lit (blinking quickly). If it is lit, set LASER and POLYGON to OFF, and restart the machine. If the machine starts up normally, the SYN08A board is normal. If the machine does not start up normally, replace the SYN08A board. If it is not lit or is blinking (blinking but not quickly), replace the SYN08A board.
I Replacement
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (3) Disconnect the connector (CN1) of the LDD08A board. (4) Remove the top cover from the scanning optics unit. (5) Disconnect the connector (CN1) of the SYN08A board. (6) Replace the SYN08A assembly.
FR101105.EPS
(6) SYN08A assembly BR M4x8 (5) CN1 Spacer (3) LDD08A CN1
MC - 158
MC - 159
CONTENTS
10
MC - 160
CONTENTS
10
MC - 161
N NOTES N
When installing the SYN08A assembly, align the SYN08A assembly against the reference face of the mounting bracket for proper positioning. The spacer that was attached before replacement should be used for reinstallation. Fit the cable into the cable guide.
If anything abnormal is found, make the following adjustments. (4) Adjust the invalid pixels 9.1 Adjusting Read Start Position and Read Width, [6] Fine Adjustment of Read Width and Read Start Position (4) Check the SYN08A board. I Checks
(8) Perform the procedures described in Check after SYN08A Assembly Replacement.
MC - 160
MC - 161
CONTENTS
10
MC - 162
CONTENTS
10
MC - 163
CAUTION
When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
Location Name NFB1/F1 NFB2/F2 NFB3/F3 NFB4/F4 NFB5/F5 NFB6/F6 NFB7/F7 NFB8/F8 NFB9/F9 NFB10/F10
Rated voltage 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V 250 V/48 V
(5) Power ON the machine. (6) Measure the voltage for test pins (related to the connector cables and power supply unit) on the SCN board. TP1 (VCC) - TP2 (GND): TP4 (+ 15AS) - TP28 (ASG): TP8 (-15AS) - TP28 (ASG): TP3 (+ 24PS) - TP38 (PGND): +5 V 0.25V +15 V 0.75V -15 V 0.75V +24 V 1.2V
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower right-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (3) Put the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board in the OFF position. (4) Make sure that the no-fuse breakers (NFB1-10) are in their shorted condition. Push the no-fuse breaker button several times to put the button in its depressed condition (breaker shorted condition), and then take the following steps.
If the voltage measured is outside the above reference value range, check the connector cables and power supply unit. If there is nothing abnormal with the connector cables and power supply unit, replace the SCN board.
D16 S1
S1 HVON
TP3 TP38
OFF state
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown. If the fuse has been blown, replace the board with a new one.
NFB8/F8 NFB7/F7 NFB10/F10 NFB6/F6 NFB9/F9 NFB3/F3 NFB1/F1 NFB4/F4 SCN08A board
FR ON T
S1 HVON
NFB5/F5
S1
D8
FR1H1194.EPS
OFF state
(7) Measure the voltage for test pins (related to the SCN board) on the SCN board. TP5 (+ 5AS) - TP28 (ASG): TP7 (- 5AS) - TP28 (ASG): TP29 (- 5AS2) - TP28 (ASG): + 5V 0.25V - 5V 0.25V - 5V 0.25V TP27 (+ 5AS2) -TP28 (ASG): + 5V 0.25V
NFB2/F2
FR1H1193.EPS
If the voltage measured is outside the above reference value range, replace the SCN board.
MC - 162
009-051-11 08.31.2005 FM4710
MC - 163
CONTENTS
10
MC - 164
CONTENTS
10
MC - 165
I Replacement
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (3) Disconnect the connectors (CN1-6) from the SCN08A board. (4) Remove the SCN08A board (BR M4x8, x6). (5) Make sure that the high-voltage switch (S1) of a new SCN08A board is in the ON position. (6) Make sure that the no-fuse breaker of the new SCN08A board is in its shorted condition. Push the no-fuse breaker button several times to put the button in its depressed condition
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
(7) Mount the new SCN08A board (BR M4x8, x6). (8) Push in the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing in Scanner Unit (9) Connect the connectors (CN1-6) to the SCN08A board. Securely connect the connectors until they are locked in place.
Lightcollecting guide
Light-receiving face
FR1H1171.EPS
CAUTION
When connecting CN1, use care not to touch the C33 and C94 capacitors.
CN8
S1
NFB10/F10 NFB6/F6 NFB9/F9 C94 NFB3/F3 C33 NFB1/F1 SCN08A board NFB4/F4 NFB2/F2
ON state
FR1H1531.EPS
(10) Reinstall all the covers. (11) Power ON the machine. (12) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
S1 HVON
MC - 164
MC - 165
CONTENTS
10
MC - 166
CONTENTS
10
MC - 167
I Removal
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Disconnect the connectors. (PMT08A CN1, 2) (3) Remove the brace that retains the light-collecting guide assembly retaining bracket. (4) Remove the arm retaining screw, and lift up the arm. By lifting up the arm, the lock on the light-collecting guide assembly is released. (5) Take out the light-collecting guide assembly. Carefully place the removed light-collecting guide assembly down onto a soft sheet or the like, using care not to damage it.
I Reinstallation
(1) Carefully install the light-collecting guide assembly onto the subscanning unit, exercising care to avoid contact with surrounding units.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Never touch the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide, even when you are wearing gloves. Carefully handle the light-collecting guide to avoid damage to it due to contact with surrounding objects. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide. When inserting the light-collecting guide assembly, align the protrusions located at both ends of the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide assembly against the reference plane in the subscanning direction, and the front protrusion against the reference pin in the main scan direction.
(1) Light-collecting guide assembly Subscanning unit
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Never touch the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide, even when you are wearing gloves. Carefully handle the light-collecting guide to avoid damage to it due to contact with surrounding objects. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
( ) Light-collecting guide assembly
PMT08A board
FR ON T
Light-receiving face
Top view (1) Light-collecting guide
F R O N T
Scanner unit
FR1H1795.EPS
Protrusion Lightreceiving Main scan face direction Positioning pin Reference plane in subscan direction
Side view (1) Light-collecting guide Sponge Reference plane in subscan direction Insert it along the sponge until it presses against the pin. The right- and left-hand lightreceiving edges of the lightcollecting guide must be in close contact with both the bottom and the reference plane in the subscan direction.
FR1H1796.EPS
Pin The light-collecting guide must be in close contact with the pin.
MC - 166
MC - 167
CONTENTS
10
MC - 168
CONTENTS
10
MC - 169
(2) While supporting the light-collecting guide assembly, secure it with the light-collecting guide assembly retaining arm in place. While pushing the shaft of the light-collecting guide assembly retaining arm, rotate it. Make sure that the stopper hooks the inner protrusion of the light-collecting guide assembly, and then screw it down.
(4) Make sure that the socket of the PMT08A board is fitted into the socket of the lightcollecting guide and that the sockets of the PMT08A board and light-collecting guide are parallel to each other. If anything abnormal is found, remove the single screw that retains the light-collecting guide retaining bracket. While holding the light-collecting guide, push in the PMT08A board assembly, and adjust the position of the sockets of the PMT08A board and lightcollecting guide as appropriate. After the brace is fixed with the screw, verify again that the sockets are parallel, and then proceed to the next step.
N NOTE N
When pushing the light-collecting guide assembly retaining arm, be sure to push its shaft portion. If the arm portion is pushed, the arm itself may be deformed.
(3) Secure the light-collecting guide assembly retaining bracket with the brace.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
Parallel Light-collecting guide assembly Not parallel
CAUTION
If the light-collecting guide assembly leaves its fixed position (i.e., position as instructed in the side view illustrated at step (1), where the right- and left-hand lightreceiving edges of the light-collecting guide must be in close contact with both the bottom and the reference plane in the subscan direction) when an attempt is made to secure the light-collecting guide with the brace, adjust the mounting location of the light-collecting guide assembly retaining bracket.
OK
(5) Connect the connectors (CN1, 2 to the PMT08A board).
(5) Light-collecting assembly
NG
FR1H1798.EPS
(2) Stopper
PMT08A board
FR
ON
Scanner unit
FR1H1797.EPS
FR1H1799.EPS
(6) Push in the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit
MC - 168
MC - 169
CONTENTS
I Checks
10
MC - 170
CONTENTS
10
MC - 171
(3) Install a new light-collecting guide to the PMT08A board assembly. I Removal (4) Make sure that the socket of the PMT08A board is fitted into the socket of the lightcollecting guide and that the sockets of the PMT08A board and light-collecting guide are parallel to each other. If anything abnormal is found, push in the PMT08A board assembly while holding the light-collecting guide, and adjust the position of the sockets of the PMT08A board and light-collecting guide as appropriate.
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide. (2) Using a blower, remove dust deposits on the light-collecting guide. (3) Check the light-collecting guide for any soil or scratch. If there is not any soil or scratch, reinstall the light-collecting guide in the reverse order of removal. If there is any soil: Clean the light-collecting guide with an ethanol-moistened lens cleaner. I Cleaning If there is any scratch about 0.8mm in width on the light-receiving face of the lightcollecting guide: Generate image output and check to see that there is no ununiformity on the resulting image due to the scratch. I Adjustment If ununiformity is observed on the image due to scratches I Replacement
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
Parallel Light-collecting guide assembly Not parallel
I Replacement
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. I Removal (2) Take out the light-collecting guide from the PMT08A board assembly.
PMT08A board assembly
Socket PMT08A board
OK
(5) Reinstall the light-collecting guide assembly. I Installation
NG
FR1H1798.EPS
I Adjustment
(1) Reinstall all the covers. (2) Power ON the machine. Make sure that the machine starts up normally. (3) Generate image output, and check if there is anything abnormal with scanner control.
Light-collecting guide
FR1H1800.EPS
Uniformly expose IPs of each size at about 1 mR. Then, check the film image recorded under SENSITIVITY from the Test Menu for scanner control failures, such as format misalignment and shading, which may cause diagnostic problems. If anything abnormal is found, make the following adjustments. (4) Perform shading/sensitivity correction. 9.2 Shading/Sensitivity Correction
MC - 170
MC - 171
CONTENTS
10
MC - 172
CONTENTS
10
MC - 173
I Cleaning
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly, and place it on a sheet or the like so as to avoid contact with its light-receiving face. I Removal (2) Fold three sheets of lens cleaning paper by half, and wipe the entire light-collecting guide with the sheets moistened with ethanol.
(4) Verify that the PMT08A board socket section is in close contact with the light-collecting guide. If anything abnormal is found, push in the PMT08A board assembly while holding the light-collecting guide, and adjust the position of the sockets of the PMT08A board and light-collecting guide as appropriate.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
Parallel Light-collecting guide assembly Not parallel
CAUTIONS
Wipe the light-collecting guide in one direction at a constant rate. Do not wipe the photomultiplier bonding surface. If the lens cleaning paper becomes soiled, replace it with a new one.
(3) Fold five new sheets of lens cleaning paper by half, and wipe the light-collecting guide dry. After wiping it dry, make sure that it has been cleaned uniformly.
5 mm approx. PMT08A board (2), (3) Cleaning range
OK
(5) Reinstall the light-collecting guide assembly. I Reinstallation
NG
FR1H1798.EPS
MC - 172
MC - 173
CONTENTS
10
MC - 174
CONTENTS
10
MC - 175
(4) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the PMT08A board. PMTH-PGND: +2 3V
(4) PGND PMT08A board
I Checks
HV135
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
CN2
To check the PMT08A board, the SCN08A board should be first checked before checking the log amp and high-voltage power supply sections of the PMT08A board. If any of the voltages measured is out of spec as a result of the checks on the log amp and high-voltage power supply sections of the PMT08A board, then replace the PMT08A board.
PMTH
FR1H1803.EPS
(5) Power ON the machine. (6) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (7) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (8) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 10. VIRTUAL IMAGE, and 2. LOG AMP in sequence. (9) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the PMT08A board. PMTH-PGND: -0.5 +0.5V
(9) PGND PMT08A board
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
HV135
FR1H1804.EPS
SCN08A board
MC - 174
MC - 175
CONTENTS
10
MC - 176
CONTENTS
10
MC - 177
(10) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 10. VIRTUAL IMAGE, and 4. ROUTINE in sequence.
CAUTION
After checks, be sure to select ROUTINE under VIRTUAL IMAGE of SCANNER UTILITY to reset the scanner back to its initial condition. If it is not reset to its initial condition, an image with lower contrast will be outputted.
PMT08A board
CN2 D3
CN3
FR1H1537.EPS
The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (7) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
S1 HVON
(8) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY and 5. HV DATA in sequence. (9) Type in 250 as a high-voltage setup value. The high voltage is set to 250 V. (10) With the terminals (HV135, PGND) touched by the probes of the tester, turn ON the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board.
FR ON T
OFF position
Scanner unit SCN08A board
FR1H1535.EPS
(2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Take out the light-collecting guide from the PMT08A board assembly.
PMT08A board assembly
CAUTION
When making voltage measurements on the PMT08A board, be sure to touch the terminals of the board by the tester probes with the high-voltage switch in its OFF position, and then turn ON the high-voltage switch. It is dangerous if the high-voltage switch is turned ON, because high voltage is applied to the PMT08A board.
(11) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the PMT08A board. HV135-PGND: -17.8 2V
(11)
CN2
Light-collecting guide
FR1H1800.EPS
PGND
FR1H1538.EPS
MC - 176
MC - 177
CONTENTS
10
MC - 178
CONTENTS
10
MC - 179
(12) Place the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board in its OFF position. (13) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY and 5. HV DATA in sequence. (14) Type in 0 as a high-voltage setup value. The high-voltage setting is turned OFF.
N NOTE N
After replacement of the PMT08A board, be sure to check the PMT08A board.
(7) Place the high-voltage switch (S1) of the SCN08A board in its ON position. (8) Reinstall all the covers. (9) Power ON the machine. (10) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
I Replacement
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (2) Remove the four screws. (3) Remove the three spacers and nut. (4) Remove the PMT08A board. (5) Install a new PMT08A board in reverse order of removal.
N NOTES N
Do not forget to tighten the PMT08A board retaining nut. If the nut is left loose, abnormal images (irregular rings) may occur. Use care not to confuse the orientation for installing the clip washer located between the PMT08A board and nut (the clipped side of the washer faces the PMT08A board). If it is put in a wrong orientation, an abnormal image (fine-grained pattern, etc.) may result.
Light-collecting guide
PMT08A board
Bracket
TN1 3 2 1
CN1
FR1H1913.EPS
N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
PMT08A board
FR1H1873.EPS
For TN1, the following steps may be taken to check its condition. (1) Start the M-Utility. (2) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 10. VIRTUAL IMAGE, and 2. LOG AMP in sequence. The virtual image output is set. (3) Return to the Routine Mode. (4) Read an erased IP (of any size), using the sensitivity of the test. (5) Start the M-Utility. (6) Select 1. ERROR LOG Utility, 1. LIST, 1. ALL, and 3. BOTH in sequence. The error log is displayed. (7) Check if TN1 is normal. HV voltage error occurred: TN1 abnormal HV voltage error did not occurred: TN1 normal
009-051-04 009-051-06 05.31.99 FM2460 04.20.2001 FM3006
MC - 178
MC - 179
CONTENTS
10
MC - 180
CONTENTS
10
MC - 181
(8) Attach the two take-out screws to the light-collecting mirror. They facilitate grasping the light-collecting mirror to prevent it from dropping into a gap. (9) Remove the two screws that retain the light-collecting mirror in place. (10) Remove the light-collecting mirror. Grasp the take-out screws and remove the light-collecting mirror while using care to avoid contact with surrounding objects.
(9), (10) Light-collecting mirror BR M4x8, x2 (8) Take-out screw M3
I Removal
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (2) Remove the after-reading conveyor. 11.1 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor (3) Disconnect the connectors (CN1-3 from the SCN08A board). (4) Remove the ground wire. (5) Remove the four screws that retain the scanning optics unit. (6) Carefully remove the scanning optics unit, using care not to shock it. (7) Remove the two screws (one of them should be merely loosened) that retain the dust cover, and remove the dust cover. Slide the dust cover to the right (right-hand side of the machine), thereby taking out the dust cover.
(5), (6) Scanner optics unit BR M4x16, x4
O FR NT
FR1H1541.EPS
Reflection face
(4) Ground wire BR M4x8 (7) Loosen screw BR M4x8 (3) CN13
O FR
NT
FR1H1810.EPS
MC - 180
MC - 181
CONTENTS
10
MC - 182
CONTENTS
10
MC - 183
I Reinstallation
(1) Attach the light-collecting mirror. Align the right and left positioning pins of the light-collecting mirror to the respective supports of the subscanning unit, and secure it in place with two screws.
Top view (1)
I Replacement
(1) Remove the light-collecting mirror. I Removal (2) Attach a new light-collecting mirror. I Reinstallationl
I Adjustment
Support Positioning pin
If anything abnormal is found even after the adjustments, replace the light-collecting mirror. (1) Reinstall all the covers. (2) Power ON the machine.
Light-collecting mirror BR M4x8, x2
FRONT
Positioning pin Support
T ON FR
Make sure that the machine starts up normally. (3) Generate image output, and check if there is anything abnormal with scanner control. Uniformly expose IPs of each size at about 1 mR. Then, check the film image recorded under SENSITIVITY from the Test Menu for scanner control failures, such as format misalignment and shading, which may cause diagnostic problems. If anything abnormal is found, make the following adjustments. (4) Perform shading/sensitivity correction. 9.2 Shading/Sensitivity Correction
FR1H1543.EPS
(2) Remove the take-out screws (M3). (3) Attach the dust cover. While aligning the sponge located at the bottom of the dust cover against the bracket of the light-collecting mirror, snugly fit the top sponge by hand into the scanning optics unit. (4) Reinstall the scanning optics unit in reverse order of removal. (5) Install the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (6) Reinstall the after-reading conveyor. 11.1 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor
I Cleaning
(1) Remove the light-collecting mirror. I Removal (2) Fold two thicknesses of lens cleaning paper into four, and dampen the paper with ethanol. (3) Wipe the reflection face of the light-collecting mirror with the ethanol-moistened lens cleaning paper.
CAUTIONS
Do not wipe the light-collecting mirror with dry paper because the reflection face of the mirror may be scratched. If the lens cleaning paper becomes soiled, replace it with a new one. Clean the light-collecting mirror until the lens cleaning paper is no longer soiled.
I Checks
(1) Remove the light-collecting mirror. I Removal (2) Check the light-collecting mirror for any soil or scratch. If there is any soil: Clean the light-collecting mirror with an ethanol-moistened lens cleaner. I Cleaning If the light-collecting mirror surface is scratched: Generate image output and check to see that there is no ununiformity on the resulting image due to the scratch. I Adjustment If the ununiformity persists even after the shading/sensitivity correction: I Replacement
Light-collecting mirror
Reflection face
FR1H1900.EPS
MC - 182
MC - 183
CONTENTS
10
MC - 184
CONTENTS
10
MC - 185
(14) Block the sensor hole of the SED08A board with a piece of cardboard or the like. Verify that D15 on the SCN08A board is not lit. If D15 is lit, replace the SED08A board. (15) Remove the piece of cardboard that blocks the sensor hole. Verify that D15 on the SCN08A board is lit. If D15 is not lit, replace the SED08A board.
I Replacement
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Remove the scanning optics unit. 9.3 Removing and Reinstalling Scanning Optics Unit (4) Remove the subscanning unit guide. 10.15 Replacing Subscanning Unit Guide (5) Remove the cable clamp. (6) Disconnect the connector (SZ1). (7) Remove SZ1. (8) Install a new SZ1 by reversing the removal steps. When installing SZ1, screw it down while pressing it against the front side.
(7)
NT ON FR T
I Checks
Check the SCN08A board first, before checking the SZ1/SED08A board. 10.1 Checking and Replacing SCN08A Board (1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Make sure that there is no IP left in the scanner unit. If any, remove all the IPs left in the scanner unit. (4) Install the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (5) Set the scanner unit in position. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (6) Make sure that the connector (CN4) of the SCN08A board has been locked. (7) Make sure that the no-fuse breaker (NFB) 8 of the SCN08A board is shorted (in the ON position).
Subscanning unit
O RT FN RO
SZ1 Screw x2
N NOTE N
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
(8) Turn OFF the light in the room where the machine is placed. If the sun is shining in through the window, draw the curtain to darken the room. (9) Power ON the machine. (10) Make sure that the LD (laser) is not emitting light. Verify that D15 on the SCN08A board is not lit. If D15 is lit, replace the SED08A board. (11) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (12) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (13) Select 5. SCANNER UTILITY, 3. LASER, and 2. ON in sequence. The LD (laser) emits light.
Positioning direction
FR1H1313.EPS
SZ1
MC - 184
MC - 185
CONTENTS
10
MC - 186
CONTENTS
10
MC - 187
N NOTE N
When monitoring SZ2, insert an Allen wrench into the cam of MZ2 and rotate it clockwise to check the OPEN/CLOSE status of SZ2.
N NOTE N
When monitoring SZ3, insert an Allen wrench into the cam of MZ3 and rotate it clockwise to check the OPEN/CLOSE status of SZ3.
I Replacement
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Remove the after-reading conveyor. 11.1 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor (4) Disconnect the connector (SZ2). (5) Remove the SZ2 bracket. (6) Take out SZ2 from the bracket.
Left side of subscanning unit Rear side plate Subscanning unit
T ON FR FR ON
I Replacement
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing In Scanner Unit (2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Remove the side-positioning conveyor. 8.1 Removing and Reinstalling Side-Positioning Conveyor (4) Disconnect the connector (SZ3). (5) Remove the SZ3 bracket. (6) Take out SZ3 from the bracket.
Subscanning unit
F N RO
(6) SZ3
(4) Connector
T ON FR
FR1H1288.EPS
FR1H1287.EPS
(7) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall a new SZ2. (8) Check SZ2. I Checks
(7) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall a new SZ3. (8) Check SZ3. I Checks
MC - 186
MC - 187
CONTENTS
10
MC - 188
CONTENTS
10
MC - 189
I Replacement
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower left-hand side cover, lower left-hand side transparent cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the Kapton belt. 10.12 Checking and Replacing Kapton Belt/Tensioner/Flywheel (3) Disconnect the connectors (CN1-3) of MZ1. (4) Remove MZ1.
(4) MZ1 BR M4x8, x5
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower left-hand side cover, lower left-hand side trsnsparent cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (4) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (5) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 2. ACTUATOR in sequence. (6) Select 2. DRIVE. A list of actuator Nos. is displayed. (7) Type in the number of MZ1 (FFM). (8) Set up an operation parameter as instructed by the onscreen message. MZ1 operation starts. (9) Measure the voltage between OK and 5G on MZ1.
FR1H1812.EPS
N NOTE N
When installing MZ1, the same settings for S1-S6 of a new MZ1 should be made as those for the older one.
S1 CN1
FR1H1874.EPS
ON
S1
6 5 4 3 2 1
OFF
(10) Select 3. STOP. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (11) Type in the number of MZ1 (FFM). MZ1 stops. (12) Change the operation parameter for MZ1 at step (7) as follows, and repeat steps (5) through (10). Rotation in normal direction Rotation in reverse direction If MZ1 rotates for all of the operation parameters and the voltage between OK and 5G on MZ1 is about 5 V, then the check is completed. If MZ1 does not rotate or the voltage between OK and 5G on MZ1 is less than 1 V for any of the operation parameters, then replace the MZ1.
FR1H1926.EPS
MC - 188
MC - 189
CONTENTS
10
MC - 190
CONTENTS
10
MC - 191
ON FR
Subscanning unit
Positioning bracket (6) T ON FR Ring Hex socket head setscrew M3x6 (5) (6) Cam Bracket BR M4x8, x4 (7) MZ2 SZ2 Sems M3x6, x3 (3) FAST-ON terminal (+) (3) FAST-ON terminal (-)
ON FR
(6) Cam
(5) Bracket BR M4x8, x4 (7) MZ3 Sems M3x6 x3 (3) FAST-ON terminal (-)
SZ3
FR1H1020.EPS
FR1H1021.EPS
(8) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall a new MZ2. When installing the MZ2 bracket, screw it down while pressing it against the positioning bracket.
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
(8) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall MZ3. When installing the MZ3 bracket, screw it down while pressing it against the positioning bracket.
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 190
MC - 191
CONTENTS
10
MC - 192
CONTENTS
10
MC - 193
I Replacement
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
I Checks
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower right-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the transparent cover located on the right-hand side. Using a blower, remove dust deposited on the transparent cover. (3) While rotating the drive shaft, check the SUS belt, rubber belt, pulley, and tensioner for any soil or flaw. If any soil is found, clean it off. SUS belt: Clean any soil off with an ethanol-moistened cloth. Rubber belt: Clean any soil off with a moistened cloth. If any flaw is found, replace the SUS belt or rubber belt.
(2)
FR ON T
Subscanning unit
Subscanning unit
(3) Spring
FR1H1190.EPS
(5) Install new SUS and rubber belts in reverse order of removal.
Subscanning unit
N NOTES N
Right-hand side transparent cover BR M4x8, x2
FR1H1189.EPS
After installing the SUS belt or rubber belt, rotate the drive shaft to check that the SUS belt or rubber belt does not come off the pulley. After replacing the SUS or rubber belt, check MZ1. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1)
(6) Reinstall the right-hand side transparent cover. (7) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
MC - 192
MC - 193
CONTENTS
10
MC - 194
CONTENTS
10
MC - 195
G Replacement of tensioner
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower right-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the transparent cover located on the right-hand side. Using a blower, remove dust deposited on the transparent cover. (3) Remove the tensioner spring located on the right-hand side. (4) Replace the SUS belt. (5) Replace the tensioner.
Drive shaft
I Checks
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower left-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the transparent cover located on the left-hand side. Using a blower, remove dust deposited on the transparent cover. (3) Check the Kapton belt, tensioner, and flywheel for any soil or flaw.
Subscanning unit
If any soil is found, clean it off with an ethanol-moistened cloth. If any flaw is found, replace the flawed part.
N NOTE N
After installing the right-hand side tensioner and SUS belt, rotate the drive shaft to check that the SUS belt or rubber belt does not come off the pulley.
(7) Power ON the machine. (8) Check MZ1. Make sure that the motor rotates normally. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (9) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
FR1H1814.EPS
(4) Reinstall the left-hand side transparent cover. (5) Power ON the machine. (6) Check MZ1. Make sure that the motor rotates normally. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (7) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
MC - 194
MC - 195
CONTENTS
10
MC - 196
CONTENTS
10
MC - 197
I Replacement N NOTES N
To install the Kapton belt, orient the belt with the arrow printed on its front facing the subscanning unit. The arrow mark on the front of the Kapton belt may disappear over a certain period of time. When removing or reinstalling the existing Kapton belt, you may mark an arrow on the belt surface with a marker so as not to confuse its mounting orientation. After installation of the Kapton belt, rotate the flywheel to ensure that the belt does not come off the pulley.
G Replacement of tensioner
(1) Remove the following covers. Lower front cover, lower left-hand side cover 3. Removing and Reinstalling Covers (2) Remove the transparent cover located on the left-hand side. Using a blower, remove dust deposited on the transparent cover. (3) Remove the spring. (4) Remove the Kapton belt. (5) Replace the tensioner.
E-ring Subscanning unit (4) Kapton belt (2) Left-hand side transparent cover BR M4x8, x2
(3) Spring
FR
ON
FR1H1816.EPS
(6) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. (7) Power ON the machine.
Subscanning unit (4) Kapton belt (2) Left-hand side transparent cover Screw x2
FR ON T
FR1H1815.EPS
(8) Check MZ1. Make sure that the motor rotates normally. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (9) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
(5) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps. (6) Power ON the machine. (7) Check MZ1. Make sure that the motor rotates normally. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (8) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
MC - 196
MC - 197
CONTENTS
10
MC - 198
CONTENTS
10
MC - 199
G Replacement of flywheel
(1) Pull out the scanner unit. 7. Pulling Out and Pushing in Scanner Unit (2) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (3) Remove the after-reading conveyor. 11.1 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor (4) Remove the transparent cover located on the left-hand side. (5) Remove the spring. (6) Remove the Kapton belt. (7) Insert an Allen wrench or so forth into the hole of the shaft located inside the side plate to secure it in place, and remove the nut that retains the flywheel. (8) Replace the flywheel.
(5) Remove the rubber roller from the subscanning unit. (6) Remove the shaft, bearings, E-rings, and caps from the rubber roller.
Side plate
(7) Install the shaft, bearings, E-rings, and caps removed at step (6) to a new rubber roller, and reinstall the rubber roller to the subscanning unit.
Spring Brace
(5) Spring
Hole
Subscanning unit
FR1H1526.EPS
FR
ON
FR1H1817.EPS
N NOTE N
After installing the flywheel, rotate it by hand to ensure that the Kapton belt does not come off the pulley.
(10) Power ON the machine. (11) Check MZ1. Make sure that the motor rotates normally. 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (12) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
Bearing
Rubber roller
Shaft
E-ring Cap
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
FR1H1528.EPS
MC - 198
MC - 199
CONTENTS
10
MC - 200
CONTENTS
10
MC - 201
(8) Secure the rubber roller in place with the brace. Make sure that the brace is located between the E-ring and cap.
N NOTE N
If the spring that should be attached to the lower portion of the brace has been dislocated, be sure to reattach the spring to the lower portion of the brace and to the pin located on the back of the side plate of the subscanning unit.
Brace
(4) Remove the flywheel. 10.12 Checking and Replacing Kapton Belt/Tensioner/Flywheel, G Replacement of flywheel (5) Remove the right-hand side transparent cover. (6) Remove the two screws that retain each of the two grip arms.
Rubber roller
10.15 Replacing Guide Plate of Subscanning Unit (7) Take out the grip arm from the subscanning unit.
E-ring
(8) Remove the bearing and shaft from the grip arm.
Grip arm Hex socket head setscrew M4x8
O FR
NT
Cap Spring
FR1H1527.EPS
Bearing
FR1H1544.EPS
(9) Attach the bearing and shaft removed at step (8) to a new grip arm. (10) Reinstall the grip arm to the subscanning unit. (11) Reinstall the right-hand side transparent cover. (12) Reinstall the flywheel. 10.12 Checking and Replacing Kapton Belt/Tensioner/Flywheel, G Replacement of flywheel (13) Reinstall the MZ1 (FFM). 10.8 Checking and Replacing Subscanning Motor (MZ1) (14) Reinstall the light-collecting mirror. 10.4 Servicing Light-Collecting Mirror (15) Reinstall the rubber roller located above the subscanning unit. 10.13 Replacing Rubber Roller Located Above Subscanning Unit
MC - 200
MC - 201
CONTENTS
10
MC - 202
CONTENTS
10
MC - 203
(16) Make sure that there is a gap between the upper rubber roller and lower rubber roller. If there is no gap, make adjustment as appropriate by rotating the adjustment screw.
Grip arm Adjustment screw
(5) Remove the four screws and one spacer that retain the subscanning unit guide plate. (6) Slide the right-hand-side grip arm removed at step (4) to remove the subscanning unit guide plate. (7) Install a new subscanning unit guide plate in reverse order of removal.
D
Upper rubber roller
N NOTES N
To install the subscanning unit guide plate, loosely tighten the four screws and then align the guide plate in the arrow directions illustrated below to position it as appropriate.
Top view
E A F
BR M4x12 + Spacer
Adjustment screw
F R O N T
C
FR1H6521.EPS
BR M4x8, x3
FR1H1530.EPS
After installing the subscanning unit guide plate, place a rule or the like on the lower rubber rollers, and rotate the drive shaft to check if the rule is moved, thereby verifying that the surface of the lower rubber rollers is above the subscanning unit guide plate (at six locations).
Grip arm
FR
ON
FR1H4018.EPS
FR
T ON
Subscanning unit
(9) Check image performance. 3.2 Checking Image in Preventive Maintenance Volume
MC - 202
MC - 203
CONTENTS
10
MC - 204
CONTENTS
10
MC - 205
O FR
NT
Bearing
Subscanning unit
FR1H1818.EPS
(4) Pull out the two lower rubber rollers. (5) Remove the two bearings and two wave washers. (6) Attach to a new rubber roller the two bearings and two wave washers removed at step (5). (7) Reinstall the rubber roller in reverse order of removal.
Scanner unit
FR ON T
FR1H1819.EPS
(4) Reinstall the shock-absorbing rubber in reverse order of removal. (5) Make adjustment after replacement of the shock-absorbing rubber. I Adjustment
Scanner unit
FR1H1820.EPS
(4) Reinstall the shock-absorbing rubber in reverse order of removal. (5) Make adjustment after replacement of the shock-absorbing rubber. I Adjustment
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
MC - 204
MC - 205
CONTENTS
10
MC - 206
CONTENTS
10
MC - 207
I Adjustment
(1) Loosen the two respective retaining screws on the four shock-absorbing rubbers. The screw that retains the stay of the subscanning unit and the shock-absorbing rubber should not be loosened. (2) Adjust the position of the subscanning unit so that its distances from the tray are as indicated by adjustment values (A, B, and C) shown below.
Top view
FRONT
BLANK PAGE
Tray
FR ON T
Subscanning unit B C
A = 74 1, B = 74 1, C = 100 1
Unit: mm
FR1H1615.EPS
(3) Tighten the screws that were loosened at step (1). (4) Check again the distances from the subscanning unit to the tray. If the adjustment values (A, B, and C) are out of range, repeat steps (1) through (3) all over again.
MC - 206
MC - 207
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 208
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 209
I Removal
(1) Remove the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide (2) Disconnect the connectors (CNSE1, CNME1, CNME2). (3) Remove the five screws (four screws for the old type) that retain the after-reading conveyor. (4) Pull out the after-reading conveyor horizontally.
N NOTE N
Make sure that the scanner unit has been pulled all the way out. If not, ME2 will interfere with the machine frame when the after-reading conveyor is removed.
<New type>
(2) CNME2
Old type
New type
Two screw retaining brackets are added.
(4)
(2) CNME1
FR
ON
FR
ON
T
T ON FR
<Old type>
(2) CNME2
T ON FR
FR
T ON
(4)
(2) CNME1
FR1H1289.EPS
MC - 208
MC - 209
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 210
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 211
I Reinstallation N NOTE N
Make sure that the scanner unit has been pulled all the way out. If not, ME2 will interfere with the machine frame when the after-reading conveyor is removed.
(4) Tighten the three screws on the left bracket of the after-reading conveyor.
G New type
(1) Reinstall the after-reading conveyor. The four bumps of the right and left brackets of the after-reading conveyor should be aligned against the block sections of the subscanning unit. (2) Secure the right-hand side of the after-reading conveyor to the subscanning unit by tightening the two screws in order from (2)-1 to (2)-2 as illustrated below. (3) Make sure that the three bumps (two bumps on the right-hand side and one of the two bumps on the left-hand side) are aligned against the block sections of the subscanning unit. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
Both of the two bumps on the right-hand side should be brought into contact with the block section. At least one of the two bumps on the left-hand side may be in contact with the block section.
After-reading conveyor
Bracket
FR
ON
(4) BR M4x8
FR1H1565.EPS
If any of the bumps is detached from the block section of the subscanning unit, loosen the two screws and repeat step (2) all over again.
Top view (1), (3) Left-hand side Right-hand side Block sections of subscanning unit Side view (1), (3) New after-reading conveyor Bracket Bumps (At least one of them should be contacted.) Bracket Bumps (Both of them should be contacted.) New after-reading conveyor Bracket Block section
If the bumps are detached from the block section of the subscanning unit, loosen the three screws and repeat step (4) all over again. (5) Connect the connectors (CNSE1, CNME1, CNME2). (6) Reinstall the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide
(2)-1 BR M4x8
Block section
FR1H1564.EPS
MC - 210
MC - 211
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 212
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 213
G Old type
(1) Reinstall the after-reading conveyor. Secure the after-reading conveyor in place with four screws, while pressing the bracket of the after-reading conveyor against the block section of the subscanning unit and reference side. (2) Connect the connectors (CNSE1, CNME1, CNME2).
(1)
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (5) Select 2. MONITOR.
After-reading conveyor
Block section
(2) CNME2
A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (6) Type in the number of SE1. The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state.
(2) CNME1 (1) (2) CNSE1
ME2
(7) Using a rule or the like, block the SE1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (8) Remove the rule that blocks the SE1 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Repeat steps (7) and (8) several times.
Scanner unit
FR
T ON
Bracket
If no message appears, it is likely that the sensor is faulty. So, replace the sensor.
FR1H1127.EPS
(3) Reinstall the light-collecting guide assembly. 10.2 Servicing Light-Collecting Guide
After-reading conveyor
O FR NT
SE1
After-reading conveyor
FR1H1292.EPS
(10) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility. A message prompting you to reset the machine is displayed. (11) Press the RESET button.
MC - 212
MC - 213
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 214
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 215
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SE1). (2) Remove the bracket. (3) Remove SE1 from the bracket. (4) Install a new SE1. 3.5 Sensors Not Requiring Adjustment of Its Mounting Position in Machine Description (5) Connect the connector (SE1). (6) Attach the mounting bracket. (7) Check SE1. I Checks
(3) SE1
O FR
NT
(2) CNME1
FR
ON
T
FR1H1291.EPS
MC - 214
MC - 215
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 216
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 217
After-reading conveyor
(4) Timing belt wheel (2) CNME2 (3) ME2 Pan M4x10 x3
CNME2
FR ON T
T
FR1H1290.EPS
ON FR
After-reading conveyor
FR1H1605.EPS
(4) Reinstall the shock absorber-attached guide plate. (5) Reinstall the after-reading conveyor. 11.1 Removing and Reinstalling After-Reading Conveyor
MC - 216
MC - 217
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 218
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 219
I Reinstallation
(1) Reinstall the erasure lamp assembly to the erasure conveyor.
CAUTION
Carefully handle the erasure lamp. If it is hit, the erasure lamp may be broken, so you may get injured.
N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
When installing the erasure lamp assembly, align the positioning pin located on the right-hand side of the inlet into the hole of the erasure lamp assembly, and push it all the way into the erasure conveyor.
CAUTION
Carefully handle the erasure lamp. If it is hit, the erasure lamp may be broken, so you may get injured.
(1) Power supply DCOUT4 ACOUT1 (3)
FR ON
DCOUT4 ACOUT1
DCOUT5
ACOUT2
T
FR1H1515.EPS
Erasure conveyor
T ON FR
FR1H1180.EPS
MC - 218
MC - 219
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 220
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 221
I Reinstallation
(1) Install the erasure conveyor along the shock absorber-attached cover into the machine. Align the erasure conveyor against the positioning bracket located on the left side of the machine (into the machine as seen from the direction of insertion), and secure it in place. (2) Attach the timing belt onto the timing belt wheel. (3) Put the tensioner back where it was. Loosen the single screw that retains the tensioner. Flick the timing belt several times to ensure that it snugly fits onto the belt wheel, and then tighten the screw on the tensioner in place where appropriate tension is attained.
Erasure conveyor (2) BR M4x8 CNC1 to the (4) Connect the connectors (CNF1, 2, CNSOLF1 to the erasure conveyor; (3) Tensioner CNC1 Timing belt
(2) CNF1
Before-side-positioning conveyor
Erasure conveyor
Before-side-positioning Conveyor
O FR
(5)
FR1H1704.EPS
before-side-positioning conveyor).
T ON FR
FR1H1703.EPS
Erasure conveyor
Before-side-positioning conveyor
FR1H1518.EPS
MC - 220
MC - 221
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 222
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 223
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SF1). (2) Remove SF1. (3) Install a new SF1. (4) Connect the connector (SF1). (5) Check SF1. I Checks
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (5) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (6) Type in the number of the after-reading conveyance IP sensor (SF1). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (7) Using a piece of cardboard or the like, block the SF1 light path. A message indicating that SF1 is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (8) Remove the piece of cardboard that blocks the SF1 light path. A message indicating that SF1 is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Repeat steps (7) and (8) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
Spacer
MC - 222
MC - 223
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 224
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 225
I Replacement
(1) Remove SF2. (2) Disconnect the connector (SF2). (3) Install a new SF2. (4) Connect the connector (SF2). (5) Check SF2. I Checks
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (5) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (6) Type in the number of the changeover IP sensor (SF2). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (7) Using a piece of cardboard or the like, block the sensor light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (8) Remove the piece of cardboard that blocks the SF2 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Repeat steps (7) and (8) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
SF2
Spacer
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1262.EPS
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1261.EPS
MC - 224
MC - 225
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 226
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 227
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SF3) (2) Remove SF3. (3) Install a new SF3. (4) Connect the connector (SF3). (5) Check SF3. I Checks
I Checks
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove SF3 without disconnecting the connector. (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (4) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (5) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (6) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (7) Type in the number of the load standby IP sensor (SF3). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (8) Using a piece of cardboard or the like, block the SF3 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Remove the cardboard that blocks the SF3 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (10) Repeat steps (8) and (9) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
Spacer
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1264.EPS
SF3
Erasure converyor
FR1H1263.EPS
(11) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. M-Utility is exited. (12) Power OFF the machine. (13) Install SF3.
MC - 226
MC - 227
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 228
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 229
(12) Power OFF the machine. (13) Install the SF4-attached bracket as a whole.
I Checks
I Replacement
(1) Disconnect the connector (SF4). (2) Remove the SF4-attached bracket as a whole. (3) Cut the cable tie. (4) Disconnect the connector (SF4) from the bracket. (5) Remove SF4 (both on the light emitting and light receiving sides). (6) Reverse the removal steps to reinstall a new SF4. (7) Check SF4. I Checks
(5)
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Remove the SF4-attached bracket as a whole. I Replacement (2) Power ON the machine. (3) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (4) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (5) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY and 3. SENSOR in sequence. (6) Select 2. MONITOR. A list of sensor Nos. is displayed. (7) Type in the number of the overrun IP sensor (SF4). The machine is now in the sensor monitoring enabled state. (8) Using a rule or the like, block the SF4 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is CLOSE is displayed on the operation panel. (9) Remove the piece of cardboard that blocks the SF4 light path. A message indicating that the sensor is OPEN is displayed on the operation panel. (10) Repeat steps (8) and (9) several times. If anything abnormal is found, such as no message displayed, then replace the sensor.
SF4
SF4
Sems M3x6 x4
(2) Bracket
BR M4x8
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1265.EPS
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1132.EPS
MC - 228
MC - 229
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 230
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 231
I Replacement
(1) Remove the erasure lamp assembly. 12.1 Removing and Reinstalling Erasure Lamp Assembly (2) Remove the bracket. (3) Remove the five erasure lamps. (4) Wipe the white reflection face within the erasure lamp assembly and the white reflection face behind the bracket with a dry cloth.
(7) E-ring
FR
ON T
FR1H1144.EPS
FR1H1266.EPS
(5) Install five new erasure lamps. (6) Attach the bracket. (7) Reinstall the erasure lamp assembly. 12.1 Removing and Reinstalling Erasure Lamp Assembly
MC - 230
MC - 231
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 232
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 233
I Replacement of TSW2
(1) Remove the erasure lamp assembly. 12.2 Removing and Reinstalling Erasure Conveyor (2) Remove the bracket. (3) Remove the five erasure lamps. (4) Remove the leaf spring. (5) Remove the FAST-ON terminals (TSW2COM, TSW2NO). (6) Remove TSW2. (7) For reinstallation, reverse the removal steps.
(3) Erasure lamp x5 (2) Bracket BR M4x8, x2
(5) TSW2NO
(5) TSW2COM
FR1H1268.EPS
FR1H1267.EPS
MC - 232
MC - 233
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 234
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 235
Velcro tape
(5) CNFANF1
(4) Attach a new air filter. Attach the air filter so as to cover the Velcro tape located on the lower right-hand side cover.
(7) FANF1
FR1H1520.EPS
MC - 234
MC - 235
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 236
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 237
12.12 Checking, Replacing, and Adjusting Erasure Unit IP Conveyance Timing Belt
I Checks
If anything abnormal is found during checks, replace or adjust the erasure unit IP conveyance timing belt. (1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Remove the erasure conveyor. 12.2 Removal and Reinstallation of Erasure Conveyor (3) Measure the tension value for the erasure unit IP conveyance timing belt. With a load of 300 50g applied, the deflection should be 11 1mm.
I Replacement
(1) Remove the erasure conveyor. 12.2 Removal and Reinstallation of Erasure Conveyor (2) Remove MF1. 12.7 Replacing IP Transport Motor (MF1) (3) Remove the timing belt. (4) Attach a new erasure unit IP conveyance timing belt. (5) Adjust the tension. I Adjustment
Erasure conveyor
FRONT
MF1
Spacer
Erasure conveyor
FR ON T
FR1H1188.EPS
FR
ON T
FR1H1271.EPS
MC - 236
MC - 237
CONTENTS 11
I Adjustment
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 238
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 239
(1) Measure the tension value for the timing belt. With a load of 300 50g applied, the deflection should be 11 1mm. (2) Shift the tensioner position to adjust the tension of the timing belt until the specification is met.
(4) Remove the simple bearing. 3.3 Simple Bearing Employed in Machine Description (5) Replace the erasure conveyor rubber roller.
Side view : Rubber roller
MF1
Erasure conveyor
FR ON T
FR1H1273.EPS
T ON FR
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1272.EPS
MC - 238
MC - 239
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 240
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 241
I Replacement
After replacement, be sure to check. (1) Remove the spring. (2) Disconnect the connector (CNSOLF1). (3) Remove the changeover guide drive solenoid assembly (SOLF1).
(2) CNSOLF1
CAUTION
Before removing the covers, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY, 2. ACTUATOR and 2. DRIVE in sequence. A list of actuator Nos. is displayed. (5) Select 7.SOLF1. The branch path changeover guide is driven to the front of the machine. If the branch path changeover guide is not driven, it is likely that the cable connection or sensor is faulty. So, check the cable connection, and then select 2. DRIVE again. If it is not driven after that, replace SOLF1.
Branch path changeover guide
N RO
(1) Spring
FR1H1257.EPS
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1258.EPS
MC - 240
MC - 241
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 242
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 243
(4) Loosely retain the positioning bracket by loosening its retaining screw. (5) Loosely attach a new changeover guide drive solenoid assembly. Be sure that the spring pin is lodged in the U-shaped groove in the arm. (6) Install the spring. (7) Connect the connector (CNSOLF1). (8) Move the changeover guide drive solenoid assembly along the guide and then fully tighten it. Pull the changeover guide drive solenoid assembly to the left and above by sliding it along the guide. When the arm begins to leave the stopper support, return the changeover guide drive solenoid assembly until the arm comes into contact with the stopper support, and then fully tighten the assembly.
N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
Ensure that the arm is in contact with the stopper support but not depressed.
(9) Screw down the positioning bracket while pressing it against the changeover guide drive solenoid assembly.
(5), (8) Changeover guide drive solenoid (4), (9) Positioning bracket Guide Spring pin
Stopper support
FR1H1413.EPS
ON FR
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1623.EPS
MC - 242
MC - 243
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 244
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 245
(8) Reinstall the lamp assembly. (9) Attach the bracket removed at step (2). (10) Attach the grip spring removed at step (1).
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1624.EPS
(3) Remove the two bracket retaining screws (one of them should be merely loosened) and remove the bracket. (4) Remove the lamp house assembly.
N NOTE N
When removing the lamp house assembly, use care not to damage the shock absorber.
(5) Check if the shock absorber is not peeled or frayed. If it is peeled or frayed, replace the whole filter to which the shock absorber is attached. If it is not peeled or frayed, proceed to step (8). (6) Remove the shock absorber-attached filter.
(3) Remove screw BR M4x8 (3) Bracket
FR
T ON
Erasure conveyor
MC - 244
MC - 245
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 246
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 247
(6) Remove the shock absorber-attached guide plate. (7) Check if the shock absorber is not peeled or frayed. If it is peeled or frayed, replace the whole guide plate to which the shock absorber is attached.
(6), (7) Shock absorber-attached guide plate Sems M3x6, x4
(3) SF4
FR1H1626.EPS
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1627.EPS
(8) Reinstall the shock absorber-attached guide plate. (9) Reinstall the SF2 together with the spacer. (10) Connect the connector (CNSF2). (11) Reinstall the SF4 together with the bracket. (12) Connect the connector (CNSF4).
MC - 246
MC - 247
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 248
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 249
(7) Remove the bearing. (8) Remove the branch path changeover guide assembly. The arm should be removed as attached to the shaft of the branch path changeover guide assembly. (9) Remove the arm, bearing, and slide bearing from the branch path changeover guide assembly.
T ON FR (8)
Erasure conveyor (7), (9) Bearing BR M4x12 (9) Arm Sems M3x10
FR1H1630.EPS
FR
T ON
Erasure conveyor
FR1H1628.EPS
(10) Attach the arm, bearing, and slide bearing removed at step (9) to a new shock absorber-attached branch path changeover guide. (11) Fit the spring pin into the U-shaped groove of the arm. (12) Reinstall the branch path changeover guide assembly. (13) Attach the bearing. (14) Install the stopper support while the branch path changeover guide is opened (the spring pin is pushed against the end surface of the square hole of the changeover guide driving solenoid).
(4) Remove the spring. (5) Remove the two screws that retain the stopper support, and remove the stopper support. (6) Remove SF1 without disconnecting the connector.
N NOTES N
(6) SF1 Pan head screw M3x10, x2
Make sure that the spring pin is securely pushed against the end surface of the square hole. Make sure that the stopper support is in contact with the arm. Also, verify that the spring pin or arm does not move.
End surface of the square hole Spring pin
Arm
Stopper support
FR1H1821.EPS
MC - 248
MC - 249
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 250
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 251
(15) Reinstall the SF1 together with the connector, which was removed at step (6). (16) Attach the spring removed at step (4).
Changeover guide driving solenoid
BLANK PAGE
(15) SF1
Bearing
MC - 250
MC - 251
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 252
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 253
I Replacement
(1) Power OFF the machine. (2) Disconnect the connectors (AC OUT1, 2, DCOUT1-7, TB1, 2, CN1-5). (3) Remove the four screws that retain the power supply unit. (4) Pull out the power supply unit horizontally.
(3) Loosen screw BR M4x8, x2
FR ON T
WARNING
To avoid possible electric shock hazards from high voltage, observe the following precautions. Before removing and installing the power supply unit, unplug the power plug from the outlet. Do not touch the power supply terminals. When making voltage measurements, do not touch the probes (metal portions) of a tester.
Make voltage measurements at the following points.
(4)
T SW SE RE ON
F OF
Measurement point Adjustment point Specified value TB2 1-3 DC OUT1 1-3 DC OUT3 1-6 DC OUT3 2-7 DC OUT3 4-9
NT RO
DC OUT4
OFF
Remote
Local
CN4
FR1H1248.EPS
Side view
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
2 1
4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
DCOUT4 DCOUT5
3 2 1
2 1
+
1 3
ACOUT4 ACOUT2
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 11 5 12 6
G
4
FR1B1127.EPS
MC - 252
MC - 253
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 254
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 255
F5 F8 F7 F6 F12
T ON FR
F11
F9
F10
F13 F4 F3
RE ON
SE
T SW
ote Rem al Loc
F1
F OF
F2
FR1B1269.EPS
I Fuse Ratings
Name F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F10 F11 F12 F13 Rated voltage/amperage 250V, 5A 250V, 4A 250V, 4A 250V, 500mA 250V, 500mA 250V, 2A 250V, 5A 250V, 5A 250V, 4A 250V, 4A 250V, 4A 250V, 4A 250V, 5A Remarks For SCN08A +5V (DCOUT6) For DRV08A +15V (DCOUT3) For FFM +15V (DCOUT7) For FFM +5V (DCOUT7) For erasure lamp cooling fan +24V (DCOUT5) For SCN08A +24V (DCOUT6) For SCN08A +15V (DCOUT6) For SCN08A -15V (DCOUT6) For DRV08A +24V (DCOUT3) For DRV08A +15V (DCOUT3) For DRV08A +24V (DCOUT3) For DRV08A +24V (DCOUT3) For SNS08A +5V (DCOUT2)
Power supply unit
FR1H1523.EPS
MC - 254
MC - 255
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 256
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 257
(3) Check the fuses. Measure the resistance value across the fuse.
BLANK PAGE
Fuse
FR1H1924.EPS
If the measured resistance value is 100 or greater, it is judged that the fuse has been blown.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse.
Top view (3)
FRONT
F5 F8 F7 F6 F12
T ON FR
F11
F9
F10
F13 F4 F3
SE RE ON
T SW
ote Rem al
Loc
F1
F OF
F2
(4) Attach the cover of the power supply unit. (5) Reinstall the power supply unit.
MC - 256
MC - 257
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 258
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 259
14. HDD
14.1 Setting the HDD
Short-pin settings for each HDD are illustrated below. <For SEAGATE/ST52160N (850S0107)>
<For 850S0107> HDD bottom
13 11 9 7 5 3 1
J6
19 17 15 13 11 9 7 5 3 1
FRONT 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 2
FR1H7031.EPS
14 12 10 8 6 4 2
FRONT
FRONT
FR1H7028.EPS
J5
TE
C4
2
FRONT
FR1H7029.EPS
8 10 12
C3
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23
9 11 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24
FR1H7032.EPS
J6
19 17 15 13 11 9 7 5 3 1
20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 2
MC - 258
TP2
J2
TE
MC - 259
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 260
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 261
I Reinstallation
(1) Check the HDD settings. 14.1 Setting the HDD (2) Peel off the adhesive-coat protection film from the silicone surface of the heat radiation sheet. (3) Attach the heat radiation sheet onto the parts-mounted surface of the HDD.
I Removal
(1) Disconnect the connector (CNJ2). (2) Remove the connector (CNJ1) together with the CNN08A board as a whole. (3) Remove the HDD together with the bracket as a whole. (4) Detach the HDD from the bracket.
(3) [Loosen] BR M4x8, x2 (2) [Remove] CNJ1/CNN08A (1) [Disconnect] CNJ2 T ON FR HDD
CAUTION
When attaching the heat radiation sheet onto the HDD, make sure that the silicone surface of the heat radiation sheet faces the parts-mounted surface of the HDD. If the heat radiation sheet is attached with its aluminum surface facing the partsmounted surface of the HDD, a short-circuit may occur.
(3) [Attach] Heat radiation sheet
Aluminum surface
Bracket
HDD
FR1H7034.EPS
T O P
FR1H7035.EPS
MC - 260
MC - 261
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 262
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263
(4) Peel off the adhesive-coat protection film from the aluminum surface of the heat radiation sheet attached. (5) Install the HDD to the bracket.
(6) Install the HDD together with the bracket as a whole. For reinstallation, reverse the removal procedures. (7) Install the connector and CNN08A board to the HDD. (8) Connect the connector (CNJ2) to the HDD. (9) Format the HDD and reinstall the software. 16.2 Formatting Hard Disk in the Maintenance Utility Volume 16.1 Installing the Software (Application) in the Maintenance Utility Volume (10) Turn ON the power and make sure that the machine starts up normally.
N NOTES N
When inserting the HDD into the bracket, use care not to cause the adhesivecoated surface of the heat radiation sheet to stick to the bracket. Align the threaded holes while inserting the HDD into the bracket, and bring the heat radiation sheet into close contact with the bracket. When installing the HDD to the bracket, push the HDD toward the bracket (in the direction of the arrow illustrated below) to secure it in place.
(5) #3 Bracket (4) [Peel] Protection film (5) #2 (5) #1 [Loosely Tighten/ Secure] 6-32 UNC, x4
A
Heat radiation sheet Aluminum surface (5) #4
T O P
HDD
DETAIL A
Bracket Heat radiation sheet
HDD
FR1H7036.EPS
MC - 262
MC - 263
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.1
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.2
345N1234C
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Parts to be replaced differ depending on the type of the HDD. Refer to the information on the relevant parts replacement list.
356N5849A
345N1234C
898Y0864
QUANTUM/QM32100SE-S (850S0121) PART NAME HDD Bracket Heat radiation sheet CNN08A board Shield plate PART No. 850S0121 356N5849A 345N1234C QTY. 1 1 1 G HITACHI/DK32DJ-18MW (850Y0117) G SEAGATE / ST336607LW(850Y0131) QTY. 1 1 1 PART NAME HDD Bracket Heat radiation sheet CNN08A board Shield plate PART No. 850Y0117/850Y0131 356Y0200 379N0113A 113Y1660A 898Y0864 345N1368A 345N1366B QTY. 1 1 1 1 1 2
345N1368A
345N1366B
Western Digital/WDE4550-003 (850S0080) PART NAME HDD Bracket Heat radiation sheet CNN08A board Shield plate PART No. 850S0080 356Y0200 (reused) 345N1234C
G SEAGATE/ST318416N (850Y0112)
113Y1660A 379N0113A
Western Digital/WDE9100-003 (850S0085) PART NAME HDD Bracket Heat radiation sheet CNN08A board Shield plate PART No. 850S0085 356Y0200 (reused) 345N1234C QTY. 1 1 1
SEAGATE/ST318416N (850Y0112) PART NAME HDD Bracket Bracket Heat radiation sheet CNN08A board Shield plate 345N1368 345N1366B (reused) PART No. 850Y0112 356Y0200 (reused) 356N8865 379N0113 QTY. 1 1 1 1 1 2
FR1H7037.EPS
356Y0200 (reused)
379N0113 356N8865
FR1H7038.EPS
MC - 263.1
MC - 263.2
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.3
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.4
I Removal
(1) Disconnect the connector (CNJ1, 2). (2) Remove the HDD together with the bracket as a whole. (3) Detach the HDD from the bracket.
G SEAGATE/ST52160N (850S0107) G QUANTUM/QM32100SE-S (850S0121) (2) [Loosen] BR M4x8, x2 (1) [Disconnect] CNJ1 (1) [Disconnect] T ON CNJ2 FR HDD
I Reinstallation
(1) Check the settings of a new HDD (DK32DJ-18MW/ST33607LW) to be installed. 13.1 Setting the HDD (2) Peel off the adhesive-coat protection film from the silicone surface of a new heat radiation sheet to be attached. (3) Attach the heat radiation sheet onto the parts-mounted surface of a new HDD (DK32DJ-18MW/ST33607LW) to be installed.
CAUTION
When attaching the heat radiation sheet onto the HDD, make sure that the silicone surface of the heat radiation sheet faces the parts-mounted surface of the HDD. If the heat radiation sheet is attached with its aluminum surface facing the partsmounted surface of the HDD, a short-circuit may occur.
(3) [Attach] Heat radiation sheet
Aluminum surface
Parts-mounted surface
HDD
T O P
FR1H7035.EPS
FR1H7039.EPS
MC - 263.3
MC - 263.4
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.5
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.6
(4) Peel off the adhesive-coat protection film from the aluminum surface of the heat radiation sheet attached. (5) Install the HDD to the bracket.
N NOTES N
When inserting the HDD into the bracket, use care not to cause the adhesive-coated surface of the heat radiation sheet to stick to the bracket. Align the threaded holes while inserting the HDD into the bracket, and bring the heat radiation sheet into close contact with the bracket. When installing the HDD to the bracket, push the HDD toward the bracket (in the direction of the arrow illustrated below) to secure it in place.
(5) #3 Bracket (4) [Peel] Protection film (5) #2 (5) #1 [Loosely Tighten/ Secure] 6-32 UNC, x4
CNJ1
A
Heat radiation sheet Aluminum surface (5) #4
T O P
FR1H7040.EPS
HDD
DETAIL A
Bracket Heat radiation sheet
HDD
FR1H7036.EPS
(6) Install the HDD together with the bracket as a whole. For reinstallation, reverse the removal procedures.
MC - 263.5
MC - 263.6
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.7
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.8
N NOTE N
When the HDD (ST52160N/QM32100SE-S) is to be replaced with a new one (DK32DJ-18MW/ST33607LW), the bracket that retains the HDD should also be replaced with a new one (356Y0200).
HDD (ST52160N/QM32100SE-S) HDD (DK32DJ-18MW/ST336607LW)
Bracket (356N5849A)
Bracket (356Y0200)
FR1H7041.EPS
N NOTE N
Replacement of the shield plate differs depending on the parts used. Replace it as appropriate with reference to the relevant procedures.
Fan
Shield plate (345N1368A) BR M4x8, x3 Shield plate (345N1234C) BR M4x8, x3 Shield plate (345N1366B) BR M4x35, x2
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Fan mounted locations
FR1H7043.EPS
Guard Fan
Label face Shield plate (345N1366B) BR M4x35, x2 [Replace] Shield plate (345N1368) Shield plate (345N1368A) BR M4x8, x3
FR1H7044.EPS
MC - 263.7
MC - 263.8
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.9
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.10
(11) Format the HDD and reinstall the software. 16.2 Formatting Hard Disk in the Maintenance Utility Volume 16.1 Installing the Software (Application) in the Maintenance Utility Volume (12) Turn ON the power and make sure that the machine starts up normally.
BLANK PAGE
MC - 263.9
MC - 263.10
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.11
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 263.12
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MC - 263.11
MC - 263.12
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 264
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 265
15. FDD
15.1 Setting FDD
Short-pin settings for each FDD are illustrated below.
G For 850S0086
FR1B1267.EPS
G For 850S0087/0088/0089
(3)
(2) CN2
FDD
T ON FR
(2) CNJ1
FR1B1268.EPS
FR1H1247.EPS
MC - 264
MC - 265
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 266
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 267
(6) Make sure that the short-plug setting on the FDD is at initial setting. 15.1 Setting FDD (7) Reinstall the FDD together with the bracket. (8) Connect the connectors (CN1, 2 from the VOL08A board; CNJ1, 2 from the FDD).
BLANK PAGE
ON FR
MC - 266
MC - 267
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 268
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 269
16. Monitor
16.1 Cleaning Monitor
(1) Wipe the monitor screen with a soft cloth moistened with a neutral-detergent solution. Sufficiently wring the cloth before wiping the monitor screen.
N NOTE N
Do not use alcohol. Alcohol is strongly permeative, so that if there is any small scratch or crack in the acrylic plate, it may accelerate such a scratch or crack.
(2) Clean the monitor screen with a dry cloth.
(2) Monitor screen
Board
T ON FR
Remove the upper left-hand side cover, upper right-hand side cover, and front cover. (1) Remove the power switch cover. Even when the power switch cover is removed, the connectors are still connected. (2) Disconnect connectors LED08A CN1 and CN2. (3) Open the bracket after removing two screws.
(3) Bracket BR M4x8, x2
FR1H1501.EPS
FR
T ON
FR1H4020.EPS
MC - 268
MC - 269
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 270
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 271
(4) Disconnect connectors PNL CN3 and CRT CN1 through CN4.
(4) CRT CN4 (4) CRT CN1 (4) CRT CN2 (4) CRT CN3 (4) PNL CN3
FR
ON
FR1H4023.EPS
(5) Remove the monitor together with the bracket. (6) Separate the two mounting brackets from the monitor.
(6) Bracket BR M4x8, x2
F1
FR1H1929.EPS
I Fuse Rating
Location Between power supply unit and monitor
F NT RO
Name F1
I Checking Fuse
(5) Monitor BR M4x8, x4
G Glass-tube fuse
Measure the resistance across the fuse. If the measured resistance value is 100 or greater, the fuse is considered to be blown.
FR1H4021.EPS
Fuse
FR1H1924.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse.
MC - 270
MC - 271
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 272
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 273
BLANK PAGE
G Replacement procedure
(1) Remove the upper right-hand side cover. 3. Removing and Installing the Covers (2) Replace the fuse between the power supply unit and monitor.
FR ON
T ON FR
Transparent cover
FR1H1925.EPS
MC - 272
MC - 273
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 274
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 275
17. PC Boards
17.1 Board Arrangement Diagram
The PC boards of the machine are mounted as indicated below:
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
When removing or installing the MTH08A board, see the following. 17.21 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
I MTH08A board
CN30 TP7 CN27 NFB5/F5 NFB4/F4 CN25 CN26 CN23 NFB1/F1
CN28
CN16 CN14
T ON FR
CN19
NFB2/F2 CN9 CN7 CN5 CN4 CN3 CN29 CN2 CN1 NFB3/ F3 CN21 NFB6/F6 CN24
FR1H1350.EPS
CN6
CN20
SNS08A CPU90F/ LAN90B MTH08A/D DMC08A or HCP08A IMG08B/H IMG08A BCR08A MMC90A or DIM08A IMG07B CPU90E
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name NFB1/F1 NFB2/F2 NFB3/F3 NFB4/F4 NFB5/F5 NFB6/F6 Rated voltage 250 V 250 V 250 V 250 V 250 V 250 V Rated amperage 2A 2A 2A 5A 2A 3A
FFM
T ON FR
FR1H1352.EPS
MC - 274
MC - 275
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 276
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 277
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
ON position OFF position
FR1H1353.EPS
When removing or installing the MTH08D board, see the following. 17.21 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
I MTH08D board
CN30 F5 F6
CN25 CN26
CN23 CN22
F1
Tester
CN28
TP7
CN19
CN8 CN6
S1 ON position
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse. You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown.
CN20
CN3 F2 CN29
1 2 3 4 OFF position
CN2
MC - 276
MC - 277
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 278
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 279
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name F1 F2 F3 F5 F6 Rated voltage 125 V 125 V 125 V 125 V 125 V Rated amperage 2A 2A 2A 4A 5A
I CPU90E Board
S6 RS-422 position
Fuse
FR1H1924.EPS
S7 OFF position
S2 OFF position
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
As regards the MTH08D board, the LEDs indicate blown fuses. If a certain fuse is normal, the LED mounted near the fuse glows. If the fuse is abnormal, its LED goes off. If the LED is extinguished, it is highly probable that the associated fuse is blown. In such an instance, remove the fuse to check for fuse blowout. F1/LED (D1), F2/LED (D2), F3/LED (D3), F5/LED (D5), F6/LED (D6) You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown. For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse.
S5 CN2
8 7 6 5 ON position
4 3 2 1 ON position
4 3 2 1 ON position
CN1
NFB4/F4
1 2
910
CN18 NFB1/F1
LED D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
STRAIGHT position
CROSS position
TX RX CL
FR1H1938.EPS
MC - 278
MC - 279
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 280
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 281
I Switch Setup
Switch
S1
Factory setup
General-purpose setup switch. The software reads the setting of this switch. 1) S2-1 and S2-2 (to be set up in the same manner) Performs battery backup function ON/OFF setup. 2) S2-3 Turns ON or OFF the MTH08A NMI signal issuance function. The OFF position must be selected because the MTH08A does not currently have the NMI signal issuance function. 3) S2-4 Turns ON or OFF the boot ROM write function. This function is not going to be used for the time being because it is operative only when the flash EEPROM is used as the boot ROM.
OFF
OFF
S2
ON position
OFF position
FR1H1353.EPS
OFF
OFF
S3 S4 S5 S6
S7
Issues a manual reset. Issues a manual NMI. Effects ID-Network line connection style (CROSS/STRAIGHT) changeover. Effects IDT communication line signal level (RS-422/RS-232C) changeover. Turns ON or OFF the power remote control function for the IDT. 1) S7-1 and S7-2 (to be simultaneously set up) Turns ON or OFF the IR-to-IDT power remote control function. 2) S7-3 and S7-4 (to be simultaneously set up) Turns ON or OFF the IDT-to-IR power remote control function.
RS-422 position
Tester
ON ON
ON
ON
TR1H1009.EPS
FR1H1914.EPS
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name NFB1/F1 NFB2/F2 NFB3/F3 NFB4/F4 Rated voltage 250 V 250 V 250 V 250 V Rated amperage 1A 1A 1A 2A
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse. You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown.
MC - 280
MC - 281
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 282
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 283
I IMG07B Board
CN2 CN1
I IMG08A Board
CN2 CN1
D2 D1
CN3
CN6 D3 D4 D2 D1 CN4
CN5
S1
S1
CD AB E
FR1H1930.EPS
CD AB E
F01
F01
23
Set to "4".
Set to "1".
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the switch (S1) on the IMG07B board is set to 4.
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the switch (S1) on the IMG08A board is set to 1.
MC - 282
789
23
4 56
4 56
789
FR1H1931.EPS
MC - 283
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 284
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 285
I IMG08B Board
CN2 CN1
I DMC08A Board
CN2 CN1
D6 D5 D2 D1 D4 D3 S1 CN3
CN3 D2 D1
S1
CD AB E
CD AB E
F01
F01
Set to "2".
FR1H1932.EPS
Set to "0".
I IMG08H Board
CN2 CN1
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the switch (S1) on the DMC08A board is set to 0.
LED20 (D2)
LED21 (D3)
LED22 (D4)
LED23 (D5)
CN3 S1
CD AB E
F01
Set to "2".
FR1H1933.EPS
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the switch (S1) on the IMG08B board is set to 2. Make sure that the switch (S1) on the IMG08H board is set to 2.
009-051-08 05.30.2002 FM3405
MC - 284
789
789
23
4 56
23
23
4 56
789
FR1H1934.EPS
4 56
MC - 285
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 286
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 287
I HCP08A Board
CN2 CN1
N NOTE N
With board version N or later, the software version of the machine should be updated to A09 or later. Earlier software versions do not support a newer LSI (discontinuation supported) on the daughter board (ETH90F board) of the CPU90F board.
I CPU90F Board
7 8 1 14 9 10 1 2
CNSI0 No short pin (OPEN) LED T1, 2 Short pin LED7 LED5 LED3 LED1 LED0 3 2 LED6 LED4 LED2
JP1 JP2
3 2 1
CN2
1 CN1
SW1
4 56
789
F01
CD AB E
FR1H1935.EPS
23
COL DUP LINK 100M RX TX DIS1 OFF position CNPC1 ETH90F/H board T4 NFB2/F2
NFB1/F1
Set to "5".
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the switch (SW1) on the HCP08A board is set to 5.
SW1
4 56
4 3 2 ON position 1 4 3 2 ON position 1
789
F01
CD AB E
FR1H1936.EPS
Set to "6".
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the CPU90F board is set as follows. CNSIO: No short pin (open) T1, T2: Nos. 2 and 3 are shorted. DIS1: DIS2: SW1:
009-051-08 05.30.2002 FM3405
MC - 286
23
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 288
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 289
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name NFB1/F1 NFB2/F2 Rated voltage 250 V 250 V Rated amperage 1A 3A
N NOTE N
The LAN90D board is a substitute for the CPU90F board. When replacing the CPU90F board with the LAN90D board, update the main unit software to version A18 or later. If the software is not updated to version A18 or later, the LAN90D board does not deliver the same performance as the CPU90F board.
ON position
OFF position
FR1H1353.EPS
I LAN90B/D Board
S3 CN2 CN1
CD AB E
S1 CN7 CN6 D10 100 D13 TX D12 RX 1 2 3 4 ON position 5 6 S2 OFF position D11 FDP02
F01
23
4 56
Tester
FR1H1914.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse. You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown.
I Switch Setup
Make sure that the LAN90B board has been set as shown below.
G Setting the S2
bit 1-3, 5, 6 4 Description To be determined ON: Function test (FT) OFF: OS boot (NORMAL) Setting Always OFF Always OFF
FR1B1500.EPS
G Setting the S3
Set tp 6.
MC - 288
78 9
FR1H1937.EPS
MC - 289
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 290
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 291
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
When removing or installing the DRV08A board, see the following. 17.21 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
Tester
I DRV08A Board
FR1H1914.EPS
CN15 TP1 TP7 CN5 CN13 TP5 CN6 CN12 CN1 NFB12/F1 TP3 TP4 TP2 TP6 CN14 CN10 CN8 CN11 CN4 CN9 CN26 CN16 CN20
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse. You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown.
CN2
CN3
FR1H4044.EPS
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name NFB12/F1 Rated voltage 250 V Rated amperage 1A
ON position
OFF position
FR1H1353.EPS
MC - 290
MC - 291
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 292
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 293
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
When removing or installing the SNS08A board, see the following. 17.21 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
ON position
OFF position
FR1H1353.EPS
Measure the resistance value across the fuse. If the measured resistance value is 100 or greater, it is judged that the fuse has been blown.
Fuse
CN4 NFB1/F1 CN12 CN10 CN15 CN11 CN17 CN16 CN22 CN23 CN13 CN24 CN8 CN9 CN7 CN5 NFB3/F3
CN20
CN19
Tester
CN21 CN1
CN18
FR1H1914.EPS
CN6
CN14
FR1H1351.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
For the tester, its probe resistance (resistance value at the time of probe shorting) should be measured before measurement, and compensation should be made with respect to the measured value of the fuse. You cannot accurately determine whether a fuse is blown or not while the associated board is mounted in the machine. However, if the resistance value measured across the fuse with the board installed in the machine is 1 or greater, it is highly probable that the fuse is blown. In such an instance, demount the board and check whether the fuse is actually blown.
I Fuse Ratings
Location Name NFB1/F1 NFB2/F2 NFB3/F3 Rated voltage 250 V 250 V 250 V Rated amperage 5A 2A 1A
MC - 292
MC - 293
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 294
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 295
I LED08A board
CN3 CN2 READY : READY lamp (green) CALL : CALL lamp (yellow) ERROR : ERROR lamp (orange) POWER : POWER lamp (green)
I LED08B board
D1: Cassette ejection lamp (green) D2: Cassette insertion lamp (green) D2 D1
CN1 READY
CN1
CALL
FR1H1918.EPS
ERROR
POWER
When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
I VOL08A board
CN2 CN1
Buzzer
FR1H1919.EPS
MC - 294
MC - 295
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 296
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297
17.21 Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D, SNS08A, and DRV08A boards
I Removing and Installing the MTH08A/D G Removal procedure
(1) Remove the following cover: Upper left-hand side cover Upper rear side cover 3. Removing and Installing the Covers (2) Remove the PC board brace.
I BCR08A board
CN1
CN2
MTH08A/D board
O FR
FR1H7002.EPS
NT
REFERENCE
The connectors need to be disconnected from the following PC boards: CPU90E: CN6 to CN8, CN11, CN18, and CN19
MC - 296
MC - 297
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.1
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.2
(4) Remove all the boards except the MTH08A/D board. Below is illustrated an example where the CPU90E board is removed. Other boards should also be removed in a similar manner.
N NOTE N
To remove a memory board, perform the steps indicated below. If you do not follow these steps, the connector claws become damaged. G MMC90A board (1) Push the connectors left-hand claw open. (2) Open the memory board to an angle of about 30 to 40. (3) Pull out the memory board.
Top view
MTH08A/D board
(1)
Left-hand claw
Connector
(2)
30 40
(3)
MMC90A board
FR1H7018.EPS
#1
[Loosen] T4x8
CPU90E board
#2
[Remove] T4x8
FR1H7017.EPS
G DIM08A board (1) Simultaneously open the claws on both ends of the connector by pressing them outward. (2) Remove the DIM08A board by pulling it horizontally.
Top view
(2)
DIM08A board
FR1H7019.EPS
MTH08A/D board
T ON FR
FR1H7026.EPS
MC - 297.1
MC - 297.2
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.3
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.4
(6) Remove the hard disk drive. 13.2 Replacing the HDD (7) Remove the fan (FANV1) assembly. (8) Disconnect the connectors and terminals.
N NOTE N
When removing the MTH08C/D board, hold the board by hand to detach it.
N RO
FR
ON
A
CN20 CN29
(7) #2
[Disconnect] BR4x8, x2
Fan (FANV1) assembly
CN24
MTH08A/D board
FR1H7021.EPS
G Installation procedure
Accomplish installation by reversing the removal procedure.
N NOTE N
When installing a memory board, observe the following precautions: Do not touch the connector section of the memory board. Handle the memory board only by its edges. Open the CN17/CN18 claws, align the cuts in the memory board with the protrusions in the CN17/CN18 socket, hold both ends of the memory board, and insert the memory board horizontally into the socket.
MTH08A/D board MMC90A board MMC90A/DIM08A board
FRONT
CN18 CN17
FR1H7027.EPS
MC - 297.3
MC - 297.4
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.5
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.6
DETAIL A
DRV08A board
FR
T ON
CN8
CN4
A B
SNS08A board
CN2
CN3
DETAIL B
F R O N T
CN4
FR1H7022.EPS
[Disconnect] Connectors
CN2
CN3
CN12 CN10 CN15 CN11 CN16 CN22 CN23 CN13 CN1 CN7 CN5
SNS08A board
CN8
CN9
CN6
CN14
FR1H7023.EPS
MC - 297.5
MC - 297.6
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.7
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 297.8
N NOTE N
The board assembly should be removed and installed along the rails.
[Remove] BR4x8, x2
Bracket
(4) #2
[Remove] BR4x8, x2
(5) #1
[Remove] BR3x6, x7
DRV08A board
(4) #1
[Remove] B3x10, x2
SNS08C board
Board assembly
Rails
(6) #1
[Remove] B3x6, x7
(5) #2
[Remove]
DRV08A board
FR1H7024.EPS
(4) Remove the bracket. (5) Remove the DRV08A board. (6) Remove the SNS08C board.
DRV08A board
SNS08A board
(6) #2
[Remove]
SNS08A board
FR1H7025.EPS
I Installation procedure
Accomplish installation by reversing the removal procedure.
MC - 297.7
MC - 297.8
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 298
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 299
18. Cleaning IP
After cleaning the IP, use the IP cleaned to perform IP conveyance checks.
(11) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to U-Utility. (12) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (13) Select 3. TEST MODE and 1. ROUTINE MODE in sequence. (14) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility.
I Cleaning Procedures
(1) Take out the IP from the cassette. (2) Wipe the fluorescent surface of the IP with gauze. After moving the gauze in a straight fashion, move the gauze in small circles, as illustrated below, to wipe the IP clean. If soils persist after cleaning with dry gauze, proceed to step (3). If soils are cleaned off, proceed to step (4).
IP
FR1H1314.EPS
(3) Wipe the IP with ethanol-moistened gauze. After wiping the IP with ethanol-moistened gauze, immediately wipe it with dry gauze to remove traces of alcohol left on the fluorescent surface of the IP, and wait until it is completely dry. (4) Put the IP into the cassette with its fluorescent surface down.
I IP Conveyance Check
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 3. TEST MODE, 2. AUTO MODE, and 2. PRIMARY ERASURE in sequence. A message prompting for the number of conveyances appears on screen. (5) Enter the number of IPs cleaned as a value. (6) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility. (7) Touch the RETURN button. (8) Insert the cassette that contains the cleaned IPs into each of the shelves. IP conveyance starts. (9) Make sure that there is no offensive noise or odor from the machine during IP conveyance. (10) After the IP conveyance, take out the cassette and verify that the IPs are free of scratch or other damage.
MC - 298
MC - 299
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 300
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 301
19. Tools
19.1 Standard Tools
N NOTE N
To service the machine, use the servicing instruments and tools that have been inspected and calibrated. If the machine were serviced using servicing instruments and tools that have not been inspected and calibrated, proper performance of the machine could not be guaranteed.
Thin-blade screwdriver
Type: NO.110-4
FR1H1713.EPS
FR1H1714.EPS
High-frequency screwdriver
Type: D-29
Nippers 150mm
Type: N-25
Type:
NO.195-2
W-120
FR1H1715.EPS FR1H1705.EPS
FR1H1716.EPS
FR1H1706.EPS
Pliers 150mm
Type: JP-200
FR1H1717.EPS
FR1H1718.EPS
FR1H1707.EPS
FR1H1708.EPS
Tweezers 125mm
Type: P-87
FR1H1719.EPS
FR1H1720.EPS
FR1H1709.EPS
FR1H1710.EPS
FR1H1721.EPS
FR1H1722.EPS
FR1H1711.EPS
FR1H1712.EPS
MC - 300
MC - 301
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 302
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 303
FR1H1723.EPS
FR1H1724.EPS
FR1H1733.EPS
FR1H1734.EPS
Digital tester
Type: FLUKE77
Crimp pliers
Type: P-73
Solder
Type: NO.66
FR1H1726.EPS
FR1H1735.EPS
FR1H1736.EPS
Wire stripper
Type: P-95
Scissors
Type: Manufacturer: Any commercially available one Qty.: Remarks: 1
Adapter plug
Type: 999-1
Penlight
Type: BF-318 Manufacturer: MATSUSHITA ELECTRIC Qty.: Remarks: 1
FR1H1727.EPS
FR1H1728.EPS
FR1H1737.EPS
FR1H1738.EPS
Cutter
Type: Manufacturer: Any commercially available one Qty.: Remarks: 1
Calipers
Type: N-15
Loupe
Type: 10X
Blower
Type: JUMBO
Remarks: Inspection required A block gauge for use in inspection requires calibration.
FR1H1729.EPS
FR1H1730.EPS
FR1H1739.EPS
FR1H1740.EPS
Cloth
Type:
FR1H1731.EPS
FR1H1732.EPS
FR1H1741.EPS
MC - 302
MC - 303
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 304
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 305
Cable tie
Type: PLT1M
KOGYO
Ethanol
Type:
Vacuum cleaner
Type: Manufacturer:
Any commercially available one
FR1H1745.EPS
FR1H1746.EPS
Cable tie
Type: PLT1.5S
KOGYO
Cable tie
Type: PLT2M
KOGYO
Qty.: Remarks:
FR1H1742.EPS
FR1H1743.EPS
Dust-free paper
Type: Kimwipe
Push-pull gauge
FR1H1747.EPS
FR1H1748.EPS
Dosimeter
FR1H1749.EPS
Calibration required
FR1H1875.EPS
MC - 304
MC - 305
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 306
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
MC - 307
19.5 Tools
Antistatic member positioning jig
PART NO.: Y12N0451 Manufacturer: Fuji Photo Film
Qty.: 1 Remarks:
Jig for positioning the antistatic member for the shutter section
FR1H1876.EPS
FR1H1750.EPS
FR1H1751.EPS
IC clip
Type: TC-16
IC clip
Type: TC-24
FR1H1752.EPS
FR1H1753.EPS
MC - 306
MC - 307
MU - 1
05 06
08/30/2001
07
05/30/2002 03/20/2004
08 10
08/31/2005
11
Reason Pages affected Corrections due to change in configuration All pages (FM2460) Corrections (FM2638) MU-12, 14171 Software update (FM3006) MU-19, 3341, 41.141.4, 4247, 56, 57, 61, 66, 67, 70, 73, 93, 96, 126 Support for plus MU-7, 20, 33, 35, 38, 40, 41, (support for software version A14) 41.1, 41.2, 41.441.8, 42, 44, 45, (FM3115) 53, 54, 57, 59, 60, 62, 63, 66, 70, 71, 75, 76, 119, 121, 122, 154 Addition of the information about software MU-155 installation. (FM3405) Configuration addition due to a software MU-7, 17, 18, 27, 30, 33, 34, 39, update, DICOM setting addition, scanner 41.1-41.12, 42-45, 45.1-45.4, invalid pixel/line setting change procedure 58, 59, 63-65, 65.1-65.4, 66-71, addition, and other information additions, 74, 81.1-81.4, 110, 116, 162-168, and typographical error corrections 170 (FM4275) Revision (FM4710) MU-34, 41.1, 41.2, 41.8-41.10
MU - 1
CONTENTS
10
MU - 2
CONTENTS
10
MU - 3
1.
BLANK PAGE
I Maintenance Utility
It provides functionality necessary for maintenance of the FCR5000 (machine), such as display of error log, and mechanical and electrical operations. Menus are displayed through special manipulation (not open to the user) of the machines operation panel to perform various functions. The menu hierarchy of the Maintenance Utility varies depending on whether the machine is in normal operation or otherwise (i.e., in the initialization sequence or in serous error).
I Configuration Setting
It provides various functions required to set up and change configuration settings of the machine. Because reading and writing of files that can be edited on a personal computer (PC) is supported, configuration setting may be performed on a PC running Windows 95. Setup can be done efficiently by taking advantage of PCs ease of use, when, for example, initial configuration setting is done or multiple items are changed collectively. Configuration setting may also be implemented (settings may be changed) through manipulation on the machines operation panel.
CR-IR341
Maintenance Utility
Online PC
Image Processing Parameter Adjustment
Online PC
Configuration Setting
FR1H1136.EPS
MU - 2
MU - 3
CONTENTS
10
MU - 4
CONTENTS
10
MU - 5
2.
2.2
2.1
Active Transition caused by human intervention User operation User IDT operation Service engineer operation Version display mode (5 sec) Automatic transition (No human intervention required) (NOTE 2) Initialization process mode Abnormality display mode
OS boot mode
Line failure (NOTE 1) IDT utility mode Power switch OFF End process mode Routine process mode Utility mode Power switch OFF QUIT
Special touch
Power switch OFF NOTE 1: When a line failure occurs in the IDT utility mode, the system simply switches to the routine process mode. NOTE 2: When "system shutdown" is selected upon the occurrence of an IP search abnormality
FR1H1400.EPS
Power switch OFF (NOTE) Precaution about selection of "QUIT" The "QUIT" command works when the mode is switched from the utility mode to the maintenance utility mode. If the mode is switched from the version display mode, the system does not transition to the utility mode.
FR1H1399.EPS
MU - 4
MU - 5
CONTENTS
10
MU - 6
CONTENTS
10
MU - 7
3.
3.1
Date/time setup
Read
1 2 3
Click sound
FD operation
Utility
Return
CR-IR341
U-Utility button
M-Utility screen
Copyright (c) 1998 Fuji Photo Film Co.,Ltd
: Area to be touched
Software ID : 114Y5431003 Software Version : A07
: Location to be touched
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1392.EPS
MU - 6
MU - 7
CONTENTS
10
MU - 8
CONTENTS
10
MU - 9
3.2
Exiting M-Utility
To quit M-Utility, select 0. QUIT while the main menu is displayed. If the configuration file has been edited using M-Utility, make your editing effective by resetting the machine after you exit M-Utility.
N NOTE N
If M-Utility is entered during the initialization sequence, 0. QUIT does not appear. Thus, after quitting M-Utility, the machine should be reset.
(1) While the M-Utility main menu is displayed, select 0. QUIT. The display switches to the U-Utility screen. (2) Press the reset button. The reset button should basically be pressed. You may touch the Return button only in cases where the automatic transport mode setup would be invalidated by a reset.
Stop alarm
System down
: Area to be touched
FR1B1137.EPS
MU - 8
MU - 9
CONTENTS
10
MU - 10
CONTENTS
10
MU - 11
4.
4.1
4.2
Quitting a Menu
When you select QUIT on a menu, one of the following results follows.
I Selecting QUIT
G When a menu item is displayed, the system returns to the upper-level menu. G When the main menu is displayed, the system exits M-Utility and switches to the U-Utility. G The system stops the current menu execution (operation). G The system returns to the upper-level menu while continuing with the current menu execution (operation).
Selecting a Menu
There are two methods to select a menu in M-Utility.
I Selecting STOP
When you select STOP, the actuator or motor operation (DRIVE) ends.
Example: 3. STOP is selected
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >6 0.QUIT 1.MOTOR 2.ACTUATOR 3.SENSOR 4.UNIT MU > 2 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT > 3
MU:SEN > 2 1:SA1 2:SA2 3:SA3 4:SA4 6:SA6 7:SA7 8:SA8 9:SA9 11:SA11 12:SA12 13:SA13 14:SA14 16:SA16 17:SA17 18:SB1 19:SB2 21:SB4 22:SB5 23:SC1 24:SC2 26:SD2 27:SD3 28:SE1 29:SF1 31:SF3 32:SF4 33:SZ2 34:SZ3 INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 34 : 4 SA4 ----> Close SA4 ----> Open SA4 ----> Close 0 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.MONITOR 3.MONITOR ALL MU:SEN >
A B C D E F 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 0 . SP DEL BS ENT Caps 5:SA5 10:SA10 15:SA15 20:SB3 25:SD1 30:SF2 A B C D E F 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 0 . SP DEL BS ENT Caps
FR1H1235.EPS
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
MU:AUT > 3 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 11 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1759.EPS
MU - 10
MU - 11
CONTENTS
10
MU - 12
CONTENTS
10
MU - 13
4.3
BLANK PAGE
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1500.EPS
MU - 12
MU - 13
CONTENTS
10
MU - 14
CONTENTS
10
MU - 15
[7.]
5.
5.1
2.PRINT : Defines the setup information related to film output formats. 3.REMOTE SWITCH : Remote switch ON/OFF setting for the intelligent hub. 4.EQUIPMENT : Defines the setup information related to connected equipment.
5.LOCAL INTERFACE : Defines the setup information for communication requirements of serial line connection. Not setting is needed because its default setting should be used. 0.QUIT 1.IDT 2.LIF 3.DIF 4.CSL 6.NETWORK HOST INTERFACE : Defines the setup information for network connection and communication. 7.HOSTS ADDRESS : Sets an address of network connection. 8.DISTRIBUTION : Sets a destination of network connection.
[7.7]
1.ALL : Displays all the error messages generated, in reverse chronological order. 0.QUIT 1.ERROR : Displays serious errors only. 2.WARNING : Displays warning errors only. 3.BOTH : Displays all errors. 2.SUMMARY : Groups the generated errors according to error codes and displays the number of occurrences (in four digits) for those errors. 0.QUIT 1.ERROR : Displays serious errors only. 2.WARNING : Displays warning errors only. 3.BOTH : Displays all errors. 2.CLEAR: Clears the entire error logs. 0.QUIT [6.2]
9.ROUTING : Sets routing of network connection. 10.NETMASKS : Sets a subnet mask of network connection. 11.DICOM : Base on DICOM.
1.ERROR LOG 3.SAVE TO FD : Saves error log data and trace data to a floppy disk. 0.QUIT 1.ERROR LOG : Saves the error log to a floppy disk. 2.TRACE DATA : Copies the trace data upon occurrence of error to a floppy disk. Copies logged error messages having an extension between 001 and 005 to a floppy disk. 3.IOT DATA : Saves the latest IO trace data in memory to a floppy disk. 4.SAVE TO HD : Saves error log data to the hard disk. 0.QUIT 1.ERROR LOG : Copies ERROR messages to the error0.log file and WARNING messages to the ERRORX.LOG file. NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
FR1H1383.EPS
[6.3]
1.READING & ERASURE : Performs an automatic conveyance sequence a designated number of times to execute the reading and erasure processes. 2.PRIMARY ERASURE : Performs an automatic conveyance sequence a designated number of times to execute the reading (no image output) and erasure processes. 3.SECONDARY ERASURE : Performs an automatic conveyance sequence a designated number of times to execute the erasure process only. NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
FR1H1384.EPS
[6.4]
MU - 14
MU - 15
CONTENTS
10
MU - 16
CONTENTS
10
MU - 17
[10.1] [10.2]
[10.4]
[10.5]
[10.6]
1.WRITE-READ VERIFY : Writes 1 Kbytes of monotonously increasing data onto a floppy disk, and reads it back to verify that the written data and read data agree with each other. NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
1.DEFAULT : Sets the read start position and read width to their initial values.
FR1H1385.EPS
0.QUIT 1.PIXEL AND FREQ 2.PIXEL ONLY 3.FREQ ONLY 2.FREQ ADJUST : Adjusts the read width. 3.PIXEL ADJUST : Adjust the read start position. 4.PIXEL POSITION CORRECTION: Changes the invalid pixel setting. 5.LINE POSITION CORRECTION: Changes the invalid line setting. 7.SHADING/SENSITIVITY : Temporarily records, calculates, and sets the shading or sensitivity data in order to determine it. Writing the settings to the hard disk is done in "8. DATA MANAGEMENT." "9.2 Shading/Sensitivity Correction" in Checks, Replacement and Adjustment Volume [10.7] 0.QUIT 1.REC MODE : Makes the shading correction data recordable.
FR1H1386.EPS
MU - 16
MU - 17
CONTENTS
10
MU - 18
CONTENTS
10
MU - 19
2.CALCULATION : Calculates the shading, polygon or sensitivity correction data. 0.QUIT 1.SHADING, POLYGON AND SENSITIVITY 2.SHADING, POLYGON AND SENSITIVITY FOR BAD CONDITION 3.SHADING AND POLYGON 4.SHADING AND POLYGON FOR BAD CONDITION 5.POLYGON ONLY 6.SENSITIVITY ONLY 3.SHADING / POLYGON CORRECTION : It is set to ON when the corrected data is to be enabled in routine mode. 0.QUIT 1.ON 2.OFF 4.SENSITIVITY DATA : Performs set sensitivity correction (e.g., leveling the sensitivities of multiple readers). Writing the correction value to the hard disk is done in "8. DATA MANAGEMENT." 5.HV DATA : Should not be used in the market. 6.PMT DATA : Should not be used in the market. 8.DATA MANAGEMENT : Displays and writes to the hard disk the setup values for "6. FORMAT" and "7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY." 0.QUIT
6.MECHANICAL UTILITY : Monitors individual operation of the motor, sensor status, etc.
Used for checking the motors and sensors. 0.QUIT 1.MOTOR : Sets the pulse motor drive parameters and conducts pulse motor drive/stop tests. 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.PARAMETER 3.DRIVE 4.STOP 2.ACTUATOR : Conducts solenoid, valve, pump, erasure lamp, and FFM drive/stop tests. 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP 3.SENSOR : Monitors the sensor status. Two monitoring methods are available: one is for monitoring the sensors on an individual basis, and the other is for monitoring all sensors at a time. 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.MONITOR 3.MONITOR ALL 4.UNIT 0.QUIT 1.IP FEED/LOAD UNIT : Performs operation tests on the IP removal mechanism. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.ARM HOME POSITION 2.FEED/LOAD 2.UP-DOWN UNIT : Performs operation tests on the elevation unit. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.HOME POSITION 2.SETTING UNIT POSITION 3.SIDE-POSITIONING GRIP : Performs operation tests on the side-positioning conveyance grip mechanism. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.HOME POSITION 2.GRIP 3.RELEASE 4.SIDE-POSITIONING UNIT : Performs operation tests on the side-positioning mechanism. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.HOME POSITION 2.ACTUATION 5.AFTER-READING GRIP : Performs operation tests on the after-reading conveyance grip. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.HOME POSITION 2.GRIP 3.RELEASE NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
009-051-06 009-051-05 04.20.2001 FM3006 11.20.99 FM2638
[11.]
[11.2]
[11.3]
[11.4]
[10.8]
1.SAVE SHADING AND POLYGON DATA : Writes the shading or polygon data to the hard disk. 2.SAVE SENSITIVITY DATA : Writes the sensitivity correction data to the hard disk. 3.SAVE FORMAT DATA : Writes the format data to the hard disk. 4.DISPLAY DATA : Displays set data for the format or sensitivity. NOTE 2 5.LOAD FROM FD : Reads the data in the floppy disk into the primary memory. The data read is lost when the machine is reset. 0.QUIT 1.SHADING/POLYGON 2.SENSITIVITY 6.SAVE TO FD : Writes to a floppy disk the shading, polygon, or sensitivity data in the hard disk. 9.DIAGNOSTIC : Executes all the diagnostic items. 10.VIRTUAL IMAGE : Causes the scanner hardware to generate a virtual image signal, so that the resulting image is read to isolate the cause of trouble. 0.QUIT 1.LIGHT : Generates virtual light. 2.LOG AMP : Turns OFF the HV to generate an image signal of fixed output. 3.SCN08 INPUT : Causes the SCN08 board to generate an image signal. 4.ROUTINE : Cancel the virtual image signal generation mode to revert back to the initial state. It should always be performed after the checks are completed in the virtual image signal generation mode. NOTE 1: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual. NOTE 2: The abbreviated alphabets displayed have the following meanings. MP: TMP: TML: RCNT: NCNT: HVCNT: Number of invalid pixels Total number of invalid pixels Total number of invalid lines Reference frequency division value Oscillation frequency setup value Center-sensitivity HV value HVDATA: PMTK: SAIP: Xe: Z: SMD: Reading HV value PMT sensitivity coefficient IP sensitivity during sensitivity adjustment Erasure level dosage Erasure level QL value SHD/polygon correction mode default value
FR1H1387.EPS
[11.5]
[11.6]
[10.9]
[11.7]
[10.10]
[11.8]
[11.9]
FR1H1388.EPS
MU - 18
MU - 19
CONTENTS
10
MU - 20
[11.10]
CONTENTS
10
MU - 21
[13.]
6.DRIVING GRIP : Performs operation tests on the subscanning driving grip mechanism. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.GRIP 2.RELEASE 3.D/A DATA 7.DRIVEN GRIP : Performs operation tests on the subscanning driven grip mechanism. Displays a message if any abnormality is encountered. 0.QUIT 1.GRIP 2.RELEASE 3.D/A DATA 8.MIRROR UP/DOWN : Not functional with CR-IR341.
9.HV ON/OFF : Turns ON and OFF the high-voltage switch (software switch).
[11.11]
If reading is performed with the covers opened, the photomultiplier may be damaged. Thus, be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch.
[14.] [15.]
7.FILE UTILITY : Performs file-related operations such as saving parameter files to and
reading data from floppy disks. Used when the configuration data is edited on a personal computer or when optional software is installed. 0.QUIT [12.]
2.MOVE : Changes the display location of the menu. 3.ROUTINE : Registers and deletes the routine menu. 4.EDIT : Edits the menu name and various parameters.
1.FORMAT FD : Formats a floppy disk according to the 1.44MB MS-DOS format. 2.FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION : Formats an image storage partition of the hard disk. 3.BACKUP : Writes each setup file to a floppy disk. 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA : Saves the scanner setup files to a floppy disk. 2. CONFIGURATION DATA: Saves setup files (IRSET.CFG, FILFMT.CFG) to a floppy disk. 3. NETWORK DATA: Saves network-related setup files (RMT_SW.CFG, EQUIP, DEVICE, HOSTS, CODEDSTB, ROUTE, NETMASKS, Base on DICOM) to a floppy disk. 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA : Saves image processing parameter files to a floppy disk. 5.CSL MENU DATA : Saves to a floppy disk the setup files related to CSL type menu screens and magnetic card formats. 6.EDR PROCESSING DATA : Saves EDR parameter files to a floppy disk. 4.RESTORE : Reads each setup file from the floppy disk to the hard disk. 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA : Reads the scanner setup files from a floppy disk to the hard disk. 2. CONFIGURATION DATA: Reads setup files (IRSET.CFG, FILFMT.CFG) from the floppy disk to the hard disk. 3. NETWORK DATA: Reads network-related setup files (RMT_SW.CFG, EQUIP, DEVICE, HOSTS, CODEDSTB, ROUTE, NETMASKS, Base on DICOM) from the floppy disk to the hard disk. 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA : Loads image processing parameter files from a floppy disk to the hard disk. 5.CSL MENU DATA : Loads the setup files related to CSL type menu screens and magnetic card formats from a floppy disk to the hard disk.
[12.1]
6.DELETE : Deletes menus. 7.FILMMARK : Edits film marks. NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
[12.4]
6.EDR PROCESSING DATA : Reads EDR parameter files from a floppy disk to the hard disk. 5.EDR DATA [12.5]
0.QUIT 1.PARAMETER ONLY(SAVE TO FD) : Saves to a floppy disk the EDR intermediate processing parameter files for images stored in the hard disk. 2.FULL(SAVE TO FD) : Saves to a floppy disk the EDR intermediate processing parameter files and EDR reduced-image data for images stored in the hard disk. 3.PARAMETER ONLY(SAVE TO HD) 4.FULL(SAVE TO HD) 5.DELETE EDR BACKUP FILES ON HD Setting for remote maintenance [12.6]
6.PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE: Reverts back to the immediately preceding version of system software. 7.EXECUTION : Loads a designated file from a floppy disk and executes it. Used when optional files are installed. NOTE: Numerals in brackets denote a relevant chapter in this manual.
[12.7]
FR1H1390.EPS
MU - 20
MU - 21
CONTENTS
10
MU - 22
CONTENTS
10
MU - 23
5.2
BLANK PAGE
[11.1]
MU - 22
MU - 23
CONTENTS
10
MU - 24
CONTENTS
10
MU - 25
6.
6.1
| | | | | | | |
CODE 081D
DATE COUNT 1998.04.16 14:36 0012 . . . 1722 1998.04.16 10:12 0006 23E6 1998.04.16 09:58 0213 0.END 1.NEXT 2.BEFORE (DEFAULT=1) :
| | | | | | | |
| | | | | | | | | |
CODE 081D
DATE 1998.04.16 14:36 11.E738.000002.8A0AC1.000000.000C19.8 000001.000009.00001B . . . 1722 1998.04.16 09:58 85AA1319.05972166 0.END 1.NEXT 2.BEFORE (DEFAULT=1) :
| | | | | | | | | |
3.BOTH
G Page flip
Type in one of the following numbers and press the [ENT] key. 0.END 1.NEXT 2.BEFORE (Exit the display function.) (Display the next page.) (Display the previous page.)
G Page flip
Type in one of the following numbers and press the [ENT] key. 0.END 1.NEXT 2.BEFORE (Exit the display function.) (Display the next page.) (Display the previous page.)
MU - 24
MU - 25
CONTENTS
10
MU - 26
CONTENTS
10
MU - 27
6.2
6.3
2.TRACE DATA (Overwrite trace data files having extensions .001 through .005 onto the floppy disk.) 3.IOT DATA (Save a file with a file name represented by the time it is saved, with an extension .IOT.)
4.NET WORK TRACE DATE (Save the trace data file concerning the communication with the console display software onto a floppy disk.)
N NOTE N
When saving "2. TRACE DATA" and "4. NETWORK TRACE DATA", use separate floppy disks.
(2) Select the type of error log to be saved, using one of the numbers, 1 through 4. The following message appears. PLEASE SET A FD. ARE YOU SURE TO SAVE XXXXXX TO THE FD? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : (The "xxxxxx" portion indicates the type of error log to be saved.)
CAUTION
While a file is being saved, never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button because the floppy disk or floppy disk drive may be damaged.
(3) Put a floppy disk into the machine and select 1. YES. The following message appears, with all the error logs saved to the floppy disk. XXXXXXXXXX IS SAVED. (XXXXXXXXXX represents the file name.) If all the files cannot be contained in a single floppy disk, the following message appears. THE FD IS FULL. EXCHANGE OTHER ONE. 1. CONTINUE 2.CANCEL(DEFAULT=2): Additionally, type in one of the following numbers and press the [ENT] key. 1.CONTINUE Continue to write the error log file to the floppy disk. 2.CANCEL Stop writing the error log file to the floppy disk.
MU - 26
MU - 27
CONTENTS
10
MU - 28
CONTENTS
10
MU - 29
6.4
BLANK PAGE
CAUTION
While a file is being saved, never power OFF the machine because the hard disk may be damaged.
(2) Select 1. YES. Then, the following message appears. XXXXXXXXXX IS SAVED. (XXXXXXXXXX represents the file name.)
MU - 28
MU - 29
CONTENTS
10
MU - 30
CONTENTS
10
MU - 31
7.
7.1
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1202.EPS
SP
/sb0/SYSTEM/ETC/IRSET.CFG
DEL
BS
ENT
SAVE
CANCEL
Caps
FR1B1208.EPS
FR1H1502.EPS
MU - 30
MU - 31
CONTENTS
10
MU - 32
CONTENTS
10
MU - 33
(2) Touch the location to be edited. The cursor appears at the location touched.
7.2
,
SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
Of the setup items of SYSTEM, some are only supported for the IDT type (IDT connection and CR-IR348CL connection). For the machine of the IDT type, items marked by in the IDT type column shown in 7.2.1 List of Setup Items for SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) should only be set.
The cursor can be moved by touching the (3) Using a virtual keyboard, edit it.
, or key.
Display a desired virtual keyboard for entry. Three types of virtual keyboards are available; by touching the L or M key, one of the three virtual keyboards can be selected. Also, by touching the [Caps] key, the caps mode can be toggled to the lower-cap display corresponding to the three types of virtual keyboards. Using the [DEL] or [BS] key, modify the value. [DEL] key: Each time you touch this key, it erases the character located above the cursor. [BS] key: Whenever it is touched once, a character immediately before (to the left of) the cursor is deleted. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
If it is difficult to undo the editing with the [DEL] or [BS] key, touch the [CANCEL] key and repeat from step (1) all over again.
(4) Press the [SAVE] key. The edited contents are saved to the HD.
Virtual keyboard The cursor appears at the location touched.
# # IRSET.ORG/CFG # IDT=1 #1.System Type # 0:CSL / 1:IDT FNT=0 #2.FONT(LANGUAGE) # 0:JPN / 1:ENG / 2:GER / 3:FRN / 4:ESP / # 5:ITA / 6:SWE / 7:FIN / 8:DEN / 9:NOR / # 10:KOR # 7:Not Available # 10:114Y5431030(Korean Option) is necessary. IPS="172.16.0.1 " #3.IP Address(CPU90E) (Length=15)
A B C
14.SS1: Screen Save Timer 15.ITV: Time Put at Each Image Store for Accept Reprinting (E-IF) 16.CPS: The Number of Sheets of Continues Image Store (E-IF) 17.ID_EDR: Edr Mode Variation (CSL Type) 18.ID_FILING: Filing Mode 19.ID_FUNC: Function Setting (CSL Type) 20.ID_FILMC: Film Letter (CSL Type)
D E F
21.ID_BIRTH: Birthday Format (CSL Type) 22.ID_SEARCH: Search Key (CSL Type) 23.ID_LENGTH: Patient's ID Length (CSL Type) 24.ID_PADDING: Patient's ID Padding method (CSL Type) 25.RECEPT_LENGTH: Reception No. Length (CSL Type) 26. RECEPT_PADDING: Reception No. Padding method (CSL Type) 27.EXAM_LENGTH: Examination No. Length (CSL Type)
SP
28.EXAM_PADDING: Examination No. Padding method (CSL Type) 29.IFT: Reserve 30.PRO: Function Protect 31.SF1: Read Sensitivity Semi-h 32.SF2: Read Sensitivity High
/sb0/SYSTEM/ETC/IRSET.CFG
DEL
BS
ENT
SAVE
CANCEL
Caps
FR1B1203.EPS
33.GRP: Film Sorting Group Code 34.PTR: FilmChar1/MenuName Start Pointer 35.UNQ: Film Sort Unique Code 36.PCD: I/F Pixel Clock Rate for DMS 37.PCL: I/F Pixel Clock Rate for LP 38.CIM: IP Size Code Setting 39.EBK: EDR Backup Flag 40.EBA: EDR Backup Server Address (Length=15) 41.EM1,2,3,4,5: EDR Backup Menu Code (Length=4) 42.U_LP: The Following Buttons & Icon Control (FOR OEM) 43.ID_AP: Image Reversal Mode Variation (CSL Type)
(5) Back up the configuration file that has been set up. 7.13 Backing Up Configuration File (6) Press the RESET button. The machine is reset, so that the file that has been set up is effective. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
If there is any other configuration item to be set up, do not press the RESET button. The RESET button should be pressed after all the setups are finished.
MU - 32
MU - 33
CONTENTS
10
MU - 34
CONTENTS
10
MU - 35
82.DK_FILM: Print HQ Image on 14*14 film(14*14 single format) 83.DCL: Clear the distribution code when re-outputing a image 84.FCL: Put the filing switch off when re-outputing a image 85.IDNR_CB: "ID INFORMATION NOT REGISTERED" message
IDT
0: CSL 1: IDT
0: Japanese 1: English 2: German 3: French 4: Spanish 5: Italian 6: Swedish 7: Finnish 8: Danish 9: Norwegian 10: Korean
86.U_0810: User UTL 08*10 film setting Button Control 87.RST_WRT: Reset image writing from shared memory after Happend HDD Write Error 88.RST_CBC: CBC Hard Reset
FR1BA010.EPS
FNT
N NOTE N
Be sure to observe the LENGTH (digits) requirements specified for the following items. If a wrong LENGTH is used, the setup results in error, so that the machine may not operate properly. 3.IPS: IP Address (CPU90E) (Length=15) 4.IPI: IP Address (CPU90F) (Length=15) 40.EBA: EDR Backup Server Address (Length=15) 41.EM1,2,3,4,5: EDR Backup Menu Code (Length=4)
IPS
172.16.0.1
Its IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement. Its IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement. Even if the CPU90F board is not available as an option, be sure to set its IP address.
LENGTH =15
IPI
172.16.0.2
LENGTH =15
5 6 7
1 D1 5000
ID acquisition destination LAN 0: standard LAN (CPU90E) Setup of destination to which ID-T 1: option LAN (CPU90F/LAN90B) is connected. Unit code (2 characters) Unit character string (6 characters). Reader number
SID
A reader number that does not AZ duplicate within the same network should be assigned.
SFC
0: OFF 1: ON (Standard,Semi-High-Speed) 2: ON (Standard,Semi-High-Speed, High-Speed) 0: Standard 1: Semi-High-Speed 2: High-Speed 3: Menu Default (=Memory)
10
SFD
0: OFF 1: ON
It sets to determine whether to read the data on the IP in sizes smaller than the actual IP size (to implement logical reading). Overexposure handling
12
XRY
Caution: Change
TR1B1105.EPS
MU - 34
MU - 35
CONTENTS
10
MU - 36
CONTENTS
Item number
1
IDT type
10
MU - 37
Parameters Remarks
Item
RECEPT_ LENGTH
Initial value 5
Parameters
Remarks
25
13
U_MF
0: OFF 1: ON
26
RECEPT_ PADDING
SS1
When a cassette is inserted, the screen saver, even if activated, is automatically disabled. Wait time for DMS E-I/F reoutput request interrupt Consecutive storage process count for DMS E-I/F reoutput request interrupt EDR setup range
0 : Pad with space to the head (Ex." 123") 1 : Pad with zero to the head (Ex."00123") Setting of receipt number padding 2 : Pad with space to the tail scheme (Ex."123 ") 3 : Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."12300") Setting of examination number character string length 1 10: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1 16: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0 : Pad with space to the head (Ex." 1234567") 1 : Pad with zero to the head (Ex."0001234567") 2 : Pad with space to the tail (Ex."1234567 ") 3 : Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."1234567000")
TR1B1104.EPS
15
ITV
30
0-60 [sec]
27
EXAM_ LENGTH
10
16
CPS
0-10 [sheets]
28
EXAM_ PADDING
17
ID_ EDR
Used to select the display range for EDR process mode key. FILING setup range
0: AUTO, SEMI, FIX 1: AUTO, SEMI, FIX, SEMI-X 2: AUTO, SEMI, FIX, SEMI-X, MANUAL 0: DISABLE 1: OFF, ON 2: OFF, ON*, ON 0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE 0: OFF 1: ON 0: JAPANESE DATE (H10.04.01) 1: ANSI LONG DATE (1998.APR.01) 2: ANSI SHORT DATE (1998.04.01) 3: AMERICAN LONG DATE (APR.01.1998) 4: AMERICAN SHORT DATE (04.01.1998) 5: EUROPEAN LONG DATE (01.APR.1998) 6: EUROPEAN SHORT DATE (01.04.1998)
18
19 20
0 0
21
ID_ BIRTH
Used to select either ID number, receipt number, or examination number to be displayed as a search key during connection with HIS.
Setting of ID number character string length
23
ID_ LENGTH
10
1 10: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1 64: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0: Pad with space to the head (Ex." 1234567") 1: Pad with zero to the head (Ex."0001234567") 2: Pad with space to the tail (Ex."1234567 ") 3: Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."1234567000")
TR1B1106.EPS
24
ID_ PADDING
MU - 36
MU - 37
CONTENTS
10
MU - 38
CONTENTS
3
Initial value Space Space Space Space Space 1
10
MU - 39
Remarks
LENGTH=4 LENGTH=4 LENGTH=4 LENGTH=4 LENGTH=4
Setup description Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 OEM printer setting
Parameters Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. 0: OFF 1: ON 0: L-R reversal 1: T-B reversal 2: L-R,T-B reversal 3: L-R reversal/90-deg.Rotation 4: L-R,T-B reversal/90-deg.Rotation
0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE
0: <org root>.2.0.<Private Image UID'> (IDT Type) 0: <org root>.2.1.<MAC Address>. <Time Stamp>.<Unique ID> (CSL Type) 1: <org root>.2.1.<Accesion Number'> 2: <org root>.2.2 .<Study Date + Modality(CR)> .<Accesion Number'> 3: <org root>.2.3 .<Study Date + Modality(CR)> .<Patient ID'> 4: <org root>.2.4 .<Study Date> .<Patient ID'2> .<Requesting Service'>
IDT type
Item
IFT
Initial value
0
Parameters
41 41 41 41 41 42
30
PRO
NONE TS (Temporary subtraction) ES (Energy subtraction) MS (Multilayer tomography) MX (Multi-integrated processing) WS (Whole spine) Function image protect PS (IVP) (image protect on HIC) TM (Tomography) TX (Temporary subtraction, Use to set the type of screen overall processing) that enables the screen protection 9: WX (Whole spine, overall function of HI-C. processing) 10: EX (Energy subtraction, overall processing) 11: AS (Inter-image operation) 99: ALL Sensitivity median shift 1 (relatively high sensitivity) Sensitivity median shift 2 (high sensitivity) 0 299 0 299 0: space (10) 1: space (2) + department name (8) 2: department name (4) + menu (6) 3: department name (4) + film mark (6) 4: unit code (1) + space (9) 5: space (4) + MPM (4) + space (2) 6: space (4) + film mark (6) 7: department name (4) + MPM (4) + space (2) 0 F (hexadecimal notation) No change required. No change required.
0: 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: 8:
No change required.
43
ID_AP
31 32
SF1 SF2
50 100
44
ID_DST
45
33
GRP
UID_STI
Indent
Setting used to issue study information for QA-DICOM output. Used to customize, on a hospitalby-hospital basis, how to bind images per study on the QA side
34
PTR
Position of film mark or menu character string outputted with GRP (valid when GRP = 2, 3, 6)
Indent
Default setting of image processing density Used to designate the machines default processing density. This setting is effective only when a setting other than 0 or 1 is registered from IDT3 or the like (in cases where IDT3, which cannot designate the 0: Standard Density processing density, is connected via 1: High Quality Density IDT4, or where the processing density is not designated due to a software bug of IDT4). Normally, the value that is set on the IDT side or by the internal menu of the CSL type is effective, so its initial value need not be changed.
35
UNQ
Indent
DEF_ DENSITY
36 37
PCD PCL
1 0
0: 1 sec 1: 2 sec 0: 1 sec (< 60m) 1: 2 sec (> 60m) It should be set according to the processing at the DMS.
46
38
CIM
DMS output code selection when "inch" and "metric" physical sizes differ
0: Inch 1: Metric
39
EBK
Selection of a menu to transmit EDR backup information to the IP address that is set with EBA
0: OFF (not transmitted) 1: MENU (menu selected with EM is selected) 2: Full (all menus) Transfer destination IP address The IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement.
47
JSTFY
40
EBA
...
Transfer destination IP address for the transmission of EDR backup data through a network The transmission port is fixed at 90E.
LENGTH =15
<Variable part> 0: Left justified; 1: Right justified <Corresponding to each digit of the variable part> a: Patient ID b: Patient name c: Exposure menu name d: Examination number e: Department name (alphanumeric) f-l: Reserved (default: left justified) m-p: Reserved (default: right justified)
N NOTE N
TR1B1009.EPS
TR1B1008.EPS
Be sure to observe the length (number of digits) specified for the following items. If the length (number of digits) is wrong, a setting error occurs so that the machine may fail to properly operate. 40. EBA: EDR Backup Server Address (Length = 15 including a dot (.)) 41. EM1, EM2, EM3, EM4, and EM5: EDR Backup Menu Code (Length = 4)
009-051-10 03.20.2004 FM4275
MU - 38
MU - 39
CONTENTS
Item number
10
MU - 40
Parameters Remarks No change required except for USA No change required except for USA
CONTENTS
Item number
1
IDT type
10
MU - 41
Parameters/Remarks
IDT type
Item
Initial value
Setup description
Item
Initial value
48
HQ_ FUNC
HQ function setting
0: disabled; 1: enabled
57
EXAM
49
0: disabled; 1: enabled
58
L2430
0: Pantomo size (15x30 cm) reading disabled 1: Pantomo size (15x30 cm) reading enabled
50
0: Stand. 1: Long
59
ID_ EXAM
CSL-type examination number display setting CSL-type department name display setting
51
0: CP850 1: ISO8859-1 0: Blank screen (Screen saver is disabled) 1: Pictures (Multiple pictures are displayed at regular intervals.) 0: Pad with space to the head (EX." 1234") 1: Pad with zero to the head (EX."00001234") 2: Pad with space to the tail (EX."1234 ") 3: Pad with zero to the tail (EX."12340000")
60
61
CSL-type department name character count setting CSL-type communication message character string length setting during ID online
1- 8: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1-64: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0: Maximum length of send/receive message characters is 128 bytes 1: Maximum length of send/receive message characters is 256 bytes
52
SSS
62
MES_ LENGTH
53
DST_ PADDING
63
SCS
Character code of special symbols 0: ISO-IR 6 (ISO646) with UK/US language setting (FNT=1) 1: ISO-IR 100 (ISO8859-1) (Only for Base on DICOM setting) Setting for converting patient name components from FINP to DICOM Setting of delimiter for patient name components in FINP (patient name in languages other than Japanese) Setting of delimiter for patient name components in FINP (patient name in Japanese language) 0: Not converted 1: Converted 0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," 0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix
TR1B1108.EPS
64
PN_CS
54
ENV
CR-IR341
Machine type display switching setting 0: The patient ID is automatically cleared when the cassette is set or when the menu select key is pressed, and the patient information is acquired from the online destination. 1: The patient ID is cleared when it is necessary to change the patient ID, and the patient information is acquired from the online destination. <CSL type> 0: Study/Series information is not numbered on the reader side. 1: Study/Series information is numbered on the reader side. <IDT type> 0: Study/Series information is not numbered on the IDT side. 1: Study/Series information is numbered on the IDT side.
TR1B1107.EPS
65
PN_FDS
66
PN_FDM
55
ID_ RET
67
PN_ FCS1
"F"
68
PN_ FCS2
"FG"
56
UID
MU - 40
MU - 41
CONTENTS
Item number
1
IDT type
10
MU - 41.1
Parameters/Remarks
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.2
Parameters/Remarks
Item
Initial value
Setup description
Item
Initial value
Setup description
69
PN_ FCS3
"FGM"
F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix 0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix 0: Type 1 (old type: LUT = linear) 1: Type 2 (new type: LUT = nonlinear; change in standardized image display mode) 0: BCR5242-STB (DENSEI)(~#5000) 1: NFT7175/F01RL (OPTOELECTRONICS)(#5001~)
82
DK_ FILM
Setting to specify whether or not to output an HQ image in a single format to 14" x 14" film
0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE
70
PN_ FCS4
"FGMP"
83
DCL
Setting to specify whether or not to clear the "distribution code" at the time of image retransmission
71
PN_ FCS5
"FGMPS"
84
FCL
Setting to specify whether or not to turn OFF the "filing option" at the time of image retransmission
72
PN_ FCM1
"F"
85
IDNR_ CB
Setting to specify whether or not 0: Displays the forced continuation key. to display the forced continuation 1: Does not display the forced continuation key for the unregistered ID window key.
73
PN_ FCM2
"FG"
86
U_ 0810
74
PN_ FCM3
"FGM"
Setting to specify whether or not to display the 8" x 10" film reduced 0: NO output setup button in the U-Utility 1: YES menu screen Setting to specify whether or not to write the image data in the shared memory into the HDD when the system has shut down due to a 046X error.
75
PN_ FCM4
"FGMP"
87
RST_ WRT
0: Does not write the image data into the HDD when restarting. 1: Writes the image data into the HDD when restarting. 0: Retries another HDD access without forcibly resetting the CBC. 1: Retries another HDD access with the CBC forced to be reset. * This function is effective only with a machine incorporating the MTH board which can forcibly reset the CBC. MTH08D board: Of versions B or later MTH08A board: Of versions E or later
TR1B2005.EPS
76
PN_ FCM5
"FGMPS"
88
RST_ CBC
77
PN_DD
Setting to specify whether or not to forcibly reset the CBC (data controller LSI mounted on the MTH08 board) when HDD access timeout (104X error) occurs.
78
PN_DC
"FGMPS"
79
MON
80
BCR
81
FLMW
Setting to determine whether to 0: No (output instruction is reserved without display a window that requests the displaying a window) user to replace the film tray, 1: Yes (window displayed) when DRY PIX is used
TR1B1109.EPS
MU - 41.1
MU - 41.2
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.3
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.4
G 10. SFD (default value used when manual sensitivity setting is enabled)
The default value is switched when manual sensitivity setting is enabled in 9. SFC. 0: Standard 1: Semi-High-Speed 2: High-Speed 3: Menu Default (The content previously selected in the menu is stored in memory.)
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Screen saver: In order to protect burning of the operation panel screen, this function turns OFF the screen after a certain period of time has elapsed with no user operation.
G 18. ID_FILING (selection menu for image resolution during OD-F filing)
The menu for selecting the image resolution during OD-F filing is switched. 0: DISABLE (always saved in high resolution) 1: OFF/ON selectable 2: OFF/ON*/ON ON*: The HQ image is reduced to the standard before transmission. ON: The image is transmitted without reduction. For example, the HQ image is transmitted as is.
MU - 41.3
MU - 41.4
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.5
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.6
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If the long type format is used with ID online, the host needs to support information type C.
G 51. ID_CODE_SET (acceptable character set for the CSL-type magnetic card and during ID online)
It should be set according to the character code used for the patient ID. CP850: Character code specified by IBM. It includes special characters (such as umlaut) used in Europe.
G 56. UID (Study/Series information numbering setting): Software version A10 or later
If the Study/Series information is not numbered on the IDT, or no numbering is performed, it is set to determine whether the Study/Series information is to be numbered or not on the machine. 0 : Numbering is not performed on the machine. 1 (default value): Numbering is performed on the machine (according to the format that is set in 45. UID_STI). If numbering is performed on the IDT, the Study/Series information numbered on the IDT is effective anyway.
MU - 41.5
MU - 41.6
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.7
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.8
PN_FCS4: If there are four components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, and Prefix. Assume that the patient name is Rev. John M Smith Ph. D.. Then, if Smith John M Rev. Ph. D. is entered, Smith is interpreted as Family name, John as Given name, M as Middle name, and Rev. as Prefix (when the delimiter is a half-width space). PN_FCS5: If there are five components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, Prefix, and Suffix. Assume that the patient name is Rev. John M Smith Ph. D.. Then, if Smith John M Rev. Ph. D. is entered, Smith is interpreted as Family name, John as Given name, M as Middle name, Rev. as Prefix, and Ph. D. as Suffix (when the delimiter is a half-width space). PN_FCM1=F PN_FCM2=FG PN_FCM3=FGM PN_FCM4=FGMP PN_FCM5=FGMPS PN_FCM1 through PN_FCM5 set components of a name (double-byte). If PN_FCM1 through PN_FCM5 are set as described above, they are defined as follows. PN_FCM1: If there is only one component, it is interpreted as Family name. PN_FCM2: If there are two components, they are interpreted as Family name and Given name. PN_FCM3: If there are three components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, and Middle name. PN_FCM4: If there are four components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, and Prefix. PN_FCM5: If there are five components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, Prefix, and Suffix. PN_DD=1 [change prohibited] It defines the delimiter for the patient name when DICOM output is generated. PN_DD=FGMPS [change prohibited] It defines the arrangement of the components of the patient name when DICOM output is generated.
G "86. U_0810"
Enables you to let the U-Utility menu screen display the setup button for specifying whether or not to permit the 8" x 10" film output to reduce in size.
G "87.RST_WRT"
Specifies whether or not to write the image data in the shared memory into the HDD when the system has shut down due to the 046X error.
N NOTES N
Be sure to press the reset switch to restart the machine after the system has shut down due to an image data write error. If the circuit breaker is inadvertently turned OFF and then turned ON to restart, correct image data cannot be written.
Circuit breaker
Do not change the DICOM interface board (CPU90F board, LAN90D board) and the LP interface board (IMG08A board) when the machine is to be restarted after the system has shut down due to an image data write error. If the DICOM interface board (CPU90F board, LAN90D board) and the LP interface board (IMG08A board) are changed, mapping in the shared memory is changed, and as a result the correct image data cannot be written.
MU - 41.7
MU - 41.8
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.9
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.10
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
ID information or EDR data other than the image data is backed up in the HDD DOS region when the image data write error occurs. If the data cannot be backed up in the HDD DOS region, the image data cannot be written again even if the machine is restarted.
G 88.RST_CBC
Specifies whether to retry the HDD access without forcibly resetting the CBC or to retry the HDD access after forcibly resetting the CBC when the HDD access timeout (104X error) occurs.
I Items that Should be Changed for Second and Subsequent Machines G 3. IPS: Standard LAN IP address
IP addresses that are not duplicated within the same network should be assigned.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The CBC refers to the data controller LSI mounted on the MTH08 board.
N NOTE N
The CBC forcible resetting function is effective only with a machine incorporating the MTH board which can forcibly reset the CBC. MTH08D board: Of versions B or later MTH08A board: Of versions E or later
MU - 41.9
MU - 41.10
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.11
CONTENTS
10
MU - 41.12
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MU - 41.11
MU - 41.12
CONTENTS
10
MU - 42
CONTENTS
10
MU - 43
7.3
PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG)
Settings are common both to the IDT type (IDT connection and CR-IR348CL connection) and CSL type.
BF EF IF CF ET HN
1 1 1 1 1 FUJI FILM HOSPITAL 9578 8E6D 8374 8343 838B 8380 9561 8940 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 1 0 1 7 0
2 3 4 5 6
60Char
HP
8 9 10 11 12
GF GJ MF A1 A2
0: NO 1: YES 0: NO 1: YES
Indent
Menu character string display switching Upper-limit age in years for age display in months Upper-limit age in months for age display in days Trimming amount (mammo)
0: NO 1: YES 0 99 0 12
13
TH
0.0
The trimming amount (mammo) for four sides of the IP image in HR is set.
N NOTE N
Be sure to observe the LENGTH (digits) requirements specified for the following items. If a wrong LENGTH is used, the setup results in error, so that the machine may not operate properly. 6.HN: Institution name (Max Length=60) 7.HP: 2 byte code character (Japanese, Korean) Institution name (Max Length=30)
14 TE 0
0 25 (mm)
15
CL
0: JAPANESE DATE (H10.04.01) 1: ANSI LONG DATE (1998.APR.01) 2: ANSI SHORT DATE (1998.04.01) 3: AMERICAN LONG DATE (APR.01.1998) 4: AMERICAN SHORT DATE (04.01.1998) 5: EUROPEAN LONG DATE (01.APR.1998) 6: EUROPEAN SHORT DATE (01.04.1998)
TR1B1010.EPS
MU - 42
MU - 43
CONTENTS
Item number
10
MU - 44
Parameters Remarks
CONTENTS
Item number
10
MU - 45
Remarks
Item
Initial value
Setup description
Item
Initial value
Setup description Position rotation designation for 14" x 17" (35 x 43cm) areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for landscape 14" x 17" (35 x 43cm) areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for 1843 areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for 8"x10" areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for landscape 8"x10" areas 0 and 1 Position rotation designation for 14x14 areas 0 and 1 Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas.
Parameters
16
AB
35
0010
35
1131
Specifies the area position and rotation with four digits (abcd). a = Area 0 position 0: upper left, 1: upper right; 2: lower left; 3: lower right b = Area 0 rotation 0: No; 1: Yes c = Area 1 position 0: upper left, 1: upper right; 2: lower left; 3: lower right d = Area 1 rotation 0: No; 1: Yes
17
FR1
0: NO 1: YES
35
0010
18 19
FR2 FR4
0 0
0: NO 1: YES 0: NO 1: YES
35
0010
35
1131 0010 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901
0020: 0317
Compression ratio display switching 20 CR 0 Used to determine whether the compression ratio for the image for reoutput is display. 0: NO 1: YES
35
36
FC1
21
MM
0: image information dependent (default = transparent margin) 1: image information dependent (default = black margin) 2: fixed to transparent margin 3: fixed to black margin
Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", . . . MPM1 MPM2 MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image output is to be Area position rotation designation: generated on 14" x 17", . . . MPM1 MPM2 MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid only when an Area position rotation designation: image output is to be MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 generated on 8" x 10" film. Valid only when an Area position rotation designation: image output is to be MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 generated on 8" x 10" film.
36
FC2
22 23
SG HG
0 0
14x17/14x14 magnification mode 14x17 single character size on 14x17/14x14 film DR compression enabled/disabled for reoutput
0: NO (Normal) 1: YES (Magnify) 0: Standard 1: Large 0: Depending on Image "1" cannot Information be used. 1: Depending on System Setting
0: NO 1: YES (""or"R-reverse") 2: YES ("AP"or"PA") 0: both displayed 1: Only area 1 displayed 2: Only area 2 displayed 3: not displayed 2 - 500 (0.1mm) 2 - 268 (0.1mm) 2 - 458 (0.1mm) 2 - 230 (0.1mm) 2 - 980 (0.1mm) 2 - 268 (0.1mm) 2 - 668 (0.1mm) 2 - 236 (0.1mm)
TR1B1011.EPS
36
FC3
24
OS
36
FC4
Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. "Ene.-Sub." parameter/PEM parameter output.
25
RF
36
FC5
26
CE
36
FC6
1030: ?3??
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34
Horizontal size for standard size area 0 Vertical size for standard size area 0 Horizontal size for standard size area 1 Vertical size for standard size area 1 Horizontal size for large size area 0 Vertical size for large size area 0 Horizontal size for large size area 1 Vertical size for large size area 1
37
EM
0: NO 1: YES (Ene.-Sub.) 2: YES (PEM) 0: NO 1: YES 0: NO (FCR9000 compatible) 1: YES Check for necessity to display this item before it is set. Supported by A05 or later; supported only for 15*30, 35*35, and 43*43.
38
IN
39
IM
FCR9000-compatible format support setting for 14"x14" 100% magnification/pantomo Use of long type format
40
LTC
41
XXXX: XXXX XXXX FRSC XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX
TR1B1012.EPS
MU - 44
MU - 45
CONTENTS
Item number
10
MU - 45.1
Remarks
CONTENTS
10
MU - 45.2
BLANK PAGE
Item Initial value Setup description Setting to specify whether or not to print out a radiologist name. Setting to specify whether or not to print out a pixel spacing. Changing the font size for the requesting department name Parameters
42 43
TN PS
0 0
0: Does not print out a radiologist name. Unalterable 1: Prints out a radiologist name. 0: Does not print out a pixel spacing. 1: Prints out a pixel spacing. 0: Does not change the font size. 1: Generates a film output with the font size enlarged.
TR1B2006.EPS
44
RS
MU - 45.1
MU - 45.2
CONTENTS
10
MU - 45.3
CONTENTS
10
MU - 45.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MU - 45.3
MU - 45.4
CONTENTS
10
MU - 46
CONTENTS
10
MU - 47
G 6. HN (institution name)
Institution name displayed when 2. FNT of SYSTEM is set to other than 0 (Japanese).
G 41. FRSC (setting of film output with frame/without ruler): Software version A10 or later
Used to determine whether to output film with frame/without ruler. It is set by the MPM code. Up to eight MPM codes may be set. However, if without frame is set in FRT1/FR2/ FR4, the resulting film output is without frame/without ruler. Only when with frame is set in FRT1/FR2/FR4, the setting defined in FRSC is effective. Setup example 1) FRSC= 0000 0200 XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With MPM codes of 0000 and 0200 only, the film output is with frame/without ruler. Setup example 2) FRSC= ???? XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With all the MPM codes, the film output is with frame/without ruler. Setup example 3) FRSC= 020? XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With MPM codes of 0200-020F only, the film output is with frame/without ruler.
MU - 46
MU - 47
CONTENTS
10
MU - 48
CONTENTS
10
MU - 49
G Area 0
The hospital name, patient name, sex, patient ID, age or birth date, exposure date, exposure time, set processing information, and department name are indicated. Example)
XXXXX XXXXX [ X] 7901900000 2 Hospital name Patient name Sex, patient ID, age Exposure date, exposure time
CSY0
Area 0
CSY1
Area 1
FR1B1245.EPS
XXXXX -A000000
For the large size, it is designated with 31. CLX0, 32. CLY0, 33. CLX1, and 34. CLY1.
CLX0 CLX1
G Area 1
The IP number, EDR mode/menu code, system ID/image number, image condition, normalization condition, correction item, engineer code, exposure bed information, and compression code are indicated. Example)
Gradation processing IP number EDR mode Menu code System ID Image number Frequency processing
Position 0
CLY0
Area 0
CLY1
Area 1
FR1B1246.EPS
No rotation
80KV10mAs XX: 22
Position 2
Position 3
Definition of position
Definition of rotation
FR1B1241.EPS
MU - 48
MU - 49
CONTENTS
10
MU - 50
CONTENTS
10
MU - 51
With items 36. FC1 through 36. FC4 of Film Setup, four types of area displays may be set. For each of the types, up to eight MPM codes may be set. For image data with MPM code that is not set, the setting of 35. FD1417 is used (for 14"x17").
7.4
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
A wildcard ? may be used for one letter of a MPM code that may be set with items FC1 through FC4. ? denotes any letter, from 0 to F. Example) 123? Represents a MPM code, from 1230 to 123F.
G How to set up
Position/rotation definition MPM code (Up to eight codes may be set)
Position for area 1 (0: upper left, 1: upper right, 2: lower left, 3: lower right)
FR1B1242.EPS
Setup example) FC1=0031:0123 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 789A
Area 0
Area 0 = position (0), rotation disabled (0) Area 1 = position (3), 90 rotation enabled (1)
FR1B1247.EPS
Area 1
MU - 50
MU - 51
CONTENTS
10
MU - 52
CONTENTS
10
MU - 53
7.5
7.6
EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
It sets to determine which HOST is requested to process filing function, display function, print function, and ID information acquisition function.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Intelligent hub: A hub that complies with SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol).
I Format
Function HostName ( HostName . . . )
I Format
denotes a space. IP address,root,parameter
G Function (function)
Function requested for the host that is set in HostName (host name). OD_FILE DISPLAY PRINT IDT NOPK NOPK 1000 0000 Filing function Display function Print function ID information acquisition function
G Parameter
When ON When OFF
denotes a space.
I Setup Example
REMOTE SWITCH is set to ON. An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
| | | | | | | | | | |
It should be noted that the setup for HostName (host name) is as follows. LOCAL A host connected over an E-I/F or serial line. It is designated when direct connection is to be established. LOCAL_S A host connected over an E-I/F or serial line. It is designated when direct connection is to be established. Note, however, that high-resolution data transfer is not supported. LOCAL_R It is designated when print output is to be provided only during reoutput, without generating printout during reading. During reading, images are transferred only to the HIC/QA-WS, where image checks/ adjustments are performed, and then they are routed from the HIC/QA-WS, to the CR-IR341, and to the printer for reoutput.
NNOTE N
No output can be generated directly to the printer from the CR-IR341 where LOCAL_R setting is made.
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
MU - 52
MU - 53
CONTENTS
10
MU - 54
CONTENTS
10
MU - 55
Host name that is set in the HOSTS file A network-connected host. It is designated when network connection is to be established. 7.9 HOST ADDRESS (HOSTS)
7.7
I Setup Example
OD_FILE DISPLAY PRINT IDT Network-connected to odf624. Network connections to hic654 and hic655 (multiple connections) LOCAL connection and network-connected to fn-ps551. Network-connected to fcridt4-1 and fcridt4-2.
N NOTE N
Only when CR-LP414N/FL-IM2636N or FL-IM3543N is connected to CR-IR341 (A07 or later) (including cases where it is connected as a backup printer), the setup value for N1 in the 2. LIF: siosetup.lp file should be changed from 005 to 010.
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
| | | | | | | | |
Host Name [Host Name]... = OD_FILE or DISPLAY or PRINT or IDT odf624 hic654 hic655 LOCAL fn-ps551 fcridt4-1 fcridt4-2
| | | | | | | | |
| | | | | | |
Host Name [Host Name]... = OD_FILE or DISPLAY or PRINT or IDT iip-1, iip-2 iip-1
| | | | | | |
MU - 54
MU - 55
CONTENTS
10
MU - 56
CONTENTS
10
MU - 57
7.8
I Format
HostName : Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed]
G Attr (attribute)
One of the following should be designated. Multiple attributes can be designated by delimiting them by |. PRINT HD_FILE DISPLAY OD_FILE Film output enabled Active file enabled Display function Archive file enabled
| | | | | | | | | | |
# # DEVICE # # Host Name:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed] # Attr = PRINT or HD_FILE or DISPLAY or OD_FILE # Protocol ID = 0100(FINP) or 0110(FINP) or 0200(DICOM) # System code = Hex 2 figures # Speed = Dec [Kbytes/sec] (default 8Kbytes/sec) hic654:DISPLAY|HD_FILE,0100,, odf624:OD_FILE,0100,, fn-ps551:PRINT,0100,,
| | | | | | | | | | |
If it is necessary to use the image processing exclusive selection flag, the protocol identification number needs to be set to either 0100, 0110, or 0200.
| | | | | | | | |
# # DEVICE # # Host Name:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed] # Attr = PRINT or HD_FILE or DISPLAY or OD_FILE # Protocol ID = 0100(FINP) or 0110(FINP) or 0200(DICOM) # System code = Hex 2 figures # Speed = Dec [Kbytes/sec] (default 8Kbytes/sec) iip: DISPLAY|HD_FILE,0200,,
| | | | | | | | |
MU - 56
MU - 57
CONTENTS
10
MU - 58
CONTENTS
10
MU - 59
7.9
I Setup Example
CR-IR341 IDT-IV HI-C OD-F FN-PS551 2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 2 units
I Format
IP Addr Host Name
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
denotes a space.
N NOTES N
To one CR-IR341 machine, be sure to assign both a standard LAN IP address (CPU90E) and a LAN board IP address (CPU90F/LAN90B). Example) 172.16.0.1 fcr5000a ... CR-IR341#1 (CPU90E) 172.16.0.2 fcr5000a-1 ... CR-IR341#1 (CPU90F/LAN90B) Be sure to match the standard LAN IP address (CPU90E) and LAN board IP address (CPU90F) to the IP addresses set in item No. 3 IPS and item No. 4 IPI of SYSTEM: IRSET.CFG, respectively.
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | |
# # HOSTS # # Host Name = Max 10 characters #(Available Character:a-z 0-9' -[37chars]) # IP Addr Host Name 172.16.0.1 fcr5000a 172.16.0.2 fcr5000a-1 172.16.0.11 fcr5000b 172.16.0.12 fcr5000b-1 172.16.0.21 fcridt4-1 172.16.0.22 fcridt4-2 172.16.0.101 hic654 172.16.0.102 odf624 172.16.0.103 fn-ps551
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | |
N NOTES N
If any alphabet is used in a host name, be sure to use lowercase letters. The initial letter of a host name should always be a lowercase alphabet.
| | | | | | | |
# # HOSTS # # Host Name = Max 10 characters #(Available Character:'a'-'z' '0'-'9' '-'[37chars]) # IP Addr Host Name 172.16.0.1 fcr5000 172.16.0.2 fcr5000-n 172.16.1.20 CRxxxxxxxx
| | | | | | | | |
MU - 58
MU - 59
CONTENTS
10
MU - 60
CONTENTS
10
MU - 61
I Format
Code Host Name ( HostName . . . )
denotes a space.
I Setup Example
The distribution code is set. HI-C AA0123?? An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
MU - 60
MU - 61
CONTENTS
10
MU - 62
CONTENTS
10
MU - 63
I Format
HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType],[CompType],[Timeout1], [Timeout2],[DensityType]
I Format
Network netmask
G HostName
Enter the host name that is defined by HOSTS or DEVICE.
denotes a space.
G ServiceName
Set STORAGE_U, for the local machine and STORAGE_P for the CL.
G AEName
Set the DICOM standard Application Entity name (consisting of up to 16 ASCII characters).
G PortNo.
Set the TCP port number that the Base-on-DICOM application uses. This entry is meaningless for the transmitting end. The default setting is 104.
The narrower the range of the network number portion, the greater portion may be handled as the host number (the greater for classes C, B, and A in this order). Thus, more host addresses (IP addresses) may be assigned within the same network (that is, a larger network may be implemented).
G Timeout1
Set the timeout time (in seconds) for the TCP socket connect/recv command.
N NOTE N
If the networks for the CPU90E and CPU90F are the same, the same net mask should be set for both. If the CPU90F is not available, the net mask for the CPU90F is left on its default, regardless of its setting value.
G Timeout2
Set the timeout time (in seconds) for one-image transfer.
I Setup Example
Network netmask 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0
G DensityType
Set the output density for each output destination unit. 1 should always be set.
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
| | | | | | |
# # Network masks database # # only non-default subnet masks need to be defined here # # Network netmask 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0
| | | | | | |
MU - 62
MU - 63
CONTENTS
10
MU - 64
CONTENTS
10
MU - 65
I Setup Example
The following example (bolded entry portion) shows how to enter the DICOM settings.
CAUTIONS
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | # # DICOM # # HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType], # [CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2],[DensityType] # HostName = Host name defined by hosts & device # ServiceName = STORAGE_U or # AEName # # # # (Max 16 ascii characters) Dicom application(100:default). 1:Fuji Private,2:OEM Private 0:No(Implicit little endian),1:JPEG STORAGE_P = Application Entity Name defined by DICOM | | | | | | | | | | | | |
1
Read
Never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button during file saving. The FD or FD drive may be damaged. Once a setup file is edited, be sure to reset the machine after exiting M-Utility.
(1) Put a backup floppy disk into the floppy disk drive. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
Deleting images waiting for processing Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction
# PortNo. = TCP Port Number connected to # SOPType = SOP Class Type # CompType = Compression Type # Timeout1 = connect/recv command Timeout [sec](0:endless) # Timeout2 = Every Image Trans. Timeout [sec](0:endless) # DensityType = Output Image Density # # # 0:Standard Density 1:Standard Density or High Quality Density ex) ,STORAGE_U :DPR_DICOM,,2,1,100,600,1
Date/time setup
| | | | | | | | | | | | |
: Area to be touched U-Utility button Menu selecting icon
Click sound
2 3 4
CRT test pattern display
FD operation
Utility
Return
M-Utility screen
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING
A B C
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1086.EPS
MU - 64
MU - 65
CONTENTS
10
MU - 65.1
CONTENTS
10
MU - 65.2
0.QUIT 1.FORMAT FD 2.FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION 3.BACK UP 4.RESTORE 5.EDR DATA 6.PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE 7.EXECUTION FUT> 3 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA 2.CONFIGURATION DATA 3.NETWORK DATA 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA 5.CSL MENU DATA FUT:RES>3
SP
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
Caps
FR1B1200.EPS
FR1B1225.EPS
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) HOSTS ADDRESS (HOST) DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ROUTING (ROUTE) NETMASKS (NETMASKS) DICOM (DICOM)
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
(7) Select 0. QUIT repeatedly. The screen returns to the U-Utility mode.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1214.EPS
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG,IRSET.ORG) PRINT (FILFMT.CFG,FILFMT.ORG) IRSTATUS (IRSTATUS.CFG,IRSTATUS.ORG)
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
MU - 65.1
MU - 65.2
CONTENTS
10
MU - 65.3
CONTENTS
10
MU - 65.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
MU - 65.3
MU - 65.4
CONTENTS
10
MU - 66
CONTENTS
10
MU - 67
I Setup Example 1
Two units of the IDT-IV are connected to the CPU90E board of the machine via a 10Base-T hub. The OD-F624, HI-C654 and FN-PS551 are connected to the CPU90F board of the machine via a 10Base-T hub. The machine and FL-IMD are connected via the E-i/f (IMG08A). The host is temporarily connected (including virtual equipment). The Hostname of each CR unit installed at a hospital, including the CR-IR341 itself, should be registered so that the configuration file can easily copied and restored to other units. A example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
G EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
| | | | | | | | | # # EQUIP # # Function Host Name [Host Name]... # Function = OD_FILE or DISPLAY or PRINT or IDT OD_FILE odf624 DISPLAY hic654 PRINT LOCAL fn-ps551 IDT fcridt4-1 fcridt4-2 | | | | | | | | |
G DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB)
| | | | | # # Codedstb # # Code Host Name [HostName]... AA0123?? hic654 | | | | |
MU - 66
MU - 67
CONTENTS
10
MU - 68
CONTENTS
10
MU - 69
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
| | | | | | | | # # # Network masks database # # only non-default subnet masks need to be defined here # # Network netmask 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0 | | | | | | | |
N NOTES N
The HCP08A board (optional) and CPU90F board (optional) must be installed in the control rack. The Fuji Base-on-DICOM option software must be installed.
G SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
For 2. IPS and 3. IPI, set appropriate IP addresses. For 45. UID_STI, set an appropriate examination instance user ID.
G EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
Set the transfer destination QA-WS host name (qa-ws1) as the DISPLAY attribute. To deliver the re-output from the QA-WS to the printer instead of directly delivering the output from the image reader to the printer, set LOCAL_R as the PRINT attribute.
| | |
# DISPLAY PRINT
qa-ws1 LOCAL_R
| | |
| |
# qa-ws1:DISPLAY,0200,,
| |
| | |
# 172.16.0.100 172.16.0.200
fcr5000n-1 qa-ws1
| | |
G ROUTING (ROUTE)
If the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader is not within the same network, set the IP address of the router that serves as the exit of the local network. If the destination image reader is within the same network, this setting is not required.
MU - 68
MU - 69
CONTENTS
10
MU - 70
CONTENTS
10
MU - 71
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
If the transfer destination QA-WS is not within the same network, set the subnet mask. If the transfer destination QA-WS is within the same network, there is no need to make this entry again.
I Setup Example 3: Printer Output Setup for Each Network Connection N NOTE N
The HCP08A board (optional) and CPU90F board (optional) must be installed in the control rack.
Perform network-specific printer output setup as indicated below.
G SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
For 2. IPS and 3. IPI, set appropriate IP addresses.
HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType],[CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2],[DensityType] HostName Enter the host name that is defined by HOSTS or DEVICE. ServiceName Set STORAGE_U for the local machine and STORAGE_P for the QA-WS. AEName Set the DICOM standard Application Entity name (consisting of up to 16 ASCII characters). PortNo. Set the TCP port number that the Base-on-DICOM application uses. This entry is meaningless for the transmitting end. The default setting is 104. SOPType (SOP Class Type definition) Although two options are selectable (1: FINP; 2: OEM), choose 1. CompType (image data compression definition) Although two options are selectable (0: no compression; 1: JPEG compression), choose 1. Timeout1 Set the timeout time (in seconds) for the TCP socket connect/recv command. Timeout2 Set the timeout time (in seconds) for one-image transfer. DensityType Set the output density for each output destination unit. 1 should always be set. The following example (bolded entry portion) shows how to enter the above settings. | | | | | | | | | | | | # # DICOM # # HostName,ServiceName:AEName, [PortNo.],[SOPType], # [CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2], # [DensityType] # # ServiceName = STORAGE_U | STORAGE_P | QR_U # | QR_P | PRINT_U | PRINT_P # fcr5000n-1,STORAGE_U :5000_DICOM,,1,1,100,600,1 qa-ws1,STORAGE_P :hic655qa-scp,5045,1,1,100,600,1 | | | | | | | | | | | |
G EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
Set the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader host name as the PRINT attribute. Note that only one 5000 Series image reader unit can be added.
| |
LOCAL
fcr5000n-2
| |
| |
# fcr5000n-2:PRINT,0100,,
| |
| |
# 172.16.0.100
fcr5000n-2
| |
G ROUTING (ROUTE)
If the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader is not within the same network, set the IP address of the router that serves as the exit of the local network. If the destination image reader is within the same network, this setting is not required.
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
If the transfer destination QA-WS is not within the same network, set the subnet mask. If the transfer destination QA-WS is within the same network, there is no need to make this entry again.
MU - 70
MU - 71
CONTENTS
10
MU - 72
CONTENTS
10
MU - 73
8.
N NOTE N
When 2. AUTO MODE is selected, be sure to set the operation mode of routine processing (1. ROUTINE) before executing the routine processing. If the routine processing is executed without this setting, operation error may result.
(1) Select 3. TEST MODE. (2) Select 2. AUTO MODE. The operation modes are displayed. (3) Select 3. SECONDARY ERASURE. A prompt asking you to enter the number of times appears. (4) Enter 5 (the number of times it is executed). (5) Select 0. QUIT to return to the U-Utility screen. (6) Touch the RETURN button. The mode returns to the routine screen. (7) Put the cassette into the machine. IPs are conveyed the number of times that was set in step (4).
8.1
8.2
I 2. PRIMARY ERASURE
The image is read to detect the dosage on the IP, and IP erasure is performed according to the dosage. The image so read is not outputted because the objective of this mode is to detect the amount of erasure for the IP. This mode is used when it is not necessary to test the image reading function but the image on the IP used for conveyance is to be erased.
I 3. SECONDARY ERASURE
The IP is conveyed through the reading unit without reading the image, and its erasure is performed quickly regardless of the dosage on the IP. This mode is used to merely check the mechanism of the IP conveyance function.
MU - 72
MU - 73
CONTENTS
10
MU - 74
CONTENTS
10
MU - 75
9.
9.4
9.1
Diagnostic checks are performed to determine whether communication can be established between the destination host and the LAN (CPU90E/CPU90F) of the machine. (1) Execute 2.PING. The following message appears. INPUT THE CONNECTED HOST-NAME OR IP ADDRESS. Meaning: Enter the host name or IP address of the host connected. (2) Enter the host name or IP address of the host connected. If the CPU90F board has been installed in the machine, the following message appears after input. SELECT BOARD. 1.CPU90E 2.CPU90F : Meaning: Select the board. If the CPU90F board has not been installed in the machine, the following message appears. CPU90F BOARD HAS NOT MOUNTED. Meaning: The CPU90F board is not available.
9.2
9.3
G Diagnostic result
OK: Normal ERROR (ZZZZZZ): Abnormal NO EXISTENCE: DSP (board) is not available.
009-051-10 03.20.2004 FM4275
MU - 74
MU - 75
CONTENTS
10
MU - 76
CONTENTS
10
MU - 77
I 3. CPU90F DMA
This menu should not be used.
9.5
9.6
MU - 76
MU - 77
CONTENTS
10
MU - 78
CONTENTS
10
MU - 79
MU - 78
MU - 79
CONTENTS
10
MU - 80
CONTENTS
10
MU - 81
(-)
(+) PIXEL
Enter the read start position adjustment value (a value, which is converted from the output image to the actual dimensional value on IP) in pixels (1 pixel = 0.1 mm).
FR1H2000.EPS
I 1. DEFAULT: To Display Result after Setting Read Start Position and Read Width to Their Default
The read start position (PIXEL) and read width (FREQ) are set to their default. The setup values are not written to the hard disk. 1. Execute 1. PIXEL AND FREQ, 2. PIXEL ONLY, or 3. FREQ ONLY. When it is executed normally, the following message appears. FORMAT DATA IS SET TO THE DEFAULT VALUE. Meaning: The format data is set to the default value.
MU - 80
MU - 81
CONTENTS
10
MU - 81.1
CONTENTS
10
MU - 81.2
I 4. PIXEL POSITION CORRECTION: Changing the scanner invalid pixel count setting
Used to change the scanner invalid pixel count setting for each IP size. The setting can be saved on the hard disk. (1) Choose "4. PIXEL POSITION CORRECTION". The IP sizes then appear on the display. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 2. 10x12 ST 3. 14x14 ST 4. 14x17 ST 5. 18x24 ST 6. 18x24 HR 7. 24x30 ST 8. 35x35 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT IP SIZE > (2) Select an IP size. The current setting appears on the display. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT IP SIZE >1 -50 - 50 : 3 [IP size selection] INPUT THE PIXEL (CURRENT=3) [Current setting] [To retain the current setting, press the ENTER key here.]
(3) Enter a scanner invalid pixel count setting between -50 and 50 pixels. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT THE PIXEL (CURRENT=3) -50 - 50 : xx [Enter the invalid pixel count.] A setting of 10 pixels is equivalent to 1 mm when measured on the IP. For rightward movement within the output screen, enter a plus value. For leftward movement, enter a minus (-) value. The display shows the result. RESULT - xxxxxxxxxx The "xxxxxxxxxx" portion indicates the result (OK: normal end; ERROR: abnormal end). (4) Save the setting on the hard disk. Choose "8. DATA MANAGEMENT" from SCANNER UTILITY, and then execute "3. SAVE FORMAT DATA". When the execution ends normally, the following message appears. /sd0/SYSTEM/IMG/SCN/SNDPIXEL.DAT IS SAVED Meaning: The file "/sd0/SYSTEM/IMG/SCN/SNDPIXEL" is saved.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If you press the ENTER key to retain the current setting, you are returned to the format selection screen.
MU - 81.1
MU - 81.2
CONTENTS
10
MU - 81.3
CONTENTS
10
MU - 81.4
I 5. LINE POSITION CORRECTION: Changing the scanner invalid line (reading start position) setting
Used to change the scanner invalid line setting for each IP size. The setting can be saved on the hard disk. (1) Choose "5. LINE POSITION CORRECTION". The IP sizes then appear on the display. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 2. 10x12 ST 3. 14x14 ST 4. 14x17 ST 5. 18x24 ST 6. 18x24 HR 7. 24x30 ST 8. 35x35 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT IP SIZE > (2) Select an IP size. The current setting appears on the display. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT IP SIZE >1 -50 - 50 : 3 [IP size selection] INPUT THE PIXEL (CURRENT=3) [Current setting] [To retain the current setting, press the ENTER key here.]
(3) Enter a scanner invalid line count setting (the number of pixels for shifting the reading start position) between 1 and 50 pixels. 0. QUIT 1. 8x10 ST 9. 35x43 ST 10. 24x30 HR INPUT THE PIXEL (CURRENT=3) -50 - 50 : xx [Enter the number of invalid lines.] A setting of 10 pixels is equivalent to 1 mm when measured on the IP. For rightward movement within the output screen, enter a plus value. For leftward movement, enter a minus (-) value. The display shows the result. RESULT - xxxxxxxxxx The "xxxxxxxxxx" portion indicates the result (OK: normal end; ERROR: abnormal end). (4) Save the setting on the hard disk. Choose "8. DATA MANAGEMENT" from SCANNER UTILITY, and then execute "3. SAVE FORMAT DATA". When the execution ends normally, the following message appears. /sd0/SYSTEM/IMG/SCN/SNDLINES.DAT IS SAVED Meaning: The file "/sd0/SYSTEM/IMG/SCN/SNDLINE" is saved.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If you press the ENTER key to retain the current setting, you are returned to the format selection screen.
MU - 81.3
MU - 81.4
CONTENTS
10
MU - 82
CONTENTS
10
MU - 83
I To Calculate Correction Data : 2.CALCULATION : 3.SHADING AND POLYGON : 2.CALCULATION : 4.SHADING AND POLYGON FOR BAD CONDITION : 2.CALCULATION : 5.POLYGON ONLY
Execute 3. SHADING AND POLYGON, 4. SHADING AND POLYGON FOR BAD CONDITION or 5. POLYGON ONLY. When the recorded data is correct, the following message appears. CALCULATION IS IN PROGRESS. RESULT - OK (or RESULT - ERROR) Meaning: Correction data calculation is now being performed.
N NOTE N
REC MODE (recording of correction data) is effective for a single reading. To record correction data repeatedly, execute 1. REC MODE again.
I To Test to Check If Image Size is as Specified : 2.CALCULATION : 1.SHADING, POLYGON AND SENSITIVITY : 2.CALCULATION : 2.SHADING, POLYGON AND SENSITIVITY FOR BAD CONDITION : 2.CALCULATION : 6.SENSITIVITY ONLY
(1) Select 1. SHADING, POLYGON AND SENSITIVITY. When the recorded data is correct, a prompt for input of dosage value appears as follows. INPUT DOSAGE VALUE. 0.50 - 9.99 : The unit is in mR. If the recorded data is incorrect, the following message appears. THE DATA IS RECORDED WITH INCORRECT SIZE. Meaning: The data has been recorded with wrong size. (2) Enter the dosage value. The calculation of the correction data is initiated, with the following message displayed. CALCULATION IS IN PROGRESS. RESULT - OK (or RESULT - ERROR) Meaning: Correction data calculation is now being performed.
MU - 82
MU - 83
CONTENTS
10
MU - 84
CONTENTS
10
MU - 85
I 1. SAVE SHADING AND POLYGON DATA: To Copy Invalid Pixels and Other Data into Secondary Memory
It is used when shading or polygon correction is performed in 7. SHADING/SENSITIVITY. Execute 1. SAVE SHADING AND POLYGON DATA. Once it is executed normally, the following message appears. XXXXXXXXXX IS SAVED. Meaning: The file XXXXXXXXXX is saved. If it ends in error, the following message appears. FILE I/O ERROR. (FILE=XXXXXXXXXX) XXXXXXXXXX represents the file name.
Meanings of the displayed data are as follows, where XXXX denotes four decimal digits. MP: TMP: TML: RCNT: NCNT: HVCNT: PMTK: Number of invalid pixels Total number of invalid pixels Total number of invalid lines Reference frequency division value Oscillation frequency setup value Center-sensitivity HV value PMT sensitivity coefficient IP sensitivity during sensitivity adjustment Erasure level dosage value Erasure level QL value Correction mode default value
I 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA: To Write Read Start Position or Read Width Setup Value to Hard Disk
It is used when the read start position or read width is set in 6. FORMAT. Execute 3. SAVE FORMAT DATA. Once it is executed normally, the following message appears. XXXXXXXXXX IS SAVED. Meaning: The file XXXXXXXXXX is saved. If it ends in error, the following message appears. FILE I/O ERROR. (FILE=XXXXXXXXXX) XXXXXXXXXX represents the file name.
MU - 84
MU - 85
CONTENTS
10
MU - 86
CONTENTS
10
MU - 87
MU - 86
MU - 87
CONTENTS
10
MU - 88
CONTENTS
10
MU - 89
10.10 10. VIRTUAL IMAGE: Setting in Virtual Generation Mode for Image Signal
When an abnormal image occurs, a quasi-reading image is used to isolate its cause. When this item is set and then IP conveyance is performed, a virtual image may be read and outputted to film.
I 3. SCN08 INPUT: Virtual Image for Generating Image Signal on SCN08 Board
Select 3. SCN08 INPUT. The following message appears. THE SPECIAL MODE FOR VIRTUAL IMAGE IS SET. Meaning: The quasi-reading mode is now set.
N NOTES N
To obtain a quasi-reading image, set either 1. LIGHT, 2. LOG AMP, or 3. SCN08 INPUT and then return to the routine screen, before performing IP reading. After the quasi-reading is completed, be sure to select 4. ROUTINE to cancel the quasireading mode. Judging from the virtual image, isolate the cause of the abnormal image. 3. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Abnormal Images in Troubleshooting Volume
N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
For PMT electrical input quasi-reading (LOGAMP), HV is forced to OFF. Thus, a HV-OFF warning occurs when exiting M-Utility. However, it is not an error. So, press the CONFIRM button and proceed with the operation. For PMT electrical input quasi-reading (LOGAMP), a completely different signal than a normal X-ray image is inputted as a quasi-image signal. Thus, minute flickering, which will not pose any problem for a typical image, may appear as nonuniformity, depending on image processing requirements. Even if nonuniformity occurs as a result of quasi-reading, no nonuniformity is often found on a typical X-ray image. If any nonuniformity is found during quasi-reading, adjustment should be made with a usual X-ray image. The IP conveyed should be completely erased. ID information and so forth should also be registered in a similar manner to the routine processing.
I 1. LIGHT: Virtual Image for Injecting Virtual Light of LED into Photomultiplier (LED on PMT Board)
(1) Select 1. LIGHT. The following message appears. INPUT THE LEDS LUMINESCENCE QUANTITY. 1. EQUIVALENT TO 2-3[microR] 2. EQUIVALENT TO 2-3[mR] 1 - 2 : Meaning: Enter the luminescence quantity of the LED. (2) Type in a value either 1 or 2. The luminescence quantity of the LED is set, with the following message displayed. THE SPECIAL MODE FOR VIRTUAL IMAGE IS SET. Meaning: The quasi-reading mode is now set.
I 2. LOG AMP: Virtual Image for Inputting Fixed Current into PMT Board (VH OFF on PMT)
Select 2. LOG AMP. The following message appears. THE SPECIAL MODE FOR VIRTUAL IMAGE IS SET. Meaning: The quasi-reading mode is now set.
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
MU - 88
MU - 89
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 90
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 91
MU - 90
MU - 91
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 92
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 93
(5) Type in the high-speed value. The following message appears. INPUT THE LOW-SPEED. 16 - 7200 (FIXED=XXXX) : Meaning: Enter the low-speed value. XXXX denotes the low-speed value that is currently set. (6) Type in the low-speed value. The following message appears. INPUT THE SLEW UP TIME. 1000/LOW-SPEED - 3000 (FIXED=XXXX) : Meaning: Enter the slew-up time. XXXX denotes the slew-up time that is currently set. (7) Type in the slew-up time. The following message appears. INPUT THE SLEW DOWN TIME. 1000/LOW-SPEED - 3000 (FIXED=XXXX) : Meaning: Enter the slew-down time. XXXX denotes the slew-down time that is currently set.
(10) Type in the value of magnetic phase. The following message appears. INPUT THE MOVE AND STOP MODE. 1. HI-POWER/ENERGIZED STOP AFTER DELAY 2. LOW-POWER/ENERGIZED STOP AFTER DELAY 3. HI-POWER/DEENERGIZED STOP AFTER DELAY 4. LOW-POWER/DEENERGIZED STOP AFTER DELAY 5. HI-POWER/ENERGIZED STOP 6. LOW-POWER/ENERGIZED STOP 7. HI-POWER/DEENERGIZED STOP 8. LOW-POWER/DEENERGIZED STOP 1 - 8(FIXED=X) : Meaning: Enter the move and stop mode. 1: High power driving/energized stop, with power-down delay 2: Low power driving/energized stop, with power-down delay 3: High power driving/deenergized stop, with power-down delay 4: Low power driving/deenergized stop, with power-down delay 5: High power driving/energized stop, without power-down delay 6: Low power driving/energized stop, without power-down delay 7: High power driving/deenergized stop, without power-down delay 8: Low power driving/deenergized stop, without power-down delay (11) Type in the move/stop mode (1 through 8).
(8) Type in the slew-down time. The following message appears. INPUT POWER DOWN DELAY TIME. 0 - 255 (FIXED=XXX) : Meaning: Enter the power-down delay time. XXX denotes the power-down delay time that is currently set. (9) Type in the power-down delay time. The following message appears. INPUT THE MAGNETIC PHASE. 1. 2 PHASE 2.1-2 PHASE 3. W1-2 PHASE 4.2W1-2 PHASE 1 - 4(FIXED=X) : Meaning: Enter the magnetic phase. X denotes the value of magnetic phase (1: 2-phase magnetization, 2: 1-2-phase magnetization, 3: W-1-2-phase magnetization, 4: 2W-1-2-phase magnetization) that is currently set.
The following message appears. INPUT THE STOP MODE. 1. HALT 2.LIMIT 1 - 2(FIXED=X) : Meaning: Enter the stop mode. X denotes the stop mode (1: HALT stop, 2: LIMIT stop) that is currently set.
MU - 92
MU - 93
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 94
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 95
MU - 94
MU - 95
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 96
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 97
11:SA11 12:SA12 13:SA13 14:SA14 15:SA15 16:SA16 17:SA17 18:SB1 21:SB4 26:SD2 31:SF3 22:SB5 27:SD3 32:SF4 23:SC1 28:SE1 33:SZ2
11:SA11 12:SA12 13:SA13 14:SA14 15:SA15 16:SA16 17:SA17 18:SB1 21:SB4 26:SD2 31:SF3 22:SB5 27:SD3 32:SF4 23:SC1 28:SE1 33:SZ2
INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR. 1 - 34 : Meaning: Enter the number of sensor. (2) Type in the number of sensor. Sensor monitoring is initiated, and, when the sensor status changes, the following message appears. XXXXX ----> Open XXXXX ----> Close Meaning: Sensor XXXXX becomes OPEN. Sensor XXXXX becomes CLOSE.
MU - 96
MU - 97
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 98
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 99
MU - 98
MU - 99
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 100
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 101
MU - 100
MU - 101
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 102
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 103
MU - 102
MU - 103
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 104
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 105
11.10 5. UNIT: 6. DRIVING GRIP: Operation Tests on Subscanning Driving Grip Mechanism
I 1. GRIP: To Effect Driving Shaft Grip Operation
(1) Execute 1. GRIP. The following message appears. INPUT THE GRIP SPEED. 1. ST 2. HR 1 - 2 : Meaning: Enter the grip speed. (2) Type in either 1 or 2. The following message appears. MOVED TOWARD THE NIPPING POSITION IS IN PROGRESS. DRIVE TIME : XXX RESULT - OK Meaning: Grip operation of the driving shaft is now being performed. DRIVE TIME is displayed in units of 10 msec. If it ends in error, ERROR (XXXX) appears. XXXX denotes an error code.
MU - 104
MU - 105
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 106
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 107
11.11 5. UNIT: 7. DRIVEN GRIP: Operation Tests on Subscanning Driven Grip Mechanism
I 1. GRIP: To Effect Driven Shaft Grip Operation
(1) Execute 1. GRIP. The following message appears. INPUT THE NIPPING SPEED. 1. HIGH 2. LOW 1 - 2 : Meaning: Enter the grip speed. (2) Type in either 1 or 2. The following message appears. MOVED TOWARD THE NIPPING POSITION IS IN PROGRESS. DRIVE TIME : XXX RESULT - OK Meaning: Grip operation of the driven shaft is now being performed. DRIVE TIME is displayed in units of 10 msec. If it ends in error, ERROR (XXXX) appears. XXXX denotes an error code.
MU - 106
MU - 107
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 108
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 109
MU - 108
MU - 109
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 110
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 111
The following files are saved to the floppy disk. IRSET.CFG FILMFMT.CFG IRSTATUS.CFG IRSET.ORG FILMFMT.ORG IRSTATUS.ORG
MU - 110
MU - 111
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 112
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 113
MU - 112
MU - 113
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 114
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 115
MU - 114
MU - 115
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 116
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 117
N NOTE N
Before installing the configuration data that was edited on the PC or the like, make sure that the software versions for the machine where the data was extracted and the machine where it is to be installed are the same. If the software versions are different, error may occur during installation.
MU - 116
MU - 117
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 118
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 119
MU - 118
MU - 119
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 120
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 121
MU - 120
MU - 121
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 122
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 123
12.6 6. PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE: Reverting Back to Previous Version of System Software
(1) Select 6. PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE. The following message appears. ARE YOU SURE TO INSTALL PREVIOUS VERSION ? 1.YES 2.NO(DEFAULT=2) : Meaning: Are you sure to revert back to the previous version? (2) Select 1. Once the system software reverts back to its immediately preceding version, the following message appears. PREVIOUS VERSION SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED. Meaning: The system software reverts back to its previous version. (3) Reset the machine.
It should be noted that the display format of the last line in the list varies depending on whether the previous page and/or next page is available. (2) Type in 1 through 10, 11, or 12 to select an image to be saved to a floppy disk (i.e., an image for which EDR calculated value and image data are to be saved). When either 1 through 10 is typed in, the following message appears. PLEASE SET A FD. ARE YOU SURE TO SAVE EDR DATA FILES TO THE FD ? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : Meaning: Put a floppy disk into the floppy disk drive. Are you sure to save both EDR calculation and image data to the floppy disk? (3) Select 1. Once the data is copied to the floppy disk, the following message appears. XXXXXXXXXX IS COPIED. Meaning: XXXXXXXXXX is copied. If the coping ends in error, the following message is displayed. FILE I/O ERROR. (FILE=XXXXXXXXXX) XXXXXXXXXX denotes the file name.
MU - 122
MU - 123
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 124
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 125
BLANK PAGE
MU - 124
MU - 125
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 126
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 127
BLANK PAGE
MU - 126
MU - 127
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 128
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 129
I To turn HV ON
When the HV switch is in the OFF position, menu item 9 is displayed as 9.HV ON. 0.QUIT 1.ERROR LOG UTILITY 2.CONFIGURATION SETTING 3.TEST MODE 4.ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5.SCANNER UTILITY 6.MECHANICAL UTILITY 7.FILE UTILITY 8.BACKUP MEMORY 9.HV ON 10.IP UTILITY > (1) Select 9. HV ON. When the high-voltage switch is set to ON, the following message appears. TURNING ON THE HV IS IN PROGRESS. RESULT - OK Meaning: The HV is now being turned ON. If any error occurs, either of the following messages is displayed. HV ERROR Meaning: High-voltage power supply failure Meaning: Analog power supply failure Meaning: HV switch OFF ANALOG POWER SUPPLY ERROR HV OFF (2) Select 0. QUIT.
MU - 128
MU - 129
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 130
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 131
G 1. LIST
Displays the content of each of anatomical region menus and routine menus. The content of the menus that are not displayed (non-display menus) may also be displayed.
N NOTES N
The current settings must always be backed up to the FD before modifying the menu. 12.3 BACKUP: Backing Up Various Data I 5. CSL MENU DATA: To Read CSL Type Setup File from FD to HD For the menu setting to be effective, it is necessary to reset the machine.
G 2. MOVE
Changes the display location (display order) of the menu. Whether the menu is displayed or not may also be set.
G 3. ROUTINE
Registers or delete the menu to or from the routine menu.
I Summary of Function
With the menu setting, the menu displayed on the operation screen, parameters, and the display locations and setup contents of the icons may be edited through seven commands.
Exposure menu selection screen (Example: Head) Parameter selection screen (Example: Chest)
G 4. EDIT
Edits the content of the parameter, such as EDR or IP that is set for each menu group.
2
AUTO
G 5. COPY
Copies (duplicates) the existing menu to add a new menu.
SKULL, GENERAL
PARANASAL SINUS
MANDIBLE
ORBIT
The routine menu for which an image parameter has been set is registered. The routine menu is displayed and edited.
AP
TWIN
G 6. DELETE
The image parameter is displayed and edited.
Deletes menus.
12345.
ON
18*43
CODE
RT
Adds or deletes a film mark. The display location of the film mark may also be set.
MENU
ANATOMICAL REGION
G Display menu
2
ID#1234564756
Display menu
2 2
Display location 1
ID#1234564756
XXY : ZZZZZZZZZZZZ
ID#1234564756
SKULL, GENERAL PARANASAL SINUS MANDIBLE ORBIT HEAD, SOFT TISSUE Page number 03
The display locations of the icons on the anatomical region selection screen are changed.
ROUTINE
FR1H1506.EPS
Page number 02
ANATOMICAL REGION
Page number 01
FR1H1507.EPS
MU - 130
MU - 131
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 132
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 133
G Non-display menu
Non-display menu
*XX : YYYYYYYYYYYY
Item number (two decimal digits)
FR1H1508.EPS
Example: The tenth item of the non-display menu is denoted by *10: CHEST, LYMPHA, FRN:C.
I Relevant Files
Each command for menu setting is implemented to read and/or write its relevant configuration files. A list of configuration files that are read and/or written by each command is summarized below.
Command LIST Relevant file and operation (R = read; W = write) BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG RTM_DISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM MOVE BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM ROUTINE RTM_DISP.CFG BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM EDIT BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM Fuji Standard image processing parameter User-defined image processing parameter COPY BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM Fuji Standard image processing parameter User-defined image processing parameter DELETE BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM Fuji Standard image processing parameter User-defined image processing parameter FILM MARK FILMMARK R R R R R/W R/W R R/W R R R R R R/W R R/W R R/W R/W R R/W R R/W R/W R R/W R/W Film mark and display location information
TR1H1200.EPS
4.ABDOMEN 5.PELVIS 6.UP.EXT 7.LOW.EXT 8.TEST TYPE POSITION NUMBER OF SOURCE OR * TO SPECIFY ROUTINE LIST> Meaning: Select the number of the anatomical region to be displayed on screen. To display the routine menu, type in *. (2) Select 2. CHEST. LIST>2 The following message appears. 011:CHEST,GENERAL
Routine menu display location information
File content Exposure anatomical region display location information Exposure menu display location information Routine menu display location information Exposure parameter
012:THORA.SPINE,FRN 013:UPPER RIB 014:LOWER RIB 015:CLAVICLE Meaning: Display menu of the first page. 021:SCAPULA
022:STERNUM 023:CHEST,PEDIATRICS 024:THORA.SPINE,LAT 025:CHEST,SOFT TISSUE Meaning: Display menu of the second page. 031:SHOULDER JNT,FRN 032:SHOULDER JNT,AXL 033:WHOLE SPINE 034:CHEST,GENERAL-2 035:CHEST,PORTABLE Meaning: Display menu of the third page.
MU - 132
MU - 133
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 134
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 135
*1:CHEST,SPECIAL-1 *2:THORA.SPINE,AXL *3:CHEST,PED.-1 *4:CHEST,SPECIAL-2 *5:CHEST,BL.VESSEL:C *6:BRONCHUS:C *7:CHEST,ESOPHAGUS:C *8:CHEST,MYELO.,LAT:C *9:CHEST,MYELO.,FRN:C *10:CHEST,LYMPHA,FRN:C *11:CHEST,LYMPHA,LAT:C *12:SHLD.JNT,ARTHRO:C *13:LUNG:T *14:MEDIASTINUM:T *15:STERNUM:T *16:THORA.SPINE,FRN:T *17:THORA.SPINE,LAT:T *18:SHOULDER JOINT:T *19:CHEST,MAG:M Meaning: Non-display menu N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
When the ENT key is touched with a message displayed, its subsequent message that is not displayed, if any, is displayed. When the ENT key is touched with the entire message displayed, the LIST command is quitted, with a prompt displayed.
MU - 134
MU - 135
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 136
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 137
TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE SOURCE, PAGE NUMBER OR * TO LIST 2ND LEVEL (P01) Meaning: Select the display menu number to be moved. To confirm the display menu again, type in P + page number, and to confirm the non-display menu again, type in *. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01. (3) Select *1. MOVE>*1 The following message appears. TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE DESTINATION OR PAGE NUMBER MOVE> Meaning: Type in the page number and display location of the destination to which the selected menu is to be moved. To display the menu, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01.
2
HEAD icon
Destination
TEST
ROUTINE
ROUTINE
FR1H1509.EPS
(4) Type in 021 and touch ENT. MOVE>021 After quitting the menu and restarting, the non-display menu *1: OPEN MOUTH changes its status to a display menu and is displayed in the first position on the second page. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
With similar procedures, the display menu may be moved within the same page (its display location may be changed), a display menu may be moved (changed) to a non-display menu, and so forth.
(1) Select 2. MOVE. COMMAND>2 The following message appears. 0.HEAD 8.TEST MOVE> Meaning: Select the number of the anatomical region to be changed. To change the display location of the icon on the anatomical region selection screen, type in *. 1.NECK *.MOVE 2.CHEST 3.BREAST
MU - 136
MU - 137
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 138
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 139
(2) Select *.MOVE. MOVE>* The following message appears. 11:HEAD 13:CHEST 15:ABDOMEN 17:UP.EXT 21: - - - - - - - - - 23: - - - - - - - - - 25: - - - - - - - - - 27: - - - - - - - - - 12:NECK 14:BREAST 16:PELVIS 18:LOW.EXT 22:TEST 24: - - - - - - - - - 26: - - - - - - - - - 28: - - - - - - - - - -
SPECIFY TWO LOCATIONS TO EXCHANGE TYPE FIRST LOCATION MOVE> Meaning: Select the menu number of the icon to be moved. (3) Select 11: HEAD. MOVE>11 The following message appears. TYPE ANOTHER ONE MOVE> Meaning: Select the destination menu number for the menu selected. (4) Select 21:- - - - - - - - - -. MOVE>21 After quitting the menu and restarting, the HEAD icon on the first page is moved to the left position on the top of the second page.
* TO SPECIFY ROUTINE ROUTINE> Meaning: Select the number of the anatomical region for registration of the routine menu. To display the routine menu, type in *. (2) Select 1. NECK. ROUTINE>1 The following message appears. 011:CERVICAL,GENERAL 012:CERVICAL SPINE 013:PHARYNX/LARYNX 014:CERVIC.PEDIATRICS 015:LARYNX(<35KV) *1:OPEN MOUTH *2:CERVIC.,PED.-1 *3:CERVIC.BL.VESSEL:C *4:PHARYNX/LARYNX:C *5:CERVIC.ESOPHAGUS:C *6:CERVICAL,MYELO.:C *7:CERVICAL,LYMPHA:C *8:THORA C.,MYELO:C *9:CERVICAL SPINE:T *10:PHARYNX/LARYNX:T *11:CERVIC.,MAG:M TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE SOURCE OR PAGE NUMBER (P01) ROUTINE> Meaning: Select the menu to be registered. To display the menu, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01.
MU - 138
MU - 139
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 140
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 141
(3) Select 011: CERVICAL, GENERAL. ROUTINE>011 The following message appears. 011:SKULL,GENERAL 012:PARANASAL SINUS 013:MANDIBLE 014:ORBIT 015:HEAD,SOFT TISSUE . . . 061:HEAD,MAG:M 062: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 063:AVE5CM16 064: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 065: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - TYPE NEW LOCATION NUMBER OR PAGE NUMBER (P01~P06) ROUTINE> Meaning: Specify where 011: CERVICAL, GENERAL selected is registered in the routine menu. (4) Type in 034 and touch ENT. ROUTINE>034 After quitting the menu and restarting, the routine menu of 011: CERVICAL, GENERAL is registered in the fourth position on the third page.
4.ABDOMEN 5.PELVIS 6.UP.EXT 7.LOW.EXT TYPE POSITION NUMBER OF THE SOURCE OR * TO SPECIFY ROUTINE ROUTINE> Meaning: Select the number of the anatomical region for registration of the routine menu. To display the routine menu, type in *. (2) Type in *. ROUTINE>* The following message appears. 011:SKULL,GENERAL 012:PARANASAL SINUS 013:MANDIBLE 014:ORBIT 015:HEAD,SOFT TISSUE . . . 061:HEAD,MAG:M 062: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 063:AVE5CM16 064: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 065: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE SOURCE OR PAGE NUMBER (P01~P06) ROUTINE> Meaning: Select the routine menu to be deleted (disselected). To display the menu, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01.
MU - 140
MU - 141
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 142
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 143
(3) Type in 034. ROUTINE>034 The following message appears. TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE DESTINATION, * TO DISSELECT OR PAGE NUMBER (P01~P06) ROUTINE> Meaning: To delete (disselect) the menu selected, type in *. To display the menu, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01. (4) Type in * and touch ENT. ROUTINE>* After quitting the menu and restarting, the routine menu of 034 is deleted (disselected).
MU - 142
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 144
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 145
(4) Select [01] IP. EDIT>01 The following message appears. IP(0~9,A~F)=0 EDIT> (5) Type in 2. EDIT>2 The value of IP is changed from 0 to 2, with the following message displayed. TYPE ITEM NUMBER(DEFAULT=00) OR PAGE NUMBER(P1~P5) EDIT> Meaning: Select the item number to be edited. To display all the item numbers, type in *. To display the item numbers on a page-by-page basis, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01. To quit EDIT, type in E/Q. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
By touching the ENT key while a EDIT> prompt for input is displayed, the setting of the next item number can be edited. For example, if the ENT key is touched without typing in 2 at step (5) above, then item [02] PICTURE subsequent to [01] IP can be edited.
[25]MENU-J=\375B\4974\3335\3451\2121\2121\2121\2121 \2121\2121\2121\2121\2121\2121\2121\2121 GA L [26]=0.9 R [30]=1.0 S [34]=0.9 RN L [38]=4 R [41]=4 S [44]=4 DRN L [47]=5 R [53]=5 S [59]=5 HDN L [65]= R [71]= S [77]= PRN L [83]= R [87]= S [91]= Sstd GT [27]=F [31]=A [35]=F RT [39]=R [42]=R [45]=R DRT [48]=A [54]=A [60]=A HDT [66]= [72]= [78]= PRE [84]= - - [88]= - - [92]= - - Lstd GC [28]=0.6 [32]=0.7 [36]=0.6 RE [40]=0.5 [43]=5.0 [46]=0.5 DRE [49]=0.0 [55]=0.0 [61]=0.0 HDE [67]= - - [73]= - - [79]= - - a-edge [85]= [89]= [93]= ORN [50]=5 [56]=5 [62]=5 HRN [68]= [74]= [80]= ORD [51]=1 [57]=1 [63]=1 HRT [69]= [75]= [81]= ORE [52]=0.0 [58]=0.0 [64]=0.0 HRE [70]= - - [76]= - - [82]= - - (6) Type in E/Q. EDIT>E/Q 4. EDIT is exited. GS [29]=0.30 [33]=0.10 [37]=0.30
L [95]= - - - - - [96]= - - - - R [97]= - - - - - [98]= - - - - S [99]= - - - - - [100]= - - - - [*]=LIST [E/Q]=END TYPE ITEM NUMBER(DEFAULT=00) OR PAGE NUMBER(P1~P5) EDIT> Meaning: Select the item number to be edited. To display all the item numbers, type in *. To display the item numbers on a page-by-page basis, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01. To quit EDIT, type in E/Q.
MU - 144
MU - 145
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 146
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 147
(3) Select 011: CERVICAL, GENERAL. COPY>011 The following message appears. TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE DESTINATION OR PAGE NUMBER (P01) COPY> Meaning: Select the copy destination. To display the menu, type in P + page number. Example: To display the menu on the first page, type in P01. (4) Type in 021. COPY>021 After quitting the menu and restarting, 011: CERVICAL, GENERAL is copied to the first position on the second page.
MU - 146
MU - 147
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 148
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 149
(3) Select 021: CERVICAL, GENERAL. DELETE>21 The following message appears. DELETE NECK-021"CERVICAL,GENERAL DELETE> Meaning: Are you sure to delete the menu selected? 3.BREAST (4) Type in Y. DELETE>Y After quitting the menu and restarting, the menu 021: CERVICAL, GENERAL is deleted. (Y/N)
1.NECK
2.CHEST
MU - 148
MU - 149
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 150
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 151
TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE SOURCE FILMMARK> Meaning: Select the menu number to be moved. (3) Select 24: ABC. FILMMARK>24 The following message appears. TYPE LOCATION NUMBER OF THE DESTINATION, FILMMARK> Meaning: Select the number of the destination for the menu selected. (4) Select 26: - - - - - - - - - -. FILMMARK>26 After quitting the menu and restarting, 24 ABC selected at step (2) is displayed as 24: - - - - - - - - - -, while the 26: - - - - - - - - - - selected at step (3) is displayed as 26: ABC.
MU - 150
MU - 151
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 152
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 153
(4) Type in DEF. FILMMARK>DEF After quitting the menu and restarting, ABC is changed to DEF.
FILMMARK>Y After quitting the menu and restarting, the menu 26: DEF is deleted.
MU - 152
MU - 153
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 154
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 155
I Installation FDs
All the installation FDs are DOS 1.44MB formatted, 3.5-inch floppy disks. Two system disks are supplied in addition to data disks. The number of data disks varies with the software version. Before installing the software, check that the installation FDs are supplied as indicated in the following list.
Name System disk Format Install Data disk Appl Storage device number 114Y5431001A 114Y5431002A 114Y5431003A Quantity 1 disk (1st disk of the 2-disk set) 1 disk (2nd disk of the 2-disk set) One set (This number varies with the software version.) One set (This number varies with the software version.) Use For hard disk formatting For installation For application software Software for editing the image processing parameters and CSL type menu settings
TR1B1001.EPS
I Installation Procedures
If the hard disk has been replaced, format it before installing the software. 16.2 Formatting the Hard Disk Install the software (application) by sequentially inserting the INSTALL system disk and data disks into the floppy disk drive in compliance with the message appearing on the operation panel. If any error occurs during the installation process, start all over again. (1) Make sure that the machine is OFF. If the power is ON, place the circuit breaker in the OFF position to turn OFF the machine. (2) Insert the INSTALL system disk into the floppy disk drive.
PC MENU EDITOR
114Y5431010A
CAUTION
Do not erroneously interchange the INSTALL system disk and FORMAT system disk. If you turn ON the machine with the FORMAT disk set in position, the system automatically starts formatting the hard disk so that you will lose all the data that have been saved on the hard disk.
(3) Turn ON the machine. The following messages appear on the operation panel. Attaching to DMA device...done. Attaching to <floppy> device...done. Loading /fd0/VXWORKS.ST...43992 + 66184 + 29428 Starting at 0x1001000... The following messages appear and the software installation process starts. -> Install utility. Version A00. Attaching to <floppy> device...done. Attaching to <SCSI> device...done. Upon completion of SCSI device initialization, the following message appears. Insert data floppy disk.
MU - 154
MU - 155
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 156
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 157
(4) Remove the INSTALL system disk, and insert data disk #1 into the floppy disk drive. As indicated in the example below, messages appear to indicate that software files are copied to the hard disk. Copy </fd0/bootrom.sys> To </sd0/TEMP/BOOTROM.SYS> Copy </fd0/vxworks.st> To </sd0/TEMP/VXWORKS.ST> Copy </fd0/version.dat> To </sd0/TEMP/VERSION.DAT> Copy </fd0/script.txt> To </sd0/TEMP/SCRIPT.TXT> ...... ...... Insert next data floppy disk. (5) Insert the remaining data disks in numerical order. As indicated in the example below, messages appear to indicate that software files are copied to the hard disk. Create </sd0/LOG/CORE.DMP> Create </sd0/LOG/IOT.001> Create </sd0/LOG/TCB.001> Create </sd0/LOG/ISC.001> ...... ...... Upon completion of log file initialization, the following message appears to indicate the end of installation. Install is complete.
MU - 156
MU - 157
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 158
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 159
error open directory: status= <********> The directory was not found (the ******** portion is a detail code). The SCSI hard disk drive is faulty. error create file:status= <********> The file could not be generated (the ******** portion is a detail code). The SCSI hard disk drive is faulty. error file size. The file size is illegal. The floppy disk is faulty.
I Formatting Procedures
The hard disk should be formatted only when a hard disk access error frequently occurs or the data on the hard disk is lost wholly or partly. (1) Make sure that the machine is powered OFF. If the power is ON, place the circuit breaker in the OFF position to power OFF the machine. (2) Put the FORMAT disk into the floppy disk drive.
CAUTION
If you change your mind and do not want to format the hard disk, remove the FORMAT disk from the floppy disk drive before doing anything. If you power ON the machine with the FORMAT disk inserted into the floppy disk drive, the system automatically initiates the hard disk formatting sequence without asking for the users confirmation.
MU - 158
MU - 159
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 160
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 161
16.3 Installing Menu Default FD for USA Setup File (Only for Use in USA/CSL Type)
For the CSL-type machine for use in the U.S., if the hard disk is formatted and software is installed, be sure to install the Menu default FD for USA setup file as well.
(7) Select 7. FILE UTILITY, 4. RESTORE and 5. CSL MENU DATA in sequence.
7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >7 0.QUIT 1.FORMAT FD 2.FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION 3.BACK UP 4.RESTORE 5.EDR DATA 6.PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE 7.EXECUTION FUT> 4 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA 2.CONFIGURATION DATA 3.NETWORK DATA 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA 5.CSL MENU DATA FUT:RES>5
A D 7 4 1 0
DEL
B E 8 5 2 .
BS
C F 9 6 3 SP
ENT
I Installation
(1) Put the Menu default FD for USA setup file floppy disk into the FD drive. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (4) Select 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING and 1. SYSTEM in sequence.
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >2 0.QUIT 1.SYSTEM 2.PRINT 3.REMOTE SWITCH 4.EQUIPMENT 5.LOCAL INTERFACE 6.NETWORK HOST INTERFACE 7.HOSTS ADDRESS 8.DISTRIBUTION 9.ROUTING 10.NETMASKS 11.DICOM >1
Caps
C
FR1BA009.EPS
(8) Remove the Menu default FD for USA setup file floppy disk from the FD drive.
7 8 9
(9) Select 0. QUIT repeatedly. The screen returns to the U-Utility mode. (10) Press the RESET button. The machine is reset so that the setting of the file installed becomes effective.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1BA007.EPS
3
FR1BA008.EPS
(6) Touch the [SAVE] key. The edited content is saved to the HD.
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
MU - 160
MU - 161
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 162
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 163
G ETC
IRSET.ORG IRSET.CFG FILMFMT.ORG FILMFMT.CFG IRSTATUS.ORG IRSTATUS.CFG EOUIP CODEDSTB HOSTS DEVICE Machine definition file (original) Definition of machine status, etc. (setup value, default value described) Machine setup file (user setup) Format setup file (original) Definition of film character format (setup value, default value described) Format setup file (user setup) Machine status-related item film (original) Definition of items, such as IP conveyance mode Machine status-related item file (user setup) Connected unit candidate file Definition of connected unit (IDT or LP), etc. Distribution code definition file Connected host setup file Correspondence table between connected host name and IP address Device setup file Correspondence table between host name and device connected to that host Route setup file Host name that has routing capability is described. OPTION.001 OPTION.002 OPTION.003 OPTION.004 NETMASKS RMT_SW.CFG Soft key Remote monitor function Soft key Image processing with 2 unsharp mask sizes Soft key Online connection Soft key 2430 mammo Subnet mask file Subnet mask per domain/host is described.\ Remote power config file Remote commands for the host applicable to remote power control are described. Base on DICOM connection information file Connection requirements for the host applicable to Base on DICOM connection are described.
ROUTE
DICOM
MU - 162
MU - 163
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 164
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 165
G IDM
HIPMENU.PRM Standard image processing parameter file Fuji standard menu data (image processing with same unsharp mask size) Standard image processing parameter file Institution-specific menu data Standard image processing parameter file Fuji standard menu data (image processing with independent unsharp mask sizes) Mask/frequency/gradation table Fuji standard table (standard image processing table) Mask/frequency/gradation table Institution-specific table (standard image processing table) Optional image processing parameter file Fuji standard table Optional image processing parameter file Institution-specific table Optional mask filter table Fuji standard table (optional image processing table) Optional mask filter table Institution-specific table (optional image processing table) Hyper image processing parameter file Fuji standard table HPU.PRM HPT.PRM HPTU.PRM PEM.PRM PEMU.PRM PEMT.PRM PEMTU.PRM Hyper image processing parameter file Institution-specific table Hyper mask filter table Fuji standard table (hyper image processing table) Hyper mask filter table Institution-specific table (hyper image processing table) PEM processing parameter file Fuji standard table PEM processing parameter file Institution-specific table PEM unsharp mask data table Fuji standard table (PEM processing table) PEM unsharp mask data table Institution-specific table (PEM processing table)
G CSL
MENU_WIN.JPN MENU_WIN.ENG MENU_WIN.GER MENU_WIN.FRN MENU_WIN.ESP MENU_WIN.ITA MENU_WIN.SWE MENU_WIN.DEN MENU_WIN.FIN MENU_WIN.NOR BODYDISP.CFG MENUDISP.CFG RTN_DISP.CFG MPM_DEF.PRM FILMMARK.PRM CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file CRT display/touch panel control file Exposure anatomy display information setup file Exposure menu display information setup file Routine menu display information setup file Exposure parameter setup file Film mark character setup file
HPUMN.PRM HIPMNRL.PRM
CSL_ICONS.CFG Icon data file CARDFORM.CFG Magnetic card specific information setup file SIOSETUP.CSL Data link layer setup parameter definition file
G PNL
MESSAGES.JPN Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Japanese)
MESSAGES.ENG Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (English) MESSAGES.ESP MESSAGES.FRN Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Spanish) Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (French)
MESSAGES.GER Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (German) MESSAGES.ITA Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Italian)
MESSAGES.SWE Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Swedish) MESSAGES.DEN Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Danish)
MESSAGES.NOR Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Norwegian) MESSAGES.FIN ICONS.PNL Display message definition file Message data indicated on the display (Finnish) Integration file for icons used on PNL Multiple icon files are integrated into a single file.
CR-IR341 Service Manual MU - 165
MU - 164
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 166
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 167
G IPH
PUL_PARA.FIL Pulse motor parameter definition file Pulse motor parameters complying with the mechanical control specification are defined. Conveyance timer file Timeout times complying with the mechanical control specification are defined. Subscanning parameter file Conveyance parameters complying with the subscanning control specification
SCN
SCN_IFMT.DAT SCN_MAIN.DAT Format set data file Data regarding set-specific format Main-scan control data file Data for controlling the optics, synchronization, image signal system, light-collecting system Main-scan initial setup data file Scanner initial setup parameter Sensitivity set data file Data regarding set-specific sensitivity Sensitivity set data file Data regarding set-specific sensitivity (factory-default original, file name written to the FD with UTL) Shading correction data file Shading correction result Shading correction data file (default data) Shading correction result (for institution with poor tube conditions)
IPH_TIME.FIL
RETRYCNT.FIL
G IMG
CRT_FORM.DAT IMG_SIZE.DAT DEL_TABL.FIL DEL_DEFN.FIL Erasure conveyance speed table determination file For table determination complying with the erasure control specification Erasure conveyance speed definition file Conveyance speed table complying with the erasure control specification Test pattern file Test pattern data Monitor character format information Referenced when CRT characters are created.
SCN_SHDG.SHD SCN_SHDG.DEF
SCN_SHDG.ORG Shading correction data file Shading correction result (factory-default original, file name written to the FD with UTL) SCN_POLY.POL SCN_POLY.DEF Polygon correction data file Polygon correction result Polygon correction data file (default data) Polygon correction result (for institution with poor tube conditions) Polygon correction data file Polygon correction result (factory-default original, file name written to the FD with UTL) Erasure level detection data file Table for erasure dose detection Invalid pixel setting file Invalid line setting file
CRT_TEST.DAT
EDR
MPMPRM.PRM IRMPRM.PRM MPMUMN.PRM IRMUMN.PRM NNPRM.PRM NNUMN.PRM EDR.ABS EDR standard parameter Parameters for each menu are defined. EDR standard parameter Histogram parameters are defined. EDR user parameter Menu parameter definition for specific institution EDR user parameter Histogram parameter definition for specific institution Standard neuro parameter Standard parameter for neuro analysis Specific neuro parameter Specific parameter for neuro analysis EDR program EDR software program
SCN_POLY.ORG
MICRO
DSP4M1J.S24 DSP4M2J.S24 Image processing -program Image processing -program
MU - 166
MU - 167
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 168
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 169
G LIF
LPLFMT0J.DAT LPFMT1J.DAT MCFFMT0J.BIN B4 format file 14" x 17" format file Film character format file
17.2 LOG
I LOG
ERRLOG0.000 ERRLOGX.000 Error log save file Saved only to the FD in error log (level 0) maintenance utility. Error log save file Saved only to the FD in error log (other than level 0) maintenance utility. ISC log save file ISC log journal (extensions 001 to 005 denote normal logs, while 011 to 013 denote dumb logs SED log save file (MFC) SED log journal SED log save file (JNL) SED log journal SED log save file (PNL) SED log journal SED log save file (IPH) SED log journal SED log save file (IMG) SED log journal SED log save file (IIF) SED log journal SED log save file (CSL) SED log journal SED log save file (DST) SED log journal SED log save file (LIF) SED log journal SED log save file (DIF) SED log journal SED log save file (FOT) SED log journal SED log save file (FIN) SED log journal SED log save file (DOT) SED log journal IOT data IOT data journal External unit communication log (serial LP) External unit communication log journal External unit communication log (serial DMS) External unit communication log journal
MICRO
DSP10M1J.S24 DSP10M2J.S24 DSP11M1J.S24 DSP11M2J.S24 DSP20M1J.S24 DSP20M2J.S24 DSP21M1J.S24 DSP21M2J.S24 DSP30M1J.S24 DSP30M2J.S24 DSP31M1J.S24 DSP31M2J.S24 Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program Image processing -program SED_PNL.000 SED_IPH.000 SED_IMG.000 SED_IIF.000 SED_CSL.000 SED_DST.000 SIOSETUP.DMS Data link layer setup parameter definition file Data link layer setup parameter for DMS (E-IF) connection SED_LIF.000 SED_DIF.000 SED_FOT.000 SED_FIN.000 SED_DOT.000 IOT.000 SMCU_LIF.000 SMCU_DIF.000 SED_MFC.000 SED_JNL.000 ISC.000
G DIF
MICRO
DSP0M1J.S24 DSP0M2J.S24 Image processing -program Image processing -program
G IIF
SIOSETUP.IDT Data link layer setup parameter definition file Data link layer setup parameter for IDT (serial) connection
G HCP MICRO
DSPHM1J.S24
G LAN
LANCONT.ABS LAN board control program
CR-IR341 Service Manual MU - 168
009-051-05 11.20.99 FM2638
MU - 169
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 170
CONTENTS 11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MU - 171
SMCU_IIF.000 GD_IPH.000 GD_CSL.000 GD_DST.000 GD_LIF.000 GD_FOT.000 GD_FIN.000 GD_HCP.000 GD_DOT.000 GD_IMM.000 GD_QUM.000 CORE.DMP
External unit communication log (serial IIF) External unit communication log journal Global data (IPH) External unit communication log journal Global data (CSL) External unit communication log journal Global data (DST) External unit communication log journal Global data (LIF) External unit communication log journal Global data (FOT) External unit communication log journal Global data (FIN) External unit communication log journal Global data (HCP) External unit communication log journal Global data (DOT) External unit communication log journal Image management system data External unit communication log journal (history information, etc.) Queue management system data External unit communication log journal (history information, etc.) Core dump
BLANK PAGE
MU - 170
MU - 171
SP - 1
Revision number
12 13 14
Reason
CorrectionFM3332 CorrectionFM4219 CorrectionFM4656
Pages affected
All pages SP-7, 10, 12, 14, 18 23, 25, 27, 29 123 SP-2, 19 25, 29, 31, 37, 39, 47, 57, 61, 63, 67, 69, 73, 79, 83, 89, 91, 92, 99, 100, 103 105, 107, 112, 113, 115, 119, 120
08.31.2005
Note to be taken when the Service Parts List is used The Service Parts List shall be managed using the information common to both English and Japanese versions. Thus, it should be noted that the document numbers and revision numbers are managed according to the numbers used in the Japanese version.
SP - 1
Reference list
FUJI CODE 104N0043 104N0044 104Y0162 107Y0163B 107Y0166 113Y1038 113Y1324J 113Y1324M 113Y1325D 113Y1328G 113Y1395 113Y1555C 113Y1583A 113Y1584B 113Y1660A 113Y1682B 113Y7012D/E 113Y7015C 113Y7034J 113Y7035P 113Y7041G 113Y7042D 113Y7043A 113Y7044E/F 113Y7046A 113Y7047N 113Y7067B 113Y7070A 114Y5431001A01 114Y5431002A01 114Y5431003A08 114Y5431003A09 114Y5431003A10 114Y5431003A14 114Y5431003A15 114Y5431003A17 114Y5431003A18 114Y5431003A19 114Y5431026A00 114Y5431101A 114Y5431101A02 114Y5431204A 115S0072B 115S0083 115S0136A 118SX070A 118YX159 118YX164 118YX165 118YX700B 118YX700D 119Y1097 119Y1107 119Y1119 119Y1700 120Y0074A 120Y0075A 123N0006A 123N0008A
AC 5000
DESCRIPTION Photo Sensor Photo Sensor Photo Sensor Solenoid Solenoid Assembly Board Assembly SCN08A SCN08A SED08A PMT08A Board Assembly MTH08D DIM08A LAN90B CNN08A LAN90D IMG07B MMC90A CPU90E CPU90F HCP08A MTH08A LED08A SNS08A LED08B DRV08A VOL08A BCR08A Format FD Install FD Application FD Application FD Application FD Application FD Application FD Application FD Application FD Application FD DICOM option BOOT ROM PROM CPU90E BOOT ROM Thermo Switch Thermo Switch Thermo Switch Motor Stepping Motor Stepping Motor Stepping Motor Motor Motor Fan Fan Fan Fan Socket Socket Lamp Lamp
20.10.2009
REMARKS P - LIST
124Y0045C 124Y7000C 125N0094G 125N0094H 125N0094J/K 128S0392 128Y0200 128Y0241A 128Y0258B 133Y1031B 133Y2029 134Y0050 134Y0056C 136Y6102C 136Y8515 137N2001 138S0107 305N0014A 309S0025 316S0146 316S3067 316S3156 317N1047A 317N1049A 318N1014A 318N1042A 318N1051A 318N1059A 318S3050 322N0020A 322N0021A 322SF002 322SF004 322SF012 322SF017 322SF021 322SF029 322SF041 322SF043 322SF044 322SF050 322SF050 322SF061 322SF061 322SF069 322SF103 322SF109 322SF126 322SY048 322SY054 322SY055 322SY061 322SY064 322SY067 322SY093 322SY097 322SY103 322SY112 322SY121 322SY146 323N0017 323N0033
LD Assembly LD Assembly Power Supply Power Supply Power Supply Switch Switch Micro Switch Micro Switch Assembly Motor Pump Motor Pump Solenoid Valve Solenoid Valve Cable Cable Fuse Holder Ferrite Bead Nut Washer Clamp Latch Latch Cap Cap Bushing Bushing Bushing Bushing Grommet Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Plain Bearing Belt Belt
4512 156 05691 4512 131 36301 4512 131 36311 4512 131 36312 4512 131 36313 4512 131 81561 4522 500 26401 4512 156 02091 4512 131 36331 4512 131 81571 4512 131 36341 4512 131 36351 4512 131 81581 4512 156 07781 4512 156 07791 4512 131 98151 4512 131 98161 4522 500 23581 4512 156 02481 4512 156 05901 4512 156 07701 4512 156 07702 4512 131 37211 4512 131 37221 4512 156 02501 4512 131 37231 4512 131 37241 4512 131 37251 4512 156 02531 4512 131 37261 4512 156 05771 4512 156 02571 4522 500 24291 4512 131 37271 4522 500 22211 4512 156 02581 4522 500 23291 4522 500 22231 4522 500 22751 4512 156 02591 4522 500 23081 4522 500 23081 4522 500 22081 4522 500 22081 4512 156 02601 4512 156 02621 4512 156 02651 4512 156 02661 4512 131 98181 4522 500 23441 4512 156 02681 4522 500 27651 4512 131 98191 4512 131 37291 4512 131 37301 4512 131 98201 4522 500 27601 4522 500 24341 4512 131 37311 4512 131 98211 4522 500 25701 4512 131 36361
see 'Scanner compatibility' see 'Scanner compatibility' -> 125N0094H -> 125N0094J/K
>
-> 316S31576
323N1221A 323S3066 323S3072 323S3073 323S3077 323S3082 323S3098 323S3220 323S3255 323S3281 323S3283 323S3287 323S3288 323S3289 323S3290 323S3295 324N3038C 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3093A 324N3098B 324N3106B 324N3121 327N1121608A 327N1124001A 327N1201603A 329N7003B 329N7005D 329N7006C 329Y0015A 329Y0016A 332N3463A 333N7000B 334N2339B 334N2714A 334N3453A 334N3456B 334N3457B 334N3459B 334N3460B 334N3461B 334N3462B 334N3463B 334N3464B 334N3465B 334N3466B 334N3467B 334N3488A 334N3489A 334N3556 334N3721 334N3784B 334N3785C 334N3786A 334N5004B 334N5014 334Y2197B 334Y3153C 334Y3154A 334Y3160 337N0043 337S0003
Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Spur Gear Spur Gear Gear Cam Cam Cam Cam Cam Stopper Reel Roller Plastic Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Brush Roller Brush Roller Plastic Roller Rubber Roller Assembly Rubber Roller Assembly Rubber Roller Wheel Wheel
4522 500 25671 4522 500 23561 4512 131 36881 4522 500 29251 4512 131 36891 4512 131 36901 4512 131 36911 4512 131 36931 4522 500 23571 4512 131 36951 4512 131 36961 4512 131 36971 4512 131 36981 4512 131 36991 4512 131 37001 4512 131 37011 4522 500 23101 4522 500 22981 4522 500 22981 4522 500 25121 4512 156 02731 4522 500 23541 4512 131 98811 4512 131 88431 4512 156 07711 4512 131 89971 4512 131 37321 4512 131 37331 4512 131 37341 4512 131 37332 4512 131 37342 4512 131 89281 4512 156 05781 4512 131 98251 4512 131 37351 4512 131 37021 4512 131 37031 4512 131 37041 4512 131 37051 4512 131 37061 4512 131 37071 4512 131 37081 4512 131 37091 4512 131 37101 4512 131 37111 4512 131 37121 4512 131 37131 4512 131 37141 4512 131 37151 4512 156 07021 4522 500 22992 4512 131 37161 4512 131 37171 4512 131 37181 4512 131 36371 4512 131 36372 4522 500 27461 4512 131 36381 4512 131 36391 4512 131 36401 4512 156 02901 4522 500 23781 > -> 334N5014 > -> 334N3556 > > -> 329Y0015A -> 329Y0016A
340N0152 341N0745 345N1236B 345N1237B 345Y0158A 347N0636 347N0727 347N1261 347N1490A 350N1981B 350Y1313A 350Y1314C 356N5815B 356N5828C 356N5949A 356N5966 356N5967 356N5975A 356Y0174 356Y0200 357N7028A 360N0339A 362N0468 362N0469A 362N0474B 363N1708A 363N1755D 363N1777C 363N1788B 363N1813B 363N7105B 363N7106B 363N7108B 363N7109B 363N7111A 363N7112A 363N7115B 363N7116B 363Y0274B 363Y0275B 363Y0276B 363Y0278C 363Y0279C 363Y0280C 363Y0281B 363Y0282A 363Y0283B 363Y0284A 363Y0285B 363Y0286B 363Y0292A 363Y0294A 363Y0296B 363Y0308A 363Y0310A 363Y0311 363Y0320 363Y0357 363Y0485 363Y0492 363Y1822A 363Y1823A
Trimmer Arm Louvre Louvre Cover Spacer Spacer Spacer Spacer Cover FDD cover Lower Front Cover Assembly Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Assembly Base Housing Spacer Support Support Guide Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide Plate Guide Guide Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Guide Guide Plate Guide Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate
4512 131 36411 4512 156 02911 4512 156 07161 4512 156 07171 4512 131 36421 4512 156 02951 4512 156 05911 4512 156 02971 4512 156 05921 4512 131 98381 4512 131 37362 4512 156 07971 4512 131 81221 4512 156 05931 4512 156 07121 4512 156 05941 4512 156 05951 4512 156 05851 4512 156 05841 4512 156 07361 4512 131 37371 4512 156 05791 4512 156 05961 4512 156 05861 4512 156 05871 4512 156 03191 4512 131 36431 4512 131 37381 4512 131 88021 4512 156 07111 4512 156 07621 4512 156 07581 4512 156 07631 4512 156 07641 4512 156 07651 4512 156 07591 4512 156 07601 4512 156 07611 4512 131 36441 4512 131 36451 4512 131 36461 4512 156 07661 4512 156 07671 4512 156 07681 4512 156 07691 4512 156 07081 4512 131 36471 4512 131 36481 4512 131 36491 4512 131 36501 4512 131 36511 4512 131 36521 4512 131 36531 4512 131 36591 4512 131 36601 4512 131 36611 4512 131 36621 4512 156 07082 4512 131 36621 4512 131 36532 4512 131 36631 4512 131 36641 > -> 363Y0485 > -> 363Y0492 > -> 363Y0357
367N1006 370NB020 370NB033 370NB045 370NB060 370NB075 370NC020 370NC0323 370NC070A 370NC180 371S0003 372S0049A 372S0050A 372S0053A 372S0055 372S0060 375S0040 376N0182A 376N0183 376N0184 379N0113A 383Y0057 383Y0058 383Y0059 383Y0060 383Y0061 383Y0062 383Y0063 383Y0064 383Y0065 384N0045 384N0046 384N0047 386N0726 386Y0021 386Y0021A 387N0088 387N0095A 387N0103A 387N0112A 387N0113 387N7006 388N1073 388N1075A 388N1701 388N2222 388N2227A 388N2228B 388N2229B 388N2306 388N2407 388N3075A 388N5184A 388N5214 392N0005A 392N0010 398N0057D 602Y0105 603N0162B 603Y7001 606Y0032C 615Y7000B
Caster Hose Hose Hose Hose Hose Hose Hose Hose Hose Nozzle Joint Joint Joint Diverge Tube Joint Packing Mechanical Filter Mechanical Filter Mechanical Filter Radiator Plate Wire Wire Wire Wire Wire Wire Wire Wire Wire Tape Tape Tape Shock Absorber Vibration Proof Rubber Assembly Vibration Proof Rubber Assembly Antistatic Brush Antistatic Brush Antistatic Brush Antistatic Brush Antistatic Brush Antistatic Brush Compression Coil Spring Compression Coil Spring Compression Coil Spring Extension Spring Extension Spring Extension Spring Extension Spring Extension Spring Extension Spring Torsion Coil Spring Leaf Spring Leaf Spring Suction Cup Suction Cup Shutter Mirror Assembly Filter Filter Light-collecting Guide Assembly Polygonal Mirror Assembly
4512 133 70551 4512 131 37391 4512 131 37401 4512 156 07041 4522 500 22651 4512 131 37411 4512 131 37441 4512 156 07051 4512 131 37451 4512 156 03281 4512 131 37461 4512 156 05971 4512 131 88761 4512 156 05981 4512 131 37471 4512 156 05991 4522 500 23251 4512 131 36651 4512 131 36661 4512 131 36671 4512 156 07341 4512 131 36691 4512 131 36701 4512 131 36711 4512 131 36721 4512 131 36731 4512 131 36741 4512 131 36751 4512 131 36761 4512 131 36771 4512 156 07131 4512 156 07141 4512 156 07151 4512 131 36781 4512 131 36791 4512 131 36792 4512 156 07191 4512 156 07201 4512 131 98601 4512 156 07211 4512 156 07221 4512 156 07231 4512 156 03341 4522 500 25851 4512 156 03351 4522 500 25611 4522 500 25721 4522 500 25751 4522 500 25761 4522 500 27881 4512 156 05801 4512 156 07421 4512 156 03401 4512 156 02631 4522 500 27591 4512 156 05821 4512 156 07761 4512 131 37481 4512 131 37501 4512 131 36801 4512 131 36811 4512 131 36821 REC REC > REC -> 334N0010 > -> 386Y0021A REC
815Y7003 822Y7001 831Y7000 839Y0022B/C 839Y0046 839Y0047 839Y7003E 840Y0082A 849Y0086A 850S0080 850S0086 850S0087 850S0088 850S0121 850Y0112 850Y0113D 850Y0114 850Y0117 850Y0130 850Y0131 850Y0144 850Y10019 852N0016 852N0019C 898Y0837 898Y0864 898Y0901 898Y0973 898Y1030 898Y1087
SYN08A Assembly Cassette Set Unit IP removal unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Lamp Unit Monitor HDD FDD FDD FDD HDD HDD HDD HDD HDD HDD Kit HDD HDD HDD Bar Code Reader Bar Code Reader Kit MTH08D+DIM08A HDD Attachment Kit Kit 898Y0901 Antistatic Kit AC5000 Antistatic Kit AC5000 Antistatic Kit AC5000
4512 131 36831 4512 156 07091 4512 156 05891 4512 156 05701 4512 131 37511 4512 131 89291 4512 131 37511 4512 156 07031 4512 131 36841 4512 131 36862 4512 131 36851 4512 131 36852 4512 131 36853 4512 131 36861 4512 156 05881 4512 156 05751 4512 156 05761 4512 156 07321 4512 156 05762 4512 156 07322 4512 156 07323 4512 156 07324 4512 131 36871 4512 156 07011 4512 131 98801 4512 156 07351 4512 156 07371 4512 131 89541 4512 131 89542 4512 131 89543
REC
>
> REC > > > > REC > > > > > > REC REC REC
-> 850Y0113/ 0114 -> 850S0087 -> 850S0088 see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' -> 850Y0144 see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' see 'HDDs in AC500 ....'
see 'HDDs in AC500 ....' complete IP removal arm > > -> 898Y1030 -> 898Y1087
2009/10/20
2. Parts to be ordered
Depending on the type and the serial number of the reader or the installed scanning optics unit order the parts mentioned below. Replacement of: 839Y7003D/E 839Y0022B/C 839Y0045 839Y0049A Replaced by: 839Y0047 + 124Y0045C + 113Y1324M + actual software + 1) 839Y0047 + 1) 839Y0047 839Y0049A To be ordered by Philips number: 4512 131 89291 + 4512 156 05691 + 4512 131 36062 , SW via InCenter 4512 131 89291 4512 131 89291 4512 131 98712
2008/05/21
B.Freytag
file:HDD_AC5xx_2.doc
1/1
AC 500 AC 5000 Cosima Philips Code Fuji Code Parts to be ordered in case of a first replacement of the hard disk:
- # 2084 - # 2215 4512 156 07324 850Y10019 4512 156 07351 898Y0864 4512 156 07361 356Y0200 4512 156 07324 4512 156 07331 4512 156 07341 4512 156 07361 850Y10019 113Y1660A 379N0113A 356Y0200
Description
HDD HDD Attachment kit Bracket Assembly HDD Conversion Board Radiator Plate Bracket Assembly HDD Conversion Board Radiator Plate HDD Radiator Plate
# 2085 - # 2670
# 2216 - # 2670
# 2671 - # 5170
# 2671 - # 5610 s/n not available. Check at site. # 5611 s/n not available. Check at site.
4512 156 07324 850Y10019 4512 156 07331 113Y1660A 4512 156 07341 379N0113A 4512 156 07324 850Y10019 4512 156 07341 379N0113A
# 5171 -
SP - 2
I REF.NO.
REF. NO. is a parts number indicated in the Service Parts Exploded Views. For parts having different functions, they are clearly distinguished in the REMARKS and SERIAL NUMBER columns.
SP - 3
I PART NUMBER
PART NUMBER is a code number that is unique to each part. An alphabetic letter at the right-most position of the code number has the following meaning. For hardware The alphabet denotes the version number of a part. If parts have different version numbers, they are upward-compatible. For software The alphabet denotes a difference in the specifications. Parts differing in the suffix are not compatible with each other. Although the version is indicated by a number, it is omitted.
Not repairable
without R, Q, T
Not repairable
G Export regulation-applicable character (Parts without the following character are not controlled by Export regulation.)
Character + Significance Parts applicable to export regulations.
I PART NAME
PART NAME represents a general name of a part.
Rank A = 1 + Q x 0.3 Rank C = 1 + Q x 0.05 Rank D = 1 + Q x 0.02 2N10 Rank A = 2 + N x Q x 0.3 Rank C = 2 + N x Q x 0.05 Rank D = 1 + N x Q x 0.02 11N300 Rank A = 3 + N x Q x 0.3 Rank C = 3 + N x Q x 0.05 Rank D = 3 + N x Q x 0.02
G Fault RANK characters (which provide reference for determining the recommended stock quantity) All parts are assigned either A through E.
Character A B C D Significance Consumable parts or parts that will be replaced at short intervals. Parts that may become faulty accidentally and have a relatively high failure rate. Parts that have a sufficiently long MTBF, but are expected to have a relatively high failure rate. Parts that have a sufficiently long MTBF, but are expected to become faulty. Parts that are necessary for fault analysis, or parts that may be needed in case of unexpected accidents such as man-induced damage.
I QTY.
QTY. denotes the quantity of parts used in each unit. A parts with -S assigned to the end of the quantity represents a small part that is shipped in packs of 50. (Even if such a part is ordered in quantity of 1 , a pack containing 50 pieces of that part is supplied.)
I REMARKS
The REMARKS column indicates a unique name of a part or its relevant information of note.
I SERIAL NUMBER
The units may contain different parts depending on their shipment control number. SERIAL NUMBER indicates the shipment control number to which the relevant parts are applicable. If the SERIAL NUMBER column is blank, the parts are applicable to all the relevant units. The shipment control number is represented by lower four digits of seven-digit number indicated on the rating indication label.
SP - 2
009-051-12 03.30.2002 FM3332
<The RANK guide> The Fault RANK characters, Handling RANK characters, and Export regulationapplicable character are assigned in that order. Thus, at least one character or up to three characters are assigned in the RANK column.
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
SP - 3
SP - 4
INDEX 01B
2 COVER 2
SP - 5
INDEX 04F INDEX 04G
INDEX 01A
1 COVER 1
INDEX 01C
3 COVER 3
INDEX 04E
INDEX 02A
1 FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 1
INDEX 02B
2 FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 2
INDEX 03A
1 CASSETTE SET UNIT 1
INDEX 05A
1 BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
INDEX 05B
2 BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
INDEX 05C
3 BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
INDEX 03B
2 CASSETTE SET UNIT 2
INDEX 03C
INDEX 04A
INDEX 05D
4 BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
INDEX 05E
5 BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
INDEX 06A
1 SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
INDEX 04B
INDEX 04C
INDEX 04D
INDEX 06B
2 SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
INDEX 06C
3 SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
INDEX 06D
4 SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
FR1Z0001.EPS
FR1Z0002.EPS
SP - 4
SP - 5
SP - 6
INDEX 07A INDEX 07B
SP - 7
INDEX 06E
INDEX 11
SCANNING OPTICS UNIT
INDEX 12A
1 CONTROLLER 1
INDEX 12B
2 CONTROLLER 2
INDEX 07C
3 AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 3
INDEX 08A
1 ERASURE CONVEYOR 1
INDEX 08B
2 ERASURE CONVEYOR 2
INDEX 12C
3 CONTROLLER 3
INDEX 13
OPTION
INDEX 14
CABLE
INDEX 08C
3 ERASURE CONVEYOR 3
INDEX 08D
4 ERASURE CONVEYOR 4
INDEX 09
LAMP UNIT
INDEX 15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
INDEX 16
INDEX 17
INDEX 10A
1 SUBSCANNING UNIT 1
INDEX 10B
2 SUBSCANNING UNIT 2
INDEX 10C
3 SUBSCANNING UNIT 3
INDEX 18
LIST OF QUICK WEARING PARTS
INDEX The number in the shaded area in each unit that comes after INDEX indicates the parts list section number.
FR1Z0004.EPS
FR1Z0003.EPS
SP - 6
SP - 7
01A
1 COVER 1
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
1 COVER 1
QTY.
01A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D
1 2.1 2.2 2.3 3.1 3.2 3.3 4 5.1 5.2 5.3 6.1 6.2 6.3 7.1 7.2 7.3 8.1 8.2 8.3 9 10 11 12 13
345N1237B 350Y1216A 350Y1358 350Y1359 350N2001E 350Y1319 350Y1337 388N5703A 350Y1219 350Y1364 350Y1365 350N1999E 350Y1317 350Y1335 350Y1220 350Y1366 350Y1367 350N1998F 350Y1316 350Y1334 382N0999 382N0997 382N0998 382N0996 347S0280
Louver Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Upper Left-Hand Side Cover Flat Spring Upper Rear Cover Assembly Upper Rear Cover Assembly Upper Rear Cover Assembly Upper Rear Cover Upper Rear Cover Upper Rear Cover Lower Rear Cover Assembly Lower Rear Cover Assembly Lower Rear Cover Assembly Lower Rear Cover Lower Rear Cover Lower Rear Cover Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Spacer Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Upper Right-Hand Side Cover Panel Panel Panel Lower Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Lower Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Lower Right-Hand Side Cover Assembly Lower Right-Hand Side Cover Lower Right-Hand Side Cover Lower Right-Hand Side Cover
8 1 1 1 1 1 1 60 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 10 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS T3 x W10 x L558 T12 x W15 x L558 T12 x W15 x L427 T12 x W15 x L652 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS
1
FR1Z0005.EPS
D D D D D D D D D
5 4
2-B3X6
39
DETAIL B 8 38 40 B 35 37 4 B 2 3 9 11 12 10 11 13 14 4 7
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
14.1 350Y1214A 14.2 350Y1354 14.3 350Y1355 15.1 350N2003E 15.2 350Y1321 15.3 350Y1339 16.1 352N0395 16.2 352Y0052 16.3 352Y0053 17.1 350Y1215B 17.2 350Y1356A 17.3 350Y1357A 18.1 350N2002H 18.2 350Y1320 18.3 350Y1338
13 36 17 16 4
2-W3
D D D D D
15
D D D D
42 1 19 29
2-S36
20 21
D D
19 41 28 A 1 26 27 25 25 24 18 30 DETAIL A
FR1Z0006.EPS
22 23
D D D
SP - 8
SP - 9
01A
RANK REF. PART NO.
1 COVER 1
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO.
BLANK PAGE
D D D D A D D D D D D D D D
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29
382N0987 382N0986 382N0935A 382N0934A 376N0183 382N0985 382N0982 382N0981 382N0980 382N0984 382N0983
Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Tape Tape Mechanical Filter Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Lower Front Cover Assembly Lower Front Cover Assembly Lower Front Cover Assembly
2 1 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
T3 x W10 x L410 T35 x W15 x L395 T35 x W15 x L605 T35 x W15 x L628 T3 x W10 x L438 T3 x W10 x L610 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS
A D D D D D D D D D D E
35 36
376N0184 382N1168
Mechanical Filter Sponge Tape Cover Cover Cover Louver Flat Spring Cover Cover Cover Sponge Tape Label
1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 1
SP - 10
SP - 11
01B
2 3
2 COVER 2
1
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
2 COVER 2
QTY.
01B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D
FR1Z0007.EPS
350Y1217 350Y1318 350Y1336 350Y1218 350Y1362 350Y1363 345N1236B 345N1237B 350N2006E 350Y1345 350Y1346 376N0182A 350N2007A 388N5244A 350N2000H 382N0992 382N0993 382N0975 382N0994 382N0987 382N0995 352N0394 382N0988 382N0990 382N0991 382N0989 350Y1213 356N5847C
D D
7 8 4 8 10 5 6
4-S36
Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Assembly Cover Cover Cover Louver Louver Cover Cover Cover Mechanical Filter Cover Flat Spring Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Panel Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Upper Front Cover Assembly Bracket Upper Front Cover Upper Front Cover Upper Front Cover Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Bracket Latch FDD Cover FDD Cover FDD Cover Light Protect Plate
1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS TL-231No.1 (1677) For PHILIPS For SIEMENS T8 x W10 x L380 T3 x W10 x L150 T3 x W10 x L65 T12 x W15 x L518 T12 x W15 x L403 T3 x W10 x L434 T12 x W15 x L400 T3 x W10 x L494 T3 x W10 x L446 T12 x W10 x L40 T12 x W10 x L140 T12 x W10 x L148 T12 x W10 x L56 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS T7 x W223 x L315 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For PHILIPS For SIEMENS
D D D D D D D A D D D D D D D D D D
11 12
38 17 21 22 40 23 22 24
2-BR48 2-BR48
20
13
14 15
19
18 15 16 17 14
D D D
25 26 39 28
3-BR48 2-Q46
36 37
D D E D D D D D
23.1 350Y1285A 23.2 350Y1352 23.3 350Y1353 24 25 26 27 28 382N1071 382N1069 382N1070 356N5972A 316S3067
27 A 30 32 31 33 34 31 29 36
36
37
D E D D D D D
DETAIL A
35
8-BR48 2-T48
FR1Z0008.EPS
SP - 12
SP - 13
01B
RANK REF. PART NO.
2 COVER 2
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO.
BLANK PAGE
D D D D D D D D D D E E D D D D D
31 32 33 34 35 36 37
Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Lower Left-Hand Side Cover Tape Label Label Label Label Label Label
2 1 1 1 2 4 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
T12 x W10 x L625 T12 x W10 x L575 T12 x W10 x L555 T12 x W10 x L64 T12 x W10 x L20 T10 x W8 x L55 T5 x W60 x L55 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS W19 x L230 For CR-IR341 For CR-IR341 For PHILIPS For SIEMENS For CR-IR361 Japan only For CR-IR341 Japan only CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later
40.1 405N2314A 40.2 405N2878 40.3 405N2462 40.4 405N2551 40.5 405N2608 40.6 405N2607
SP - 14
SP - 15
01C
3 COVER 3
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
3 COVER 3
QTY.
01C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D
4-BR48
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
363N7109B 319N3349A 356N6012A 363N7108B 356N7389A 356N7390A 363Y0281B 363N7105B 332N0502 363Y0280C 363Y0279C 363Y0278C 138S0132 363N7111A 363N7112A 363N7106B 363N7115B 363N7116B 113Y7046A 356N5841A 322N0022A 322N0023A 322N0024A 357N1114D 346N0975A 317N1049A 357N7028A 332N0460C
LED08B
Guide Shaft Bracket Guide Bracket Bracket Guide Guide Stopper Guide Guide Guide Ferrite Bead Guide Guide Guide Guide Guide LED08B Bracket Sliding Tape Sliding Tape Sliding Tape Base Sub Plate Cap Base Stopper
E E
3 2
3-BR48
FR1Z0009.EPS
D E E D
2 1 5
2-BR48
4
5-BR412
D E D D D E
D D D D
5-BR412
7 20 19
4-T46
D D E D
18 17 16 15 28
2-BR412
2-B36
2-B36
10 9 11
D D E E D D D
13
27 26 14 12
23
9-M36
24 22 21
25
FR1Z0010.EPS
SP - 16
SP - 17
02A
1
FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1
FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 1
PART NAME QTY.
02A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D D
FR1Z0011.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6.1 6.2 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
347S0295 382N1034 363N1769 363Y0492 363N1812 367S1078 367N1006 367Y2012 363Y0293A 363N1973C 355N0499D 356N5928 365S0028 356N5921B 356N5942A 356N5927C 356N5929A 356N5924D 356N5969A 308S1422610
Spacer Sponge Tape Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Caster Caster Adjuster Assembly Guide Plate Guide Plate Frame Bracket Rail Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Sems Screw Bracket
3 1 1 1 1 4 4 4 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 2-S 1 M2.6 x 10 CR-IR341: #2040 or earlier CR-IR341: #2041 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2041 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2041 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2041 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2041 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later 203-16-5619 T8 x W10 x L116
D E D
3-B36
3
3-B36
D D D E E E D E
4 23
24
2-T4X6 (3B)
E E E E E
22 13
3-BR48 2-T46(3B) 2-BR48 2-BR48
17 X
2 5
2-BR48
E E
12
4-T46 (3B)
14
20.1 356N5970
3-BR48
11
2-BR48
16
20.2 356N6219
Bracket
15
12
18
21
356N6216
Bracket
4-BR48
22
356N6218
Bracket
X 10
4-T46(3B) BR48 2-T46(3B)
19
D 23 382N1156 Sponge Tape 1
20.1 20
D 24 382N1155 Sponge Tape 1
9
44-BR 612
6 8 7
21
20.2
T4X8 2-BR4X8
FR1Z0012.EPS
SP - 18
SP - 19
02B
DETAIL E
2
FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 2
RANK REF. PART NO.
2
FRAME & POWER SUPPLY 2
PART NAME QTY.
02B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E E
FR1Z0013.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
356N5936A 356N5937A 356N5934B 356N5932B 356N5931A 310N0603A 401N0744A 401N0742B 356N5935 125N0094K 119Y1119 318S1121
Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Pin Counter Plate Counter Plate Bracket Power Supply Fan Bush Clamp Clamp Bush Bush Antistatic Brush
1 1 2 1 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 TB-1520 Japanese, USA Europe Japanese, USA Europe CR-IR341: #2368 or earlier CR-IR341: #2369 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later JPS-1
E E E E E E CR D E
35
2-BR48
10,36,37,38,39
4-B36 2-BR412
15
4-B36
E E E E
13.1 316N0348 13.2 316N0349 14.1 318S1055 14.2 318S1177 15.1 387N0088
11
4-BR48
4-M330
D 15 16
12 9
4-M330
11 A
6-BR38
15.2 387N0112/A 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 356N6015 382N0977 382N0978 352N0392C 382N0979 382N1035 382N0975 382N0974 352N0391B 382N0976 382N1038 356N5800B 365N0091 355N0498H 356N5799C 387N0095/A 386N0726 345Y0158A 318N3015 322N0033 137S1192 137S1076 137S1193 137S1077 137S1194 137S1079 137S1195 137S1080
Antistatic Brush Bracket Shock Absorber Shock Absorber Panel Shock Absorber Sponge Tape Shock Absorber Shock Absorber Panel Shock Absorber Sponge Tape Bracket Rail Frame Bracket Antistatic Brush Shock Absorber Cover Grommet Sliding Tape Fuse Fuse Fuse Fuse Fuse Fuse Fuse Fuse Bracket Sponge Tape
2 1 1 1 1 1 4 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 2 1 4 4 6 2 1 4 W35 x L620 250V4A F2, F3, F9~12 250V0.5A F4, F5 250V2A F6 250V5A F1, F7, F8, F13 1 1 T12xW10xL140 T8 x W20 x L70 T12 x W20 x L80 T12 x W10 x L40
33 34 32 31 31 32 21 22
21
3-BR4x8
E E E
E 21
3-BR48
C
21 40
E E D E E E
41
26 B 27
5-TR46 3-BR48
E D E D E E D D E E D AT
DETAIL A
2-BR48
3 2
2-BR48 5-TR46
28
5-T46
1
4-BR48
5 30 6 7 DETAIL B 22 23 24 25 28
5-TR46
5
2-BR48
29 DETAIL D 18 14 19 20 13
AT AT AT
8
2-BR48
2-BR48
DETAIL C 17
E D
2-BR48
FR1Z0014.EPS
40 41
356N8850 382N0994
SP - 20
SP - 21
03A
03A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D E
FR1Z0015.EPS
107Y0163A/B 319Y1132A *** *** 341N0954A 322SF109 362N0450A 388N2389A 319N3335A 388N3076A 341N0860B 347N0745 308S1422610 356N5913A 356N5896A 356N5947 356N5907B 388N3075A 322SY064 398N0057D 322SY054 356N5908 387N0181 382N1693
Solenoid Shaft Assembly Arm Arm Arm Bearing Support Extension Spring Shaft Torsion Coil Spring Arm Spacer Sems Screw Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Torsion Coil Spring Plain Bearing Shutter Plain Bearing Bracket Antistatic Brush Tape
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4-S 1 1 1 1 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
SOLA1 to 4 # 5116 or earlier # 5116 or earlier # 5117 or later FLW684ZZA For REF3.1,3.2 # 5116 or earlier
E E D E D E D E E E
3.3
3.2
Dia.4 x 20 M2.6 x 10
5 2 3.1
E3
E E
B36
E E D D D D
7
43-B36 BQ410
E D D
4-BR430 4-Na4
20
4-B36 4-B310
19 18
REF.3.1REF.3.2 REF.3.303B REF.26.2 REF.21REF.22 REF.3.1 or REF.3.2 should be replaced with both REF.3.3 and REF.26.2 of Index 03B. REF.21 and REF.22 should be replaced in combination.
8
17
10 9
3-BR48
11 21 22 16
2-B36
13 11 14 12
2-BR48
15
FR1Z0016.EPS
5-BR48
SP - 22
SP - 23
03B
1 2 3
Q312 SW3
03B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 13 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
898Y0534 363Y0287 363N1787A 332N3463A 388N1142 363N1708A 362N0441B 332N3464A 384N0047 362N0440A 332N3465A 384N0045 363N1813B 384N0046 356N5914C 363N1788A 347N0704 313N0967 322SY146 356N5915C 388N1143 104N0044
Kit Guide Assembly Guide Stopper Compression Coil Spring Bracket Guide Support Stopper Tape Support Stopper Tape Guide Tape Bracket Guide Spacer Stay Plain Bearing Bracket Compression Coil Spring Photo Sensor Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Guide Stopper Guide Stopper Guide Assembly Compression Coil Spring Bracket Photo Sensor Bracket Bracket Guide
1 4 1 1 1 1 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 4 4 4 4 8 4 8 3 4 4 4 4 1 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 4 4 4 1 1 16
42
BQ41030
E E
FR1Z0017.EPS
8 7
SW3 BR48
E D E D D
Q312 S310
9 10
BR48
356N5917D/6416B
15
Q312
30
BQ410
BR48
41
BQ41030
D D D D D D D E D E
17 33
Q312 SW3
12 13
7 x 160
32
Q312 SW3
Y
BR48 BR48
2-Q48
31
S310
16 x 45 39 x 50
5 X
34 15 16 35
BR48
Dia.3 x 2.5 HPF-0505 13 /For tiers NO.1~3 L31.3 SA3,7,11,15 # 5116 or earlier # 5117 or later 4 /For tiers NO.4
2-Q48
18(Ver.C)
E D E
29 36 36
BQ410 BR48
28
22 18(Ver.B) 19
D D E E
26.1 *** 26.2 356N8486 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 356N6200 356N5897E 356N5905D 363N1787A 332N3463A 363N1786A 332N3462A 363Y0289 388N1142 104N0043 356N5912B/C 356N6201 363Y0357 308S8190410
37
BR48 Q412 2-B310
X
Q412 BR48 BR48
BR48 Q412
Y
B310
23
22 21 24 20
E E E D D D
356N5902C/6415B
D D D E D E E E D
L43.1 SA1,5,9,13
26.1
2-Q412 BR48 BR48
26.2
25
356N5904C/6414B
27
2-Q412
2-Q412
38 39 Z
BQ4 x 10 (SCM )
REF.26.1 REF.26.203A REF.3.3 REF.26.1 should be replaced with both REF.26.2 and REF.3.3 of Index 03A.
2-Q412
40
2-BR48
FR1Z0018.EPS
SP - 24
SP - 25
03C
03C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D D
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
388N2306 360N0339A 322N0021A 356N5949A 334Y3160 356N5895B/C 104N0044 388N2407 356N5948 308S3420210 128Y0241A 356N5903A 128Y0258B 356N5910C 388N5214
Extension Spring Housing Bearing Bracket Rubber Roller Bracket Photo Sensor Extension Spring Bracket Double Sems Screw Micro Switch Bracket Micro Switch Assembly Bracket Leaf Spring
4 8 8 8 4 1 1 4 3 8-S 4 4 4 4 4
L117.5
10
11 12
FR1Z0019.EPS
E D E D
13 14 15
BR48 W3 B36
D E E D E D E D
BR48
1 2 3
4-BR412
4 5
BR48
5 A 5
B36
3 2 8
5
B36
4
B36
4-BR412
(4/4 Places
FR1Z0020.EPS
SP - 26
SP - 27
04A
1
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 1
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
1
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 1
QTY.
04A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
Q425 SW4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44
318N1049 327N5202004A 322SF126 319N3339A 347N1480A 318N1048 327N1201603A 356N5920B 347N0746 356N5825B 356N6410 322N0028A 334N3488 356N6388 383Y0065 319N3447 347N0240 322SY067 334N3489 356N6411 363Y0276B 363Y0275B 363Y0274B 356N6409 347N0701 363N1763A 388N1701 356N5816B 347N0524 347N1479A 323S3255 324N3121 318N1042A 319N3338A 327N4201R04A 318N1057 322SF069 356N5819B 356N6364 118YX165 324N3093A/B 356N5818A 401N0741 356N5824B
Bush Gear Bearing Shaft Spacer Bush Gear Bracket Spacer Bracket Bracket Shaft Support Rubber Roller Bracket Wire Shaft Spacer Plain Bearing Rubber Roller Bracket Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate Bracket Spacer Guide Compression Coil Spring Bracket Spacer Spacer Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Bush Shaft Gear Bush Bearing Bracket Bracket Stepping Motor Timing Belt Wheel Bracket Counter Plate Bracket
1 1 3 1 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 4 3 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Dia.4 x 12
1 2 3
Q412 E10 SW4
FR1Z0021.EPS
D D E E E D E E
35 34
A
Q412 SW4
Dia.4 x 8.5
36
Dia.4 x 25
E8
37
B
E D D E
2-A410
33 32 37 31
Q412
38 42
BR48 E4 BR48
D E E
Dia.3 x 8
6 7
2-BR48
SW4
30
SW4 SW4 W4
40
D D E D D D E E D
41
39
3 29
28 27 26
2-B36 BR430
30
A
S38
43
S36(3B)
D E
25
44
W4
5
C
2-BR48 W4 SW4 SW4 E10
E E D
Q412
SW4
D E E D E D E
BR48
21
24
3-B310
6 7
3
B36
W4
SW4
19
E3
22
B36 4-BQ410 B36
6900ZZNR
20
18
16 15 14
B310
17
2-B36 B312 2-BR48 B36
BR48
BR48
9
C
8
BR430
E D D
MB3, 103H7123-0642
B36
23 10
B310
E E
B310
13
B310
12
B36
11
2-BR48 2-BR48 009-051-12 03.30.2002 FM3332(1)
FR1Z0022.EPS
SP - 28
SP - 29
04B
2
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 2
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
2
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 2
QTY.
04B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E D
FR1Z0023.EPS
1 2 3 4 5
1 1 1 1 1 Dia.3 x 10 CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later
E E
BR312 BR36
BR48
5
BR36
4-BR48 2-BR48
6.1
356N5817C
Bracket
6.1
E 6.2 356N8785A Bracket 1
A
BR48
7.1
133Y2029
Motor Pump
PB1 (CM-15)
7.2
133Y1031A/B
Motor Pump
11
D 8.1 134Y0050 Solenoid Valve 1 SVB1 (SV2013FD)
8.1 9
10 13 14 15
B310
16.1
D
2-B310
8.2 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Solenoid Valve Switch Sems Screw Nozzle Bracket Hose Hose Diverge Tube Hose
1 1 2-S 1 1 1 1 1 1 Dia.4 x Dia.7 x L60 Dia.4 x Dia.4 x L33 Dia.4 x Dia.7 x L75 SB5 (1000m/mH20) M2.6 x 14
2-WP48 (3B)
12 38 23
B36
7.1 18 19
E E
37
17 18 29
E3
20 21
2-Q412 2-SW4
E D D E
30
E3
22
30
31
29
39 36 33 40
41
3-Q412 3-SW4
42.1
42.2
D 16.1 370NB060
B36
D D E E
16.2 370NB045 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 370NB020 372S0050 372S0048 372S0053 316S0146 118YX164 322SF061 347N0636 323S3073 324N3041E 324N3123B 341N0866C 315S0011/0040 322SY061
Hose Hose Joint Joint Joint Clamp Stepping Motor Bearing Spacer Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Arm Retaining Ring Plain Bearing
1 1 2 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 4 4
CR-IR341:#5001 or later
6.2
2-BR48
26
E4
E E D D E
BR48
25
23 8.2 35 34
27 24
E3
B36
D D
33
32
B36
D E
29
30
31 30
E3
2-B310
29
28
7.2 16.2
FR1Z0024.EPS
SP - 30
SP - 31
04B
RANK REF. PART NO.
2
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 2
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO.
BLANK PAGE
E E D D E E E E E D E E E
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
341N0864 347N0276 322SF103 104N0044 356N5821A 347N0734 341N0865A 347N0831 319N3337B 104N0043 356N5813A/B
Arm Spacer Bearing Photo Sensor Bracket Spacer Arm Spacer Shaft Photo Sensor Bracket Bracket Bracket
SP - 32
SP - 33
04C
3
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 3
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
3
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 3
QTY.
04C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E E
FR1Z0025.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8.1
2 2 5 1 1 1 1 2
EF (TAC) /EF elbow (TAC joint) BF3.2 BS-04 Dia.1.5 x Dia.3.5 x L20 BTU-4 x 2.5-BSN Dia.1.5 x Dia.3.5 x L180 CR-IR341: #2711 or earlier R-IR361: #2005 or earlier CR-IR341: #2712 or later CR-IR361: #2006 or later
D E D E D
80F-0304
D E E E D E E E A A E E
8.2 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
322SY048 356Y0174 356N5967 362N0469A 322SF103 347N0727 309S0002 362N0468 392N0010 375S0040 356N5975A 356N5828C
Plain Bearing Bracket Bracket Support Bearing Spacer Polypropylene Slider Spacer Suction Cup Packing Bracket Bracket Hose
2 1 1 1 2 2
80F-0303
1 2 2 1 1 1
13
E3 E3
See 04B 12 1 2 3 22 4 6 3 5 3
B36 B36 B36 B36
20.1 370NC070
See 04B
1 1 1 1 1
9
E
CR-IR341: #2711 or earlier CR-IR361: #2005 or earlier CR-IR341: #2712 or later CR-IR361: #2006 or later
8
2-B310
D E
20 3
B36
B36
10 2 1 11 12
21 19
2-B36
*REF.20.2REF.8.2 REF.20.1REF.8.1
2-B36
18 17 16
Q312 Na3
15 13 14
E3
*The REF. 20.2 and REF. 8.2 must be paired. The REF. 20.1 and REF. 8.1 must be paired as well.
2-B36
17 16 24 23 See 04B
FR1Z0026.EPS
E3
SP - 34
SP - 35
04D
4
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 4
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
4
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 4
QTY.
04D
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29
334N3461A 334N3459A 363N1762D 356N5944 113Y1395 334N3462A 363Y0310A 363Y0486 334N3460A 313N1030 322SF050 360N0339A 388N2390 327N1121608A 113Y1038 347N1196A 308S1422614 346N0979A 305N0014A 337S0003 118YX164 388N2391 319N2940 322SF017 324N3098A/B 324N3041E 323S3287 324N3125 324N3038C
Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Guide Plate Bracket Board Assembly Rubber Roller Guide Guide Plate Rubber Roller Stay Bearing Housing Extension Spring Spur Gear Board Assembly Spacer Sems Screw Reinforcement Nut Wheel Stepping Motor Extension Spring Shaft Bearing Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel
1 1 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 8 8 2 4 1 1 2-S 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 291-3M-9 /UNITTA 291-3M-9 WA676ZZA Dia.50 Dia.6.35 D5063 MB2, 103H7123-0612 L84.4 M2.6 x 14 SB2 L89.7 WBC8-14ZZA SB4
1
FR1Z0027.EPS
D E E D D E E
B36 2-BR48
2 3
D E D D
4 5
D D D E E
6 9 7 7
BR48
E D E
7
2-B36 2-B48
D D E
D D D D D
X Y 10 11 12 13 14
11 12 11 12 22 28 27
E6 WP(3B)
13 19 16 15
2-A38
14
29
E6
BR430
24
25
24
23
22
12
11 17 18 20 21
E4
2-A410
26
FR1Z0028.EPS
SP - 36
SP - 37
04E
5
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 5
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
5
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 5
QTY.
04E
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E D
FR1Z0029.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
319N3340 356N5814A 322SF017 324N3098A/B 322SF050 360N0339A 388N2384 324N3038C 323S3288 319N2940 324N3125 347N0636 322SF061 324N1026A 347N0834 323S3281 327N1121608A 388N2385
Shaft Bracket Bearing Timing Belt Wheel Bearing Housing Extension Spring Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Shaft Timing Belt Wheel Spacer Bearing Flat Belt Wheel Spacer Timing Belt Spur Gear Extension Spring
1 1 12 2 16 16 4 5 1 5 2 1 2 4 1 1 8 4 L91.9 Dia.8 x 16 177-3M-9 /UNITTA 177-3M-9 Dia.8 x 4 SC866ZZNRCS09/1 KG1 705-3M-9 /UNITTA 705-3M-9 L78.4 WBC8-14ZZA WA676ZZA
D D D D D D E D E
BR48
2 5 6 7
4 3
E4
D D E D
8 A
E6
D D
A 1 5 6 7 8
E6
A
E6
5 6 10 5 6 17 18 5 6 17 18 5 6 17 18 5 6 17 8 16
E6
8 A
3 4 3
13 12 11
E6
5 6 7 8
E6
10 3 14 3
18
4-BR430
DETAIL"A" 13 15
E6
11
FR1Z0030.EPS
SP - 38
SP - 39
04F
4
4-Q312 4-BR48 4-B310 4-Na3
6
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 6
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
6
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 6
QTY.
04F
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
2-BR48
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
322SF044 315S0008/0048 388N2392A 356N5815B 322SY097 341N0863A 363N1765B 334N3463A 334N3465A 334N3464A 363N1800A 363Y0311
Bearing Retaining Ring Extension Spring Bracket Plain Bearing Arm Guide Plate Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Guide Guide
7
2-BR48
FR1Z0031.EPS
D D
7
2-BR48
E D E D D D
3 2
4-S38 (3B)
4-E4
D D
5 6 1
11
12
5 12 10 5 12 10 5
E4 E4 E4
10
5
E4
10
FR1Z0032.EPS
SP - 40
SP - 41
04G
7
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 7
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
7
UP-DOWN IP REMOVAL UNIT 7
QTY.
04G
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D E
FR1Z0033.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
356N6360 333N7000B 319N3448 383Y0065 356N6359 313N0958C/D 365N0089 356N5829 318N1053A 327N6204701A 346N0978B 401N0741 356N5826A 356N5831B 356N5827B 308S1422610 401N0740 356N6362 356N6361 388N2421 356N5823A 313N1032
Bracket Reel Shaft Wire Bracket Stay Rail Bracket Bush Rack Reinforcement Counter Plate Bracket Bracket Bracket Sems Screw Counter Plate Bracket Bracket Extension Spring Bracket Stay
D E E D E E
3 1
BR416
E E E
E
BR416
5 3
E E E
E E D E E
BR416 3-BR48
7 8
3-T46 (3B)
3-T46 (3B)
7 8
X
4-BR420
9
3-B46
12
11
20 2 3
BR48 BR416
21 10 9 19
2-BR48
10
18
2-BR48 2-BR48
E4
14
BR48
2-BR48
13
2 15
2-B310
22 17
BR48
2-B36
16
FR1Z0034.EPS
SP - 42
SP - 43
05A
1
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
PART NAME QTY.
05A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D E
FR1Z0035.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
319N3324 322SY121 341N0858B 322SF017 324N3124 323S3289 388N3073B 347N0832 322SF061 347N0818 324N3038C 322SF050 360N0339A 388N2384 327N1121608A 388N2386 356N6014 388N3074B 341N0857B 323S3066 356N5805B 388N2388 341N0867 356N5803 107Y0163B 113Y1038 347N1196A 356N5806A 347N1174 322N0020A
Shaft Plain Bearing Arm Bearing Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Torsion Coil Spring Spacer Bearing Spacer Timing Belt Wheel Bearing Housing Extension Spring Spur Gear Extension Spring Bracket Torsion Coil Spring Arm Timing Belt Bracket Extension Spring Arm Bracket Solenoid Board Assembly Spacer Bracket Spacer Bearing
2 4 1 4 2 1 1 2 2 2 2 8 8 3 6 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 SOLC1 SC1,2 L29.4 207-3M-9/ UNITTA 207-3M-9 L115.9 L78.4 WBC8-14ZZA Dia.8 x 14 SC866ZZNRCS09/1 KG1 Dia.8 x 5 240-3M-9 /UNITTA 240-3M-9 WA676ZZA 80F-0805
D D
2-BR48
6 5 4
D D E
4
BR48
B36 E6
D E D D D D
7 9 10 11
2 12 13
E6
14 15 13 14 15
D E D E D
12
2-BR48 BR48
9 10 11
E6
8 18 12
12
13
14 15
D E E D
13 1 2 19 4 5 4
B36 2-B36
2
E6 2-BR48
17 16
D E E E D
20
2-BR48 2-BR412
21
B310
30 29 24 26
2-BR48
22 23
3-B36
2-A310
2-B36
25 27
2-A310
28
26
FR1Z0036.EPS
SP - 44
SP - 45
05B
3 2 1
E6
2
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
RANK REF. PART NO.
2
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
PART NAME QTY.
05B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
5 4
FR1Z0037.EPS
D D D D D D D E D E D
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
323S3220 324N3038C 388N2385 360N0339A 322SF050 322SF017 324N1026A 319N2940 305N0014A 319N3322A 322SF061 347N0818 356N6014 388N2387 323S3082 118YX165 324N3041E 323S3072 324N3121 318N1042A 319N3326A
Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Extension Spring Housing Bearing Bearing Flat Belt Wheel Shaft Nut Shaft Bearing Spacer Bracket Extension Spring Timing Belt Stepping Motor Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Bushing Shaft
1 6 3 8 8 6 3 3 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Dia.4 x 6.5 192-3M-9 /UNITTA 192-3M-9 L137.9 420-3M-9 /UNITTA 420-3M-9 MC1, 103H7123-0642 SC866ZZNRCS09/1 KG1 Dia.8 x 5 WA676ZZA L91.9
9 8
BR430
6 6 7 6 6 7 9 8
BR430
E E D
5
E6
4 2 3 5 6
BR430
4 3 2
E6
D D D D D E
2-B36
5 4 13
E6
11 12 2 10
14
E6
15 DETAIL A
21
Q412 SW4
20
E4
19 18
3-A410
17 X
E6
12 11 2
16
FR1Z0038.EPS
SP - 46
SP - 47
05C
3
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
RANK REF. PART NO.
3
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
PART NAME QTY.
05C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D D
FR1Z0039.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Cover Guide Plate Rubber Roller Guide Plate Rubber Roller Guide Plate Rubber Roller Ring Shaft
1 1 1 1 2 1 3 3 1
E D E D E E
5
2-B36
4 3 2
4-BR48
1
2-B36 4-B36
5 6
3-WP48
7
6-B36
8 7 7 9
FR1Z0040.EPS
SP - 48
SP - 49
05D
4
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
RANK REF. PART NO.
4
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
PART NAME QTY.
05D
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D D
FR1Z0041.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
322SY121 334N3457A 334N3456A 347N0580 313N0952C 363Y0284A 319N3328B 322SY054 363Y0283B 363N1757B
Pain Bearing Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Spacer Stay Guide Shaft Pain Bearing Guide Guide Plate
2 2 2 4 1 4 1 1 1 1
80F-0805
E E D D D
3 x 3.5
10
80F-0605
9 8
D E
4-BR36
7 6 4
B310
2 3
BR48
6 5 4
B310
6 4
B310
6 4
B310
1
BR48
BR48
BR48
FR1Z0042.EPS
SP - 50
SP - 51
05E
5
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
RANK REF. PART NO.
5
BEFORE-SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
PART NAME QTY.
05E
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E E
FR1Z0043.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7.1 7.2 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
363N1766D 350N1992B 347N0787 347N0784 334Y2197B 322SY121 334N5004B 334N5014 347N0821 327N1124001A 350N1991C 356N5804A 327N0035C 363Y0286B 363N1755C 356N6060
Guide Plate Cover Spacer Spacer Plastic Roller Plain Bearing Brush Roller Brush Roller Spacer Spur Gear Cover Bracket Spur Gear Guide Plate Guide Plate Bracket
1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 CR-IR341: #2369 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2369 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2369 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2369 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later Dia.8 x 8 80F-0805 Dia.6 x 5.5 Dia.6 x 4
E D D A A E D E E D D
2-B36 2-B36
15
17
E E
Y X
16
356N6059
Bracket
4-B36
16
17
387N7006
Antistatic Brush
L356
4-B36
E
E4 E6
18
387N0113
Antistatic Brush
L380
1 4 5
6 7 2
18
B310
9 10 6 8
BR48 B36 E4
11 13 12
Y
14
2-B36 2-B36
FR1Z0044.EPS
SP - 52
SP - 53
06A
1
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
1
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 1
QTY.
06A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D E
FR1Z0045.EPS
1 2.1
113Y7070A 356N7391B
1 1 CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later M2.6 x 10 W678ZZA W688ZZ CR-IR341: #3360 or earlier CR-IR361: #2396 or earlier CR-IR341: #3361 or later CR-IR361: #2397 or later
S38
1
4-B36
E E E
2.2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Bracket Cable Sems Screw Shaft Bearing Bushing Bearing Bushing Extension Spring
1 1 2-S 3 9 3 6 3 6 L121
2.1 5
B310 4-B36
E D D D D
3 8 6 9 8 10
S38
4 2.2 11
10.1 388N2395
7
BR48 B310 B310 NK
12 6 13
D
E4 T36 E4
5 6
8 7 9 8 10
6
Na3
10.2 388N2501 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 347N1261 329N7003B 324N3711B 319N7138 319N7119 333N7000B 401N0749 383Y0059 383Y0057 383Y0058 322SF050 322SY055 342N7002B 347N7061A 342N7001B 319N7118A 113Y1038 347N1196A 347S0068 383Y0063 383Y0064 341N7047B 313N1038 319N7112B 356N7347A 347N0404 388N2729 388N2721A 347N0704 328N7003B
Extension Spring Spacer Cam Timing Belt Wheel Shaft Shaft Reel Counter Plate Wire Wire Wire Bearing Plain Bearing Lever Spacer Lever Shaft Board Assembly Spacer Spacer Wire Wire Arm Stay Shaft Bracket Spacer Extension Spring Extension Spring Spacer Claw
6 3 3 1 3 3 6 6 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
BR48
29
S38
15 14 11 12 6 6
16
3-B36
D D E E D E D D
17 18
7 10
6
Na3 E4
14 28 27 8 9 8 6 11 12 26 22 25 24
BR425 E6
19 6
Na3
14
T36 E4
20
T36
D D D E E E E D E E D D E E E E
X
E3
2-A310
21
23
22
BQ410
2-BR48 2-B36
A 30
35
BR48 E3 E3
36 37
D D E D
34
B310
2-B36
A
BR48
X 31
E3
B312
40
Na3
38 39
33
32 16 17
BR48
DETAIL A
FR1Z0046.EPS
SP - 54
SP - 55
06B
6.2
2
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
2
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 2
QTY.
06B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1 2 3 4 5 6.1
Timing Belt wheel Polypropylene Slider Bearing Cam Spacer Extension Spring
3 Dia.8 /For looseness W678ZZA Dia.8 x 2.6 L121 CR-IR341: #3360 or earlier CR-IR361: #2396 or earlier CR-IR341: #3361 or later CR-IR361: #2397 or later
Y1
FR1Z0047.EPS
E D D E
9 3 3 3
Y2
D
6.2
Y1
S38
D D
6.2 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
388N2395 322SF004 318N1014A 319N7114B 318N1059A 319N7119 319N7138 333N7000B 401N0749 383Y0059 383Y0058 383Y0057 388N2396 322SF050 322SY055 342N7004B 347N7061A 319N7136 322SF017 324N1026A 342N7003B 347N0727 347N0742 388N2722A 319N7137 324N3098A/B 118YX165 324N3041E 356N7384B 323S3077 356N6045
Extension Spring Bearing Bushing Shaft Bushing Shaft Shaft Reel Counter Plate Wire Wire Wire Extension Spring Bearing Plain Bearing Lever Spacer Shaft Bearing Flat Belt Wheel Lever Spacer Spacer Extension Spring Shaft Timing Belt Wheel Motor Timing Belt Wheel Bracket Timing Belt Bracket
6 6 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 2 12 4 1 1 2 1 5 2 1 1 1 1 1
L121 W688ZZ
9
Y3
6.2 5 3 1
E4 E4 T36
8 7 7 6.1
B310
D E D D
3 10
S38
4 3
Na3
Y2
2-BR48
E D E D D D
9 8 7 3 10 3
Na3
36
B310 B310
L311.7 L260.7 L238.4 L118 WBC8-14ZZA 80F-0806 Dia.10 x 11.4 WA676ZZA CR-IR341: #3360 or earlier CR-IR361: #2396 or earlier
13
3-B36
12 4 3
E4
2 11 6.1 5
S38
D D D E E E D D E E
14 15 35 B
E4
2 2
X 10 18
Na3
Y3
12 17 12 16
6.1 9 7 8 7 4 5 23 22 23 28 26 27 28
Q46 SW4
A A A
E3
T36 T36
2
E4 E4 E6
2 3
E D E D D D E D E
19
BR420
20
22 21 25 24 24 20 E4
BR420 A410
MD3, 103H7123-0642
34 33 32
E4 3-BR48
29 X
BR420
936-3M-9
3-B310
30 25 24
E4
2-B310
30 31 24 24
E4
3-A410
24
DETAIL A
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
DETAIL B
FR1Z0048.EPS
SP - 56
SP - 57
06C
3
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
3
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 3
QTY.
06C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D D
FR1Z0049.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6
Guide Plate Guide Plate Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Guide Plate
2 1 1 3 2 1
D D E
3-B36 4-B36
3-B36 8-B36
6 5
FR1Z0050.EPS
SP - 58
SP - 59
06D
4
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
4
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 4
QTY.
06D
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1.1
356N7383B
Bracket
FR1Z0051.EPS
1.2
356N8843
Bracket
CR-IR341:#5001 or later
D 2.1 852N0016 Bar Code Reader 1 IDT/For IDT
1.2
D E 2.2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 852N0019B 319N7120B 356N7351B 323S3295 324N3710B 318N1700A 104N0043 356N7419A 118YX165 324N3041E 347S0068 322SF012 329Y0015A 329Y0016A 356N6212 356N6213 387N0103/B Bar Code Reader Shaft Bracket Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Bushing Photo Sensor Bracket Motor Timing Belt Wheel Spacer Bearing Cam Cam Bracket Bracket Antistatic Brush 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 SA7M4-30-F FLW688ZZ MD2, 103H7123-0642 Dia.4 x 7.5 SD2 285-3M-9 /UNITTA 285-3M-9
CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier CR-IR361: #2442 or earlier CR-IR341: #5001 or later
1.1 2.2
4-B36
E D D E D E D D E
4-B36
3 2.1 5
2-B36
D D E E D
6
E 19 356N6710A Bracket 1
15 13
3-A410 SW4 Q412
2-B36
7 9
E4 SW4
7 12
Q412
20
356N6711
Bracket
21
387N0088
Antistatic Brush
16 17
BR48
CR-IR341: #2370 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2370 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2370 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #2370 or later CR-IR361: #2001 or later
10 20
11
3-B48
13 14
7
SW4
18 19 21
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
20
Q412
FR1Z0052.EPS
SP - 60
SP - 61
06E
5
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
5
SIDE-POSITIONING CONVEYOR 5
QTY.
06E
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D E D
FR1Z0053.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
322SY054 319N7115 388N2724 316N0755D 322SY093 334N2714A 319N7116 328N7002A 322SY067 310N0706 319N7139 388N2723 334N2339B 319N3438 365N7002 305N0014A 355N7051B 356N7343A 104N0044 356N7344B 319N7111 324N3041E 356N7342A 316N7054A 323S3098 356N6224A 356N7346D 118YX159
Plain Bearing Shaft Extension Spring Clamp Plain Bearing Plastic Roller Shaft Claw Plain Bearing Pin Shaft Extension Spring Roller Shaft Rail Nut Frame Bracket Photo Sensor Bracket Shaft Timing Belt Wheel Bracket Clamp Timing Belt Bracket Bracket Motor
2 1 1 1 2 1 1 2 4 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
80F-0605 L21.5
E D D E D D D E D
80F-0403
L37.1
1
E4
D E D D E
E D E E D E
SD1
3 4
E4
E D E
5 6 5 7
2-B36 B316 B36 E4 4-B36 E4
E D
MD1, 103G770-2251
8 10
2-BR48
9
B325
9 11
2-BR48
26
BR48
4-A410
28
12 24 23
2-B46 BR48
8 10 9
B325
9 11 19 18 17 14
BR48
27 25
3-BR48
13
2-B36
20
BR435
21 16 15
4-T46
22
E4
22
FR1Z0054.EPS
SP - 62
SP - 63
07A
1
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 1
PART NAME QTY.
07A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D D
FR1Z0055.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
319N7114B 322SF041 318N1014A 322SF004 318N1059A 388N2395 347N1261 329N7003B 319N7138 324N3711B 333N7000B 401N0749 383Y0062 383Y0060 383Y0061 347N7061A 342N7004B 322SY055 322SF050 319N7136 313N7040B 319N7119
Shaft Bearing Bushing Bearing Bushing Extension Spring Spacer Cam Shaft Timing Belt Wheel Reel Brace Wire Wire Wire Spacer Lever Plain Bearing Bearing Shaft Stay Shaft
3 9 3 6 3 6 3 3 3 1 4 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 4 80F-0806 WBC8-14ZZA L405.5 L216.7 L245.7 Dia.10 x 11.4 L121 Dia.8 x 2.6 W688ZZ W678ZZA
D D D E D
S38
2 3
D D E D
4-S38
8 2 1 4 6
S38 E4
D D E E D
7 3
E4 Na3
2 2 5 1
BQ410 S38 BQ410
T36
10
E4
D E E E
9 11
22 6 8 2 12 1 4 7
E4 Na3 4-B36
13
2 21
E4
E4
3 6 2 8
4 9 21 20 14
T36 Na3 E4 E4
4 15 7 9 16 17
T36 E4
18
BR420
E6 E3
19
FR1Z0056.EPS
SP - 64
SP - 65
07B
2
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 2
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
2
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 2
QTY.
07B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
323S3290 324N3711B 309S0006 322SF041 329N7003B 347N1261 388N2395 318N1059A 318N1014A 322SF004 319N7138 383Y0062 401N0749 333N7000B 322SF017 324N1026A 319N7137 356N6042A 319N7114B 347N0742 383Y0060 319N7136 347N7061A 383Y0061 342N7001B 322SY055 322SF050 342N7005B 347N0727 388N2731 356N7385D 324N3041E 118YX165 319N7119 356N6739
Timing Belt Timing Belt Wheel Polypropylene Slider Bearing Cam Spacer Extension Spring Bushing Bushing Bearing Shaft Wire Brace Reel Bearing Flat Belt Wheel Shaft Bracket Shaft Spacer Wire Shaft Spacer Wire Lever Plain Bearing Bearing Lever Spacer Extension Spring Bracket Timing Belt Wheel Motor Shaft Bracket
1 3
804-3M-9 /UNITTA 804-3M-9 Dia.8 /For looseness W678ZZA Dia.8 x 2.6 L121
8 7 5 4 3
E4 Na3
FR1Z0057.EPS
D D D D
S38
9 3 3 3 3 3 6 3 1 4 4 4 2 1 1 3 2 1 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 4 1
D D D E
4-S38
10 6 11 4 16 15 34
E4
19 17
2-BR48
2 1
E4
W688ZZ
15
D E D D
T36
WA676ZZA
X 13 12
4-B36
14 7 5 4 3
Na3
4 18
BR420
S38
D E E E
19
20 10
BR420
S38
E D E E D E
Dia.4 x 16
E4
2 4 8
E4
19
Dia.10 x 11.4
Z 3
E4
6
Na3
3 4 10 9 10
T36
D D E E
2
E4
29 30
A410 BR420
11 21 22 23
D E D D
11
T36
25 24
E E
26 22 23 28 15 16 26
BR420
E4
27
E6 E3
Y 15
Z 31
32 33
E4
3-BR48
35
3-A410
FR1Z0058.EPS
SP - 66
SP - 67
07C
3
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 3
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
3
AFTER-READING CONVEYOR 3
QTY.
07C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D E D
FR1Z0059.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
334N3785B 363N7119C 334N3786 363Y1823A 334N3784A 322SF012 329Y0016A 318N1700A 104N0043 356N7419A 356N7351A 319N7120B 324N3710B 323S3295 347S0068 118YX165 324N3041E 356N6212 356N6213 329N7005D
Rubber Roller Guide Plate Rubber Roller Guide Plate Rubber Roller Bearing Cam Bushing Photo Sensor Bracket Sensor Dog Shaft Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Spacer Motor Timing Belt Wheel Bracket Bracket Cam
3 1 1 1 2 2 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 285-3M-9 /UNITTA 285-3M-9 SA7M4-30-F ME1, 103H7123-0642 Dia.4 x 7.5 SE1 FLW688ZZ
D D D D E D E E E D D
2 3
1 5 4
E D D E E D
X 5
Y 20 6 Z
10-B36 SW4
Q412 3-BR48
18 19
BR48 E4
17
2-B36
3-B36
14
15
3-A410
3-BR48
8 13
SW4 Q412
16
9 10
6 7
SW4 Q412
12
2-B36
11
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
FR1Z0060.EPS
SP - 68
SP - 69
08A
1 ERASURE CONVEYOR 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1 ERASURE CONVEYOR 1
PART NAME QTY.
08A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D D
FR1Z0061.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
322SF050 360N0339A 388N2384 327N1121608A 322SF061 347N0818 324N3038C 347N1196A 113Y1038 104Y0162 356N5871B 356N5870C 356N5872 347N1174 356N6028 382N1067
Bearing Housing Extension Spring Spur Gear Bearing Spacer Timing Belt Wheel Spacer Board Assembly Photo Sensor Bracket Bracket Bracket Spacer Bracket Tape
12 12 6 12 1 1 1 2 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 4
D D
1 2 16 3 1 2 3 4 4
E D E D D E E E E E
16
SF1,2,3 SF4
16 5 6 16 7
E6
1 2 1 2 3 4 1 2
2-BR48
1 2 3 4
3 4
8 9 8 9
2-A310
2-A310
15
2-B36
10
2-BR48
12 11
2-B36
B36 BR48
14
9
2-A310 2-BR48
13
FR1Z0062.EPS
SP - 70
SP - 71
08B
2 ERASURE CONVEYOR 2
RANK REF. PART NO.
2 ERASURE CONVEYOR 2
PART NAME QTY.
08B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
337S0003 118YX164 324N3041E 356N5894A 347S0098/0362 322SF029 356N5858A 323S3072 318N1051A 318N1042A 324N3121 324N3038C 347N0818 322SF061 388N2385 360N0339A 322SF050 347N1478A 319N3332B 334N3466A 334N3467A 356N5875B 356N5874B 324N3106B 323S3283 322SF017 324N3098A/B 319N2940 305N0014A 347N0389
Wheel Stepping Motor Timing Belt Wheel Bracket Spacer Bearing Bracket Timing Belt Bushing Bushing Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Wheel Spacer Bearing Extension Spring Housing Bearing Spacer Shaft Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Bracket Bracket Timing Belt Wheel Timing Belt Bearing Timing Belt Wheel Shaft Nut Spacer
1 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 7 1 2 6 12 12 3 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 12 6 6 1 1
Q420
14 12 13
FR1Z0063.EPS
D D E E D E D
SW4
10
3-BR48
SB8M4-10-F
SW4
3-BR48
11 6 4 2 3
E4
E E D D E D
WP44
SW4
D D D
SW4
18 19
4-A410
E E D D E E D D D
1 17 15 12 15
E6
SW4
18 18 17 16
20
16
22
3-BR48
21 23
20
12
1260-D3M9 WA676ZZA
17 16 17
3-BR48
21
D E D E
E6
15 12 15
E6
16
12
E6
A B B
E6
15 B 12
16
17
E6
17 15 12 14 29 28 26 27 26 26
5-BR430
16
25
E6
30 24
27
26
28
BR430
DETAIL A
DETAIL B
FR1Z0064.EPS
SP - 72
SP - 73
08C
X
3 ERASURE CONVEYOR 3
RANK REF. PART NO.
3 ERASURE CONVEYOR 3
PART NAME QTY.
08C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D E
FR1Z0065.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
334N3457A 334N3456A 363N1777C 363Y0485 363N1923A 356N6029A 356N5960A 388N2728B 341N0867 322N0020A 322SF061 107Y0166 356N5869B 334N3556 338N0219A 319N3329A 322SY054 363Y0294A 363N1819
Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Guide Plate Guide Plate Guide Plate Bracket Bracket Extension Spring Arm Bearing Bearing Solenoid Assembly Bracket Rubber Roller Ring Shaft Plain Bearing Guide Guide Plate
D E E E D E D
D D E
D E E D
Z 4
1 2
D E
5 1 2 X Y
Z 14 17 19 18
4-BR36 3-WP48
15 16
E6
2-S36
11
7 10 9 8
B310
6
2-BR48
2-BR412 4-B36
3-BR48
12 13
FR1Z0066.EPS
SP - 74
SP - 75
08D
4-B36
4 ERASURE CONVEYOR 4
RANK REF. PART NO.
4 ERASURE CONVEYOR 4
PART NAME QTY.
08D
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E D D
FR1Z0067.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
345N1264A 363Y0308A 334N3457A 334N3456A 363N1775C 407N0099 356N6026 308S1422610 356N5878A 356N5866C 310N0605A 386N0707 386N0706 356N5867B/C 386N0710 603Y7001 347N0226 356N5886C/D 407N0092B 401N0738A/B 401N0737 386N0739 386N0734
Cover Guide Plate Rubber Roller Rubber Roller Guide Plate Reflective Plate Bracket Sems Screw Bracket Bracket Pin Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Bracket Sponge Tape Filter Spacer Bracket Reflective Plate Brace Brace Shock Absorber Sponge Tape
D E E E
E E E E D D E D A E E
3
4-B36
5 X
D E E D D
4-B36 3-B310
22
22
4-B36
7 20
2-B36 2-BR48 2-BR48
21 19
23
9
2-BQ410 BR48
10
2-BR48 2-BR48
11 15
18
15
X 15 15
2-BR48 2-S36
12
13 12
B46
14 16 17
5-BR48
FR1Z0068.EPS
SP - 76
SP - 77
09
30
LAMP UNIT
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
LAMP UNIT
QTY. REMARKS
09
SERIAL NO.
D D D
FR1Z0069.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
386N0701 386N0700 386N0703 386N0702A 358N0153B 119Y1097 358N0154B/C 356N5861A/B 356N5864E 356N5964A/B 356N5963A/B 356N5892 318S3054 313N0963A 407N0094A 386N0709 356N5868A/B 120Y0074A 362N0467A 388N5184A 115S0072/B 305N0037 123N0008 120Y0075A 362N0466A 407N0093B 386N0699
Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Box Fan Box Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Bracket Grommet Stay Reflective Plate Sponge Tape Bracket Socket Support Leaf Spring Thermo Switch Nut Lamp Socket Support Reflective Plate Sponge Tape Thermo Switch Thermo Switch Bracket Lamp Unit
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 5 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1
T10 x W8.6, W14 x L40 T10 x W10 x L129 T3 x W16.5 x L129 T10 x W6.6, W12 x L40
5 3 6 7(Ver.B)
D E D E
2 8
2-BR48
E E E E E D
MG-12 (5612)
2-BR48 2-BR48
E D D E D E D D
10
4-BR48
2-BR48
T8 x W10 x L27
11
3-BR48 2-BR48
12
4-B345
2-A36
13 28 14 27 7(Ver.C)
A D E D D D D
27 26
2-B36 5-B36
15 25 24 23
2-B36 BR48 2-BR48 2-B36
16 16 22 21 20
2-A34 2-B36 5-B36 2-BR412
17
19 18
29
FR1Z0070.EPS
SP - 78
SP - 79
10A
1 SUBSCANNING UNIT 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1 SUBSCANNING UNIT 1
PART NAME QTY.
10A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D E D
WP48 WP48
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
341N0853D 319N3327A 322SF043 317N1047A 388N2228B 401N0734A 401N0735A 319N3318A 322SF002 334N3453 388N2229B 602Y0105 309N0050 322SF021 334Y3153B 334Y3154 347N1472C 363N1747A 309S0025 347N0636 322SF061 337N0038 388N1073 323N0033 337N0052A 388N2222 118YX700/B 341N0852B 319N3312A 319N3319A 356N5796 310N0599A 323N0017 323N1221A 319N3314C 319N3317 341N0745 388N2227A 337N0043 113Y1325D 347N1797A
SED08A
Arm Shaft Bearing Cap Extension Spring Counter Plate Counter Plate Shaft Bearing Rubber Roller Extension Spring Mirror Assembly Washer Bearing Rubber Roller Assembly Rubber Roller Assembly Spacer Guide Plate Washer Spacer Rolling Bearing Wheel Spring Belt Flywheel Spring Motor Arm Shaft Shaft Bracket Pin Belt Belt Shaft Shaft Arm Spring Wheel SED08A Spacer
4 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 1 4 4 1 1 1 1 2 2 4 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 SZ1 CR-IR341: #3421 or earlier CR-IR361: #2000 or later L40.09 SE-G30SBC2 /KOBE STEEL L60.48 MZ1 /HOKUSHIN WW-16 Dia.8 x 4 SC866ZZNRCS09/ 1KG1 L31.86 ( ; 0.9) L31.86 (Wire diameter ; 0.9) W686ZZA L31.95 ( ; 1.0) L31.95 (Wire
6 1
WP48
4
FR1Z0071.EPS
D D
9 10
E4
E4 E4
E4 E4
E4
4 7
E E E D D D
WP48
2
WP48
WP48
9 11 10
1
WP48 WP48
9 9 17 12 3
BR412 3-BR48
DQ
S410
S410
14 41
B36
D D
14
B36
D D E E D
8 4 7
E4 E4 E4 E4 E4 E4 2-BR48
18
19
6 4 5 16 41 40 14 15 28 29 13 14 13
BR48 BR48 E6
19 22 24 25
SW8 W8
20 21
E6
E D D D D E D
21 23
Na8
26 27
DQ E E E E E
5-BR48
30
D D
E E E D D D E
Na3
31 32 32
BR48 Na3
BR48 BR48
33 34
BR48
31
Q316
35 37
12-BR48 BR48
E6
20 21
39
21
23 38
36
FR1Z0072.EPS
SP - 80
SP - 81
10B
2 SUBSCANNING UNIT 2
RANK REF. PART NO.
2 SUBSCANNING UNIT 2
PART NAME QTY.
10B
REMARKS SERIAL NO.
E CR E
FR1Z0073.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
350N2029B 113Y1328F/G 318S1216 350N2010D 347N1493B 356N6076A 309N0058A 606Y0032C 332N0458B 356N5802 388N1075A 319N3320 310N0598 341N0855A 346N0970A 338N0458 329N0134 329N0133 356N5784B 104N0043 356N5783A 118SX070/A 356N5782
PMT08A
Cover PMT08A Bush Cover Spacer Bracket Washer Light-collecting Guide Assembly Stopper Bracket Compression Coil Spring Shaft Pin Arm Reinforcement Ring Cam Cam Bracket Sensor Bracket Motor Bracket
E E E E DQ E
9 6 5 4 3 2 1 7 3 3 13 12 11
E4 2-BR48
E
B36
10
D E E E E E D D E D E D E
BR48
BR48
BR48
14
15
BR48
15
16 17
3-B36 B36
4-BR48 WP36
16 18
3-B36
19 21 20
22
B36
23 19 20 22
FR1Z0074.EPS
SP - 82
SP - 83
10C
24
3 SUBSCANNING UNIT 3
RANK REF. PART NO.
3 SUBSCANNING UNIT 3
PART NAME QTY.
10C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
D D D
4-B36
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
382N0913A 318S3050 382N0914A 350N1981B 350N1980C 382N0911A 382N0912B 310S1011 350N1982C 347N7063
Sponge Tape Grommet Sponge Tape Cover Cover Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Straight Pin Cover Spacer
1 1 2 1 1 2 1 3 1 4
4
2-BR48
FR1Z0075.EPS
3 8
E D D E D E
6 26 6 1 25 2 7 8 26
3-BR48
9
E D E E 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 356N5798A 386Y0021 332N0488/A 332N0456B/C 347S0098 356N5801G 356N5810C 356N5811A 350N1983C 356N5808C 347N1574 898Y0612 350Y1404B 382N1372 382N1373 356N8565 309N0049 Bracket Vibration Proof Rubber Assembly Stopper Stopper Spacer SCN08A Bracket Bracket Bracket Cover Bracket Spacer Kit Cover Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Bracket Washer
2 1 1 1 1 6 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 4 SCN08A F5 to F10(48V1A) M/M version or later SCN08A F1 to F4(48V2A) M/M version or later T3 x W20 x L50 T3 x W20 x L38 SB8M4-10-F 41 /A set of four
BR410
E
BR48
21 10, 22
BR410
10, 22
CR E E E
113Y1324J/K/L/M SCN08A
BR410 2-BR48
10
4-BR612 BR410
D E E E
BR48 2-BR48
E D D E E
20
2-BR48
11 10
2-BR48 BR612 W8
*1
18 17 16, 29, 30 19
2-BR48 BR612 W8
12
AT
29
137S1242
Fuse
BR612 W8
AT
30
137S1245
Fuse
28
BR612 W8 M4X12 3-BR48 2-BR48
27 28 21 14
BR410 2-BR48
23
BR410
22 22
6-BR48
15
* REF.23 * REF 23:Although the after-reading conveyor is not a service part, this kit is required when installing a new after-reading conveyor to an older model of the machine (~# xxxx ). *1) CR-IR341 : #2973 or earlier Except #2720, #2770, #2792, #2795, #2815, #2831, #2847, #2852, #2858, #2899, #2901, #2912, #2914, #2919, #2930, #2935, #2951, #2954, #2955, #2956, and #2961 CR-IR361 : #2157 or earlier Except #2041, #2073, #2084, #2098, #2107, #2135, #2145, and #2150
10C-REF.16 (SCN08A), 11-REF.1 (SCANNING OPTICS UNIT) SCANNING OPTICS UNIT / - Ver.J 11-REF1.1 839Y7002 11-REF1.2 839Y0021
TR1Z1002.EPS
13
2-BR48
SCN08A
FR1Z0076.EPS
Ver.K or later
SP - 84
SP - 85
11
11
SERIAL NO.
DR DR
FR1Z0077.EPS
1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 3 4 5.1 5.2 6 7 8 9 10 11
839Y7002C 839Y0021A 839Y0044 839Y0046 839Y7003D/E 839Y0022B 839Y0045 839Y0047 815Y7003 615Y7000A/B 124Y7000B 124Y0045C 382N1010 382N1011 356N8326A 350N2503A 345N1543A 138S0219
SYN08A LD LD
Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit Scanning Optics Unit SYN08A Assembly Polygonal Mirror Assembly LD Assembly LD Assembly Sponge Tape Sponge Tape Bracket Cover Cover Filter
DR DR DR DR DR
CR-IR341:#3240 or earlier CR-IR361:#2296 or earlier CR-IR341:#3241 to #3421 CR-IR361:#2297 to #2442 CR-IR341:#5001 or later CR-IR341:#2001 to #3240 CR-IR361:#2001 to #2296 CR-IR341:#3240 or earlier CR-IR361:#2296 or earlier CR-IR341:#3241 to #3421 CR-IR361:#2297 to #2442 CR-IR341:#5001 or later
DR C C CQ CQ D D E
CR-IR341:#3240 or earlier CR-IR361:#2296 or earlier CR-IR341:#3241 to #3421 #5001 or later CR-IR361: #2297 to #2442
E E
CR-IR341:#3397 or later CR-IR361:#2417 or later CR-IR341:#3397 or later CR-IR361:#2417 or later CR-IR341:#3397 or later CR-IR361:#2417 or later CR-IR341:#3397 or later CR-IR361:#2417 or later
4, 11 3
7 6
1 REF2.1 REF1.4 SCN08A 10C-REF16 113Y1324K 114Y5431003 A10 2 REF1.1 REF1.4 SCN08A 10C-REF16 113Y1324K 114Y5431003 A10 3 REF2.2 REF2.4 4 REF1.2 REF1.4 5 REF1.4 REF2.4 6 #2306,#2413,#3400,#3410-#3413,#3415,#3417,#3419-#3421REF1.3REF2.3 #2306,#2413 REF5.2LD 1 When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 2.1 to be replaced, if it is not available, it should be replaced with REF 1.4. When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.4 is employed, the version of the SCN08A board (10C-REF16) should always be 113Y1324K or later and the version of the software (114Y5431003) should be updated to A10 or later. 2 When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.1 to be replaced, if it is not available, it should be replaced with REF 1.4. When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.4 is employed, the version of the SCN08A board (10C-REF16) should always be 113Y1324K or later and the version of the software (114Y5431003) should be updated to A10 or later. 3 When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 2.2 to be replaced, if it is not available, it should be replaced with REF 2.4. 4 When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.2 to be replaced, if it is not available, it should be replaced with REF 1.4. 5 When the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.4 or 2.4 is employed, install the attached spacers to the subscanning unit at the same time. 6 However, the Scanning Optics Unit of the machine number #2306,#2413,#3400,#3410-#3413,#3415,#3417 and #3419-#3421 should be replaced with the Scanning Optics Unit of REF 1.3 or 2.3. Moreover the LD Assembly of the machine number #2306 and #2413 should be replaced with its of REF 5.2.
10 8
B3x8
A set of REF2 and REF5 SCANNING OPTICS UNIT / REF2.1 839Y7003E OK NG REF2.2 839Y0022B NG OK REF2.3 839Y0045 NG OK REF2.4 839Y0047 NG OK
TR1Z1003.EPS
LD Assembly
FR1Z0078.EPS
SP - 86
SP - 87
12A
1.2
3-BR4X8
1 CONTROLLER 1
RANK REF. PART NO.
1 CONTROLLER 1
PART NAME QTY.
12A
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1.1
345N1234C
Cover
E D E D E
1.2 2 3 4 5 6.1
1 2 7 3 2 1 109-099C
26 26 2 3
2-BR435
2-BR435
2-BR48
E E
6.2 7 8 9 10
3-BR48
3 2
2-BR435
D D E
1.1
5 3 4
3
2-BR435
11
3 4 3 5
D D
2-BR48
850S0086/ 0087/0088/0089
FDD
FDD
12 13 14
1 1 1 1 CSL/For CSL JIS MCS-1800P-2 CSL /JIS MCS-1800P-2 JIS MCS-1803P-2 CSL /JIS MCS-1803P-2 ISO MCS-1820P-2 CSL / ISO MCS-1820P-2 ISO MCS-1823P-2 CSL /ISO MCS-1823P-2
E D
6.1
BR48
15.1 852S0006A
3 4 13
15.2 852S0011
D
2-BR48
15.3 852S0007A
27
2-BR48
19 20 30 18
29 28
4-BR48 4-BR48
D E D
Magnet Card Reader Bracket Switch Cover Cover Filter Bracket Bracket Bracket Cover CRT Fuse Holder Fuse Key Top
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 1
17 16
6-B310
D D
4-B36
18.1 350N2022A 18.2 350N2004A 19 20 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 603N0162B 356N5844 356N5845 356N5940C 345N1366B 849Y0086A 137N2001 137S1119/1319 340N0149B
10
E E E
12
11
E E
FR1Z0080.EPS
C E D D
(250V/3A)
SP - 88
SP - 89
12B
7-B3X6
2 CONTROLLER 2
RANK REF. PART NO.
2 CONTROLLER 2
PART NAME QTY.
12B
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
1
2-BR4X8
E CR E
FR1Z0081.EPS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
356N6046A 113Y7047M/N 346N0976D 113Y7044E/F 356N5856B 363S0014 356N5855A 356N5854B 356N5852A *** *** ***
DRV08A SNS08A
Bracket DRV08A Sub Plate SNS08A Bracket Rail Bracket Bracket Bracket
1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1 1 GR-280S
CR E E
7-B3X6
3 32
2-B36
E E E
9
CR
13.1 113Y7035M/N/P 13.2 113Y1682B 13.3 113Y1584D 14.1 113Y7040F/G 14.2 113Y7041G/H 15.1 113Y7038E 15.2 113Y1461F 16 17 18 19 113Y7037G/H 113Y7012D/E 113Y7034G/H/J 138S0107
5
CR
2-BR48
CPU90F LAN90D LAN90B DMC08A HCP08A IMG08B IMG08H IMG08A IMG07B CPU90E
CPU90F LAN90D LAN90B DMC08A HCP08A IMG08B IMG08H IMG08A IMG07B CPU90E Ferrite Bead
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Optional CPU90F /Substitute for Optional Optional Optional Optional (for CR-IR361) Optional (for CR-IR341)
32
CR CR
6
2-BR48
CR CR CR
A05 or later
6 13 30
2-BR48
CR CR CR E
8 23
22
Tsus48
14
* REF.18(CPU90E)REF.29(BOOT ROM) CPU90EROMREF.29 REF.18 ROM CPU90E
24
BR48 2-BR48 4-BR48
31
2-BR48
25 24
Tsus48 6-B36
27
Tsus48 BR48 Tsus48
15
* REF 18 (CPU90E) is not bundled with REF 29 (BOOT ROM). If that ROM is needed during replacement of CPU90E, REF 29 should be ordered as well. If only REF 18 is ordered, the ROM that was mounted should be removed and a new ROM should be remounted on REF 18 (CPU90E). The same holds
26
2-BR48 Tsus48
16 33 21 34,35,36 20
Tsus48
true for REF 30 and REF 13 (CPU90F). * If REF. 13 (CPU90F) is version N or later, it is necessary that the software version of the machine be A09 or later. * If the CPU90F is to be changed to the LAN90B for REF. 13 of #5000 or earlier, REF. 27 (350N2005) should be updated to version "E" or later at the same time.
17 28
Tsus48
29 18
Tsus48
19
Tsus48
FR1Z0082.EPS
SP - 90
SP - 91
12B
RANK REF. PART NO.
2 CONTROLLER 2
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO.
CR
20.1 113Y7015C
MMC90A DIM08A MTH08A MTH08D FD (System) FD (System) FD (System) FD FD (QA-WS) BOOT ROM BOOT ROM IMG08H MTH08
MMC90A
32MW (Standard) REF.21.1/ Pair with REF.21.1 REF.21.2/ Pair with REF.21.2 REF.20.1/ Pair with REF.20.1 REF.20.2/ Pair with REF.20.2
20.2 113Y1583A
DIM08A
CR
21.1 113Y7042E
MTH08A
CR E E E E E D D D D D D C C CR E C
MTH08D Bracket Bracket Bracket Panel Panel Cover FD (System) FD (System) FD (System) FD FD (QA-WS connection) BOOT ROM BOOT ROM IMG08H Plastic Washer Substitute for MTH08A
1 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 4 1
CR-IR341: #5233 or earlier CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #5234 or later CR-IR341: #5233 or earlier CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #5234 or later
BLANK PAGE
28.1 114Y5431001A 28.2 114Y5431002A 28.3 114Y5431003A 28.4 114Y5431020A 28.5 114Y5431025A 29 30 31 32 33 114Y5431101A 114Y5431204A 113Y1461F 309S0037 898Y0837
For Formatting For Installation For Data For USA&CSL type For CPU90E For CPU90F Optional CR-IR341: #5233 or earlier CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #5234 or later CR-IR341: #5234 or later CR-IR341: #5234 or later
AT AT AT
34 35 36
1 1 1
SP - 92
SP - 93
12C
3 CONTROLLER 3
CR-IR341:#2670 or earlier
RANK REF. PART NO.
3 CONTROLLER 3
PART NAME QTY.
12C
SERIAL NO.
REMARKS
E E E E D D D D
Bracket Bracket Assembly Bracket Bracket Screw HDD HDD HDD HDD
1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 1
1.1
D
2-BR48
6-32UNC (UNIFI) SEAGATE : ST52160N QUANTUM : QM32100SE-S Western Digital: WDE4550-003 Western Digital: WDE9100-003 SEAGATE : ST318416N
5.1 5.2
5.5
850Y0112
HDD
5.6
850Y0117
HDD
HDD
D
E D E E
5.7 6 7 8 9
HDD HDD
1 4 4 1 1 1
CR-IR341: #2671 to #*** CR-IR341: #*** to #3330 CR-IR341: #3331 to #5612 CR-IR361: #2397 or later CR-IR341: #5613 or later, #5525,#5568 to 5611 #5613 or later #5525,#5568 to 5611
2 3 7
10.1 898Y0816
For REF.5.5
10.2 898Y0864
HDD
6
C 11 113Y1660A CNN08A CNN08A 1
4-B3x12
CR-IR341: #3331 to #5612 CR-IR361: #2397 or later CR-IR341: #5613 or later, #5525, #5568 to 5611 CR-IR341: #5613 or later, #5525, #5568 to 5611
1.2 2 3 7 6
4-B3x12
FR1Z0092.EPS
SP - 94
SP - 95
13
RANK REF. PART NO.
OPTION
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO.
13
BLANK PAGE
PC Menu Editor FD 1 For Overseas CSL type For Japanese CSL type PC Menu Editor FD 1
1.1
114Y5431010A
1.2
114Y5431010B
SP - 96
SP - 97
14
RANK REF. PART NO.
CABLE 1/3
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO. CONNECTION DIAGRAM
RANK REF. PART NO. PART NAME
CABLE 2/3
QTY. REMARKS
14
SERIAL NO. CONNECTION DIAGRAM
E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
136Y6089A 136Y6090A 136Y6101A 136Y6395 136Y6396 136Y6135A 136Y6136A 136Y6137A 136Y6138A 136Y6139A 136Y6140A 136Y6141A 136Y6142A 136Y6145A 136Y6146A 136Y6147A 136Y6148A 136Y6149A
***
Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable
6/10 6/10 8/10 2/10 2/10 2/10 2/10,4/10 2/10,5/10 2/10,5/10 2/10,3/10 2/10,3/10 2/10,5/10 2/10,9/10
E E E E E E E E E E E
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51
136Y6177A 136Y6178A 136Y6179A 136Y6180A 136Y6181A 136Y6182A 136Y6183A 136Y6184A 136Y6187A 136Y6197A 136Y6198A
Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
8/10 8/10 8/10 8/10 8/10 9/10 9/10 9/10 3/10,4/10 9/10 9/10 CR-IR341: #3240 or earlier 10/10 CR-IR361: #2296 or earlier 10/10 * 10/10 CR-IR341: #3368 or earlier 10/10 CR-IR361: #2396 or earlier 6/10 6/10 CR-IR341: #5000 or earlier 8/10 CR-IR361: #2001 or later CR-IR341: #5001 or later
52
136Y6119B
Cable
E E E
53 54 55
1 1 1
56
136Y8427A
Cable
E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E
20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
136Y6151A 136Y6152A 136Y6155A 136Y6156A 136Y6157A 136Y6158A 136Y6159A 136Y6160A 136Y6161A 136Y6162A 136Y6163B 136Y6164B 136Y6165A 136Y6166A 136Y6167A 136Y6168A 136Y6169A 136Y6170A 136Y6171A 136Y6175A 136Y6176A
Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
3/10 3/10 3/10,4/10 4/10 4/10 4/10 4/10,7/10 5/10 5/10,7/10 5/10,7/10 5/10 3/10,5/10 5/10 5/10 6/10 6/10 6/10 6/10 6/10 8/10 8/10
E E
57 58
136Y6091A 136Y6092B
Cable Cable
1 1
59.1 136Y6102C/B
Cable
E E E E E E E E E E E E E E
59.2 136Y8515 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 136Y6094A 136Y6104A 136Y6105C/B 136Y6106A 136Y6126A 136N0276 136Y6088A 136Y6095A 136Y6096A 136Y6097A 136Y6098A 136Y6100B 136Y6107A 136Y6108A 136Y6109A 136Y6110A 136Y6113A 136Y6115A 136Y6116A 136Y6117A 136Y6118A
Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable
8/10 6/10 8/10 2/10,8/10 8/10 2/10,8/10 2/10 6/10 7/10 7/10 7/10 7/10 7/10 9/10 9/10 9/10 9/10 9/10 10/10 10/10 10/10 10/10
*)
CR-IR341 : #2973 or earlier Except #2720, #2770, #2792, #2795, #2815, #2831, #2847, #2852, #2858, #2899, #2901, #2912, #2914, #2919, #2930, #2935, #2951, #2954, #2955, #2956, and #2961 CR-IR361 : #2157 or earlier Except #2041, #2073, #2084, #2098, #2107, #2135, #2145, and #2150
E E E E E E E E
SP - 98
SP - 99
14
RANK REF. PART NO.
CABLE 3/3
PART NAME QTY. REMARKS SERIAL NO. CONNECTION DIAGRAM
13
BLANK PAGE
1 1 1 1 1 Power cable Japanese /USA (including 316N0348, 318S1055) Power cable BSI (including 316N0349, 318S1177) Power cable CEE (including 316N0349, 318S1177) Power cable Japanese 200V Spec.cable with round terminals *2 10/10 6/10 8/10 7/10
E E E E E
81 82 83 84 85
86
136Y6391A
Cable
87
136Y6392
Cable
88
136Y6393
Cable
89
136Y4641A
Cable
E E E E E E E E E E E E E E
92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99
Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable Cable
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CR-IR341: #3397 or later CR-IR361: #2417 or later CR-IR341: #5001 or later 100V (JIS CR-IR341: ) #5001 or later Japan only Japan only 10/10 *1 *1 *1 *1 *1 *1 2/10,10/10 10/10 10/10 10/10 10/10 10/10
100 136Y8370B 101 136Y8371B 102 136Y8372B 103 136Y8373B 104 136Y8428A 105 136Y8466
E E E
1 1 1
2/10
*1) CR-IR341
#2720, #2770, #2792, #2795, #2815, #2831, #2847, #2852, #2858, #2899, #2901, #2912, #2914, #2919, #2930, #2935, #2951, #2954, #2955, #2956, #2961, or later CR-IR361 #2041, #2073, #2084, #2098, #2107, #2135, #2145, #2150, #2158 or later
*2) CR-IR341 : #2973 or earlier Except #2720, #2770, #2792, #2795, #2815, #2831, #2847, #2852, #2858, #2899, #2901, #2912, #2914, #2919, #2930, #2935, #2951, #2954, #2955, #2956, and #2961 CR-IR361 : #2157 or earlier Except #2041, #2073, #2084, #2098, #2107, #2135, #2145, and #2150
SP - 100
SP - 101
15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
JPS-1
FR1Z0083.EPS
SP - 102
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
15
/D / 113Y1555
/137S1319
FR1Z0084.EPS
SP - 103
15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
FR1Z0085.EPS
SP - 104
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
15
/852S0011 /852S0012 S
FR1Z0086.EPS
SP - 105
15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
FR1Z0087.EPS
SP - 106
#5000 or earlier
#5001 or later
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
15
15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
FR1Z0089.EPS
SP - 108
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
15
FR1Z0090.EPS
SP - 109
15
CONNECTION DIAGRAM
FR1Z0091.EPS
SP - 110
13
BLANK PAGE
SP - 111
16
Part No.
16
INDEX No.-REF.No
INDEX No.-REF.No
104N0043 104N0043 104N0043 104N0043 104N0043 104N0044 104N0044 104N0044 104N0044 104Y0162 107Y0163A/B 107Y0163B 107Y0166 113Y1038 113Y1038 113Y1038 113Y1038 113Y1324J/K/L/M 113Y1325D 113Y1328F/G 113Y1395 113Y1461F 113Y1461F 113Y1555B/C 113Y1583A 113Y1584D 113Y1660A 113Y1682B 113Y7012D/E 113Y7015C 113Y7034G/H/J 113Y7035M/N/P 113Y7037G/H 113Y7038E 113Y7040F/G 113Y7041G/H 113Y7042E 113Y7043A 113Y7044E/F 113Y7046A 113Y7047M/N 113Y7067B 113Y7070A 114Y5431001A 114Y5431002A 114Y5431003A
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
03B-38 04B-40 06D-8 07C-9 10B-20 03B-25 03C-7 04B-34 06E-19 08A-10 03A-1 05A-25 08C-12 04D-15 05A-26 06A-27 08A-9 10C-16 10A-40 10B-2 04D-5 12B-15.2 12B-31 12B-21.2 12B-20.2 12B-13.3 12C-11 12B-13.2 12B-17 12B-20.1 12B-18 12B-13.1 12B-16 12B-15.1 12B-14.1 12B-14.2 12B-21.1 12A-13 12B-4 01C-19 12B-2 12A-8 06A-1 12B-28.1 12B-28.2 12B-28.3
114Y5431010A 114Y5431010B 114Y5431020A 114Y5431025A 114Y5431101A 114Y5431204A 115S0072/B 115S0083 115S0136 118SX070A 118YX159 118YX164 118YX164 118YX164 118YX165 118YX165 118YX165 118YX165 118YX165 118YX165 118YX700/B 119Y1097 119Y1107 119Y1119 119Y1700 120Y0074A 120Y0075A 123N0008 124Y0045C 124Y7000B 125N0094K 128S0392 128Y0200 128Y0241A 128Y0258B 133Y1031A/B 133Y2029 134Y0050 134Y0056B 136N0276 136Y4641A 136Y6088A 136Y6089A 136Y6090A 136Y6091A 136Y6092B
13 -1.1 13 -1.2 12B-28.4 12B-28.5 12B-29 12B-30 09-21 09-28.1 09-28.2 10B-22 06E-28 04B-22 04D-21 08B-2 04A-40 05B-16 06B-32 06D-10 07B-33 07C-16 10A-27 09-6 12A-4 02B-11 12A-2 09-18 09-24 09-23 11-5.2 11-5.1 02B-10 04B-9 12A-17 03C-11 03C-13 04B-7.2 04B-7.1 04B-8.1 04B-8.2 14-65 14-89 14-66 14-1 14-2 14-57 14-58
136Y6093A 136Y6094A 136Y6095A 136Y6096A 136Y6097A 136Y6098A 136Y6099A 136Y6099A 136Y6100B 136Y6101A 136Y6102C/B 136Y6103A 136Y6104A 136Y6105C/B 136Y6106A 136Y6107A 136Y6108A 136Y6109A 136Y6110A 136Y6113A 136Y6115A 136Y6116A 136Y6117A 136Y6118A 136Y6119B 136Y6120A 136Y6121B/A 136Y6122A 136Y6124B/A 136Y6125B/A 136Y6126A 136Y6135A 136Y6136A 136Y6137A 136Y6138A 136Y6139A 136Y6140A 136Y6141A 136Y6142A 136Y6145A 136Y6146A 136Y6147A 136Y6148A 136Y6149A 136Y6151A 136Y6152A
14-83 14-60 14-67 14-68 14-69 14-70 06A-3 14-85 14-71 14-3 14-59.1 14-84 14-61 14-62 14-63 14-72 14-73 14-74 14-75 14-76 14-77 14-78 14-79 14-80 14-52 14-53 14-54 14-55 14-81 14-82 14-64 14-6 14-7 14-8 14-9 14-10 14-11 14-12 14-13 14-14 14-15 14-16 14-17 14-18 14-20 14-21
SP - 112
136Y6155A 136Y6156A 136Y6157A 136Y6158A 136Y6159A 136Y6160A 136Y6161A 136Y6162A 136Y6163B 136Y6164B 136Y6165A 136Y6166A 136Y6167A 136Y6168A 136Y6169A 136Y6170A 136Y6171A 136Y6175A 136Y6176A 136Y6177A 136Y6178A 136Y6179A 136Y6180A 136Y6181A 136Y6182A 136Y6183A 136Y6184A 136Y6187A 136Y6197A 136Y6198A 136Y6391A 136Y6392 136Y6393 136Y6395 136Y6396 136Y6694 136Y6695 136Y6696 136Y6697 136Y6698 136Y6699 136Y8368A 136Y8369B 136Y8370B 136Y8371B 136Y8372B
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
14-22 14-23 14-24 14-25 14-26 14-27 14-28 14-29 14-30 14-31 14-32 14-33 14-34 14-35 14-36 14-37 14-38 14-39 14-40 14-41 14-42 14-43 14-44 14-45 14-46 14-47 14-48 14-49 14-50 14-51 14-86 14-87 14-88 14-4 14-5 14-92 14-93 14-94 14-95 14-96 14-97 14-98 14-99 14-100 14-101 14-102
136Y8373B 136Y8427A 136Y8428A 136Y8466 136Y8513 136Y8515 136Y8544A 136Y8551 137N2001 137S1076 137S1077 137S1079 137S1080 137S1086 137S1088 137S1090 137S1119/1319 137S1192 137S1193 137S1194 137S1195 137S1242 137S1245 138S0107 138S0132 138S0219 301N7000 305N0014A 305N0014A 305N0014A 305N0014A 305N0037 308S1422610 308S1422610 308S1422610 308S1422610 308S1422610 308S1422614 308S1422614 308S3420210 308S8190410 309N0049 309N0050 309N0058A 309S0002 309S0006
14-103 14-56 14-104 14-105 14-106 14-59.2 14-108 14-107 12A-28 02B-36 02B-37 02B-38 02B-39 12B-34 12B-35 12B-36 12A-29 02B-36 02B-37 02B-38 02B-39 10C-29 10C-30 12B-19 01C-13 11-11 12C-4 04D-19 05B-9 06E-16 08B-29 09-22 02A-19 03A-11 04G-16 06A-4 08D-8 04B-10 04D-17 03C-10 03B-42 10C-28 10A-13 10B-7 04C-14 06B-2
309S0006 309S0025 309S0037 310N0598 310N0599A 310N0603A 310N0605A 310N0706 310S1011 313N0952C 313N0958C/D 313N0963A 313N0967 313N1030 313N1032 313N1038 313N7040B 315S0008/0048 315S0011/0040 316N0348 316N0349 316N0755D 316N7054A 316S0146 316S0146 316S3067 317N1047A 317N1049A 318N1014A 318N1014A 318N1014A 318N1014A 318N1042A 318N1042A 318N1042A 318N1048 318N1049 318N1051A 318N1053A 318N1057 318N1059A 318N1059A 318N1059A 318N1059A 318N1700A 318N1700A
07B-3 10A-19 12B-32 10B-13 10A-32 02B-6 08D-11 06E-10 10C-8 05D-5 04G-6 09-14 03B-21 04D-10 04G-22 06A-33 07A-21 04F-2 04B-29 02B-13.1 02B-13.2 06E-4 06E-24 04B-21 04C-3 01B-28 10A-4 01C-26 06A-9 06B-8 07A-3 07B-9 04A-33 05B-20 08B-10 04A-6 04A-1 08B-9 04G-9 04A-36 06A-7 06B-10 07A-5 07B-8 06D-7 07C-8
SP - 113
16
Part No.
16
INDEX No.-REF.No
INDEX No.-REF.No
318N3015 318S1055 318S1121 318S1177 318S1216 318S3050 318S3054 318S3172 319N2940 319N2940 319N2940 319N2940 319N3312A 319N3314C 319N3317 319N3318A 319N3319A 319N3320 319N3321B 319N3322A 319N3324 319N3326A 319N3327A 319N3328B 319N3329A 319N3332B 319N3335A 319N3337B 319N3338A 319N3339A 319N3340 319N3349A 319N3438 319N3447 319N3447 319N3448 319N7111 319N7112B 319N7114B 319N7114B 319N7114B 319N7114B 319N7115 319N7116 319N7118A 319N7119
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
02B-34 02B-14.1 02B-12 02B-14.2 10B-3 10C-2 09-13 12C-7 04D-23 04E-10 05B-8 08B-28 10A-29 10A-35 10A-36 10A-8 10A-30 10B-12 05C-9 05B-10 05A-1 05B-21 10A-2 05D-7 08C-16 08B-19 03A-7 04B-39 04A-34 04A-4 04E-1 01C-2 06E-14 04A-16 04B-2 04G-3 06E-21 06A-34 06A-5 06B-9 07A-1 07B-19 06E-2 06E-7 06A-26 06A-15
319N7119 319N7119 319N7119 319N7120B 319N7120B 319N7136 319N7136 319N7136 319N7137 319N7137 319N7138 319N7138 319N7138 319N7138 319N7139 319Y1132A 322N0020A 322N0020A 322N0021A 322N0022A 322N0023A 322N0024A 322N0028A 322N0033 322SF002 322SF004 322SF004 322SF004 322SF004 322SF012 322SF012 322SF017 322SF017 322SF017 322SF017 322SF017 322SF017 322SF017 322SF021 322SF029 322SF041 322SF041 322SF041 322SF041 322SF043 322SF044
06B-11 07A-22 07B-34 06D-3 07C-12 06B-23 07A-20 07B-22 06B-30 07B-17 06A-14 06B-12 07A-9 07B-11 06E-11 03A-2 05A-30 08C-10 03C-3 01C-21 01C-22 01C-23 04A-12 02B-35 10A-9 06A-8 06B-7 07A-4 07B-10 06D-13 07C-6 04D-24 04E-3 05A-4 05B-6 06B-24 07B-15 08B-26 10A-14 08B-6 06A-6 06B-3 07A-2 07B-4 10A-3 04F-1
322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF050 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF061 322SF069 322SF103 322SF103 322SF109 322SF126 322SY048 322SY054 322SY054 322SY054 322SY054 322SY055 322SY055 322SY055 322SY055 322SY061 322SY064 322SY067 322SY067 322SY093 322SY097 322SY103 322SY121 322SY121 322SY121 322SY146 323N0017 323N0033 323N1221A
04D-11 04E-5 05A-12 05B-5 06A-21 06B-19 07A-19 07B-27 08A-1 08B-17 04B-23 04E-13 05A-9 05B-11 08A-5 08B-14 08C-11 10A-21 04A-37 04B-33 04C-12 03A-4 04A-3 04C-8.2 03A-19 05D-8 06E-1 08C-17 06A-22 06B-20 07A-18 07B-26 04B-30 03A-17 04A-18 06E-9 06E-5 04F-5 04C-8.1 05A-2 05D-1 05E-6 03B-22 10A-33 10A-24 10A-34
SP - 114
323S3066 323S3072 323S3072 323S3073 323S3077 323S3082 323S3098 323S3220 323S3255 323S3281 323S3283 323S3287 323S3288 323S3289 323S3290 323S3295 323S3295 324N1026A 324N1026A 324N1026A 324N1026A 324N3038C 324N3038C 324N3038C 324N3038C 324N3038C 324N3038C 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3041E 324N3093A/B 324N3098A/B 324N3098A/B 324N3098A/B 324N3098A/B 324N3106B 324N3121 324N3121 324N3121 324N3123B
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
05A-20 05B-18 08B-8 04B-25 06B-35 05B-15 06E-25 05B-1 04A-31 04E-16 08B-25 04D-27 04E-9 05A-6 07B-1 06D-5 07C-14 04E-14 05B-7 06B-25 07B-16 04D-29 04E-8 05A-11 05B-2 08A-7 08B-12 04B-26 04D-26 05B-17 06B-33 06D-11 06E-22 07B-32 07C-17 08B-3 04A-41 04D-25 04E-4 06B-31 08B-27 08B-24 04A-32 05B-19 08B-11 04B-27
324N3124 324N3125 324N3125 324N3710B 324N3710B 324N3711B 324N3711B 324N3711B 324N3711B 327N0035C 327N1121608A 327N1121608A 327N1121608A 327N1121608A 327N1124001A 327N1201603A 327N4201R04A 327N5202004A 327N6204701A 328N7002A 328N7003B 329N0133 329N0134 329N7003B 329N7003B 329N7003B 329N7003B 329N7005D 329Y0015A 329Y0016A 329Y0016A 332N0456B/C 332N0458B 332N0460C 332N0488/A 332N0502 332N3462A 332N3463A 332N3463A 332N3464A 332N3465A 333N7000B 333N7000B 333N7000B 333N7000B 333N7000B
05A-5 04D-28 04E-11 06D-6 07C-13 06A-13 06B-1 07A-10 07B-2 05E-12 04D-14 04E-17 05A-15 08A-4 05E-9 04A-7 04A-35 04A-2 04G-10 06E-8 06A-40 10B-18 10B-17 06A-12 06B-4 07A-8 07B-5 07C-20 06D-14 06D-15 07C-7 10C-14 10B-9 01C-28 10C-13 01C-9 03B-34 03B-4 03B-32 03B-9 03B-13 04G-2 06A-16 06B-13 07A-11 07B-14
334N2339B 334N2714A 334N3453 334N3456A 334N3456A 334N3456A 334N3456A 334N3457A 334N3457A 334N3457A 334N3457A 334N3459A 334N3460A 334N3461A 334N3462A 334N3463A 334N3464A 334N3465A 334N3466A 334N3467A 334N3488 334N3489 334N3556 334N3556 334N3784A 334N3784A 334N3785B 334N3785B 334N3786 334N3786 334N5004B 334N5014 334Y2197B 334Y3153B 334Y3154 334Y3160 337N0038 337N0043 337N0052A 337S0003 337S0003 338N0219A 338N0219A 338N0458 340N0149B 340N0152
06E-13 06E-6 10A-10 05C-5 05D-3 08C-2 08D-4 05C-3 05D-2 08C-1 08D-3 04D-2 04D-9 04D-1 04D-6 04F-8 04F-10 04F-9 08B-20 08B-21 04A-13 04A-19 05C-7 08C-14 06C-5 07C-5 06C-4 07C-1 06C-3 07C-3 05E-7.1 05E-7.2 05E-5 10A-15 10A-16 03C-5 10A-22 10A-39 10A-25 04D-20 08B-1 05C-8 08C-15 10B-16 12A-30 12A-9
SP - 115
16
Part No.
16
INDEX No.-REF.No
INDEX No.-REF.No
341N0745 341N0852B 341N0853D 341N0855A 341N0857B 341N0858B 341N0860B 341N0863A 341N0864 341N0865A 341N0866C 341N0867 341N0867 341N0954A 341N7047B 342N7001B 342N7001B 342N7002B 342N7003B 342N7004B 342N7004B 342N7005B 345N1233D 345N1234C 345N1236B 345N1236B 345N1237B 345N1237B 345N1239C 345N1264A 345N1366B 345N1367B 345N1368 345N1543A 345Y0158A 345Y0174 346N0970A 346N0975A 346N0976D 346N0978B 346N0979A 347N0226 347N0240 347N0276 347N0389 347N0404
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
10A-37 10A-28 10A-1 10B-14 05A-19 05A-3 03A-9 04F-6 04B-31 04B-37 04B-28 05A-23 08C-9 03A-3.3 06A-32 06A-25 07B-25 06A-23 06B-26 06B-21 07A-17 07B-28 12A-7 12A-1.1 01A-38 01B-3 01A-1 01B-4 12A-6.1 08D-1 12A-26 12A-6.2 12A-1.2 11-10 02B-33 01B-30 10B-15 01C-25 12B-3 04G-11 04D-18 08D-17 04A-17 04B-32 08B-30 06A-36
347N0524 347N0524 347N0580 347N0636 347N0636 347N0636 347N0701 347N0704 347N0704 347N0709 347N0727 347N0727 347N0727 347N0734 347N0742 347N0742 347N0745 347N0746 347N0784 347N0787 347N0818 347N0818 347N0818 347N0818 347N0821 347N0831 347N0832 347N0834 347N1174 347N1174 347N1196A 347N1196A 347N1196A 347N1196A 347N1261 347N1261 347N1261 347N1261 347N1472C 347N1478A 347N1479A 347N1480A 347N1490A 347N1493B 347N1574 347N1797A
04A-29 04B-4 05D-4 04B-24 04E-12 10A-20 04A-25 03B-20 06A-39 12C-6 04C-13 06B-27 07B-29 04B-36 06B-28 07B-20 03A-10 04A-9 05E-4 05E-3 05A-10 05B-12 08A-6 08B-13 05E-8 04B-38 05A-8 04E-15 05A-29 08A-14 04D-16 05A-27 06A-28 08A-8 06A-11 06B-5 07A-7 07B-6 10A-17 08B-18 04A-30 04A-5 04C-21 10B-5 10C-22 10A-41
347N7061A 347N7061A 347N7061A 347N7061A 347N7063 347S0068 347S0068 347S0068 347S0098 347S0098/0362 347S0280 347S0295 350N1980C 350N1981B 350N1982C 350N1983C 350N1991C 350N1992B 350N1998F 350N1999E 350N2000H 350N2001E 350N2002H 350N2003E 350N2004A 350N2005E 350N2006E 350N2007A 350N2010D 350N2021A 350N2022A 350N2029B 350N2037B 350N2503A 350Y1205C 350Y1206F 350Y1213 350Y1214A 350Y1215B 350Y1216A 350Y1217 350Y1218 350Y1219 350Y1220 350Y1261 350Y1285A
06A-24 06B-22 07A-16 07B-23 10C-10 06A-29 06D-12 07C-15 10C-15 08B-5 01A-13 02A-1 10C-5 10C-4 10C-9 10C-20 05E-10 05E-2 01A-8.1 01A-6.1 01B-9 01A-3.1 01A-18.1 01A-15.1 12A-18.2 12B-27 01B-5.1 01B-7 10B-4 05C-1 12A-18.1 10B-1 01A-40.1 11-9 01B-29.1 01A-30.1 01B-21 01A-14.1 01A-17.1 01A-2.1 01B-1.1 01B-2.1 01A-5.1 01A-7.1 01A-37.1 01B-23.1
SP - 116
350Y1313A 350Y1314C 350Y1316 350Y1317 350Y1318 350Y1319 350Y1320 350Y1321 350Y1327A 350Y1331A 350Y1332C 350Y1334 350Y1335 350Y1336 350Y1337 350Y1338 350Y1339 350Y1345 350Y1346 350Y1347 350Y1348 350Y1352 350Y1353 350Y1354 350Y1355 350Y1356A 350Y1357A 350Y1358 350Y1359 350Y1360 350Y1361 350Y1362 350Y1363 350Y1364 350Y1365 350Y1366 350Y1367 350Y1380 350Y1381 350Y1404B 352N0383A 352N0384 352N0388 352N0391B 352N0392C 352N0394
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
01B-29.2 01A-30.2 01A-8.2 01A-6.2 01B-1.2 01A-3.2 01A-18.2 01A-15.2 01B-38.1 01B-29.3 01A-30.3 01A-8.3 01A-6.3 01B-1.3 01A-3.3 01A-18.3 01A-15.3 01B-5.2 01B-5.3 01A-40.2 01A-40.3 01B-23.2 01B-23.3 01A-14.2 01A-14.3 01A-17.2 01A-17.3 01A-2.2 01A-2.3 01B-38.2 01B-38.3 01B-2.2 01B-2.3 01A-5.2 01A-5.3 01A-7.2 01A-7.3 01A-37.2 01A-37.3 10C-24 12A-12 12B-25 12B-26 02B-24 02B-19 01B-16
352N0395 352Y0052 352Y0053 355N0498H 355N0499D 355N7051B 356N5782 356N5783A 356N5784B 356N5796 356N5798A 356N5799C 356N5800B 356N5801G 356N5802 356N5803 356N5804A 356N5805B 356N5806A 356N5808C 356N5810C 356N5811A 356N5813A/B 356N5814A 356N5815B 356N5816B 356N5817C 356N5818A 356N5819B 356N5821A 356N5823A 356N5824B 356N5825B 356N5826A 356N5827B 356N5828C 356N5829 356N5831B 356N5841A 356N5844 356N5845 356N5846C 356N5847C 356N5848D 356N5849A 356N5850
01A-16.1 01A-16.2 01A-16.3 02B-29 02A-10 06E-17 10B-23 10B-21 10B-19 10A-31 10C-11 02B-30 02B-27 10C-17 10B-10 05A-24 05E-11 05A-21 05A-28 10C-21 10C-18 10C-19 04B-41 04E-2 04F-4 04A-28 04B-6.1 04A-42 04A-38 04B-35 04G-21 04A-44 04A-10 04G-13 04G-15 04C-19 04G-8 04G-14 01C-20 12A-20 12A-24 12A-5 01B-22 12A-10 12C-1.1 12A-14
356N5851 12A-16 356N5852A 12B-9 356N5853A 12B-22 356N5854B 12B-8 356N5855A 12B-7 356N5856B 12B-5 356N5858A 08B-7 356N5861A/B 09-8 356N5864E 09-9 356N5866C 08D-10 356N5867B/C 08D-14 356N5868A/B 09-17 356N5869B 08C-13 356N5870C 08A-12 356N5871B 08A-11 356N5872 08A-13 356N5874B 08B-23 356N5875B 08B-22 356N5878A 08D-9 356N5886C/D 08D-18 356N5892 09-12 356N5894A 08B-4 356N5895B/C 03C-6 356N5896A 03A-13 356N5897E 03B-28 356N5902C/6415B 03B-29 356N5903A 03C-12 356N5904C/6414B 03B-37 356N5905D 03B-30 356N5907B 03A-15 356N5908 03A-20 356N5910C 03C-14 356N5911B 03B-26.1 356N5912B/C 03B-39 356N5913A 03A-12 356N5914C 03B-18 356N5915C 03B-23 356N5917D/6416B 03B-6 356N5920B 04A-8 356N5921B 02A-13 356N5924D 02A-17 356N5927C 02A-15 356N5928 02A-11 356N5929A 02A-16 356N5931A 02B-5 356N5932B 02B-4
SP - 117
16
Part No.
16
INDEX No.-REF.No
INDEX No.-REF.No
356N5934B 356N5935 356N5936A 356N5937A 356N5940C 356N5942A 356N5944 356N5945 356N5947 356N5948 356N5949A 356N5956 356N5957A 356N5960A 356N5963A/B 356N5964A/B 356N5966 356N5967 356N5969A 356N5970 356N5972A 356N5975A 356N6012A 356N6014 356N6014 356N6015 356N6026 356N6027 356N6028 356N6029A 356N6042A 356N6045 356N6046A 356N6059 356N6060 356N6076A 356N6200 356N6201 356N6212 356N6212 356N6213 356N6213 356N6216 356N6218 356N6219 356N6224A
009-051-13 01.15.2004 FM4219
02B-3 02B-9 02B-1 02B-2 12A-25 02A-14 04D-4 04B-12 03A-14 03C-9 03C-4 12B-23 12B-24 08C-7 09-11 09-10 04C-7 04C-10 02A-18 02A-20.1 01B-27 04C-18 01C-3 05A-17 05B-13 02B-16 08D-7 09-29 08A-15 08C-6 07B-18 06B-36 12B-1 05E-16 05E-15 10B-6 03B-27 03B-40 06D-16 07C-18 06D-17 07C-19 02A-21 02A-22 02A-20.2 06E-26
356N6357 356N6358 356N6359 356N6360 356N6361 356N6362 356N6364 356N6388 356N6409 356N6410 356N6411 356N6706 356N6707 356N6710A 356N6711 356N6739 356N7342A 356N7343A 356N7344B 356N7346D 356N7347A 356N7351A 356N7351B 356N7383B 356N7384B 356N7385D 356N7389A 356N7390A 356N7391B 356N7419A 356N7419A 356N8285 356N8286 356N8326A 356N8486 356N8565 356N8785A 356N8843 356N8847 356N8850 356N8865 356Y0174 356Y0200 356Y0284 357N1114D 357N7028A
04B-5 04B-1 04G-5 04G-1 04G-19 04G-18 04A-39 04A-14 04A-24 04A-11 04A-20 04B-42.1 04B-42.2 06D-19 06D-20 07B-35 06E-23 06E-18 06E-20 06E-27 06A-35 07C-11 06D-4 06D-1.1 06B-34 07B-31 01C-5 01C-6 06A-2.1 06D-9 07C-10 12C-2 12C-3 11-8 03B-26.2 10C-27 04B-6.2 06D-1.2 06A-2.2 02B-40 12C-8 04C-9 12C-1.2 04C-23 01C-24 01C-27
358N0153B 358N0154B/C 360N0339A 360N0339A 360N0339A 360N0339A 360N0339A 360N0339A 360N0339A 362N0440A 362N0441B 362N0450A 362N0466A 362N0467A 362N0468 362N0469A 362N0474B 363N1708A 363N1747A 363N1751C 363N1755C 363N1757B 363N1758C 363N1762D 363N1763A 363N1765B 363N1766D 363N1769 363N1775C 363N1777C 363N1786A 363N1787A 363N1787A 363N1788A 363N1800A 363N1812 363N1813B 363N1819 363N1923A 363N1973C 363N7100D 363N7105B 363N7106B 363N7108B 363N7109B 363N7111A
09-5 09-7 03C-2 04D-12 04E-6 05A-13 05B-4 08A-2 08B-16 03B-12 03B-8 03A-5 09-25 09-19 04C-15 04C-11 04C-22 03B-7 10A-18 05C-6 05E-14 05D-10 05C-4 04D-3 04A-26 04F-7 05E-1 02A-3 08D-5 08C-3 03B-33 03B-3 03B-31 03B-19 04F-11 02A-5 03B-16 08C-19 08C-5 02A-9 06C-6 01C-8 01C-16 01C-4 01C-1 01C-14
SP - 118
363N7112A 363N7115B 363N7116B 363N7119C 363S0014 363Y0274B 363Y0275B 363Y0276B 363Y0278C 363Y0279C 363Y0280C 363Y0281B 363Y0283B 363Y0284A 363Y0285B 363Y0286B 363Y0287 363Y0289 363Y0293A 363Y0294A 363Y0308A 363Y0310A 363Y0311 363Y0357 363Y0485 363Y0486 363Y0492 363Y1822A 363Y1823A 363Y1823A 364S0005 365N0089 365N0091 365N7002 367N1006 365S0028 367S1078 367Y2012 370N0323 370NB020 370NB033 370NB045 370NB060 370NB075 370NC020 370NC070
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
01C-15 01C-17 01C-18 07C-2 12B-6 04A-23 04A-22 04A-21 01C-12 01C-11 01C-10 01C-7 05D-9 05D-6 05C-2 05E-13 03B-2 03B-35 02A-8 08C-18 08D-2 04D-7 04F-12 03B-41 08C-4 04D-8 02A-4 06C-2 06C-1 07C-4 12A-3 04G-7 02B-28 06E-15 02A-6.2 02A-12 02A-6.1 02A-7 04C-20.2 04B-17 04B-13 04B-16.2 04B-16.1 04B-14 04C-4 04C-20.1
370NC180 371S0003 372S0048 372S0049 372S0050 372S0053 372S0053 372S0055 372S0060 375S0040 376N0182A 376N0183 376N0184 379N0113A 382N0911A 382N0912B 382N0913A 382N0914A 382N0934A 382N0935A 382N0969 382N0970 382N0971 382N0972 382N0973 382N0974 382N0975 382N0975 382N0976 382N0977 382N0978 382N0979 382N0980 382N0981 382N0982 382N0983 382N0984 382N0985 382N0986 382N0987 382N0987 382N0988 382N0989 382N0990 382N0991 382N0992
04C-6 04B-11 04B-19 04C-1 04B-18 04B-20 04C-2 04B-15 04C-5 04C-17 01B-6 01A-23 01A-35 12C-9 10C-6 10C-7 10C-1 10C-3 01A-22 01A-21 01B-32 01B-33 01B-31 01B-34 01B-35 02B-23 01B-12 02B-22 02B-25 02B-17 02B-18 02B-20 01A-27 01A-26 01A-25 01A-29 01A-28 01A-24 01A-20 01A-19 01B-14 01B-17 01B-20 01B-18 01B-19 01B-10
382N0993 382N0994 382N0994 382N0995 382N0996 382N0997 382N0998 382N0999 382N1010 382N1011 382N1034 382N1035 382N1036 382N1037 382N1038 382N1067 382N1069 382N1070 382N1071 382N1155 382N1156 382N1159 382N1168 382N1372 382N1373 382N1486 382N1693 383Y0057 383Y0057 383Y0058 383Y0058 383Y0059 383Y0059 383Y0060 383Y0060 383Y0061 383Y0061 383Y0062 383Y0062 383Y0063 383Y0064 383Y0065 383Y0065 383Y0065 384N0045 384N0046
01B-11 01B-13 02B-41 01B-15 01A-12 01A-10 01A-11 01A-9 11-6 11-7 02A-2 02B-21 01B-36 01B-37 02B-26 08A-16 01B-25 01B-26 01B-24 02A-24 02A-23 01B-39 01A-36 10C-25 10C-26 01A-41 03A-22 06A-19 06B-17 06A-20 06B-16 06A-18 06B-15 07A-14 07B-21 07A-15 07B-24 07A-13 07B-12 06A-30 06A-31 04A-15 04B-3 04G-4 03B-15 03B-17
SP - 119
16
Part No.
INDEX No.-REF.No
BLANK PAGE
384N0047 386N0699 386N0700 386N0701 386N0702A 386N0703 386N0706 386N0707 386N0709 386N0710 386N0726 386N0734 386N0739 386Y0021 387N0088 387N0088 387N0095/A 387N0103/B 387N0112/A 387N0113 387N0181 387N7006 388N1073 388N1075A 388N1142 388N1142 388N1143 388N1701 388N2222 388N2227A 388N2228B 388N2229B 388N2306 388N2384 388N2384 388N2384 388N2385 388N2385 388N2385 388N2386 388N2387 388N2388 388N2389A 388N2390 388N2391 388N2392A
009-051-14 08.31.2005 FM4656
03B-10 09-27 09-2 09-1 09-4 09-3 08D-13 08D-12 09-16 08D-15 02B-32 08D-23 08D-22 10C-12 02B-15.1 06D-21 02B-31 06D-18 02B-15.2 05E-18 03A-21 05E-17 10A-23 10B-11 03B-5 03B-36 03B-24 04A-27 10A-26 10A-38 10A-5 10A-11 03C-1 04E-7 05A-14 08A-3 04E-18 05B-3 08B-15 05A-16 05B-14 05A-22 03A-6 04D-13 04D-22 04F-3
388N2395 388N2395 388N2395 388N2395 388N2395 388N2396 388N2407 388N2421 388N2501 388N2721A 388N2722A 388N2723 388N2724 388N2728B 388N2729 388N2731 388N3073B 388N3074B 388N3075A 388N3076A 388N5184A 388N5214 388N5244A 388N5244A 388N5703A 392N0010 398N0057D 401N0734A 401N0735A 401N0737 401N0738A/B 401N0740 401N0741 401N0741 401N0742B 401N0744A 401N0749 401N0749 401N0749 401N0749 405N2314A 405N2462 405N2551 405N2607 405N2608 405N2878
06A-10.1 06B-6.1 06B-6.2 07A-6 07B-7 06B-18 03C-8 04G-20 06A-10.2 06A-38 06B-29 06E-12 06E-3 08C-8 06A-37 07B-30 05A-7 05A-18 03A-16 03A-8 09-20 03C-15 01A-39 01B-8 01A-4 04C-16 03A-18 10A-6 10A-7 08D-21 08D-20 04G-17 04A-43 04G-12 02B-8 02B-7 06A-17 06B-14 07A-12 07B-13 01B-40.1 01B-40.3 01B-40.4 01B-40.6 01B-40.5 01B-40.2
405Y0158 407N0092B 407N0093B 407N0094A 407N0099 602Y0105 603N0162B 603Y7001 606Y0032C 615Y7000A/B 815Y7003 839Y0021A 839Y0022B 839Y0044 839Y0045 839Y0046 839Y0047 839Y7002C 839Y7003D/E 840Y0082A 849Y0086A 850S0080 850S0085 850S0086 850S0087 850S0088 850S0089 850S0107 850S0121 850Y0112 850Y0117 850Y0131 852N0016 852N0019B 852S0006A 852S0007A 852S0011 852S0012 898Y0534 898Y0612 898Y0816 898Y0837 898Y0864 898Y0901
01A-42 08D-19 09-26 09-15 08D-6 10A-12 12A-19 08D-16 10B-8 11-4 11-3 11-1.2 11-2.2 11-1.3 11-2.3 11-1.4 11-2.4 11-1.1 11-2.1 09-30 12A-27 12C-5.3 12C-5.4 12A-11 12A-11 12A-11 12A-11 12C-5.1 12C-5.2 12C-5.5 12C-5.6 12C-5.7 06D-2.1 06D-2.2 12A-15.1 12A-15.3 12A-15.2 12A-15.4 03B-1 10C-23 12C-10.1 12B-33 12C-10.2 04C-24
SP - 120
SP - 121
17
No. Part name
18
3.
1 Fixing plug
1.
2.
S T
S3 x 10
T4 x 8
M3 x 10 M4 x 8
1.
Flat-head screw S
2.
2 Binding band
Fixing plug
Truss-head screw T
Binding band
N.K. clamp
4.
5.
A3 x 6
M3 x 6
3.
Pan -head screw with spring washer A
4.
Pan-head screw with spring and plain washers B
Edging
Edge saddle
TR1Z0042.EPS
B3 x 16
M3 x 16
5.
6.
Hexagon-headed bolt Q
Cross-recessed hexagon-
BR
BR4 x 25
M4 x 25
6 Hexagon-headed bolt
Q3 x 20
M3 x 20
7.
8.
BQ
BQ4 x 10
M4 x 10
Hexagon-headed set Hexagon-Headed bolt with spring and plain washer screw WP BQ
9.
8 (double-point)
Hexagon-headed setscrew
10.
Hexagon nut Na
WP
WP4 x 6
M4 x 6
11.
CS CS3x6 M3x6
Plain washer W
12.
Spring washer SW
10 Hexagon nut
Na
Na3 Na4 x 8
M3 M4 x 8
13.
11 Plain washer 12 Spring washer 13 E ring
: Stainless-made : Painted black
W SW E
W4 SW3 E6
M4 M3
Nominal diameter 6
E ring E
TR1Z0041.PCT
SP - 122
SP - 123
IN - 1
05
04/20/2001
06
08/30/2001
07
Installation (IN)
05/30/2002 03/20/2004 08 10
08/31/2005
11
Reason Pages affected Corrections due to change in configuration All pages (FM2460) Corrections (FM2638) IN-1, 3.13.4, 12, 13, 13.1, 13.2, 1417, 21, 21.1, 21.2, 22, 23, 25, 28, 30, 34, 35, 43, 47, 5052, 68~70, 85, 87122, 135, 137,138, 140, 141, 143, 144, 149 IN_A2-All pages Corrections (FM3006) IN-4, 5, 16, 1723, 23.123.2, 2433, 35.135.4, 38, 39, 43, 48, 50, 51, 56, 81, 82, 98100, 103, 105107, 107.1107.4, 108113, 127, 130, 131, 134 IN_A2-All pages IN_A8-14 Support for plus, corrections (FM3115) IN-All pages IN_A1-All pages, IN_A2-1, 9, 14, 1721 IN_A4-All pages, IN_A9-All pages Addition of the information about the IN-100107, 110115, 130, 137 scanner unit clamps, etc. (FM3405) IN_A4-1 Configuration addition due to a software IN-5, 12, 17, 18, 22, 23 ,28, 31, update, DICOM setting addition, and 31.1-31.4, 35.2-35.4, 36-41, other information additions, and 41.1-41.3, 48-50, 52, 53, typographical error corrections (FM4275) 53.1-53.4, 54-60, 77, 109, 113-115, 115.1-115.2, 117, 119, 120, 122, 124-129, 129.1, 130, 138, 140, 144, 150, 154, IN_A2-6, 8-14, 14.1, 14.2, 16, 18-24 IN_A3-2 Revision (FM4710) IN-22, 23, 31, 31.1, 35.2, 35.3, 68, IN_A2-14.1
IN - 1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 3
1.
First machine
Appendix of INSTALLATION Volume
Copy
W or ks he et
Copy
The worksheet is used when configuration setting of the machine is actually performed.
FR1B1253.EPS
When se veral units of the CR-IR341 are to be installed, the w or ksheet f or the first machine should be first filled out, and then it should be copied for the subsequent machines, so that item(s) to be changed may be red-penciled.
IN - 2
et
IN - 3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 5
A
6.3 Setting and Installing Boards 6.3.1 MTH08A board or MTH08D board 6.3.2 MMC90A board or DIM08A board 6.3.3 CPU90E board 6.3.4 IMG07B board 6.3.5 CPU90F board or LAN90B board 6.3.6 HCP08A board 6.3.7 DMC08A board 6.3.8 IMG08B/H board 6.1 Work Flow 6.3.9 IMG08A board 6.2 Unclamping and Installing Separate Packaged Items (Except for Boards) 6.2.1 Removal of Covers 6.4 Cable Wiring Diagram 6.2.2 Procedures at Cassette Set Unit and Up-Down IP Removal Unit 6.2.3 Procedures at Erasure Conveyor and Before-SidePositioning Conveyor 6.2.4 Procedures at SidePositioning Conveyor, Subscanning Unit, and Power Supply Unit 6.2.5 Procedures at Scanner Unit 6.9 Setting Date and Time 6.2.6 Procedures at Controller 6.2.7 Unclamping Check List 6.3.10 Installing Board Retaining Plate
5.1 Unloading, Transfer, and Unpacking 5.2 Checking the Items Supplied 5.2.1 Machine main body 5.2.2 Separate packaged items 5.2.3 Options 5.3 Temporary Placement Procedures
3.8 DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) 3.9 ROUTING (ROUTE) 3.10 NETMASKS (NETMASKS) 3.11List of Setup Items Related to Network and Setup Examples
6. Installation
2.3.2 Pattern Where IDT-IV Is Connected to CPU90Fa 2.3.3 Pattern Where CR-IR348CL is Connected to LAN90B 2.4 IDT Type and CSL Type
4. Preparation for Installation Environment 4.1 Specifications of Machine 4.1.1 Machine Moving and Fixing Means 4.1.2 Environmental Requirements
6.4.1 Interface Cables 6.5 Preparations for Power ON 6.6 Turning ON the Power
3. Determination of Configuration Information "Appendix 2. For Determination of Configuration Information" 3.1 SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) 3.1.1 List of Setup Items of SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) 3.1.2 Setup Items of SYSTEM to be Changed for Second and Subsequent Machines 4.1.3 Electrical Specifications 4.2 Preinstallation Work 4.3 Tools Used
A
3.2 PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG) 3.2.1 List of Setup Items of PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG)
FR1B1502.EPS
END
FR1B1501.EPS
IN - 4
IN - 5
CONTENTS
B
A1
A2
IN - 6
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 7
BLANK PAGE
7. Setting Configuration File 7.1 Installing Configuration File "Appendix 3. Common Information about M-Utility" "Appendix 6. Installing Optional Software"
7.2 Editing Configuration Files 7.3 Backing Up Configuration File 7.4 Resetting Machine
8. Final Installation and Checks 8.1 Checking IP Conveyance in M-Utility 8.2 Reinstalling Covers 8.3 Final Placement 8.4 Checks after Machine Startup 8.5 Checking Interface Operation 8.6 Checking Image and Adjusting Image Requirements 8.7 Checking and Deleting Error Logs That Occur during Setup 8.8 Checking Machine Shutdown 8.9 Cleaning Covers 8.10 Attachment of Labels
END
FR1B1503.EPS
IN - 6
IN - 7
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 8
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 9
2.
2.1
N NOTE N
If the printer connection for the CR-IR341 (A05 or later) is changed from local to network, or from network to local, the printer after that change should be selected through printer selection in U-Utility.
I Printers that can be connected to CR-IR341 G Printers that can be directly connected
Models of the pr inters that can be directly connected to the CR-IR341 b board, and their softw are v ersions , are sho wn belo w. y use of the E-I/F
It should be noted that ULP in the configuration is automatically set on the CR-IR341 side, so its setting is unnecessar y. Model CR-LP414/FL-IM2636 CR-LP414N/FL-IM2636N* CR-LP415/FL-IM2636II CR-LP416/FL-IM3543II CR-LP417/FL-IMD CR-DP L FM-DP2636 FM-DP3543 FL-IM3543 FL-IM3543N (MN)* DRYPIX1000 Connection protocol: E-I/F for all *: If the CR-LP414N/FL-IM2636N or FL-IM3543N is connected to the CR-IR341(A07 or later) (including being connected as a backup printer), the setup value for N1 in 2. CONFIGURA TION SETTING, 5. LOCAL INTERFACE, 2. LIF: siosetup .lp file should be changed from 005 to 010 Software version (Currently not suppor ted) CPU68J board: A05; IF68J board: A04 (IF68J board: A05 cannot be used) A07 or later A07 A10 A04, B00 or later (B04 or later f or 8"x10" film output) C05 or later C01 or later (Currently not suppor ted) CPU68J board: A06; IF68J board: A04 (IF68J board: A06 cannot be used) A01 or later (A01 or later f or 8"x10" film output)
IN - 8
IN - 9
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 10
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 11
2.2
2.3
The multi-frequency processing function is automatically activ ated by installing the IMG08B board. Thus, it is unnecessar y to set this function in the configur ation and so f or th.
IN - 10
IN - 11
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 12
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 13
N NOTE N
Some of the devices connected to the network may require you to perform communication method setup. They generally operate when the "Auto Negotiation" is chosen or when the default settings are used. If they do not normally operate, adjust the settings as suggested in the table below.
Hub supported 10BASE-T Switch setting HALF DUPLEX Communication mode 10M HALF DUPLEX
CR-IR341 DMS e.g.) HIC654 DMC08A CPU90E IMG08A PRINTER e.g.) FL-IM D
CPU90E board 10BASE-T / 10M HALF DUPLEX 10BASE-T/100 BASE-TX selection AUTO NEGOTIATION 10BASE-T HALF DUPLEX 10M HALF DUPLEX CPU90F board 10BASE-T / 10BASE-T/100 BASE-TX selection 100M HALF DUPLEX
ID data
10M HALF DUPLEX 10M HALF DUPLEX 100M HALF DUPLEX 100M HALF DUPLEX
HUB (10BASE-T)
IDT-IV No.1
IDT-IV No.2
IDT-IV No.3
IDT-IV No.4
IDT-IV No.5
IDT-IV No.6
FR1B1128.EPS
AUTO NEGOTIATION
or k (100BASE-TX).
e.g.) FMDP3543
Remote power ON/OFF HUB (10BASE-T) No.2 ID data HI-C655 CPU90F & HCP08A Image data HUB (100BASE-TX) PRINTER e.g.)FN-PS551 Image data ID data CPU90F & HCP08A ID data CR-IR341 HUB (10BASE-T) No.1 CPU90E Remote power ON/OFF IDT-IV IDT-IV
FR1B1129.EPS
CR-IR342 CPU90E
IN - 12
IN - 13
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 14
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 15
CR-IR341
HI-C655
OD-F614
CPU90F & HCP08A Image data ID data 100M/10M switching HUB (100BASE-TX) Image data Switching to 10M ID data CPU90F & HCP08A CR-IR341 HUB (10BASE-T) CPU90E
HI-C655
OD-F614
IDT-IV
IDT-IV
PRINTER e.g.)FN-PS551
ROUTER
IDT-IV
CR-IR341
LAN90B
HI-C655 CPU90F & HCP08A Image data ID data HUB (100BASE-TX) Image data ID data CPU90F & HCP08A
CR-IR348CL
IDT-IV
PRINTER e.g.)FN-PS551
100M/10M Bridge
Image data
CR-IR341
CR-DPL
HUB(10BASE-T) CPU90E
HI-C
CR-IR342
PRINTER
FR1B1263.EPS
IN - 14
IN - 15
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 15.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 15.2
2.4
BLANK PAGE
IN - 15.1
IN - 15.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 16
CONTENTS
1
3.6
A1
A2
IN - 17
3.
NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) It contains information regarding the function, communication protocol, transfer rate, and so forth of a device that is locally connected to the machine or a device that is network connected (host).
3.7
HOSTS ADDRESS (HOSTS) It contains information regarding the correspondence between the name and IP address of a host that is connected to the machine to send and receive data.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The configuration information determined should be described in copies of the worksheets of Appendixes 1 and 2. Configuration settings should be done during installation procedures with reference to those worksheets.
3.8
DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) It contains information regarding the correspondence between the distribution code and distribution host name when the data is distributed.
3.9
ROUTING (ROUTE) It contains information regarding the destination IP address and name of a router when used.
NNOTE N
For the CL connection type, setting should be made which complies with CR Console (CRIR348CL) connection.
Appendix 9 Procedures for Connecting with CR Console (CR-IR348CL)
3.10 NETMASKS (NETMASKS) It contains information regarding the network address and subnet mask. 3.11 DICOM (Base on DICOM) This file contains the DICOM setup information about the CR-IR341 and CL.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Intelligent hub: A hub that complies with SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol).
3.4
EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) It contains information regarding the name and function of a host that is connected to the machine to send and receive data.
3.5
LOCAL INTERFACE (INTERFACE) It defines setup information for communication requirements over serial line connection.
N NOTE N
Only when CR-LP414N/FL-IM2636N or FL-IM3543N is connected to CR-IR341 (A07 or later) (including cases where it is connected as a backup printer), the setup value for N1 in the 2. LIF: siosetup.lp file should be changed from 005 to 010.
IN - 16
IN - 17
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 18
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 19
CAUTIONS
Never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button during file saving. The FD or FD drive may be damaged. When retrieving the configuration data from one machine and installing it to another, make sure that the source and destination machines have the same software version. If the software version is different, an error may occur during installation.
(1) Put a DOS-formatted 1.44MB floppy disk into a floppy disk drive. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to U-Utility. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1200.EPS
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
>7
Output destination selection FD operation
1 2 3
Click sound
Utility
Return
0.QUIT 1.FORMAT FD 2.FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION 3.BACK UP 4.RESTORE 5.EDR DATA 6.PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE 7.EXECUTION FUT> 3 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA 2.CONFIGURATION DATA 3.NETWORK DATA 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA 5.CSL MENU DATA FUT:RES>2
U-Utility button
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
3
FR1B1214.EPS
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG,IRSET.ORG) PRINT (FILFMT.CFG,FILFMT.ORG) IRSTATUS (IRSTATUS.CFG,IRSTATUS.ORG)
Caps
FR1B1086.EPS
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved to the floppy disk contain the machines language setting. Thus, if the machines language setting during RESTORE is different from the one used during BACK UP, the files cannot be read during RESTORE.
IN - 18
IN - 19
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 20
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 21
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1225.EPS
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) HOSTS ADDRESS (HOST) DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ROUTING (ROUTE) NETMASKS (NETMASKS) DICOM (DICOM)
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved to the floppy disk contain the machines language setting. Thus, if the machines language setting during RESTORE is different from the one used during BACK UP, the files cannot be read during RESTORE.
(7) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to U-Utility. (8) Remove the floppy disk.
IN - 20
IN - 21
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 22
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 23
3.1
SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
Of the setup items of SYSTEM, some are only supported for the IDT type (IDT connection and CR-IR348CL connection). For the machine of the IDT type, items marked by in the IDT type column shown in 3.1.1 List of Setup Items for SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) should only be set.
82.DK_FILM: Print HQ Image on 14*14 film(14*14 single format) 83.DCL: Clear the distribution code when re-outputing a image 84.FCL: Put the filing switch off when re-outputing a image 85.IDNR_CB: "ID INFORMATION NOT REGISTERED" message
86.U_0810: User UTL 08*10 film setting Button Control 87.RST_WRT: Reset image writing from shared memory after Happend HDD Write Error 88.RST_CBC: CBC Hard Reset
FR1BA011.EPS
N NOTE N
Be sure to observe the LENGTH (digits) requirements specified for the following items. If a wrong LENGTH is used, the setup results in error, so that the machine may not operate properly. 3.IPS: IP Address (CPU90E) (Length=15) 4.IPI: IP Address (CPU90F) (Length=15) 40.EBA: EDR Backup Server Address (Length=15) 41.EM1,2,3,4,5 : EDR Backup Menu Code (Length=4)
IN - 22
IN - 23
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 24
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 25
Parameters
Remarks
13
U_MF
0: OFF 1: ON
SS1
IDT type
Item
Initial value
Parameters
Remarks
When a cassette is inserted, the screen saver, even if activated, is automatically disabled. Wait time for DMS E-I/F reoutput request interrupt Consecutive storage process count for DMS E-I/F reoutput request interrupt EDR setup range
IDT
0: CSL 1: IDT
0: Japanese 1: English 2: German 3: French 4: Spanish 5: Italian 6: Swedish 7: Finnish 8: Danish 9: Norwegian 10: Korean
15
ITV
30
0-60 [sec]
FNT
16
CPS
0-10 [sheets]
17
ID_ EDR
Used to select the display range for EDR process mode key. FILING setup range
0: AUTO, SEMI, FIX 1: AUTO, SEMI, FIX, SEMI-X 2: AUTO, SEMI, FIX, SEMI-X, MANUAL 0: DISABLE 1: OFF, ON 2: OFF, ON*, ON 0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE 0: OFF 1: ON 0: JAPANESE DATE (H10.04.01) 1: ANSI LONG DATE (1998.APR.01) 2: ANSI SHORT DATE (1998.04.01) 3: AMERICAN LONG DATE (APR.01.1998) 4: AMERICAN SHORT DATE (04.01.1998) 5: EUROPEAN LONG DATE (01.APR.1998) 6: EUROPEAN SHORT DATE (01.04.1998)
IPS
172.16.0.1
Its IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement. Its IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement. Even if the CPU90F board is not available as an option, be sure to set its IP address.
18
LENGTH =15
19 20
LENGTH =15
0 0
IPI
172.16.0.2
5 6 7
1 D2 5000
ID acquisition destination LAN 0: standard LAN (CPU90E) Setup of destination to which ID-T 1: option LAN (CPU90F/LAN90B) is connected. Unit code (2 characters) Unit character string (6 characters). Reader number
21
Change prohibited. Change prohibited.
ID_ BIRTH
SID
A reader number that does not AZ duplicate within the same network should be assigned.
SFC
0: OFF 1: ON (Standard,Semi-High-Speed) 2: ON (Standard,Semi-High-Speed, High-Speed) 0: Standard 1: Semi-High-Speed 2: High-Speed 3: Menu Default (=Memory)
22
ID_ SEARCH
Used to select either ID number, receipt number, or examination number to be displayed as a search key during connection with HIS.
Setting of ID number character string length
23
ID_ LENGTH
10
1 10: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1 64: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0: Pad with space to the head (Ex." 1234567") 1: Pad with zero to the head (Ex."0001234567") 2: Pad with space to the tail (Ex."1234567 ") 3: Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."1234567000")
TR1B1106.EPS
10
SFD
0: OFF 1: ON
It sets to determine whether to read the data on the IP in sizes smaller than the actual IP size (to implement logical reading). Overexposure handling
24
ID_ PADDING
12
XRY
Caution: Change
TR1B1105.EPS
IN - 24
IN - 25
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 26
Parameters Remarks
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 27
Item number 25
IDT type
Item
RECEPT_ LENGTH
Initial value 5
IDT type
Item
IFT
Initial value
0
Parameters
26
RECEPT_ PADDING
0 : Pad with space to the head (Ex." 123") 1 : Pad with zero to the head (Ex."00123") Setting of receipt number padding 2 : Pad with space to the tail scheme (Ex."123 ") 3 : Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."12300") Setting of examination number character string length 1 10: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1 16: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0 : Pad with space to the head (Ex." 1234567") 1 : Pad with zero to the head (Ex."0001234567") 2 : Pad with space to the tail (Ex."1234567 ") 3 : Pad with zero to the tail (Ex."1234567000")
TR1B1104.EPS
27
EXAM_ LENGTH
10
30
PRO
28
EXAM_ PADDING
NONE TS (Temporary subtraction) ES (Energy subtraction) MS (Multilayer tomography) MX (Multi-integrated processing) WS (Whole spine) Function image protect PS (IVP) (image protect on HIC) TM (Tomography) TX (Temporary subtraction, Use to set the type of screen overall processing) that enables the screen protection 9: WX (Whole spine, overall function of HI-C. processing) 10: EX (Energy subtraction, overall processing) 11: AS (Inter-image operation) 99: ALL Sensitivity median shift 1 (relatively high sensitivity) Sensitivity median shift 2 (high sensitivity) 0 299 0 299 0: not specified 1: space (2) + department name (8) 2: department name (4) + menu (6) 3: department name (4) + film mark (6) 4: unit code (1) + space (9) 5: space (4) + MPM (4) + space (2) 6: space (4) + film mark (6) 7: department name (4) + MPM (4) + space (2) 0 F (hexadecimal notation) No change required. No change required.
0: 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: 8:
31 32
SF1 SF2
50 100
33
GRP
Indent
34
PTR
Position of film mark or menu character string outputted with GRP (valid when GRP = 2, 3, 6)
Indent
35
UNQ
Indent
36 37
PCD PCL
1 0
0: 1 sec 1: 2 sec 0: 1 sec (< 60m) 1: 2 sec (> 60m) It should be set according to the processing at the DMS.
38
CIM
DMS output code selection when "inch" and "metric" physical sizes differ
0: Inch 1: Metric
39
EBK
Selection of a menu to transmit EDR backup information to the IP address that is set with EBA
0: OFF (not transmitted) 1: MENU (menu selected with EM is selected) 2: Full (all menus) Transfer destination IP address The IP address should be described in fifteen digits stuffed to the left. If the number of digits is less than 15, space should be added to the end to meet the 15-digit requirement.
40
EBA
...
Transfer destination IP address for the transmission of EDR backup data through a network The transmission port is fixed at 90E.
LENGTH =15
TR1B1008.EPS
IN - 26
IN - 27
CONTENTS
2
IDT type
A1
A2
IN - 28
Parameters Remarks
LENGTH =4 LENGTH =4 LENGTH =4 LENGTH =4 LENGTH =4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 29
Parameters Remarks
Item number 41
Item EM1
Setup description Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 Menu code for executing backup when EBK = 1 OEM printer setting
Item number
IDT type
Item
Initial value
Setup description
Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. Four hexadecimal digits are used for menu code designation. 0: OFF 1: ON
48
HQ_ FUNC
HQ function setting
0: disabled; 1: enabled
No change required
41 41 41 41 42
49
0: disabled; 1: enabled
No change required
50
0: Stand. 1: Long
No change required.
51
43
ID_AP
0: L-R reversal 1: T-B reversal Image reversal mode (orientation) 2: L-R,T-B reversal setting range 3: L-R reversal/90-deg.Rotation 4: L-R,T-B reversal/90-deg.Rotation Distribution code setting
0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE
0: CP850 1: ISO8859-1 0: Blank screen (Screen saver is disabled) 1: Pictures (Multiple pictures are displayed at regular intervals.) 0: Pad with space to the head (EX." 1234") 1: Pad with zero to the head (EX."00001234") 2: Pad with space to the tail (EX."1234 ") 3: Pad with zero to the tail (EX."12340000")
52
SSS
44
ID_DST
45
UID_STI
0: <org root>.2.0.<Private Image UID> (IDT Type) 0: <org root>.2.1.<MAC Address>. Setting of study instance UID type <Time Stamp>.<Unique ID> (CSL Type) 1: <org root>.2.1.<Accesion Number> <org root>= Setting used to issue study information for QA-DICOM output. 2: <org root>.2.2 1.2.392 .<Study Date + Modality(CR)> Used to customize, on a hospital.200036.9125 .<Accesion Number> by-hospital basis, how to bind 3: <org root>.2.3 images per study on the QA side .<Study Date + Modality(CR)> .<Patient ID> 4: <org root>.2.4 .<Study Date> .<Patient ID2> .<Requesting Service>
53
DST_ PADDING
54
ENV
CR-IR341
Machine type display switching setting 0: The patient ID is automatically cleared when the cassette is set or when the menu select key is pressed, and the patient information is acquired from the online destination. 1: The patient ID is cleared when it is necessary to change the patient ID, and the patient information is acquired from the online destination. <CSL type> 0: Study/Series information is not numbered on the reader side. 1: Study/Series information is numbered on the reader side. <IDT type> 0: Study/Series information is not numbered on the IDT side. 1: Study/Series information is numbered on the IDT side.
TR1B1107.EPS
Default setting of image processing density Used to designate the machine s default processing density. This setting is effective only when a setting other than 0 or 1 is registered from IDT3 or the like (in cases where IDT3, which 0: Standard Density cannot designate the processing 1: High Quality Density density, is connected via IDT4, or where the processing density is not designated due to a software bug of IDT4). Normally, the value that is set on the IDT side or by the internal menu of the CSL type is effective, so its initial value need not be changed.
55
ID_ RET
46
DEF_ DENSITY
47
JSTFY
00010000 00001111
<Variable part> 0: Left justified; 1: Right justified <Corresponding to each digit of the variable part> a: Patient ID Definition of right or left justification b: Patient name for long format c: Exposure menu name d: Examination number e: Department name (alphanumeric) f-l: Reserved (default: left justified) m-p: Reserved (default: right justified)
56
Common to DMS output, CRT display, and FILM output.
UID
N NOTE N
TR1B1009.EPS
Be sure to observe the length (number of digits) specified for the following items. If the length (number of digits) is wrong, a setting error occurs so that the machine may fail to properly operate. 40. EBA: EDR Backup Server Address (Length = 15 including a dot (.)) 41. EM1, EM2, EM3, EM4, and EM5: EDR Backup Menu Code (Length = 4)
009-051-10 03.20.2004 FM4275
IN - 28
IN - 29
CONTENTS
Item number
1
IDT type
A1
A2
IN - 30
Parameters/Remarks
CONTENTS
Item number
1
IDT type
A1
A2
IN - 31
Parameters/Remarks
Item
Initial value
Item
Initial value
Setup description
57
EXAM
69
PN_ FCS3
"FGM"
58
L2430
0: Pantomo size (15x30 cm) reading disabled 1: Pantomo size (15x30 cm) reading enabled
70 PN_ FCS4 "FGMP" Setting of patient name components (for four components in FINP)
F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix 0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix 0: Type 1 (old type: LUT = linear) 1: Type 2 (new type: LUT = nonlinear; change in standardized image display mode) 0: BCR5242-STB (DENSEI)(~#5000) 1: NFT7175/F01RL (OPTOELECTRONICS)(#5001~)
59
ID_ EXAM
CSL-type examination number display setting CSL-type department name display setting
60
71
PN_ FCS5
"FGMPS"
61
CSL-type department name character count setting CSL-type communication message character string length setting during ID online
1- 8: ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1-64: ID_INFO_TYPE=1 0: Maximum length of send/receive message characters is 128 bytes 1: Maximum length of send/receive message characters is 256 bytes
72 PN_ FCM1 "F"
62
MES_ LENGTH
63
SCS
Character code of special symbols 0: ISO-IR 6 (ISO646) with UK/US language setting (FNT=1) 1: ISO-IR 100 (ISO8859-1) (Only for Base on DICOM setting) Setting for converting patient name components from FINP to DICOM Setting of delimiter for patient name components in FINP (patient name in languages other than Japanese) Setting of delimiter for patient name components in FINP (patient name in Japanese language) 0: Not converted 1: Converted
73
PN_ FCM2
"FG"
64
PN_CS
74
65
PN_FDS
0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," 0: Space " " 1: Caret "^" 2: Comma "," F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix F: Family name G: Given name M: Middle name P: Prefix S: Suffix
TR1H1110.EPS
PN_ FCM3
"FGM"
75
66
PN_FDM
PN_ FCM4
"FGMP"
67
PN_ FCS1
"F"
76
PN_ FCM5
"FGMPS"
77
PN_DD
68
PN_ FCS2
"FG"
78
PN_DC
"FGMPS"
79
MON
80
BCR
81
FLMW
Setting to determine whether to 0: No (output instruction is reserved without display a window that requests the displaying a window) user to replace the film tray, 1: Yes (window displayed) when DRY PIX is used
TR1B1109.EPS
IN - 30
IN - 31
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 31.1
Parameters/Remarks
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 31.2
Item
Initial value
Setup description
BLANK PAGE
82
DK_ FILM
Setting to specify whether or not to output an HQ image in a single format to 14" x 14" film
0: DISABLE 1: ENABLE
83
DCL
Setting to specify whether or not to clear the "distribution code" at the time of image retransmission
84
FCL
Setting to specify whether or not to turn OFF the "filing option" at the time of image retransmission
85
IDNR_ CB
Setting to specify whether or not 0: Displays the forced continuation key. to display the forced continuation 1: Does not display the forced continuation key for the unregistered ID window key.
86
U_ 0810
Setting to specify whether or not to display the 8" x 10" film reduced 0: NO output setup button in the U-Utility 1: YES menu screen Setting to specify whether or not to write the image data in the shared memory into the HDD when the system has shut down due to a 046X error.
87
RST_ WRT
0: Does not write the image data into the HDD when restarting. 1: Writes the image data into the HDD when restarting. 0: Retries another HDD access without forcibly resetting the CBC. 1: Retries another HDD access with the CBC forced to be reset. * This function is effective only with a machine incorporating the MTH board which can forcibly reset the CBC. MTH08D board: Of versions B or later MTH08A board: Of versions E or later
TR1B2007.EPS
88
RST_ CBC
Setting to specify whether or not to forcibly reset the CBC (data controller LSI mounted on the MTH08 board) when HDD access timeout (104X error) occurs.
IN - 31.1
IN - 31.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 31.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 31.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
IN - 31.3
IN - 31.4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 32
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 33
G 10. SFD (default value used when manual sensitivity setting is enabled)
The default value is switched when manual sensitivity setting is enabled in 9. SFC. 0: Standard 1: Semi-High-Speed 2: High-Speed 3: Menu Default (The content previously selected in the menu is stored in memory.)
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Screen saver: In order to protect burning of the operation panel screen, this function turns OFF the screen after a certain period of time has elapsed with no user operation.
G 18. ID_FILING (selection menu for image resolution during OD-F filing)
The menu for selecting the image resolution during OD-F filing is switched. 0: DISABLE (always saved in high resolution) 1: OFF/ON selectable 2: OFF/ON*/ON ON*: The HQ image is reduced to the standard before transmission. ON: The image is transmitted without reduction. For example, the HQ image is transmitted as is.
IN - 32
IN - 33
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 34
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 35
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If the long type format is used with ID online, the host needs to support information type C.
G 51. ID_CODE_SET (acceptable character set for the CSL-type magnetic card and during ID online)
It should be set according to the character code used for the patient ID. CP850: Character code specified by IBM. It includes special characters (such as umlaut) used in Europe.
PN_CS=0 Name components and delimiters are not converted. Settings for PN_FDS/PN_FDM/ . . . . /PN_DC are ignored. <Separated by delimiter when DICOM output is generated> PN_CS=1 Name components and delimiters are converted. Settings for PN_FDS/PN_FDM/ . . . . /PN_DC are effective. Cases where the setting for each of the items is at its initial value are described below. PN_FDS=0 Space is handled as a delimiter. PN_FDM=0 Full-width space is handled as a delimiter for a patient name in Kanji. PN_FCS1=F PN_FCS2=FG PN_FCS3=FGM PN_FCS4=FGMP PN_FCS5=FGMPS PN_FCS1 through PN_FCS5 set components of a name (single-byte). If PN_FCS1 through PN_FCS5 are set as described above, they are defined as follows. PN_FCS1: If there is only one component, it is interpreted as Family name. Assume that the patient name is Fuji Taro. Then, if only Fuji is entered, Fuji is interpreted as Family name. PN_FCS2: If there are two components, they are interpreted as Family name and Given name. Assume that the patient name is Fuji Taro. Then, if Fuji Taro is entered, Fuji is interpreted as Family name and Taro as Given name (when the delimiter is a half-width space). PN_FCS3: Assume that the patient name is Rev. John M Smith Ph. D.. Then, if Smith John M is entered, Smith is interpreted as Family name, John as Given name, and M as Middle name (when the delimiter is a halfwidth space).
G 56. UID (Study/Series information numbering setting): Software version A10 or later
If the Study/Series information is not numbered on the IDT, or no numbering is performed, it is set to determine whether the Study/Series information is to be numbered or not on the machine. 0 : Numbering is not performed on the machine. 1 (default value): Numbering is performed on the machine (according to the format that is set in 45. UID_STI). If numbering is performed on the IDT, the Study/Series information numbered on the IDT is effective anyway.
IN - 34
IN - 35
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 35.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 35.2
PN_FCS4: If there are four components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, and Prefix. Assume that the patient name is Rev. John M Smith Ph. D.. Then, if Smith John M Rev. Ph. D. is entered, Smith is interpreted as Family name, John as Given name, M as Middle name, and Rev. as Prefix (when the delimiter is a halfwidth space). PN_FCS5: If there are five components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, Prefix, and Suffix. Assume that the patient name is Rev. John M Smith Ph. D.. Then, if Smith John M Rev. Ph. D. is entered, Smith is interpreted as Family name, John as Given name, M as Middle name, Rev. as Prefix, and Ph. D. as Suffix (when the delimiter is a half-width space). PN_FCM1=F PN_FCM2=FG PN_FCM3=FGM PN_FCM4=FGMP PN_FCM5=FGMPS PN_FCM1 through PN_FCM5 set components of a name (double-byte). If PN_FCM1 through PN_FCM5 are set as described above, they are defined as follows. PN_FCM1: If there is only one component, it is interpreted as Family name. PN_FCM2: If there are two components, they are interpreted as Family name and Given name. PN_FCM3: If there are three components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, and Middle name. PN_FCM4: If there are four components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, and Prefix. PN_FCM5: If there are five components, they are interpreted as Family name, Given name, Middle name, Prefix, and Suffix. PN_DD=1 [change prohibited] It defines the delimiter for the patient name when DICOM output is gener ated. PN_DD=FGMPS [change prohibited] It defines the arrangement of the components of the patient name when DICOM output is generated.
G "86. U_0810"
Enables you to let the U-Utility menu screen display the setup button for specifying whether or not to permit the 8" x 10" film output to reduce in size.
G "87.RST_WRT"
Specifies whether or not to write the image data in the shared memory into the HDD when the system has shut down due to the 046X error.
N NOTES N
Be sure to press the reset switch to restart the machine after the system has shut down due to an image data write error. If the circuit breaker is inadvertently turned OFF and then turned ON to restart, correct image data cannot be written.
Circuit breaker
Do not change the DICOM interface board (CPU90F board, LAN90D board) and the LP interface board (IMG08A board) when the machine is to be restarted after the system has shut down due to an image data write error. If the DICOM interface board (CPU90F board, LAN90D board) and the LP interface board (IMG08A board) are changed, mapping in the shared memory is changed, and as a result the correct image data cannot be written.
IN - 35.1
IN - 35.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 35.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 35.4
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
ID information or EDR data other than the image data is backed up in the HDD DOS region when the image data write error occurs. If the data cannot be backed up in the HDD DOS region, the image data cannot be written again even if the machine is restarted.
3.2
PRINT (FILMFMT.CFG)
There are 41 setup items for PRINT, and their settings are common to both the IDT and CSL types.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The CBC refers to the data controller LSI mounted on the MTH08 board.
N NOTE N
The CBC forcible resetting function is effective only with a machine incorporating the MTH board which can forcibly reset the CBC. MTH08D board: Of versions B or later MTH08A board: Of versions E or later
3.1.2 Setup Items of SYSTEM to be Changed for Second and Subsequent Machines
If two or more machines are installed, some of the setup items must be set with different values than the first machine, such as IP address and reader number. For other items, configuration setting can be achieved by copying the configuration files of the first machine and installing them to the second and subsequent machines.
16.AB: Representation of age 17.FR1: Print image frame 18.FR2: Print image frame 19.FR4: Print image frame 20.CR: Print compression rate 21.MM: Margin 22.SG: Print Standard Image on 14*17, 14*14 film like HQ Image 23.HG: Size selection of 14*17, 14*14 film character (Single format) 24.OS: DR compression in reprint 25.RF: Print reverse mark
N NOTE N
Be sure to observe the LENGTH (digits) requirements specified for the following items. If a wrong LENGTH is used, the setup results in error, so that the machine may not operate properly. 6.HN: Institution name (Max Length=60) 7.HP: 2 byte code character (Japanese, Korean) Institution name (Max Length=30)
IN - 35.3
IN - 35.4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 36
CONTENTS
Item number
A1
A2
IN - 37
Parameters Remarks
Item
Initial value
Setup description
16
AB
17
FR1
0: NO 1: YES
1 2 3 4 5 6
BF EF IF CF ET HN
1 1 1 1 1 FUJI FILM HOSPITAL 9578 8E6D 8374 8343 838B 8380 9561 8940 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 1 0 1 7 0
18 19
FR2 FR4
0 0
0: NO 1: YES 0: NO 1: YES
Compression ratio display switching 20 CR 0 Used to determine whether the compression ratio for the image for reoutput is display. 0: NO 1: YES
60Char
21
MM
0: image information dependent (default = transparent margin) 1: image information dependent (default = black margin) 2: fixed to transparent margin 3: fixed to black margin
HP
22 23
SG HG
0 0
14x17/14x14 magnification mode 14x17 single character size on 14x17/14x14 film DR compression enabled/disabled for reoutput
0: NO (Normal) 1: YES (Magnify) 0: Standard 1: Large 0: Depending on Image "1" cannot Information be used. 1: Depending on System Setting
0: NO 1: YES (""or"R-reverse") 2: YES ("AP"or"PA") 0: both displayed 1: Only area 1 displayed 2: Only area 2 displayed 3: not displayed 2 - 500 (0.1mm) 2 - 268 (0.1mm) 2 - 458 (0.1mm) 2 - 230 (0.1mm) 2 - 980 (0.1mm) 2 - 268 (0.1mm) 2 - 668 (0.1mm) 2 - 236 (0.1mm)
TR1B1011.EPS
8 9 10 11 12
GF GJ MF A1 A2
0: NO 1: YES 0: NO 1: YES
Indent
24
OS
Menu character string display switching Upper-limit age in years for age display in months Upper-limit age in months for age display in days Trimming amount (mammo)
0: NO 1: YES
25
0 99 0 12
RF
26
0.0 25.0 (mm)
CE
Display selection for film character area 1 and/or 2 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 0 horizontal size (standard) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 0 vertical size (standard) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 1 horizontal size (standard) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 1 vertical size (standard) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 0 horizontal size (large) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 0 vertical size (large) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 1 horizontal size (large) 14" x 17", 100% magnification, area 1 vertical size (large)
13
TH
0.0
The trimming amount (mammo) for four sides of the IP image in HR is set.
27 28
14
TE
The numeral value for trimming of four sides of the IP image in ST is set.
0 25 (mm)
29 30
15
CL
0: JAPANESE DATE (H10.04.01) 1: ANSI LONG DATE (1998.APR.01) 2: ANSI SHORT DATE (1998.04.01) 3: AMERICAN LONG DATE (APR.01.1998) 4: AMERICAN SHORT DATE (04.01.1998) 5: EUROPEAN LONG DATE (01.APR.1998) 6: EUROPEAN SHORT DATE (01.04.1998)
TR1B1010.EPS
31 32 33 34
IN - 36
IN - 37
CONTENTS
Item number
A1
A2
IN - 38
Remarks
CONTENTS
Item number
A1
A2
IN - 39
Remarks
Item
Initial value
Setup description Position rotation designation for 14" x 17" (35 x 43cm) areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for landscape 14" x 17" (35 x 43cm) areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for 1843 areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for 8"x10" areas 0 and 1. Position rotation designation for landscape 8"x10" areas 0 and 1 Position rotation designation for 14x14 areas 0 and 1 Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas.
Parameters
Item
Initial value
Setup description Setting to specify whether or not to print out a radiologist name. Setting to specify whether or not to print out a pixel spacing. Changing the font size for the requesting department name
Parameters
35
0010
42
Specifies the area position and rotation with four digits (abcd). a = Area 0 position 0: upper left, 1: upper right; 2: lower left; 3: lower right b = Area 0 rotation 0: No; 1: Yes c = Area 1 position 0: upper left, 1: upper right; 2: lower left; 3: lower right d = Area 1 rotation 0: No; 1: Yes
TN PS
0 0
0: Does not print out a radiologist name. Unalterable 1: Prints out a radiologist name. 0: Does not print out a pixel spacing. 1: Prints out a pixel spacing. 0: Does not change the font size. 1: Generates a film output with the font size enlarged.
TR1B2008.EPS
35
1131
43
35
0010
44
RS
35
0010
35
1131 0010 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901 XXXX: 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901
0020: 0317
35
36
FC1
Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image Area position rotation designation: output is to be generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid when an image output is to be Area position rotation designation: generated on 14" x 17", MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 14" x 14", 11" x 14", or 8" x 10" film. Valid only when an Area position rotation designation: image output is to be MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 generated on 8" x 10" film. Valid only when an Area position rotation designation: image output is to be MPM1 MPM2 . . . MPM8 generated on 8" x 10" film.
36
FC2
36
FC3
36
FC4
Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. Position rotation designation for specific MPM code (8 max.) areas. "Ene.-Sub." parameter/PEM parameter output.
36
FC5
36
FC6
1030: ?3??
37
EM
0: NO 1: YES (Ene.-Sub.) 2: YES (PEM) 0: NO 1: YES 0: NO (FCR9000 compatible) 1: YES Check for necessity to display this item before it is set. Supported by A05 or later; supported only for 15*30, 35*35, and 43*43.
38
IN
39
IM
FCR9000-compatible format support setting for 14"x14" 100% magnification/pantomo Use of long type format
40
LTC
41
XXXX: XXXX XXXX FRSC XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX
TR1B1012.EPS
IN - 38
IN - 39
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 40
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 41
G 6. HN (institution name)
Institution name displayed when 2. FNT of SYSTEM is set to other than 0 (Japanese).
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The long type format function is intended to extend the number of characters outputted to the HI-C655QA, film, and operation panel. When this function is used, the long character output is enabled in the setting of IDT-IV (A07/B07 or later).
G 41. FRSC (setting of film output with frame/without ruler): Software version A10 or later
Used to determine whether to output film with frame/without ruler. It is set by the MPM code. Up to eight MPM codes may be set. However, if without frame is set in FRT1/FR2/ FR4, the resulting film output is without frame/without ruler. Only when with frame is set in FRT1/FR2/FR4, the setting defined in FRSC is effective. Setup example 1) FRSC= 0000 0200 XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With MPM codes of 0000 and 0200 only, the film output is with frame/without ruler. Setup example 2) FRSC= ???? XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With all the MPM codes, the film output is with frame/without ruler. Setup example 3) FRSC= 020? XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX With MPM codes of 0200-020F only, the film output is with frame/without ruler.
IN - 40
IN - 41
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 41.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 41.2
G Area 0
The hospital name, patient name, sex, patient ID, age or birth date, exposure date, exposure time, set processing information, and department name are indicated. Example)
Hospital name Patient name Sex, patient ID, age Exposure date, exposure time Set processing information Department name
FR1B1243.EPS
CSY0
Area 0
CSY1
Area 1
FR1B1245.EPS
For large size: Designated with items 31. CLX0, 32. CLY0, 33. CLX1, and 34. CLY1.
CLX0 CLX1
XXXXX -A000000
G Area 1
The IP number, EDR mode/menu code, system ID/image number, image condition, normalization condition, correction item, engineer code, exposure bed information, and compression code are indicated. Example)
Gradation processing IP number EDR mode Menu code System ID Image number Frequency processing
CLY0
Area 0
CLY1
Area 1
FR1B1246.EPS
No rotation
03012246
0200
80KV10mAs XX: 22
Position 2
Position 3
Definition of position
Definition of rotation
FR1B1241.EPS
IN - 41.1
IN - 41.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 41.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 41.4
With items 36. FC1 through 36. FC4, four types of area positions and area rotations may be set for a specific MPM code (up to eight codes may be set). For a MPM code that is not set with items FC1 through FC4, a normal output format (area 0 = position 0/no rotation, area 1 = position 1/no rotation) will result.
BLANK PAGE
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
A wildcard ? may be used for one letter of a MPM code that may be set with items FC1 through FC4. ? denotes any letter, from 0 to F. Example) 123? Represents a MPM code, from 1230 to 123F.
G Setting procedures
Position/rotation definition MPM code (Up to eight codes may be set)
Setup example) FC1=0031:0123 1234 2345 3456 4567 5678 6789 789A
Area 0
Area 0 = position (0), rotation disabled (0) Area 1 = position (3), 90 rotation enabled (1)
FR1B1247.EPS
Area 1
IN - 41.3
IN - 41.4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 42
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 43
3.3
3.4
EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
It sets to determine which HOST is requested to process filing function, display function, print function, and ID information acquisition function.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
Intelligent hub: A hub that complies with SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol).
I Format
Function HostName ( HostName . . . )
I Format
denotes a space. IP address, root, parameter
G Function (function)
Function requested for the host that is set in HostName (host name). OD_FILE DISPLAY PRINT IDT (Filing function) (Display function) (Print function) (ID information acquisition function)
G Parameter
When ON NOPK When OFF denotes a space. 1000 0000 NOPK
I Setup Example
REMOTE SWITCH is set to ON. An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
| | | | | | | | | | |
It should be noted that the setup for HostName (host name) is as follows. LOCAL A host connected over an E-I/F or serial line. It is designated when direct connection is to be established. LOCAL_S A host connected over an E-I/F or serial line. It is designated when direct connection is to be established. Note, however, that high-resolution data transfer is not supported. LOCAL_R It is designated when print output is to be provided only during reoutput, without generating printout during reading. During reading, images are transferred only to the HIC/QA-WS, where image checks/ adjustments are performed, and then they are routed from the HIC/QA-WS, to the CR-IR341, and to the printer for reoutput.
N NOTE N
No output can be generated directly to the printer from the CR-IR341 where LOCAL_R setting is made.
009-051-07 08.30.2001 FM3115
IN - 42
IN - 43
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 44
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 45
Host name that is set in the HOSTS file A network-connected host. It is designated when network connection is to be established. 3.7 HOST ADDRESS (HOSTS)
3.5
I Setup Example
OD_FILE DISPLAY PRINT IDT Network-connected to odf624. Network connections to hic654 and hic655 (multiple connections) LOCAL connection and network-connected to fn-ps551. Network-connected to fcridt4-1 and fcridt4-2.
N NOTE N
Only if the CR-LP414N/FL-IM2636N or FL-IM3543N is connected to the CR-IR341 (A07 or later) (including being connected as a backup printer), the setup value for N1 in 2. LIF: siosetup.lp file should be changed from 005 to 010.
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
| | | | | | | | |
Host Name [Host Name]... = OD_FILE or DISPLAY or PRINT or IDT odf624 hic654 hic655 LOCAL fn-ps551 fcridt4-1 fcridt4-2
| | | | | | | | |
IN - 44
IN - 45
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 46
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 47
3.6
I Format
HostName:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed]
G Attr (attribute)
One of the following should be designated. Multiple attributes can be designated by delimiting them by |. PRINT HD_FILE DISPLAY OD_FILE Film output enabled Active file enabled Display function Archive file enabled
| | | | | | | | | | |
# # DEVICE # # Host Name:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed] # Attr = PRINT or HD_FILE or DISPLAY or OD_FILE # Protocol ID = 0100(FINP) or 0110(FINP) or 0200(DICOM) # System code = Hex 2 figures # Speed = Dec [Kbytes/sec] (default 8Kbytes/sec) hic654:DISPLAY|HD_FILE,0100,, odf624:OD_FILE,0100,, fn-ps551:PRINT,0100,,
| | | | | | | | | | |
If it is necessary to use the image processing exclusive selection flag, the protocol identification number needs to be set to either 0100, 0110, or 0200.
IN - 46
IN - 47
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 48
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 49
3.7
I Setup Example
CR-IR341 IDT-IV HI-C OD-F FN-PS551 2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 2 units
I Format
IP Addr Host Name
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
denotes a space.
N NOTES N
To one CR-IR341 machine, be sure to assign both a standard LAN IP address (CPU90E) and a LAN board IP address (CPU90F/LAN90B). Example) 172.16.0.1 fcr5000a ... CR-IR341#1 (CPU90E) 172.16.0.2 fcr5000a-1 ... CR-IR341#1 (CPU90F/LAN90B) Be sure to match the standard LAN IP address (CPU90E) and LAN board IP address (CPU90F) to the IP addresses set in item No. 3 IPS and item No. 4 IPI of SYSTEM: IRSET.CFG, respectively.
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | |
# # HOSTS # # Host Name = Max 10 characters #(Available Character:a-z 0-9' -[37chars]) # IP Addr Host Name 172.16.0.1 fcr5000a 172.16.0.2 fcr5000a-1 172.16.0.11 fcr5000b 172.16.0.12 fcr5000b-1 172.16.0.21 fcridt4-1 172.16.0.22 fcridt4-2 172.16.0.101 hic654 172.16.0.102 ODF624 172.16.0.103 fn-ps551
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | |
N NOTES N
If any alphabet is used in a host name, be sure to use lowercase letters. The initial letter of a host name should always be a lowercase alphabet.
| | | | | | | |
# # HOSTS # # Host Name = Max 10 characters #(Available Character:'a'-'z' '0'-'9' '-'[37chars]) # IP Addr Host Name 172.16.0.1 fcr5000 172.16.0.2 fcr5000-n 172.16.1.20 CRxxxxxxxx
| | | | | | | | |
IN - 48
IN - 49
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 50
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 51
3.8
DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB)
It sets the distribution destination for network connection. One distribution code should be defined per line. Up to 128 lines of distribution code can be defined.
3.9
ROUTING (ROUTE)
It sets the information about the router address in the network and about the network connection, when a router is used for connection to another network.
I Format
Code Host Name ( HostName )
I Setup Example
The distribution code is set. HI-C AA0123?? An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
IN - 50
IN - 51
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 52
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 53
I Setup Example
Network netmask 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0
An example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
I Format
Network netmask
| | | | | | |
denotes a space.
# Network masks database | # | # only non-default subnet masks need to be defined here | # | # Network netmask | 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0
Default setup value
The narrower the range of the network number portion, the greater portion may be handled as the host number (the greater for classes C, B, and A in this order). Thus, more host addresses (IP addresses) may be assigned within the same network (that is, a larger network may be implemented).
N NOTE N
If the networks for the CPU90E and CPU90F are the same, the same net mask should be set for both. If the CPU90F is not available, the net mask for the CPU90F is left on its default, regardless of its setting value.
IN - 52
IN - 53
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 53.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 53.2
I Setup Example
The following example (bolded entry portion) shows how to enter the DICOM settings.
I Format
HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType],[CompType],[Timeout1], [Timeout2],[DensityType] | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | # # DICOM # # HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType], # [CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2],[DensityType] # HostName = Host name defined by hosts & device # ServiceName = STORAGE_U or # AEName # # # # (Max 16 ascii characters) Dicom application(100:default). 1:Fuji Private,2:OEM Private 0:No(Implicit little endian),1:JPEG STORAGE_P = Application Entity Name defined by DICOM | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | ,STORAGE_U :DPR_DICOM,,2,1,100,600,1 | | | |
G HostName
Enter the host name that is defined by HOSTS or DEVICE.
G ServiceName
Set STORAGE_U, for the local machine and STORAGE_P for the CL.
G AEName
Set the DICOM standard Application Entity name (consisting of up to 16 ASCII characters).
# PortNo. = TCP Port Number connected to # SOPType = SOP Class Type # CompType = Compression Type # Timeout1 = connect/recv command Timeout [sec](0:endless) # Timeout2 = Every Image Trans. Timeout [sec](0:endless) # DensityType = Output Image Density # # # 0:Standard Density 1:Standard Density or High Quality Density ex)
G PortNo.
Set the TCP port number that the Base-on-DICOM application uses. This entry is meaningless for the transmitting end. The default setting is 104.
G Timeout1
Set the timeout time (in seconds) for the TCP socket connect/recv command.
G Timeout2
Set the timeout time (in seconds) for one-image transfer.
G DensityType
Set the output density for each output destination unit. 1 should always be set.
IN - 53.1
IN - 53.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 53.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 53.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
IN - 53.3
IN - 53.4
CONTENTS
An example of how to change the settings of the network-related configuration file is presented below. Referring to this example, configuration file settings should be made as appropriate for each system configuration.
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8
DEVICE
I Attr (attribute) OD_FILE: archive filing DISPLAY: display PRINT: printer HD_FILE: active filing I Protocol ID (protocol) 0001 DMS protocol 0100 FINP 0200 DICOM (Base on DICOM) I IP Addr (IP address) xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx An IP address should be set using numerals ranging from 0 to 255. A host name should be set within 10 characters, using lowercase alphabets (a-z), numerals (0-9), and hyphen (-). The initial letter of a host name should always be a lowercase alphabet.
A1
3.6
A2
HOSTS ADDRESS
HOSTS
3.7
TR1B1015.EPS
IN - 54
CONTENTS
Item
File name
Description
Format
Parameter I [Code] (distribution destination code) A distribution destination code should be set using eight alphanumerical characters or "?". Example: AA0123?? I [Host Name] (host name) The host name represents a host name that is set in the "HOSTS" file. I Dst Addr For the transfer destination IP address, a transfer destination address of an individual host or a transfer destination network address should be set. When the transfer destination network address is set, its host number portion should be "0". <NOTE 1> Example: 172.16.0.0 255.255.255.0
Remarks
Refer to
DISTRIBUTION
CODED STB
I The distribution destination code should not be set using more than 8 characters. I Up to four entries of [Host Name] (host name) may be set.
3.8
2 3
ROUTING
ROUTE
Information about the router address within the network and the IP address for network connection
Dst Addr [host name] [Host IP], [Seg Size], [Win Size], [Delay Timer], [Rate] <NOTE 1>
3.9
NETMASKS
NET MASKS
Network
netmask Network number I HostName Specify the host name that is defined by "HOSTS" and "DEVICE". I ServiceName Set "STORAGE_U" for the RU and "STORAGE_P" for the CL. I [SOPType] (SOP Class Type definition) 1: FINP 2: OEM I [CompType] (image data compression definition) 0: No compression 1: JPEG compression I [Timeout1] Timeout time (seconds) for the TCP Socket connect/recv command I [Timeout2] Timeout time (seconds) for the transfer of one image I [DensityType] Output density For [AEName], set the DICOM standard Application Entity name consisting of up to 16 ASCII characters. For [PortNo.], set the TCP port number that the Base-on-DICOM application uses. This entry is meaningless for the transmitting end. The default setting is "104". For [SOPType], choose "1". For [CompType], choose "1". For [DensityType], be sure to choose "1".
3.10
7 8 A1 A2
DICOM
DICOM
Setting of DICOM
3.11
IN - 55
<NOTE 1> The format/parameter for A08 or later is as follows. (Dst-Addr | Dst-Network-Addr) L (Router-Name | Router-Addr) , , , , The destination IP address or the destination network IP address, and the router name or the IP address of the router are set.
TR1B1016.EPS
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 56
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 57
I Setup Example 1
Two units of the IDT-IV are connected to the CPU90E board of the machine via a 10Base-T hub. The OD-F624, HI-C654 and FN-PS551 are connected to the CPU90F board of the machine via a 10Base-T hub. The machine and FL-IMD are connected via the E-i/f (IMG08A). The host is temporarily connected (including virtual equipment). The Hostname of each CR unit installed at a hospital, including the CR-IR341 itself, should be registered so that the configuration file can easily copied and restored to other units. A example of description (bold faced) for the above setup is presented below.
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
| | | | | | | | # # # Network masks database # # only non-default subnet masks need to be defined here # # Network netmask 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0 | | | | | | | |
IN - 56
IN - 57
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 58
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 59
N NOTES N
The HCP08A board (optional) and CPU90F board (optional) must be installed in the control rack. The Fuji Base-on-DICOM option software must be installed.
HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType],[CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2], [DensityType]
HostName Enter the host name that is defined by HOSTS or DEVICE. ServiceName Set STORAGE_U for the local machine and STORAGE_P for the QA-WS. AEName Set the DICOM standard Application Entity name (consisting of up to 16 ASCII characters). PortNo. Set the TCP port number that the Base-on-DICOM application uses. This entry is meaningless for the transmitting end. The default setting is 104. SOPType (SOP Class Type definition) Although two options are selectable (1: FINP; 2: OEM), choose 1. CompType (image data compression definition) Although two options are selectable (0: no compression; 1: JPEG compression), choose 1. Timeout1 Set the timeout time (in seconds) for the TCP socket connect/recv command. Timeout2 Set the timeout time (in seconds) for one-image transfer. DensityType Set the output density for each output destination unit. 1 should always be set. The following example (bolded entry portion) shows how to enter the above settings. | | | | | | | | | | | | # # DICOM # # HostName,ServiceName:AEName, [PortNo.],[SOPTType], # [CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2], # [DensityType] # # ServiceName = STORAGE_U | STORAGE_P | QR_U # | QR_P | PRINT_U | PRINT_P # fcr5000n-1,STORAGE_U :5000_DICOM,,1,1,100,600,1 qa-ws1,STORAGE_P :hic655qa-scp,5045,1,1,100,600,1 | | | | | | | | | | | |
G SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
For 2. IPS and 3. IPI, set appropriate IP addresses. For 45. UID_STI, set an appropriate examination instance user ID.
G EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
Set the transfer destination QA-WS host name (qa-ws1) as the DISPLAY attribute. To deliver the re-output from the QA-WS to the printer instead of directly delivering the output from the image reader to the printer, set LOCAL_R as the PRINT attribute.
| | |
# DISPLAY PRINT
qa-ws1 LOCAL_R
| | |
| |
# qa-ws1:DISPLAY,0200,,
| |
| | |
# 172.16.0.100 172.16.0.200
fcr5000n-1 qa-ws1
| | |
G ROUTING (ROUTE)
If the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader is not within the same network, set the IP address of the router that serves as the exit of the local network. If the destination image reader is within the same network, this setting is not required.
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
If the transfer destination QA-WS is not within the same network, set the subnet mask. If the transfer destination QA-WS is within the same network, there is no need to make this entry again.
IN - 58
IN - 59
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 60
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 61
I Setup Example 3: Printer Output Setup for Each Network Connection N NOTE N
The HCP08A board (optional) and CPU90F board (optional) must be installed in the control rack.
Perform network-specific printer output setup as indicated below.
BLANK PAGE
G SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG)
For 2. IPS and 3. IPI, set appropriate IP addresses.
G EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
Set the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader host name as the PRINT attribute. Note that only one 5000 Series image reader unit can be added.
| |
LOCAL
fcr5000n-2
| |
| |
# fcr5000n-2:PRINT,0100,,
| |
| |
# 172.16.0.100
fcr5000n-2
| |
G ROUTING (ROUTE)
If the transfer destination 5000 Series image reader is not within the same network, set the IP address of the router that serves as the exit of the local network. If the destination image reader is within the same network, this setting is not required.
G NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
If the transfer destination QA-WS is not within the same network, set the subnet mask. If the transfer destination QA-WS is within the same network, there is no need to make this entry again.
IN - 60
IN - 61
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 62
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 63
4.
4.1
I Installation Space
The space required for installation differs depending on whether the machine is secured with the anchoring members or not.
Without clamps Height: 1800 or more With clamps Height: 1800 or more 50 or more Rear 100 or more
I Product Code
CR-IR341
Rear
I Dimensions
W730 x D720 x H1720 (mm)
Unit: mm 730
200 or more
700 or more
Front
700 or more
Front
FR1B1058.EPS
1720
720
FR1B1000.EPS
I Weight
310 kg approx.
IN - 62
IN - 63
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 64
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 65
I Fixing Means
Fixing: Four adjustable feet
I Line Voltage
100VAC 10%, or 200 - 240 VAC 10%
I Capacity
0.8kVA
I Power Cord
100 V: 200 V: 3.5 m 15 m
I Rated Amperage
100 V: 200 V: 8A 4A
I Overload Protection
100 V/200 V: 15 A
I Floor Levelness
10 mm/mm (1/100 of inclination) or less for both front and rear and both right and left
I Power Consumption
0.8kVA
I Grounding (Overseas)
Use a separate cable kit specifically designed for local use, and securely insert the power plug into an indoor polarized receptacle.
I Floor Flatness
10 mm or less
I Noise
Standby: Operation: Single-shot noise: 55 dB or less 60 dB or less 70 dB or less
I Warm-up time
4 min approx.
IN - 64
IN - 65
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 66
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 67
4.2
Preinstallation Work
Before starting the grounding procedures, make sure that the place where the machine is to be installed meets the criteria set forth in SSS Installation Site Requirements. Before the machine is transferred, preinstallation procedures should be completed for necessary electrical utility, water supply/drain piping, waste solution disposal, and air-conditioning system installation work.
IN - 66
IN - 67
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 68
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 69
4.3
Tool List
N NOTE N
To service the machine, use the servicing instruments and tools that have been inspected and calibrated. If the machine were serviced using servicing instruments and tools that have not been inspected and calibrated, proper performance of the machine could not be guaranteed.
Pliers 150mm
Type: JP-200
I Standard tools
FR1H1707.EPS
FR1H1708.EPS
Digital tester
Type: FLUKE77
W-120
FR1H1724.EPS
FR1H1705.EPS
Nippers 150mm
Type: N-25
Scissors
Type: Manufacturer: Any commercially available one Qty.: Remarks: 1
Calipers
Type: N-15
Remarks: Inspection required A block gauge for use in inspection requires calibration.
FR1H1728.EPS
FR1H1730.EPS
FR1H1709.EPS
FR1H1706.EPS
FR1H1711.EPS
FR1H1712.EPS
FR1H1731.EPS
FR1H1732.EPS
Penlight
Type: BF-318 Manufacturer: MATSUSHITA ELECTRIC Qty.: Remarks: 1
FR1H1719.EPS
FR1H1714.EPS
FR1H1733.EPS
FR1H1738.EPS
IN - 68
IN - 69
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 69.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 69.2
Blower
Type: JUMBO
Cloth
Type:
BLANK PAGE
FR1H1740.EPS
FR1H1741.EPS
IN - 69.1
IN - 69.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 69.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 69.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
IN - 69.3
IN - 69.4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 70
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 71
5.
5.1
Temporary Placement
Unloading, Transfer, and Unpacking
(2) Remove the top protective cover from the machine, and pull out the nails from it.
N NOTE N
Use care not to break the top protective cover. The top protective cover is needed when placing the machine from the carrier pallet down onto the floor.
(3) Remove the wooden crate pieces and protective members, except for the vinyl sheet left that directly covers the machine.
Top protective cover (placed upside down for use as slope)
I Unloading
CAUTIONS
Exercising due care to avoid nails that retain the wooden crate pieces, dismantle the wooden crate. Once the wooden crate is dismantled, pull out the nails immediately. If the crate pieces are left with nails attached, someone or the machine may get hurt.
(1) Secure a transfer path of the machine. Move away any obstacle out of the way on the transfer entry, corridors, and corners, so that the machine can be moved to the installation place safely. Also, see that an elevator is available.
CAUTION
Before unloading the machine, be sure to secure its transfer path.
Carrier pallet
FR1B1011.EPS
IN - 70
IN - 71
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 72
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 73
(4) Remove the four clamps that fasten the machine to the carrier pallet. If you use the removed clamps for machine installation, bring them together with the machine to the installation site.
(5) Nail the top protective cover removed at step (2) onto the carrier pallet on the rear side of the machine to form a slope for placing the machine down onto the floor.
N NOTES N
The slope should be formed on the rear side of the machine. If the slope is formed on the front side of the machine, the adjustable feet will interfere with the floor when the machine is put down from the carrier pallet, so that it cannot be put down smoothly. Both upper-end corners of the top protective cover should be nailed securely onto the carrier pallet. If you try to lower the machine without nailing the top protective cover down, the top protective cover may move out of position, causing the machine to topple down. The top protective cover should be used as a slope only once when the machine is unloaded. If the top protective cover is used many times, it may lose strength, so that it may be broken when the machine is placed on it.
Machine
Carrier pallet
Side view Machine Loosen nut Clamp Loosen hex socket head bolt Remove nut
Nail
Rear of machine
FR1B1093.EPS
Adjustable foot
Carrier pallet
FR1B3034.EPS
(6) Raise the adjustable feet of the machine all the way up. (7) Move the machine over the slope surface with the aid of the machine casters until it is lowered from the carrier pallet.
CAUTION
When moving the machine over the slope surface with the aid of the casters, be sure to have an assistant support the upper portion of the machine for the purpose of preventing the machine from toppling down. Also, move the machine slowly over the slope surface to avoid shocking the machine.
Machine Push When the machine is unloaded, its adjustable feet may come into contact with the floor, thereby damaging the floor surface. If it is necessary to protect the floor surface, fold up the moisture-proof sheet that covered the machine, and place it between the slope plate and floor before unloading the machine.
FR1B1013.EPS
IN - 72
IN - 73
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 74
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 75
I Transfer
Bring the machine into the installation place.
5.2
CAUTIONS
When the machine is transferred with its casters, be sure to raise the adjustable feet of the machine all the way up. When bringing the machine into the installation place, support it so that it will not topple down. Because the machine is top-heavy, it may topple during transit. If the machine should be moved over some step or bump, move it as slowly as possible to avoid shock to it. Note that the step over which the machine may move over is about 10 mm high at most.
I Unpacking
CAUTION
Allow the packed machine to stand at a room temperature for an adequate period of time. If you unpack it immediately after transferring it indoors, moisture condensation may occur on the machine.
Carrier pallet
FR1B1012.EPS
The machine retaining members also serve as retainers used during transit.
IN - 74
IN - 75
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 76
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 77
5.2.3 Options
DMC08A board (DMS interface board) Required to establish local connection with the DMS. IMG08B/H board LAN90B board or CPU90F board (Ethernet card, 100BASE-TX Intelligent LAN card) HCP08A board (Ethernet card) 1 1 1 1
5.3
Rear
600 or more
Machine
700 or more
I Small-size box 2
Power cable kit 100-200 V spec for Japan and US 200-240 V spec for Europe (excluding UK) 200-240V spec for UK 1 (either model)
Front 700 or more Unit: mm
FR1B1004.EPS
I Small-size box 3
IMG08A board (LP interface board) Required to establish local connection with the LP. 1
Machine Seating face on the frame side
I Medium-size box
Erasure lamp assembly 1
Nut
I Large-size box:
Light-collecting guide assembly 1
Adjustable foot
FR1B1005.EPS
IN - 76
IN - 77
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 78
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 79
6.
6.1
Installation
Work Flow
START
6.2
Unclamp and install separate packaged items (other than the printed circuit boards)
Put the removed clamps and screws in one place. After unclamping, count them to check that nothing is left unclamped. "6.2 Unclamping and Installing Separate packaged Items"
Vertical conveyor
END
FR1B1218.EPS
Erasure conveyor
Power supply
Light-collecting guide Scanning optics unit After-reading conveyor Sub-scanning unit Side-positioning conveyor
FR1B1144.EPS
IN - 78
IN - 79
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 80
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 81
(6) Lower left-hand side cover Tape (7) Upper front cover
(4)
(5)
Tape x3
(9)
FR1B1032.EPS
IN - 80
IN - 81
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 82
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 83
I Procedures
(1) Cut the four cable ties that retain the changeover guide. (2) Remove the two brackets. (3) Reposition the brackets removed at step (2).
START
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
Unclamping Vertical Conveyor Pulling out Tray of Cassette Set Unit Unclamping Multi-Stage Cassette Loading Cover Removing Multi-Stage Cassette Loading Cover Unclamping Cassette Set Unit Removing Cassette Set Unit
Cable tie
FR ON T
Be sure to reposition the brackets because they will be used as jigs for adjusting the cassette hold solenoid. The two screws used to retain the vertical conveyor should be removed and kept in another place for later use.
(1)
Unclamping IP Removal Unit Reinstalling Cassette Set Unit Pushing in Tray of Cassette Set Unit
(2),(3) (2),(3) Bracket Reposition BR M4x8, x2 Bracket
Vertical conveyor
Bracket BR M4x8, x2
Bracket BR M4x8, x2
FRB1030.EPS
IN - 82
IN - 83
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 84
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 85
(4) Remove one tape and four foam blocks from the multi-stage cassette loading cover. (5) Remove one tape that retains the ferrite core. (6) Disconnect the connectors (CNA1 3 from the cassette set unit; CNB1, 3, 4 from the up-down IP removal unit; CNT1 from the multi-stage cassette loading cover). (7) Slide the tensioner until the timing belt can be removed. Loosen the screw (BR M4x8) that retains the tensioner to slide the tensioner as appropriate, and then secure the tensioner in place. 3.4 Tensioners Not Requiring Tension Adjustment in Machine Description (8) Remove the timing belt. (9) Remove one screw that retain the multi-stage cassette loading cover and the two screws that retain the tray of the cassette set unit. (10) While using care to prevent the connector cables, etc. from getting caught, pull out the tray of the cassette set unit.
Up-down IP removal unit (6) CNB4 CNB3
(11) Remove the six screws that retain the multi-stage cassette loading cover. (12) Pull out the multi-stage cassette loading cover horizontally. (13) Remove four tapes that retains the inch/metric guide assembly and four tapes that retains the 24x30 mammo guide assembly. (14) Cut four cable ties that retains the solenoid.
Inch/metric guide assembly
(12)
CNB1
ON FR
FR1B1081.EPS
(15) Remove the six screws that retain the cassette set unit. (16) Pull out the cassette set unit horizontally. (17) Remove one tape that retains the IP removal arm, and one foam block.
Vertical conveyor (7), (8) Timing belt
With the foam block pushed by the finger, remove the tape by slowly moving it horizontally, using care not to bend the IP removal arm. (18) Remove the single tape that retains the IP removal arm located on the right-hand side of the IP removal unit.
IP removal unit (17) Tape IP removal arm Foam block Guide plate
BR M4x8
F NT RO
(10) (6) CNT1 (9) Tray of cassette set unit BR M4x8, x2 (5) Ferrite core Tape Foam block Tape
FR
FR1B1080.EPS
(4)
Front view
(16)
Tape
FR1B1231.EPS
IN - 84
IN - 85
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 86
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 87
(19) Rotate the timing belt to move up the IP removal unit to about 10 - 20 mm.
(19) Timing belt
(21) Reinstall the cassette set unit horizontally along the positioning brackets (22) Secure the cassette set unit in place with six screws.
Top view (21) Positioning bracket
IP removal unit
Cassette set unit
F R O N T
FR
ON
(21) Top stay of up-down IP removal unit Push top stay of up-down IP removal unit Cassette set unit
FR1B1236.EPS
(20) Remove the two tapes and two foam blocks for absorbing the shock that would be applied to the IP removal assembly when it falls.
IP removal unit
T ON FR
FR1B1062.EPS
IN - 86
IN - 87
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 88
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 89
(23) While using care to prevent the connector cables, etc. from getting caught, put the cassette set unit back where it was.
(28) Mount the multi-stage cassette loading cover on the machine main body, and loosely retain the four lower screws.
N NOTE N
CAUTION
When removing and installing the units, use care not to damage the cables.
(24) Secure the tray of the cassette set unit in place with two screws. (25) Connect the connectors (CNA1 3 to the cassette set unit; CNB1, 3, 4 to the up-down IP removal unit). (26) Attach the timing belt to the timing belt wheel. (27) Put the tensioner back where it was originally located. Loosen the screw (BR M4x8) that retains the tensioner. Flick the timing belt several times to ensure that it snugly fits onto the timing belt wheel, and then secure the tensioner in place. 3.4 Tensioner Not Requiring Tension Adjustment in Machine Description
Up-down IP removal unit (25) CNB4
Accomplish positioning at the time of multi-stage cassette loading cover installation. If you do not complete positioning, a cassette holding failure may occur.
FR
T ON
(29) Insert a 150 mm scale along the right-hand side of the lowermost shelf (fourth shelf).
CNB3
Press the manual release lever to lower the hold pin. (30) Slide the multi-stage cassette loading cover until the scale comes into contact with the cassette set unit entry reference guide protrusion (level difference: 0.5 1 mm), and then tighten the four screws that were loosely retained.
CNB1
(29)
(23) (24) Tray of cassette set unit BR M4x8, x2 (23) Push it all the way in until the bracket comes into contact with the pin. Cassette set unit (25) CNA3 BR M4x8
(29)
Top view (30) 0.5 - 1mm Cassette set unit entry reference guide (white plastic)
CNA1 CNA2
Tensioner
Scale
FR1B1237.EPS
IN - 88
IN - 89
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 90
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 91
(31) Insert a 300-mm scale along the right edge of the topmost shelf (first shelf). Push the manual release lever so that the hold pin is withdrawn. (32) Secure the multi-stage cassette loading cover in place. Loosely tighten the two screws on top of the cover, and take positioning steps (30) for the topmost shelf (first shelf) before screwing it down.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
Because of parts machining precision, the multi-stage cassette loading cover may be slightly warped when secured, though this will not pose any problem. Alignment with the cassette set unit should take first priority.
Scale
I Procedures
Manual release lever
(31)
T ON FR
(32) Top view Multi-stage cassette loading (32) cover BR M4x8, x2 0.51mm (33) CNT1
(1) Cut the single cable tie for retaining the branch path changeover guide driving solenoid (SOLF1).
Cassette set unit entry reference guide (white plastic)
Erasure conveyor
0.51mm
Scale
Erasure conveyor
FR1B1021.EPS
IN - 90
IN - 91
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 92
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 93
(2) Take out the erasure lamp assembly from the mid-size box contained as part of the separately packaged items.
6.2.4 Procedures at Side-Positioning Conveyor, Subscanning Unit, and Power Supply Unit
I Workflow
FRONT
CAUTION
Carefully handle the erasure lamp. If it is hit, the erasure lamp may be broken, so you may get injured.
(3) Install the erasure lamp assembly into the erasure conveyor.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
When inserting the erasure lamp assembly, align the positioning pin located on the right-hand side of the inlet into the hole of the erasure lamp assembly, and push it all the way into the erasure conveyor.
(4) Using the mounting screw supplied, secure the erasure lamp assembly in place. (5) Connect the connectors (DCOUT 4, 5, ACOUT 1, 2).
(5) Power supply DCOUT5 ACOUT2
I Procedures
(1) Remove the single screw that retains the clamp and side-positioning member.
DCOUT4 ACOUT1
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The screw removed should be kept in another place for later use.
(2) Loosen the single screw that retains the clamp onto the MD1, and slide the clamp leftward and secure it in place.
(3) Erasure lamp assembly
ET RES ON SW
te Remo Local
OFF
Erasure conveyor
T ON FR
(2)
(6) Cut the single cable tie for retaining the changeover guide driving solenoid (SOLC1).
Side-positioning conveyor
FR ON T
FR
ON
T
FR1B1029.EPS
Before-sidepositioning conveyor
FR1B1091.EPS
IN - 92
IN - 93
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 94
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 95
(3) Remove the transparent cover located on the left-hand side of the machine. (4) Remove the single tape and foam block for retaining the tensioner.
FG Hole
Kapton belt
TB1 L N G (7)
Re
ON RE SE OF F
mo
te
T SW
(10)
Rem ote
Lo
Loc al
ca l
Power cable
FR ON
Flywheel
Bracket BR M4x8, x2
FR
ON T
FR1B1083.EPS
(5) While rotating the flywheel by hand, check to ensure that the Kapton belt does not come off the pulley and that there is no offensive noise. (6) Reinstall the transparent cover removed at step (3). (7) Place in the REMOTE position the REMOTE/LOCAL switch of the power supply unit located on the left-hand side of the machine. (8) Take out the power cable from the small-sized box. (9) Put the power cable through the hole in the frame and connect it to TB1 of the power supply unit. (10) Attach the power cable retaining bracket to the machine.
T SW SE RE ON
ote Rem al Loc
(12) Set to ON the circuit breaker located on the left-hand side of the machine.
S RE ON
ET
SW
ote Rem l ca Lo
F OF
Circuit breaker
F OF
FR
ON
FR1B1034.EPS
IN - 94
IN - 95
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 96
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 97
(13) With the power plug unplugged, measure the resistance value between terminals shown in the table below.
BLANK PAGE
CAUTION
If anything abnormal is found with the results of the check for power supply short, take remedial action as appropriate with reference to 3. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Improper Operation in Troubleshooting before proceeding to the next step.
If the specified value shown in the table is not met, connect the power supply all over again. Terminal Resistance value L-N 180K to 230K L-E N-E E-E 0.2 or less
<UK model> E N L L N
<US/Japan model>
E L N
FG E
TB1 L N G
FR1B1084.EPS
IN - 96
IN - 97
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 98
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 99
I Procedures
CAUTIONS
C "6.2.4 Procedures at Side-Positioning Conveyor and Subscanning Unit"
Pulling Out Scanner Unit Unclamping Scanner Unit Installing Light-Collecting Guide Pushing in Scanner Unit
Before pulling out the scanner unit, be sure to remove the two bracket retaining screws located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board and disconnect the connectors. If pulled out without removing them, the SCN08A board may be damaged. When pulling out the scanner unit, be sure to lower the adjustable feet down to the floor. If not, the bolts of the adjustable feet would interfere with the cable cover. When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
(1) Disconnect the connectors (CN7-9, CNZ6-8, 10 from the SCN08A board; CNZ1, 2, 4, 5 from the subscanning unit).
Subscanning unit
CN7 CN9
CNZ8 CNZ10
FR O
NT
Scanner unit
FR1B1220.EPS
The cables connected to the SCN08A board should be pushed aside to the right and top sides of the scanner unit, while the cables connected to the subscanning unit, both front and rear, should be fitted beneath the cable cover.
Cable
FR ON T
Cable cover
T ON
FR
ON
Cable
T
FR1B1219.EPS
IN - 98
IN - 99
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 100
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 101
(2) Remove the two bracket retaining screws located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board. (3) Remove the two screws that retain the scanner unit. (4) Remove the three shock absorbers and three tapes from the bottom of the scanner unit. (5) Pull out the scanner unit.
(7) Remove the bottom retaining screw from each of the four scanner unit retaining brackets, and loosen the screw on the scanner unit. (8) Move the four brackets furthest away from the bottom and secure them in place. The four screws that retain the brackets should be removed and kept separately.
Example where the bracket is moved away from the bottom
FR ON T
N NOTE N
When pulling out the scanner unit, use care so that it is not caught by the connectors or cables disconnected.
(6) Bracket
FR ON T
Scanner unit
FR1B1016.EPS
(5)
(10) Remove the single screw from the light-collecting guide retaining arm, and rotate the arm. (11) Remove the single tape that retains the connector (CN1, 2).
FR1B1015.EPS
After-reading conveyor
ME2
CN1
CNME2
(5)
Scanner unit
FR ON T
FR1B1017.EPS
FR1B1217.EPS
IN - 100
IN - 101
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 102
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 103
(12) Take out the light-collecting guide assembly from the large-size box.
(13) Carefully install the light-collecting guide assembly onto the subscanning unit, while exercising care to prevent contact with surrounding units.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when installing the light-collecting guide assembly. If installed with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Never touch the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide assembly even when you are wearing the gloves. Carefully handle the light-collecting guide assembly to avoid damage to it due to contact with surrounding objects. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Never touch the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide, even when you are wearing gloves. Carefully handle the light-collecting guide to avoid damage to it due to contact with surrounding objects. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide. When inserting the light-collecting guide assembly, align the protrusions located at both ends of the light-receiving face of the light-collecting guide assembly against the reference plane in the subscanning direction, and the front protrusion against the reference pin in the main scan direction.
(13) Light-collecting guide assembly Subscanning unit
Lightcollecting guide
Light-receiving face
FR1H1171.EPS
FR
ON
F R O N T
Protrusion Lightreceiving Main scan face direction Positioning pin Reference plane in subscan direction
Side view (13) Light-collecting guide Sponge Reference plane in subscan direction Insert it along the sponge in contact with the pin. The right- and left-hand light-receiving edges of the light-collecting guide must be in close contact.
FR1B1019.EPS
Pin The light-collecting guide must be in close contact with the pin.
IN - 102
IN - 103
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 104
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 105
(14) While supporting the light-collecting guide assembly, secure it with the light-collecting guide assembly retaining arm in place. While pushing the shaft portion of the light-collecting guide retaining arm, rotate it. Make sure that the stopper hooks the inner protrusion of the light-collecting guide assembly, and the screw it down.
(16) Make sure that the socket of the PMT08A board is fitted into the socket of the lightcollecting guide and that the sockets of the PMT08A board and light-collecting guide are parallel to each other. If anything abnormal is found, remove the single screw that retains the light-collecting guide retaining bracket. While holding the light-collecting guide, push in the PMT08A board assembly, and adjust the position of the sockets of the PMT08A board and lightcollecting guide as appropriate. After the brace is fixed with the screw, verify again that the sockets are parallel, and then proceed to the next step.
N NOTE N
When pushing the light-collecting guide assembly retaining arm, be sure to push down its shaft portion. If the arm portion is pushed, the arm itself may be deformed.
(15) Secure the light-collecting guide assembly in place with the mounting screw supplied and brace.
CAUTIONS
Wear gloves when handling the light-collecting guide assembly. If it is handled with bare hands, the light-collecting guide assembly may be soiled or damaged. Wear a mask to prevent saliva from sputtering around on the light-collecting guide.
Parallel Light-collecting guide assembly Not parallel
CAUTION
Once the light-collecting guide is secured in place with the brace, make sure that the light-collecting guide assembly is not dislocated from its fixed position (i.e., position as instructed in the side view illustrated at step (12), where the light-collecting guide must be in close contact). If it is dislocated, move the light-collecting guide retaining bracket to adjust the fixed position as appropriate.
OK
NG
FR1H1798.EPS
Mounting screw supplied BR M4x12 Brace supplied Light-collecting guide assembly retaining bracket
(14) Stopper
FR1B1020.EPS
IN - 104
IN - 105
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 106
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 107
(17) Connect the connectors (CN1 and CN2 on the PMT08A board). (18) While pushing the stopper located on the front side of the machine, put the scanner unit back into the machine until the stopper located on the rear side of the machine is activated. (19) While pushing the stopper located on the rear side of the machine, put the scanner unit all the way into the machine.
(23) Make sure that the no-fuse breaker settings on the SCN08A board are all shorted (in the ON position). The no-fuse breakers (NFB) are to be shorted (ON) at factory prior to shipment and must be so at installation. However, since they may unexpectedly turn OFF due to vibration during transit, press all the no-fuse breaker buttons two or three times to ensure that they are depressed to ON.
No-fuse breaker status
N NOTE N
When putting the scanner unit back where it was, use care so that it is not caught by the connectors and cables disconnected.
(17)
ON position
OFF position
FR1B1147.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
FR
With board version J or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
ON T
NFB5/F5
CN2
CN1
FR1B1028.EPS
NFB4/F4 NFB2/F2
(20) Using two screws, secure the bracket located on the upper portion of the SCN08A board. (21) Secure the scanner unit in place with two screws. (22) Connect the connectors (CN7-9, CNZ6-8, 10 on the SCN08A board; CNZ1, 2, 4, 5 on the subscanning unit).
Sub-scanning unit (22) CNZ4 CNZ5 CNZ2 CN7 CNZ1 CN9 CN8 CNZ6 CNZ7 (20) Bracket BR M4x8, x2 SCN08A board (22)
FR1B1177.EPS
FR ON T
CNZ8 CNZ10
IN - 106
IN - 107
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 108
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 109
I Procedures
CAUTION
When servicing any printed circuit board, be sure to wear an anti-static wristband to ensure proper grounding. If not, static electricity built on the human body may cause damage to electric parts mounted on the board.
The no-fuse breaker (NFB) is to be shorted (in the ON position) by factory default and during installation. Because it may be accidentally placed in the OFF position due to vibration during transit, push each of the no-fuse breaker buttons several times to ensure that they are all depressed to ON.
No-fuse breaker status
I Workflow
FRONT
Checking No-fuse Breaker on DRV08A Board Checking No-fuse Breaker on SNS08A Board
ON position
OFF position
FR1B1147.EPS
END
FR1B1146.EPS
(1) Make sure that the no-fuse breaker settings on the DRV08A board are all shorted (in the ON position).
NFB12/F1
FR1B1173.EPS
(2) Make sure that the no-fuse breaker settings on the SNS08A board are all shorted (in the ON position).
NFB2/F2 NFB1/F1 NFB3/F3
FR1B1174.EPS
IN - 108
IN - 109
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 110
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 111
6.3
CAUTION
Use care not to depress the white button of the no-fuse breaker more than necessary. If it is depressed too much, it may remain depressed, thereby causing OPEN/CLOSE failure. Especially, do not strongly push it with a pen point or the like.
MTH08A/D board
FR ON T
(1)
(1) Loosen Truss M4x8 (1) Board retaining plate Sems M3x8, x2
IMG07B board
FR1B1507.EPS
IN - 110
IN - 111
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 112
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 113
(2) Disconnect the connectors (CN6-8, 11, 18, 19 from the CPU90E board).
(4) When the MTH08A board is used, check that all the no-fuse breakers are shorted (ON). The no-fuse breaker (NFB) is to be shorted (in the ON position) by factory default and during installation. Because it may be accidentally placed in the OFF position due to vibration during transit, push each of the no-fuse breaker buttons several times to ensure that they are all depressed to ON.
No-fuse breaker status
MTH08A/D board
N RO
ON position
OFF position
FR1B1147.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
CPU90E board
With board version D or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
NFB5/F5 NFB1/F1
CPU90E board
CN2 CN1
NFB4/F4
NFB2 /F2
CN19
T SW SE RE
ote Rem al
CN7
ON
Loc
F OF
FR
(5) When the MTH08D board is used, check that the S1 is set as indicated below:
S1 setup
Bit 1, 2 3 4 5, 6 7 8 Description SDRAM type selection OFF (both bits): 128MB SDRAM DIMM CL use OFF: Not used Refresh cycle setting OFF: 4K refresh DIMM use OFF: Not used DIMM size selection ON: 64MW Undefined Setting OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MTH08A/D board
S1 ON position
1 2 3 4 OFF position
8
FR1B1511.EPS
CPU90E board
FR1B1175.EPS
IN - 112
IN - 113
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 114
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 115
N NOTE N
Take the following procedures to remove the MMC90A/DIM08A board. If the procedures are not observed, the connector tab(s) may be damaged. G MMC90A board (1) Push out the left tab of the connector. (2) Press out the left end of the MMC90A board at an angle of 30-40. (3) Remove the MMC90A board.
Top view
REFERENCE
For CR-IR341 units with Serial Numbers 2848 and above and CR-IR361 units with Serial Numbers 2048 and above, you do not have to perform the installation procedure for the MMC90A/DIM08A because it is factory installed in the machine prior to shipment. The MMC90A board is connected to the CN17 and CN18. The DIM08A board is connected to the CN17. However, for units with the following serial numbers, the MMC90A board is a separate packaged item, so that its installation procedures should be performed. CR-IR341 #28492852, 2854, 2858, 2860, 2863, 2868, 2873, 2883, 2894 CR-IR361 #20502055, 20572075
Install the MMC90A boards (the memory modules) to the connectors (CN17, 18) of the MTH08A board.
(1) Connector (2) (3)
FR1B1508.EPS
G DIM08A board (1) Simultaneously open the claws on both ends of the connector by pressing them outward. (2) Remove the DIM08A board by pulling it horizontally.
Top view
N NOTE N
When mounting the MMC90A board, pay attention to the following points. Do not touch the connector portion of the MMC90A board, but grasp both ends of the board. Open the tabs of CN17/18, align the notches of the MMC90A board to the notched edges in the CN17/18 slot, and insert the MMC90A board straight into the slot, while holding both ends of the board . After installing the MMC90A board, make sure that the tabs have been closed and the MMC90A board has been securely locked into place.
MTH08A board CN18 CN17 MMC90A board Tab Push both ends of the module. Notched edge Tab
(2)
DIM08A board
FR1H1601.EPS
Notch
MMC90A board
FR1B1186.EPS
IN - 114
IN - 115
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 115.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 115.2
(2) Install the CPU90E board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the CPU90E board supplied into the bottom slot, and secure it in place with two mounting screws supplied.
MTH08A/D board
CPU90E board
ON position OFF position
FR1B1147.EPS
FR1B1178.EPS
N NOTE N
With board version G or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
Nos. 1 and 2 of S2 (both are in the OFF position by factory default) should be placed in the ON position. If they remain in the OFF position, the memory cannot be backed up, so the setup cannot be saved. The rest should be set as follows. S1: All OFF S2: Nos. 3 and 4 are OFF S5: STRAIGHT S6: RS-422 S7: All ON
S1 OFF position S7 OFF position S2 OFF position
MTH08A/D board
FR
ON
(2)
8 7 6 5 ON position CN2
4 3 2 1 ON position
4 3 2 1 ON position CN1
(3) Connect the connectors (CN6-8, 11, 18, 19 on the CPU90E board).
CPU90E board
NFB4/F4
CN2
CN1
NFB2/F2
NFB3/F3 NFB1/F1
S5 STRAIGHT position
CROSS position
S6 RS-422 position
CN19
RS-232C position
CN7 CN18
FR1B1149.EPS
CN11
CN8
CN6
FR1B1221.EPS
IN - 115.1
IN - 115.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 115.3
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 115.4
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
IN - 115.3
IN - 115.4
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 116
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 117
(2) Install the IMG07B board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the IMG07B board supplied into the second slot from the bottom, and secure it in place with two screws supplied.
MTH08A/D board
IMG07B board
FR1B1179.EPS
MTH08A/D board
S1
F01
CD AB E
Set to "4"
23
4 56
789
O FR
FR1B1195.EPS
NT
IN - 116
IN - 117
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 118
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 119
(2) Make sure that the switches on the CPU90F board are set as illustrated below.
G CPU90F board
CNSI0 No short pin (OPEN) T1,2 Short pin 3 2
N NOTE N
CPU90F board version N or later, the software version of the machine should be updated to A09 or later. Earlier software versions do not support a newer LSI (discontinuation supported) on the daughter board (ETH90F board) of the CPU90F board.
(1) For the CPU90F board, make sure that the no-fuse breakers are all shorted (in the ON position). The no-fuse breakers (NFBs) are to be shorted (ON) at factory prior to shipment and must be so at installation. However, since they may unexpectedly turn OFF due to vibration during transit, press all the no-fuse breaker buttons two or three times to ensure that they are depressed to ON.
No-fuse breaker status
1 CN1
CN2
NFB1/F1
DIS1
SW1
ON position
OFF position
FR1B1147.EPS
OFF position
4 56
4 3 2 ON position 1 4 3 2 ON position 1
789
F01
S1
CD AB E
N NOTE N
CPU90F board version M or later, the no-fuse breaker (NFB) is replaced with the fuse. Thus, make sure that the fuse has not been blown.
23
Set to "6"
FR1B1136.EPS
G LAN90B board
S3 CN2 CN1
CD AB E
F01
23
4 56
CN7
CN6
S2 OFF position 1 2 3 4 5 6
S2 setting bit 13, 5, 6 4 ON position Description To be determined ON: Function test (FT) OFF: OS boot (NORMAL) Setting Always OFF Always OFF
FR1B1266.EPS
IN - 118
789
IN - 119
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 120
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 121
(3) Remove the slot cover, and reposition its two screws to the CPU90F board or LAN90B board.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The slot cover removed should be repositioned to any vacant slot located below its original position. If there is no free slot, the slot cover should be kept in another place for later use.
(4) Install the CPU90F board or LAN90B board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the CPU90F board or LAN90B board into the top slot, and secure it in place with the two screws that were used to secure the slot cover.
MTH08A/D board
4 56
FR1B1185.EPS
789
F01
CD AB E
MTH08A/D board
23
Set to "5"
FR1B1105.EPS
T ON FR
(4)
IN - 120
IN - 121
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 122
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 123
(2) Remove the slot cover supplied, and reposition its two screws to the HCP08A board.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The slot cover removed should be repositioned to any vacant slot located below its original position. If there is no free slot, the slot cover should be kept in another place for later use.
(3) Install the HCP08A board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the HCP08A board into the second slot from the top, and secure it in place with the two screws that were used to secure the slot cover.
MTH08A/D board
CN3 CN4
CN5
S1
FR1B1184.EPS
CD AB E
F01
23
4 56
MTH08A/D board
Set to "0"
T ON FR
(3)
IN - 122
789
FR1B1107.EPS
IN - 123
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 124
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 125
(2) Remove the slot cover supplied, and reposition its two screws to the DMC08A board.
BLANK PAGE
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The slot cover removed should be repositioned to any vacant slot located below its original position. If there is no free slot, the slot cover should be kept in another place for later use.
(3) Install the DMC08A board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the DMC08A board into the second slot from the top, and secure it in place with the two screws that were used to secure the slot cover.
MTH08A/D board
FR1B1183.EPS
MTH08A/D board
O FR
NT
(3)
IN - 124
IN - 125
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 126
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 127
CN6
CN3 CN4
CN5
S1
F01
CD AB E
CN3 S1
F01
Set to "1"
Push the IMG08B board into the fourth slot from the top, and secure it in place with two screws supplied.
MTH08A/D board
FR1H1904.EPS
23
4 56
FR1B1196.EPS
(2) Make sure that the IMG08H board has been securely inserted in place.
MTH08A/D board
FR1B1600.EPS
IN - 126
789
23
4 56
789
IN - 127
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 128
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 129
(2) Remove the slot cover, and reposition its two screws to the IMG08A board.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The slot cover removed should be repositioned to any vacant slot located below its original position. If there is no free slot, the slot cover should be kept in another place for later use.
(3) Install the IMG08A board to the MTH08A/D board. Push the IMG08A board into the fourth slot from the bottom, and secure it in place with the two screws that were used to secure the slot cover.
MTH08A/D board
CN6 CN3
IMG08A board
CN5 CN4
S1
F01
CD AB E
FR1B1180.EPS
Set to "1"
23
4 56
FR1B1196.EPS
789
MTH08A/D board
FR
T ON
IN - 128
IN - 129
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 129.1
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 129.2
BLANK PAGE
N NOTE N
After installing the board retaining plate, be sure to check if the board retaining plate is fitted to the frame. If it is not fitted properly, check to ensure again that the boards have been installed as appropriate.
FR
ON
FR1B1194.EPS
IN - 129.1
IN - 129.2
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 130
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 131
6.4
6.5
WARNING
Be sure to turn OFF the high-voltage switch before powering ON with the covers removed. If the machine is powered ON with any of the covers removed, the photomultiplier will be damaged.
(2) Connect the power plug into the power outlet.
CAUTIONS
Do not connect a telephone line to a connector that is marked with an alert symbol having an exclamation mark. Only the LAN cables for 10BaseT/100BaseT (IEC950/UL1950 standard) are suitable for this machine. For the network cable connection to the CPU90F board, use a shielded type (STP). For the network cable connection to the LAN90B board, use a shielded type (STP) or unshielded type (UIP).
LAN90B board or CPU90F board DMC08A board IMG08A board For HUB (100BASE-T or 10BASE-T) For DMS For LP CPU90E board For modem For remote switch For HUB (IDT, 10BASE-T) 100BASE-T or 10BASE-T I/F cable CR Console (CR-IR348CL) For monitor
FR O NT
OFF position
Scanner unit SCN08A board
FR1B1239.EPS
Network
LP I/F cable
LP
Network
HUB (10BASE-T)
ID-T741
Monitor I/F cable Remote switch I/F cable Modem I/F cable
VGA monitor
Modem
FR1B1197.EPS
IN - 130
S1 HVON
IN - 131
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 132
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 133
(3) Make sure that the REMOTE/LOCAL switch is placed in the REMOTE position. (4) Make sure that the system power is in the OFF position.
BLANK PAGE
T ON FR
FR1B1222*.EPS
IN - 132
IN - 133
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 134
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 135
6.6
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If an HV OFF error or line connection error for IDT, LP, etc. occurs during the initialization sequence, press the CHECK button. To check for errors during the initialization sequence, take steps as described in 8. Final Installation and Checks.
The exhaust fans and intake fans to be checked for operation are located at four points. Make sure that they operated during the initialization sequence of the machine. Fan located on upper portion of right-hand side: Two intake fans (monitor side and right-hand side cover) Fan located on lower portion of right-hand side: Three exhaust fans (Two power supply units and One erasure lamp) Fan located on upper portion of rear: One exhaust fan Fan located on upper portion of front left-hand side: Two intake fans
W TS SE RE ON
ote Rem ca l
Lo
RE ON
T SW SE
Rem
ote
F OF
al Loc
Circuit breaker
OF
O FR
NT
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
FR1B1034.EPS
For the exhaust fan attached to the erasure lamp assembly, check its operation during IP conveyance checks.
ND ND
WI
ND
WI
WI
ND
WI WI
ND
ND
T ON FR
FR1B1222.EPS
The initialization sequence starts. The machine starts up about four and a half minutes later.
FR1B1031.EPS
IN - 134
IN - 135
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 136
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 137
(5) As the high-voltage switch OFF window appears, press Stop Alarm. (6) Make sure that the machine starts up normally. An example of operation panel screen appearing when the machine has started up normally is shown below.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification)
6.7
Read
1 2 3 4
If any measured value differs from the specified value, rotate the associated voltage adjustment trimmer (adjustment point) as needed.
Measurement point
TB2 1-3
0
5.1 5.3V 12.0 12.6V 14.5 15.5V 23.0 25.0V 23.0 25.0V 14.5 15.5V -14.5 -15.5V
U-Utility button NOTE: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear.
DC OUT3 4-9
FR1H1488.EPS
FR
ON
Side view
DCOUT6 DCOUT7
DCOUT2 DCOUT1
DCOUT3
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
2 1
4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TB2
DCOUT4 DCOUT5
3 2 1
2 1
+
1 3
ACOUT4 ACOUT2
6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5
7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 11 5 12 6
G
4
FR1B1127.EPS
IN - 136
IN - 137
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 138
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 139
6.8
(5) Select 1. The backup memory is initialized, with the following message displayed. BACKUP MEMORIES ARE CLEARED. Meaning: The backup memory has been initialized. The following files are cleared from the HD. IMG Set processing information, information for image number generation, HV ON/OFF information IPH IP position information, subscanning grip correction data PNL Audible click tone enabled/disabled, parallax correction data DST Output LP information (NET/LOCAL) JNL Error log information LIF Format frequency information MFC Setup options information CSL (for CSL specification only) Multiframe-related information, set processing-related information, menu selection information
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >8 0.QUIT 1.CLEAR BKM > 1 ARE YOU SURE TO CLEAR THE ALL BACKUP MEMORIES? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : 1 BACKUP MEMORIES ARE CLEARED.
N NOTE N
Be sure to reset the machine after clearing the backup memory. Unless the machine is reset, the backup memory is not cleared.
(1) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (2) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
Read
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
1 2 3
Click sound
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
SP
FR1B1086.EPS
(3) Select 8. BACK MEMORY. (4) Select 1. CLEAR. The following message appears. ARE YOU SURE TO CLEAR ALL THE BACKUP MEMORIES? 1.YES 2.NO (DEFAULT=2) : Meaning: Are you sure to initialize (clear) the backup memory? (6) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT. The screen returns to U-Utility. (7) Press the RESET switch of the machine.
009-051-10 03.20.2004 FM4275
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1237.EPS
IN - 138
IN - 139
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 140
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 141
6.9
(2) Touch the date/time setting on the U-Utility screen. The date/time setting screen appears. (3) Touch the virtual keyboard to enter the current date and time. (4) After entering the date and time, touch the ENT key to confirm the entry. When the setting is confirmed, OK appears below the entry column. If the date or time is entered incorrectly, touch the BS key (backspace key) to return to the character to be corrected.
Read
1 2 3 4
Set the new date and time in the order of Year, Month, Date and Time (military time) Ex)February 25, 1998.10:15 AM Input 98022511015
Virtual keyboard
4 5 6
9802251015
SET DATE/TIME
QUIT
FR1H1489.EPS
U-Utility button NOTE: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear.
U-Utility screen
Date/time setup
Click sound
CRT test pattern display 8" x 10" film reduced output setup
FD operation
Utility
NOTE: For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear.
Return
FR1H1487.EPS
IN - 140
IN - 141
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 142
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 143
7.
7.1
CAUTIONS
When installing the setup file, be sure to match the following language settings (FNT) in SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG). a) Language setting used when the setup file to be installed is saved b) Language setting for the machine to be installed
# # IRSET.ORG/CFG # IDT=1 #1.System Type # 0:CSL / 1:IDT FNT=0 #2.FONT(LANGUAGE) # 0:JPN / 1:ENG / 2:GER / 3:FRN / 4:ESP / # 5:ITA / 6:SWE / 7:FIN / 8:DEN / 9:NOR / # 10:KOR # 7:Not Available # 10:114Y5431030(Korean Option) is necessary.
Is there any configuration file that has already been set? Is the machine a second or subsequent machine to be installed?
N Y
3
FR1B1226.EPS
N Y
Never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button during file saving. The FD or FD drive may be damaged. Once a setup file is installed, be sure to reset the machine after exiting M-Utility. After installing the setup file, do not change the FNT (language setting) item of SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG). Only one menu parameter can be saved in the machine. Thus, if the FMT (language setting) item is changed and then saved, the setup file contains the initial value for the new language changed, so that the setup file installed becomes invalid.
Back up the configuration file. 7.3 Backing Up Configuration File Reset 7.4 Resetting Machine
END
FR1B1206.EPS
IN - 142
IN - 143
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 144
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 145
(1) Put a floppy disk (FD) containing the setup file into the FDD. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
Read
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
1 2 3
Click sound
SP
DEL
Utility
Return
BS
ENT
Caps
U-Utility button
FR1B1201.EPS
Of the setup files, the following files are saved from the floppy disk to the hard disk. SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) PRINT (FILFMT.CFG) IRSTATUS (IRSTATUS.CFG)
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1086.EPS
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1200.EPS
IN - 144
IN - 145
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 146
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 147
7.2
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
SP
FR1B1223.EPS
DEL
BS
ENT
Of the setup files, the following files are saved from the floppy disk to the hard disk. REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) HOSTS ADDRESS (HOSTS) DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ROUTING (ROUTE) NETMASKS (NETMASKS) DICOM (DICOM)
Caps
FR1B1202.EPS
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
(7) Select 0. QUIT repeatedly. The screen returns to the U-Utility mode. (8) Press the RESET button. The machine is reset, so that the settings of the files installed become effective.
8.DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) : Set up the distribution destination for network connection 9.ROUTING (ROUTE) : Set up the routing for network connection 10.NETMASKS (NETMASKS) : Set up the subnet mask for network connection 11.DICOM (DICOM) : Base on DICOM. NOTE 1: Titles in parentheses denote file names to be edited. NOTE 2: Numerals in brackets denote relevant chapter in this manual.
FR1B1199.EPS
IN - 146
IN - 147
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 148
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 149
(2) Touch the location to be edited. The cursor appears at the location touched.
The cursor can be moved by touching the (3) Using a virtual keyboard, edit it.
, , or key.
Display a desired virtual keyboard for entry. Three types of virtual keyboards are available; by touching the L or M key, one of the three virtual keyboards can be selected. Also, by touching the Caps key, the caps mode can be toggled to the lower-cap display corresponding to the three types of virtual keyboards. Using the [DEL] or [BS] key, modify the value. [DEL] key: [BS] key: Whenever it is touched once, a character immediately after (to the right of) the cursor is deleted. Whenever it is touched once, a character immediately before (to the left of) of the cursor is deleted.
(1) Select 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING and 1. SYSTEM. The contents of SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG) are displayed.
# # IRSET.ORG/CFG # IDT=1 #1.System Type # 0:CSL / 1:IDT FNT=0 #2.FONT(LANGUAGE) # 0:JPN / 1:ENG / 2:GER / 3:FRN / 4:ESP / # 5:ITA / 6:SWE / 7:FIN / 8:DEN / 9:NOR / # 10:KOR # 7:Not Available # 10:114Y5431030(Korean Option) is necessary. IPS="172.16.0.1 " #3.IP Address(CPU90E) (Length=15)
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If you edited the file incorrectly and it is difficult to undo the editing with the [DEL] or [BS] key, press the [CANCEL] key and repeat from step (1) all over again.
B C
(4) Press the [SAVE] key. The edited contents are saved to the HD.
Virtual keyboard The cursor appears at the location touched.
# # IRSET.ORG/CFG # IDT=1 #1.System Type # 0:CSL / 1:IDT FNT=0 #2.FONT(LANGUAGE) # 0:JPN / 1:ENG / 2:GER / 3:FRN / 4:ESP / # 5:ITA / 6:SWE / 7:FIN / 8:DEN / 9:NOR / # 10:KOR # 7:Not Available # 10:114Y5431030(Korean Option) is necessary. IPS="172.16.0.1 " #3.IP Address(CPU90E) (Length=15)
A B C
SP
/sb0/SYSTEM/ETC/IRSET.CFG
DEL
BS
ENT
0 . SP
SAVE
CANCEL
Caps
FR1B1208.EPS
/sb0/SYSTEM/ETC/IRSET.CFG
SAVE
CANCEL
(5) Back up the configuration file that has been set up. 7.3 Backing Up Configuration File (6) Press the RESET button. The machine is reset so that the file that has been set up is effective.
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
If there is any other configuration item to be set up, do not press the RESET button. The RESET button should be pressed after all the setups are finished.
IN - 148
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1203.EPS
IN - 149
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 150
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 151
7.3
CAUTIONS
Never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button during file backup. The FD or FD drive may be damaged. Once a setup file is edited, be sure to reset the machine after exiting M-Utility.
(1) Put a backup floppy disk into the FDD. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1200.EPS
Read
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
1 2 3
Click sound
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
0.QUIT 1.FORMAT FD 2.FORMAT IMAGE PARTITION 3.BACK UP 4.RESTORE 5.EDR DATA 6.PREVIOUS SYSTEM SOFTWARE 7.EXECUTION FUT> 3 0.QUIT 1.SCANNER DATA 2.CONFIGURATION DATA 3.NETWORK DATA 4.IMAGE PROCESSING DATA 5.CSL MENU DATA FUT:RES>2
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
SP
Caps
DEL
BS
ENT
FR1B1214.EPS
Caps
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. SYSTEM (IRSET.CFG,IRSET.ORG) PRINT (FILFMT.CFG,FILFMT.ORG) IRSTATUS (IRSTATUS.CFG,IRSTATUS.ORG)
FR1B1086.EPS
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
IN - 150
IN - 151
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 152
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 153
7.4
Resetting Machine
In order to make changes to the configuration files effective, reset the machine.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1B1225.EPS
Of the setup files, the following files are saved to the floppy disk. REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) EQUIPMENT (EQUIP) NETWORK HOST INTERFACE (DEVICE) HOSTS ADDRESS (HOST) DISTRIBUTION (CODEDSTB) ROUTING (ROUTE) NETMASKS (NETMASKS) DICOM (DICOM)
N NOTE N
The menu parameters saved in the floppy disk also contain the language setting for the machine. Thus, if the language setting differs during RESTORE and during BACK UP, the file cannot be read during RESTORE.
(7) Select 0. QUIT repeatedly. The screen returns to the U-Utility mode.
IN - 152
IN - 153
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 154
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 155
8.
(4) Select 3. TEST MODE, 2. AUTO MODE, and 2. READING & ERASURE in sequence. A message prompting you to enter the number of conveyances appears on screen. (5) Set the number of IP conveyances to 10. (6) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility.
8.1
I IP Conveyance Check
(1) Power ON the machine. (2) Touch the U-Utility button. The screen switches to the U-Utility mode. (3) Touch the upper left corner and upper right corner of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated.
Routine screen (screen made to CSL specification) U-Utility screen
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1822.EPS
Read
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
(7) Insert the following four types of cassettes (five if the mammo type is included) into any location of the shelf. IP conveyance is started. 14" x 14"(35cm x 35cm) 14" x 17"(35cm x 43cm) 10" x 12"(24cm x 30cm) 8" x 10" (18cm x 24cm) (18 cm x 24 cm mammo) (8) Check the following checkpoints during IP conveyance. There is no offensive noise or odor from the machine.
1 2 3
Click sound
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
IPs are conveyed in order of cassettes inserted. The exhaust fan (FANF1) mounted on the erasure lamp assembly operates. (9) After IP conveyance is completed, take out all the cassettes, and make sure that the IPs are free of any scratch. (10) Change the shelf locations where the cassettes are inserted, and repeat steps (7) through (9). When a total of ten IP conveyances are completed, the machine automatically stops. (11) Take out the cassettes. (12) Press the RESET button.
FR1B1086.EPS
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection.
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
IN - 154
IN - 155
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 156
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 157
(13) Touch the upper left and upper right corners of the operation panel in sequence. M-Utility is activated. (14) Select 3. TEST MODE and 1. ROUTINE MODE in sequence. (15) Repeatedly select 0. QUIT to exit M-Utility. (16) Power OFF the machine.
8.2
Reinstalling Covers
CAUTION
Before installing the covers, make sure that the high-voltage switch of the SCN08A board is in the ON position.
(1) Reinstall the covers. For reinstallation of the covers, reverse the removal steps. 4.2.1 Removal of Covers To reinstall the lower front cover, use the two screws (truss M4x12) supplied as separate packaged items. (2) Adjust the stack table locations. (3) Secure the I/F cable onto the lower rear cover with NK clamps. When installing the lower rear cover, secure the I/F cable onto the lower rear cover with three screws (truss M4x20) and NK clamps supplied as separate packaged items. Choose one of the three types of NK clamps according to the thickness and number of I/F cables secured in place.
N NOTES N
Be sure to secure the I/F cable onto the lower rear cover with NK clamps. If not, a line error for units connected may result. When fixing the NK clamps, be sure to use screws (truss M4x20) supplied as separate packaged items.
Control rack
FR
ON
I/F cable
FR1B1229.EPS
(4) Make sure that the covers have been installed securely and that there is no missing cover screws.
009-051-07 08.30.2001 FM3115
IN - 156
IN - 157
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 158
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 159
8.3
Final Placement
For final placement, there are two installation methods. One is to install the machine by securing it with the clamps that were removed at the time of unloading. The other is to install the machine without using such clamps. Check the space available for installation, and consult with the user about his wishes before choosing between the above two installation methods.
CAUTION
In order to avoid electric shock hazards, power OFF the machine before performing any procedures.
The space required for final placement differs depending on whether the machine is to be secured with the clamps or not.
Without clamps Height: 1800 or more Rear 50 or more With clamps Height: 1800 or more
Machine
200 or more Machine 200 or more 700 or more Machine 700 or more
700 or more
FR1B1058.EPS
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
If the rear clamps are not tightened by the adjustable foot nuts, the machine can be repositioned as needed for maintenance or like purposes simply by removing the two front clamps. If the rear of the machine cannot be provided with an adequate space for clamp installation, tighten the two front clamps only.
N NOTES N
Lift up the machine until the casters are free to roll. Make sure that all the four adjustable feet are used.
(4) Push the upper nut against the adjustable foot and secure it in place.
Machine Seating face on the frame side Nut
Adjustable foot
FR1B1057.EPS
IN - 158
78.8
Unit: mm
FR1B1228.EPS
Front
Front
F R O N T
769.7
IN - 159
Rear
100 or more
78.8
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 160
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 161
(5) Remove the clamps, and move the machine away. Secure space for anchor nut embedding work. (6) Embed the anchor nuts in the locations marked at step (4). (7) Move the machine back to the installation location, and secure the earthquake protection members onto both the machine and anchor nuts.
Hex socket head bolt M12x30 Spring washer M12 Plain washer M12 Plain washer M16
8.4
Read
2 3 4
Anchor nut
0
FR1B1227.EPS
(8) Tighten the height adjustment screws of the earthquake protection members.
U-Utility button NOTE: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear.
FR1H1488.EPS
IN - 160
IN - 161
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 162
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 163
8.5
8.6
IN - 162
IN - 163
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 164
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 165
White blank
IP
FR1B1115.EPS
Steel rules
The distance measured on the film may differ from the actual size measured on the IP, depending on the reading size. For example, for a two-in-one image of 14" x 14" (35cm x 35cm) size, because its reduction factor is 50%, the actual size on the IP is twice the distance measured on the film. The relationship between the reading size and reduction factor is shown below.
Reading size Two-in-one Full image image 1/2 1/2 2/3 6/7 2/3 2/3 1/1 1/1
TR1H1001.EPS
FR1B1114.EPS
14" x 17" ( 35 cm x 43cm) 14" x 14" ( 35 cm x 35cm) 10" x 12" ( 24 cm x 30cm) 8" x 10" ( 18 cm x 24cm)
(2) Make recording in SENSITIVITY from the test menu of the IDT, and generate output. (3) Make sure that there is no jitter on the resulting image of the frame and steel rules on the output film. If any jitter is found, take remedial measures as appropriate. 3. Troubleshooting Procedures Based on Abnormal Images in Troubleshooting
FR1H1010.EPS
IN - 164
IN - 165
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 166
CONTENTS
A
1
B
2
A
4
B
A1
A2
IN - 167
A
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
Image
B
B
Image
Image
f g
s i
k m
q o
Image
Image
SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE
The output characters indicated in the character display areas (A and B) are variously laid out depending on the employed output pattern.
18 x 43 (long) two-image output (14" x 17"LP)
A A B
FR1B1126.EPS
Image
Image
B
Image
A
Image
B A One-image output
FR1B1120.EPS
IN - 166
IN - 167
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 168
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 169
8.7
8.8
IN - 168
IN - 169
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 170
CONTENTS
A1
A2
IN - 171
8.9
Cleaning Covers
Clean all the covers with a moistened cloth.
MCR label
20mm 41mm 20mm Exposure markers precaution label Front shelf cover Align it to this line Cassette precaution label
15mm 15mm
FR1B1171.EPS
IN - 170
IN - 171
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A1 - 1
IN_A1 - 1
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 1
IDT=
#1.System Type # 0:CSL / 1:IDT 1
FNT=
#2.FONT(LANGUAGE) # # # # # Note: 10:114Y5431030(Korean Option) is necessary. 10:KOR 0:JPN / 1:ENG / 2:GER / 3:FRN / 4:ESP / 5:ITA / 6:SWE / 7:FIN / 8:DEN / 9:NOR / 0
IPS=
#3.IP Address(CPU90E) (Length=15)
172.16.0.1
IPI=
#4.IP Address(CPU90F) (Length=15)
172.16.0.2
ILA=
#5.IDT Network Port # 0:CPU90E / 1:CPU90F 1
IN_A2 - 1
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 2
Initial value
SCD=D1"
#6.System Code (Length=2) D1 * Change not permitted
SMJ=5000
#7.System Name (Length=6) 5000 * Change not permitted
SID=
#8.System ID (Length=1) # A-Z A
SFC=
#9.Manual Sensitivity Settting(CSL Type) # 0:(OFF) # 1:Standard,Semi-High-Speed # 2:Standard,Semi-High-Speed,High-Speed 0
SFD=
#10.Manual Sensitivity Default(CSL Type) # 0:Standard # 1:Semi-High-Speed # 2:High-Speed # 3:(Depend on menu default=Memory) # # Note: # SFC # SFC | 0 1 2 # ---------------------# 0 | # 1 | # 2 | X # 3 | X X 0
IN_A2 - 2
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 3
Initial value
LGR=
#11.Logical Reading(CSL Type) # 0:OFF / 1:ON # Note: # # # # is confirmed). (The monitor image is not displayed until ID set 1. IP is read after ID is confirmed when LGR is 0
XRY=
#12.OverXray Flag # 0:LOG & MESSAGE / 1:LOG ONLY / 2:NONE * Change not necessary 0
U_MF=
#13.User UTL Multi-Frame Button Control # 0:OFF / 1:ON 0
SS1=
#14.Screen Save Timer # 0-60[min] 5
ITV=
#15.Time put at each image store for accept reprinting (E-IF) # 0-60[sec] 30
CPS=
#16.The number of sheets of continues image store (E-IF) # 0-10[sheet] 5
ID_EDR=
#17.Edr Mode Variation(CSL Type) # # # 0:AUTO,SEMI,FIX 1:AUTO,SEMI,FIX,SEMI-X 2:AUTO,SEMI,FIX,SEMI-X,MANUAL 0
ID_FILING=
#18.Filing Mode # 0:DISABLE / 1:OFF,ON / 2:OFF,ON*,ON 0
IN_A2 - 3
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 4
Initial value
ID_FUNC=
#19.Function Setting(CSL Type) # 0:DISABLE / 1:ENABLE 0
ID_FILMC=
#20.Film Letter(CSL Type) # 0:OFF / 1:ON 0
ID_BIRTH=
#21.Birthday Format(CSL Type) # # # # # # # 6:EUROPEAN SHORT DATE(01.04.1998) 5:EUROPEAN LONG DATE(01.APR.1998) 4:AMERICAN SHORT DATE(04.01.1998) 3:AMERICAN LONG DATE(APR.04.1998) 2:ANSI SHORT DATE(1998.04.01) 1:ANSI LONG DATE(1998.APR.01) 0:JAPANESE DATE(H10.04.01) 2
ID_SEARCH=
#22.Search Key(CSL Type) # # 3:ID#,RECEPT#,EXAM# 0:ID# / 1:ID#,RECEPT# / 2:ID#,EXAM# / 0
ID_LENGTH=
#23.Patients ID Length(CSL Type) # # 1-64:ID_INFO_TYPE=1 1-10:ID_INFO_TYPE=0 10
ID_PADDING=
#24.Patients ID Padding method(CSL Type) # # # # # 1:Pad with zero 0:Pad with space to the head (Ex. 1234567") ) (Ex.1234567000") to the head (Ex.0001234567") 0
2:Pad with space to the tail (Ex.1234567 3:Pad with zero to the tail
RECEPT_LENGTH=
#25.Reception No. Length(CSL Type) # # 1-5:ID_INFO_TYPE=0 1-16:ID_INFO_TYPE=1 5
IN_A2 - 4
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 5
Initial value
RECEPT_PADDING=
#26.Reception No. Padding method(CSL Type) # # # # 3:Pad with zero to the tail (Ex.12300") 2:Pad with space to the tail (Ex.123 ) 1:Pad with zero to the head (Ex.00123") 0:Pad with space to the head (Ex. 123") 0
EXAM_LENGTH=
#27.Examination No. Length(CSL Type) # 1-10:ID_INFO_TYPE=0 # 1-16:ID_INFO_TYPE=1 10
EXAM_PADDING=
#28.Examination No. Padding method(CSL Type) # # # # 3:Pad with zero to the tail (Ex.1234567000") 2:Pad with space to the tail (Ex.1234567 ) 1:Pad with zero to the head (Ex.0001234567") 0:Pad with space to the head (Ex. 1234567") 0
IFT=0
#29.Reserve * Change not necessary 0
PRO=
#30.Function Protect # # # 99:ALL 0:NONE / 1:TS / 2:ES / 3:MS / 4:MX / 5:WS / 6:PS / 7:TM / 8:TX / 9:WX / 10:EX / 11:AS / 0
SF1=50
#31.Read Sensitivity Semi-h # 0-299 * Change not necessary 50
SF2=100
#32.Read Sensitivity High # 0-299 * Change not necessary 100
IN_A2 - 5
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 6
Initial value
GRP=0
#33.Film Sorting Group Code # 0:None # 1:Space(2)+Dep.Code(8) # 2:Dep.Code(4)+MenuName(6) # 3:Dep.Code(4)+FilmChar1(6) # 4:FCRImageID(1)+Space(9) # 5:Space(4)+MPMcode(4)+Space(2) # 6:Space(4)+FilmChar1(6) # 7:Dep.Code(4)+MPMcode(4)+Space(2) # # (3,6;Not Available for HIC655,HIC655QA,QA-WS771 store/reprint) * Indent 0
PTR=0
# 34.FilmChar1/MenuName Start Pointer 0 * Indent
UNQ=0
#35.Film Sort Unique Code # #(1:Not Available for HIC655,HIC655QA,QA-WS771 #store/reprint) 0:SPACE / 1:ID# 0 * Indent
PCD=
#36.I/F Pixel Clock Rate for DMS # 0:1usec / 1:2usec 1
PCL=
#37.I/F Pixel Clock Rate for LP # 0:1usec(<60m) / 1:2usec(>60m) 0
CIM=
#38.IP Size Code Setting # 0:INCH / 1:METRIC 0
EBK=
#39.EDR Backup Flag # 0:OFF / 1:MENU / 2:FULL 0
IN_A2 - 6
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 7
Initial value
EBA=
#40.EDR Backup Server Address (Length=15) . . .
U_LP=
#42.The following buttons & icon control(for OEM) # - SELECT PRINTER(User UTL) # - DELETE PRINTING IMAGES(S) # # - The number of sheets of print icon # # # 0:OFF / 1:ON of REOUTPUT IMAGE(User UTL) and Manual EDR. of DELETE WAITING IMAGES(User UTL) 1
ID_AP=
#43.Image Reversal Mode Variation(CSL Type) # # # # # 2:L-R, T-B reversal 3:L-R reversal / 90-deg,Rotation 4:L-R, T-B reversal / 90-deg,Rotation 1:T-B reversal 0:L-R reversal 0
ID_DST=
#44.Distribution Code Setting # 0:DISABLE / 1:ENABLE 0
IN_A2 - 7
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 8
Initial value
UID_STI=
#45.UID Issuance Type # # <Unique ID> (CSL Type) # # .<Accession Number> # .<Patient ID> # .<Requesting Service> #Note: #(1)<org root>=1.2.392.200036.9125 #(2)When Study Date cannot be acquired, # Acquisition Date is used. 4:<org root>.2.4.<Study Date> .<Patient ID2> 3:<org root>.2.3.<Study Date + Modality(CR)> 2:<org root>.2.2.<Study Date + Modality(CR)> 1:<org root>.2.1.<Accession Number> 0:<org root>.2.0.<MAC Address>.<Time Stamp>. 0:<org root>.2.0.<Private Image UID>(IDT Type) 3
DEF_DENSITY=
#46.Image Density Device Default # # 1:High Quality Density 0:Standard Density 0
JSTFY=
# abcdefghijklmnop
10010000 00001111
#47.Right/Left justify of long character type. # # # # # # # # # # c: Menu Name d: Examination Number e: Department Name f-l: Reserved(default: Left) m-p: Reserved(default: Right) b: Patient Name a: Patient ID <Field> <Parameter> 0:Left Justify / 1:Right Justify
HQ_FUNC=
#48.HQ Function Setting # 0:DISABLE / 1:ENABLE 1
IN_A2 - 8
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 9
Initial value
DRC_FUNC=
#49.DRC Function Setting # 0:DISABLE / 1:ENABLE 1
ID_INFO_TYPE=
#50.ID info. type(CSL Type) # 0:Stand. / 1:Long 0
ID_CODE_SET=
#51.ID info.code set # # 0:CP850 / 1:ISO8859-1 (CSL Type:Magnetic Card / ID-ONLINE) 0
SSS=
#52.Select Screen Save Display # # 1:Pictures 0:Black Screen 0
DST_PADDING=
#53.Distribution Code Padding method # # # # 3:Pad with zero to the tail 2:Pad with space to the tail (Ex.1234 1:Pad with zero to the head (Ex.00001234) ) (Ex.12340000) 0:Pad with space to the head (Ex. 1234) 2
ENV=
#54.Equipment name for version display. # (9 character)
CR-IR341
ID_RET=
#55.Select retrieve key input timing # # 0:Whenever you set a cassette. 1:When you need to change patient info. 0
UID=
#56.UID Issuance # Whether study and series information is to be issued by IR or not. # # 1:ON 0:OFF 0
IN_A2 - 9
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 10
Initial value
EXAM=
#57.Examination Number Field # Which data is to be handled as an examination number. # # 1:Reception Number 0:Examination Number 0
L2430=
#58.Logical reading(15cm*30cm size) of 24cm*30cm IP # If you select panoramic-tomo menu, logical reading is enable. # # 1:ON 0:OFF 0
ID_EXAM=
#59.Examination No. Display Mode(CSL Type) # # 1:DISPLAY AND INPUT 0:NO DISPLAY AND INPUT 0
ID_DEPT=
#60.Department Name Display Mode(CSL Type) # # 1:DISPLAY AND INPUT 0:NO DISPLAY AND INPUT 0
DEPT_LENGTH=
#61.Department Name Length(CSL Type) # # 1-64:ID_INFO_TYPE=1 1-8:ID_INFO_TYPE=0 8
MES_LENGTH=
#62.Maximum Text Length for On-line Connection (CSL Type) # # 0:128byte(Include STX,ETX,ETB and BCC) 1:256byte(Include STX,ETX,ETB and BCC) 1
SCS=
#63.Select specific character to be set. This setting is valid if you select FNT=1(English). # # 0:ISO-IR 6 1:ISO-IR 100 0
IN_A2 - 10
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 11
Initial value
PN_CS=
#64.CONVERSION OF PATIENT NAME #This setting is whether patient name is converted from FINP data to DICOM VR or not. # # 1:Converted 0:Not converted 0
PN_FDS=
#65.FINP COMPONENT DELIMITER FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION # # # # 2:Comma , 1:Caret ^ 0:Space 0
PN_FDM=
#66.FINP COMPONENT DELIMITER FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION # # # # Note: # Japanese(JIS X 0208). Multi byte representation is limited in 2:Comma , 1:Caret ^ 0:Space 0
PN_FCS1=
#67.FINP COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 1 component. # # # # # S:Suffix P:Prefix M:Middle name G:Given name F:Family name F
IN_A2 - 11
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 12
Initial value
PN_FCS2=
#68.FINP COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 2 components. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix FG
PN_FCS3=
#69.FINP COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 3 components. # # # # # S:Suffix P:Prefix M:Middle name G:Given name F:Family name FGM
PN_FCS4=
#70.FINP COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 4 components. # # # # # S:Suffix P:Prefix M:Middle name G:Given name F:Family name
FGMP
PN_FCS5=
FGMPS
#71.FINP COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 5 components. # # # # # P:Prefix S:Suffix F:Family name G:Given name M:Middle name
IN_A2 - 12
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 13
Initial value
PN_FCM1=
#72.FINP COMPOSITION FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 1 component. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix F
PN_FCM2=
#73.FINP COMPOSITION FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 2 components. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix FG
PN_FCM3=
#74.FINP COMPOSITION FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 3 components. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix
FGM
PN_FCM4=
FGMPS
#75.FINP COMPOSITION FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 4 components. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix
IN_A2 - 13
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 14
Initial value
PN_FCM5=
#76.FINP COMPOSITION FOR MULTI BYTE REPRESENTATION #This definition is used, when the FINP data contains 5 components. # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix FGMPS
PN_DD=
#77.DICOM COMPONENT DELIMITER # 0:Space # 1:Caret ^ # 2:Comma , 1
PN_DC=
#78.DICOM COMPOSITION # F:Family name # G:Given name # M:Middle name # P:Prefix # S:Suffix
FGMPS
MON=
#79.display type on CRT monitor # # 1:Type2 0:Type1 1
BCR=
#80.BCR TYPE #Select a correct BCR # # 0:BCR5242-STB(DENSEI) 1:NFT7175/F01RL(OPTOELECTRONICS) 0
FLMW=
#81.Film size confirm window open # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
IN_A2 - 14
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 14.1
Initial value
DK_FILM=
#82. Print HQ Image on 14*14 film(14*14 Single # format) # 0:DISABLE/1:ENABLE 0
DCL=
#83. Clear the distribution code when re-outputing # a image. # 0:No(with no changes) # 1:Yes 1
FCL=
#84. Put the filing switch off when re-outputing a # image. # 0:No(with no changes) # 1:Yes 1
IDNR_CB=
#85 ID INFORMATION NOT REGISTERED message # 0:With the CONTINUE button. # 1:Without the CONTINUE button. 1
U-0810=
#86. User UTL 08*10 film Setting Button Control # 0:OFF/1:ON 0
RST_WRT=
#87. Reset image writing from shared memory after # Happend HDD Write Error # 0:OFF/1:ON 0
RST_CBC=
#88. CBC Hard Reset # 0:OFF/1:ON #end of file 0
IN_A2 - 14.1
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 14.2
BLANK PAGE
IN_A2 - 14.2
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 15
BF=
#1.Print barcode # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
EF=
#2.Print EDR mode # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
IF=
#3.Print image process condition # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
CF=
#4.Print L,S,CS,SS condition # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
ET=
#5.Print shot day # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
HN=
....
FUJI FILM HOSPITAL
HP=
#
....
9578 8E6D 8374 8343 838B 8380 9561 8940 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140 8140
#7.2 byte code character (Japanese, Korean) Institution name (Max Length=30)
IN_A2 - 15
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 16
Initial value
GF=
#8.Print set process # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
GJ=
#9.Print engineer ID # 0:No / 1:Yes 0
MF=
#10.Print menu # 0:No / 1:Yes 1
A1=
#11.Maximum age of monthly representation # 0-99 7
A2=
#12.Maximum age of daily representation # 0-12 0
TH=
#13.Trimming(mammo) # 0.0-25.0(mm) 0
TE=
#14.Trimming(others) # 0-25(mm) 0
CL=
#15.Representation of date # # # 0:Japanese / 1:ANSI Long / 2:ANSI Short / 3:American Long / 4:American Short / 5:European Long / 6:European Short 2
AB=
#16.Representation of age # 0:Age / 1:Date of birth 0
IN_A2 - 16
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 17
Initial value
FR1=
#17.Print image frame #(14*17 film:14*17,14*14,18*43 Single format # 14*14 film:14*14 Single format # 8*10 film:8*10 Single format) # 0:No / 1:Yes 0
FR2=
#18.Print image frame #(14*17 film:18*43 LR/2on1 format) # 0:No / 1:Yes 0
FR4=
#19.Print image frame #(14*17 film:14*17,18*43,8*10 4on1 format) # 0:No / 1:Yes 0
CR=
#20.Print compression rate # 0:No / 1:Yes 0
MM=
#21.Margin # (default:Transparent) # # # 3:Black Margin(Fix) 2:Transparent Margin(Fix) 1:Margin depend on image ID(default:Black) 0:Margin depend on image ID 0
SG=
#22.Print standard image on 14*17, 14*14 film like #HQ Image. # 0:NO / 1:YES(Magnify) 0
HG=
#23.Size selection of 14*17, 14*14 film character (single format) # 0:Standard / 1:Large 0
IN_A2 - 17
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 18
Initial value
OS=
#24.DR compression in reprint # # # (1:Not Available) 1:Depending on system setting 0:Depending on image information 0
RF=
#25.Print reverse mark # # # 2:Yes(APorPA) 1:Yes( orR-reverse) 0:No 2
CE=
#26.Print 14*17,14*14,8*10 film character field # (Size-format:14*17-Single,18*43-LR/2on1, # 14*17-4on1,18*43-4on1,8*10-4on1, 14*14-Single,8*10-Single,18*24-Single) # # # # 3:None 2:Only field 2 1:Only field 1 0:Both of field 1 & 2 0
CSX0=
#27.Character Area0(Standard) horizontal size # 2-500(0.1mm) 500
CSY0=
#28.Character Area0(Standard) vertical size # 2-268(0.1mm) 268
CSX1=
#29.Character Area1(Standard) horizontal size # 2-458(0.1mm) 458
CSY1=
#30.Character Area1(Standard) vertical size # 2-230(0.1mm) 174
CLX0=
#31.Character Area0(Large) horizontal size # 2-980(0.1mm) 980
IN_A2 - 18
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 19
Initial value
CLY0=
#32.Character Area0(Large) vertical size # 2-268(0.1mm) 268
CLX1=
#33.Character Area1(Large) horizontal size # 2-668(0.1mm) 668
CLY1=
#34.Character Area1(Large) vertical size # 2-236(0.1mm) 180
IN_A2 - 19
CONTENTS
1
8
A1 A2
2
3
6
7
IN_A2 - 20
Initial value
FC1=
FC1,2,3,4= XXXX: 1234 2345
FC2=
3456 4567 5678 6789 7890 8901
FC3=
FC4=
FC5=
FC5= FC6=
0020:0317
FC6=
1030:?3??
#36.Film character fields position & # rotation #(user definition rules) # FC1-4:14*17,14*14,8*10film # FC5-6:8*10film #If processing menu code matches MPM1,MPM2,...,or #MPM8(max 8 menus), the character fields change #the position & rotation due to abcd rule #(max 4+2 rules). # ex) # FC1=2030:0000 0002" means, # Rule FC1: # For only SKULL GENERAL(0000) # orMANDIBLE(0002), # 14*17,14*14,8*10 film character position # Area0 is Left-Bottom, Area1 is Right-Bottom.
EM=
#37.Print Energy-Subtraction Param./PEM Param. # 0:No / 1:Yes(Ene.-Sub.) / 2:Yes(PEM) 2
IN_A2 - 20
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 21
Initial value
IN=
#38.Print film char2/examination number # #Film char2 depends on IDT setting (Short info.(KVP mAs),etc) #Only when GJ is set 1, film char2 is displayed. #Examination number is displayed without depending #on GJ. 0 0:film char2 / 1:examination number 0
IM=
#39.Image areas move to the top of 14*17 film. # # # 1:Yes 0:No (FCR9000 compatible) (only for 15*30, 35*35, 43*43) 0
LTC=
#40.Long type character format # # # # the long type item.) .... (Refer to JSTFY of irset.cfg for details of 1:Yes 0:No (default) 0
FRSC=
#41.No print scale #(user definition rules)
#if MPM code of processing menu matches above, #scale isnt printed on film. You can write max #8 MPM codes. #ex 1) #FRSC=XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX #Scale is always printed on film. #ex 2) #FRSC=???? XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX #Scale isnt printed on film. #ex 3) #FRSC=0000 0200 XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX #When processing menu is SKULL GENERAL(0000) or #CHEST GENERAL(0200), scale isnt printed on #film.
IN_A2 - 21
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 22
Initial value
TN=
#42.Print operator or technologists Name # 0:No/1:Yes * Change not permitted 0
PS=
#43.Print pixel spacing[mm](ex.:0.05->0.10) # 0:No / 1:Yes #Note: #In case TN=1 or PS=1,both CLY1 and CSY1 must #be changed to CLY1=236,CSY1=230 0
RS=
#44.Requesting service charaters, # 0:Normal / 1:Large #end of file 0
IN_A2 - 22
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 23
Setup date:
REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG): "NOPK 1000" : ON "NOPK 0000" : OFF EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
L L L L L L
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . .
DISTRIBUTION (CODESTB)
L L L L L L L L
ROUTING (ROUTE)
NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
.
L L
. . . . . .
Host unit name: IP address: Machine manufacture serial number: Ethernet address: Installation site: : : : : :
FR1B1215.EPS
IN_A2 - 23
CONTENTS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A1 A2
IN_A2 - 24
Example of Description
Network System Administration Sheet (FCR5000)
Prepared by: FUJI Setup date: April 20, 1999
REMOTE SWITCH (RMT_SW.CFG) : "NOPK 1000" : ON "NOPK 0000" : OFF EQUIPMENT (EQUIP)
OD_FILE
L L L odf624 L fcridt4-1 L fcridt4-2
L hic654
IDT
fcr5000a fcr5000a-1 . . . . . . . . . fcr5000b fcr5000b-1 172.16.0.102 odf624 172.16.0.101 hic654 172.16.0.22 fcridt4-1
172.16.0.21
fcridt4-1
172.16.0.103
fn-ps551
DISTRIBUTION (CODESTB)
A A 0 1 2 3 ? ?
L L L L L L
hic654
L L
ROUTING (ROUTE)
NETMASKS (NETMASKS)
172
L L
. 16 . . . . . .
255
. 255 .
. .
Host unit name: IP address: Machine manufacture serial number: Ethernet address: Installation site: : : : : :
FR1B1216.EPS
IN_A2 - 24
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 1 2
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 2 3
U-Utility screen
Read
Processed image reproduction output Touch panel parallax correction Multiframe forced output
Date/time setup
1 2 3
Click sound
Utility
Return
U-Utility button
CR-IR341
M-Utility screen
Copyright (c) 1998 Fuji Photo Film Co.,Ltd Software ID : 114Y5431003
: Area to be touched
NOTES: For the IDT type, the "menu selecting icon" does not appear. For the initial setting, the "Multiframe forced output" button will not appear. The IDT type includes CR-IR348CL connection. : Location to be touched Software version number
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1392.EPS
FR1B1086.EPS
Touch the upper left corner of the operation panel and then the upper right corner within two seconds.
Stop alarm
System down
: Area to be touched
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
FR1B1137.EPS
IN_A3 - 1 2
IN_A3 - 2 3
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 4 3
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 4 5
N NOTE N
If M-Utility is entered during initialization sequence, 0. QUIT does not appear. Thus, after quitting M-Utility, the machine should be reset.
Appendix 3.3.1
MU:SEN > 2 1:SA1 2:SA2 3:SA3 4:SA4 6:SA6 7:SA7 8:SA8 9:SA9 11:SA11 12:SA12 13:SA13 14:SA14 16:SA16 17:SA17 18:SB1 19:SB2 21:SB4 22:SB5 23:SC1 24:SC2 26:SD2 27:SD3 28:SE1 29:SF1 31:SF3 32:SF4 33:SZ2 34:SZ3 INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 34 : 4 SA4 ----> Close SA4 ----> Open SA4 ----> Close 0 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.MONITOR 3.MONITOR ALL MU:SEN >
A B C D E F 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 0 . SP DEL BS ENT Caps 5:SA5 10:SA10 15:SA15 20:SB3 25:SD1 30:SF2 A B C D E F 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 0 . SP DEL BS ENT Caps
FR1H1235.EPS
IN_A3 - 3 4
IN_A3 - 4 5
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 6 5
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 6 7
Appendix 3.3.2
I Select QUIT
Appendix 3.3.3
When QUIT is selected from the menu items, one of the following results. G When a menu item is displayed, it reverts back to its immediately above menu. G When the main menu is displayed, M-Utility is exited and the U-Utility is entered. G The menu (operation) being executed is halted. G It reverts back to its immediately above menu, while the current menu remains active.
When a menu, such as an IP conveyance menu, is executed, it is necessary to enter parameters, such as the number of IP conveyances. In M-Utility, touch the virtual keyboard displayed on the right side of the operation panel to enter a value.
I Select STOP
When STOP is selected, the operation (DRIVE) of the actuator or motor is ended.
Example: 3. STOP is selected
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING >6 0.QUIT 1.MOTOR 2.ACTUATOR 3.SENSOR 4.UNIT MU > 2 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT > 3
SP
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
Caps
FR1H1500.EPS
MU:AUT > 3 1:SOLA1 2:SOLA2 3:SOLA3 4:SOLA4 5:PB1 6:SVB1 7:SOLF1 8:SOLC1 9:LAMP STB 10:LAMP ON 11:FFM INPUT THE NUMBER OF SENSOR 1 - 11 : 11 0.QUIT 1.NUMBER 2.DRIVE 3.STOP MU:AUT >
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
FR1H1759.EPS
IN_A3 - 5 6
IN_A3 - 6 7
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A3 - 8 7
Example) Change the numerical value from 9801 to 9901. 1) Touch the operation panel to position the cursor under 0. 2) Touch the [BS] key once to delete 8. 3) Touch 9.
IN_A3 - 7 8
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A4 - 1
G Network cable
Grade: Category-5 shielded type 10Base-T (CPU90E/F), 100BaseTX (CPU90F/LAN90B) Cable length: up to 100 m Connection: Straight
N NOTES N
When the cable is laid out, be sure to clamp it onto the rear cover of the machine (to prevent radiation noise). An unshielded network cable can also be connected to the LAN90B board.
G Network hub
A 10BaseT- and/or 100BaseTX-compliant hub should be used. The hub should have modular connectors of shielded type.
IN_A4 - 1
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A5 - 1
Appendix 5.
I HI-C654
Information on the FCR5000 should be set in NETWORK DEVICE of COMMON FILE that contains network common information. Append the following items in sequence. 1. HOST NAME 2. IP ADDRESS 3. PROTOCOL NO.: 100 4. UNIT CODE 5. MACHINE ATTRIBUTE: F 6. TRANSFER SPEED: 100
I OD-F624
Information on the FCR5000 should be set in NETWORK DEVICE of COMMON FILE. Append the following items in sequence. 1. HOST NAME 2. IP ADDRESS 3. PROTOCOL NO.: 100 4. UNIT CODE 5. MACHINE ATTRIBUTE: F 6. TRANSFER SPEED: 100
009-051-04 05.31.99 FM2460
IN_A5 - 1
CONTENTS A3
A4
A5
A6
IN_A6 - 1
Appendix 6.
To install the optional software (FD), use 7. EXECUTION under 7. FILE UTILITY of MUtility.
CAUTION
Never power OFF the machine or press the FD eject button during file installation. The FD or FD drive may be damaged.
I Example of Operation
An example where the Hyper Image Processing Option is to be installed is described below. (1) Activate M-Utility. Appendix 3. Common Information for M-Utility (2) Put the optional software install floppy disk into the floppy disk drive. (3) Select 7. FILE UTILITY and 7. EXECUTION in sequence. The files contained in the floppy disk are displayed. 1)OPTION.ABS 2)INSTALL 3)UNINST 4)OPTION.008 . . . (4) Select item No. (2), or INSTALL, and touch the [ENT] key. (To uninstall, select UNINST.) The following message appears. ARE YOU SURE TO EXECUTE SELECTED FILE? 1. YES 2. NO : (5) Select 1. YES. File copying is initiated, with the following message displayed. (When uninstalled, the file is deleted.) ***** Install is complete ***** *** Please reset the system*** INSTALL IS EXECUTED. N SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE N
If any error occurs during installation, the floppy disk or SCSI hard disk drive may be faulty. Take remedial measure as appropriate, and then repeat from step (1) all over again.
IN_A6 - 1
CONTENTS A8
IN_A8 - 1
CONTENTS A8
(5) Click Yes. The PC-ME Property window appears.
IN_A8 - 2
Appendix 8.
For the CSL type, the Menu Editor (running on Windows) should be used in order to edit the image processing parameters and menu parameters (exposure menus). Before editing the parameters for the machine with the Menu Editor, perform Menu Editor settings in accordance with the following procedures.
I How to Start
(1) Power ON the personal computer (PC) where the Menu Editor is installed. (2) From the Start menu of Windows, select Run.... The Run window opens. (3) Type in C:\Program Files\MENUEDITOR\ServiceUty.exe
IN_A8 - 1
IN_A8 - 2
CONTENTS A8
I How to Set N NOTE N
The CR-IR347-only function (for mammography) should be disabled.
(1) Set the following items in the PC-ME Property window. MFP: Multi-frequency processing DRC: Dynamic range compression processing TAS: Tomographic artifacts suppression processing PEM: Breast pattern enhancement processing (2) Click [OK]. The setup is completed.
IN_A8 - 3
CONTENTS A8
IN_A8 - 4
BLANK PAGE
IN_A8 - 3
IN_A8 - 4
IN_A9 - 1
IN_A9 - 2
BLANK PAGE
Appendix 9.
When the CR-IR341 is to be connected to the CR Console (CR-IR348CL), reference should be made to the following manual bundled. CR-IR341P/342P/343P/344P/345P/347P/348RU Common Service Manual: Procedures for Connecting with CR Console (CR-IR348CL)
IN_A9 - 1
IN_A9 - 2
Control Sheet
Control Sheet
CR-IR341P/342P/343P/344P/345P/347P/348RU
FCR5000 plus/5000R plus/5501 plus/5501D plus/5502D plus/5000MA plus/XU-D1
Issue date
04/15/2001 08/30/2001
Revision number 00 01
3
From N Step 1
1.
CL configurations
Re-Setting the Selector [Only When the Host Name of the Built-In device Is Changed]
To "N Step 2"
00000050.EPS
Checking Image Transfer Backing Up the CL Configuration Files to Floppy Disks Connecting HI-C, QA-WS, ODF, RIS, and Other Devices to the CL
4
N Step 1
After performing hardware setups, such as cable connection, perform software setups for activating the CL.
2.
IR
CL
N Step 2
ID information Image transfer CL IR Perform configuration settings on the CL and IR that are network connected in one-to-one correspondence, so that images can be transferred from the IR to the CL.
Hospital network
IDT
IR
IR
IR
IDT
G Software-related setups
OTHER IR IDT Nodes where the CL and IR are to be added
Installing the touch panel driver Installing the option keys <Note> Then, install the energy subtraction processing option key for the FCR XU-DI. Installing the AP keys Recognizing the destination (5000 Series)
N Step 3
IDT
IR
IR
IR
IDT
Configuration setting for CL system information Configuration setting for IDT and console functions Optimizing the display view Connecting and setting the barcode reader and magnetic card
ID information
Image transfer
OTHER
IR
IDT
CL
IR
HI-C655
Incorporate the CL and IR that were set in Step 2 into the hospital network. After setting the selector and distribution code, check image transfer again.
00000042.EPS
7
I Setting for the Source (CL)
(1) Click Setup Configuration Item.
3.
3.2 Setting the Selector [Only When the Built-In Device Is Connected]
3.3 Setting the CL Configuration Regarding LP Connection (Setting in CLs Service Utility)
3.1
Click first on the upper left corner and then on the upper right corner.
00000008.EPS
(3) Click
00000045.EPS
8
(7) Perform the following settings in the DICOM Setup dialog box. (4) Select in the Add Node portion and click .
VI
I II III
00000009.EPS
The Application Entity List dialog box appears. (5) Perform the following settings in the Application Entity List dialog box.
IV
V
00000011.EPS
II
I. II.
III
III. Select JPEG Lossless. IV. Select ST&HQ. When the 5000MA is connected, select ST&HQ&SH. V. Select HQ/SH. VI. If two-byte characters are to be used, check this checkbox. (8) Click .
I. Type in the Application Entity Name (DICOM_IIP) of the CL. II. Type in the Port No. (21760) of the CL. III. Select OTHER. (6) Click .
10
I Setting for the Destination (IR)
(1) Click Configuration Item dialog box.
I
11
(5) Perform the following settings in the Application Entity List dialog box.
in the Setup
(2) Click
The New Node dialog box appears. (3) Type in the host name of the IR (fcr5501-n * NOTE) in address of the IR (172.16.0.2) in . and the IP
II
00000013.EPS
I.
Type in the Application Entity Name of the IR (for example, DICOM_IR). DICOM_IR is set, by default, for every IR.
II. Select either BUILTIN or CASSETTE. 5000/5000R/5000MA 5501H/5501D/5502D/XU-D1 (6) Click . :CASSETTE :BUILTIN
00000012.EPS
N NOTE (* NOTE) N
The default host names for the respective machines are as follows. 5000/5000R/5000MA: fcr5000-n 5501/5501D/5502D/XU-D1: fcr5501-n
(4) Select
10
11
12
(7) Perform the following settings in the DICOM Setup dialog box.
13
I Setting for ID Information Exchange N NOTE N
This setting may be omitted for a cassette-based reader. If it is omitted, communication between the reader and CL operates as FINP110.
(1) Click
I II III
(host name of the destination) in the Setup Configuration Item dialog box. (2) Click
IV
I. Select PrivateUnstandardizedCRStorage. II. Select SCU. III. Select JPEG Lossless. IV. Select the film output destination. Select IIP when the LP is connected to the CL, or FCR5000 when the LP is connected to the IR.
N NOTE N
If the XU-D1 is connected, FCR5000 should not be selected in the Film Output field. The XU-D1 does not support LP output.
(8) Click
(9) Click
12
13
14
(4) Perform the following settings in the FINP Setup dialog box.
15
I Saving the Configuration and Quitting the Service Utility
(1) Choose Save from the Config (F) menu in the Setup Configuration Item dialog box.
II
00000019.EPS
(2) Click
00000016.EPS
I. Select either BUILTIN or CASSETTE. 5000/5000R/5000MA : CASSETTE 5501H/5501D/5502D/XU-D1 :BUILTIN II. Select ST&HQ. When the 5000MA is connected, select SH. III. Select ST&HQ. (5) Click .
00000020.EPS
The settings that that have been made are saved. (3) Choose Close from the Config (F) menu. Back to the Service Utility screen.
14
15
16
17
The Selector Setting dialog box appears.
3.2
II
N NOTES N
Up to 16 cassette devices and up to two built-in devices may be connected to the CL. If no device is set in the selector, the CL application will not start up. Be sure to set at least one device in the selector.
(1) Click the Selector Setting button in the Service Utility screen.
V VI III
IV
00000037.EPS
(2) Perform selector settings. I. II. III. IV. Choose an unregistered Selector tab. In the Selector 1 tab, the cassette device has been registered by default. Set the Technique Code that does not overlap with any other selector. Select the device to be added to the selector (by way of host name). Select Reader Type. 5501H/5501D/XU-D1 5502D : 5501 : 5502
00000048.EPS
To revert back to Cassette, choose a vacant item from the pull-down menu of the hostname: field. V. Type in letters to be displayed in the selector button (up to five half-width letters). VI. To make the currently edited selector initially active when the CL is started, turn ON the radio button.
16
17
18
(3) If no cassette device is connected, the selector setting for the cassette device that has been set by default should be deleted. 1. Select the Selector 1 tab. 2. Change Technique Code to -1. (4) Click .
19
3.3
Back to the Service Utility screen. (5) Click the Exit Service Utility button. The Service Utility exits to the desktop.
REFERENCE
Below is shown an example of user screen where one cassette device and one built-in device are set in the selector.
Selector
00000049.EPS
18
19
20
21
3.4
(6) Click
REFERENCE
The console display software is an application program, called Built_in Console found in Add/Remove Programs in the Control Panel.
Appendix A Uninstalling Various Applications of Reinstalling Software (RI) in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual (2) Put the first console display software floppy disk (FD) into the FD drive of the CL. (3) Double-click Setup.exe in the FD (A:\).
00000024.EPS
(4) When a message prompting you to replace the FD, put the next FD into the drive. Repeat this process for the number of FDs. Once all the data in the FDs is loaded, the Built_in Console Setup window appears. (5) Click .
Installation starts. After the installation, the following dialog box appears. (7) Click .
00000025.EPS
A window prompting you to restart the PC appears. (8) Remove the FD from the FD drive. (9) Click .
00000023.EPS
00000026.EPS
The PC is restarted.
20
21
22
23
G For 5501H/5501D/5502D/XU-D1
(1) Turn ON the powers in the following sequence. Breaker of the power distribution switchboard Breaker of the IR When the IR is booted up, a message, FUJI COMPUTED RADIOGRAPHY, appears on the IR panel. (2) Once the CL recognizes the IR, click .
3.5
Read
REOUTPUT IMAGE
SET DATE/TIME
1 2 3 4
DISPLAY CRT TEST PATTERN SET CLICK SOUND ADJUST TOUCH POINT OUTPUT MULTI-FRAME IMAGE SELECT IMAGE OUTPUT DESTINA.
U-Utility button
M-Utility screen
0. QUIT 1. ERROR LOG UTILITY 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING 3. TEST MODE 4. ELECTRICAL UTILITY 5. SCANNER UTILITY 6. MECHANICAL UTILITY 7. FILE UTILITY 8. BACKUP MEMORY 9. HV OFF 10. MENU SETTING
A B C
SP
DEL
BS
ENT
Caps
: Location to be touched
00000046.EPS
22
23
24
(3) Click once on each of the areas shown below.
25
I Setting the Configuration Files
(1) Select the 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING menu. The CONFIGURATION SETTING menu appears. >2 0.QUIT 1.SYSTEM 2.PRINT 9.ROUTING 10.NETMASKS 11.DICOM (2) Set the following four configuration files (change the bold-faced portions).
00000028.EPS
N NOTE N
Unless otherwise specified, the configuration files described below should be regarded as those for XU-D1. The contents of the configuration files vary depending on the machine. For more detail, see the Service Manual for each IR.
EQUIP file (Select 4. EQUIPMENT.) # EQUIP # # Function Hn=name [Host Name]... # # Function = DISPLAY or IDT # Host Name= HostName (Network:Hostname def. by hosts) IDT CRxxxxxxxx DISPLAY CRxxxxxxxx * CRxxxxxxxx is the host name of the CL (xxxxxxxx: CL product serial number)
N NOTE N
The host name of the CL may be identified by taking the following steps. - Settings - Control Panel in sequence. 1. Click 2. Double-click System and click the Network Identification tab. 3. Click Properties. The content of Computer name is the host name of the CL.
24
25
26
DEVICE file (Select 6. NETWORK HOST INTERFACE.) For 5000/5000R/5501/5501D/5502D/XU-D1 # DEVICE # # Host Name:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed] # Attr = DISPLAY # Protocol ID = 0200(DICOM) # System code = Hex 2 figures # Speed = Dec [Kbytes/sec] (default 8Kbytes/sec) CRxxxxxxxx:DISPLAY,0200,, * CRxxxxxxxx is the host name of the CL (xxxxxxxx: CL product serial number) For 5000MA # DEVICE # # Host Name:Attr|Attr,[Protocol ID],[System code],[Speed], # [Density Type] # Attr = DISPLAY # Protocol ID = 0200(DICOM) # System code = Hex 2 figures # Speed = Dec [Kbytes/sec] (default 8Kbytes/sec) # DensityType = Output Image Density(Default1) # 1:Standard Density or High Quality Density(Max Pixel # Spacing:100) # 2:Standard Density or High Quality Density(Max Pixel # Spacing:050) CRxxxxxxxx:DISPLAY,0200,,,2*NOTE * CRxxxxxxxx is the host name of the CL (xxxxxxxx: CL product serial number) (*NOTE) Output density 1:Standard Density or High Quality Density (supported for up to 10 pixel/mm) 2:Standard Density or High Quality Density (supported for up to 10 pixel/mm) HOSTS file (Select 7. HOSTS ADDRESS.) # HOSTS # # Host Name = Max 10 characters #(Available Character:a-z 0-9' -[37chars]) # IP Addr Host Name 172.16.0.1 fcr55es 172.16.0.2 fcr55es-n 172.16.1.20 CRxxxxxxxx * CRxxxxxxxx is the host name of the CL (xxxxxxxx: CL product serial number)
27
Base on DICOM file (Select 11. DICOM.) # DICOM # # HostName,ServiceName:AEName,[PortNo.],[SOPType], # [CompType],[Timeout1],[Timeout2],[DensityType] # HostName = Host name defined by hosts & device # ServiceName = STORAGE_U or STORAGE_P # AEName = Application Entity Name defined by DICOM # (Max 16 ascii characters) # PortNo. = TCP Port Number connected to # Dicom application(100:default). # SOPType = SOP Class Type # 1:Fuji Private,2:OEM Private # CompType = Compression Type # 0:No(Implicit little endian),1:JPEG # Timeout1 = connect/recv command Timeout [sec] (0:endless) # Timeout2 = Every Image Trans. Timeout [sec] (0:endless) # DensityType = Output Image Density # 0:Standard Density # 1:Standard Density or High Quality Density # Which Density is to be chosen depends on ID Information. # ex) # fcr5501-n ,STORAGE_U :DPR_DICOM,,2,1,100,600,1 # dest-1 ,STORAGE_P :DPR_DICOM,21760,2,1,100,600,1 fcr55es-n,STORAGE_U:DICOM_IR,,1,1,100,600,1 CRxxxxxxxx,STORAGE_P:DICOM_IIP,21760,1,1,100,600,1 * CRxxxxxxxx is the host name of the CL (xxxxxxxx: CL product serial number)
REFERENCE
When the 5000MA is connected, set as follows. fcr5000-n,STORAGE_U:DICOM_IR,,1,1,100,600,1 CRxxxxxxxx,STORAGE_P:DICOM_IIP,21760,1,1,100,600,2*NOTE (*NOTE) Output density 0: Standard Density 1: Standard Density or High Quality Density (supported for up to 10 pixel/mm) 2: Standard Density or High Quality Density(supported for up to 20 pixel/mm)
(3) Press the RESET switch of the IR. The IR is rebooted.
26
27
28
29
I Reading the IP and Film Output to the LP G For 5000/5000R/5000MA
(1) Use the barcode reader to register the IP barcode and set the cassette into the IR. The image read is transferred to the CL.
3.6
Click first on the left corner and then on the right corner.
00000047.EPS
(2) Type in the patient data and exposure menu in the user screen (examination receipt) of the CL, and click .
Patient data Exposure menu
Image read
00000030.EPS
(2) Click
00000029.EPS
28
29
30
G For 5501H/5501D/5502D/XU-D1
(1) Send a shot signal to read an image of the IP. The image read is transferred to the CL. (1) Click on the upper right corner of the screen. The menus appear. (2) While holding down the <SHIFT> key, click The CL-AP exits to the desktop. .
31
I Quitting the CL-AP
Image read
00000030.EPS
(2) Click
30
31
32
33
3.7
3.8
No setup IR IR
00000054.EPS
(2) Set the CL configuration. The settings to be made are as follows. IR host name, IP address Application Entity name, service class, etc. Information on FINP for exchange of ID information I Setting for the Destination (IR) and I Setting for ID Information Exchange in 3.1 Setting the CL Configuration Regarding IR Connection (Setting in CLs Service Utility) (3) For the built-in device, perform selector setting. 3.2 Setting the Selector [Only When the Built-In Device Is Connected] (4) Set the IR configuration. The settings to be made are as follows. EQUIP file setting DEVICE file setting HOSTS file setting Base on DICOM file setting 3.5 Setting the IR Configuration Regarding CL Connection (Setting in M-Utility) (5) Check image transfer. 3.6 Checking Image Transfer (6) If there is a third IR, repeat steps (1) through (5). Thats all there is to Step 2. Perform image parameter transfer setting described in 3.8 Image Processing Parameter Transfer Setting, as needed.
32
33
34
35
4.
4.2
N NOTE N
4.3 Re-Setting the Selector
The procedures described in this section should be performed for items that need to be changed. For the network information that need not be changed, the values that have been set in Step 2 should be used as they are. For example, when the CL and IR are incorporated into the hospital network as illustrated below, the network information to be changed are: Subnet mask; CL IP address; and IR host name and IP address. In this scenario, the configurations should be changed with reference to the following, which are described in detail later. I Subnet Mask, CL/IR Host Name, CL/IR IP Address [Changing the M-Utility] I IR Host Name, IR IP Address [Changing the Service Utility] I Subnet Mask, CL IP Address [Changing Network Settings in Windows 2000]
N Example of Participation into the Hospital Network
Hospital network (subnet mask: 255.255.255.0)
N NOTE N
If multiple CLs are to be connected to a single 5000 cassette-based reader, the procedures described in the following reference should be performed together with the procedures described in the above work flow. Appendix 1. Setup for Connecting Multiple CLs to a Single 5000 Cassette-based Reader If the 5000plus system is to be added in the hospital network where the IDT-IV and CL already exist, the procedures set forth in the following reference should be performed, in addition to the work flow described above. Appendix 2. Setting for Adding the 5000plus System in the Network where the IDT-IV Exists
IDT
IR
IR
100.150.100.3 CR5502D
IR
IDT
OTHER
IR
IDT
100.150.100.8 IDT-4
CL
172.16.1.20 CRxxxxxxxx
IR
172.16.0.2 fcr5501-n
HI-C655
100.150.100.9 HIC-1
4.1
34
35
36
I Subnet Mask, CL/IR Host Name, CL/IR IP Address [Changing the M-Utility]
(1) Start the M-Utility and modify the configuration files in 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING. I Starting the M-Utility in 3.5 Setting the IR Configuration Regarding CL Connection (Setting in M-Utility) Modify the configuration(s) marked by a circle, depending on the network information changed.
Network information changed IR config SYSTEM EQUIPMENT NETWORK HOST INTERFACE HOSTS ADDRESS NETMASKS DICOM
00000041.EPS
37
I CL/IR Application Entity Name, CL Port No. [Changing the M-Utility]
(1) Start the M-Utility and change the 11. DICOM configuration file in 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING. I Starting the M-Utility in 3.5 Setting the IR Configuration Regarding CL Connection (Setting in M-Utility) Example of change: IR Application Entity name: DICOM_IR CL Application Entity name: DICOM_IIP CRXUD1_02_U CL_02_P
IR host name
IR IP address
CL host name
CL IP address
Subnet mask
Port No.: 21760 10113 # fcr5501-n ,STORAGE_U :DPR_DICOM,,2,1,100,600,1 # dest-1 ,STORAGE_P :DPR_DICOM,21760,2,1,100,600,1 fcr5501-n,STORAGE_U:DICOM_IR,,1,1,100,600,1 CRxxxxxxxx,STORAGE_P:DICOM_IIP,21760,1,1,100,600,1 Changed # fcr5501-n ,STORAGE_U :DPR_DICOM,,2,1,100,600,1 # dest-1 ,STORAGE_P :DPR_DICOM,21760,2,1,100,600,1 fcr5501-n,STORAGE_U:CRXUD1_02_U,,1,1,100,600,1 CRxxxxxxxx,STORAGE_P:CL_02_P,10113,1,1,100,600,1
N NOTES N
The SYSTEM configuration should be set in the 2. SYSTEM menu of 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING in the M-Utility. For the IP address setting in 2. SYSTEM of 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING in the M-Utility, the IP address on the CPU90F board side (IPI: IP Address (CPU90F)) should be changed. The NETMASK configuration should be set in the 7. NETMASK menu of 2. CONFIGURATION SETTING in the M-Utility.
(2) If there are multiple IRs, change the IR configuration for the second and third IRs in a similar manner to step (1).
REFERENCE
If a second CL is to be connected to a single 5000 cassette-based reader, the following line should be described (example: host name is CL-a, AE name is CL_a_SCP, and port number is 10114). fcr5000-n,STORAGE_U:CR5000_02_U,,1,1,100,600,1 CRxxxxxxxx,STORAGE_P:CL_02_P,10113,1,1,100,600,1 Description for the second CL CL-a,STORAGE_P:CL_a_SCP,10114,1,1,100,600,1
N NOTE N
Be sure to modify the IR configuration before the CL configuration. If the CL configuration (IP address) were changed first, the IR would be lost.
(3) Once the configuration file has been modified, restart the IR.
(2) If there are multiple IRs, change the IR configuration for the second and third IRs in a similar manner to step (1).
N NOTE N
Be sure to modify the IR configuration before the CL configuration. If the CL configuration (IP address) were changed first, the IR would be lost.
(3) Once the configuration file has been modified, restart the IR.
009-064-01 08.30.2001 FM3145
36
37
38
I CL Host Name [Changing the Service Utility]
Appendix B Changing the CL Host Name of Reinstalling the Software (RI) in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual (4) Select and click .
39
N NOTE N
Changing the CL host name involves complicated procedures, such as reinstalling the MSDE. Be sure to observe the procedures described in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual to change the CL host name.
00000032.EPS
(2) Double-click
The Local Area Connection Status dialog box appears. (3) Click .
00000020.EPS
38
39
40
(5) Make sure that subnet mask. is selected, and change the IP address or
41
I IR Host Name, IR IP Address [Changing the Service Utility]
(1) Start the Service Utility of the CL. 1. Procedures for Starting and Quitting the Service Utility of Maintenance Utility (MU) in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual (2) Click the Setup Configuration Item button. The Setup Configuration Item dialog box appears. (3) Click (IR host name).
The right side of the dialog box switches to Host Name. (4) Change the host name or IP address.
00000033.EPS
(6) Click
IR host name
Back to the Local Area Connection Properties dialog box. (7) Click Close. Back to the desktop. (8) Close the Network and Dial-up Connections window.
IR IP address
00000034.EPS
(5) Click
and choose Save from the Config menu to save the setting.
40
41
42
I CL Application Entity Name, CL Port No. [Changing the Service Utility]
(1) Start the Service Utility of the CL. 1. Procedures for Starting and Quitting the Service Utility of Maintenance Utility (MU) in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual (2) Click the Setup Configuration Item button. The Setup Configuration Item dialog box appears. (3) Click (CL Application Entity name). The right side of the dialog box switches to DICOM Setup (4) Change the Application Entity name or Port No.
43
I IR Application Entity Name [Changing the Service Utility]
(1) Start the Service Utility of the CL. 1. Procedures for Starting and Quitting the Service Utility of Maintenance Utility (MU) in the CR-IR346/348CL Service Manual (2) Click the Setup Configuration Item button. The Setup Configuration Item dialog box appears. (3) Click (IR host name) Application Entity name). The right side of the dialog box switches to DICOM Setup (4) Change the Application Entity name. (IR
Port No.
00000035.EPS
00000036.EPS
(5) Click
and choose Save from the Config menu to save the setting. (5) Click and choose Save from the Config menu to save the setting.
42
43
44
45
(3) Perform selector setting.
4.3
N NOTE N
If the host name of the built-in device has been changed, be sure to re-set the selector. If the CL-AP is started without re-setting the selector, an error (code: 31099) will occur.
II
(1) Start the Service Utility of the CL. (2) Click the Selector Setting button.
00000051.EPS
00000048.EPS
I. Select the tab where the built-in device has been registered. II. Because this field is vacant, choose the host name of the built-in device. (4) Click .
Back to the Service Utility screen. (5) Click the Exit Service Utility button. The Service Utility exits to the desktop.
44
45
46
47
4.4
4.5
4.6
46
47
48
49
G Patient information share function
The patient information share function is intended to share ID information among the ID registered devices (CL and IDT-IV units). Upon inquiry about ID information from the reader, if the patient information of interest is not found in the CL, it makes an inquiry to another CL or IDT-IV where sharing setup has been done to receive the ID information, and returns a notification to the reader regarding where the ID information of interest is found. This setting should always be made if multiple CLs are to be connected to a single 5000 cassette-based reader.
Equipment file : . IDT CL-a : . 5000-based cassette reader (6) ID information return (3) ID information inquiry
Appendix 1. Setup for Connecting Multiple CLs to a Single 5000 Cassette-based Reader
If multiple CLs are to be connected to a single 5000 cassette-based reader, it is necessary to set the distribution code and patient information share function, in addition to the configuration settings required to exchange image and ID information. Procedures for setting the distribution code and patient information share function are described here.
1.1
General Description
G Distribution code
The distribution code is set to determine in which CL the image read by the reader is registered for identification. Unless the distribution code is set, an image-sending CL cannot be identified, so that transmission cannot be done.
Distribution code setup file : CL-a 5000-CLa CL-b 5000-CLb : 5000-based cassette reader
(2) Reading
CL-a (5000-CLa)
CL-b (5000-CLb)
(1) ID registration
(2) Reading
CL-a (5000-CLa)
CL-b (5000-CLb)
(1) ID registration
Data flow (1) On the CL-b, the ID information and cassette barcode are registered. (2) The cassette is set on the reader to read image data. (3) The reader transmits image data according to the distribution code setup file.
00000040.EPS
Data flow (1) On the CL-b, the ID information is registered. (2) The cassette is set on the reader to read image data. (3) The CL-a is inquired about ID information. (4) Because no ID Information is found in the CL-a, CL-b is inquired about ID information where sharing setup has been done. (5) The ID information is returned to the CL-a. (6) The ID information is returned to the reader.
00000056.EPS
In the example of the illustration (distribution code) on the previous page, an inquiry about ID information is made first to the CL-a, and the distribution code of the CL-b is communicated to the reader via the CL-a.
48
49
50
51
G Patient information sharing setup
(1) Start the Service Utility of the CL. (2) Click the Setup Configuration Item button. A Setup Configuration Item window opens. (3) Click .
1.2
Setup Procedures
N NOTE N
The setup procedures described here presumes that the procedures described in 3. Step 2 <Temporary Installation> have been completed.
The right side of the window switches to the CONFIG\IDT CONNECTING screen. (4) Click .
00000038.EPS
The right side of the dialog box switches to the IDT and console information configuration screen.
field.
N NOTES N
The distribution code should be within 8 characters in length. The distribution code should be set so that it does not overlap within the same network.
50
51
52
(5) Perform the following settings.
53
G Example of CL (CL-a and CL-b) setup N NOTE N
II
III
IV
V
00000064.EPS
00000061.EPS
I. Type in the host name for the host where sharing setup is made. II. Type in the IP address. III. Select the attribute of the device. IV. Set GroupName.
N NOTE N
If GroupName is set for the first time, type in GroupName by use of a keyboard, since there is no entry in the GroupName field.
V. To set this device as a GateWay device, check the box ( ).
N NOTE N
If patient information is to be shared among different groups, it is necessary to set one GateWay device for each group (check the box).
REFERENCES
Up to five IDT units may be specified in the IDT CL-a... setup item. When IDT CL-a CL-b CL-c is set, an inquiry about ID information is made to the host that is described first (in this case, CL-a). Only if communication with that host fails due to power-OFF and so forth, an inquiry about ID information is made to the host that is described next.
(6) Click
(7) To continue setup for another CL, repeat steps (4) through (6). (8) In the Config (F) menu, save the setup that has been done.
52
53
54
(2) Delete the DISPLAY attribute setting.
55
1.3
N NOTE N
If the distribution code is used, the DISPLAY attribute setting should always be deleted.
# EQUIP # # Function Hn=name [Host Name]... # # Function = DISPLAY or IDT # Host Name= HostName (Network:Hostname def. by hosts) IDT CL-a CL-b Delete DISPLAY CL-a
G DEVICE file
CL-a:DISPLAY,0200,, CL-b:DISPLAY,0200,,
G HOSTS file
172.16.0.1 IR-1 172.16.1.10 CL-a 172.16.1.20 CL-b
54
55
56
G Codedstb file
5000-CLa 5000-CLb
57
G Codedstb file
5000-CLa 5000-CLb 5000-CLc
CL-a CL-b
G DEVICE file
CL-a:DISPLAY,0200,, CL-b:DISPLAY,0200,, CL-c:DISPLAY,0200,,
G HOSTS file
172.16.0.1 IR-1 172.16.1.10 CL-a 172.16.1.20 CL-b 172.16.1.30 CL-c
56
57
PC - 1
PC - 1
PC - 2
PC - 3
+15Va: (Specified value: +14.5V to +15.5V) Record initial voltage measured _____ -15Va: (Specified value: -15.5V to -14.5V) Record initial voltage measured _____ 6.8 Clearing Backup Memory 6.9 Setting Date and Time 7.1 Installing Configuration File 7.2 Editing Configuration Files 7.3 Backing Up Configuration File 7.4 Resetting Machine 8.1 Checking IP Conveyance in M-Utility 8.2 Reinstalling Covers 8.3 Final Placement 8.4 Checks after Machine Startup 8.5 Checking Interface Operation 8.6 Checking Image and Adjusting Image Requirements Check for the image quality ST: Exposure: _____ mR S value: _____ Check for the shading Check for the artifact Pass Pass Pass Pass Pass Leave the final film at the customer site 8.7 Checking and Deleting Error Logs That Occur during Setup Software Version: _____ 8.8 Checking Machine Shutdown 8.9 Cleaning Covers 8.10 Attachment of Labels Summary Test Pass/Fail Fail Fail Fail Fail Fail Adjusted voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____
Installation Information
CR-IR341/341P Serial Number: __________ Site Name: __________ Site Number: __________ Room Number: __________ Software Ver.: __________ Installed by: __________ Signature: __________ Date Completed: __________
Checklist
2 Determination of System Configuration 3 Determination of Configuration Information 4 Preparation for Installation Environment 5 Temporary Placement 5.2 Checking the Items Supplied 6 Installation 6.1 Work Flow 6.2 Unclamping and Installing Separate Packaged Items (Except for Boards) 6.2.4 Procedures at Side-Positioning Conveyor, Subscanning Unit, and Power Supply Unit Record resistance value measured_____ 6.3 Setting and Installing Boards 6.4 Cable Wiring Diagram 6.5 Preparations for Power ON 6.6 Turning ON the Power 6.7 Measuring and Adjusting Voltage Meet Specifications +5V: (Specified value: +5.1V to +5.3V) Record initial voltage measured _____ +12V: (Specified value: +12.0V to +12.6V) Record initial voltage measured _____ +15V: (Specified value: +14.5V to +15.5V) Record initial voltage measured _____ +24V1: (Specified value: +23.0V to +25.0V) Record initial voltage measured _____ +24V2: (Specified value: +23.0V to +25.0V) Record initial voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____ Adjusted voltage measured _____
Test equipment: _____ Model: _____ Serial: _____ Calibration Due: _____ Test equipment: _____ Model: _____ Serial: _____ Calibration Due: _____ Test equipment: _____ Model: _____ Serial: _____ Calibration Due: _____ Test equipment: _____ Model: _____ Serial: _____ Calibration Due: _____
PC - 2
PC - 3